General
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
010-2
How to Use This Manual
WARNING!
Your common sense and good
judgment are crucial to safe and
successful service work. Read
procedures through before starting
them. Think about whether the
condition of your car, your level of
mechanical skill, or your level of
reading comprehension might result
in or contribute in some way to an
occurrence that might cause you
injury, damage your car, or result in
an unsafe repair. If you have doubts
for these or other reasons about your
ability to perform safe repair work on
your car, have the work done at an
authorized BMW dealer or other
qualified shop.
The manual is divided into ten sections:
0 GENERAL DATA AND
MAINTENANCE
1 ENGINE
2 TRANSMISSION
3 SUSPENSION, STEERING AND
BRAKES
4 BODY
5 BODY EQUIPMENT
6 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
7 EQUIPMENT AND
ACCESSORIES
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
ELE ELECTRICAL WIRING
DIAGRAMS
OBD ON BOARD DIAGNOSTICS
0 GENERAL DATA AND
MAINTENANCE covers general vehicle
information (Repair Group 010) as well
as the recommended maintenance
schedules and service procedures to
perform BMW scheduled maintenance
work (Repair Group 020).
The next seven sections (Repair
Groups 1 through 7) are repair based
and organized by three digit repair
groups. Most major sections begin with
a General repair group, e.g. 100
Engine–General. These “00” (double
zero) groups are mostly descriptive in
nature, covering topics such as theory
of operation and troubleshooting. The
remainder of the repair groups contain
the service and repair information. The
last two major sections contains
detailed electrical wiring schematics
and scan tool codes.
A master listing of the individual repair
groups can be found on the inside
front cover. A comprehensive index can
be found at the back of the manual.
Warnings, cautions and notes
Throughout this manual are many
passages with the headings
WARNING, CAUTION, or NOTE. These
very important headings have different
meanings.
WARNING!
The text under this heading warns of
unsafe practices that are very likely
to cause injury, either by direct
threat to the person(s) performing
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
the work or by increased risk of
accident or mechanical failure while
driving.
CAUTION!
A caution calls attention to important
precautions to be observed during
the repair work that will help prevent
accidentally damaging the car or its
parts.
Note:
A note contains helpful information, tips
that will help in doing a better job and
completing it more easily.
Please read every WARNING,
CAUTION, and NOTE at the front of
the manual and as they appear in
repair procedures. They are very
important. Read them before you begin
any maintenance or repair job.
WARNING!
Never run the engine in the work
area unless it is well-ventilated.
The exhaust should be vented to
the outside. Carbon monoxide
(CO) in the exhaust kills.
Remove all neckties, scarfs,
loose clothing, or jewelry when
working near running engines or
power tools. Tuck in shirts. Tie
long hair and secure it under a
cap. Severe injury can result
from these things being caught
in rotating parts.
Remove rings, watches, and
bracelets. Aside from the
dangers of moving parts,
metallic jewelry conducts
electricity and may cause
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
shorts, sparks, burns, or
damage to the electrical system
when accidentally contacting
the battery or other electrical
terminals.
Disconnect the battery negative
(–) cable whenever working on
or near the fuel system or
anything that is electrically
powered. Accidental electrical
contact may damage the
electrical system or cause a fire.
Fuel is highly flammable. When
working around fuel, do not
smoke or work near heaters or
other fire hazards. Keep an
approved fire extinguisher
handy.
The fuel system is designed to
retain pressure even when the
ignition is off. When working
with the fuel system, loosen the
fuel lines slowly to allow the
residual pressure to dissipate
gradually. Take precautions to
avoid spraying fuel.
Illuminate the work area
adequately and safely. Use a
portable safety light for working
inside or under the car. A
fluorescent type light is best
because it gives off less heat. If
using a light with a normal
incandescent bulb, use rough
service bulbs to avoid breakage.
The hot filament of an
accidentally broken bulb can
ignite spilled fuel or oil.
Keep sparks, lighted matches,
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
and any open flame away from
the top of the battery. Hydrogen
gas emitted by the battery is
highly flammable. Any nearby
source of ignition may cause the
battery to explode.
Never lay tools or parts in the
engine compartment or on top
of the battery. They may fall into
confined spaces and be difficult
to retrieve, become caught in
belts or other rotating parts
when the engine is started, or
cause electrical shorts and
damage to the electrical system.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
010-3
Getting Started
Most of the necessary maintenance
and minor repair that an automobile will
need can be done with ordinary tools.
Below is some important information on
how to work safely, a discussion of
what tools will be needed and how to
use them.
Safety
Although an automobile presents many
hazards, common sense and good
equipment can help ensure safety.
Many accidents happen because of
carelessness. Pay attention and stick
to safety rules in this manual.
Lifting the car
The proper jacking points should be
used to raise the car safely and avoid
damage. The jack supplied with the car
can only be used at the four side
points (arrows)—just behind the front
wheels or just in front of the rear
wheels.
WARNING!
Never work under a lifted car
unless it is solidly supported on
jack stands that are intended for
that purpose.
When raising the car using a
floor jack or a hydraulic lift,
carefully position the jack pad to
prevent damaging the car body.
Plastic pads are provided for
this purpose by the
manufacturer at the jacking
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
points.
Watch the jack closely. Make
sure it stays stable and does not
shift or tilt. As the car is raised,
it may roll slightly and the jack
may shift.
Raising car safely
-
Park car on flat, level surface.
-
If changing a tire, loosen lug bolts
before rasing car. See
Changing a tire.
Place jack into position. Make sure jack
is resting on flat, solid ground. Use a
board or other support to provide a firm
surface for the jack, if necessary
-
Raise car slowly while constantly
checking position of jack and car.
-
Once car is raised, block wheel
that is opposite and farthest from
jack to prevent car from
unexpectedly rolling.
WARNING!
Do not rely on the transmission
or the emergency brake to keep
the car from rolling. They are
not a substitute for positively
blocking the opposite wheel.
Never work under a car that is
supported only by a jack. Use
jack stands that are designed to
support the car. See
Tools.
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Working under car safely
-
Disconnect negative (–) cable from
battery so that no one can start
car. Let others know what you will
be doing.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Raise car slowly as described
above.
-
Use at least two jack stands to
support car. Use jack stands
designed for the purpose of
supporting a car. For more
information on jack stands, see
Tools.
WARNING!
A jack is a temporary lifting
device and should not be used
alone to support the car while
you are under it.
Do not use wood, concrete
blocks, or bricks to support a
car. Wood may split. Blocks or
bricks, while strong, are not
designed for that kind of load,
and may break or collapse.
-
Place jack stands on firm, solid
surface. If necessary, use a flat
board or similar solid object to
provide a firm footing.
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
-
Lower car slowly until its weight is
fully supported by jack stands.
Watch to make sure that the jack
stands do not tip or lean as the
car settles on them.
-
Observe all jacking precautions
again when raising car to remove
jack stands.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:07 PM
General
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
010-4
Advice for the Beginner
The tips in the paragraphs that follow are
general advice to help any do-it-yourself
BMW owner perform repairs and
maintenance tasks more easily and more
professionally.
Planning ahead
To prevent getting in too deep, know what
the whole job requires before starting. Read
the procedure thoroughly, from beginning to
end, in order to know just what to expect and
what parts will have to be replaced.
Cleanliness
Keeping things organized, neat, and clean is
essential to doing a good job. When working
under the hood, fender covers will protect
the finish from scratches and other damage.
Make sure the car finish is clean so that dirt
under the cover does not scratch the finish.
Any repair job will be less troublesome if the
parts are clean. For cleaning old parts, there
are many solvents and parts cleaners
commercially available.
For cleaning parts prior to assembly,
commercially available aerosol cans of parts
cleaner or brake cleaner are handy to use,
and the cleaner will evaporate completely.
WARNING!
Most solvents used for cleaning parts are
highly flammable as well as toxic,
especially in aerosol form. Use with
extreme care. Do not smoke. Do not use
these products indoors or near any source
of heat, sparks or flame.
Non-reusable fasteners
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Many fasteners used on the cars covered by
this manual must be replaced with new ones
once they are removed. These include but
are not limited to: bolts, nuts (self-locking,
nylock, etc.), cotter pins, studs, brake
fittings, roll pins, clips and washers. Genuine
BMW parts should be the only replacement
parts used for this purpose.
Some bolts are designed to stretch during
assembly and are permanently altered
rendering them unreliable once removed.
These are known as torque-to-yield
fasteners. Always replace fasteners where
instructed to do so. Failure to replace these
fasteners could cause vehicle damage and
personal injury. See an authorized BMW
dealer for applications and ordering
information.
Tightening fasteners
When tightening the bolts or nuts that attach
a component, it is always good practice to
tighten the bolts gradually and evenly to
avoid misalignment or over stressing any one
portion of the component. For components
sealed with gaskets, this method helps to
ensure that the gasket will seal properly.
Where there are several fasteners, tighten
them in a sequence alternating between
opposite sides of the component. Repeat the
sequence until all the bolts are evenly
tightened to the proper specification.
For some repairs a specific tightening
sequence is necessary, or a particular order
of assembly is required. Such special
conditions are noted in the text, and the
necessary sequence is described or
illustrated. Where no specific torque is
listed,
Table a can be used as a general
guide for tightening fasteners.
WARNING!
Table a is a general reference only. The
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
values listed in the table are not intended
to be used as a substitute for torques
specifically called out in the text.
Note:
Metric bolt classes or grades are
marked on the bolt head.
Do not confuse wrench size with bolt
diameter. For a listing of the common
wrenches used on various bolt
diameters, see
Basic tool
requirements.
Table a. General bolt tightening torques
in Nm (max. permissible)
Bolt
Bolt Class (according to DIN
diameter 267)
5.6
5.8
6.8
8.8
10.9 12.9
M5
2.5
3.5
4.5
6
8
10
M6
4.5
6
7.5
10
14
17
M8
11
15
18
24
34
40
M10
23
30
36
47
66
79
M12
39
52
62
82
115
140
M14
62
82
98
130 180
220
M16
94
126 150 200 280
340
M18
130 174 210 280 390
470
Gaskets and seals
Gaskets are designed to crush and become
thinner as the mating parts are bolted
together. Once a gasket has been used, it is
no longer capable of making as good a seal
as when new, and is much more likely to
leak. For this reason, gaskets should not be
reused.
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Some gaskets—such as head gaskets—are
directional. Make sure that these are
installed correctly. This same logic applies to
any part used for sealing, including rubber
O-rings and copper sealing washers.
In places where a shaft must pass through a
housing, flexible lip seals are used to keep
the lubricating oil or grease from leaking out
past the rotating shaft. Seals should never
be reused once they have been removed.
When removing a seal, be careful not to
damage the metal surfaces.
The key to seal installation is to get the seal
in straight without damaging it. Use a seal
driver that is the same diameter as the seal
housing to gently and evenly install into
place. If a proper size seal driver is not
available, a socket of the right size will do.
Some seals are directional and special
installation instructions apply. Make sure a
seal is installed with the lip facing the correct
way. Note the installation direction of the old
seal before removing it.
Electrical testing
Many electrical problems can be understood
and solved with only a little fundamental
knowledge of how electrical circuits function.
Electric current only flows in a complete
circuit. To operate, every electrical device in
the car requires a complete circuit including
a voltage source and a path to ground. The
positive (+) side of the battery is the original
voltage source, and ground is any return
path to the negative (–) side of the battery,
whether through the wiring harness or the
car body. Except for portions of the charging
system, all electrical current in the car is
direct current (DC) and flows from positive
(+) to negative (–).
Switches are used to turn components on or
off by completing or interrupting the circuit. A
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
switch is “open” when the circuit is
interrupted, and “closed” when the circuit is
completed. See
600 Electrical System–
General for electrical troubleshooting.
Wire repairs
Repairs to a wiring harness require special
care to make the repair permanent. The wire
ends must be clean. If frayed or otherwise
damaged, cut off the end. If the wire is too
short, splice in a new piece of wire of the
same size and make two connections.
Use connectors that are designed for the
purpose. Crimped-on or soldered-on
connectors are best. Crimp connectors and
special crimping pliers are widely available. If
soldering, use needlenose pliers to hold the
wire near the solder joint and create a “heat
dam”. This keeps the heat and the solder
from traveling up the wire. Always use a
solder made specifically for electrical work
(rosin core).
Note:
Twisting wires together to make a repair is
not recommended. Corrosion and vibration
will eventually spoil the connection and may
lead to irreparable damage to sensitive
electronic components.
Insulate the finished connection. Electronics
stores can supply heat-shrinkable insulating
tubing that can be placed onto the wire
before connecting, slid over the finished
joint, and shrunk to a tight fit with a heat gun
or hair dryer. The next best alternative is
electrical tape. Make sure the wire is clean
and free of solder flux or other
contamination. Wrap the joint tightly to seal
out moisture. See
600 Electrical System–
General for more information.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
010-5
Buying Parts
Many of the maintenance and repair
tasks in this manual call for the
installation of new parts, or the use of
new gaskets and other materials when
reinstalling parts. Most often, the parts
that will be needed should be on hand
before beginning the job. Read the
introductory text and the complete
procedure to determine which parts will
be needed.
Note:
For some bigger jobs, partial
disassembly and inspection are
required to determine a complete parts
list. Read the procedure carefully and, if
necessary, make other arrangements to
get the necessary parts while your car
is disassembled.
Genuine BMW parts
Genuine BMW replacement parts from
an authorized BMW dealer are
designed and manufactured to the
same high standards as the original
parts. They will be the correct material,
manufactured to the same
specifications, and guaranteed to fit
and work as intended by the engineers
who designed the car. Some genuine
BMW parts have a limited warranty.
Many independent repair shops make
a point of using genuine BMW parts,
even though they may at times be
more expensive. They know the value
of doing the job right with the right
parts. Parts from other sources can be
as good, particularly if manufactured
by one of BMWs original equipment
suppliers, but it is often difficult to
know.
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
BMW is constantly updating and
improving their cars, often making
improvements during a given model
year. BMW may recommend a newer,
improved part as a replacement, and
your authorized dealer’s parts
department will know about it and
provide it. The BMW parts organization
is best equipped to deal with any BMW
parts needs.
Non-returnable parts
Some parts cannot be returned, even
for credit. The best example is
electrical parts, which are almost
universally considered non-returnable.
Buy electrical parts carefully, and be as
sure as possible that a replacement is
needed, especially for expensive parts
such as electronic control units. It may
be wise to let an authorized BMW
dealer or other qualified shop confirm
your diagnosis before replacing an
expensive non-returnable part.
Information you need to know
Model. When ordering parts it is
important that you know the correct
model designation for your car. Models
covered in this E46 manual are 323i/Ci,
325i/Ci, 325Xi, 328i/Ci, 330i/Ci 330Xi in
Sedan, Coupe, Convertible and Sport
Wagon body styles.
Model year. This is not necessarily the
same as date of manufacture or date of
sale. A 1999 model may have been
manufactured in late 1998, and
perhaps not sold until early 2000. It is
still a 1999 model. Model years covered
by this manual are 1999 to 2001.
Date of manufacture. This information
is necessary when ordering
replacement parts or determining if any
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
of the warranty recalls are applicable to
your car. The label on the driver’s door
below the door latch will specify the
month and year that the car was built.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
This is a combination of letters and
numbers that identify the particular car.
The VIN appears on the state
registration document, and on the car
itself. One location is on the right front
strut tower in the engine compartment
(arrow), another in the lower left corner
of the windshield.
Engine code. 3 Series cars covered in
this manual are powered by 6-cylinder
engines. For information on engine
codes and engine applications, see
100 Engine–General.
Transmission code. The transmission
type with its identifying code may be
important when buying clutch parts,
seals, gaskets, and other transmissionrelated parts. For information on
transmission codes and applications,
see
200 Transmission–General.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:08 PM
General
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
010-7
Tools
Most maintenance can be
accomplished with a small selection of
the right tools. Tools range in quality
from inexpensive junk, which may
break at first use, to very expensive
and well-made tools for the
professional. The best tools for most
do-it-yourself BMW owners lie
somewhere in between.
Many reputable tool manufacturers
offer good quality, moderately priced
tools with a lifetime guarantee. These
are your best buy. They cost a little
more, but they are good quality tools
that will do what is expected of them.
Sears’ Craftsman® line is one such
source of good quality tools.
Some of the repairs covered in this
manual require the use of special tools,
such as a custom puller or specialized
electrical test equipment. These special
tools are called out in the text and can
be purchased through an authorized
BMW dealer. As an alternative, some
special tools mentioned may be
purchased from the following tool
manufacturers and/or distributors:
Assenmacher Specialty Tools
6440 Odell Place, Boulder, CO
80301
303-530-2424
http://www.asttool.com
Baum Tools Unlimited, Inc.
P.O. Box 5867, Sarasota, FL
34277-5867
800-848-6657
http://www.baumtools.com
Schley Products, Inc.
5350 E. Hunter Ave., Anaheim Hills,
CA 92807
714-693-7666
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
http://www.sptool.com
Zelenda Machine and Tool Corp.
65-60 Austin Street, Forest Hills, NY
11374-4695
718-896-2288
http://www.zelenda.com
Basic tool requirements
The basic hand tools described below
can be used to accomplish most of the
simple maintenance and repair tasks.
Screwdrivers. The common flat-blade
type and the Phillips type will handle
almost all screws used on BMWs. Two
or three different sizes of each type will
be required, since a screwdriver of the
wrong size will damage the screw
head.
A complete set of screwdrivers should
also include Torx® type screwdrivers.
Wrenches. Wrenches come in different
styles, including open-end, 12-point
box-end, 6-point box-end and flare nut.
The basic open-end wrench is the most
widely used, but grips on only two
sides. The box-end wrench has better
grip on all six sides of a nut or bolt.
A 12-point box-end can loosen a nut or
bolt where there is less room for
movement, while a 6-point box-end
provides better grip. For hex fasteners
on fluid lines, like brake lines and fuel
lines, a flare-nut wrench offers the
advantages of a box-end wrench with a
slot that allows it to fit over the line.
The combination wrench is the most
universal. It has one open-end and one
box-end. 10 mm and 13 mm wrenches
are the most common sizes needed. A
more complete set of wrenches would
include 6 mm through 19 mm sizes.
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Sockets. Sockets are used with a
ratchet handle for speed and
convenience and can be combined with
extensions and universal joints
(swivels) to reach fasteners more
easily. The most common drive sizes
are 1/4 in., 3/8 in., and 1/2 in.
Sockets come in 6-point and 12-point
styles. The 6-point offers a better grip
on tight nuts and bolts. 6mm to 19mm
sockets are the most needed sizes.
Below is a list of typical bolt diameters
and the corresponding wrench sizes.
Common bolt diameters and
wrench sizes
M5
8 mm
M6
10 mm
M8
12 mm or 13 mm
M10
17 mm
M12
19 mm
M14
22 mm
Spark plug socket. A special socket for
spark plugs is the correct size, is deep
enough to accommodate a spark plug’s
length, and includes a rubber insert to
both protect the spark plug from
damage and grip it for easier removal.
Pliers. There are many types of pliers
including snap-ring, needlenose,
adjustable-joint, slip-joint
(Channellock®), and locking (ViseGrip®) most of which are used for
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
holding irregular objects, bending, or
crimping. Some have special
applications.
Needlenose pliers are used for gripping
small and poorly accessible objects,
and are useful for wiring and other
electrical work. Locking pliers such as
the Vise-Grip® are useful because of
their tight grip.
Snap-ring and circlip pliers with special
tipped jaws are used to remove and
install snap-rings or circlips.
Channel-lock® or water pump pliers
have adjustable jaws that can be
quickly changed to match the size of
the object being held to give greater
leverage.
An adjustable wrench can be a useful
addition to a small tool kit. It can
substitute in a pinch if two wrenches of
the same size are needed to remove a
nut and bolt. Use extra care with
adjustable wrenches, as they tend to
loosen, slip, and damage fasteners.
Compared to a wrench of the correct
size, an adjustable wrench is always
second best. They should only be used
when the correct size wrench is not
available. Choose one of average size
range, about 6 to 8 inches in length.
Jack stands
Strong jack stands are extremely
important for any work that is done
under the car. Use only jack stands
that are designed for the purpose.
Blocks of wood, concrete, bricks, etc.
are not safe or suitable substitutes.
WARNING!
A jack should be used only to raise
the vehicle and should not be used
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
to support the car for a long period.
Always use jack stands to support a
raised vehicle.
Jack stands are available in several
styles. The best ones are made of
heavy material for strength, have a
wide base for stability, and are
equipped to positively lock in their
raised positions. Get the best ones
available.
Oil change equipment
Changing engine oil requires a 17 mm
socket or wrench to loosen and tighten
the drain plug and a drain pan (at least
8 qt. capacity). A wide, low drain pan
will fit more easily under the car. Use a
funnel to pour the new oil into the
engine.
The M52/M54 engines use an oil filter
canister with a disposable filter
cartridge insert. Therefore, an oil filter
wrench is not required. See
020
Maintenance for oil change
instructions.
Feeler gauges
Feeler gauges are thin metal strips of
precise thickness, used to measure
small clearances. They are normally
available as a set, covering a range of
sizes.
Torque wrench
A torque wrench is used to precisely
tighten threaded fasteners to a
predetermined value. Many of the
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
repair procedures in this manual
include BMW-specified torque values in
Newton-meters (Nm) and the
equivalent values in foot-pounds (ft-lb).
Several types of torque wrenches are
available. An inexpensive beam-type
(top) is adequate but must be read
visually. A ratchet-type (bottom) can be
preset to indicate (click) when the
torque value has been reached. They
all do the same job, but offer different
convenience features at different
prices. The most convenient ones have
a built-in ratchet, and can be preset to
indicate when a specific torque value
has been reached. Follow the wrench
manufacturer’s directions for use to
achieve the greatest accuracy.
A torque wrench with a range up to
about 150 Nm (185 ft-lb) has adequate
capacity for most of the repairs covered
in this manual. For recommended
torque values of 10 Nm or below, the
English system equivalent is given in
inch-pounds (in-lb). These small values
may be most easily reached using a
torque wrench calibrated in
inch-pounds. To convert inch-pounds
to foot-pounds, divide by 12.
Digital multimeter
Many of the electrical tests in this
manual call for the measurement of
resistance (ohms) or voltage values.
For safe and accurate tests of sensitive
electronic components and systems, a
multimeter or Digital Volt/Ohmmeter
(DVOM) with high input impedance (at
least 10,000 ohms) should be used.
Some meters have automotive
functions such as dwell and pulse
width that are useful for
troubleshooting ignition and fuel
injection problems.
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
CAUTION!
Vehicle electronic systems may be
damaged by the high current draw of
a test light with a normal
incandescent bulb. As a general rule,
use a high impedance digital
multimeter or an LED test light for all
electrical testing.
BMW special tools
Many repairs covered in this manual
call for the use of BMW special tools.
This, however, does not automatically
mean that the job is too complicated or
out of reach of the do-it-yourselfer.
Many of the BMW special tools
mentioned in this manual are simply
the best thing to use to do the job
correctly. In these cases, the tool is
identified with a BMW part number.
See your authorized BMW dealer parts
department for information on how to
order special tools.
There are some jobs for which
expensive special tools are essential,
and not a cost-effective purchase for
one-time repair by the do-it-yourself
owner. This manual includes such
repairs for the benefit of those with the
necessary experience and access to
tools. For the do-it-yourselfer, the need
for special tools is noted in the text,
and whether or not BMW dealer service
is recommended.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
010-8
Emergencies
Changing a tire
-
Stop car on as flat a surface as
possible, in a place where you can
be easily seen by other drivers.
Avoid stopping just over the crest
of a hill.
-
Turn on emergency flashers, and
set out flares or emergency
markers well behind car. Chock
wheel (wheel chock located in
trunk) diagonally opposite to the
one being changed. Passengers
should get out of car and stand
well away from road.
WARNING!
If a tire goes flat while driving, pull
well off the road. Changing a tire on
a busy street or highway is very
dangerous. If necessary, drive a
short distance on the flat tire to get
to a safe place. It is much better to
ruin a tire or rim than to risk being
hit.
-
Take jack and tools from tool area
beneath trunk mat. Remove spare
tire from tire storage tray.
-
Loosen wheel bolts while car is on
ground, but leave them a little
snug.
Place jack in lifting point nearest wheel
being changed. Use a board to provide
a firm footing for jack if ground is soft.
Raise car only far enough so that
wheel is fully off ground and then
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
remove wheel nuts and wheel.
-
Install spare wheel. Install wheel
nuts and tighten them hand tight
using lug nut wrench.
-
Lower car. With all wheels on
ground, fully tighten nuts in a
crisscross pattern. Torque wheel
nuts when installing wheel. Check
inflation pressure of spare tire.
Tightening torque
Wheel to wheel
hub
100 ± 10 Nm (74 ±
7 ft-lb)
Car will not start
If the engine turns over slowly or not at
all, especially on cold mornings, the
battery may not be sufficiently charged.
Jump-starting the battery from another
car may help.
CAUTION!
On cars with manual transmission,
push starting (or tow starting) a car
is not recommended by BMW.
If the engine is turning over at normal
speed with the starter motor, the
battery and starter are fine. If the
starter will not operate, see
121
Battery, Alternator, Starter for
information on the starter and starter
immobilization systems.
Check to make sure that there is fuel in
the tank. Do not rely on the fuel gauge
as it may be faulty. Instead, remove the
gas filler cap and rock the car. If there
is gas in the tank, you should hear a
sloshing sound at the filler neck.
See
OBD On Board Diagnostics at
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
the rear of this manual for diagnostic
code reading procedures.
Jump starting
Cars with discharged or dead batteries
can be jump-started using the good
battery from another car. When
jump-starting the engine, always note
the following warnings.
WARNING!
Battery acid (electrolyte) can
cause severe burns, and will
damage the car and clothing. If
electrolyte is spilled, wash the
surface with large quantities of
water. If it gets into eyes, flush
them with water for several
minutes and call a doctor.
Batteries produce explosive and
noxious gasses. Keep sparks
and flames away. Do not smoke
near batteries.
Do not jump-start the engine if
you suspect that the battery is
frozen. Trapped gas may
explode. Allow the battery to
thaw first.
Do not quick-charge the battery
(for boost starting) for longer
than one minute, and do not
exceed 16.5 volts at the battery
with the boosting cables
attached. Wait at least one
minute before boosting the
battery a second time.
-
Place cars close together, but do
not allow them to touch each
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
other.
-
Turn off engine of car with
good battery.
-
Turn off ignition switch of car
with discharged battery.
Connect one end of positive (+) cable
to positive (+) post of good battery.
Remove cover from the positive (+)
junction post (A) in engine
compartment and connect other end of
the positive (+) cable to the junction
post.
-
Connect one end of negative (–)
cable to negative (–) battery post
of good battery. Connect opposite
end of negative cable (–) to
ground lug (–) in engine
compartment (B).
-
Start car with good battery and
run engine at about 2,000 rpm,
then start car with dead battery.
-
With engine at idle, switch on
blower motor and rear window
defogger to avoid a damaging
voltage surge from alternator.
-
Carefully disconnect jumper
cables, starting with negative
cable on ground lug. Turn all
electrical consumers off.
Note:
The engine should be run for at least an
hour to recharge the battery.
Indicator and warning lights
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Many of the vehicle systems are
self-monitored both statically and
dynamically while driving. Generally, a
red warning lamp that comes on during
driving should be considered serious. If
you cannot immediately determine the
seriousness of the warning light, stop
the vehicle in a safe place and turn the
engine off as soon as possible. Consult
the owner’s manual in the glove box for
additional information on the warning
lamp and the recommended action.
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL),
“Check Engine” or “SERVICE ENGINE
SOON” warning light, comes on or
flashes, it indicates that an emissionsrelated fault has occurred. Faults such
as a faulty oxygen sensor or a faulty
fuel injector can cause the exhaust or
evaporative emissions to exceed a
specified limit. When these limits are
exceeded, the MIL will be turned on.
The car can be safely driven with the
light on, although the emission
systems should be checked as soon as
OBD On Board
possible. See
Diagnostics for more information on the
MIL and the On-board diagnostic
system.
Towing
The cars covered by this manual
should be towed with a tow truck using
wheel lift or flat bed equipment. Do not
tow the car on all four wheels except
for very short distances to move it to a
safe place.
CAUTION!
Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. The front spoilers and
bumper covers may sustain damage.
To access threaded towing eye socket,
pry open trim (arrow) on front or rear
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
bumper.
Note:
A towing eye is provided in the luggage
compartment tool kit. The towing eye
can be screwed into the front or rear
bumper.
Install towing eye into threaded hole.
-
Standard transmission: A
maximum towing distance of 20
miles is acceptable with the rear
wheels on the ground and the
transmission out of gear. If the car
needs to be towed further, have
the rear wheels placed on dollies.
-
Automatic transmission: If
absolutely necessary, car can be
towed with rear wheels on ground,
but the tow should not exceed 25
miles (40 km), at speeds at or
below 30 mph (48 km/h).
-
Be sure transmission fluid has
been topped off before
starting tow.
-
Always tow car with
transmission lever in “N”
(neutral). If tow must exceed
25 miles (40 km), add one
quart of ATF to transmission,
or better yet, remove
driveshaft.
-
Be sure to drain or pump out
added fluid once tow has
been completed.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
ATF draining and filling is covered
in
240 Automatic Transmission.
Be sure to read the filling and
draining procedure, as special
service equipment is required to
check the fluid level.
Driveshaft removal is covered in
260 Driveshaft.
Spare parts kit
Carrying a basic set of spare parts can
prevent a minor breakdown from
turning into a major annoyance. Many
of the following items won’t allow you
to do major repair work on the car, but
they will help in the event of the failure
of something that can disable the car
or compromise its safety.
Spare parts kit – basic
Poly-ribbed drive belt(s)
Engine oil (one or two quarts)
Engine coolant (1 gallon of
premixed 50/50 BMW anti-freeze
and water)
Fuse assortment (7.5A, 10A,
15A, 20A, 30A, 50A)
Radiator hoses (upper and
lower)
Spare parts kit – additional
contents
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
General
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Spare parts kit – additional
contents
Exterior lighting bulbs
(headlight, brake light, turn
signal, and taillight)
Wiper blades
Brake fluid (new unopened
bottle, DOT 4 specification)
Main relay for DME system
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:09 PM
Maintenance
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
020-1
General
The information given in this repair
group includes the routine checks and
maintenance steps that are both
required by BMW under the terms of
the vehicle warranty protection and
recommended by BMW to ensure long
and reliable vehicle operation.
Note:
Aside from keeping your car in the best
possible condition, proper maintenance
plays a role in maintaining full
protection under BMW's new-car
warranty coverage. If in doubt about the
terms and conditions of your car's
warranty, an authorized BMW dealer
should be able to explain them.
Service Interval Indicator (SII)
For the 1999 and later 3 Series (E46),
BMW introduced an extended oil
change interval of approximately
15,000 miles depending on engine
operating conditions. The introduction
of BMW High Performance Synthetic
Oil has made this longer interval
possible.
1999 to 6/2000 models. BMW uses a
unique system to determine
maintenance intervals. BMW's Service
Interval Indicator (SII), calculates
maintenance intervals based not only
on elapsed mileage, but also on such
inputs as engine speed, engine
temperature, number of starts, length
of trips, and the amount of fuel used.
At the appropriate time, the system
indicates, through lights in the
instrument cluster, when the next
routine maintenance is due.
6/2000 and later models. For the
2/25/2009 10:01 PM
Maintenance
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
mid-2000 models BMW introduced new
service interval software which
calculates service based on the
amount of fuel used. When SII detects
total fuel consumption that equals the
preset limits (in gallons), the
instrument cluster indicates that service
is required.
Using a 328i as an example:
Standard transmission model: SII
illuminates after consumption of
601 gallons of fuel.
Automatic transmission model: SII
illuminates after consumption of
667 gallons.
After the service is performed the SII
can be reset to zero.
The SII displays the mileage remaining
before service is due. The type of
service (OIL SERVICE or INSPECTION)
is also illuminated in the display.
Note:
An OIL SERVICE interval will always be
followed by an INSPECTION interval,
which will then be followed by an OIL
SERVICE interval, and so on.
When the ignition is turned on, the
service recommendation and miles
remaining are displayed for a few
seconds. A flashing message and a
negative (-) symbol in front of the
number indicate that the service
interval has been exceeded by the
distance displayed.
The On-Board Computer uses the rate
of fuel consumption in the period
immediately preceding to calculate the
mileage before the next service is due.
2/25/2009 10:01 PM
Maintenance
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Service Interval Indicator (SII),
resetting
The SII signals the need for basic
routine maintenance:
Engine oil and oil filter change,
after the engine has been warmed
up.
BMW-recommended additional
maintenance as listed in
Table
a.
Note:
For reference, the BMW oil service
requirements are approximately
equivalent to the maintenance that
other European manufacturers specify
at intervals with a maximum of every
15,000 miles or 12 months.
When the specified maintenance has
been carried out, the SII memory
should be reset.
1999 to 6/2000 models
In vehicles equipped with the DLC in
the right side engine compartment, the
SII may be reset using BMW service
and scan tool DIS or MoDiC, or a
specialty tool from another
manufacturer. Plug the tool (arrow)
into the DLC
CAUTION!
Follow the manufacturer's directions
when resetting the SII. If the reset
procedures are done incorrectly, the
reset tool or the electronic Service
Interval Indicator may be damaged.
2/25/2009 10:01 PM
Maintenance
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Aftermarket reset tools that can reset
all models with the DLC can be
purchased from one of the following
suppliers:
Assenmacher Specialty Tools
6440 Odell Place, Boulder, CO
80301
303-530-2424
http://www.asttool.com
Baum Tools Unlimited, Inc.
P.O. Box 5867, Sarasota, FL
34277-5867
800-848-6657
http://www.baumtools.com
Peake Research, Automotive
Products Division
P.O. Box 28776, San Jose, CA 95159
408-369-0406
http://www.peakeresearch.com
6/2000 and later models
On vehicles without the data link
connector (DLC) in the engine
compartment the reset tool can no
longer be used. Instead, the SII can be
reset with the trip odometer reset
button in the instrument cluster:
The ignition key must be in OFF
position.
Press and hold trip odometer
button in instrument cluster, and
turn ignition key to ACCESSORY
position.
Keep button pressed for approx. 5
more seconds until any of the
following appear in the display:
"Oil Service" or "Inspection", with
"Reset" or "Re".
2/25/2009 10:01 PM
Maintenance
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Press button again and hold for
approx. 5 seconds until "Reset" or
"Re" flash.
While display is flashing, press
button briefly to reset SII.
After display has shown new
interval, the following will appear
in display for approx. 2 seconds:
"End SIA".
The system can only be reset again
after the vehicle has been driven
approx. 50 to 75 miles (consumes at
least 2.5 gal. fuel). If the display shows
"Reset" or "Re" when resetting, the
minimum driving distance has been
fulfilled and the system can be reset
again. It is possible to interrupt and
end the reset procedure by changing
the position of the ignition key.
Inspection I and Inspection II
The Service Interval Indicator signals
the need for more comprehensive
maintenance and inspection. There are
two sets of inspection requirements.
These inspections alternate throughout
a car's maintenance history. If the last
inspection interval was Inspection I, the
next inspection interval (following an oil
service) will be Inspection II, the next
after that will be Inspection I, and so
on.
Inspection I tasks are listed in
Table
b. Inspection II includes most of the
tasks from Inspection I with additional
Inspection II tasks. A complete listing of
Inspection II tasks is in
Table c.
Note:
For reference, the BMW Inspection I
2/25/2009 10:01 PM
Maintenance
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
and Inspection II requirements are
approximately equivalent to the
maintenance requirements that other
European manufacturers specify.
Inspection I is normally due at intervals
with a maximum of 30,000 miles or 24
months. Inspection II is normally due at
intervals with a maximum of 60,000
miles or 48 months.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:01 PM
Maintenance
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Maintenance Tables
The intervals for most tasks listed in the maintenance table below are determined by the SII.
Except where noted, the maintenance items listed apply to all models and model years covered
by this manual. The columns on the right side of each table give quick-reference information
about the job. The text in the "additional repair information" column refers to repair groups.
Table a. Oil service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
Engine compartment
maintenance
Change oil and oil filter
020
Reset Service Interval
Indicator (SII).
020
Replace interior
ventilation microfilter.
020
Under car
maintenance
Check overall thickness
of front and rear brake
pads. If replacement is
necessary: Examine
brake disc surfaces.
Clean brake pad
contact points in
calipers. Grease wheel
centering hubs (alloy
wheels only). Check
thickness of parking
brake linings only when
replacing rear brake
pads. Check operation
of parking brake and
adjust as necessary.
340
Check and adjust tire
pressures, including
spare
020
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table b. Inspection I service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
Under car
maintenance
Change engine oil and
filter.
020
Check transmission and
differential(s) for
external leaks.
230
240
Check CV joint boots for
damage or leaks.
311
331
Visually check fuel tank,
fuel lines and
connections for leaks.
160
Check condition,
position, and mounting
of exhaust system.
Visually check for leaks.
180
Check power steering
system for leaks. Check
power steering fluid
level and adjust if
necessary.
320
Check steering rack and
tie rods for tightness.
Check condition of front
axle joints, steering
linkage and steering
shaft joints.
320
Check overall thickness
of front and rear brake
pads using special
BMW tool. If
replacement is
necessary: Examine
brake disc surfaces.
Clean brake pad
contact points in
calipers. Grease wheel
340
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table b. Inspection I service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
centering hubs (alloy
wheels only). Check
thickness of parking
brake linings only when
replacing rear brake
pads. Check operation
of parking brake and
adjust as necessary.
Check front control arm
bushings for damage or
wear.
310
Check brake system
connections and lines
for leaks, damage and
incorrect positioning.
340
Check parking brake
actuator. Adjust if
necessary.
340
Check all tire pressures
(including spare) and
correct if necessary.
Check condition of tires
(outer tread surfaces),
tread wear pattern; in
case of uneven tread
wear, perform a wheel
alignment if requested.
020
Inspect entire body
according to terms of
rust perforation limited
warranty. (Must be
performed at least every
two years.)
Engine compartment
maintenance
Read out on-board
diagnostic (OBD II)
system.
100
130
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table b. Inspection I service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
Check engine coolant
system/heater hose
connections for leaks.
Check coolant level and
antifreeze protection
level. Add coolant as
necessary.
170
Check windshield
washer fluid level and
antifreeze protection.
Add washer fluid as
necessary.
611
Replace ventilation
microfilter. (Note:
reduce replacement
intervals in dusty
operating conditions).
020
Reset service interval
indicator.
020
Body/electrical
Check operation of air
conditioner.
640
Check operation of
headlights, parking
lights, back-up lights,
license plate lights,
interior lights, glove box
light, engine
compartment light,
trunk light, turn signals,
emergency flashers,
stop lights, horns,
headlight flasher and
dimmer switch
630
Check instrument panel
and dashboard lights.
620
Check wipers and
windshield washer
611
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table b. Inspection I service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
system. Check aim of
washer jets and adjust if
necessary.
Check condition and
function of seat belts.
720
Visually examine all
airbag units for torn
covers, obvious damage
or attachment of decals,
decorations or
accessories.
721
Check central locking
system and double lock.
515
Replace batteries for
alarm remote controls in
all master keys.
515
Check operation and
condition of all door,
hood and trunk latches.
410
515
Check heater, air
conditioner blower, and
rear window defogger
operation.
640
Convertible models:
Activate automatic
roll-over protection
system via diagnostic
link. Note: first remove
hardtop or lower
convertible top.
541
Check all
warning/indicator lights,
check control.
620
Check operation of rear
view mirrors.
Road test
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table b. Inspection I service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
Check braking
performance, steering,
heating, air conditioner
operation. Check
manual transmission
and clutch operation or
automatic transmission
operation.
Table c. Inspection II service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
Engine compartment
maintenance
Replace air filter
element. (Note: reduce
replacement intervals in
dusty operating
conditions).
020
Brake system service
Replace brake fluid
every 2 years (time
interval begins from
vehicle production
date).
340
Cooling system
service
Replace coolant every 4
years (time interval
begins from vehicle
production date).
170
Oxygen sensor
service
Replace oxygen sensor
every 100,000 miles.
180
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table c. Inspection II service
Maintenance item
Tools
required
New parts
required
Warm
engine
required
Dealer service
recommended
Additional
repair
information
Spark plug service
Replace spark plugs
every 100,000 miles.
020
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
020-3
Fluid and Lubricant
Specifications
The illustration shows engine oil viscosity
(SAE grade) vs. operating temperature
range for the BMW engines covered in this
manual.
Fluid and lubricant capacities and
specifications for E46 cars are listed in
Table d.
WARNING!
The use of fluids that do not meet BMW's
specifications may impair performance
and reliability, and may void warranty
coverage.
Table d. Fluids and lubricants
Fluid
Approximate Specification
capacity
Engine oil with filter change
Rear
wheel
drive
6.5 liters
(6.9 US qt.)
All wheel
drive
7.5 liters
(8 US qt.)
Synthetic oil
with API
rating SH or
higher
Manual transmission oil
Getrag
1.1 liters
S5D 250G (1.15 US qt.)
ZF S5D
320Z
1.3 liters
(1.37 US qt.)
ZF S5D
280Z
1.35 liters
(1.42 US qt.)
BMW 83 22 9
408 942
(MTF-LT-1)
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF)
(drain and fill)
(additional fluid required when installing
a dry torque converter)
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Table d. Fluids and lubricants
Fluid
Approximate Specification
capacity
ZF A5S
325Z
Complete
refill:
9.0 liters
(9.5 US qt.)
Oil and filter
change:
4.0 liters
(4.2 US qt.)
GM A5S
360R
GM A5S
390R
BMW 83 22 9
407 807
(Exxon LT
71141)
BMW 83 22 0
024 359
(Texaco ETL
8072B)
Differential, front or rear(drain and fill)
(Lifetime fluid; no fluid change required)
Front
Fill:
differential 0.7 liter
(0.74 US qt.)
Refill:
0.6 liter
(0.63 US qt.)
Rear wheel
drive:
Rear
differential 0.9 liter
(0.95 US qt.)
All wheel
drive:
1.0 liter
(1.06 US qt.)
BMW
SAF-XO
synthetic oil
Power steering fluid
All models Permanently
sealed
(no drain
plug)
Dexron III®
ATF
Brake fluid
All models
SAE DOT4
Engine coolant
All models 8.4 liters (8.9
US qt.)
50% BMW
anti-freeze/
50% distilled
water
CAUTION!
Multi-viscosity engine oils should not be
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
used in the manual transmission. Use of
such an oil could shorten the service life
of the transmission.
Brake fluid
Brake fluid absorbs moisture easily, and
moisture in the fluid affects brake
performance and reliability. This is why
brake fluid should be flushed from the
system every two years. When replacing or
adding brake fluid, use only new fluid from
previously unopened containers. Do not
use brake fluid that has been bled from the
system, even if it is brand new. Use only
DOT 4 brake fluid.
Note:
See
340 Brakes for more brake fluid
information.
Engine coolant (anti-freeze)
BMW recommends coolant that is a 50/50
mixture of distilled water and
phosphate/nitrate free anti-freeze
containing ethylene glycol. Anti-freeze
raises the boiling point and lowers the
freezing point of the coolant. It also
contains additives that help prevent cooling
system corrosion.
Differential gear oil
BMW recommends using only a specially
formulated synthetic gear oil (SAF-XO) that
is available through an authorized BMW
dealer parts department. For additional
information on this lubricant and any other
lubricants that may be compatible, contact
an authorized BMW dealer service
department.
Power steering fluid
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
The power steering fluid is Dexron III® ATF,
or equivalent. The system is permanently
filled and does not have a drain. Routinely
adding ATF is not required unless the
system is leaking.
Transmission fluid, automatic
The automatic transmissions installed in
the E46 models are filled with special
automatic transmission fluids, depending
on transmission type and model year.
Note:
The transmission lubricant type can be
found on the "type-plate" on the side of
the transmission. See
240
Automatic Transmission.
Consult an authorized BMW dealer for
alternate fluid use and the most-upto-date information regarding
transmission operating fluids.
Transmission fluid, manual
The manual transmissions installed in the
E46 models are normally filled with a
special lifetime fluid (MTF-LT-1). Consult
230 Manual Transmission for further
information.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:02 PM
Maintenance
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
020-4
Engine Oil Service
With the introduction of synthetic oil
and extended oil change intervals, a
new oil filter with improved filter paper
design was introduced. The new filter
paper resists deterioration caused by
high oil temperatures over an extended
time.
Note:
Early style oil filter numbers with BMW
part numbers 11 42 1 427 908 or 11 42
1 745 390 should not be used in the
1999 and later BMW models.
Use any synthetic low viscosity oil to
top off the engine oil level between oil
changes, as long as it meets the API
classification SH. Castrol is now the
supplier of both the mineral based oil
used in earlier models and the
synthetic based oil used from model
year 1999.
Oil recommendation
BMW High
Performance
Synthetic (part
number 07 51 0
017 866)
5W-30
Note:
The use of engine oil additives is
not recommended when using
BMW High Performance Synthetic
engine oil.
BMW is constantly upgrading
recommended maintenance
procedures and requirements. The
information contained here is as
accurate as possible at the time of
2/25/2009 9:28 PM
Maintenance
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
publication. If there is any doubt
about what procedures apply to a
specific model or model year, or
what intervals should be followed,
remember that an authorized BMW
dealer has the latest information
on factory-recommended
maintenance.
Engine oil, checking level
Engine oil level is checked with a
dipstick (arrow) in engine block.
Check oil level with car on a level
surface, after engine has been
stopped for at least a few minutes.
Check level by pulling out dipstick
and wiping it clean. Reinsert it all
way and withdraw it again.
Oil level is correct if it is between
two marks near end of stick.
Add oil through filler cap (arrow) on
top of cylinder head. Add only amount
needed to bring oil level to MAX mark
on dipstick, using an oil of correct
viscosity and grade. Too much oil can
be just as harmful as too little.
Engine oil and filter, changing
A complete oil change requires new oil,
a new oil filter insert kit, and a new
drain plug sealing washer. The tools
needed, a 17 mm drain plug socket or
box wrench and a drain pan (8 - 10 US
2/25/2009 9:28 PM
Maintenance
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
qt. capacity), are described in
General.
010
Note:
If using a "fast-lube" service facility for
oil changes, make sure the technician
hand-starts and torques the engine oil
drain plug using hand-tools. Power
tools can strip the threads of the plug
and the oil pan.
-
Run engine for a few minutes to
warm engine oil. Shut engine off.
-
With car on level ground, place
drain pan under oil drain plug.
Using a 36 mm wrench, loosen and
remove oil filter housing cover (arrow).
Remove filter cartridge and discard any
O-rings.
On Coupe or Convertible model:
Remove oil drain plug access panel in
center of front end reinforcement plate
below engine.
Using a socket or box wrench, loosen
drain plug at oil drain pan. Remove
plug by hand and let oil drain into pan.
2/25/2009 9:28 PM
Maintenance
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
CAUTION!
Pull the loose plug away from the
hole quickly to avoid being scalded
by hot oil. It will run out quickly
when the plug is removed. If
possible, use gloves to protect your
hands.
-
When oil flow has diminished to
an occasional drip, reinstall drain
plug with a new metal sealing
washer and torque plug.
Tightening torques
Engine oil drain
plug (M12 bolt)
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Working at oil filter housing:
Lubricate and install new oil filter
O-rings.
Install a new filter cartridge and
housing cover.
Tighten cover.
1 - Filter housing
2 - filter housing cover -tighten to 25
Nm (18 ft-lb)
3 - O-ring (always replace)
4 - O-rings (always replace)
5 - Filter element
Tightening torque
Oil filter cover filter
housing
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:28 PM
Maintenance
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
-
Refill crankcase with oil.
Approximate oil capacity is listed
in
Table d. Use dipstick to
check correct oil level.
-
Start engine and check that oil
pressure warning light
immediately goes out.
-
Allow engine to run for a few
minutes to circulate new oil, then
check for leaks at drain plug and
oil filter. Stop engine and recheck
oil level.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:28 PM
Maintenance
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
020-5
Engine Compartment
Maintenance
The information under this heading
describes routine maintenance other
than oil change done in the engine
compartment. It is not necessary for
the car to be raised and supported off
the ground. Information on oil change
is given earlier in this group.
Accelerator linkage
The accelerator and throttle linkage
should be lubricated periodically. Use a
general purpose oil on the joints and
bearings of the linkage. Use a
multipurpose grease on the bearing
points of the throttle plate.
Air filter, replacing
The specified replacement intervals for
the air filter are based on normal use. If
the car is operated primarily in dusty
conditions, the air filter should be
serviced more frequently.
Release mass air flow sensor clips (A)
and pull sensor assembly out of air
filter upper housing (arrow).
-
Release upper air filter housing
clips (B).
Lift air filter upper housing, and then
remove filter element insert from
cartridge.
-
On installation, install O-ring for
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
mass air flow sensor (arrow) into
retaining clips in air filter upper
housing.
Cooling system service
Routine cooling system maintenance
consists of maintaining the coolant
level and inspecting hoses. Because
the coolant's anti-corrosion and
anti-freeze additives gradually lose
their effectiveness, replacement of the
coolant every four years is
recommended.
CAUTION!
Use only BMW approved
phosphate-free anti-freeze when
filling the cooling system. Use of
anti-freeze containing phosphates is
considered to be harmful to the
cooling system.
The float in the radiator tank indicates
coolant level, and should be inspected
while the coolant is cold. When the
upper mark on the float is level with the
top of the filler neck, coolant is at the
minimum allowable level. When the
lower mark on the float is level with the
top of the filler neck, the coolant is at
the maximum level.
Hose connections should be tight and
dry. Coolant seepage indicates either
that the hose clamp is loose, that the
hose is damaged, or that the
connection is dirty or corroded. Dried
coolant has a chalky appearance.
Hoses should be firm and springy.
Replace any hose that is cracked, that
has become soft and limp, or has been
contaminated by oil.
As a preventive measure, replacement
of the cooling system hoses every four
years is also recommended. The
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
illustration shows examples of damage
to coolant hoses. Any of conditions
shown is cause for replacement.
(Courtesy of Gates Rubber Company,
Inc.)
Engine drive belt service
Drive belts and pulleys transfer power
from the engine crankshaft to various
accessories. E46 models use two
poly-ribbed (serpentine) belts:
The outer belt only turns the A/C
compressor
The inner, longer belt activates the
alternator, coolant pump and
power steering.
Automatic belt tensioners are used to
keep the belts tensioned properly.
Unless a tensioner mechanism
malfunctions, the poly-ribbed belts do
not require tension adjustment.
Inspect drive belts with the engine off.
If the belt shows signs of wear,
cracking, glazing, or missing sections,
it should be replaced immediately. To
reduce the chance of belt failure while
driving, replacement of the belts every
four years is recommended.
Note:
When belts are replaced with new ones,
store the old set in the luggage
compartment for emergency use.
To remove drive belts:
Use long-handled wrench to turn
A/C belt tensioner release lug (A)
clockwise (against spring tension).
Remove A/C belt.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Similarly, turn main engine drive
belt tensioner lug (B) clockwise
and remove belt.
WARNING!
Observe care when replacing belts.
Personal injury could result if a
tensioner springs back into position
uncontrollably.
CAUTION!
Mark drive belt rotation direction if
removing and reusing an old belt.
-
When installing a new belt, gently
pry it over the pulleys. Too much
force may damage the belt or the
accessory.
Idle speed
Engine idle speed can change due to a
number of factors, including normal
wear. The idle speed in E46 models is
electronically adaptive and
non-adjustable. See
130 Fuel
Injection for more information.
Oxygen sensors
The engine management system in
E46 models is equipped with multiple
oxygen sensors. A regulating sensor is
mounted before each catalytic
converter and a monitoring sensor
downstream of each converter. The
regulating sensor monitors engine
combustion efficiency and helps to
control the fuel injection system and
exhaust emissions. The monitoring
sensor is used by the on-board
diagnostic (OBD II) system to monitor
the function of the catalytic converter.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
OBD II enhanced emission standards
require the engine control module
(ECM) to monitor the oxygen content in
the exhaust both before and after the
catalytic converter. This allows for
tighter control of the tail pipe emissions
and also allows the ECM to diagnose
converter problems. If the ECM detects
that catalytic converter or oxygen
sensor efficiency has degraded past a
certain pre-programmed limit, it will
turn on the Check Engine light, and
store a diagnostic trouble code (DTC)
in the ECM. See
OBD On Board
Diagnostics in the rear of this manual
for more information on OBD systems.
Replacement of oxygen sensors at the
specified intervals ensures that the
engine and emission control system
will continue to operate as designed.
Extending the replacement interval
may void the emission control warranty
coverage. See
180 Exhaust System
for information on replacing the oxygen
sensors.
Tightening torque
Oxygen sensor to
exhaust manifold
50 Nm (37 ft-lb)
Note:
A special socket for replacing the
oxygen sensor is available from most
automotive parts stores. The socket
has a groove cut down one side to allow
the sensor to be installed without
damaging the wire harness.
Power steering fluid, checking
level
To check power steering fluid level in
fluid reservoir:
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Park car on level ground with
engine off.
Level is correct if it is between MIN
and MAX marks on dipstick.
If level is below MIN mark, start
engine and add fluid to reservoir
to bring level up.
Stop engine and recheck level.
Hand-tighten reservoir cap.
Power steering fluid
Recommended fluid Dexron III® ATF
Spark plugs, replacing
E46 engines use a "coil-over"
configuration, with one ignition coil
above each spark plug.
Remove microfilter housing:
Remove microfilter for interior
Ventilation
ventilation. See
microfilter, replacing
Open wiring harness loom (A),
remove harness and lay aside.
Unfasten screws (B) and take off
lower microfilter housing.
Remove engine cover over ignition
coils:
Remove oil filler cap.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
Remove cover hold down bolts.
Remove ignition coil grounding
harnesses (arrows).
Remove ignition coils:
Pull up on spring clips to
disconnect ignition coil harness
connectors.
Remove coil mounting bolts.
Remove coils.
-
Remove spark plugs.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
bearing in mind the following:
Lightly lubricate new spark plug
threads with copper-based
anti-seize compound.
Thread plugs into cylinder head
by hand to prevent crossthreading.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Be sure to reinstall coil grounding
harness.
Spark plug recommendations
Bosch
FGR7 DQP
NGK
BKR6 EQUP
Tightening torque
Spark plug to
cylinder head
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Ventilation microfilter,
replacing
Working at cowl housing inside engine
compartment, twist microfilter cover
retainers (arrows) 90° each and pull
cover up.
Pull filter out and replace.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
1 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
020-6
Other Mechanical
Maintenance
Battery, checking and cleaning
The battery is located in the right side
of the luggage compartment. Simple
maintenance of the battery and its
terminal connections will ensure
maximum starting performance,
especially in winter when colder
temperatures reduce battery power.
Note:
Design characteristics of the
convertible body cause vibrations in the
trunk area. Therefore, E46 Convertibles
require a special battery designed for
constant vibration. When replacing the
battery, be sure the replacement is
designed specifically for the
Convertible.
Battery cables should be tight. The
terminals, the cable clamps, and the
battery case should be free of the white
deposits that indicate corrosion and
acid salts. Even a thin layer of dust
containing conductive acid salts can
cause battery discharge.
-
To remove battery corrosion:
Disconnect battery cables.
Disconnect negative (-) cable first.
Remove battery from trunk.
Clean terminal posts and cable
clamps with a wire brush.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
2 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Clean main chassis ground
terminal next to battery. Corrosion
can be washed away with a
baking soda and water solution
that will neutralize acid. Apply
solution carefully, though, since it
will also neutralize acid inside
battery.
Reconnect cable clamps, positive
(+) cable first.
Lightly coat outside of terminals,
hold down screws, and clamps
with petroleum jelly, grease, or a
commercial battery terminal
corrosion inhibitor.
WARNING!
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Battery acid is extremely
dangerous. Take care to keep it
from contacting eyes, skin, or
clothing. Wear eye protection.
Extinguish all smoking materials
and do not work near any open
flames.
Battery electrolyte should be
maintained at the correct level just
above the battery plates and their
separators. The correct level is
approximately 5 mm (1/4 in.) above the
top of battery plates or to the top of the
indicator marks (if applicable). The
battery plates and the indicator marks
can be seen once the filler caps are
removed. If the electrolyte level is low,
replenish it by adding distilled water
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
3 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
only.
Note:
The original equipment battery in E46
models is maintenance free. The
original electrolyte will normally last the
entire service life of the battery under
moderate climate conditions.
Battery, replacing
The original equipment BMW battery is
equipped with a built-in hydrometer
"magic eye" (arrow). Battery condition
is determined by the color of the eye:
Green: Adequate charge
Black: Inadequate charge;
recharge
Yellow: Defective battery; replace
Batteries are rated by ampere hours
(Ah), the number of hours a specific
current drain can be sustained before
complete discharge, or by cold
cranking amps (CCA), the number of
amps available to crank the engine in
cold weather conditions. In general,
replacement batteries should always
be rated equal or higher than the
original battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
The battery is held in place by a single
hand screw and plate. A secure battery
hold-down is important in order to
prevent vibrations and road shock from
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
4 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
damaging the battery.
Note:
Always disconnect the negative (-)
cable first, and connect it last.
While changing the battery, clean
away any corrosion in or around
the battery tray.
Design characteristics of the
convertible body cause vibrations
to oscillate in the trunk area.
Therefore, the convertible model
uses a special battery and battery
retaining mechanism designed for
this constant vibration.
More battery and charging system
121 Battery,
information is in
Alternator, Starter.
Brake fluid, replacing
BMW strictly recommends replacing
the brake fluid every two years. This
will help protect against corrosion and
the effects of moisture in the fluid.
Note:
See
340 Brakes for brake fluid
flushing procedures.
Brake pad/rotor wear, checking
All E46 cars are fitted with disc brakes
at all four wheels. Although the brakes
are equipped with a brake pad warning
system, the system only monitors one
wheel per axle. It is recommended that
pad thickness should be checked
whenever the wheels are off or brake
work is being done.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
5 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Disc brake pad wear can be checked
through opening in caliper:
Measure distance (A) of brake pad
"ear" to brake rotor. See
340
Brakes. Compare to specification
below.
Unbolt caliper from steering arm to
properly inspect:
Brake pad thickness (A)
Brake rotors
Condition of caliper seal (B)
Condition of caliper slider bolts (C)
Note:
Brake caliper removal and installation
procedures are given in
340 Brakes.
Brake pad lining minimum
thickness
Front or rear pad
Dimension A
3.0 mm (0.12
in.)
Brake system, inspecting
Routine maintenance of the brake
system includes maintaining the brake
fluid in the reservoir, checking brake
pads for wear, checking parking brake
function, and inspecting the system for
fluid leaks or other damage:
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
6 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Check that brake hoses are
correctly routed to avoid chafing or
kinking.
Inspect unions and brake calipers
for signs of fluid leaks.
Inspect rigid lines for corrosion,
dents, or other damage.
Inspect flexible hoses for cracking.
Replace faulty hoses or lines, see
340 Brakes.
WARNING!
Incorrect installation or
overtightening hoses, lines, and
unions may cause chafing or
leakage. This can lead to partial or
complete brake system failure.
Parking brake, checking
The parking brake system is
independent of the main braking
system and may require periodic
adjustment depending on use. Adjust
the parking brake if the brake lever can
be pulled up more than 8 clicks. Check
that the cable moves freely. A
description of the parking brake and
parking brake adjustment can be found
in
340 Brakes.
Note:
The parking brake may lose some of its
effectiveness if it is not used frequently.
This is due to corrosion build-up on the
parking brake drum. To remove
corrosion, apply the parking brake just
until it begins to grip, then pull the lever
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
7 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
up one more stop (click). Drive the car
approximately 400 meters (1,300 ft.)
and release the brake. To recheck the
adjustment of the parking brake see
340 Brakes.
Clutch fluid, checking
The hydraulic clutch and the brake
system share the same reservoir and
the same brake fluid. Clutch fluid level
and brake fluid level are checked at the
same time.
Note:
See
340 Brakes for more
information.
See
210 Clutch for information
on the clutch and the hydraulic
clutch operating system.
Drive axle joint (CV joint) boots,
inspecting
CV joint protective boots must be
closely inspected for cracks and any
other damage that will allow
contaminants to get into the joint. If the
rubber boots fail, the water and dirt
that enter the joint will quickly damage
it.
Note:
Replacement of the CV joint boots and
inspection of the joints are described in
311 Front Axle Final Drive and
331 Rear Axle Final Drive.
Exhaust system, inspecting
Exhaust system life varies widely
according to driving habits and
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
8 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
environmental conditions. If shortdistance driving predominates, the
moisture and condensation in the
system will not fully dry out. This will
lead to early corrosion damage and
more frequent replacement.
Scheduled maintenance of the exhaust
system is limited to inspection:
Check to see that all the hangers
(arrow) are in place and properly
supporting the system and that
the system does not strike the
body.
Check for restrictions due to dents
or kinks.
Check for weakness or perforation
due to rust.
Note:
Alignment of the system and the
location of the hangers are described
in
180 Exhaust System.
Differential oil level, checking
The differential units in E46 models are
filled with lifetime oil that ordinarily
does not need to be changed.
All wheel drive models: Check front
differential fluid level at front differential
filler plug (arrow).
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
9 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Check rear differential oil level at rear
differential filler plug (arrow).
-
Check lubricant level with car on a
level surface:
Remove oil filler plug.
Level is correct when fluid just
reaches edge of filler hole.
If necessary, top up fluid.
Install and tighten oil filler plug
when oil level is correct.
The differential should be filled with a
special BMW lubricant available
through an authorized BMW dealer.
Note:
Use a 14 mm or 17 mm Allen
socket to remove the drain plug.
If the car is raised in the air, it
should be level.
Tightening torques
Front differential
filler plug to
housing
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Rear differential
filler plug to
housing
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
Fuel filter, replacing
The fuel filter is located beneath the
center of the car, approximately under
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
10 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
the driver's seat. A protective cover
must be removed to access the filter.
Fuel filter for M52 TU engine is shown
in illustration.
E46 cars with M54 engine are
equipped with a fuel filter that has a
built in fuel pressure regulator.
-
Disconnect battery negative (-)
cable.
-
Drain fuel filter from inlet side into
a container and inspect drained
fuel. Check for rust, moisture and
contamination.
-
When replacing fuel filter:
Clamp filter inlet and outlet hoses
to lessen fuel spillage.
Loosen center clamping bracket
and hose clamps on either end of
filter.
Note arrow or markings indicating
direction of flow on new filter.
Install new filter using new hose
clamps.
WARNING!
Fuel will be expelled when the filter
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
11 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
is removed. Do not smoke or work
near heaters or other fire hazards.
Keep a fire extinguisher handy.
CAUTION!
Clean thoroughly around the filter
connections before removing them.
Note:
When installing fuel filter cover, take
care to reinstall foam rubber seal in
front of cover correctly to prevent
flooding of filter with rain splash water.
Fuel tank and fuel lines,
inspecting
Inspect the fuel tank, fuel lines, and
fuel system for damage or leaks.
Check for fuel leaks in the engine
compartment or fuel odors in the
passenger compartment. Check for
faulty flexible fuel lines by bending
them. If any leaks are present, fuel
should be expelled. Check for any
evaporative emissions hoses that may
have become disconnected, checking
carefully at the charcoal canister and
evaporative emissions purge system.
WARNING!
When checking for fuel leaks, the
engine must be cold. A hot exhaust
manifold or exhaust system could
cause the fuel to ignite or explode
causing serious personal injury.
Ventilate the work area and clean up
spilled fuel immediately.
Note:
See
130 Fuel Injection and
160
Fuel Tank and Fuel Pump for
component locations and additional
information.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
12 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Suspension, front, inspecting
Inspection of the front suspension and
steering includes a check of all moving
parts for wear and excessive play.
Inspect ball joint and tie-rod rubber
seals and boots for cracks or tears that
could allow the entry of dirt, water, and
other contaminants.
On All wheel drive models check front
differential fluid level and check CV
joint boots for cracks.
Note:
See
310 Front Suspension and
331 Rear Axle Final Drive
Suspension, rear, inspecting
Differential and rear drive axle service
consists of checking and changing the
gear oil, inspecting for leaks, and
checking the rear drive axle rubber
boots for damage.
The areas where leaks are most likely
to occur are around the drive shaft and
drive axle mounting flanges.
Note:
For more information on identifying oil
leaks and their causes, see
330 Rear
Suspension and
311 Front Axle Final
Drive.
Tires, checking inflation
pressure
Correct tire pressures are important to
handling and stability, fuel economy,
and tire wear. Tire pressures change
with temperature. Pressures should be
checked often during seasonal
temperature changes. Correct inflation
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
13 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
pressures can be found on the driver's
door pillar and in the owner's manual.
Note that tire pressures should be
higher when the car is more heavily
loaded.
WARNING!
Do not inflate any tire to a pressure
higher than the tire's maximum
inflation pressure listed on the
sidewall. Use care when adding air
to warm tires. Warm tire pressures
can increase as much as 4 psi (0.3
bar) over their cold pressures.
Tires, rotating
BMW does not recommend tire
rotation. Due to the car's suspension
design, the front tires begin to wear
first at the outer shoulder and the rear
tires begin to wear first at the middle of
the tread or inner shoulder. Rotating
the tires may adversely affect road
handling and tire grip.
Transmission service,
automatic
The automatic transmission is not
equipped with a dipstick. Therefore,
checking the ATF level is an involved
procedure which includes measuring
and maintaining a specified ATF
temperature during the checking
procedure.
Note:
For more complete ATF service
information, including checking ATF
level and ATF filter replacement
procedures, see
240 Automatic
Transmission.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
14 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Transmission service, manual
Manual transmission service consists of
inspecting for leaks and checking the
fluid.
Evidence of transmission leaks is likely
to be seen around the driveshaft
mounting flange and at the bottom of
the bellhousing.
Note:
For more information on identifying oil
230
leaks and their causes, see
Manual Transmission and
210
Clutch.
Transmission fluid, checking
and filling (manual
transmission)
The manual transmission in E46
models is filled with lifetime oil that
ordinarily does not need to be
changed.
Check manual transmission oil level at
transmission filler plug (arrow). Make
sure car is on level surface.
Note:
Transmission fluid level checking and
replacement procedures are covered in
230 Manual Transmission.
Wheels, aligning
BMW recommends checking the front
and rear alignment once a year and
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
15 of 15
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
whenever new tires are installed.
Note:
See
320 Steering and Wheel
Alignment for a more detailed
discussion of alignment requirements
and specifications.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
020-7
Body and Interior
Maintenance
Body and hinges, lubricating
The door locks and lock cylinders can
be lubricated with an oil that contains
graphite.
The body and door hinges, the hood
latch, and the door check rods should
be lubricated with SAE 30 or SAE 40
engine oil. Lubricate the seat runners
with multipurpose grease. Do not apply
any oil to rubber parts. If door weatherstrips are sticking, lubricate them with
silicone spray or talcum powder. The
hood release cable should be
lubricated as well.
The use of winter lock de-icer sprays
should be kept to an absolute
minimum, as the alcohol in the de-icer
will wash the grease out of the lock
assemblies, and may cause the locks
to corrode internally, or become difficult
to operate.
Exterior washing
The longer dirt is left on the paint, the
greater the risk of damaging the glossy
finish, either by scratching or by the
chemical effect dirt particles may have
on the painted surface.
Do not wash the car in direct sunlight.
If the engine hood is warm, allow it to
cool. Beads of water not only leave
spots when dried rapidly by the sun or
heat from the engine, but also can act
as small magnifying glasses and burn
spots into the finish. Wash the car with
a mixture of lukewarm water and a car
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
wash product. Rinse using plenty of
clear water. Wipe the body dry with a
soft cloth towel or chamois to prevent
water-spotting.
Interior care
Dirt spots can usually be removed with
lukewarm soapy water or a dry foam
cleaner. Use spot remover for grease
and oil spots. Do not pour the liquid
directly on the carpet or fabric, but
dampen a clean cloth and rub
carefully, starting at the edge of the
spot and working inward. Do not use
gasoline, naptha, or other flammable
substances.
Leather upholstery and trim
Leather upholstery and trim should be
periodically cleaned using a slightly
damp cotton or wool cloth. The idea is
to get rid of the dirt in the creases and
pores that can cause brittleness and
premature aging. On heavily soiled
areas, use a mild detergent (such as
Woolite®) or other specially formulated
leather cleaners. Use two tablespoons
to one quart of cold water. Dry the trim
and upholstery completely using a soft
cloth. Regular use of a good quality
leather conditioner will reduce drying
and cracking of the leather.
Polishing
Use paint polish only if the finish
assumes a dull look after long service.
Polish can be used to remove tar spots
and tarnish, but afterwards a coat of
wax should be applied to protect the
clean finish. Do not use abrasive polish
or cleaners on aluminum trim or
accessories.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Seat belts
Dirt and other abrasive particles will
damage seat belt webbing. If it is
necessary to clean seat belts, use a
mild soap solution. Bleach and other
strong cleaning agents may weaken
the belt webbing and should be
avoided.
WARNING!
Do not clean the seat belt webbing
using dry cleaning or other
chemicals. Allow wet belts to dry
before allowing them to retract.
The condition of the belt webbing and
the function of the retractor
mechanisms should be inspected.
Note:
See
720 Seat Belts for seat belt
inspection information.
Special cleaning
Tar spots can be removed with a bug
and tar remover. Never use gasoline,
kerosene, nail polish remover, or other
unsuitable solvents. Insect spots also
respond to tar remover. A bit of baking
soda dissolved in the wash water will
facilitate their removal. This method
can also be used to remove spotting
from tree sap.
Washing chassis
Periodic washing of the underside of
the car, especially in winter, will help
prevent accumulation of road salt and
rust. The best time to wash the
underside is just after the car has been
driven in wet conditions. Spray the
chassis with a powerful jet of water.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
Commercial or self-service car washes
may not be best for this, as they may
recycle the salt-contaminated water.
Waxing
For a long-lasting, protective, and
glossy finish, apply a hard wax after
the car has been washed and dried.
Use carnauba or synthetic based
products. Waxing is not needed after
every washing. You can tell when
waxing is required by looking at the
finish when it is wet. If the water coats
the paint in smooth sheets instead of
forming beads that roll off, a new coat
of wax is needed. Wax should not be
applied to black trim pieces, rubber, or
other plastic parts.
Windshield wiper blade
maintenance
Common problems with the windshield
wipers include streaking or sheeting,
water drops after wiping, and blade
chatter. Streaking is usually caused
when wiper blades are coated with
road film or car wash wax. Clean the
blades using soapy water. If cleaning
the blades does not cure the problem,
they should be replaced. BMW
recommends replacing the wiper
blades twice a year, before and after
the cold season.
To replace wiper blade, depress
retaining tab (arrow) and slide blade
out of arm.
On older cars, check the tension spring
that holds the wiper to the glass.
Replace the wiper arm if the springs
are weak.
Drops that remain behind after wiping
are caused by oil, road film, or diesel
exhaust coating the windshield. Use an
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
Maintenance
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/0...
alcohol or ammonia solution, or a
non-abrasive cleanser to clean the
windshield.
Wiper blade chatter may be caused by
dirty or worn blades, by a dirty
windshield, or by bent or twisted wiper
arms. Clean the blades and windshield
as described above. Adjust the wiper
arm so that there is even pressure
along the blade, and so that the blade
is perpendicular to the windshield at
rest. Lubricate the wiper linkage with a
light oil. The linkage is located under
the hood on the driver's side. If the
problem persists, the blades are
excessively aged or worn and should
be replaced.
Note:
See
611 Wipers and Washers for
more information.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:03 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
OBD-2
On-Board Diagnostics
(OBD II)
OBD II is an acronym for On-Board
Diagnostics II, the second generation of
on-board self-diagnostic equipment
requirements. These standards were
originally mandated for California
vehicles. Since 1996 they have been
applied to all passenger vehicles sold
in the United States.
On-board diagnostic capabilities are
incorporated into the hardware and
software of the engine control module
(ECM) to monitor virtually every
component that can affect vehicle
emissions. OBD II works to ensure that
the vehicles remain as clean as
possible over their entire life.
Each emission-influencing component
is checked by a diagnostic routine to
verify that it is functioning properly. If a
problem or malfunction is detected, the
OBD II system illuminates a warning
light on the instrument panel to alert
the driver. This malfunction indicator
light (MIL) will display the phrase
"Check Engine" or "Service Engine
Soon."
The OBD II system also stores
important information about the
detected malfunction so that a repair
technician can accurately find and fix
the problem.
Note:
Specialized OBD II scan tool
equipment is needed to access the
fault memory and OBD II data.
The OBD II fault memory
(including the MIL) can only be
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
reset using the special scan tool.
Removing the connector from the
ECM or disconnecting the battery
will not erase the fault memory.
The extra hardware needed to operate
the OBD II system consists mainly of
the following:
Additional oxygen sensors
downstream of the catalytic
converters
Fuel tank pressure sensor and
device to pressurize fuel storage
system
Several engine and performance
monitoring devices
Standardized 16-pin OBD II
connector under the dash
Upgraded components for the
federally required 100,000 mile or
10 year reliability mandate
Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL)
The OBD II system is designed to
illuminate the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) when emission levels
exceed 1.5 times the Federal
standards.
Note:
On model year 1999 and 2000 cars, the
MIL is labeled Check Engine. On model
year 2001 cars, the MIL is labeled
Service Engine Soon.
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
The MIL will come on under the
following conditions.
An engine management system
fault is detected for two
consecutive OBD II drive cycles.
A catalyst damaging fault.
A component malfunction (such
as catalyst deterioration) causes
emissions to exceed 1.5 times
OBD II standards.
Manufacturer-defined
specifications are exceeded.
An implausible input signal is
generated.
Misfire faults occur.
A leak is detected in evaporative
system.
The oxygen sensors observe no
purge flow from purge
valve/evaporative system.
The engine control module (ECM)
fails to enter closed-loop operation
within specified time.
The engine control module (ECM)
or automatic transmission control
module (TCM) enters "limp home"
operation mode.
Key is in "ignition on" position
before cranking (bulb check
function).
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
Additional information, MIL:
A fault code is stored within the
ECM upon the first occurrence of
a fault in the system being
checked.
Two complete consecutive drive
cycles with the fault present
illuminate the MIL. The exception
to the two-fault requirement is a
catalyst damaging fault, which will
turn the light on immediately.
If the second drive cycle was not
complete and the specific function
was not checked as shown in the
example, the ECM counts the third
drive cycle as the next consecutive
drive cycle. The MIL is illuminated
if the function is checked and the
fault is still present.
Once the MIL is illuminated it will
remain illuminated unless the
specific function has been
checked without fault through
three complete consecutive drive
cycles.
The fault code will be cleared from
memory automatically if the
specific function is checked
through 40 consecutive drive
cycles without the fault being
detected.
Note:
In order to automatically clear a catalyst
damaging fault from memory, the
condition under which the fault occurred
must be evaluated for 80 consecutive
drive cycles without the fault
reoccurring.
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
With the use of a universal or 'generic'
scan tool connected to the DLC
(Diagnostic Link Connector), diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) can be obtained,
along with the conditions associated
with the illumination of the engine
service light. Using a more advanced or
BMW-dedicated scan tool, additional
'proprietary' information is normally
available.
Scan tool and scan tool display
Owing to the advanced nature of OBD
II adaptive strategies, all diagnostics
need to start with a scan tool. The
aftermarket scan tools can be
connected to either the 16-pin OBD II
Data Link Connector (DLC) or the BMW
20-pin DLC in the engine compartment.
Data from the OBD II DLC may be
limited, depending on scan tool and
vehicle.
OBD II standards mandate that the
16-pin DLC must be located within
three (3) feet of the driver and must not
require any tools to be exposed. The
communication protocol used by BMW
is ISO 9141.
Starting with June 2000 production, the
20-pin BMW diagnostic port (Data Link
Connector or DLC) which was
previously located in the engine
compartment has been deleted. All
diagnostic, coding and programming
functions are incorporated into the
OBD II diagnostic port, located under
left side of dashboard.
Note:
On cars built up 06-2000: when
accessing emissions related DTCs
through the 16-pin OBD II DLC, the
BMW 20-pin DLC cap must be
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
installed.
Professional diagnostic scan tools
available at the time of this
printing include the BMW factory
tools (DISplus and MoDiC) and a
small number of aftermarket
BMW-specific tools. The CS2000
from Baum Tools Unlimited, the
Retriever from Assenmacher
Specialty Tools, and the MT2500
from Snap-On Tools are examples
of quality OBD scan tools.
In addition to the professional line
of scan tools, inexpensive
`generic' OBD II scan tool software
programs and handheld units are
readily available. These tools do
have limited capabilities, but they
are nonetheless powerful
diagnostic tools. These tools read
live data streams and freeze frame
data as well as a host of other
valuable diagnostic data.
For the do-it-yourself owner,
simple aftermarket DTC readers
are also available. These
inexpensive BMW-only tools are
capable of checking for DTCs as
well as turning off the illuminated
MIL and resetting the service
indicator lights.
Diagnostic monitors
A diagnostic monitor is an operating
strategy that runs internal tests and
checks a specific system, component
or function. This is similar to computer
self tests.
Completion of a drive cycle ensures
that all monitors have completed their
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
required tests. The ECM must
recognize the loss or impairment of the
signal or component and determine if a
signal or sensor is faulty based on 3
conditions:
Signal or component shorted to
ground
Signal or component shorted to
B+
Signal or component missing
(open circuit)
The OBD II system must monitor all
emission control systems that are
on-board. Not all vehicles have a full
complement of emission control
systems. For example, a vehicle may
not be equipped with secondary air
injection, so naturally no secondary air
readiness/function code would be
present.
OBD lI requires monitoring of the
following:
Oxygen sensor monitoring
Catalyst monitoring
Misfire monitoring
Evaporative system monitoring
Secondary air monitoring
Fuel system monitoring
Monitoring these emissions related
functions is done using DME input
sensors and output accouters based
on preprogrammed data sets. If the
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
ECM cannot determine the
environment or engine operating
conditions due to missing or faulty
signals it will set a fault code and,
depending on conditions, illuminate the
MIL.
Oxygen sensor monitoring: When drive
conditions allow, response rate and
switching time of each oxygen sensor
is monitored. In addition, the heater
function is also monitored. The OBD II
"diagnostic executive" knows the
difference between upstream and
downstream oxygen sensors and reads
each one individually.
All oxygen sensors are monitored
separately. In order for the oxygen
sensor to be effectively monitored, the
system must be in closed loop
operation.
Catalyst monitoring: This strategy
monitors the two heated oxygen
sensors per bank of cylinders. It
compares the oxygen content going
into the catalytic converter to the
oxygen leaving the converter.
The diagnostic executive knows that
most of the oxygen should be used up
during the oxidation phase and if it
sees higher than programmed values,
a fault will be set and the MIL will
illuminate.
Misfire detection: This strategy
monitors crankshaft speed fluctuations
and determines if a misfire occurs by
variations in speed between each
crankshaft sensor trigger point. This
strategy is so finely tuned that it can
even determine the severity of the
misfire.
The diagnostic executive must
determine if misfire is occurring, as well
as other pertinent misfire information.
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
Specific cylinder(s)
Severity of the misfire event
Emissions relevant or catalyst
damaging
Misfire detection is an on-going
monitoring process that is only
disabled under certain limited
conditions.
Secondary air injection monitoring:
Secondary air injection is used to
reduce HC and CO emissions during
engine warm up. Immediately following
a cold engine start (-10 to 40�C),
fresh air/oxygen is pumped directly into
the exhaust manifold. By injecting
oxygen into the exhaust manifold,
catalyst warm-up time is reduced.
System components:
Electric air injection motor/pump
Electric motor/pump relay
Non-return valve
Vacuum/vent valve
Stainless steel air injection pipes
Vacuum reservoir
The secondary air system is monitored
via the use of the pre-catalyst oxygen
sensors. Once the air pump is active
and air is injected into the system, the
signal at the oxygen sensor will reflect
a lean condition. If the oxygen sensor
signal does not change, a fault will be
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
set and identify the faulty bank(s). If
after completing the next cold start a
fault is again present, the MIL will be
illuminated.
Fuel system monitoring: This monitors
receives high priority. It looks at the
fuel delivery needed (long/short term
fuel trim) for proper engine operation
based on programmed data. If too
much or not enough fuel is delivered
over a predetermined time, a DTC is
set and the MIL is turned on.
Note:
Fuel trim refers to adjustments to base
fuel schedule. Long-term fuel trim
refers to gradual adjustments to the fuel
calibration adjustment as compared to
short term fuel trim. Long term fuel trim
adjustments compensate for gradual
changes that occur over time.
Fuel system monitoring monitors the
calculated injection time (ti) in relation
to engine speed, load, and the
pre-catalytic converter oxygen
sensor(s) signals as a result of residual
oxygen in the exhaust stream.
The diagnostic executive uses the
precatalyst oxygen sensor signal as a
correction factor for adjusting and
optimizing the mixture pilot control
under all engine operating conditions.
Evaporative system monitoring: This
monitor checks the sealed integrity of
the fuel storage system and related
fuel lines.
This monitor has the ability to detect
very small leaks anywhere in the
system. A pressure test is be
performed on the EVAP system on a
continuous basis as the drive cycle
allows.
On MS 42.0 cars, a leak detection
pump (LDP) is used to pressurize and
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
check system integrity. On MS 43.0
cars, a more sophisticated DMTL
(Diagnostic Module - Leak Detection)
pump is used.
Drive cycle
The OBD II drive cycle is an important
concept in understanding OBD II
requirements. The purpose of the drive
cycle is to run all of the emissionrelated on-board diagnostics over on a
broad range of driving conditions.
The drive cycle is considered
completed when all of the diagnostic
monitors have run their tests without
interruption. For a drive cycle to be
initiated, the vehicle must be started
cold and brought up to 160�F and at
least 40�F above its original starting
temperature.
Once the drive cycle is completed, the
system status or
inspection/maintenance (I/M) readiness
codes are set to "Yes."
System status codes will be set to "No"
in the following cases:
The battery or ECM is
disconnected.
The ECM's DTCs have been
erased after completion of repairs
and a drive cycle has not be
completed.
A scan tool can be used to determine if
on-board diagnosis is complete as well
as the status of the I/M codes. All
required tests must be completed
before the I/M readiness codes will be
set to "Yes".
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
Readiness codes
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
1 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
OBD-3
BMW Fault Codes
(DTCs)
Below is a comprehensive listing of
BMW DTCs and the corresponding
SAE P-codes.
Table a. Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
1
Ignition coil cyl.2
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
2
Ignition coil cyl.4
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
3
Ignition coil cyl.6
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
5
P0202
Injector circuit cyl.
2
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
6
P0201
Injector circuit cyl.
1
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
2 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
8
P0101
Mass air flow
circuit range/perf.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
10
Engine coolant
temp. circuit
range/perf.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits within specific engine
operations.
11
Coolant temp.
coolant outlet
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits within specific engine
operations.
14
P0111
Intake air temp.
Input analog
range/performance (0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits within specific engine
operations.
18
P1397
Exhaust cam
position sensor
malfunction
Input analog
phase shift (0-5V)
Internal check of phase shift
from camshaft sensor should change during every
crankshaft revolution.Phase
shift occurs due to 2:1
relationship between
camshafts.
19
P1529
VANOS solenoid
activation, exhaust
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
21
P1525
VANOS solenoid
activation, intake
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
22
P0203
Injector circuit cyl.
3
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
3 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
23
P0206
Injector circuit cyl.
6
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
24
P0204
Injector circuit cyl.
4
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
25
P0135
Oxygen sensor
heater pre-cat
(Bank1)
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
27
P1550
Idle control valve
closing coil
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
29
Ignition coil cyl.1
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
30
Ignition coil cyl.3
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
31
Ignition coil cyl.5
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
4 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
33
P0205
Injector circuit cyl.
5
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
35
P1453
Secondary air
injection pump
Output digital
on/off (active low)
TDME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
36
MS 43
Main relay
malfunction
Input analog
(0-12V)
Signal range check between
DME ignition analog input
and main relay power circuit
analog input.
38
MS 43
Clutch switch
faulty
Input digital
(0-12V)
Plausibility check of clutch
switch and DME internal
values such as load and
engine speed.
39
Brake light switch,
and brake light
plausibility test
Input digital
(0-12V)
When brake light switch is
active, brake light test switch
must be also active. If not,
fault is stored.
40
Brake light switch,
pedal sensor
plausibility test
Input digital /
analog (0-12V /
0-5V)
If pedal sensor is showing
angle greater than "limp
home angle" and additionally
brake light switch is active,
fault is stored.
42
Multi functional
steering wheel,
redundant code
Input binary
stream (0-12V)
Every signal from cruise
control switch is transferred
redundantly. A fault is set
whenever two redundant
information paths are showing
a different status.
43
Multi functional
steering wheel,
control switch
Input binary
stream (0-12V)
When status from cruise
control showing
set/accelerate and
deceleration are same time,
fault is set.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
5 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
45
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
Multi functional
steering wheel,
toggle-bit
Input binary
stream (0-12V)
Every 0.5 sec. a message that
includes a toggle bit (toggles
between 0->1 and 1->0) is
transmitted. Change bit is
monitored to indicate proper
function.
47
MS 43
Torque monitoring
level 1
DME internal
values logical
48
MS 43
Internal control
module
DME HW test
memory
ECU internal test
DME HW test
P1145
MS 42
Running losses
valve (3/2), final
stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
MS 43
ECU internal test
DME HW test
MS 43
ECU internal test
DME HW test
49
50
51
52
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Rear exhaust valve Output digital
flap
steady (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
53
P1509
Idle control valve
opening coil
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
55
P0155
Oxygen sensor
heater pre-cat
(Bank 2)
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Ignition feedback,
interruption at
Input analog (32V)
Check for correct signal
voltage. If voltage is 32V
56
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
6 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
shunt resistor
Explanation
(limitation voltage) then
secondary ignition voltage is
detected and shunt resistor
may be faulty.
57
P0325
Knock sensor 1
circuit, (Bank 1)
circuit continuity
Input analog
amplitude
(13-19kHz)
Plausibility check between
knock sensor amplitude
during knocking with internal
knock detection mapped DME
values.
59
P0330
Knock sensor 2
circuit, (Bank 2)
circuit continuity
Input analog
amplitude
(13-19kHz)
Plausibility check between
knock sensor amplitude
during knocking with internal
knock detection mapped DME
values.
61
P0141
Oxygen sensor
heater post-cat
(Bank 2)
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
62
P0412
Secondary air
injection system
switching valve
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
65
P0340
Intake cam position Input analog
sensor,
phase shift 0-5V
malfunction
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
68
Output digital
EVAP system,
purge control valve pulse width (active
circuit
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
69
Relay fuel pump
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
Output digital
on/off (active low)
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
7 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
transistor and component
exists.
74
AC compressor
relay
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
79
P0161
Oxygen sensor
heater post-cat
(Bank 1)
83
P0335
Crankshaft position Input digital
sensor,
(0-12V)
malfunction
Checks for correct signal
pattern and correct number of
expected flywheel teeth.
100
P0601
Internal control
module, memory
check sum or
communication
DME internal
values logical
Internal hardware test of
RAM, ROM, and Flash Prom.
103
P1519
VANOS faulty
reference value
intake
DME internal
values logical
Maximum VANOS adjustment
angle, checked at every
engine start must be within a
specified limit.
104
P1520
VANOS faulty
reference value
exhaust
DME internal
values logical
Maximum VANOS adjustment
angle, checked at every
engine start must be within a
specified limit.
105
P1522
VANOS stuck
(Bank 1) intake
DME internal
values
Monitoring of a desired
VANOS adjustment within a
predefined diagnostic time
limit.
106
P1523
VANOS stuck
(Bank 2) exhaust
DME internal
values
Monitoring of a desired
VANOS adjustment within a
predefined diagnostic time
limit.
109
P1580
Motor throttle valve Output digital
pulse width
pulse width not
(0-12V)
plausible
Throttle position control
algorithm checks for problems
with mechanical coupling
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
8 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
spring within motor throttle
body.
110
P1542
Pedal sensor
potentiometer 1
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
111
P1542
Pedal Sensor
Potentiometer 2
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
112
P0120
MS 42
Motor throttle valve Input analog
potentiometer 1
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
MS 43
Throttle position
sensor 1
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
113
P0120
Motor throttle valve Input analog
potentiometer 2
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
114
P1580
MS 42
Motor throttle valve DME internal test
final stage
Final stage inside DME
(special H-bridge), will set
internal flag whenever a short
to ground, a short to battery
voltage or a disconnection
occurs.
MS 43
A second pedal
sensor range
check failure is
determined
DME internal
values logical
If pedal sensor malfunction is
determined, followed by a
second malfunction, a signal
is sent.
P1623
MS 42
Output voltage 5V
for potentiometer
operation 1
DME internal (5V)
Check for proper 5 volts
supply to potentiometers is
possible within a predefined
voltage limit.
MS 43
Range check for
throttle position
adaptation
Input analog
(0-5V)
Range check for closed
position of throttle sensors.
P1623
Output voltage for
potentiometer
operation 2
DME internal (5V)
Check for proper 5 volts
supply to potentiometers is
possible within a predefined
voltage limit.
115
116
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
9 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
117
P1542
Pedal sensor
potentiometer
plausibility
Input analog
(0-5V)
If there is a difference greater
than specified between two
redundant signals from
potentiometer, fault will be
set.
118
P0120
MS 42
Motor throttle
feedback
potentiometer
plausibility
Input analog
(0-5V)
If there is a difference greater
than specified between two
redundant signals from
potentiometer, fault will be
set.
MS 43
Throttle position
sensor 1;
plausibility check
sensor 1 to mass
air flow meter
DME internal
values
Signal range is checked
against predetermined
diagnostic limits. Rationality
check with mass air flow
meter.
P1580
MS 42
MDK, throttle
mechanical
sticking
DME internal test
Throttle doesn't reach desired
opening angle within a
specified time.
MS 43
Throttle position
sensor 2;
plausibility check
sensor 1 to mass
air flow meter
DME internal
values
Signal range is checked
against predetermined
diagnostic limits. Rationality
check with mass air flow
meter.
P1542
MS 42
Pedal sensor/
DME internal
motor throttle valve values logical
potentiometer not
motor
plausible
Signal from motor throttle
valve potentiometer must be
equal signal from pedal
sensor potentiometer plus
any adaptive values.
MS 43
Plausibility check
between brake
switch and pedal
sensor
Input digital /
analog
Plausibility check between
constant pedal value and
brake switch. First pedal
value must be constant and
for next step brake switch
must be active.
122
P1101
Oil temp. sensor
malfunction
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits and calculated
temperature.
123
P1622
Electric thermostat
control, final stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
119
120
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
10 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
124
P1593
DISA, range/perf.
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Coolant fan, final
stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
P1470
MS 42
LDP-magnetic
valve
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
MS 43
DMTL valve
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
127
Fuel pump
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
128
EWS signal not
present or faulty
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
During time out check no
signal was present within
specific time or faulty
information from serial
interface (parity, overrun,
etc.).
130
CAN time out
(ASC1)
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
125
126
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
11 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
131
CAN time out (instr Input binary
2)
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
132
CAN time out (instr Input binary
3)
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
133
CAN time out
(ASC3)
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
135
MS 43
Limp home
position adaptation
necessary
DME internal
values logical
Limp home position must be
in specified range. If range is
exceeded, a fault is set.
136
MS 43
Motor throttle valve DME internal
open / closing test values logical
failed
From limp home mode
position, throttle valve will be
open, afterwards it must fall
back into limp home position.
If fall back position is not in
specified range, fault is set.
140
P1475
LDP reed-switch
not closed
Input digital on/off
(0-12V)
With shut off valve open and
no pressure on system, reed
contact should be closed,
showing a "high signal". If not
the case in beginning of every
diagnostics check, a signal is
sent.
140
MS 43
DMTL pump final
stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
141
P1477
EVAP: reed switch
not closed, doesn't
open or doesn't
close
Input digital on/off
(0-12V)
Within predetermined time
LDP reed switch signal must
change from high to low or
from low to high or LDP reed
switch is "low" for longer than
predetermined time.
142
P1477
EVAP: reed switch
not closed, doesn't
open or doesn't
close
Input digital on/off
(0-12V)
Within predetermined time
LDP reed switch signal must
change from high to low or
from low to high or LDP reed
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
12 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
switch is "low" for longer than
predetermined time.
142
MS 43
DMTL module fault DME internal
values logical
143
P1476
EVAP: clamped
tube check
146
MS 43
DME internal input
Range check
voltage supply
analog
pedal sensor 2 and
throttle position
sensors
Supply voltage for sensors
must be within a specified
range.
147
MS 43
Range check
DME internal input
voltage supply
analog
pedal sensor 2 and
throttle position
sensors
Supply voltage for sensors
must be within a specified
range.
149
P1140
Motor throttle
feedback
potentiometer and
air mass sensor
signal not
plausible
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal from motor throttle
valve potentiometer must be
suitable to signal from air
mass sensor. A fault is set if
difference exceeds specified
limit.
150
P0130
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
short to battery
volt.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal has to be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or a fault will set.
151
P0130
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
short to ground
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
152
P0130
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
Input digital
frequency (0-12V)
Frequency of LDP pumps
reed switch is lower then
predetermined limit. Volume
of leak is determined to be too
small (i.e. pinched or
restricted hose)
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
13 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
on input line.
153
P0150
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 2),
short to battery
volt.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
154
P0150
Oxygen
sensorpre-cat
(Bank 2), short to
ground
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
155
P0150
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 2),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
on input line.
156
P0136
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 1),
short to battery
volt.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
157
P0136
Oxygen sensor
Input analog
Post Cat. (Bank 1), (0-5V)
short to ground
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
159
P0156
Input analog
Oxygen sensor
Post Cat. (Bank 2), (0-5V)
short to battery
volt.
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
160
P0156
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 2),
short to ground
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
Input analog
(0-5V)
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
14 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
160
MS 43
Throttle valve
position controller
DME internal
values logical
161
MS 43
Throttle valve
position controller
DME internal
values logical
162
MS 43
Throttle valve
position controller
DME internal
values logical
168
MS 43
Throttle valve
position, throttle
sticking
DME internal test
calculated
MDK final stage
shut off
DME internal test
This fault indicates problem
on pedal sensor, throttle
potentiometer or throttle. A
separately stored fault code
indicates problem.
169
Explanation
171
P0601
System has been
shut down due to
safety controller
DME internal test
Safety controller has shut
down motor throttle valve
function due to not plausible
MDK input values.
172
P1542
Pedal sensor
potentiometer
short between two
potentiometer
paths
DME internal
check
5 volts for potentiometers are
switched on within a specific
time pattern.
173
P0120
Motor throttle valve Rationality check
potentiometer
contact short
Motor throttle valve
potentiometer
174
P0120
Motor throttle valve Input analog
potentiometer
(0-5V)
adaptation of idle
end position
Signal for idle position must
be within a specified range. If
range is exceeded, fault is
set.
Pedal sensor
potentiometer 1
adaptation of the
idle end position
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal for idle position must
be within a specified range. If
range is exceeded, fault is
set.
Pedal sensor
potentiometer 2
adaptation of the
idle end position
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal for idle position must
be within a specified range. If
range is exceeded, fault is
set.
175
176
P1542
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
15 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
188
P1132
Oxygen sensor
heater, pre-cat
(Bank 1),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
189
P1133
Oxygen sensor
heater, pre-cat
(Bank 2),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
190
P1186
Oxygen sensorheater, post-cat
(Bank 1),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
191
P1187
Oxygen sensor
heater, post-cat
(Bank 2),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
197
MS 43
Signal range check DME internal
analog input
202
P0170
Fuel trim (Bank 1),
O2 control limit
DME internal
values logical
Controller for lambda is too
long beyond a min. or a max.
203
P0173
Fuel Trim (Bank 2), DME internal
O2 control limit
values logical
Controller for lambda is too
long beyond a min. or a max.
204
P0505
Idle control
system, idle speed
not plausible
DME internal
values logical
Functional check between
actual engine speed (RPM)
and predetermined RPM
exceeds maximum deviation
of +200/-100 RPM.
208
EWS, engine
speed check not
ok
DME internal test
Engine speed signal is
transferred by EWS to DME.
Fault is set if transferred
signal is not reflecting engine
speed due to input problem in
EWS.
209
EWS, content of
message
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
Content of binary message
received from EWS invalid.
210
Ignition feedback,
faulty (>2
cylinders)
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
Check for correct signal
timing after each ignition has
been initiated by feedback
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
16 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
signal. If more than two
ignition signals are not
recognized than there might
be a problem in feedback line.
211
P1510
Idle control valve
stuck
DME internal
values logical
Functional check against a
calculated value by
monitoring flow though air
mass meter to determine if
idle valve is mechanically
stuck open. Tested during
closed throttle.
214
P0500
Vehicle speed
sensor
Input digital
frequency (0-12V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits. No vehicle speed is
observed after specific time
when compared to engine
speed and load equivalent to
moving vehicle.
215
P0136
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 1),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
on input line.
216
P0136
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 2),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
on input line.
217
P0505
CAN time out
(EGS1)
Input digital binary
information(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS was not received
within expected time.
CAN-chip, bus off
Input digital binary Hardware test determines if
information (0-12V) CAN bus is off line. Data
transmission is disturbed.
219
220
P1184
Input analog (high
Oxygen sensor
is lean) (0-5V)
post-cat (Bank 1)
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor stays in rich or
lean state. If it remains there
too long in either, fault will
set.
221
P1185
Input analog (high
Oxygen sensor
is lean) (0-5V)
post-cat (Bank 2)
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor stays in rich or
lean state. If it remains there
too long in either fault will set.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
17 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
222
P0125
Insufficient coolant
temp. to permit
closed loop
operation
Input analog
(0-5V)
Comparison of actual coolant
temperature against
calculated DME value which
varies with load signal.
223
P1180
Oxygen sensor
Input analog (high
post-cat (Bank 1),
is lean) (0-5V)
switching time slow
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If too long, fault will
set.
224
P1181
Oxygen sensor
Input analog (high
post-cat (Bank 2),
is lean) (0-5V)
switching time slow
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If too long, fault will
set.
225
P1192
Post-cat sensor
(Bank 1); trim
control
Input analog
(0-5V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with post
catalyst sensor bank 1.
226
P0193
Post-cat sensor
(Bank 2); trim
control
Input analog
(0-5V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with post
catalyst sensor bank 2.
227
P0188
Fuel trim (Bank 1),
O2 control
adaptation limit
DME internal
values logical
Range control of adaptation
values.
228
P0189
Fuel trim (Bank 2),
O2 control
adaptation limit
DME internal
values logical
Range control of adaptation
values.
229
P0133
Oxygen sensor
Input analog (high
pre-cat (Bank 1,
is lean) (0-5V)
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If too long, fault will
set.
230
P0153
Input analog (high
Oxygen sensor
is lean) (0-5V)
pre-cat (Bank 2),
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor stays in its rich
or lean state. If it remains
there too long in either fault
will set.
231
P1178
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
switch time too
slow
Input analog (high
is lean) (0-5V)
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If it takes too long to
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
18 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
switch fault will set.
232
P0179
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 2),
switch time too
slow
Input analog (high
is lean) (0-5V)
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If it takes too long to
switch fault will set.
233
P0420
Catalyst efficiency
(Bank 1), below
threshold
Input analog
(0-5V)
Compares value of pre-cat
oxygen sensor to value of
post-cat oxygen sensor to
measure oxygen storage
capability / efficiency of
catalytic converter. Post-cat
oxygen sensor must be
relatively lean.
234
P0430
Catalyst efficiency
(Bank 2), below
threshold
Input analog
(0-5V)
Compares value of pre-cat
oxygen sensor to value of
post-cat oxygen sensor to
measure oxygen storage
capability / efficiency of
catalytic converter. Post-cat
oxygen sensor must be
relatively lean.
235
P1190
Pre-cat sensor
(Bank 1):trim
control
Input analog (high
is rich) (0-1V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with
pre-cat sensor bank 1
236
P1191
Pre-cat sensor
(Bank 2):trim
control
Input analog (high
is rich) (0-1V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with
pre-cat sensor bank 2
238
P0301
Cyl. 1 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 1 is longer, fault
will set.
239
P0302
Cyl. 2 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
19 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
for cylinder 2 is longer, fault
will set.
240
P0303
Cyl. 3 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 3 is longer, fault
will set.
241
P0304
Cyl. 4 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 4 is longer, fault
will set.
242
P0305
Cyl. 5 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 5 is longer, fault
will set.
243
P0306
Cyl. 6 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 6 is longer, fault
will set.
Segment timing
faulty, flywheel
adaptation
Input analog
(0-5V)
Flywheel segments are
monitored during deceleration
to establish baseline for
misfire calculation. If
segments are too long/short
(bad flywheel) and exceed
limit, fault will be set.
244
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
20 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
245
P1423
Secondary air
injection (Bank 1),
flow too low
Input analog
(0-5V)
Checks to see if oxygen
sensor reacts to increase in
unmetered airflow generated
by secondary air pump
operation. Oxygen sensor
must sense lean condition or
fault will set.
246
P1421
Secondary air
injection (Bank 2),
flow too low
Input analog
(0-5V)
Checks to see if oxygen
sensor reacts to increase in
unmetered airflow generated
by secondary air pump
operation. Oxygen sensor
must sense lean condition or
fault will set.
247
P1432
Secondary air
valve stuck open
Input analog
(0-5V)
Checks to see if oxygen
sensor reacts to increase in
unmetered airflow generated
by secondary air pump
operation. Oxygen sensor
must sense lean condition or
fault will set.
248
P1184
Post-cat sensor;
signal after decel
phase not
plausible; (Bank 1)
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal is checked for a lean
signal in decel and a
transition between lean to rich
after decel
249
P1185
Post-cat sensor;
signal after decel
phase not
plausible; (Bank 2)
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal is checked for a lean
signal in decel and a
transition between lean to rich
after decel
250
P0440
Functional check
purge valve
Input analog
(0-5V)
This functional check looks
for reaction of oxygen sensor
signal during canister
purging. Oxygen sensor, air
flow meter and RPM values
must react to purging of
canister.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
Engine-General
1 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
100-1
General
This section covers system descriptions
and general information on engines
and engine management systems. Also
covered is basic engine
troubleshooting.
For specific repair procedures, refer to
the appropriate repair group:
110 Engine Removal and
Installation
113 Cylinder Head Removal
and Installation
116 Cylinder Head and
Valvetrain
117 Camshaft Timing Chains
119 Lubrication System
120 Ignition System
130 Fuel Injection
170 Radiator and Cooling
System
Engine
M52 TU 6-cylinder engine is a technical
update (hence the designation TU) of
the earlier 2.8 liter M52 engine. The
main `technical update' for M52 TU was
the addition of double VANOS.
In model year 2001, the M54 (2.5 and
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
2 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
3.0 liter) engines were introduced. This
engine incorporates all the technical
features of the M52 TU engines with
addition of fully electronic throttle
control and enhanced emission
controls.
Table a. Engine specifications lists
engine specifications for the vehicles
covered by this manual.
Table a. Engine specifications
Model
year
323i
1999 2000
Engine No. of
Displacement Bore/ Compression Torque
code
cylinders cc (cu. in.)
stroke ratio
lb-ft/rpm
M52
TU B25
325i/Ci/xi M54
2001
B25
328i/Ci
1999 2000
M52
TU B28
330i/Ci/xi M54
2001
B30
Horsepower
Hp/rpm
2494 (152.2)
84
mm
(3.307
in.)
75
mm
(2.953
in.)
10.5: 1
181/3,500 170/5,500
2494 (152.2)
84
mm
(3.307
in.)
75
mm
(2.953
in.)
10.5: 1
175/3,500 184/6,000
6
2793 (170.4)
84
mm
(3.307
in.)
84
mm
(3.307
in.)
10.2: 1
206/3,500 193/5,500
6
84
mm
(3.307
2979.3 (181.8) in.)
89.6
mm
(3.528
10.2: 1
214/3,500 225/5,900
6
6
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
3 of 19
Model
year
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Engine No. of
Displacement Bore/ Compression Torque
code
cylinders cc (cu. in.)
stroke ratio
lb-ft/rpm
Horsepower
Hp/rpm
in.)
Torque/power graphs
M52 TU 2.5 liter
M52 TU 2.8 liter
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
4 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
M54 2.5 liter
M54 3.0 liter
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
5 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Cylinder block and crankshaft
The cylinder block is cast aluminum
alloy (AlSi9Cu3) with cast iron cylinder
liners. The cylinders are exposed on all
sides to circulating coolant.
The counterweighted crankshaft rotates
in replaceable split-shell main bearings.
Oilways drilled into the crankshaft
provide bearing lubrication. Oil seals
pressed into alloy seal housings are
installed at both ends of the crankshaft.
The 2.5 liter crankshaft is cast iron. The
2.8 and 3.0 liter engines use a forged
steel crankshaft to accommodate the
higher torque. The crankshaft for the 3.0
liter engine is adapted from the S52 M3
engine.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
6 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connecting rods and pistons
The forged steel connecting rods use
replaceable split-shell bearings at the
crankshaft end and solid bushings at the
piston pin end.
The pistons are of the three-ring type
with two upper compression rings and a
lower one-piece oil scraper ring.
Full-floating piston pins are retained with
circlips.
The 2.8 and 3.0 liter engines use a
graphite coating on the piston skirts to
reduce friction and noise.
Cylinder head and valvetrain
Cooling passages in the cylinder head
are designed for optimum coolant
circulation, allowing the head to operate
at lower temperatures than the cylinder
block.
The aluminum cylinder head uses chaindriven double overhead camshafts and
four valves per cylinder. The cylinder
head employs a crossflow design for
greater power and efficiency. Intake air
enters the combustion chamber from
one side while exhaust gasses exit from
the other.
Oilways in the head provide lubrication
for the camshafts and valvetrain.
Valve clearance is set by self-adjusting
(zero-lash) hydraulic lifters for reduced
valve noise and the elimination of routine
valve adjustment.
Exhaust manifolds
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
7 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Each exhaust manifold assembly
incorporates a catalytic converter. The
converters are mounted close to the
engine for faster heat up. Pre- and
post-catalyst oxygen sensors are a
mounted in each exhaust manifold.
Cooling system
The cooling system circulation is
designed so that coolant flows directly
from the coolant pump to the cylinder
head. The coolant is fed from the coolant
pump through a cast coolant feed
passage to the rear of the cylinder head.
From there it flows forward to the
thermostat housing, radiator and heater
valve.
The coolant passages in the cylinder
block are only connected to the coolant
supply through the holes in the head
gasket. A reduced volume of the coolant
flows through the cylinder block.
All models are equipped with a
DME-controlled electric cooling fan. On
some models, a supplemental cooling
170 Radiator and
fan is used. See
Cooling System for specific configuration
and application information.
An electrically heated thermostat
controls the flow of coolant through the
radiator based on coolant and outside
temperature, engine load, and driving
speed, rather than just coolant
temperature.
The DME-controlled heated thermostat
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
8 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
allows the engine to be operated at
higher controlled temperatures during
low and part throttle. This optimizes
operating temperatures in both cylinder
head and block, reduces friction and
thereby fuel consumption.
The cooling system is designed to:
Reduce operating temperatures of
cylinder head. The result of lower
temperatures is increased torque
due to improved volumetric
efficiency.
Increase operating temperature of
cylinder block.
Lubrication system
The lubrication system is pressurized
whenever the engine is running. The oil
pump draws oil through a pickup in the
bottom of the oil pan, then forces it
through a replaceable oil filter and into
the engine oil passages.
The chain-driven oil pump is bolted to
the bottom of the cylinder block inside
the oil pan. A pressure relief valve limits
the maximum system pressure. A
bypass valve prevents the oil filter from
bursting and insures engine lubrication
should the filter become plugged. See
119 Lubrication System for additional
information.
Resonance/turbulence intake
system
The intake manifold, made of molded
plastic, is configured as two sets of three
runners. This design enhances low end
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
9 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
torque by changing the intake air flow
configuration for varying engine speeds.
This helps achieve optimum torque
throughout the entire RPM range.
During engine operation, a closed
resonance valve gives the intake air
charge the dynamic effect of long intake
runners at low to mid-range RPM (up to
3750 rpm). This helps increase torque.
During mid-range to high rpm operation
(above 4100 rpm), the solenoid is
de-energized and the resonance valve is
sprung open. This allows intake air to be
drawn through both resonance tubes,
providing the air volume necessary for
additional power at the upper rpm range.
Note:
The rpm for resonance valve activation
may vary slightly depending on
temperature.
In addition, when the valve is closed, a
dynamic effect is produced. For
example, as intake air is flowing into
cylinder 1, the intake valves will close.
This blocks the onrushing air. The
cylinder 1 air flow will stop and expand
backward (resonance back pulse) to fill
cylinder 5. The resonance wave along
with the intake velocity enhances
cylinder filling.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
10 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
The intake manifold includes intake
turbulence ports. The 5.5 mm (0.217 in.)
turbulence ports channel idle and low
speed air directly from the idle speed
control valved to one intake valve of each
cylinder.
Routing intake air to one intake valve per
cylinder causes the air charge to swirl in
the cylinder. Together with the high flow
rate of intake air across the small (5.5
mm) port, intake fluctuations are
reduced for more stable combustion.
VANOS (Variable Camshaft
Timing)
A double VANOS system is used on
both the M52 TU and the M54 engines.
VANOS is fully variable and operates
independently on both intake and
exhaust sides.
When the VANOS solenoid is actuated,
engine oil pressure is applied to the front
side of the gear cup piston. This forces
the gear cup into the camshaft helical
gears to change camshaft timing.
In addition to offering increased power,
the double VANOS system offers the
following advantages:
Increased torque at lower and
medium RPM ranges
More efficient combustion and
improved idle quality
Internal EGR in part-load range for
lower NOx emissions.
Quicker warm-up cycle for catalytic
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
11 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
converter and faster reduction in
emissions.
Overall improved fuel economy.
See
117 Camshaft Timing Chains for
VANOS system testing and repair
information.
Engine management system
The Siemens engine management
systems used in E46 cars combine fuel
injection, ignition and other functions
under the control of the engine control
module (ECM) They are compliant with
second generation on-board diagnostics
(OBD II) standards. See
OBD On
Board Diagnostics at the back of this
manual for additional information.
Table b. Engine management
systems
Year:
Engine
DME system
1999 - 2000:
M52 TU B25
M52 TU B28
Siemens MS 42.0
2001:
M54 B25
M54 B30
Siemens MS 43.0
Engine control module (ECM)
The engine control module (ECM) is
mounted in the electronics box (E-box)
next to the brake master cylinder.
-
The ECM is flash-programmable
and features 5 electrical harness
connectors with a total of 134 pins.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
12 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector 1: Voltages and grounds
Connector 2: Ancillary signals
(oxygen sensors, CAN, etc.)
Connector 3: Engine signals
Connector 4: Vehicle signals
Connector 5: Ignition signals
Note:
The flash EEPROM (chip) is specifically
`programmed' to the vehicle. It has the
capability to be programmed up to 13
times.
ECM inputs:
Hot film mass air flow (MAF) sensor
monitors intake air with no moving
parts.
Pre- and post-catalytic converter
oxygen sensors monitor engine
emissions and catalyst efficiency.
MS 42.0: Static Hall-effect sensors
are used to detect camshaft
position as soon as the ignition is
turned ON, before the engine is
started.
Dynamic Hall-effect crankshaft
position sensor is mounted at the
flywheel end of the engine block
and is integral to misfire detection.
Engine coolant temperature sensor
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
13 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
(ECT) in cylinder head supplies
coolant temperature information to
the ECM.
ECM outputs:
Fuel injector opening duration.
Intake and exhaust valve timing via
the VANOS system.
The radiator cooling fan and the
heated coolant thermostat.
Motor-driven throttle valve: MDK in
MS 42.0 or EDK in MS 43.0.
Idle speed control valve (MS 42.0)
Resonance valve in the intake
manifold.
ECM outputs (cont.):
MS 42.0: Fuel pressure via 3/2 way
valve monitors running losses
(evaporative losses during engine
operation).
Secondary air injection (if
applicable) to reduce HC and CO.
Multiple spark ignition system.
Maximum vehicle speed and cruise
control.
Brake booster vacuum pump.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
14 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Fuel purge valve and fuel tank
leakage diagnosis pump (LDP or
DM-TL).
Fuel metering: The ECM meters
pressurized fuel by changing the
opening time (pulse width) of the fuel
injectors. The exact amount of fuel
injected is determined by the amount of
time the injectors are open. To ensure
that injector pulse width is the only factor
that determines fuel metering, fuel pump
pressure is maintained by a pressure
regulator. The injectors are mounted to a
common fuel rail.
The ECM monitors engine operating
conditions to determine injector opening
duration. Each injector can be
individually controlled for cylinder
selective fuel trim. The fuel-injectors
inject fuel at an angle in a dual cone
spray pattern.
Air intake: Air entering the engine passes
through a pleated paper air filter in the
air cleaner. Intake air mass is then
measured by a mass air flow (MAF)
sensor. A reference current is used to
heat a thin film in the sensor when the
engine is running. The current needed to
hold the temperature of the film constant
is the basis of the electronically
converted voltage measurement
corresponding to the mass of the intake
air.
Idle speed control: Idle speed is
electronically controlled via the idle
speed control valve by bypassing
varying amounts of air around the closed
throttle valve. Idle speed is not
adjustable. The ECM determines idle
speed by controlling a dual-winding
rotary idle control valve. The basic
functions and parameters of idle speed
control are as follows:
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
15 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Control of cold air intake volume.
For example, at air temperatures
below 0°C (32°F), electronic throttle
control (MDK/EDK) is also opened
during idle.
Smooth idle speeds regardless of
load and inputs
Lower rpm range
Smooth transition from acceleration
to deceleration
Idle speed stabilization is active during
the following conditions:
Engine warm up
A/C activation
Drive gear selected (auto.
transmission)
During passenger compartment
heating
During different cooling fan speeds
If the ECM detects a fault in the idle
control valve, it will increase or decrease
air flow, depending on the nature of the
fault:
If the fault causes decreased air
flow (idle control valve closed), the
electronic throttle control (MDK or
EDK) will compensate to maintain
idle. The EML lamp will illuminate to
inform the driver of a fault.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
16 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
If the fault causes increased air flow
(actuator failed open), VANOS and
knock control are deactivated. This
reduces engine performance
noticeably.
Throttle control: The throttle valve plate
is electronically operated for precise
throttle operation, OBD II compliant for
fault monitoring, and ASC/DSC and
cruise control. This integrated electronic
throttle reduces additional control
modules, wiring and sensors. Adjusting
electronic throttles is not permitted and
the throttle assembly must be replaced
as a unit if found to be faulty.
The throttle assembly for the MS 42.0
system is referred to as the MDK (Motor
Driven Throttle Valve). The MDK is
identified as follows:
A throttle cable is used to actuate
the accelerator pedal position
potentiometers and also serves as a
backup to open the throttle plate
(full control) when the MDK system
is in the failsafe mode.
The throttle assembly for the MS 43.0
system is referred to as the EDK
(Electronic Throttle Valve). The EDK is
identified as follows:
The accelerator position
potentiometers (PWG) are located
in the accelerator pedal assembly.
The EDK is fully electronic. The
accelerator pedal is not
mechanically linked to the EDK.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
17 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Ignition function: a distributorless ignition
system with individual ignition coils for
each cylinder is employed. The coils are
mounted over the spark plugs and
connect to the plugs via a short lead.
The Siemens systems use multiple spark
ignition to reduce emissions and extend
spark plug life.
Knock control. Knock (detonation)
sensors monitor and control potentially
damaging ignition knock through the
ECM. The knock sensors function like
microphones and are able to convert
mechanical vibration (knock) into
electrical signals. The ECM is
programmed to react to frequencies that
are characteristic of engine knock and
adapt the ignition timing point
accordingly. See
120 Ignition System
for further details.
Note:
M52 TU and M54 engines are designed
to operate best with fuel octane of at
least 91 anti-knock index (AKI). The
adaptive engine management system,
however, will allow use of fuel rated 87
AKI.
Siemens DME MS 42.0
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
18 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Siemens DME MS 43.0
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
19 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:58 PM
Engine-General
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
100-2
Driveability
Troubleshooting
The Siemens systems are
sophisticated self-diagnosing OBD II
systems. These systems continuously
monitor components and record and
store valuable diagnostic information.
If the `Check Engine' or `Service
Engine Soon' light [also known as the
malfunction indicator lamp (MIL)] is
illuminated, the first diagnostic test
should be to hook up a
BMW-compatible scan tool and check
the fault memory.
The powerful diagnostic capabilities of
these systems have the potential to
save hours of diagnostic time, incorrect
component replacement and possible
damage to system components. See
OBD On Board Diagnostics at the
back of this manual.
Two of the most common causes of
driveability problems are system
voltage levels and poor grounds.
System voltage
The DME system requires that the
system (battery) voltage be maintained
within a narrow range. Voltage levels
outside the operating range can cause
havoc. When troubleshooting an
illuminated MIL, make sure the battery
is fully charged and capable of
delivering all its power to the electrical
system.
To make a quick check of the battery
charge, measure the voltage across the
battery terminals with all cables
attached and the ignition off. A fully
charged battery will measure 12.6 volts
or slightly more, compared to 12.15
2/25/2009 9:59 PM
Engine-General
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
volts for a battery with a 25% charge.
Even a fully charged battery cannot
deliver power unless it is properly
connected to the electrical system.
Check the battery terminals for
corrosion or loose cable connections. If
the battery does not maintain the
proper voltage, the charging system
may be at fault. See
121 Battery,
Alternator, Starter.
If a battery cable connection has no
visible faults, but is still suspect,
measure the voltage drop across the
connection. A large drop indicates
excessive resistance, indicating that the
connection is corroded, dirty, or
damaged. Clean or repair the
connection and retest.
Note:
For instructions on conducting a voltage
drop test and other general electrical
troubleshooting information, see
600
Electrical System–General.
The DME system operates at low
voltage and current levels, making it
sensitive to small increases in
resistance. The electrical system is
routinely subjected to corrosion,
vibration and wear, so faults or
corrosion in the wiring harness and
connectors are not uncommon.
Visually inspect all wiring, connectors,
switches and fuses in the system.
Loose or damaged connectors can
cause intermittent problems, especially
the small terminals in the ECM
connectors. Disconnect the wiring
harness connectors to check for
corrosion, and use electrical cleaning
spray to remove contaminants.
Main grounds
2/25/2009 9:59 PM
Engine-General
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Good grounds are critical to proper
DME operation. If a ground connection
has no visible faults but is still suspect,
measure the voltage drop across the
connection. A large voltage drop
indicates high resistance, indicating
that the connection is corroded, dirty or
damaged. Clean or repair the
connection and retest.
Note:
For instructions on conducting a voltage
drop test and other general electrical
troubleshooting information, see
600
Electrical System–General.
Below is a listing of the main grounds
for the fuel and ignition circuits of the
DME system.
Main ground (arrow) for engine
management system in left rear of
engine compartment on bulkhead
behind E-box.
Main grounds for ignition coils
(arrows).
Main chassis ground harness
connection (arrow) in left front of
2/25/2009 9:59 PM
Engine-General
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
engine compartment, behind left
headlight assembly (headlight
assembly shown removed).
Main fuel pump ground (arrow) behind
right rear seat back rest.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:59 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
1 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
110-2
Engine Removal and
Installation
Be sure to cover all painted surfaces
before beginning the removal
procedure. As an aid to installation,
label all components, wires and hoses
before removing them. Do not reuse
gaskets, O-rings or seals during
reassembly.
WARNING!
Due to risk of personal injury, be
sure the engine is cold before
beginning the removal procedure.
-
Remove engine hood or place
hood in service position. See
410 Fenders, Engine Hood.
Note:
It is not necessary to remove the engine
hood, but it is helpful and will make
engine removal and installation easier.
Intake manifold, removing and
installing
Note:
The intake manifold must be removed
to facilitate engine assembly removal.
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable in luggage compartment.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
2 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom cover
(A) and remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove intake manifold cover:
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
Remove cover hold down bolts
and lift off cover.
Working above engine, detach the
following:
A Positive engine lead at B+
terminal
B Manifold vacuum line
C Oxygen sensor connectors
D Electrical harness connector for
intake air temperature sensor
E Positive lead hold-down bracket
F Resonance valve electrical
connector
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
3 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
If oxygen sensor harness connectors
are separated, be sure to mark them
so that they can be reassembled as
before.
Working at left rear of engine
compartment:
Peel rubber edge seal off top of
panel.
Twist plastic panel retainers
(arrows) 90° and pull out to
remove.
Disengage panel from hoses and
wiring harnesses and remove from
engine compartment.
Separate brake booster vacuum
hose at one way valve (A). Plug
hose ends.
Detach engine vent hose from cylinder
head cover by squeezing sides of
spring clip (arrows). Detach VANOS
solenoid electrical harness connector
(A).
Detach fuel injector electrical
connectors from injectors:
Use small screwdriver to pry one
corner of wire lock clip on fuel
injector 1 connector.
Repeat for all injectors.
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
4 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Lift off connector loom and lay
aside.
Remove complete air filter housing:
Detach vacuum line at intake boot
(A).
Disconnect electrical harness
connector on mass air flow sensor
(B).
Release mass air flow sensor clips
(C).
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (D).
Detach air duct connection (E)
and lift complete air filter housing
out of engine compartment,
pulling it forward away from mass
air flow sensor.
Note:
In this step, mass air flow sensor
remains attached to rubber air duct.
Loosen clamps 2 and 8 and remove
mass air flow sensor and air ducts.
1 - Throttle assembly
2 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
3 - Y-duct
4 - Air duct
5 - Hose clamp 83 - 90 mm
6 - Mass air flow sensor
7 - Idle control valve
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
5 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
8 - Hose clamp 28 - 33 mm
9 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
Where applicable: Pull throttle cable
upwards out of rubber retainer (A) and
unhook ball end of cable (B) from
throttle actuator.
Note:
Models equipped with M54 engines do
not use a throttle cable mounted to
throttle housing.
Remove nuts and bolt (arrows)
retaining wiring harness conduit to
throttle body.
Working at throttle housing: Turn
harness plug (arrow) counterclockwise
and remove.
Disconnect electrical harness
connector at idle speed control valve
(arrow).
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
6 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Detach electrical harness connector at
fuel tank venting valve (A). Disconnect
hose at quick disconnect fitting
(arrow).
Remove dipstick guide tube:
Detach wiring harness brackets
from tube (A).
Detach fuel lines from tube (B).
Remove lower guide tube
mounting bolt (C). Pull out dip
stick guide tube.
Remove schræder valve cap (arrow)
from air connection on fuel rail. Using a
tire chuck, blow fuel back through feed
line using a brief burst of compressed
air (maximum of 3 bar or 43.5 psi).
WARNING!
Fuel in fuel line is under
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
7 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
pressure (approx. 3 - 5 bar or 45
- 75 psi) and may be expelled
under pressure. Do not smoke or
work near heaters or other fire
hazards. Keep a fire
extinguisher handy. Before
disconnecting fuel hoses, wrap
a cloth around fuel hoses to
absorb any leaking fuel. Catch
and dispose of escaped fuel.
Plug all open fuel lines.
Always unscrew the fuel tank
cap to release pressure in the
tank before working on the tank
or lines.
-
Raise car and support in a safe
manner.
CAUTION!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove protective engine splash
guard.
Working beneath car (on left side
under driver seat), remove fuel filter
cover and clamp fuel hose(s).
Detach fuel hose(s) from fuel line(s)
(arrows) using special fuel line
removal tool 16 1 050 or equivalent.
Seal off fuel line(s) with BMW special
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
8 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
tools 13 5 281/13 5 282.
CAUTION!
Fuel may be expelled under
pressure. Do not smoke or work near
heaters or other fire hazards. Keep a
fire extinguisher handy. Before
disconnecting fuel hoses, wrap a
cloth around fuel hoses to absorb
any leaking fuel. Plug all open fuel
lines.
Working underneath car, remove lower
intake manifold support mounting bolt
(arrow), located adjacent to left engine
mount.
Remove fuel rail mounting bolts
(arrows).
Carefully pry fuel rail off manifold.
Separate fuel line support bracket
at rear of intake manifold.
Thread fuel line(s) out of rear of
engine compartment while lifting
fuel rail out.
Remove manifold mounting nuts
(arrows).
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
9 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Lift up manifold just enough to detach
positive cables from starter motor
terminal 50 (arrow).
-
Remove intake manifold from
cylinder head while carefully
checking for electrical connections
or hoses.
CAUTION!
Stuff clean rags into open intake
ports to prevent any parts from
falling into the engine intake.
-
Intake manifold Installation is
reverse of removal.
Use new fuel injector seals.
Carefully check intake manifold
gasket and replace if necessary.
Inspect O-ring seal between mass
air flow sensor and air filter
housing. To facilitate reassembly,
coat seal with acid-free grease.
nothing
CAUTION!
When reattaching throttle assembly
harness connector, connector is fully
tightened when arrows on connector
and plug line up.
Tightening torques
Intake manifold to cylinder head
M7
15 Nm (11 ft-lb)
M8
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
10 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Engine assembly, removing
and installing
Note:
The intake manifold must be removed
as described earlier to facilitate engine
assembly removal.
Remove cylinder head top cover:
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
Remove cover hold down bolts
and lift off cover.
Drain engine coolant and remove
coolant hoses.
Remove expansion tank cap on
radiator.
Place a 3-gallon pail beneath
engine to capture coolant.
Remove coolant drain plug
located on exhaust side of cylinder
2 of engine block (arrow).
Drain radiator into a 3-gallon pail by
removing plastic drain plug completely
(arrow).
WARNING!
Use extreme caution when draining
and disposing of engine coolant.
Coolant is poisonous and lethal to
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
11 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
humans and pets. Pets are attracted
to coolant because of its sweet smell
and taste. Consult a veterinarian
immediately if coolant is ingested by
an animal.
Note:
Catch and dispose of drained coolant
according to local, state, and federal
laws.
Remove hoses from thermostat
housing by releasing locks (arrows).
On vehicles equipped with automatic
transmissions: Remove radiator cooling
170
fan and radiator as described in
Radiator and Cooling System.
CAUTION!
32 mm radiator fan mounting nut has
left hand threads.
Detach coolant hose at rear left side of
engine above starter by releasing lock
(arrow).
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
12 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Detach coolant hose at front left side of
engine by engine mount by releasing
lock (arrow).
-
Unbolt power steering fluid
reservoir and pull aside without
detaching hoses. Tie to fender
with cord or stiff wire.
Working at E-box at left rear of engine
compartment:
Detach engine electrical harness
connectors (arrows).
Lift off harness looms and lay over
engine.
-
Remove poly-ribbed drive belts.
Mark belt direction of rotation if
020
belts will be reused. See
Maintenance.
-
All wheel drive models: Remove
front axle differential and output
311
shaft bearing pedestal. See
Front Axle Final Drive.
-
Remove transmission from car.
See
230 Manual Transmission
or
240 Automatic Transmission.
Note:
Detach automatic transmission cooler
lines from radiator, remove brackets
holding lines to side of engine, and
store lines in a clean environment.
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
13 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove power steering pump:
Remove steering pump pulley.
Remove front and rear pump
mounting bolts (arrows).
Hang pump from body using stiff
wire.
Remove A/C compressor mounting
bolts (arrows) and A/C compressor
from its mounting bracket without
disconnecting, distorting, or deforming
any refrigerant lines. Hang from body
using stiff wire.
-
Remove windshield and headlight
washer reservoir:
Remove bolt on top of reservoir.
Lift tank and disconnect electrical
connections to pump and to
washer fluid level sensor.
Disconnect hoses to windshield
washer and headlight washer. Tilt
reservoir to prevent fluid from
leaking out.
Remove secondary air pump:
Remove hose at one-way valve
(A).
Remove bolts at support bracket
on strut tower (arrows).
Disconnect electrical harness from
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
14 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
bottom of secondary air pump.
Remove bracket from strut tower.
Separate oxygen sensor electrical
harness connectors (arrows) and
mounting clip (A) on right side of
engine.
Remove chassis ground strap (arrow)
at right engine mounting pedestal.
Install an engine lifting device (BMW 11
0 000 or equivalent) to the front and
rear engine supports and raise engine
until its weight is supported. Detach left
and right engine mounts.
-
Carefully raise engine out of car,
checking for any wiring, fuel lines,
or mechanical parts that might
become snagged as engine is
removed.
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
15 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
When reinstalling, make sure locating
pin on left engine mount (arrow) seats
correctly in slot of subframe boss.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Replace all gaskets, O-rings and
seals.
Change engine oil and filter and
check all other fluid levels. See
020 Maintenance.
Refill and bleed cooling system.
See
170 Radiator and Cooling
System.
Use new fuel injector seals.
Carefully check intake manifold
gasket and replace if necessary.
Inspect O-ring seal between mass
air flow sensor and air filter
housing. To facilitate reassembly,
coat seal with acid-free grease.
CAUTION!
When reattaching throttle assembly
harness connector, connector is fully
tightened when arrows on connector
and plug line up.
Check that engine drive belts
properly engage pulley grooves.
Install exhaust manifolds using
new gaskets and self-locking nuts.
Use copper paste on threads.
See
180 Exhaust System.
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Engine Removal and Installation
16 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
Coolant drain plug
to cylinder block
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Engine mount to subframe
M10
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Exhaust manifold to cylinder head
M6
M7 or M8
10 Nm (8 ft-lb)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Intake manifold to cylinder head
M7
15 Nm (11 ft-lb)
M8
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Radiator cooling
fan to coolant
pump
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Radiator drain
screw to radiator
2.5 Nm (22 in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:36 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
113-1
General
This group covers E46 cylinder head
removal and installation as well as
cylinder head/valve diagnosis
procedures.
The information given in this repair
group assumes that the engine is
installed in the engine bay. In order to
remove the cylinder head from the
engine block, the VANOS control unit
and the camshafts must be removed
from the cylinder head. For cylinder
head and valvetrain reconditioning
information, see
116 Cylinder Head
and Valvetrain.
Note:
If a head gasket problem is suspected,
a compression test or leak-down test
will usually detect the fault. See
Diagnostic Testing later in this group.
Special tools
Special BMW service tools are required
to properly remove and install the
cylinder head on engines covered by
this manual. The special tools are used
to time the valvetrain to the crankshaft,
to remove the VANOS control unit, the
camshafts and the Torx (E12) head
bolts. Read the entire procedure
through before beginning the job.
Rotary angle dial gauge BMW special
tool 00 9 120
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Torque wrench w/ flex extension BMW
special tool 00 9 250
E-12 Torx socket BMW special tool 11
2 250
Crankshaft locking tool BMW special
tool 11 2 300
Camshaft locking tool BMW special
tool 11 3 240
Camshaft locking tool bracket BMW
special tool 11 3 244
Lifter retaining suction cup BMW
special tool 11 3 250
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Camshaft bearing cap removal tool
BMW special tool 11 3 260 /11 3 270
Timing chain tensioner tool BMW
special tool 11 4 220
VANOS adjustment plate BMW special
tool 11 6 150
Secondary sprocket setup tool BMW
special tool 11 6 180
Air line adapter BMW special tool 11 3
450
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Secondary chain tensioner lock pin
BMW special tool 11 3 292
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
1 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
113-2
Cylinder Head Removal
WARNING!
Due to risk of personal injury, be
sure the engine is cold before
beginning the removal procedure.
Cylinder head removal and installation
is a complicated repair procedure.
VANOS control unit, timing chain, and
camshaft removal and installation all
require special tools. Read the entire
procedure before beginning the repair.
CAUTION!
Cover all painted surfaces before
beginning the removal procedure. As
an aid to installation, label all
components, wires, and hoses
before removing them. Do not reuse
gaskets, O-rings or seals during
reassembly.
To assist the technician in this repair,
the procedure has been organized into
discrete jobs. Please be advised that
these individual jobs must be
accomplished in the order in which
they appear.
Intake manifold, removing
Cylinder head cover, removing
VANOS control unit, removing
Camshafts and valvetrain, removing
Cylinder head assembly, removing
Intake manifold, removing
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable in trunk.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
2 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Disconnecting the battery may
erase fault code(s) stored in
control module memory. Check
for fault codes using special
BMW diagnostic equipment.
Remove microfilter for interior
ventilation.
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom cover
(A) and remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove intake manifold cover:
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
3 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove cover hold down bolts
from intake cover and lift off cover.
Working above engine, disconnect the
following:
A Positive engine lead at B+
terminal
B Manifold vacuum line
C Oxygen sensor connectors
(label connectors before
disconnecting)
D Electrical harness connector for
intake air temperature sensor
E Positive lead hold-down bracket
F Intake manifold resonance valve
electrical connector
Working at left rear of engine
compartment:
Peel rubber edge seal off top of
panel.
Separate brake booster vacuum
hose at intake jet pump (A). Plug
hose ends.
Twist plastic panel retainers
(arrows) 90° and pull out to
remove.
Disengage panel from hoses and
wiring harnesses and remove from
engine compartment.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
4 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Disconnect engine vent hose from
cylinder head cover by squeezing sides
of spring clip (arrows). Disconnect
VANOS solenoid electrical harness
connector (A).
Disconnect fuel injector electrical
connectors from injectors:
Use small screwdriver to pry one
corner of wire lock clip on fuel
injector 1 connector.
Repeat for all injectors.
Lift off connector loom and lay
aside.
Remove complete air filter housing:
Disconnect vacuum line at intake
boot (A).
Disconnect electrical harness
connector on mass air flow sensor
(B).
Release mass air flow sensor clips
(C).
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (D).
Disconnect air duct connection (E)
and lift complete air filter housing
out of engine compartment,
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
5 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
pulling it forward away from mass
air flow sensor.
Note:
In this step, mass air flow sensor
remains attached to rubber air duct.
Loosen clamps 2 and 8 and remove
mass air flow sensor and air duct.
1 - Throttle assembly
2 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
3 - Y-duct
4 - Air duct
5 - Hose clamp 83 - 90 mm
6 - Mass air flow sensor
7 - Idle control valve
8 - Hose clamp 28 - 33 mm
9 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
Where applicable: Pull throttle cable
upwards out of rubber retainer (A) and
unhook ball end of cable (B) from
throttle actuator.
Note:
Models with M54 engines do not use a
throttle cable.
Remove nuts and bolt (arrows)
retaining wiring harness conduit to
throttle body.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
6 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Working at throttle housing:
Turn harness plug (arrow)
counterclockwise and remove.
Disconnect electrical harness
connector at idle speed control valve
(arrow) directly above throttle housing.
Working under front corner of intake
manifold, disconnect electrical harness
connector at fuel tank venting valve
(A). Disconnect vent hose at quick
disconnect fitting (arrow).
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
7 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove dipstick guide tube:
Disconnect wiring harness
brackets from tube (A).
Disconnect fuel lines from
retaining clips (B).
Remove lower dip stick guide tube
mounting bolt (C). Pull out guide
tube.
Remove schræder valve cap (arrow).
Using a tire chuck, blow fuel back
through feed line using a brief burst of
compressed air (maximum of 3 bar or
43.5 psi).
WARNING!
Fuel in fuel line is under
pressure (approx. 3 - 5 bar or 45
-75 psi) and may be expelled
under pressure. Do not smoke or
work near heaters or other fire
hazards. Keep a fire
extinguisher handy. Before
disconnecting fuel hoses, wrap
a cloth around fuel hoses to
absorb any leaking fuel. Catch
and dispose of escaped fuel.
Plug all open fuel lines.
Always unscrew fuel tank cap to
release pressure in the tank
before working on the tank or
lines.
-
Raise car and support in a safe
manner.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
8 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove protective engine splash
guard from beneath engine
compartment.
Working beneath car (on left side
under driver seat), remove fuel filter
cover and clamp off fuel hose(s)
(arrows).
Note:
M54 engines equipped with a non-return
fuel rail use only a single supply line.
Disconnect fuel hose(s) from fuel
line(s) (arrows) using special fuel line
removal tool 16 1 050 or equivalent.
Plug open fuel line(s) with BMW
special tools 13 5 281/13 5 282.
Working underneath car, remove lower
intake manifold support mounting bolt
(arrow), located adjacent to left
(driver's side) engine mount.
Remove fuel rail mounting bolts
(arrows).
Carefully pry fuel rail off manifold.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
9 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Separate fuel line support bracket
at rear of intake manifold.
Thread fuel line(s) out of rear of
engine compartment while lifting
fuel rail out.
Remove intake manifold mounting nuts
(arrows).
Lift up manifold enough to disconnect
positive cables from starter motor
terminal (arrow).
Remove intake manifold from
cylinder head while carefully
checking for any remaining
electrical connections or hoses.
CAUTION!
Stuff clean lint free rags into open
intake ports to prevent any foreign
matter from falling into the ports.
Drain engine coolant from engine
block:
Remove expansion tank cap on
radiator.
Place 3-gallon pail beneath
engine to capture coolant.
Remove coolant drain plug
located on exhaust side of cylinder
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
10 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
2 of engine block (arrow).
Drain radiator into a 3-gallon pail by
removing plastic drain plug at lower left
end of radiator (arrow).
WARNING!
Use caution when draining and
disposing of engine coolant. Coolant
is poisonous and lethal to humans
and pets. Pets are attracted to
coolant because of its sweet smell
and taste. Consult a veterinarian if
coolant is ingested by an animal.
Dispose of drained coolant
according to local, state, and federal
laws.
Remove hoses from thermostat
housing by releasing locks (arrows).
-
Disconnect electrical harness at
thermostat housing.
-
Remove radiator cooling fan and
shroud as described in
170
Radiator and Cooling System
CAUTION!
On cars with viscous clutch cooling
fan, radiator fan mounting nut (32
mm) has left-hand threads.
Remove fasteners (arrows) from heater
bypass tube and set tube to side
leaving heater hose connected.
-
Unbolt power steering fluid
reservoir and pull aside without
disconnecting hoses. Tie to fender
with cord or stiff wire.
-
Remove windshield and headlight
washer reservoir:
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
11 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove bolt on top of reservoir.
Lift tank and disconnect electrical
connections to pump and to
washer fluid level sensor.
Disconnect hoses to windshield
washer and headlight washer. Tilt
reservoir to prevent fluid from
leaking out.
Remove secondary air pump:
Disconnect hose at one-way valve
(A).
Remove bolts at support bracket
on strut tower (arrows).
Lift up pump and disconnect
electrical harness from bottom of
pump. Remove pump.
Unbolt and remove pump bracket
from strut tower.
Cylinder head cover, removing
Remove cylinder head top cover:
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
Remove cover hold down nuts and
lift off cover.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
12 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove ignition coils.
Disconnect ignition coil harness
connectors.
Remove coil mounting fasteners.
Remove coils.
Remove ground straps.
Set coil harness to left side of
engine compartment.
-
Remove cylinder head cover
mounting fasteners and remove
cylinder head cover.
Note:
The cylinder head cover mounting bolt
insulators and gaskets should be
reinstalled in their original locations.
The three grounds mount to the first,
second and fourth central studs. Make
note of their arrangement during
removal.
-
Remove spark plugs.
CAUTION!
Stuff clean lint free rags into open
intake ports to prevent any foreign
matter from falling into the ports.
Remove oil baffle cover from above
intake camshaft.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
13 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Double VANOS
components (M52
TU, M54 engine)
1
- Impulse wheel
mounting nut
2
- Exhaust
camshaft
impulse wheel
3
- Spring plate
4
- Thrust spacer (T
= 3.5 mm)
5
- Splined shaft
6
- Torx screw
7
- Exhaust
secondary
sprocket
8
- Secondary
timing chain
9
- Splined sleeve
10 - Primary
sprocket
11 - Threaded
locating stud
12 - Secondary
chain tensioner
13 - Secondary
chain lower
guide
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
14 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
14 - Sprocket
mounting nut
15 - Spring plate
16 - Splined shaft
17 - Intake camshaft
sprocket
18 - Locating stud
19 - Thrust spacer
20 - Intake camshaft
impulse wheel
21 - Chain tensioner
rail
22 - Crankshaft
sprocket
23 - Primary chain
tensioner
24 - Primary chain
25 - Locating stud
26 - Guide rail
27 - Locating stud
28 - Woodruff key
VANOS control unit, removing
Disconnect electrical connections at
exhaust camshaft position sensor and
exhaust camshaft VANOS control valve
(arrows).
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
15 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove banjo bolt from VANOS unit oil
pressure line. Use banjo bolt to attach
BMW special tool 11 3 450 (compressed
air fitting) to VANOS control unit.
Cover oil hole (arrow) in VANOS unit
with shop towel to capture oil which will
spray when compressed air is applied.
-
Connect compressed air line to air
fitting. Apply air pressure set to 2 8 bar (30 - 110 psi).
With compressed air line connected,
rotate engine in direction of rotation
(clockwise) until cylinder 1 intake and
exhaust camshaft lobes face each other
(arrows) in the top dead center (TDC)
position for cylinder 1.
-
Rotate engine at least twice, leaving
the cylinder 1 intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes facing each other,
as shown.
CAUTION!
Do not rotate engine counterclockwise
to reach the top dead center position.
Instead, complete another two
complete rotations.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
16 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove sealing plug from special tool
bore on lower left side of engine block
near flywheel. Secure crankshaft in TDC
position with BMW special tool 11 2 300
(arrow).
Unscrew and remove two cylinder head
cover studs (arrows) at rear of cylinder
head.
Secure camshafts in TDC position using
BMW special tools 11 3 240 and 11 3
244.
-
Disconnect compressed air line,
leaving compressed air fitting
attached to VANOS unit.
CAUTION!
Oil will drain from pressure line. Have
a drain container and rags ready. Do
not allow oil to run onto drive belts.
Unscrew sealing plugs (arrows) from
VANOS unit.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
17 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Oil will drain from plugs (arrows) when
removed. Have a container and rags
ready. Do not allow oil to run onto drive
belts.
Pull sealing caps straight out of VANOS
unit with BMW special tool 11 6 170, or
with short nose pliers.
Note:
Additional oil may drain from VANOS
unit.
Remove set screws (left-hand thread) on
ends of intake and exhaust camshafts.
CAUTION!
Set screws have left hand threads.
Remove in clockwise motion.
Remove VANOS unit:
Remove engine support eye
fasteners from side of VANOS unit.
Remove VANOS mounting nuts
(arrows) from cylinder head and
pull VANOS unit and metal gasket
off.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
18 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Do not crank the engine with VANOS
unit removed. The splined shaft on
the intake camshaft might slip out of
the VANOS spline teeth, causing the
intake cam to no longer be positively
connected to the timing chain,
allowing for possible piston/valve
interference.
Note:
The VANOS unit will contain a small
quantity of oil. Place shop towels to catch
oil as unit is removed or tilted.
CAUTION!
If the VANOS adjustment unit is
replaced, or if operations are
completed that may change the timing
of the camshafts, the camshaft timing
must be checked as described later in
this chapter.
Camshafts and valvetrain,
removing
Remove primary camshaft chain
tensioner cylinder (arrow).
CAUTION!
Primary camshaft chain tensioning
piston is under spring pressure.
Press down on secondary chain
tensioner and lock into place using BMW
special tool 11 3 292 or a similar size pin.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
19 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove exhaust camshaft impulse
wheel mounting nuts (arrows). Remove
impulse wheel (A).
Remove spring plate (A).
Remove intake camshaft sprocket
mounting nuts (arrows) and remove
spring plate (labelled FRONT).
Remove torx screws from exhaust
camshaft sprocket (arrows).
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
20 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Lift off exhaust and intake sprockets
together with secondary chain, thrust
spacer (A) from exhaust camshaft, and
splined shaft (B) from intake camshaft.
CAUTION!
Splined shafts share the same part
number for both intake and exhaust
camshafts. Remove and mark used
splined shafts in order and reinstall in
original locations.
Remove exhaust camshaft splined
sleeve (A) and shaft (B).
Remove secondary chain tensioner
mounting bolts (arrows). Remove
tensioner from between camshafts while
keeping retaining pin in place.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
21 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove primary chain sprocket
mounting studs (arrows) on exhaust
camshaft.
Lift primary chain sprocket off exhaust
camshaft. Remove sprocket from chain.
Place timing chain on end of exhaust
camshaft.
Remove locating studs (arrows) from
intake camshaft. Lift off intake camshaft
thrust spacer (A) and impulse wheel (B).
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
22 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Do not remove end spline retaining
screws from camshafts (arrows).
Remove cylinder head cover mounting
studs (arrows) from center of cylinder
head.
-
Remove flywheel locking tool from
transmission bellhousing so that
crankshaft is no longer secured.
Lift primary chain and hold under
tension, then rotate engine against
direction of rotation (counterclockwise)
approximately 30°.
CAUTION!
To prevent damaging valves while
working on camshafts, no pistons
should be in the TDC position.
-
Remove BMW special tools 11 3
240 and 11 3 244 from rear of
cylinder head.
Remove retaining nuts (arrows) and
bearing cap 1 of intake camshaft.
CAUTION!
Intake camshaft bearing cap 1 is
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
23 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
centered with adapter sleeves. To
avoid camshaft damage, it must be
removed before any other caps.
Fit BMW special tools 11 3 260 (A) and
11 3 270 (B) to cylinder head and screw
long bolts (arrows) into spark plug
threads. Tensioners will align with the
bearing caps on the intake camshaft.
CAUTION!
Do not over torque bolts into spark
plug holes.
Turn eccentric shaft of special tool to
pretension intake camshaft bearing
caps. Remove nuts on remaining
bearing caps.
-
Release tension on eccentric shaft
and remove BMW special tools 11 3
260 and 11 3 270. Remove bearing
caps and set aside in order.
Remove camshaft and store safely.
-
Repeat procedure for exhaust
camshaft.
Secure hydraulic lifters in lifter bores
using BMW special tool 11 3 250, or
remove lifters using a magnetic pick-up
tool. With lifters secure or removed, lift
out camshaft bearing carriers from
cylinder head.
CAUTION!
Do not let the hydraulic lifters fall
out as the camshaft carrier is
removed.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
24 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Hydraulic lifters should be stored
in an upright position.
Used hydraulic lifters must be
replaced into original lifter bores.
Cylinder head assembly,
removing
-
Remove exhaust manifolds. See
180 Exhaust System.
Remove intake camshaft position sensor
(arrow) from side of cylinder head.
Remove secondary chain lower guide
bolts (arrows). Remove chain guide.
The bolt on the intake camshaft side is a
long bolt that extends into the lower
timing chain cover.
Remove screws (arrows) holding lower
timing chain cover to cylinder head.
(Photo shows camshafts in place).
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
25 of 25
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Using BMW special tool 11 2 250 or
equivalent, loosen cylinder head bolts in
several stages in sequence shown.
Discard head bolts.
Note:
BMW special tool 11 2 250 is a
thin-walled Torx E12 socket with an
extended reach. The cylinder head bolts
are recessed into the head below the
camshaft towers with little working space.
-
Lift off cylinder head. Refer to
116 Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
to evaluate the head.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:39 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
1 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
113-3
Cylinder Head
Installation
Clean cylinder head and gasket
surfaces of cylinder block and all
timing chain covers.
Remove foreign matter and liquid from
bolt holes.
CAUTION!
Do not use a metal scraper or wire
brush to clean the aluminum cylinder
head or pistons. If necessary, use a
hard wooden or plastic scraper. Also
available are abrasive discs to be
used in conjunction with an electric
drill. Be sure to use the correct disc
for the type of metal being cleaned.
Evaluate cylinder head as shown in
116 Cylinder Head and Valvetrain.
Note:
If the cylinder head has been
machined, a special 0.3 mm
(0.011 in.) thicker gasket should
be installed. The thicker gasket is
available from an authorized BMW
dealer.
Cylinder head and valve
specifications are covered in
116 Cylinder Head and Valvetrain.
Lubricate camshafts, camshaft carriers,
bearing caps, hydraulic lifters, friction
washers, splined shafts and spline
hubs with assembly lubricant before
installation.
To assist the technician in cylinder
head installation, the procedure has
been organized as separate
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
2 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
operations. Please be advised that
these individual jobs must be
accomplished in the order in which
they appear.
Cylinder head assembly, installing
Camshafts and valvetrain, installing
VANOS control unit, installing
Cylinder head cover, manifolds,
cooling system, installing
Cylinder head assembly,
installing
Check that two cylinder head locating
aligning sleeves (arrows) are correctly
positioned in block and are not
damaged.
-
Apply permanently elastic sealing
compound 3 Bond® 1209 to joints
with timing belt cover.
-
Place new cylinder head gasket
on cylinder block.
Note:
The word OBEN, printed on the gasket,
should face up. The cylinder head
gasket will fit correctly in only one
orientation.
-
Set cylinder head in position,
guiding primary chain through
cylinder head opening.
CAUTION!
Make sure the crankshaft, which had
been rotated approximately 30°
opposite the direction of engine
rotation from TDC, is still in that
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
3 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
position before lowering the cylinder
head into position. All pistons must
be out of TDC position to prevent
valve/piston interference when the
camshafts are installed.
-
Lightly lubricate new cylinder
head bolts. Install bolts and
washers finger tight. Install
cylinder head-to-lower timing
chain cover bolts finger tight.
Note:
Cylinder head bolts should not be
reused. They are stretch-type bolts
and must always be replaced
whenever loosened.
Check that all washers for the
head bolts are in place before
installing the bolts. Some of the
washers may be staked to the
cylinder head.
Tighten cylinder head bolts in correct
sequence (1-14).
CAUTION!
The bolts should be tightened in
three stages as listed below. The
final stages require the use of a BMW
special tool 11 2 110 or a suitable
protractor to tighten the bolts to a
specified torque angle.
-
Secure cylinder head bolts by
torquing an additional 90° each for
Stage 2 and 3.
Tightening torques
Cylinder head to engine block
(Torx E12 M10 bolts)
Stage 1
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
4 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
Stage 2
+90°
Stage 3
+90°
Install intake camshaft position sensor
(arrow).
-
Install exhaust manifolds. See 180
Exhaust System.
Install lower secondary chain guide.
Tighten Torx bolts (arrows) to
specifications. The bolt on the intake
camshaft side is long and extends into
the engine block.
Tightening torque
Secondary chain
guide to cylinder
head
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Install and tighten cylinder
head-to-lower timing chain cover bolts
(arrows). (Photo shows camshafts in
place)
Camshafts and valvetrain,
installing
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
5 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
A minimum waiting time is required
for the hydraulic lifters to "bleed
down" after installing the camshafts
into the cylinder head, but before
synchronizing the crankshaft and
valve train timing. When the
camshafts are removed, the
hydraulic lifters can expand. This
expansion can cause increased valve
lift when the camshafts are bolted
down, possibly resulting in piston
interference.
Before installing camshaft carriers,
examine bearing points (arrows) on
hydraulic lifter bores for signs of wear.
Install camshaft carriers with hydraulic
lifters into cylinder head. Note marks
on carriers: (E) for intake side and (A)
for exhaust side.
Center camshaft carrier on pins
(arrows) at bearing positions 2 and 7.
-
Lift timing chain and place
exhaust camshaft onto exhaust
camshaft carrier. Place intake
camshaft on intake camshaft
carrier.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
6 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Rotate camshafts so that intake and
exhaust lobes for cylinder 1 face each
other (arrows).
CAUTION!
Be sure that crankshaft is still
positioned at least 30° back from
TDC.
-
Place bearing caps on cams, but
do not install retaining nuts.
Fit BMW special tools 11 3 260 (A) and
11 3 270 (B) to cylinder head over
intake camshaft and screw long bolts
(arrows) into spark plug threads.
CAUTION!
Do not overtighten bolts into spark
plug holes.
Turn eccentric shaft of special tool to
pretension bearing caps. Install and
torque nuts on intake camshaft bearing
caps.
Tightening torque
Camshaft bearing
cap to cylinder
head (M7)
-
14 Nm (10 ft-lb)
Release tension on eccentric shaft
and remove BMW special tool 11 3
260/270.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
7 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Repeat procedure for exhaust
camshaft.
Note:
Before the next step, observe waiting
time for lifter bleed down before
continuing with camshaft installation.
Crankshaft / valve timing waiting
times
68°F (20°C) and
higher
4 minutes
50 - 68°F (10 20°C)
11 minutes
32 - 50°F (0 10°C)
30 minutes
Secure camshafts in TDC position
using BMW special tools 11 3 240 and
11 3 244.
If necessary, turn camshaft so that
special tools are squarely seated on
cylinder head.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
8 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Lift timing chain and hold under
tension.
While maintaining tension on timing
chain, rotate crankshaft from 30°
before TDC in direction of rotation up to
cylinder 1 TDC position (0|T on front
pulley lined up with pointer on lower
timing chain cover).
Secure crankshaft in TDC position with
BMW special tool 11 2 300 (arrow).
Slide impulse wheel on intake
camshaft, aligning boss with raised
portion on camshaft (arrow).
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
9 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Fit thrust spacer to intake camshaft
and tighten down with threaded
locating studs (place longer threaded
portion of studs into camshaft).
Tightening torque
Impulse wheel
studs to intake
camshaft (M7)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Fit top sprocket to primary timing chain
and install on exhaust camshaft so that
pointer on sprocket (arrow) lines up
with cylinder head sealing surface.
Insert BMW special tool 11 4 220 into
timing chain tensioning piston bore and
bring adjustment screw into contact
with tensioning rail, but do not
pretension timing chain.
Note:
BMW special tool 11 4 220 is a dummy
primary chain tensioner and simulates
the function of the tensioner.
-
Recheck that arrow on top primary
sprocket is aligned with upper
edge of cylinder head. Reposition
sprocket if necessary.
Insert and tighten down threaded
locating studs (arrows) in end of
exhaust camshaft.
Tightening torques
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
10 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
Exhaust camshaft
locating stud
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Install secondary chain tensioner on
cylinder head (arrows). Keep tensioner
compressed using BMW special tool 11
3 292 or suitable pin.
Fit exhaust camshaft splined sleeve.
Confirm that gap in sleeve splines
aligns with corresponding gap in
camshaft splines (arrows).
Slide splined shaft onto exhaust
camshaft. Be sure that locating tooth of
shaft (arrow) fits into spline gaps of
camshaft and splined sleeve.
Slide splined shaft in further until
three small slots on splined sleeve
are centered on three threaded
holes in primary chain sprocket.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
11 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Place intake and exhaust sprockets in
BMW special tool 11 6 180. Position
spline gap on intake sprocket (arrow)
as shown and place secondary chain
on sprockets.
Remove chain and sprockets from tool
and slide sprockets on camshafts.
Confirm that gap in intake sprocket
splines lines up with corresponding
gap in camshaft splines (arrow).
CAUTION!
Do not alter position of sprockets
with respect to chain when removing
from special tool 11 6 180.
Slide splined shaft onto intake
camshaft until approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.)
of splines (arrows) are visible. Confirm
that locating tooth of shaft fits into
spline gaps on camshaft and sprocket.
Install intake camshaft spring plate so
that FRONT mark is visible. Install
mounting nuts (arrows) finger tight.
Insert sprocket mounting bolts
(arrows) on exhaust side camshaft
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
12 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
assembly.
Initially tighten to approx. 5 Nm
(44 in-lb) and then back off by half
a turn.
Fit thrust spacer (A) on exhaust
camshaft.
Install spring plate (A) to exhaust
camshaft. Make sure that F mark is
visible.
Note:
If F mark is no longer visible, install
spring plate so that convex side points
forward (toward front of car).
Install exhaust camshaft impulse
wheel, aligning pointer (B) with top
edge of cylinder head (A). Install
mounting nuts (arrows) finger tight.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
13 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Pull out exhaust camshaft splined shaft
to stop.
-
Press down on secondary chain
tensioner and remove tensioner
lock-down tool.
Preload primary chain:
Tighten adjusting screw on BMW
special tool 11 4 220 to specified
torque.
Tightening torque
Primary chain
tensioner preload
0.7 Nm (6 in-lb)
Preload exhaust camshaft spring plate
by pressing on impulse wheel while
tightening mounting nuts (arrows)
finger tight.
Install BMW special tool 11 6 150
(VANOS setup bracket) to front of
cylinder head timing case. Install nuts
(arrows) finger tight, then tighten down
uniformly until special tool is in full
contact with cylinder head.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
14 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Make sure all gasket material is
removed from face of cylinder head.
Clean sealing face and keep free of
oil. If any foreign material is present
on the sealing surface, the camshaft
timing will be incorrect.
Secure camshaft sprockets and
impulse wheels:
Tighten mounting screws (A) on
exhaust camshaft impulse wheel
to approx. 5 Nm (44 in-lb).
Tighten mounting nuts (B) on
exhaust and intake sprocket
assemblies to approx. 5 Nm (44
in-lb).
Torque down mounting screws (A)
and nuts (B) to final specifications.
Tightening torques
Sprocket assembly to camshaft
initial torque
5 Nm (44 in-lb)
Sprocket assembly wheel to
camshaft
M7 Torx screws (A)
M6 mounting nut
(B)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
10 Nm (8 ft-lb)
-
Remove flywheel locking tool from
transmission bellhousing so that
crankshaft is no longer secured.
-
Remove camshaft locking tools
from cylinder head.
Turn engine over twice in direction of
rotation until cylinder 1 intake and
exhaust camshaft lobes (arrows) face
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
15 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
each other.
-
Secure crankshaft in TDC position
with BMW special tool 11 2 300.
Place BMW special tool 11 3 240 over
camshafts and measure clearances.
Note:
If the exhaust side of the tool (A) is
not flush with the head, camshaft
timing is incorrect. Reset camshaft
117
timing as described in
Camshaft Timing Chains.
Due to flexible sprocket design,
VANOS unit tolerances and play in
the VANOS splines, when the
camshaft timing is set correctly,
the intake side of special tool 11 3
240 (B) may be up to 1 mm (0.04
in) above the surface of the
cylinder head. This is normal.
Reassemble engine. Otherwise,
reset camshaft timing as described
in
117 Camshaft Timing Chains
-
Remove BMW special tool 11 6
150 from front of cylinder head.
VANOS control unit, installing
Clean contact edges of cylinder head
face and VANOS unit and apply a thin
coat of sealing compound
3-Bond®1209 or equivalent to
surfaces.
CAUTION!
Make sure all gasket material is
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
16 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
removed from face of cylinder
head. Clean sealing face and
keep free of oil. If any foreign
material is present on the
sealing surface, the camshaft
timing will be incorrect.
Check locating dowel (A) and
dowel sleeve (B) at top of
cylinder head for damage or
incorrect installation.
-
Replace steel gasket.
-
Install VANOS unit to front of
cylinder head.
Note:
If Double VANOS control unit is being
replaced, be sure to check and adjust
camshaft timing as described in
117
Camshaft Timing Chains.
-
Reinstall engine support hook.
Tightening torque
VANOS unit to cylinder head
M6 nut
10 Nm (89int-lb)
M7 nut
14 Nm (10 ft-lb)
-
Reconnect electrical harness
connectors to camshaft position
sensors and VANOS solenoid
valves.
Insert and tighten down VANOS
hydraulic piston set screws (arrows) in
splined shafts on intake and exhaust
camshafts.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
17 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Set screws have left hand thread.
Tighten counterclockwise.
Tightening torque
Hydraulic piston to splined shaft
M6 set screw
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Replace sealing caps inside VANOS
unit with BMW special tool 11 6 170, or
short flat nosed pliers.
Insert and secure VANOS sealing
plugs (arrows) with new sealing
O-rings.
Tightening torque
Sealing plug to
VANOS unit
50 Nm (37 ft-lb)
Install coolant pipe fasteners at base of
cylinder head and tighten fasteners
(arrows).
Note:
Use new sealing O-ring on coolant pipe.
-
Install VANOS oil line banjo bolt
with new seals. Attach oil line to
VANOS unit.
Tightening torque
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
18 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torque
Oil line to VANOS
unit (banjo bolt)
-
32 Nm (24 ft-lb)
Remove BMW special tool 11 4
220 and reinstall chain tensioner
cylinder.
Tightening torque
Primary chain
tensioner cylinder
to cylinder head
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
-
Remove flywheel locking tool from
transmission bellhousing. Replace
special tool bore sealing plug.
-
Remove camshaft locking tools
from cylinder head.
Cylinder head cover,
manifolds, cooling system,
installing
Install intake camshaft cover and
cylinder head cover.
Check for correct seating of
half-moon seals (A) in back of
cylinder head cover.
Use a small amount of
3-Bond®1209 or equivalent
sealant at corners (B) of
half-moon cutouts.
Seat gasket and seal corners in
front of cylinder head at VANOS
unit.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
19 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torque
Cylinder head
cover to cylinder
head (M6)
-
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Install exhaust manifolds using
new gaskets and nuts. Coat
manifold studs with copper paste
prior to installing nuts.
Tightening torque
Exhaust manifold
to cylinder head
(M7)
-
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Install electrical harness
connectors for oil pressure sender
and coolant temperature sensor
before installing intake manifold.
Intake manifold Installation is reverse of
removal.
1 - Manifold mounting nuts -tighten to
15 Nm (11 ft-lb)
2 - Fuel pipe bracket
3 - Fuel pipe bracket
4 - Vacuum pump bracket
5 - Manifold mounting bracket
6 - Tank venting valve bracket
7 - Mounting bracket to manifold bolt
(M6) -tighten to 10 Nm (7 ft-lb)
8 - Mounting bracket to cylinder block
nut (M10) -tighten to 47 Nm (33
ft-lb)
Use new fuel injector seals.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
20 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Carefully check intake manifold
gasket and replace if necessary.
Inspect O-ring seal between mass
air flow sensor and air filter
housing. To facilitate reassembly,
coat seal with acid-free grease.
CAUTION!
When reattaching throttle assembly
harness connector, connector is fully
tightened when arrows on connector
and plug line up.
Tightening torques
Intake manifold to cylinder head
M7
15 Nm (11 ft-lb)
M8
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Mounting bracket
to cylinder block
(M10)
47 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Mounting bracket
to intake manifold
(M6)
10 Nm (7 ft-lb)
-
Installation of remaining parts is
reverse of removal, noting the
following:
Refill cooling system as described
in
170 Radiator and Cooling
System.
Change engine oil and filter as
described in
020 Maintenance.
If necessary, adjust accelerator
cable.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
21 of 21
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Reconnect battery.
CAUTION!
To prevent damaging engine
electronic systems, install all ground
wires previously removed, including
the ground wires for the ignition
coils.
Tightening torques
Coolant drain plug
to cylinder block
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Radiator cooling
fan to coolant
pump
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Radiator drain
screw to radiator
2.5 Nm (22 in-lb)
Spark plug to
cylinder head
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:42 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
113-4
Diagnostic Testing
Cylinder compression,
checking
A compression gauge is needed to
make a compression test. For accurate
test, the battery and starter must be
capable of cranking the engine at least
300 rpm, and the engine should be at
normal operating temperature.
Note:
Performing a compression test may
cause a fault to set in the ECM and
may illuminate the engine service light.
The light can only be turned out using
either BMW special service scan tools
or an equivalent aftermarket scan tool.
Disconnecting the battery will not erase
the fault memory nor turn out the light.
Disable ignition system by removing
DME main relay (arrow) from the
electronics box (E-box) in left rear of
engine compartment
WARNING!
The ignition system produces
high voltages that can be fatal.
Avoid contact with exposed
terminals and use extreme
caution when working on a car
with the ignition switched on or
the engine running.
Do not touch or disconnect
ignition components while the
engine is running or being
cranked by the starter.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:43 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Failure to remove the DME main
relay or attempting to disable the
ignition system by other methods
may result in damage to the engine
control module (ECM).
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom cover
(A) and remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
-
Remove oil filler cap.
-
Remove engine cover over ignition
coils. Replace oil filler cap.
Remove ignition coils.
Pull up on spring clips to
disconnect ignition coil harness
connectors.
Remove coil grounding straps.
Remove coils.
Remove spark plugs.
Note:
Check the spark plugs for oil deposits
that may indicate poor cylinder sealing,
then set them aside in order. Used
spark plugs should be reinstalled in the
same cylinder from which they were
2/25/2009 9:43 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
removed.
Install compression gauge in first
cylinder's spark plug hole, tight
enough to form a good seal.
-
With parking brake set,
transmission in PARK or
NEUTRAL, and accelerator pedal
pressed to floor, crank engine with
starter. Record highest value
indicated by gauge.
Note:
The compression gauge reading
should increase with each
compression stroke and reach
near its maximum reading in about
4-6 strokes.
All cylinders should reach
maximum compression in the
same number of strokes. If a
cylinder needs significantly more
strokes to reach maximum
compression, there is a problem.
-
Release pressure at compression
gauge valve, then remove gauge
from spark plug hole. Repeat test
for each cylinder and compare
results with values given below.
Compression pressures
Minimum
Maximum
difference between
cylinders
-
10 - 11 bar
(142 - 156 psi)
0.5 bar (7 psi)
Compression readings may be
interpreted as follows:
2/25/2009 9:43 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Low compression indicates a
poorly sealed combustion
chamber.
Relatively even pressures that are
below specification normally
indicate worn piston rings and/or
cylinder walls.
Erratic values tend to indicate
valve leakage.
Dramatic differences between
cylinders are often the sign of a
failed head gasket, burned valve,
or broken piston ring.
-
Reinstall spark plugs and ignition
coils.
Note:
Used spark plugs should be reinstalled
in the same cylinder from which they
were removed.
-
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal. Be sure to
reinstall all wires disconnected
during test, especially ground
wires at coils and cylinder head
cover (where applicable).
Tightening torque
Spark plug to
cylinder head
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Wet compression test
To further help analyze the source of
poor compression, a wet compression
test is the next step:
2/25/2009 9:43 PM
Cylinder Head Removal and Installation
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Repeat compression test, this time
with about a teaspoon of oil
squirted into each cylinder. (The
oil will temporarily help seal
between piston rings and cylinder
wall, practically eliminating
leakage past rings for a short
time.)
-
If this test yields higher
compression reading than "dry"
compression test, there is
probably leakage between piston
rings and cylinder walls, due
either to wear or to broken piston
rings.
-
Little or no change in compression
reading indicates other leakage,
probably from valves.
Cylinder leak-down test
The most conclusive diagnosis of low
compression symptoms requires a
cylinder leak-down test. Using a
special tester and compressed air,
each cylinder, in turn, is pressurized.
The rate at which the air leaks out of
the cylinder, as well as where the air
leaks out, can accurately pinpoint the
magnitude and location of the leakage.
Before attempting any repair that
requires major engine disassembly,
use a leak-down test to confirm low
compression.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:43 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
116-1
General
This repair group covers cylinder head
and valvetrain service and repair.
Procedures described here require that
the cylinder head first be removed as
described in
113 Cylinder Head
Removal and Installation.
Note:
For timing chain and VANOS
repair information, see
117
Camshaft Timing Chains.
If it is determined that the cylinder
head will require significant
reconditioning work, a
remanufactured cylinder head may
be a good alternative.
Remanufactured cylinder heads
are available from an authorized
BMW dealer.
The information given in this repair
group is organized according to engine
code. For engine application
information, see
100 Engine–
General.
Special tools
BMW special tools are required for
most cylinder head service described in
this repair group. Many of these tools
are expensive and only available
through an authorized BMW dealer. If
the special tools are not available, have
the cylinder head disassembled and
removed by an authorized BMW
dealer. Be sure to read each procedure
thoroughly before starting a job to
determine which special tools and
equipment will be necessary.
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Most of the repairs to a cylinder head
require precision machine work to
specific tolerances. This type of work
should be performed by an authorized
BMW repair facility or an ASE certified
machinist.
Cylinder head jig BMW 00 1 490
Valve seat grinder BMW 00 3 520
Valve guide reamer BMW 00 4 210
Valve stem seal driver BMW 11 1 200
Valve stem seal puller BMW special
tool 11 1 480
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Valve stem seal guide BMW special
tool 11 1 960
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
116-2
Cylinder Head
This section provides the specifications
and special reconditioning information
necessary to repair the cylinder heads
covered by this manual.
The disassembled cylinder head
should be inspected for warpage and
cracks. Check the valve guides and
valve seats for wear before machining a
warped head. Always decarbonize and
clean the head before inspecting it. A
high-quality straight edge can be used
to check for warpage.
Visually inspect the cylinder head for
cracks. If a cracked cylinder head is
suspected and no cracks are detected
through the visual inspection, have the
head further tested for cracks by an
authorized BMW dealer or an ASE
certified machinist. A cracked cylinder
head must be replaced.
Note:
When disassembling and inspecting the
cylinder head on an engine, be sure to
check the camshaft carrier bearing
surfaces for warpage.
A warped cylinder head can be
machined provided no more than 0.3
mm (0.012 in.) of material is removed. If
further machining is required, the head
should be replaced. Removing more
than this amount will reduce the size of
the combustion chamber and adversely
affect engine performance. A 0.3 mm
thicker gasket is available from an
authorized BMW parts department for
machined heads.
Before machining the head to correct
for warpage, measure the total height
(A) (thickness of the cylinder head).
Minimum height specifications are
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
given in
Table a.
Table a. Cylinder head height
New
Minimum height
(dimension A)
140.0 mm (5.512
in)
139.7 mm (5.500
in)
Valves, leak test
To test the valves for leakage, the
cylinder head must be disassembled
with camshafts and camshaft carriers
removed. Install the valve assemblies
and the spark plugs in each cylinder.
Place the cylinder head on a
workbench with the combustion
chamber facing upward. Fill each
combustion chamber with a thin
non-flammable liquid, such as a parts
cleaning fluid. After fifteen minutes,
check the level of the fluid. If the fluid
level in any cylinder drops, that
cylinder is not sealing properly.
Camshaft
Camshaft wear is usually caused by
insufficient lubrication. Visually inspect
camshaft lobes and journals for wear.
Camshaft wear specifications are given
Table b.
in
Table b. Camshaft wear
specifications
Axial play
0.150-0.330 mm
(0.0060-0.013 in.)
Radial play
(Plastigage)
0.020-0.054 mm
(0.0008-0.0021
in.)
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
If the camshaft is being replaced due
to cam lobe wear, it is recommended
that the corresponding lifters should
also be replaced to avoid damaging
the new camshaft.
Hydraulic lifters, checking and
replacing
Modern BMW 6 cylinder engines use
self-adjusting hydraulic lifters to keep
the valve clearances within a limited
working range. (A) section view of
camshaft , (B) hydraulic lifters are
sealed units and require no
maintenance, (C) valve with conical
valve spring.
Under some circumstances, such as a
cold start, the cam followers may
become noisy. Hydraulic lifter noise is
usually a high-pitched tapping or
chattering noise. In most instances,
this is considered normal as long as
the noise goes away in a few minutes
(maximum 20 minutes). If the noise
does not go away, either the lifter is
faulty or the oil pressure to the lifter is
low. Hydraulic lifter replacement
requires that the camshaft first be
removed.
Note:
Before checking hydraulic lifters, make
sure engine oil is fresh and at the
proper level.
-
Run engine until it reaches normal
operating temperature.
Remove microfilter housing:
Remove microfilter for interior
ventilation.
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Open wiring harness loom (A),
remove harness and lay aside.
Unfasten screws (B) and take off
lower microfilter housing.
-
Remove engine cover.
-
Detach positive and ground
connections from intake manifold
and cylinder head cover, as
necessary.
Remove ignition coils.
Disconnect ignition coil harness
connectors and lay harness aside.
Remove coil grounding straps.
Remove coils.
Remove spark plugs.
-
Remove cylinder head cover
mounting fasteners and remove
cylinder head cover.
Note:
The cylinder head cover mounting bolt
insulators and gaskets should be
reinstalled in their original locations.
Make note of their arrangement during
removal.
Remove oil baffle cover from above
intake camshaft.
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Use a plastic or wooden stick to press
down on top of lifter. If there is any
noticeable clearance, the lifter is faulty
and should be replaced.
Note:
When checking a hydraulic lifter, make
sure the corresponding camshaft lobe is
facing up so that there is no valve
spring pressure on the follower.
-
To replace a hydraulic lifter,
remove appropriate camshaft.
Refer to camshaft removal
procedures given in
113
Cylinder Head Removal and
Installation.
-
Once camshaft is removed,
withdraw faulty lifter and replace
with new one. Inspect lifter bores
for wear and scoring.
-
Camshaft, timing chain and
cylinder head cover reassembly is
reverse of disassembly.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:47 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
116-3
Valves
Valves, removing and installing
-
Remove cylinder head as
described in
113 Cylinder Head
Removal and Installation.
CAUTION!
Do not let the hydraulic lifters
fall out as the camshaft carrier is
removed. Special suction cups
are available from BMW to hold
the hydraulic lifters in place
during carrier removal.
Hydraulic cam lifters should be
stored in an upright position. If
necessary, use a magnetic tool
to aid in removal of the lifters.
-
Remove valves using a valve
spring compressor.
CAUTION!
Label each valve assembly as it is
removed so it can be installed in its
original position.
-
Remove and discard valve stem oil
seals from valve guides. See
Valve stem oil seals later in this
section.
-
Valve installation is reverse of
removal.
Valve specifications are listed in
Table c. Remove carbon deposits from
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
the valves using a wire brush or wire
wheel.
Table c. Valve specifications
Specification
M 52TU 2.5/2.8
engines
(1999 - 2000)
M 54 2.5/3.0
engines (2000 2001)
Valve head dia.
Intake
33.0 mm (1.299
in.)
Exhaust
30.5 mm (1.201
in.)
Valve stem dia.
Standard
Intake
6.0-0.015 mm
(0.2362-0.0006
in.)
Exhaust
6.0 -0.015 mm
(0.2362-0.0006
in.)
Oversize 1
Intake
6.1-0.025 mm
(0.2401-0.0010
in.)
Exhaust
6.1-0.040 mm
(0.2401-0.0016
in.)
Oversize 2
Intake
6.2-0.025 mm
(0.2441-0.0010
in.)
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Table c. Valve specifications
Specification
M 52TU 2.5/2.8
engines
(1999 - 2000)
M 54 2.5/3.0
engines (2000 2001)
Exhaust
6.2-0.040 mm
(0.2441-0.0016
in.)
Valve guides
BMW does not supply valve guides as
replacement parts. If a valve guide is
excessively worn, it should be reamed
to accept oversized valve stems. Valve
guide specifications are listed in
Table d.
Valve guides should be checked for
wear using a new valve. Be sure to
thoroughly inspect the cylinder head to
ensure that it can be reused before
reworking the guides.
Note:
International Organization for
Standardization (ISO) tolerance
classes are listed in
Table c.
ISO allowances are based on
nominal sizes and should be used
to determine proper fit. Most
machine shops should have this
information available.
Replacement valve guides may be
available through aftermarket
suppliers. Valve guide
replacement requires special tools
and a press. It is also necessary to
heat the cylinder head and chill the
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
valve guides when replacing the
guides.
BMW supplies oversize valves. See
Table d for additional information.
Table d.Valve guide specifications
Specifications
Valve guide wear,
maximum (valve
tilt clearance
measured with
new valve)
M52TU / M54
engine(1999 2001)
0.5 mm (0.020
in.)
Valve guide inside
diameter, installed
(tolerance per ISO
allowance H7)
Standard
6.0 mm (0.236
in.)
Oversize 1
6.1 mm (0.240
in.)
Oversize 2
6.2 mm (0.244
in.)
Valve stem oil seals
The purpose of the valve stem oil seal
is to prevent excess oil from entering
the combustion chamber. The sign of
faulty valve stem oil seals is excessive
oil consumption and smoke from the
exhaust immediately after starting and
during deceleration
Note:
Valve stem oil seals should not be
reused. If valves are removed, new
valve stem oil seals should be installed.
Valve stem oil seal replacement
requires that the cylinder head be
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
disassembled and the valves removed
as described above under
Valves,
removing and installing.
Note:
BMW special tools are available to
remove the valve stem oil seals. As an
alternative, standard valve seal removal
tools are available from most
automotive parts stores.
Lubricate new seal and install using
hand pressure only. Be sure to install
valve spring seat(s) before installing
seal.
Valve seats
The valve seats should be resurfaced
whenever new valves or valve guides
are installed. Cutters are required to
resurface the seats. Always check the
valves for leaks after reconditioning a
Table
valve seat as described above.
e lists valve seat dimensions.
Note:
Standard size replacement valve seats
are not available from BMW.
Replacement valve seats are only
available from BMW in 0.4 mm
oversize (oversized in both height and
diameter). The manufacturer does not
provide specifications for valve seat
replacement for the engines covered by
this manual.
Table e. Valve seat specifications
Specification
M52TU/M54
engines
(1999-2001)
A: Valve seat
angle
45°
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Cylinder Head and Valvetrain
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Table e. Valve seat specifications
Specification
M52TU/M54
engines
(1999-2001)
B: Correction
angle, outside
15°
C: Correction
angle, inside
60°
D: Valve seat
width
intake
1.65 ± 0.25 mm
(0.065 ± 0.010 in)
exhaust
1.65 ± 0.25 mm
(0.065 ± 0.010 in)
E: Valve seat
outside dia.
intake
32.4 mm (1.276 in)
exhaust
30.0 mm (1.181 in)
Valve springs
The valve springs should be checked
for fatigue. To quickly check the
springs, line them up in a row. Place a
straight edge across the top of the
springs. Any spring that is significantly
shorter than the others is worn and
should be replaced.
Note:
Valve spring specifications and wear
limits are not available from BMW.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:48 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
117-1
General
This repair group covers timing chain
and Variable Camshaft Timing
(VANOS) repair information.
The timing chains are lubricated by
engine oil and do not require
maintenance. Worn timing chains and
sprockets can lead to noisy operation
and erratic valve timing. A faulty
tensioner can also cause timing chain
noises.
Note:
See
100 Engine–General for engine
code and application information.
Special tools
Special BMW service tools are needed
to remove and disassemble the timing
chain, the VANOS control unit, the
camshafts and the valvetrain. Many of
these tools are expensive and only
available through an authorized BMW
dealer. Be sure to read each procedure
thoroughly before starting a job to
determine which special tools will be
necessary.
In addition, VANOS system diagnosis
can only be carried out by using BMW
specific electronic scan tools, such as
BMW DIS or MoDiC or equivalent.
CAUTION!
The VANOS system must be
removed and installed exactly as
described later in this repair group.
Torque wrench w/ flex extension BMW
00 9 250
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Crankshaft hub locking tools BMW 11
2 150 /11 2 410
Crankshaft locking tool BMW 11 2 300
Seal extractor tool BMW 11 2 380
Camshaft locking tools BMW 11 3
240/11 3 244
Installer bush BMW 11 3 280
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Secondary chain tensioner locking pin
BMW 11 3 292
Air line fitting BMW 11 3 450
Primary chain tensioner tool BMW 11 4
220
VANOS setup bracket BMW 11 6 150
Secondary sprocket tool BMW 11 6 180
Crankshaft hub locking tool BMW 11 8
190 /11 8 200
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Puller for crankshaft hub BMW 11 8
210
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
117-2
Crankshaft Front Oil
Seal
The crankshaft front seal is located in
the lower timing cover on the front of
the engine, behind the vibration
damper.
Note:
Cars built up to January 2000 are fitted
with a 2-piece vibration damper and hub
assembly. Cars built from January 2000
use an integral vibration damper and
hub assembly. If the early vibration
damper needs to be replaced, only the
single piece with integral hub is
available from BMW.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Disconnecting the battery may
erase fault code(s) stored in
control module memory. Check
for fault codes using special
BMW diagnostic equipment.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Remove drive belts:
Use long-handled wrench to turn
A/C belt tensioner hex (A)
clockwise (against spring tension).
Remove A/C belt.
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Similarly, turn main engine drive
belt tensioner hex (B) clockwise
and remove belt.
-
Secure crankshaft hub using
special holding tools:
Up to 1/2000 production: use
special tools 11 2 150 and 11 2
410.
From 01/2000 production: use
special tools 11 8 190 and 11 8
200.
CAUTION!
Do not use BMW special tool 11 2
300 to hold crankshaft stationary to
loosen or tighten crankshaft hub
center bolt. Use only the special
tools specified, or equivalent hub
holding tool.
Note:
The crankshaft hub center bolt is
tightened to a torque of 410 Nm (300
ft-lb).
-
On cars built up to 1/2000 (2-piece
vibration damper assembly),
remove vibration damper mounting
bolts and remove vibration damper
and pulley from hub.
-
Remove crankshaft hub (up to
1/2000 production) or vibration
damper (1/2000 and later
production).
Note:
If necessary, use BMW special tool 11
8 219 or equivalent puller to remove
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
hub from crankshaft.
Place special tool 11 2 383 on end of
crankshaft to cover threaded hole, and
fit special tool 11 2 385, aligning groove
in 11 2 385 with keyway on crankshaft
(arrow).
Put special tool 11 2 380 over tools
installed on crankshaft, and screw in
until it makes firm contact with the seal.
Tighten screw in end of 11 2 380 to
draw out seal.
To install new seal, coat with oil, and
use special tool 11 3 280 and
crankshaft center bolt to draw seal in
flush with timing case cover.
-
Install crankshaft hub (up to
1/2000) or vibration damper (from
1/2000) to crankshaft. Install new
crankshaft center bolt finger tight.
-
Torque crankshaft hub center bolt,
using special tools 11 2 150/11 2
410 (up to 1/2000) or 11 8 190/11
8 200 (from 1/2000). nothing
Tightening torque
Vibration damper
410 Nm (302
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torque
hub to crankshaft
ft-lb)
CAUTION!
Do not use BMW special tool 11 2
300 to hold crankshaft stationary to
loosen or tighten crankshaft hub
center bolt. Use only the special
tools specified, or equivalent hub
holding tool.
Install vibration damper mounting bolts,
where applicable. Note hub locating
dowel (arrow).
Tightening torque
Vibration damper
to crankshaft hub
(M8)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:50 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
1 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
117-3
Camshaft Timing
Chains, Removing
Camshaft timing chain removal
requires that the engine oil pan be
removed. This requires raising the
engine and/or lowering the front
suspension subframe. See
119
Lubrication System. Also required is
removal of the VANOS unit and
disassembly of the intake and exhaust
camshaft sprocket assemblies as
described later in this repair group.
Special BMW service tools are needed
for timing chain removal and
installation procedures. The special
tools assure proper timing of the
valvetrain. Precise marks to set the
timing on the camshafts are not
provided for reassembly. Read the
procedures through before beginning
the job.nothing
CAUTION!
If the camshafts are not properly
timed, the pistons can contact the
valves.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Disconnecting the battery may
erase fault code(s) stored in
control module memory. Check
for fault codes using special
BMW diagnostic equipment.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
2 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
viii.
Remove microfilter for interior
ventilation.
Remove microfilter housing:
Open wiring harness loom (A),
remove harness and lay aside.
Unfasten screws (B) and take off
lower microfilter housing.
Remove complete air filter housing:
Release mass air flow sensor clips
(A).
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (B).
Disconnect air duct connections
(C) and lift complete air filter
housing out of engine
compartment, pulling it forward
away from mass air flow sensor.
Note:
Mass air flow sensor remains attached
to air duct in above step.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
3 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove engine covers:
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
Remove cover hold down bolts.
Drain engine coolant and remove
coolant hoses.
Remove expansion tank cap on
radiator.
Place a 3-gallon pail beneath
engine to capture coolant.
Remove engine block drain plug
on exhaust side near cylinder 2
(arrow).
WARNING!
Allow engine to cool before
opening or draining cooling
system.
Use caution when draining and
disposing of engine coolant.
Coolant is poisonous and lethal
to humans and pets. Pets are
attracted to coolant because of
its sweet smell and taste.
Consult a veterinarian
immediately if ingested by an
animal.
-
Drain radiator into 3-gallon pail by
removing plastic drain plug at
lower left corner of radiator.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
4 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Remove radiator cooling fan
shroud and viscous clutch cooling
fan (cars with automatic
transmission) or electric cooling
fan (cars with manual
transmission). See
170 Radiator
and Cooling System
CAUTION!
On cars with viscous clutch, 32 mm
cooling fan mounting nut has left
hand threads.
Release locking clips and pull hoses
from thermostat housing (arrows).
Unbolt and remove thermostat houses.
Remove drive belts:
Use long-handled wrench to turn
A/C belt tensioner hex (A)
clockwise (against spring tension).
Remove A/C belt.
Similarly, turn main engine drive
belt tensioner hex (B) clockwise
and remove belt.
-
Remove coolant pump pulley.
-
Remove alternator cooling duct at
radiator support.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
5 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Drain engine oil and remove oil
pan as described in
119
Lubrication System.
-
On cars produced up to 1/2000
with 2-piece vibration damper:
Remove vibration damper
mounting bolts and separate
vibration damper and pulley from
crankshaft hub.
Note:
Cars built up to January 2000 are fitted
with a 2-piece vibration damper and hub
assembly. Cars built from January 2000
use an integral vibration damper and
hub assembly.
-
Using BMW special holding tool,
secure crankshaft hub to prevent
crankshaft from turning. Loosen
but do not remove crankshaft hub
center bolt.
CAUTION!
Do not use BMW special tool 11 2
300 (flywheel locking tool) to hold
crankshaft stationary to loosen or
tighten crankshaft hub center bolt.
Use only the special tools specified,
or equivalent hub holding tool.
Note:
The crankshaft hub center bolt is
tightened to a torque of 410 Nm (300
ft-lb). BMW special tools 11 2 150 and
11 2 410 (up to 1/2000 models) or 11 8
190 and 11 8 200 (1/2000 and later
models) should be used to hold the
crankshaft stationary while the bolt is
loosened.
Working at top center of engine,
disconnect vent hose by squeezing at
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
6 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
fitting (arrows).
-
Disconnect electrical connection at
intake camshaft position sensor
(A).
Remove ignition coils and spark plugs:
Pull up on retaining clips to
disconnect ignition coil harness
connectors.
Remove grounding straps at coil
mounting studs.
Remove all ignition coils.
Remove spark plugs.
-
Remove cylinder head cover
mounting fasteners and remove
cylinder head cover.
Note:
The cylinder head cover mounting bolt
insulators, gaskets and coil grounds
should be reinstalled in their original
locations.
Remove oil baffle cover from intake
camshaft.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
7 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Working at left front of cylinder head,
disconnect electrical connections at
exhaust camshaft position sensor and
exhaust camshaft VANOS control valve
(arrows).
Remove banjo bolt from VANOS
control unit oil pressure line. Use banjo
bolt to attach BMW special tool 11 3
450 (compressed air fitting) (arrow) to
VANOS unit.
Cover oil hole in VANOS unit (arrow)
with shop towel to capture oil which will
spray when compressed air line is
connected.
-
Connect compressed air line to air
fitting. Apply air pressure set to 2 8 bar (30 - 110 psi).
With compressed air line connected,
rotate engine in direction of rotation
(clockwise) at least two full rotations,
leaving cylinder 1 intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes facing each other, as
shown (arrows).
CAUTION!
Do not rotate engine
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
8 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
counterclockwise to reach the top
dead center position. Instead,
complete another two complete
rotations.
Remove sealing plug from bore on
lower left side of engine block below
starter. Secure crankshaft in TDC
position with BMW special tool 11 2
300 (arrow).
Unscrew and remove threaded studs
(arrows) at rear of cylinder head.
Secure camshafts in TDC position
using BMW special tools 11 3 240 and
11 3 244.
-
Detach compressed air line,
leaving compressed air fitting
attached to VANOS unit.
Note:
Oil will drain from pressure line. Have a
container and rags ready.
Unscrew sealing plugs from VANOS
unit (arrows).
Note:
Oil will drain from sealing plug bores.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
9 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Have a container and rags ready.
Pull sealing caps straight out of
VANOS unit with BMW special tool 11
6 170, or with short nose pliers.
Note:
Additional oil may drain from VANOS
unit.
Remove set screws (left hand thread)
on ends of intake and exhaust
camshafts.
CAUTION!
Set screws have left hand threads.
Remove with a clockwise motion.
Remove VANOS unit:
Remove fasteners from engine
support eye.
Remove VANOS mounting nuts
(arrows) from cylinder head. Slide
VANOS unit and metal gasket off.
CAUTION!
Do not crank or turn over engine with
VANOS unit removed. Piston/valve
interference is possible.
Note:
The VANOS unit will contain
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
10 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
residual oil. Place shop towels
beneath adjustment unit when
removing.
If the VANOS control unit is
replaced, or if repair operations
are completed that may change
camshaft timing, the camshaft
timing must be checked as
described later in this chapter.
Remove primary camshaft chain
tensioner (arrow) from timing chain
cover.
CAUTION!
Primary camshaft chain tensioning
piston is under spring pressure.
Press down on secondary chain
tensioner and lock into place using
BMW special tool 11 3 292 or a similar
size rod.
Remove exhaust camshaft impulse
wheel mounting nuts (arrows).
Remove impulse wheel (A).
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
11 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove spring plate (A).
Remove intake camshaft sprocket
mounting nuts (arrows) and remove
spring plate (labelled FRONT).
Remove torx screws from exhaust
camshaft sprocket (arrows).
Lift off exhaust and intake sprockets
together with secondary chain, thrust
spacer (A) and splined shaft (B).
CAUTION!
Splined shafts for both intake and
exhaust camshafts share the same
part number. Remove and mark used
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
12 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
splined shafts in order to reinstall in
original locations.
Remove exhaust camshaft splined
sleeve (A) and shaft (B).
Remove secondary chain tensioner
mounting bolts (arrows). Remove
tensioner while keeping locking pin in
place.
Remove primary chain sprocket
mounting studs (arrows) on exhaust
camshaft.
Lift primary chain sprocket off exhaust
camshaft. Remove sprocket from chain.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
13 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Set timing chain on exhaust camshaft
end.
Working in cylinder head cavity,
remove timing chain cover bolts
(arrows).
Remove secondary chain lower guide
bolts (arrows). Remove chain guide.
Note:
Bolt on intake camshaft side is long and
extends into timing chain cover.
-
Remove crankshaft hub center
bolt and remove crankshaft hub
(to 1/2000 models) or vibration
damper (models from 1/2000).
CAUTION!
The crankshaft must not be allowed
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
14 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
to rotate when the timing chains are
loosened or removed. The pistons
can contact the valves.
Using a drift of less than 5 mm
diameter, drive two locating dowels (A)
in left and right sides of lower timing
chain cover toward rear of car. Remove
cover mounting bolts (arrows) and
carefully lift cover off.
CAUTION!
Use care when removing the cover
from the cylinder head gasket. If the
cover is stuck, use a sharp knife to
separate it from the head gasket.
Note:
The chain cover can be removed
with the coolant pump installed.
Use care when removing the cover
from the coolant pipe at rear.
-
Push primary chain tensioner
guide rail aside and remove chain.
Double VANOS
components (M52
TU, M54 engine)
1
- Impulse wheel
mounting nut
2
- Camshaft
impulse wheel
(exh.)
3
- Spring plate
4
- Thrust spacer (T
= 3.5 mm)
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
15 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
5
- Primary chain
tensioner
6
- Torx screw
7
- Exhaust
secondary
sprocket
8
- Splined shaft
9
- Secondary
timing chain
10 - Splined sleeve
11 - Primary
sprocket
12 - Threaded stud
13 - Secondary
chain tensioner
14 - Sprocket
mounting nut
15 - Spring plate
16 - Splined shaft
17 - Intake camshaft
sprocket
18 - Secondary
chain lower
guide
19 - Thrust spacer
20 - Camshaft
impulse wheel
(intake)
21 - Chain tensioner
rail
22 - Crankshaft
sprocket
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
16 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
23 - Threaded stud
24 - Primary chain
25 - Threaded stud
26 - Guide rail
27 - Threaded stud
28 - Woodruff key
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
117-4
Camshaft timing chains,
Installing
CAUTION!
The procedure outlined below
assumes that the camshafts and the
crankshaft are locked in the TDC
installation position with special
locking tools as shown earlier.
Inspect timing chain sprockets. Inspect
guide rail and tensioner rail for deep
grooves caused by chain contact.
Replace any part that is worn or
damaged.
1 - Primary chain tensioner
2 - Chain tensioner rail
3 - Crankshaft sprocket
4 - Exhaust camshaft sprocket
5 - Primary chain
6 - Anchor bolt
7 - Guide rail
8 - Anchor bolt
9 - Woodruff key
Note:
If any sprockets are being replaced due
to wear, the chain should also be
replaced. If the crankshaft sprocket
requires replacement, the oil pump
drive sprocket and chain must be
removed. See
119 Lubrication
System for oil pump removal
information.
-
Install primary timing chain to
crankshaft sprocket and hang
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
upper end from exhaust camshaft.
-
If necessary, replace crankshaft
seal as described earlier.
-
To install lower timing case cover:
Clean cover and cylinder block
sealing surfaces.
Use new gaskets and coolant pipe
O-ring.
Drive timing cover dowels in until
they just protrude slightly from
sealing surface.
Apply a small bead of silicon
sealer (3-Bond 1209® or
equivalent) to corners of cylinder
head where timing cover meets
cylinder head and engine block.
Tap cover into position to engage
dowels.
Install all bolts hand tight,
including two Torx bolts from
above.
Install secondary chain lower
guide.
Drive dowels in flush to front of
cover.
Tighten cover mounting bolts
alternately and in stages.
Tightening torques
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
Lower timing cover
to cylinder block
(M6)
-
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Install oil pan with new gasket.
See
119 Lubrication System.
Tightening torque
Oil pan to engine block (M6)
8.8 grade
10.9 grade
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
12 Nm (9 ft-lb)
Install crankshaft hub or vibration
damper to crankshaft. Install
crankshaft center bolt finger tight.
Make sure hub is fully seated, noting
alignment dowel (arrow), where
applicable.
Note:
Cars built up to January 2000 are fitted
with a 2-piece vibration damper and hub
assembly. Cars built from January 2000
use an integral vibration damper and
hub assembly. If the early vibration
damper needs to be replaced, only the
single piece with integral hub is
available from BMW.
Tightening torque
Vibration damper
to crankshaft hub
(M8)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Fit top sprocket to primary timing chain
and install on exhaust camshaft so that
pointer (arrow) on sprocket lines up
with cylinder head sealing surface.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Insert BMW special tool 11 4 220 in
cylinder head and screw in adjustment
screw by hand just until it contacts
tensioning rail.
Note:
BMW special tool 11 4 220 is a dummy
primary chain tensioner and simulates
the function of the tensioner.
-
Make sure arrow on top primary
sprocket is still lined up with upper
edge of cylinder head. Reposition
sprocket if necessary.
Install and tighten down threaded
locating studs (arrows) in end of
exhaust camshaft.
Tightening torques
Exhaust camshaft
locating stud
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Install secondary chain tensioner on
cylinder head.
Make sure tensioner is locked in
compressed position as described
earlier.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Fit exhaust camshaft splined sleeve,
aligning gap in sleeve splines with
corresponding gap on camshaft splines
(arrows).
Slide splined shaft onto exhaust
camshaft, aligning larger tooth with
corresponding gap of splined sleeve.
Slide splined shaft in further until
3 small slots in splined sleeve are
centered on 3 threaded holes in
sprocket.
Place intake and exhaust sprockets in
BMW special tool 11 6 180. Position
spline gap on intake sprocket (arrow)
as shown and place secondary chain
on sprockets.
Carefully remove chain and sprockets
from tool and slide onto camshafts.
Align gap in intake sprocket splines
with corresponding gap in camshaft
splines (arrow).
CAUTION!
Do not alter position of sprockets
with respect to chain when removing
from special tool 11 6 180.
Slide splined shaft onto intake
camshaft until approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.)
of splines can still be seen.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Install intake camshaft spring plate so
that FRONT mark is visible. Install
mounting nuts (arrows) finger tight.
Working at exhaust side, insert
sprocket mounting Torx screws into
threaded holes (arrows).
Initially tighten screws to approx. 5
Nm (44 in-lb). Back off half a turn.
Fit thrust spacer (A) on exhaust
camshaft.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Install spring plate (A) to exhaust
camshaft. Make sure that F marking is
visible.
Note:
If F marking is no longer visible, install
spring plate so that convex side points
forward (toward front of car).
Install exhaust camshaft impulse
wheel, aligning mark (B) with top edge
of cylinder head (A). Install mounting
nuts (arrows) finger tight.
Pull out exhaust splined shaft until it
stops.
-
Press down on secondary chain
tensioner and remove tensioner
lock-down tool.
Preload primary chain:
Tighten adjusting screw on BMW
special tool 11 4 220 to specified
torque.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torque
Primary chain
tensioner preload
0.7 Nm (6 in-lb)
Preload exhaust camshaft spring plate
by pressing on impulse wheel while
tightening mounting nuts (arrows)
finger tight.
Install BMW special tool 11 6 150
(VANOS setup bracket) to front of
cylinder head timing case.
-
Tighten tool mounting nuts
(arrows) by hand, and then
tighten down uniformly until
special tool is firmly contacting
cylinder head.
CAUTION!
Make sure all gasket material is
removed from face of cylinder head.
Clean sealing face and keep free of
oil. If any foreign material is present
on the sealing surface, the camshaft
timing will be incorrect.
Secure camshaft sprockets and
impulse wheels:
Tighten mounting screws (A) on
exhaust camshaft impulse wheel
to approx. 5 Nm (44 in-lb).
Tighten mounting nuts (B) on
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
exhaust and intake sprocket
assemblies to approx. 5 Nm (44
in-lb).
Torque down mounting screws (A)
and nuts (B) to final specifications.
Tightening torques
Sprocket assembly
to camshaft initial
torque
5 Nm (44 in-lb)
Sprocket assembly to camshaft
M7 Torx screw (A)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
M6 mounting nut
(B)
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
-
Remove flywheel locking tool from
transmission bellhousing so that
crankshaft is no longer secured.
-
Remove camshaft locking tools
from rear of camshafts.
Crank engine over by hand twice in
direction of rotation until cylinder 1
intake and exhaust camshaft lobes
(arrows) face each other.
-
Secure crankshaft in TDC position
with BMW special tool 11 2 300.
Place BMW special tool 11 3 240 over
camshaft ends and measure clearance
of tool to cylinder head surface.
Note:
If the exhaust side of the tool is not
flush with the head (gap A), retime
the camshafts as described later in
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
this repair group.
Due to flexible sprocket design,
VANOS unit tolerances, and play
in the VANOS splines, when the
camshaft timing is set correctly,
the intake side of special tool 11 3
240 may be up to 1 mm (0.04 in)
above the surface of the cylinder
head (gap B).This is normal.
Otherwise, retime the camshafts
as described later in this repair
group.
-
Remove VANOS setup bracket
from front of cylinder head.
-
Install VANOS unit. See
VANOS control unit, given later.
-
Install intake camshaft oil baffle
Install cylinder head cover.
Check for correct seating of
half-moon seals (A) in back of
cylinder head cover.
Use a small amount of
3-Bond®1209 or equivalent
sealant at corners (B) of
half-moon cutouts. Seal corners in
front of cylinder head at VANOS
unit.
Tightening torque
Cylinder head
cover to cylinder
head
-
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Reassemble remainder of engine:
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Torque crankshaft hub center bolt,
using special tools 11 2 150/11 2
410 (to 1/2000) or 11 8 190/11 8
200 (from 1/2000).
CAUTION!
Do not use BMW special tool 11 2
300 (flywheel locking tool) to hold
crankshaft stationary to loosen or
tighten crankshaft hub center bolt.
Use only the special tools specified,
or equivalent hub holding tool.
Reinstall air filter housing, engine
covers, interior ventilation
microfilter housing.
Secure all coolant hoses,
thermostat housing, engine
coolant drains.
Reinstall engine oil drain plug.
Refill engine oil and coolant
before running engine. Check for
leaks.
Tightening torques
Coolant drain plug
to cylinder block
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Radiator cooling
fan (viscous clutch)
to coolant pump
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Radiator drain
screw to radiator
Vibration damper
hub to crankshaft
-
2.5 Nm (22
in-lb)
410 Nm (302
ft-lb)
Use scan tool to check VANOS
operation with engine idling.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:51 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
1 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
117-5
Vanos
The main components of the double
VANOS system are:
Intake and exhaust camshafts with
helical spline inserts
Camshaft sprockets with
adjustable gears
VANOS actuators (two position
piston housing with
internal/external helical spline
cup)
Three-way solenoid switching
valves
Camshaft position impulse wheels
Hall effect camshaft position
sensors
Camshaft position is varied based on
engine rpm, throttle position signal,
intake air and coolant temperature.
When engine is started, camshafts are
in deactivated position:
Intake camshaft is held in
RETARDED position by oil
pressure.
Exhaust camshaft is held in
ADVANCED position by preload
spring and oil pressure.
Within 2 - 5 seconds (50 engine
revolutions), the ECM begins
monitoring and controlling camshaft
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
2 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
positions.
The Double VANOS system allows full
variability of camshaft timing up to the
limits of the system. When the ECM
detects that the camshafts are in
optimum position, the solenoids are
modulated at approximately 100 - 220
Hz to maintain oil pressure on both
sides of the actuator pistons to
maintain timing.
In models with DME MS 43.0 (model
year 2001), the engine control module
(ECM) detects camshaft position before
the engine starts, thereby adjusting
camshaft timing immediately upon
start-up
Note:
BMW does not provide diagnostic
information or specifications for
the Double VANOS system.
VANOS system troubleshooting
and diagnostics is best
accomplished using a scan tool.
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
pertaining to the VANOS system
are listed in
Table a. See also
OBD On Board Diagnostics at
the back of this manual.
Elevated oil temperatures can
cause VANOS to deactivate. Oil
that is too thick (high viscosity)
may cause a DTC to be set in the
ECM. If VANOS is deactivated
(limp-home mode), there will be a
noticeable loss of power.
Table a. VANOS fault codes
BMW
code
P-code
Fault
description
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
3 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Table a. VANOS fault codes
BMW
code
P-code
Fault
description
19
P1529
VANOS
solenoid valve
activation,
exhaust
21
P1525
VANOS
solenoid valve
activation,
intake
103
P1519
VANOS faulty
reference value
intake
104
P1520
VANOS faulty
reference value
exhaust
105
P1522
VANOS stuck
(Bank 1) intake
106
P1523
VANOS stuck
(Bank 2)
exhaust
Double VANOS components
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
4 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
VANOS control unit
1
- Bolt M6
2
- Exhaust
camshaft
position sensor
3
- Sealing ring
4
- Camshaft end
sealing plug
tighten to 50
Nm (37 ft-lb)
5
- Camshaft seal
cap
6
- VANOS
hydraulic piston
set screw
CAUTION:
left hand
thread
tighten to 10
Nm (89 in-lb)
7
- Nut M7
tighten to 14
Nm (10 ft-lb)
8
- Engine lifting
hook
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
5 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
9
- Stud M7
10 - Nut M6
tighten to 10
Nm (89 in-lb)
11 - Gasket
12 - Cylinder head
13 - Sealing ring
14 - Intake camshaft
sensor
15 - Bolt M6
16 - VANOS control
unit
17 - Copper sealing
ring
18 - VANOS oil feed
line
19 - Banjo bolt
tighten to 32
Nm (24 ft-lb)
VANOS control unit, removing
Note:
If the Double VANOS control unit is
being replaced, camshaft timing must be
checked as described later in this group.
This procedure requires multiple special
tools. Be sure to read the procedures
through before beginning the repair.
-
Working inside trunk, disconnect
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
6 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
negative (-) battery cable.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Disconnecting the battery may
erase fault code(s) stored in
control module memory. Check
for fault codes using special BMW
diagnostic equipment.
-
Remove complete air filter housing,
cylinder head cover, intake
camshaft plastic cover and spark
plugs, as described earlier in
Camshaft Timing Chains,
Removing.
Remove banjo bolt from VANOS unit oil
pressure line. Use banjo bolt to attach
BMW special tool 11 3 450 (compressed
air fitting) to VANOS unit.
CAUTION!
Oil will drain from pressure line.
Have a container and rags ready.
Do not allow oil to run onto drive
belts.
Cover top of VANOS unit with
lint-free shop cloth. Compressed
air will force oil to spray out of oil
bore on top of unit.
-
Connect compressed air line (with
line pressure set to 2 - 8 bar or 30 110 psi) to air fitting.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
7 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
With compressed air line connected,
turn engine at least twice in direction of
rotation until cylinder 1 intake and
exhaust camshaft lobes (arrows) face
each other.
Remove sealing plug from bore on lower
left side of engine block (flywheel end).
Secure crankshaft in TDC position with
BMW special tool 11 2 300 (arrow).
-
Unscrew and remove cylinder head
cover studs at rear of cylinder head.
Secure camshafts in TDC position using
BMW special tools 11 3 240 ans 11 3
244.
-
Detach compressed air line, leaving
compressed air fitting attached to
VANOS unit.
Note:
Oil will drain from fittings when air line is
removed. Have a container and rags
ready. Do not allow oil to run onto drive
belts.
Unscrew sealing plugs (arrows) from
VANOS unit.
Note:
Oil will drain from plugs when removed.
Have a container and rags ready. Do not
allow oil to run onto drive belts.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
8 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove sealing caps from inside
VANOS unit with BMW special tool 11 6
170, or with short flat nose pliers.
Note:
Additional oil may drain from VANOS
unit.
Remove set screws (left hand thread) on
ends of intake and exhaust camshaft
hydraulic pistons.
CAUTION!
Set screws have left-hand threads.
Remove with a clockwise motion.
Disconnect electrical harness connectors
from camshaft position sensors and
solenoid valves on both exhaust and
intake sides of VANOS unit.
Remove VANOS unit:
Remove fasteners from engine
support eye.
Remove VANOS mounting nuts
(arrows) from cylinder head. Slide
VANOS unit and metal gasket off.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
9 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Do not crank or turn over engine with
VANOS unit removed. Piston/valve
interference is possible.
VANOS control unit, installing
Clean contact edges of cylinder head
face and VANOS unit and apply a thin
coat of sealing compound (3-Bond®1209
or equivalent) to surfaces.
CAUTION!
Make sure all gasket material is
removed from face of cylinder
head. Clean sealing face and
keep free of oil. If any foreign
material is present on the sealing
surface, the camshaft timing will
be incorrect.
Check locating dowel (A) and
dowel sleeve (B) at top of cylinder
head for damage or incorrect
installation.
Note:
If the Double VANOS control unit is
being replaced, be sure to check
and adjust camshaft timing as
described later in this group.
If work being carried out has no
effect on camshaft timing, it is not
necessary to recheck the timing. It
is recommended however that the
VANOS operation be checked using
a compatible scan tool.
-
Using new gasket, install VANOS
unit to cylinder head.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
10 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Reinstall engine support eye.
Tightening torque
VANOS unit to cylinder head
M6 nut
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
M7 nut
14 Nm (10 ft-lb)
Insert and tighten down VANOS
hydraulic piston set screws on intake
and exhaust camshafts.
CAUTION!
Set screws have left hand thread.
Tighten counterclockwise.
Tightening torque
Hydraulic piston to
splined shaft
M6 set screw
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Replace sealing caps inside VANOS unit
with BMW special tool 11 6 170, or short
flat nosed pliers.
Insert and secure VANOS sealing plugs
(arrows), using new sealing O-rings.
Tightening torque
Sealing plug to
VANOS unit
-
50 Nm (37 ft-lb)
Remove compressed air fitting from
VANOS unit.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
11 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Fit VANOS oil line banjo bolt with
new seals. Attach oil line to VANOS
unit.
Tightening torque
Oil line to VANOS
unit (banjo bolt)
32 Nm (24 ft-lb)
-
Attach electrical harness connectors
to camshaft position sensors and
VANOS solenoid valves.
-
Remove BMW special locking tools
from rear of cylinder head.
-
Remove BMW special locking tool
from flywheel and replace dust
guard.
Install intake camshaft plastic baffle and
then install cylinder head cover.
Check for correct seating of
half-moon seals (A) in back of
cylinder head cover.
Use a small amount of
3-Bond®1209 or equivalent sealant
at corners (B) of half-moon cutouts.
Similarly, seat gasket and seal
corners in front of cylinder head, at
VANOS unit.
Tightening torque
Cylinder head
cover to cylinder
head (M6)
-
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Remainder of installation is reverse
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
12 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
of removal.
Tightening torques
Radiator fan
(viscous clutch) to
coolant pump
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Spark plug to
cylinder head
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Camshaft timing, adjusting
Use this procedure to check and, if
necessary, adjust camshaft timing. This
procedure assumes that the cylinder
head cover and intake camshaft plastic
baffle have been removed as described
under
Camshaft Timing Chains,
Removing. Also, be sure the cooling fan
behind the radiator and the spark plugs
have been removed.
Remove primary camshaft chain
tensioner cylinder (arrow).
CAUTION!
Primary camshaft chain tensioning
piston is under spring pressure.
Insert BMW special tool 11 4 220 in
cylinder head and bring adjustment
screw into contact with tensioning rail.
Note:
BMW special tool 11 4 220 is a dummy
primary chain tensioner and simulates
the function of the tensioner.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
13 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Preload primary chain tensioner rail:
Tighten adjusting screw on BMW
special tool 11 4 220.
Tightening torque
Primary chain
tensioner preload
0.7 Nm (6 in-lb)
Unscrew oil pressure pipe from VANOS
unit. Remove banjo bolt from oil
pressure line and install BMW special
tool 11 3 450.
CAUTION!
Cover top of VANOS unit with lint-free
shop cloth. Attachment of compressed
air line will force oil to spray out of
bore.
-
Connect compressed air line to air
fitting. Apply air pressure set to 2 8 bar (30 - 110 psi).
With compressed air line connected,
turn engine at least twice in direction of
rotation until cylinder 1 intake and
exhaust camshaft lobes (arrows) face
each other.
CAUTION!
Do not rotate engine counterclockwise
to reach the top dead center position.
Instead, complete another two
complete rotations.
Remove sealing plug from bore on lower
left side of engine block near flywheel.
Secure crankshaft in TDC position with
BMW special tool 11 2 300 (arrow).
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
14 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Unscrew and remove cylinder head
cover studs at rear of cylinder head.
Place BMW special tool 11 3 240 over
camshafts ends and measure clearance
of tool to cylinder head surface.
Note:
If the exhaust side of the tool (A) is
not flush with the head, retime the
camshafts as described below.
Due to flexible sprocket design,
VANOS unit tolerances and play in
the VANOS splines, when the
camshaft timing is set correctly, the
intake side of special tool 11 3 240
(B) may be up to 1 mm (0.04 in)
above the surface of the cylinder
head. This is normal. Reassemble
engine. Otherwise, retime the
engine as described below.
-
Remove Double VANOS unit as
described earlier.
Press down on secondary chain
tensioner and lock into place using BMW
special tool 11 3 292 or equivalent.
-
Make sure primary chain tensioner
dummy tool (special tool 11 4 220)
is installed in side of cylinder head
and just touching tensioning rail. Do
not preload chain yet.
Loosen intake camshaft sprocket
mounting nuts (arrows) by 1 turn.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
15 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Loosen exhaust camshaft sprocket
mounting bolts (A) turn.
Loosen exhaust camshaft impulse
wheel mounting nuts (B) 2 turns.
Slide out intake camshaft splined shaft
until approx. 1 mm (0.04 in) of splines
(arrows) can be seen.
Pull out exhaust camshaft splined shaft
to stop.
-
Make sure camshafts are secured in
TDC position using BMW special
tools 11 3 240 and 11 3 244.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
16 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Preload primary chain tensioning rail:
Tighten adjusting screw on BMW
special tool 11 4 220.
Tightening torque
Primary chain
tensioner preload
0.7 Nm (6 in-lb)
Preload exhaust camshaft spring plate
by pressing on impulse wheel. Tighten
mounting nuts (arrows) by hand. Do not
tighten fully.
Install BMW special tool 11 6 150
(VANOS setup bracket) to front of
cylinder head timing case. Tighten nuts
(arrows) by hand, and then tighten
down uniformly until special tool is in full
contact with cylinder head.
CAUTION!
Make sure all gasket material is
removed from face of cylinder head.
Clean sealing face and keep free of oil.
If any foreign material is present on
the sealing surface, the camshaft
timing will be incorrect.
Secure camshaft impulse sprockets and
wheels:
Pretighten Torx screws (A) on
exhaust camshaft impulse wheel to
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
17 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
approx. 5 Nm (44 in-lb).
Pretighten mounting nuts (B) on
exhaust and intake sprocket
assemblies to approx. 5 Nm (44
in-lb).
Torque down Torx screws (A) and
nuts (B) to final specifications.
Tightening torques
Sprocket assembly
to camshaft initial
torque
5 Nm (44 in-lb)
Sprocket assembly to camshaft
M7 Torx screw (A)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
M6 mounting nut
(B)
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
-
Remove flywheel locking tool from
transmission bellhousing so that
crankshaft is no longer locked.
-
Remove camshaft locking tools from
rear of cylinder head.
-
Crank engine over twice by hand in
direction of rotation until cylinder 1
intake and exhaust camshaft lobes
face each other again.
-
Secure crankshaft with BMW
special tool 11 2 300.
Place BMW special tool 11 3 240 over
camshaft ends and measure clearance
of tool to cylinder head surface.
Note:
If the exhaust side of the tool (A) is
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
18 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
not flush with the head, camshaft
timing is incorrect. Repeat camshaft
timing procedure.
Due to flexible sprocket design,
VANOS unit tolerances and play in
the VANOS splines, when the
camshaft timing is set correctly, the
intake side of special tool 11 3 240
(B) may be up to 1 mm (0.04 in)
above the surface of the cylinder
head. This is normal. Otherwise,
repeat camshaft timing procedure.
-
Remove camshaft locking tools from
rear of camshafts.
-
Remove BMW special tool 11 4 220
(dummy primary chain tensioner).
Reinstall primary chain tensioner.
Tightening torque
Primary chain
tensioner cylinder
to cylinder head
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
-
Remove flywheel locking tool from
transmission bellhousing Reinstall
sealing plug.
-
Remove VANOS setup bracket from
front of cylinder head.
-
Install VANOS control unit as
described earlier in this group.
-
Remove compressed air fitting
(special tool 11 3 450) from VANOS
unit.
-
Fit VANOS oil line banjo bolt with
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Camshaft Timing Chain
19 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
new seals. Attach oil line to VANOS
unit.
Tightening torque
Oil line to VANOS
unit (banjo bolt)
-
32 Nm (24 ft-lb)
Remainder of engine assembly is
reverse of disassembly.
Tightening torques
Radiator cooling
fan (viscous clutch)
to coolant pump
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Cylinder head
cover to cylinder
head
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Spark plug to
cylinder head
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
119-1
General
This repair group covers lubrication
system troubleshooting as well as oil
pan removal and oil pump
replacement.
Special tools
The engine needs to be properly
supported while the front suspension
subframe is removed to access the
lubrication system. If BMW special
tools 00 0 200 / 00 0 208 are not
available, a device to support the
weight of the engine from above would
be suitable.
A standard oil pressure gauge may be
used for measuring oil pressure. If the
BMW DIS tester system is to be used,
a special adapter is needed.
Note:
Oil change procedure and oil filter
replacement are covered in
020
Maintenance
Engine support bracket BMW 00 0
200/00 0 208
Adapter for BMW oil pressure gauge
BMW 11 4 050
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Engine lubrication
Oil pressure is generated by a
gear-type pump bolted to the bottom of
the engine block. The oil pump is chain
driven off the front of the crankshaft.
Oil passages in the cylinder block and
cylinder head connect the oil pump to
components such as camshafts,
crankshaft and valve lifters.
Engine oil capacity (includes filter
replacement)
Rear wheel drive
6.5 liters (6.9 qt.)
All wheel drive
7.5 liters (7.9 qt.)
Troubleshooting
The oil pressure warning system
consists of an oil pressure switch
mounted in the oil circuit and an
instrument panel warning light. Other
safety features include:
Oil level warning system
A filter bypass to provide
lubrication should the oil filter
become clogged
An oil pump pressure relief valve
to prevent excessive system
pressure
CAUTION!
If the red oil pressure warning light
comes on or flashes on while
driving, always assume that the oil
pressure is low.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Oil pressure, checking
In some engines access to the oil
pressure warning switch port may be
extremely restricted.
-
Unscrew oil filter cap in order to
allow engine oil to drain back
down into oil pan.
Disconnect harness connector from oil
pressure switch (arrow) and remove
switch.
CAUTION!
Running the engine with the oil
pressure switch disconnected may
set a fault code (DTC).
Note:
Thoroughly clean around the oil
pressure switch before removing it.
Be prepared to catch leaking oil
with a shop towel.
Component location
Oil pressure
switch
base of oil filter
housing
-
Install pressure gauge in place of
switch.
-
With gauge installed, start engine
and allow to reach operating
temperature. Check oil pressure
both cold and hot.
Note:
For the most accurate test results, the
engine oil and filter should be new. The
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
oil should be the correct grade.
Oil pressure
Idle (minimum)
Regulated
pressure (elevated
engine speed)
-
0.5 bar (7 psi)
4.0 bar (59 psi)
Remove pressure gauge and
reinstall pressure switch.
Tightening torque
Oil pressure switch
to oil filter housing
27 Nm (20 ft-lb)
If testing shows low oil pressure, one or
more of the following conditions may
be indicated:
Worn or faulty oil pump
Worn or faulty engine bearings
Severe engine wear
All of these conditions indicate the
need for major repairs.
Oil pressure warning system,
testing
When the ignition is turned on, the oil
pressure warning light comes on.
When the engine is started and the oil
pressure rises slightly, the oil pressure
switch opens and the warning light
goes out. Make sure the oil level is
correct before making tests.
-
Turn ignition switch on.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Warning light on instrument panel
must light up.
-
Remove connector from oil
pressure switch.
Warning light on instrument panel
must go out.
CAUTION!
Running the engine with the oil
pressure switch disconnected may
set a fault code (DTC).
Note:
If the light does not go out, the wiring to
the switch is most likely grounded
somewhere between the switch terminal
and the warning light. See Electrical
Wiring Diagrams at rear of manual for
electrical schematics.
-
If warning light does not light
when ignition is on, remove
connector from oil pressure switch
and use a jumper wire to ground
connector terminal to a clean
metal surface.
Note:
If the warning light comes on, check the
switch as described in the next step. If
the warning light does not come on, the
wiring to the instrument cluster or to the
light itself is faulty.
-
To test switch, connect an
ohmmeter between terminal in
switch body and ground. With
engine off, there should be
continuity. With engine running,
oil pressure should open switch
and there should be no continuity.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Replace a faulty switch.
CAUTION!
Keep in mind that low oil pressure
may be preventing the switch from
turning the light out. If the light
remains on while the engine is
running, check the oil pressure as
described earlier. Do not drive the
car until the problem is corrected.
The engine may be severely
damaged.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:52 PM
Lubrication System
1 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
119-2
Oil Pan
The oil pan removal procedure requires
that the engine be supported from
above and the front suspension
subframe be unbolted and lowered
from the chassis.
Oil pan, removing and
installing (rear wheel drive
models)
-
Raise car and place securely on
jack stands.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from under
engine.
-
Drain engine oil as described in
020 Maintenance
-
Remove air filter housing complete
with mass air flow sensor.
Install engine lifting equipment at front
engine lifting point and raise
approximately 5 mm ( inch) until engine
weight is supported.
-
On cars with automatic
transmission, remove ATF cooler
line brackets from oil pan and
from transmission.
Note:
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
2 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Place drain pan under lines to catch
ATF drips.
Remove oil dipstick guide tube:
Detach mounting bolt (A) from left
engine mounting bracket.
Detach fuel lines and wiring
harness brackets (B).
Disconnect oil separator hose (C)
from base of guide tube and
remove tube from oil pan.
Note:
The guide tube is sealed in the block
using an O-ring. Check that the O-ring
comes out with the tube.
Working underneath car, remove bolts
(arrow) and lower reinforcing brace
between front suspension subframe
and body.
Note:
Reinforcement consists of a
triangulated bar for Sedan or Sport
Wagon or a reinforced plate for
Convertible or Coupe.
Separate steering column shaft from
steering rack at universal joint.
CAUTION!
In order to avoid the need for
front-end realignment, do not unbolt
power steering rack from suspension
subframe.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
3 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove power steering pump pulley.
Remove two mounting bolts from the
front (arrows)
Note:
Do not detach power steering fluid lines
from pump.
Remove third power steering mounting
bolt (arrow) and remove pump from its
mounting bracket. Use stiff wire to
suspend pump from chassis.
Detach electrical harness connector
(arrow) at oil level sensor.
Loosen top engine mount fasteners
(arrow).
Note:
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
4 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Right side is shown in photo. Left is
similar.
Loosen lower engine mount fasteners
(arrows).
Note:
Right side is shown in photo. Left is
similar.
If applicable, remove front ride level
sensor mounting bolt (arrow) and lay
sensor aside.
Remove left and right front control arm
bracket bolts (arrows) from frame rails.
Note:
Right side is shown in photo. Left is
similar.
-
Detach left and right stabilizer bar
anchors from frame rails.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
5 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove left control arm ball joint
mounting nut (arrow) at front
suspension subframe.
Drive ball joint out from subframe
using soft hammer.
Push control arm aside.
Repeat for left side.
Support suspension subframe from
below using appropriate jacking
equipment. Remove subframe
mounting bolts (arrows) and lower
subframe as far as possible.
Note:
Right side is shown in photo. Left is
similar.
Remove oil pan screws (arrows) at
cylinder block and transmission
bellhousing. Lower oil pan forward to
remove.
CAUTION!
If the oil pan does not separate
easily from the engine cylinder
block, a few taps with a rubber
mallet should break it free. Do not
pry the oil pan loose.
When installing oil pan:
Thoroughly clean all old gasket
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
6 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
material from mating surfaces and
use a new gasket.
Apply a small amount of
non-hardening sealer (3-Bond
1209® or equivalent) to oil pan
gasket directly below joints
(arrows) for end cover and front
timing case cover. Apply a bead 3
mm wide by 2 mm high.
Tighten oil pan bolts to cylinder
block evenly all around.
Tighten transmission bellhousing
bolts last.
Tightening torque
Oil drain plug to
oil pan (M12)
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Oil pan to engine block
M6, 8.8 grade
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
M6, 10.9 grade
12 Nm (106 in-lb)
Transmission bellhousing to oil pan
M8 Allen
24 Nm (17 ft-lb)
M8 Torx
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
-
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal.
Replace self-locking nuts when
reinstalling front suspension
components.
Match up key ways while installing
steering column shaft. See
320
Steering and Wheel Alignment for
more specific procedures.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
7 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Use new oil dipstick tube sealing
O-ring.
Fill engine with oil as described in
020 Maintenance.
After adding engine oil, start and
run engine. Raise engine speed to
2,500 rpm until oil pressure
warning lamp goes out (about 5
seconds).
Note:
BMW does not recommend a front end
alignment following this procedure.
Tightening torques
Control arm ball
joint to suspension
subframe
90 Nm (66 ft-lb)
Front subframe to frame rails (M12,
use new bolts)
8.8 grade
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
10.9 grade
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
12.9 grade
105 Nm (77
ft-lb)
Front end reinforcement to frame rails
or suspension subframe (M10, use
new bolts)
Initial torque
Torque angle
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
90° + 30°
Stabilizer bar to
frame rail (M8 nut)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Steering column
universal joint
clamping screw
(M8 bolt, use new
bolt)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
8 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Oil pan, removing and
installing (all wheel drive
models)
-
Raise car and place securely on
jack stands.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from under
engine.
-
Drain engine oil as described in
020 Maintenance
-
Remove air filter housing complete
with mass air flow sensor.
Install engine lifting equipment at front
engine lifting point and raise
approximately 5 mm ( inch) until engine
weight is supported.
-
Remove fuel line clamping
brackets from oil pan.
-
On cars with automatic
transmission, remove ATF cooler
line brackets from oil pan and
from transmission.
Note:
Place drain pan under lines to catch
ATF drips.
Remove oil dipstick guide tube:
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
9 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Detach mounting bolt (A) from left
engine mounting bracket.
Detach fuel lines and wiring
harness brackets (B).
Disconnect oil separator hose (C)
from base of guide tube and
remove tube from oil pan.
Note:
The guide tube is sealed in the block
using an O-ring. Check that the O-ring
comes out with the tube.
Separate steering column shaft from
steering rack at universal joint. Point
wheels straight ahead before
disconnecting shaft from rack. See
320 Steering and Wheel Alignment.
Remove power steering pump pulley.
Remove two mounting bolts from the
front (arrows).
Note:
Do not detach power steering fluid lines
from pump.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
10 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove third power steering mounting
bolt (arrow) and remove pump from its
mounting bracket. Use stiff wire to
suspend pump from chassis.
Detach electrical harness connector at
oil level sensor.
-
Remove lower engine mount
fasteners.
If applicable, remove front ride level
sensor mounting bolt (arrow) and lay
sensor aside.
Working at rear right corner of front
subframe, unhook heatshield from
subframe (arrow).
-
Detach stabilizer bar anchors from
frame rails.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
11 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove control arm rear bracket and
ball joint mounting bolts (arrows) from
subframe.
-
Remove control arms and front
drive axles as described in
310
Front Suspension.
-
Remove front differential and right
axle inner bearing pedestal as
311 Front Axle
described in
Final Drive.
Support subframe while removing four
mounting bolts (arrows).
CAUTION!
Lower subframe as far as possible
without damaging power steering
lines. Make sure it is adequately
supported throughout the remainder
of this procedure.
Remove oil pan:
Remove bellhousing bolts from oil
pan.
Remove all oil pan periphery bolts.
Remove center oil pan bolts
(arrows).
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
12 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Lower oil pan to remove.
CAUTION!
If the oil pan does not separate
easily from the engine cylinder
block, a few taps with a rubber
mallet should break it free. Do not
pry the oil pan loose.
-
When reinstalling oil pan:
Thoroughly clean all old gasket
material from mating surfaces and
use a new gasket.
Apply a small amount of
non-hardening sealer (3-Bond
1209® or equivalent) to oil pan
gasket directly below joints for end
cover and front timing case cover.
Apply a bead 3 mm wide by 2 mm
high.
Tighten oil pan bolts to cylinder
block evenly all around.
Tighten transmission bellhousing
bolts last.
Tightening torque
Oil drain plug to
oil pan (M12)
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Oil pan to engine block
M6, 8.8 grade
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
M6, 10.9 grade
12 Nm (106 in-lb)
M8, 8.8 grade
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Transmission bellhousing to oil pan
M8 Allen
24 Nm (17 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
13 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torque
M8 Torx
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Reinstall front differential and right axle
inner bearing pedestal. See
311
Front Axle Final Drive.
Fill differential to lower edge of fill
plug.
Tightening torques
Fill or drain plug to
front differential
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Front differential to
oil pan (M10)
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
-
Reinstall front axles, control arms
and front steering arms as
described in
310 Front
Suspension.
Note:
Be sure to replace seals on
differential output flanges.
Replace self-locking fasteners
when reinstalling front suspension
components.
Tightening torques
Control arm ball joint bracket to
subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Control arm mounting bracket to
subframe
M10 bolt (always
replace)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
When reattaching engine to subframe,
be sure that left engine mount locating
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
14 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
tab (arrow) is seated correctly in
subframe slot.
Tightening torques
Engine mount to subframe
M10 self-locking
nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Front of subframe to frame rail (M12
bolt, always replace)
8.8 grade
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
10.9 grade
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
12.9 grade
105 Nm (77
ft-lb)
Rear of subframe to mounting
adapter
M12 bolt (always
replace)
-
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal.
Match up key ways while installing
320
steering column shaft. See
Steering and Wheel Alignment for
more specific procedures.
Use new oil dipstick tube sealing
O-ring.
Fill engine with oil as described in
020 Maintenance.
After adding engine oil, start and
run engine. Raise engine speed to
2,500 rpm until oil pressure
warning lamp goes out (about 5
seconds).
Note:
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
15 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Be sure to align the front end after this
procedure.
Tightening torques
Stabilizer bar to
frame rail (M8 nut)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Steering column
universal joint
clamping screw
(M8 bolt, use new
bolt)-
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
All wheel drive oil
pan, front
differential and
front subframe
assembly
1
- Front subframe
1a - Right engine
mounting point
1b - Left engine
mounting point
2
- Right axle inner
bearing pedestal
3
- Sealing O-ring
4
- Oil pan
5
- Bolt M12
(always replace)
8.8 grade tighten to
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
10.9 grade tighten
to 110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
16 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
12.9 grade tighten
to 105 Nm (77 ft-lb)
6
- Bolt M12
(always replace)
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
7
- Bolt M10
(always replace)
tighten to 59 Nm (44
ft-lb)
8
- Bolt M10
(always replace)
tighten to 59 Nm (44
ft-lb)
9
- Bolt M12
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
10 - Front control
arm with ball
joint and rear
mounting
bracket
11 - Front
differential
12 - Bolt M10
tighten to 45 Nm (33
ft-lb)
13 - Left front axle
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
119-3
Component
Replacement
Oil pressure warning switch
The pressure warning switch is located
under the intake manifold, in the rear of
the oil filter housing.
Note:
Switch removal may require intake
manifold removal.
Tightening torque
Oil pressure switch
to oil filter housing
27 Nm (20 ft-lb)
Oil level warning switch
The oil level warning switch is located
at the bottom of the engine oil pan.
Note:
Anytime the oil level warning switch is
removed, be sure to replace the sealing
O-ring between switch and oil pan.
Oil pump, removing and
installing
Note:
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Oil pump removal requires lowering the
front suspension subframe to remove
the oil pan.
-
Drain oil as described in
Maintenance.
020
-
Remove oil pan as described
earlier.
Remove oil pump sprocket mounting
nut (left-hand thread) (arrow). Lift
sprocket off together with drive chain.
Remove mounting bolts from oil pump
(7) and oil pump pickup tube (12).
Withdraw pump.
1 - Drive chain
2 - Nut M10x1left-hand thread
-tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
3 - Oil pump sprocket
4 - Inner rotor
5 - Outer rotor
6 - Oil pressure relief valve assembly
7 - Bolt M8 -tighten to 22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
8 - Oil pump housing
9 - Locating dowels
10 - Sealing O-ring
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
11 - Oil pick-up pipe
12 - Bolt M6 -tighten to 10 Nm (89
in-lb)
-
On engines with integrated oil
pump and oil scraper: Remove oil
pump with scraper.
-
On engines with separate oil
pump and scraper:
First remove mounting bolts and
withdraw oil pump intake pipe.
Remove oil pump mounting bolts.
Remove oil pump assembly.
Note:
Note any spacers between pump
and engine block.
Note positions of locating dowels.
-
Remove cover from oil pump and
check for wear or scoring. Spin oil
pump shaft and check that gears
turn smoothly. Replace pump if
gears spin with difficulty or any
wear is present.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Align sprocket splines to oil pump
shaft splines before tightening
sprocket nut.
Tightening torques
Oil drain plug to oil
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Lubrication System
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
pan (M12)
Oil pan to engine block
M6, 8.8 grade
M6, 10.9 grade
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
12 Nm (106
in-lb)
M8, 8.8 grade
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Oil pump to engine
block (M8)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Oil pump sprocket to oil pump shaft
M10x1 left-hand
thread
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Transmission bellhousing to oil pan
M8 Allen
24 Nm (17 ft-lb)
M8 Torx
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Oil pump pressure relief valve
The oil pump pressure relief valve is
held in the side of the oil pump with a
circlip.
1 - Control plunger
2 - Spring
3 - Sealing O-ring
4 - Sleeve
5 - Circlip
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:53 PM
Ignition System
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
120-1
General
This repair group covers component
replacement information for the ignition
system.
When diagnosing engine management
problems, including on-board
diagnostics (OBD II) fault code
analysis, also refer to these repair
groups:
100 Engine–General
130 Fuel Injection
Electrical Wiring Diagrams at the
rear of this manual
OBD On Board Diagnostics at
the rear of this manual
Special tools
Owing to the coil-per-cylinder
configuration, system diagnosis and
testing requires special test equipment.
LED test light Baum 1115 (Source:
Baum Tools Unlimited)
Automotive digital multimeter Fluke 87
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Primary voltage test harness BMW 12 7
020
Secondary voltage test harness BMW
12 7 030
Ignition coil test adapters BMW 12 7
040
Engine management
BMW E46 engines use an advanced
engine management system known as
Digital Motor Electronics (DME). DME
incorporates on-board diagnostics, fuel
injection, ignition and other engine
control functions. DME variants are
Table a.
listed in
Second generation On-Board
Diagnostics (OBD II) is incorporated
into the engine management systems
used on the cars covered by this
manual. Using a BMW-specific
electronic scan tool, it is possible to
access Diagnostic Trouble Codes
(DTCs) that pinpoint ignition and other
engine management problems.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Additional information about DTCs and
engine management system electronic
system diagnosis is provided in
OBD
On Board Diagnostics at the rear of this
manual.
Table a. Engine management
systems
Year:
Engine
DME system
1999 - 2000:
M52 TU B25
M52 TU B28
Siemens MS 42.0
2001:
M54 B25
M54 B30
Siemens MS 43.0
Ignition system
All engines use a distributorless
ignition system with individual ignition
coils for each cylinder. There is no
distributor cap or ignition rotor.
Each coil can be controlled by the
Engine Control Module (ECM) on a
cylinder-by-cylinder basis.
Note:
Schematic diagram of ignition coil
circuit is for MS 42.0 engine
management system. On MS 43.0
system, ignition coil terminal 3 receives
power from Fuse 1 (30 amp). See
Electrical Wiring Diagrams for specific
wiring information.
WARNING!
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Do not touch or disconnect any
cables from the coils while the
engine is running or being
cranked by the starter.
The ignition system produces
high voltages that can be fatal.
Avoid contact with exposed
terminals. Use extreme caution
when working on a car with the
ignition switched on or the
engine running.
Connect and disconnect the
DME system wiring and test
equipment leads only when the
ignition is OFF.
Before operating the starter
without starting the engine (for
example when making a
compression test) always
disable the ignition.
Knock sensors (arrows) monitor the
combustion chamber for enginedamaging knock. Two sensors monitor
three cylinders each. If engine knock is
detected, the ignition point is retarded
by the ECM.
Note:
When knock is detected, ignition timing
will be retarded at the selective
cylinder(s) by 3° increments. If knock is
no longer detected, the timing will be
advanced in 1° increments.
Ignition timing is electronically mapped
and not adjustable. The ECM uses
engine load, engine speed, coolant
temperature, knock detection and
intake air temperature as the basic
inputs for timing control. A three
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
dimensional map similar to the one
shown is digitally stored in the ECM.
The initial ignition point is determined
by the crankshaft speed sensor during
cranking. Once the engine is running,
timing is continually adjusted based on
operating conditions.
Basic troubleshooting
principles
Poor driveability may have a variety of
causes. The fault may lie with the
ignition system, the fuel system, parts
of the emission control system, or a
combination of the three. Because of
these interrelated functions and their
effects on each other, it is often difficult
to know where to begin looking for
problems.
For this reason, effective
troubleshooting should always begin
with an interrogation of the On-Board
Diagnostics (OBD II) system. The OBD
II system detects engine management
malfunctions. When faults are
detected, the OBD II system stores a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) in the
Engine Control Module (ECM) along
with other pertinent fault information. In
addition, the Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL) will come on if an emissions
related fault is detected. Additional
OBD II information, including a DTC
lookup table can be found in the back
OBD On Board
of this manual under
Diagnostics.
Note:
On model year 1999 and 2000 cars, the
MIL is labeled Check Engine. On model
year 2001 cars, the MIL is labeled
Service Engine Soon.
An engine that starts and runs
indicates that the ignition system is
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
fundamentally working-delivering
voltage to the spark plugs. A
hard-starting or poor-running engine,
however, may indicate a problem with
how well the spark is delivered. Faulty
or worn ignition components, such as
old spark plugs, or an individual coil
problem may be the cause.
WARNING!
Inefficient combustion (rich air/fuel
mixture) can cause elevated
hydrocarbon exhaust emissions and
catalytic converter damage. For this
reason, if a severe misfire is
detected, the fuel injector will be
turned off to the specific cylinder
and the MIL illuminated.
One way to diagnose a faulty coil on a
car that is running is to use an
oscilloscope to analyze spark quality.
The illustrations show normal scope
trace of spark at idle.
Table b lists common ignition coil
voltage faults and related causes.
Note:
Note the length of sparking period and
the up-down voltage attenuations. A
short sparking period and/or an
irregular/low voltage attenuation usually
indicates a faulty coil.
A normal oscilloscope pattern for a six
cylinder engine.
1 - Start of ignition voltage peak
2 - Level of ignition voltage
3 - Level of combustion voltage
4 - Period of combustion
5 - Combustion curve characteristics
6 - Start of decay process
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
7 - Termination oscillations
Note:
See
Ignition coil assembly, testing
and replacing as described later.
Table b. Ignition trace diagnostics
Parameter
Ignition
voltage
low
Ignition
voltage
high
Spark plug
electrode
gap
too small too big
Spark plug
electrode
condition
-
worn/burnt
Spark plug
electrode
temperature
too high
too low
Engine
compression
too low
too high
Spark plug
wire(s)
-
faulty
Fuel air
mixture
-
too lean
Misfire detection
Engine misfire, the result of inefficient
combustion in one or more cylinders,
may be caused by a variety of
malfunctions in various subsystems.
The OBD II system incorporated into
the MS 42.0 and MS 43.0 engine
management systems is designed to
detect and warn of misfire faults during
engine operation. Misfire fault codes
are listed in
Table c. Misfire fault
codes. For a detailed list of fault codes
see
OBD On Board Diagnostics.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Once engine misfire has been detected
and the fault codes downloaded from
the ECM, it is necessary to follow a
diagnostic path to correct the problem.
The ignition subset of the diagnostic
path is shown in
Table d. Ignition
system problems
Table c. Misfire fault codes
P code
BMW
fault
code
Fault code
Possible cause(s)
P0301
238
Misfire cylinder 1
P0302
239
Misfire cylinder 2
P0303
240
Misfire cylinder 3
P0304
241
Misfire cylinder 4
P0305
242
Misfire cylinder 5
P0306
243
Misfire cylinder 6
Ignition fault: Defective or incorrect spark plug(s)
or connector(s); defective ignition coil(s)
Mechanical fault: Crankshaft pulse wheel loose
or damaged; damaged piston(s), valve(s) or
camshaft(s); oil pressure low
Catalyst fault: Excessive exhaust backpressure
due to restricted catalyst
Fuel supply fault: Contaminated fuel; fuel
delivery fault (blocked filter, low fuel in tank,
defective fuel pump); running loss system fault;
leaking or blocked fuel injector(s); fuel pressure
regulator fault; evaporative system fault
ECM/sensor input fault: Implausible sensor
signal; oxygen sensor(s) faulty; ECM faulty
P1396
244
Crankshaft sensor
adaptation at limit
Misfire detection fault: Varying pulse wheel
tolerances or loose pulse wheel
Table d. Ignition system problems
Component
Condition
Test
Repair
Spark plug
Incorrect spark plug
Electrode gap too
small
Electrode(s) missing
Oil or fuel fouled
spark plug
Ceramic insulation
cracked
Inspect spark plugs.
Verify correct spark
plugs.
Replace plugs if
defective.
Check crankcase
ventilation and oil
level.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Component
Condition
Test
Repair
Secondary circuit
Wet coil
Corroded coil
connections
Secondary circuit
Check for water leak.
Check resistance
values (see
Table
e).
Ignition coil
Primary or secondary
circuit on or shorted
Housing cracked,
damaged
Primary and
secondary circuits
Table e)
(see
Replace coil as
necessary.
Ignition coil harness
connector
Power supply,
primary control circuit
or ground (shunt
signal) circuits
impaired
Primary ignition and
terminal 4A feedback
preset measurements
Look for open, loose
connector, corrosion,
crossed or damaged
connector pins.
Inspect ignition
unloader relay.
Replace coils as
necessary.
Warnings and cautions
The engine management system
contains sensitive electronic components.
To protect the system and for general
safety, the following warnings and
cautions should be observed during
ignition system troubleshooting,
maintenance or repair work.
WARNING!
Do not touch or disconnect any
cables from the coils while the
engine is running or being
cranked by the starter.
The ignition system produces
high voltages that can be fatal.
Avoid contact with exposed
terminals. Use extreme caution
when working on a car with the
ignition switched on or the engine
running.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connect and disconnect the DME
system wiring and test equipment
leads only when the ignition is
OFF.
Before operating the starter
without starting the engine (for
example when making a
compression test) always disable
the ignition.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Do not attempt to disable the
ignition by removing the coils
from the spark plugs.
Connect or disconnect ignition
system wires, multiple wire
connectors, and ignition test
equipment leads only while the
ignition is off. Switch multimeter
functions or measurement ranges
only with the test probes
disconnected.
Do not disconnect the battery
while the engine is running.
A high impedance digital
multimeter should be used for all
voltage and resistance tests. An
LED test light should be used in
place of an incandescent-type test
lamp.
In general, make test connections
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
only as specified by BMW, as
described in this manual, or as
described by the instrument
manufacturer.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
1 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
120-2
Ignition System Service
Ignition firing order
Each ignition coil is mounted above the
corresponding spark plug. Cylinder 1 is
at the front of the engine.
Ignition firing order
M52 TU/M54
engine
1-5-3-6-24
Disabling ignition system
The ignition system operates in a lethal
voltage range and should therefore be
disabled any time engine service or
repair work is being done that requires
the ignition to be switched on.
The engine management system can be
disabled by removing the DME main
relay (arrow). The relay is located in the
electronics box (E-box) in the left rear of
the engine compartment.
CAUTION!
Relay locations may vary. Use care
when identifying relays. The main
relay has a large (4 mm 2) red wire at
terminal 30 and a large (4 mm 2)
red/white wire at terminal 87. See
610 Electrical Component Locations.
Checking for spark
CAUTION!
If a spark test is done incorrectly,
damage to the Engine Control Module
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
2 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
(ECM) or the ignition coils may result.
Note:
Spark plug replacement is covered in
020 Maintenance.
Checking for spark is difficult on
engines with distributorless ignition
systems.
Try removing the spark plugs and
inspecting for differences between
them. A poor-firing plug may be wet
with fuel and/or black and sooty, but not
always. If a coil is not operating, the
engine management system will
electrically disable the fuel injector to
that cylinder. The key is to look for
differences between cylinders.
Ignition coil assembly, testing
and replacing
CAUTION!
Use a digital multimeter for the
following tests.
Remove interior ventilation microfilter.
Remove housing for microfilter for
interior ventilation.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
3 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
-
Remove plastic engine cover from
top of valve cover by prying off bolt
covers and removing cover
mounting bolts.
Disconnect harness connector from coil.
Connect multimeter between terminal
15 (+) in connector and ground.
-
Turn ignition on and check for
battery voltage.
If battery voltage is not present,
check wire between terminal 15
and ignition switch. See Electrical
Wiring Diagrams.
CAUTION!
The wiring to terminal 15 (+) of the
coil (via the ignition switch) is not
fuse protected. Use care when testing
this circuit.
-
Turn ignition off.
Remove coil and inspect coil housing
for hairline cracks or leaking casting
material. A leaky ignition coil may
indicate a faulty Engine Control Module
(ECM). Check ECM before installing a
new coil.
CAUTION!
Note location of coil ground straps
before coil removal; reinstall in the
same location.
-
Use a multimeter to test:
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
4 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Coil primary resistance at coil
terminals
Spark plug connector resistance
Compare results to specification in
Table e.
Table e. Ignition coil resistance
Component Terminals Resistance
Coil primary
1 (-) and
15 (+)
Coil
secondary
approx. 0.8
N.A.
Spark plug
connector
Bosch
1k
Beru
1.8 k
20%
-
20%
Replace ignition coil or spark plug
connector if resistance readings do
not meet specifications.
Remove ignition coil to be tested.
Install BMW special tool 12 7 030
(A) on coil to be tested.
Connect ground jumper between
coil mounting point and engine
ground point (B).
Clip scope high pick-up lead (C)
around ignition lead.
Start engine.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
5 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Compare scope pattern with
diagrams in
Basic
troubleshooting principles.
Note:
When replacing ignition coils, ensure
that the replacements are from the same
manufacturer with the same part/code
numbers. If individual coils with the
correct specifications are not available,
all coils should be replaced.
Crankshaft speed sensor,
replacing
The crankshaft speed sensor is
mounted in the left rear side of the
cylinder block below the starter. The
sensor reads a toothed pulse wheel
(arrow) mounted to the end of the
crankshaft.
If the Engine Control Module (ECM)
does not receive a signal from the
crankshaft speed sensor during
cranking, the engine will not start.
If the OBD II system misfire detection
protocol detects a catalyst damaging
fault due to a malfunction in crankshaft
speed sensor components, the Check
Engine light (Malfunction Indicator Light
or MIL) will be illuminated.
Note:
If the crankshaft speed sensor pulse
wheel is damaged, the engine will have
to be disassembled down to the
crankshaft to replace the wheel.
-
Make certain ignition has been
turned off.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
6 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Raise car and support in a safe
manner.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove under-engine splash
guards.
Working just underneath starter:
Cut off wire tie securing crankshaft
speed sensor harness connector
(arrow) to sensor.
Disconnect harness connector.
Remove sensor mounting screw (arrow)
and remove sensor from cylinder block.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Use a new O-ring when installing
sensor.
Be sure wiring is rerouted in same
orientation.
Secure sensor using new wire ties.
Use scan tool to read out and clear
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
7 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
ECM fault memory.
Camshaft position sensors
The camshaft position sensors are used
by the engine management system for
VANOS control, sequential fuel injection
and knock control.
Intake camshaft position
sensor, replacing
-
Make certain ignition has been
turned off.
-
Remove housing for the microfilter
for interior ventilation as shown
earlier.
-
Remove plastic cover from above
fuel injectors by prying off bolt
covers and removing cover
mounting bolts.
Remove complete air filter housing:
Disconnect electrical harness
connector on mass air flow sensor
(B).
Detach vacuum line at intake boot
(A).
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (D).
Loosen hose clamp at intake boot
and detach air duct connections
(C).
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
8 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Disconnect cold air duct tube (E).
-
Disconnect harness connector
from VANOS solenoid and unscrew
solenoid from VANOS control unit.
Be prepared with shop rags to
catch oil released from VANOS
unit.
Remove camshaft sensor (arrow) from
left front of cylinder head, next to top of
oil filter housing.
-
Disconnect camshaft sensor
harness from under intake
manifold. Prior to removal, attach a
stiff piece of wire to the harness
connector end to preserve proper
routing of harness for
reinstallation.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Use new O-rings when installing
sensor and solenoid.
Be sure wiring is rerouted in same
orientation.
Use scan tool to read out and clear
ECM fault memory.
Tightening torques
Intake camshaft
sensor to cylinder
head
5 Nm (3.5 ft-lb)
VANOS solenoid to
VANOS control unit
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
Exhaust camshaft position
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
9 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
sensor, replacing
-
Make certain ignition has been
turned off.
Working at front of engine on exhaust
(right) side, detach exhaust camshaft
position sensor electrical harness
connector (arrow).
-
Remove camshaft sensor from
right front of cylinder head.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Use a new O-ring when installing
sensor.
Be sure wiring is rerouted in same
orientation.
Use scan tool to read out and clear
ECM fault memory.
Tightening torque
Exhaust camshaft
sensor to cylinder
head
5 Nm (3.5 ft-lb)
Knock sensors, replacing
The knock sensors are bolted to the left
side of the cylinder block under the
intake manifold.
-
Remove intake manifold as
described in
113 Cylinder Head
Removal and Installation.
Disconnect knock sensor electrical
harness connector (arrow) on left side
of engine cylinder block.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Ignition System
10 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove knock sensor mounting
bolts (A) on side of cylinder block.
Remove sensors.
CAUTION!
Note the installed angle of the knock
sensor on the block before removing
it. Reinstall the sensor in the same
position. Be sure to use a torque
wrench when tightening the sensor
mounting bolt.
Clean knock sensor contact surface on
engine block and sensor (arrows)
before installing knock sensor.
Tightening torque
Knock sensor to
cylinder block
-
20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs.)
Use scan tool to read out and clear
ECM fault memory.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:54 PM
Fuel Injection
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
130-1
General
This repair group covers service and
repair for the Siemens engine
management systems used on the E46
models covered by this manual.
Additional engine management
information may also be found in the
following repair groups:
100 Engine–General
120 Ignition System
160 Fuel Tank and Fuel Pump
Electrical Wiring Diagrams
Note:
Fuel pressure testing and fuel pump
160
repair information is covered in
Fuel Tank and Fuel Pump.
Table a. Engine management
systems
Model Year:
Engine code
DME system
1999 - 2000:
M52 TU B25
M52 TU B28
Siemens MS 42.0
2001:
M54 B25
M54 B30
Siemens MS 43.0
The Siemens systems are
sophisticated self-diagnosing OBD II
systems. These systems continuously
monitor components and record and
store valuable diagnostic information.
When faults arise, or if the MIL
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
(malfunction indicator lamp) in the
instrument cluster is illuminated, begin
troubleshooting by hooking up a
BMW-compatible scan tool. The rich
diagnostic capabilities of these systems
have the potential to save hours of
diagnostic time, incorrect component
replacement and possible damage to
system components. See
OBD On
Board Diagnostics at the back of this
manual.
Tools and test equipment
If the equipment required to do the job
is unavailable, it is recommended that
these repairs be left to an authorized
BMW dealer or other qualified BMW
repair facility.
Fuel pressure gauge Baum 1318
(Source: Baum Tools Unlimited)
Automotive digital multimeter Fluke 87
Low current test light (“noid”) Baum
1115a (Source: Baum Tools Unlimited)
Factory DTC scan tool BMW
DIS/MoDiC
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Fuel line plugs BMW 13 5 281 / 13 5
282
Aftermarket DTC scan tool Baum
CS2000 (Source: Baum Tools
Unlimited)
Fuel line clamp BMW 13 3 010
Fuel rail to pressure gauge fitting BMW
13 5 220
Note:
Professional diagnostic scan tools
available at the time of this
printing include the BMW factory
tools (DISplus and MoDiC) and a
small number of aftermarket
BMW-specific tools. The `CS2000'
from Baum Tools Unlimited, the
`Retriever' from Assenmacher
Specialty Tools, and the MT2500
from Snap-on are three examples
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
of quality OBD scan tools.
In addition to the BMW
professional line of scan tools,
there are many inexpensive
`generic' OBD II scan tool software
programs and handheld units
available. Although these tools
have limited capabilities as
compared to the dedicated tools,
they are powerful diagnostic tools.
These tools read live data
streams, freeze frame information
for DTCs (diagnostic trouble
codes) and impending DTCs, as
well as a host of other valuable
diagnostic data.
For the DIY owner, simple
aftermarket DTC readers are also
available. These inexpensive
BMW-only tools are capable of
checking for DTCs as well as
turning off the illuminated MIL, and
resetting the service indicator
lights.
See
020 Maintenance for
specialty tool manufacturer contact
information.
Principle of operation
The DME fuel injection system is
completely electronic in operation.
Intake air, engine coolant temperature,
crank and camshaft positions, engine
speed and many other engine
operating parameters are measured
electronically and the information is
supplied to the engine control module
(ECM).
Based on input information, the ECM
controls the ignition coils, fuel injectors,
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
motor driven throttle valve, double
VANOS system, radiator cooling fan,
electrically heated thermostat, as well
as other outputs.
The illustration on the following page
shows the MS 42.0 ECM inputs and
outputs. The MS 43.0 system is similar
in operation, with the main difference
being the fully electronic `drive-by-wire'
throttle valve. Additional system
operational information can be found
in
100 Engine–General.
DME MS 42.0
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Warnings and cautions
For personal safety, as well as the
protection of sensitive electronic
components, adhere to the warnings and
cautions on the following pages.
WARNING!
Gasoline is highly flammable and
its vapors are explosive. Do not
smoke or work on a car near
heaters or other fire hazards when
diagnosing and repairing fuel
system problems. Have a fire
extinguisher available in case of
an emergency.
When working on an open fuel
system, wear suitable hand
protection, as prolonged contact
with fuel can cause illnesses and
skin disorders.
The ignition system produces
high voltages that can be fatal.
Avoid contact with exposed
terminals. Use extreme caution
when working on a car with the
ignition switched on or the engine
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
running.
Do not touch or disconnect any
cables from the coils while the
engine is running or being
cranked by the starter.
Connect and disconnect the DME
system wiring and test equipment
leads only when the ignition is
switched off.
Renew fuel system hoses, clamps
and O-rings any time they are
removed.
Before making any electrical tests
that require the engine to be
cranked using the starter, disable
the ignition system as described
in
120 Ignition System.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Do not connect any test
equipment that delivers a 12-volt
power supply to terminal 15 (+) of
the ignition coil. The current flow
may damage the ECM. In general,
connect test equipment only as
specified by BMW, or the
equipment maker.
Only use a digital multimeter for
electrical tests.
Only use an LED test light for
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
quick tests.
Disconnecting the battery may
erase fault code(s) stored in
memory. Check for fault codes
prior to disconnecting the battery
cables.
Wait at least 40 seconds after
turning off the ignition before
removing the engine control
module (ECM) connector. If the
connector is removed before this
time, residual power in the system
relay may damage the control
module.
Cleanliness is essential when
working on an open fuel system.
Thoroughly clean fuel line
connections and surrounding
areas before loosening. Avoid
moving the car. Only install clean
parts.
Fuel system cleaners and other
chemical additives other than
those specifically recommended
by BMW may damage the catalytic
converter, the oxygen sensor or
other fuel supply components.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
130-2
Electrical Checks and
Component Testing
Troubleshooting and fault diagnosis on
OBD II cars is best performed using an
electronic scan tool. However, it may
be necessary to perform basic tests of
the engine management main
components, fuel system or wiring.
CAUTION!
The tests in this section may set
fault codes (DTCs) in the ECM
and illuminate the MIL. After all
testing tests is completed,
access and clear DTC fault
memory using a BMW
compatible scan tool. See
OBD On Board Diagnostics at
the back of this manual.
Only use a digital multimeter for
electrical tests.
Relay positions can vary. Be
sure to confirm relay position by
identifying the wiring in the
socket using the wiring
diagrams found at the rear of
this manual.
DME main relay, testing
The DME main relay is energized via
the engine control module (ECM) and
supplies battery positive (B+) power to
many of the engine management
components and subsystems. If this
relay is faulty, the engine will not start.
With ignition off, remove main relay
(arrow) in electronics box (E-box) at
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
left rear of engine compartment.
Check for voltage at terminal 6 of main
relay socket (30- red wire).
If battery voltage is present
continue testing.
If battery voltage is not present,
check large red wire in relay
socket. See Electrical Wiring
Diagrams.
-
Reinstall relay and turn ignition
on. Gain access to underside of
relay socket and check for ground
at terminal 4 (85- brown/white
wire).
If ground is present continue
testing.
If ground is not present, signal
from ECM (connector X60002, pin
23) is missing. Check wire
between ECM and relay.
-
With ignition on and relay
installed, check for battery voltage
at terminal 2 (87- red/white wire).
If battery voltage is present, relay
has energized and is functioning
correctly.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
If battery voltage is not present
and all earlier tests are OK, relay
is faulty and should be replaced.
Fuel pump relay, testing
The ECM energizes the fuel pump
relay by providing the coil side of the
relay with ground. During starting, the
fuel pump runs as long as the ignition
switch is in the start position and
continues to run once the engine
starts. If the relay is faulty the fuel
pump will not run.
Fuel pump relay (arrow) is located
behind glove compartment. Remove
glove compartment. See
513 Interior
Trim.
-
Remove fuel pump relay from
socket.
With ignition in START position, check
for battery voltage at relay connector
(X10156) terminals 6 and 8 (red/violet
andred/white wires).
CAUTION!
Ensure that manual transmission
vehicles are not in gear, and
automatic transmission vehicles are
in Park or Neutral prior to operating
ignition in START position.
-
With ignition in START position,
use digital multimeter to check for
ground at terminal 4 (black/violet
wire).
Note:
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
The ground at terminal 4 is switched by
the ECM. The ECM harness must be
connected to check the switched ground
connection.
-
If no faults are found up to this
point, turn ignition key off. Using a
fused (14 gauge) jumper wire,
connect relay connector terminal 6
to terminal 2. The fuel pump
should run.
If pump runs and all other tests
are as specified, fuel pump relay
is probably faulty.
If pump does not run, test fuel
pump operation as described in
160 Fuel Tank and Fuel Pump.
CAUTION!
The jumper wire should be 1.5 mm2
(14 ga.) and include an in-line fuse
holder with a 15 amp fuse. To avoid
fuse/relay panel damage from
repeated connecting and
disconnecting, also include a toggle
switch.
Fuel delivery and fuel pressure
Checking fuel delivery volume and fuel
pressure is a fundamental part of
troubleshooting and diagnosing the
engine management system. Fuel
pressure directly influences fuel
delivery. Procedures for measuring the
fuel pressure and fuel volume are
given in
160 Fuel Tank and Fuel
Pump.
Relieving fuel pressure
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
The fuel system retains fuel pressure in
the system when the engine is turned
off. To prevent fuel from spraying on a
hot engine, system fuel pressure
should be relieved before
disconnecting fuel lines. One method
is to tightly wrap a shop towel around a
fuel line fitting and loosen or
disconnect the fitting.
Cleanliness is essential when working
with fuel circuit components.
Thoroughly clean the unions before
disconnecting fuel lines.
WARNING!
Gasoline is highly flammable
and its vapors are explosive. Do
not smoke or work on a car near
heaters or other fire hazards
when diagnosing and repairing
fuel system problems. Have a
fire extinguisher available in
case of an emergency.
When working on an open fuel
system, wear suitable hand
protection. Prolonged contact
with fuel can cause illnesses
and skin disorders.
Remove interior ventilation microfilter
housing.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
move wiring out of way.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove fuel rail cover by prying off nut
covers (arrows) and removing nuts.
Unscrew schræder valve cap (arrow)
from fuel rail. Unscrew fuel tank cap to
release pressure to vent tank.
-
Using a brief burst of compressed
air (maximum of 3 bar or 43.5 psi)
blow fuel back through return line
into fuel tank.
WARNING!
Fuel in fuel line is under
pressure (approx. 3 - 5 bar or 45
-75 psi) and may be expelled
under pressure. Do not smoke or
work near heaters or other fire
hazards. Keep a fire
extinguisher handy. Before
disconnecting fuel hoses, wrap
a cloth around fuel hoses to
absorb any leaking fuel. Catch
and dispose of escaped fuel.
Plug all open fuel lines.
Always unscrew fuel tank cap to
release pressure in the tank
before working on the tank or
lines.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
1 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
130-3
Component
Replacement
After diagnosing and replacing a faulty
engine management component, be
sure to use a BMW-compatible scan
tool to check and clear the fault
memory in the ECM. Diagnostic trouble
codes are given in
OBD On Board
Diagnostics at the back of this book.
Fuel rail and injectors,
removing and installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Remove housing for microfilter for
interior ventilation.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove fuel rail cover by prying off nut
covers (arrows) and removing nuts.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
2 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Working above engine, disconnect
electrical harness connectors:
VANOS control unit harness
connector (A)
Connectors for oxygen sensors
(B)
Connector for intake air
temperature sensor (C)
CAUTION!
Mark oxygen sensor harness
connectors in order to avoid
reversing them during installation.
Incorrect reconnection can cause
serious engine damage.
Disconnect fuel injector electrical
connectors from injectors:
Use small screwdriver to pry one
corner of wire lock clip on fuel
injector 1 connector.
Repeat for all injectors.
Lift off connector loom and set
aside.
Unscrew schræder valve cap (arrow)
from fuel rail. Unscrew fuel tank cap to
release pressure to vent tank.
-
Using a brief burst of compressed
air (maximum of 3 bar or 43.5 psi)
blow fuel back through return line
into fuel tank.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
3 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
WARNING!
Do not smoke or work near
heaters or other fire hazards.
Keep a fire extinguisher handy.
Before disconnecting fuel
hoses, wrap a cloth around fuel
hoses to absorb any leaking
fuel. Catch and dispose of
escaped fuel. Plug all open fuel
lines.
Always unscrew the fuel tank
cap to release pressure in the
tank before working on the tank
or lines.
-
Raise car and support in a safe
manner.
CAUTION!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove protective engine splash
guard.
Working beneath car (on left side
under driver seat), remove fuel filter
cover and clamp off fuel hose(s).
Note:
MS 42.0 vehicle shown. Fuel line
arrangement on MS 43.0 vehicles
varies from that shown. The MS 43.0
system uses a non-return fuel rail. Only
a single fuel line leads to the engine
compartment.
Disconnect fuel hose(s) from fuel
line(s) (arrows) using special fuel line
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
4 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
removal tool 16 1 050 or equivalent.
Seal off fuel line(s) with BMW special
tools 13 5 281/13 5 282.
CAUTION!
Fuel may be expelled under
pressure. Do not smoke or work near
heaters or other fire hazards. Keep a
fire extinguisher handy. Before
disconnecting fuel hoses, wrap a
cloth around fuel hoses to absorb
any leaking fuel. Plug all open fuel
lines.
Remove fuel rail mounting bolts
(arrows).
Carefully pry fuel rail off manifold.
Separate fuel line support bracket
at rear of intake manifold.
Guide fuel line(s) out of rear of
engine compartment while lifting
fuel rail out.
Remove individual injectors:
Pry retaining clip from injector (1).
Pull injector from rail (2).
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Fit new O-rings when installing
injectors. For ease of installation,
lightly lubricate all fuel system
O-rings with assembly lubricant.
Check that injector electrical
connections are correctly fitted
and that injectors are fully seated
prior to installing fuel rail mounting
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
5 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
bolts.
Replace any wire ties removed
during removal procedure.
CAUTION!
Replace any flexible fuel lines which
were pinched shut during testing.
Fuel pressure regulator,
replacing
E46 fuel pressure regulator
location
DME MS 42.0
under left side of
car, in 3/2-way
valve
DME MS 43.0
under left side of
car, in fuel filter
On models with DME MS 43.0, the fuel
pressure regulator (arrow) is an integral
part of the fuel filter. Fuel filter
replacement procedure is covered in
020 Maintenance.
DME MS 42.0: Working under car
below driver's seat, remove protective
cover from below fuel pressure
regulator (arrow).
-
Disconnect vacuum hose (A) from
fuel pressure regulator.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
6 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Remove locking spring clip
retaining fuel pressure regulator.
-
Wrap a shop rag around
regulator, then remove regulator
from 3/2 way valve by pulling
straight down.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace sealing O-rings.
Mass air flow (MAF) sensor,
removing and installing
CAUTION!
Be sure the ignition is OFF before
replacing DME system components.
Loosen hose clamp (A) and pull intake
air duct from mass air flow (MAF)
sensor.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector (B) and unclip fasteners
(C).
-
Remove sensor. Inspect protective
screen in sensor housing. Replace
sensor if screen is damaged.
-
Inspect air intake ducting for
damage and cracks. Replace
rubber parts as necessary.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace sealing O-ring between
sensor and air filter housing.
Note:
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
7 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
No adjustment to air flow sensor is
possible.
Engine coolant temperature
(ECT) sensor, replacing
The engine coolant temperature (ECT)
sensor is located toward the rear of the
cylinder head below intake runner no.
6. Intake manifold removal is required
to access the ECT sensor.
CAUTION!
Be sure the ignition is OFF before
replacing DME system components.
-
Remove intake manifold as
110 Engine
described in
Removal and Installation.
WARNING!
Due to risk of personal injury, be
sure the engine is cold before
beginning the removal procedure.
Working at rear of cylinder head,
disconnect harness connector (arrow)
from ECT sensor.
-
Remove sensor. Catch any
coolant that leaks out with shop
rags.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Use a new copper sealing washer
when installing new sensor.
Replace lost coolant.
Tightening torque
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
8 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torque
ECT sensor to
cylinder head
13 Nm (10 ft-lb)
Intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, replacing
The intake air temperature (IAT) sensor
is located at the top center of the intake
manifold. The intake air temperature
sensor functions to adapt or fine tune
the fuel mixture and engine timing
based on varying intake air
temperatures.
Remove housing for microfilter for
interior ventilation.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove fuel rail cover by prying off
plastic covers (arrows) and removing
nuts.
Remove electrical harness connector
(arrow) from IAT sensor.
CAUTION!
Be sure the ignition is OFF.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
9 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Depress locking clip on side of
temperature sensor and pull
straight out of intake manifold.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Use a new sealing O-ring at base
of sensor and lubricate with
assembly lubricant for ease of
installation.
Throttle assembly, removing
and installing
Some throttle assembly faults will reset
the engine control module (ECM)
adaptation values. BMW's diagnostic
tool (DIS or MoDiC) or aftermarket
equivalent tool is necessary to reset
ECM adaptations after throttle
assembly replacement.
CAUTION!
After replacement of the throttle
valve assembly, and/or on MS 43.0
systems the pedal position sensor,
an adaption procedure must be
performed using the factory scan
tool or equivalent. The vehicle will
not start unless this adaption
procedure is carried out.
Disconnect battery negative (-) cable in
luggage compartment.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Remove complete air filter housing:
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
10 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Disconnect vacuum line at intake
boot (A).
Disconnect electrical harness
connector on mass air flow sensor
(B).
Release mass air flow sensor clips
(C).
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (D).
Disconnect air duct connections
(E) and lift complete air filter
housing out of engine
compartment, pulling it forward
away from mass air flow sensor.
Note:
In this step, mass air flow sensor
remains attached to rubber air duct.
Loosen clamps 2 and 8 and remove
mass air flow sensor and air ducts.
1 - Throttle assembly
2 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
3 - Y-duct
4 - Air duct
5 - Hose clamp 83 - 90 mm
6 - Mass air flow sensor
7 - Idle control valve
8 - Hose clamp 28 - 33 mm
9 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
On MS 42.0 vehicles: Pull throttle cable
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
11 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
upwards out of rubber retainer (A) and
unhook ball end of cable (B) from
throttle actuator.
Remove nuts and bolt (arrows)
retaining wiring harness conduit to
throttle body.
Working at throttle housing: Turn
harness plug (arrow) counterclockwise
and remove.
Working at side of intake manifold,
disconnect electrical harness
connectors:
Idle control valve (A)
Intake manifold resonance valve
(B)
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
12 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors (arrows) at oil pressure
sender and oil temperature sender at
base of oil filter housing.
Remove dipstick guide tube:
Disconnect wiring harness
brackets from tube (A).
Unclip fuel lines from tube (B).
Remove lower guide tube
mounting bolt (C). Pull out
dipstick guide tube.
If necessary, disconnect electrical
harness connector at fuel tank venting
valve (A). Disconnect hose at quick
disconnect fitting (arrow).
-
Remove throttle assembly
mounting screws at all corners
and pull assembly off manifold.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace sealing ring between
throttle assembly and intake
manifold.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
13 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Reattach throttle assembly
harness connector with care.
Arrow on fully tightened connector
must line up with corresponding
arrow on throttle assembly
housing.
On DME MS 42.0: Reattach
throttle cable and adjust as
described later.
Use BMW scan tool to reset ECM
adaptation values.
Throttle cable, adjusting (MS
42.0)
Models with DME MS 42.0 are
equipped with a throttle cable. Cable
adjustment should be adjusted any
time it is disconnected or replaced.
This procedure requires the factory
scan tool or an equivalent to read and
adjust throttle angle. It is
recommended that procedure be done
by an authorized BMW dealer service
department.
Basic adjustment:
Ensure that at idle (accelerator
pedal in rest position) throttle
cable has detectable play at
throttle lever attaching point. Play
must not exceed maximum
allowable.
Adjust by turning knurled adjustor
(arrow) on end of throttle cable
sheath at throttle housing.
Throttle cable clearance
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
14 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Throttle cable clearance
Max. play at
throttle plate lever
-
3 mm (0.125 in.)
Full throttle adjustment (manual
transmission):
With ignition key on press pedal
fully to stop. Check throttle angle
using scan tool. Adjust pedal stop
if necessary.
Throttle angle specifications
Manual
transmisssion:
Full throttle
-
80° - 84°
Full throttle adjustment (automatic
transmission):
With ignition key on, press
accelerator until pedal touches
kickdown stop. Check throttle
angle. Press accelerator pedal
down beyond kickdown stop
pressure point. Check throttle
angle. Adjust kickdown stop if
necessary, recheck.
Press accelerator down fully
against stop. Check throttle angle.
Use scan tool diagnostic program
or road test vehicle to confirm
transmission downshifts when
kickdown is actuated.
Throttle angle specifications
Automatic
transmission:
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
15 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Throttle angle specifications
Kickdown stop
contacted
76° - 80°
Kickdown pressure
point range
84° - 88°
Full-load downshift
100%
Idle speed control valve,
replacing
The idle speed control valve is
mounted under the intake manifold
adjacent to the dipstick tube bracket.
The valve can be removed with the
manifold in place, although the job is
easier if the manifold is first removed.
Intake manifold removal is described in
113 Cylinder Head Removal and
Installation.
-
Disconnect battery negative (-)
cable in trunk.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Remove complete air filter housing:
Disconnect vacuum line at intake
boot (A).
Disconnect electrical harness
connector on mass air flow sensor
(B).
Release mass air flow sensor clips
(C).
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
16 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (D).
Disconnect air duct connections
(E) and lift complete air filter
housing out of engine
compartment, pulling it forward
away from mass air flow sensor.
Note:
In this step, mass air flow sensor
remains attached to intake duct.
Loosen clamps 2 and 8 and remove
mass air flow sensor and air ducts.
1 - Throttle assembly
2 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
3 - Y-duct
4 - Air duct
5 - Hose clamp 83 - 90 mm
6 - Mass air flow sensor
7 - Idle control valve
8 - Hose clamp 28 - 33 mm
9 - Hose clamp 77 - 84 mm
DME MS 42.0: Pull throttle cable
upwards out of rubber retainer (A) but
leave attached to throttle actuator (B).
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
17 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Working at side of intake manifold,
disconnect electrical harness
connectors:
Idle control valve (A)
Intake manifold resonance valve
(B)
-
Disconnect bypass hose from idle
control valve.
-
Remove idle control valve:
Remove idle control valve bracket
mounting fasteners.
Slide control valve with bracket out
from between intake manifold and
throttle assembly.
Pull control valve from rubber
retainer.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Use new gaskets and O-ring seals
when installing. Use assembly
lubricant to facilitate reassembly.
Install idle control valve rubber
seal in intake manifold first, then
insert control valve.
Similarly, install mass air flow
sensor into intake duct, then
install to throttle assembly.
Engine control module (ECM),
removing and installing
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
18 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Note:
Replacement ECMs must be coded with
application information (i.e. engine
code, transmission type, etc.) prior to
installation. Consult an authorized
BMW dealer before replacing the ECM.
Alternatively, coded ECMs may be
available at an additional cost.
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable. Wait at least three minutes.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove E-box cover at left rear of
engine compartment. Cover is
retained with four captive screws.
ECM (arrow) is located in right rear of
E-box, as identified with five electrical
harness connectors.
Disconnect ECM harness connectors
by releasing lock on each plug and
pivoting lever. Pull all five connector up
and off ECM.
-
Remove ECM from retaining
brackets and pull from its holder.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
19 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:55 PM
Fuel Injection
1 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
130-4
ECM Pin Assignments
ECM pin assignments are given in
Table b. ECM pin assignment-DME
MS 42.0 and MS 43.0. This information
may be helpful when diagnosing faults
to or from the ECM. If all inputs and
wiring are OK but operational problems
still exist, the ECM itself may be faulty.
Generally, absence of voltage or
continuity means there is a wiring or
connector problem. Test results with
incorrect values do not necessarily
mean that a component is faulty.
Check for loose, broken or corroded
connections and wiring before
replacing components. If the results
are still incorrect, check the component
itself.
For engine management system
electrical schematics, see Electrical
Wiring Diagrams.
CAUTION!
Always wait at least three
minutes after turning off the
ignition before removing the
connector from the engine
control module (ECM). If the
connector is removed before
this time, residual power in the
system relay may damage the
ECM.
Always connect or disconnect
the control module connector
and meter probes with the
ignition off.
When making checks at the ECM itself,
a breakout box should be used to allow
tests to be made with the connector
attached to the ECM. This also
prevents damage to the small terminals
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
2 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
in the connector. As an alternative, the
harness connector housing can be
separated so that electrical checks can
be made from the back of the
connector.
Table b. ECM pin assignment-DME MS 42.0 and MS 43.0
Connector X60001 9-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
1
Output
Terminal 15
Unloader relay terminal 15
2
not used
3
not used
4
Ground
Ground
Ground point
5
Ground
Ground
Ground connector
6
Ground
Ground
Ground connector
7
Input
Terminal 30 (Fuse 80
amp)
B+ Terminal
8
Input
Voltage supply (Fuse 2)
Fuse carrier, engine electronics
9
Input
Voltage supply
Fuse carrier, engine electronics
Connector X60002 24-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
1
Input
Heater, precatalyst
oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 1 in
front of catalytic converter
2
not used
3
Input/output
CAN bus signal, low
Transmission control module
4
Input/output
CAN bus signal, high
Transmission control module
5
not used
6
Input/output
Transmit diagnosis line
(TXD) data link signal
Transmission control module
7
Input
Heater, post-catalyst
oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 1
behind catalytic converter
8
not used
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
3 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60002 24-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
9
not used
10
not used
11
not used
Notes
12
Input
Signal, 3/2-way valve,
running losses (MS
42.0)
3/2 way valve, running losses
(MS 42.0)
13
Input
Heater, precatalyst
oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2 in
front of catalytic converter
14
Input
Signal, precatalyst
oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 1 in
front of catalytic converter
15
Input
Signal, precatalyst
oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2 in
front of catalytic converter
16
Input
Signal, post-catalyst
oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 1
behind catalytic converter
17
not used
18
Input
Signal, post-catalyst
oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2
behind catalytic converter
19
Input
Heater, post catalyst
oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2
behind catalytic converter
20
Ground
Ground, precatalyst
oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 1 in
front of catalytic converter
21
Ground
Ground, precatalyst
oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2 in
front of catalytic converter
22
Ground
Ground, post-catalyst
oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 1
behind catalytic converter
23
Input
DME main relay signal
activation
DME main relay
24
Ground
Ground, post-catalyst
oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2
behind catalytic converter
Connector X60003 52-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
1
Input
Signal, mass air flow
Hot film mass air flow sensor
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
4 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60003 52-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
sensor
2
Input
Signal, exhaust
camshaft sensor 1
3
Input
Signal, suction jet pump Suction jet pump valve
valve (2.8 L, 3.0 L)
4
Output
Throttle valve supply
(MS 42.0)
Throttle valve (MS 42.0)
5
Input
Signal, intake camshaft
position sensor
Camshaft position sensor I
6
Camshaft position sensor II
not used
7
Output
Throttle valve supply
Throttle valve
8
Input
Signal, crankshaft
position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
9
Input
Signal, pedal position
sensor 2 (MS 42.0)
Throttle valve (MS 42.0)
10
Input
Signal, throttle position
potentiometer 2
Throttle valve
11
not used
12
Input
Feedback signal,
engine start
Starter
13
Input
Signal, battery charge
indicator lamp
Generator (Alternator)
14
Ground
Ground, throttle position Throttle valve (MS 42.0)
sensor (MS 42.0)
15
Ground
Ground, exhaust
camshaft sensor 1
Camshaft position sensor II
16
Input
Signal, pedal position
sensor 1 (MS 42.0)
Throttle valve (MS 42.0)
17
Ground
Ground, mass air flow
sensor
Hot film mass air flow sensor
18
Ground
Ground, intake
camshaft sensor 1
Camshaft position sensor I
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
5 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60003 52-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
19
Input
Signal, throttle
potentiometer 1
Throttle valve
20
Ground
Ground, throttle position Throttle valve
sensor
21
Ground
Ground, crankshaft
position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
22
Output
Signal, intake air
temperature
Intake air temperature sensor
23
Ground
Ground, intake air
temperature sensor
Intake air temperature sensor
24
Output
Signal, coolant
temperature sensor
Coolant temperature sensor
25
Ground
Ground, coolant
temperature sensor
Coolant temperature sensor
26
Input
Signal, oil pressure
Oil pressure switch
27
Output
Signal, engine oil
temperature
Oil temperature sensor
28
Ground
Ground, engine oil
temperature sensor
Oil temperature sensor
29
Output
Signal, knock sensor
Knock sensor
30
Output
Signal, knock sensor
Knock sensor
31
Output
Signal, knock sensor
Knock sensor
32
Output
Signal, knock sensor
Knock sensor
33
Input
Signal, cylinder 1 fuel
injector
Cylinder 1 fuel injector
34
Input
Signal, cylinder 2 fuel
injector
Cylinder 2 fuel injector
35
Input
Signal, cylinder 3 fuel
injector
Cylinder 3 fuel injector
36
Input
Signal, cylinder 4 fuel
injector
Cylinder 4 fuel injector
37
Input
Signal, cylinder 5 fuel
injector
Cylinder 5 fuel injector
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
6 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60003 52-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
38
Input
Signal, cylinder 6 fuel
injector
Cylinder 6 fuel injector
39
Input
Signal, oil level sensor
Oil level sensor
40
Input
Signal, VANOS inlet
valve
VANOS inlet valve
41
Input
Signal, VANOS outlet
valve
VANOS outlet valve
42
Input
Signal, evaporative
emissions valve
Evaporative emissions valve
43
Input
Signal, throttle valve
drive
Throttle valve
44
Input
Signal, throttle valve
drive
Throttle valve
45
Input
Signal, engine coolant
thermostat
Engine coolant thermostat
(map controlled)
46
Input
Signal, close idle speed
control valve
Idle speed control valve
47
Input
Signal, open idle speed
control valve
Idle speed control valve
48
Ground
Signal shield, knock
sensor
Shield, knock sensor
49
Input
Signal, resonance valve
intake system
Resonance valve intake system
50
not used
51
not used
52
Input
Signal, secondary air
injection pump valve
Secondary air injection valve
Connector X60004 40-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
1
Input
Signal, battery charge
indicator lamp
Instrument cluster control unit
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
7 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60004 40-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
2
Input
Feedback signal,
engine start
Instrument cluster control
module
3
Input
Signal, secondary air
injection pump
Secondary air injection pump
relay
4
Input
Signal, electric fan
Auxiliary fan motor
5
not used
6
not used
7
Pedal position sensor
(PWG) (MS 43.0)
Pedal position sensor (PWG)
(MS 43.0)
8
Signal, pedal position
sensor (PWG) (MS
43.0)
Pedal position sensor (PWG)
(MS 43.0)
9
Pedal position sensor
(PWG) (MS 43.0)
Pedal position sensor (PWG)
(MS 43.0)
10
Input
Signal, fuel pump relay
1
Fuel pump relay 1
11
Input
Signal, oil pressure
switch
Instrument cluster control
module
12
Pedal position sensor
(PWG) (MS 43.0)
Pedal position sensor (PWG)
(MS 43.0)
13
Signal, pedal position
sensor (PWG) (MS
43.0)
Pedal position sensor (PWG)
(MS 43.0)
14
Pedal position sensor
(PWG) (MS 43.0)
Pedal position sensor (PWG)
(MS 43.0)
15
not used
16
not used
17
Input
Speed signal (MS 42.0
up to 6-00)(MS 42.0
from 6-00 and MS 43.0)
18
not used
19
not used
Data link connector OBDII 16
pin connector)
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
8 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60004 40-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
20
Output
Diagnostic module tank
leak (DMTL) detection
(MS 43.0)
Leak detection (DMTL) (MS
43.0)
21
Input
Signal, oil level sensor
Instrument cluster control
module
22
Input
Signal, processed
wheel speed, right rear
ABS/ASC module, ABS/DSC
module
23
Output
Signal, clutch pedal
position switch
Clutch pedal position switch
24
Input
Signal, brake light
switch
Light switching center control
unit
25
not used
26
Input
Terminal 15
Fuse F29
27
Output
Voltage supply,
multifunction steering
wheel
Volute spring
28
Input
Signal, brake light
switch
Brake light switch
29
Input
Signal, relay, A/C
compressor
A/C compressor relay
30
Signal, leakage
diagnosis pump (MS
42.0)Signal diagnostic
module (MS43.0)
Leakage diagnosis pumpLeak
detection (MS 43.0)
31
not used
32
Input/output
Transmit diagnosis line
(TXD) data link signal
Data link connector (MS
42.0)OBD II connector (MS
43.0)
33
Input
Electronic vehicle
immobilization
Electronic immobilizer control
module
34
Signal, leakage
diagnosis pump (LDP)
(MS 42.0)
Leakage diagnosis pump (LDP)
(MS 42.0)
35
not used
36
Input/output
CAN bus signal, high
Connector, CAN bus
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Fuel Injection
9 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Connector X60004 40-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
37
Input/output
CAN bus signal, low
Connector, CAN bus
38
Ground
Ground, coolant outlet
temperature sensor
Temperature sensor
39
Output
Signal, coolant outlet
temperature
Temperature sensor
40
not used
Connector X60005 9-pin black
Pin
Signal
Component/function
Notes
1
Input
Signal, ignition coil 3
Ignition coil 3
2
Input
Signal, ignition coil 2
Ignition coil 2
3
Input
Signal, ignition coil 1
Ignition coil 1
4
not used
5
Ground
Ground
Ground connector
6
Ground
Ground
Ground connector
7
Input
Signal, ignition coil 6
Ignition coil 6
8
Input
Signal, ignition coil 5
Ignition coil 5
9
Input
Signal, ignition coil 4
Ignition coil 4
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
170-1
General
This section covers component repair
information for the engine cooling
system.
The E46 cooling system uses a
centrifugal-type belt-driven coolant
pump, an electric primary cooling fan,
and an electrically heated thermostat.
The cooling system is unique in that
the cooling fan and the thermostat are
controlled and monitored by the DME
engine management system.
Therefore, cooling system faults can be
diagnosed using an appropriate scan
tool.
Special tools
Special tools are necessary for fan
clutch removal and pressure testing
the cooling system.
Cooling fan counterhold wrench BMW
11 5 030
Cooling fan wrench BMW 11 5 040
Cooling system pressure tester BMW
17 0 002/17 0 005
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Expansion tank cap test adapter BMW
17 0 007
Cooling system (DME MS 42.0)
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Coolant pump
A centrifugal-type coolant pump is
mounted to the front of the engine. The
belt-driven pump circulates coolant
through the system whenever the engine
is running.
Thermostat
An electrically heated thermostat
regulates the engine coolant
temperature and is controlled by the
DME control module. The heated
thermostat allows the engine to be
operated at higher temperatures at idle
and at part throttle. Having the ability to
control the engine coolant temperature
electronically results in improved
emissions and performance. Problems
with the heated thermostat can be
diagnosed using a compatible scan tool.
Radiator and expansion tank
The radiator is a crossflow design. An
expansion tank provides for coolant
expansion at higher temperatures and
easy monitoring of the coolant level.
On cars with automatic transmission,
ATF is circulated through an additional
heat exchanger (ATF cooler).
Cooling fan (primary)
The are two cooling fan configurations
used on the cars covered by this
manual, depending on transmission
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
application.
On cars with automatic transmissions,
the main fan is electric and mounted on
the bumper side of the radiator. The fan
is controlled by the DME control module
via the output final stage. Additionally a
belt-driven fan via a viscous fluid
coupling (clutch) is attached to the front
of the coolant pump. The fan clutch
controls the speed of the fan based on
engine compartment temperature.
On cars with manual transmissions, a
single multi-speed electric cooling fan is
used. The fan is mounted on the engine
side of the radiator and controlled by the
DME control module via the output final
stage.
On both configurations, the output final
stage is mounted on the fan housing,
next to the fan motor. The fan is
operated using a pulse width modulated
(PWM) signal and is protected by a
50-amp fuse. Electric fan activation is
based on the following inputs to the
ECM:
Radiator outlet temperature
Catalyst temperature (calculated
temperature)
Vehicle speed
Battery voltage
A/C pressure (calculated pressure)
When the vehicle is first started, The
ECM activates the electric fan briefly at
20% of its maximum speed, then
switches off. This is for diagnostic
monitoring. The voltage generated by
the fan when it slows down (acting as a
generator) must match the stored `rpm'
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
values in the fan power output stage to
confirm that the fan is operating
correctly.
Note:
If the ECM stored a cooling fan
fault, check that the fan is not
seized and that is spins freely.
When A/C is switched ON, the
electric fan is not immediately
turned on.
After the engine is switched OFF,
the fan may continue to run at
varying speeds for up to 10 minutes,
based on calculated catalyst
temperature.
Warnings and cautions
The following warnings and cautions
should be observed when working on
the cooling system.
WARNING!
At normal operating temperature
the cooling system is
pressurized. Allow the system to
cool as long as possible before
opening-a minimum of an
hour-then release the cap slowly
to allow safe release of pressure.
Releasing the cooling system
pressure lowers the coolant
boiling point and the coolant may
boil suddenly. Use heavy gloves
and wear eye and face protection
to guard against scalding.
Use extreme care when draining
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
and disposing of engine coolant.
Coolant is poisonous and lethal
to humans and pets. Pets are
attracted to coolant because of its
sweet smell and taste. Consult a
veterinarian immediately if
coolant is ingested by an animal.
CAUTION!
Avoid adding cold water to the
coolant while the engine is hot or
overheated. If it is necessary to
add coolant to a hot system, do
so only with the engine running
and coolant pump turning.
To avoid excess silicate gel
precipitation in the cooling
system and loss of cooling
capacity, use BMW coolant or
equivalent low silicate antifreeze.
If oil enters the cooling system,
the radiator, expansion tank and
heating circuit must be flushed
with cleaning agent. BMW
recommends removal of the
radiator and expansion tank to
flush.
When working on the cooling
system, cover the alternator to
protect it against coolant drips.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:56 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
170-2
Troubleshooting
Begin the diagnosis of cooling system
problems with a thorough visual
inspection. If no visual faults are found,
it is recommend that the DME system
be checked for stored diagnostic fault
codes (DTCs) using BMW scan tools
DIS (Diagnostic Information System) or
MoDiC (Mobile Diagnostic Computer) or
an aftermarket equivalent.
Common cooling system faults can be
grouped into one of four categories:
Cooling system leaks
Poor coolant circulation
Radiator cooling fan faults
Electrical/electronic faults
Be sure to check the condition and
tension of the coolant pump drive belt.
Check hoses for cracks or softness.
Check clamps for looseness. Check
the coolant level and check for
evidence of coolant leaks from the
engine.
Check that the radiator fins are not
blocked with dirt or debris. Clean the
radiator using low-pressure water or
compressed air. Blow outward, from
the engine side out.
To check coolant pump:
Lever tensioner clockwise using
wrench on hex (large arrow) and
slip belt off pulley.
Firmly grasp opposite sides of
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
pulley and check for play in all
directions.
Spin pulley and check that shaft
runs smoothly without play.
Note:
The coolant provides lubrication for the
pump shaft, so an occasional drop of
coolant leaking from the pump is
acceptable. If coolant drips steadily
from the vent hole, the pump should be
replaced.
The cooling system becomes
pressurized at normal operating
temperature, which raises the boiling
point of the coolant. Leaks may prevent
the system from becoming pressurized,
allowing the coolant to boil at a lower
temperature. If visual evidence is
inconclusive, a cooling system
pressure test can help to pinpoint
hard-to-find leaks.
If the cooling system is full of coolant
and holds pressure, the next most
probable causes of overheating are:
Faulty radiator fan or DME control
circuit. Use an appropriate scan
tool to interrogate the DME control
module for faults.
Loose or worn drive belt.
Failed thermostat or coolant pump
impeller. Some pumps may be
fitted with plastic impellers.
Clogged/plugged radiator or
coolant passages.
Cooling system pressure test
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
A cooling system pressure test is used
to check for internal leaks. Some of the
common sources of internal leaks are a
faulty cylinder head gasket, a cracked
cylinder head, or a cracked cylinder
block.
To do a cooling system pressure test, a
special pressure tester is needed.
WARNING!
At normal operating temperature the
cooling system is pressurized. Allow
the system to cool before opening.
Release the cap slowly to allow safe
release of pressure.
With engine cold, install pressure
tester (BMW special tools 17 0 002/17
0 005 or equivalent) to expansion tank.
Pressurize system to specification
listed in
Table a.
Pressure should not drop more
than 0.1 bar (1.45 psi) for at least
two minutes.
If pressure drops rapidly and there
is no sign of external leakage,
cylinder head gasket may be
faulty. Perform compression and
leak-down tests as described in
100 Engine–General
Also test expansion tank cap
using pressure tester and correct
adapter (BMW special tool 17 0
007 or equivalent). Replace faulty
cap or cap gasket.
Table a. Cooling system test
pressures
Component
Test pressure
Radiator
1.5 bar (21.75
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Table a. Cooling system test
pressures
Component
Test pressure
psi)
Radiator cap
2 bar (29 psi)
CAUTION!
Exceeding the specified test
pressure could damage the radiator
or other system components.
Combustion chamber leak test
-
If you suspect that combustion
chamber pressure is leaking into
the cooling system past the
cylinder head gasket, use an
exhaust gas analyzer to test the
vapors rising from the coolant at
the expansion tank.
CAUTION!
Use an extension tube above the
reservoir neck to maintain
distance between the top of the
coolant and the gas analyzer
nozzle. The gas analyzer is
easily damaged if it is allowed to
inhale liquid coolant.
While running engine to check
for causes of overheating,
observe coolant temperature
carefully in order to avoid
engine damage.
Thermostat, checking
If the engine overheats or runs too cool
and no other cooling system tests
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
indicate trouble, the electrically heated
thermostat may be faulty.
Check for thermostat diagnostic fault
codes (DTCs) using BMW scan tools
DIS or MoDiC or equivalent. DTCs
pertaining to cooling system
malfunctions are listed in
Table b.
See also
OBD On Board Diagnostics
at the back of this manual.
Table b. Cooling system fault
codes
BMW
fault
code
Explanation
Possible
cause(s)
10
Engine
coolant
temperature
out of
predefined
range
Faulty
thermostat or
cooling fan.
Faulty wiring
to cooling fan
or
thermostat.
222
Insufficient
coolant
temperature
signal to
permit closed
loop operation
Faulty
thermostat.
Faulty
thermostat
electrical
circuit.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
1 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
170-3
Cooling System Service
Coolant, draining and filling
WARNING!
Allow the cooling system to cool
before opening or draining the
cooling system.
-
Raise front of car and support
safely.
CAUTION!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from under
engine.
Loosen radiator bleed screw at top
radiator fitting (arrow).
-
Remove cap from radiator
expansion tank. Set temperature
controls to full warm.
-
Place 3-gallon pail underneath
radiator.
Remove drain plug (arrow) on bottom
of radiator.
WARNING!
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
2 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Coolant is poisonous. It is especially
lethal to pets. Clean up spills
immediately and rinse the area with
water.
Place empty 3-gallon pail underneath
exhaust side of engine block. Loosen
and remove engine block coolant drain
plug (arrow).
Note:
The block drain plug is located on the
exhaust side of the engine block at
cylinder 2.
-
Reinstall radiator and engine
block drain plugs using new
sealing washers.
-
Before refilling radiator:
Switch ignition to ON.
Set temperature controls to full
warm.
Set blower control to low.
-
Using a coolant mixture of 50%
antifreeze and 50% distilled water,
fill expansion tank slowly.
Continue until coolant emerges
from bleed screw. Cooling system
Table c.
capacity is listed in
Note:
Be sure radiator bleed screw is
loose when filling cooling system.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
3 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tap water may cause corrosion of
radiator, engine and coolant
hoses.
Coolant can often be reused
provided it is clean and less than
two years old. Do not reuse
coolant when replacing damaged
engine parts. Contaminated
coolant may damage the engine or
cooling system.
Table c. Cooling system capacity
Engine
Capacity
M52 TU/M54
8.4 liters (8.8 qt.)
Tightening torques
Engine block drain
plug to block
Radiator drain
plug to radiator
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2 - 3 Nm (18 - 27
in-lb)
Cooling system, bleeding
Air may become trapped in the system
during cooling system service. Trapped
air can prevent proper coolant
circulation. Whenever the coolant is
drained and filled, the system should
be bled of trapped air.
Loosen bleed screw (arrow) on radiator
expansion tank.
-
Set temperature controls in
passenger compartment to full
warm, set blower to low setting
and turn ignition to ON position
(do not start engine).
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
4 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
-
Slowly add coolant until it spills
from bleed screw. When coolant
spilling from bleed screws is free
of air bubbles, tighten screw.
Run engine until it reaches operating
temperature.
After engine has cooled, recheck
coolant level.
Top up so that coolant level
indicator is at MAX.
CAUTION!
Always use genuine BMW coolant or
its equivalent to avoid the formation
of harmful, clogging deposits in the
cooling system. Use of other
antifreeze solutions may be harmful
to the cooling system.
Tightening torque
Radiator bleed
screw
2.5 Nm (22 in-lb)
Viscous clutch cooling fan,
replacing (models with
automatic transmission)
To gain access to viscous clutch fan or
electric fan at front of the engine:
Remove expansion rivets (arrows)
and remove intake duct.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
5 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Working at top of fan shroud, remove
screw and expansion rivet (arrows)
holding fan shroud to radiator. Unclip
or disconnect electrical connector(s)
from right side of shroud.
Note:
Shroud is detached from radiator at this
point but can only be removed later
when fan and clutch assembly is
removed.
Using 32 mm wrench (BMW special
tool 11 5 040) on fan clutch nut
(arrow), turn wrench quickly in a
clockwise direction (working from front
of car) to loosen. Spin fan off coolant
pump.
Note:
The radiator cooling fan nut (32
mm wrench) has left-hand threads.
If fan nut is difficult to loosen, use
BMW special tool 11 5 030 to
counterhold coolant pump pulley.
-
Lift fan and shroud together out of
engine compartment.
-
To replace fan clutch, remove fan
mounting bolts and separate
viscous clutch from fan.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Tightening torques
Clutch nut to coolant pump (left-hand
threads)
without BMW tool
11 5 040
40 Nm (29 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
6 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
with BMW tool 11
5 040
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
Fan to viscous
clutch
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Electric cooling fan, replacing
(models with manual
transmission)
On models with manual transmission,
the primary cooling fan is electrically
operated and is mounted on the engine
side of the radiator.
-
Remove air intake duct as
described above.
Working at top of fan shroud, remove
screw and expansion rivet (arrows)
holding fan shroud to radiator. Unclip
or disconnect electrical connector(s)
from right side of shroud.
-
Lift fan assembly straight up and
off radiator. If necessary, push
center top area of fan shroud
toward engine to unhook shroud
from radiator crossmember.
-
Fan can be separated from
shroud on bench.
CAUTION!
Do not carry fan by the blades; it
may disturb the balance.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Electric cooling fan, replacing
(models with automatic
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
7 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
transmission)
The electric cooling fan on cars with
automatic transmission is mounted
behind the front bumper, in front of the
A/C condenser.
-
Remove air intake duct as
described above.
-
Remove front bumper. See
Exterior Trim, Bumpers.
-
Disconnect fan electrical
connector (arrow) on right side of
radiator shroud
510
Pull out plastic expansion rivets
(arrows) and remove cover from front
of fan.
Remove fan mounting nuts (arrows)
and lift out fan.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
510
Install front bumper. See
Exterior Trim, Bumpers.
Thermostat, replacing
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
8 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
The electrically-heated thermostat is an
integral part of the thermostat housing.
The operation of the thermostat is
monitored by the DME control module.
If a faulty thermostat is suspected, the
DME control module should be
interrogated for stored fault codes
using an appropriate scan tool.
1 - Bolt M6
2 - Bolt M8
3 - Housing with heated thermostat
4 - Gasket
-
Drain radiator and engine block as
described above under
Coolant, draining and filling.
WARNING!
Allow cooling system to cool before
opening or draining the system.
-
Remove air intake duct, cooling
fan and fan shroud as described
earlier.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector from thermostat
housing.
Lever out retaining clips (arrows) and
pull hose fittings off housing.
-
Unbolt and remove thermostat
housing from front of engine.
Loosen nut at top of engine lifting
eye to facilitate removal.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Keep sealing faces free of oil.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
9 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Use new sealing gasket.
Fill system with coolant as
described under
Coolant,
draining and filling
Tightening torques
Engine block drain
plug to block
Radiator drain
plug to radiator
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2 - 3 Nm (18 - 27
in-lb)
Coolant pump, replacing
The engine coolant pump is mounted
in the front of the engine in the timing
chain cover.
1 - Bolt M6 -tighten to 10 Nm (89
in-lb)
2 - Drive pulley
3 - Coolant pump
4 - O-ring seal
5 - Nut M6 -tighten to 10 Nm (89
in-lb)
-
Drain cooling system as described
earlier.
WARNING!
Allow cooling system to cool before
opening or draining system.
-
Remove air intake duct, cooling
fan and fan shroud as described
earlier.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
10 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove engine drive belt: Lever
tensioner hex (large arrow) in
clockwise direction (facing engine) and
slip belt off coolant pump pulley.
Note:
Mark direction of drive belt rotation if
reusing belt.
-
Remove coolant pump pulley bolts
and remove pulley from pump.
-
Remove pump mounting nuts
(qty. 4).
Note:
The coolant pump is mounted on studs
and retained by nuts.
Insert two M6 screws (arrows) in
tapped bores and tighten uniformly
until pump is free from timing chain
cover. (Thermostat and hoses have
been removed for visual access.)
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Be sure to replace sealing O-ring
and gaskets.
Coat O-ring with lubricant during
installation.
Tightening torques
Coolant pump to
timing chain cover
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Coolant pump
pulley to coolant
pump
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Engine block drain
plug to block
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
11 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
Radiator drain
plug to radiator
2-3 Nm (18-27
in-lb)
Radiator, removing and
installing
-
Raise front of car and support
safely.
CAUTION!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from under
engine.
-
Drain radiator and engine block as
described earlier.
WARNING!
Allow cooling system to cool before
opening or draining system.
-
Remove complete air filter
housing.
-
Remove air intake duct, cooling
fan and fan shroud as described
earlier.
Working on left side of radiator, lever
out hose retaining clips and disconnect
coolant hose fittings from radiator (A)
and radiator expansion tank (B).
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
12 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Working on ride side of radiator,
release hose retaining clips (A) and
disconnect lower coolant hose fitting
from radiator (B).
-
Working underneath radiator,
disconnect harness connector
from coolant level sensor.
Where applicable, disconnect
automatic transmission fluid (ATF)
cooler lines from ATF cooler at quick
disconnect unions (arrows) as follows:
Push hose toward oil cooler.
Press black locking ring into hose
fitting while pulling hose off
cooler.
CAUTION!
Be sure to have a drain pan ready to
catch spilled ATF.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
13 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Note:
Alternatively, detach ATF cooler from
radiator by pulling up on quick release
clips and pulling cooler from radiator
tank.
Remove plastic bolts at top of radiator
(arrows). Pull radiator up and out of
car.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Do not coat sealing O-rings with
anti-seize paste.
Fill radiator and cooling system as
described under
Coolant,
draining and filling
Check ATF level and, if necessary,
240 Automatic
top up. See
Transmission.
Tightening torques
Engine block drain
plug to block
Radiator drain
plug to radiator
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2 - 3 Nm (18 - 27
in-lb)
Coolant expansion tank,
removing and installing
-
Raise front of car and support
safely.
CAUTION!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
14 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from under
engine.
-
Drain radiator and engine block as
described earlier.
WARNING!
Allow cooling system to cool before
opening or draining system.
-
Remove complete air intake filter
housing.
Working at front of engine
compartment, remove expansion rivets
(arrows) retaining air intake duct to
radiator support and remove intake
duct.
Release hose retaining clips and
disconnect coolant hose fittings (A and
B) from expansion tank.
-
Working underneath radiator,
disconnect harness connector
from coolant level sensor.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
15 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Remove coolant level sensor (9) by
twisting counterclockwise and pulling
out of bottom of tank.
1 - Thermostat (ATF heat exchanger)
2 - Expansion tank cap
3 - Label
4 - Radiator
5 - Mounting bracket
6 - Sealing O-ring
7 - Self-tapping screw
8 - Connector (ATF heat exchanger)
9 - Coolant level sensor
10 - Locking clip
-
Pull out expansion tank by
detaching from radiator at top.
Then pull up from mounting
bracket at bottom.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Do not coat O-rings with anti-seize
paste.
Fill radiator and cooling system as
Coolant,
described under
draining and filling
Tightening torques
Engine block drain
plug to block
25 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Radiator and Cooling System
16 of 16
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/1...
Tightening torques
Radiator drain
plug to radiator
2 - 3 Nm (18 - 27
in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 9:57 PM
Exhaust System
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
200-1
General
This section covers the repairs related
to the clutch, manual and automatic
transmissions, shift linkages,
driveshafts, and transfer case (all
wheel drive vehicles only). For repairs
related to drive axles and front and rear
final drive differentials, see
311
Front Axle Final Drive and
331 Rear
Axle Final Drive.
Drivetrain
E46 models are equipped with a
longitudinal drivetrain. The
transmission is bolted directly to the
rear of the engine. In rear wheel drive
models, a driveshaft connects the
output shaft of the transmission to the
rear final drive. On all wheel drive
models, a transfer case is mounted to
the rear of the transmission, with drive
shafts leading to front and rear final
drive assemblies. Individual drive axles
with integrated constant velocity joints
transfer rotational power from the final
drive units to the drive wheels.
Manual transmission
Due to different power characteristics
and performance requirements, three
different manual transmissions are
used in models covered by this
manual. Manual transmission
Table a.
applications are given in
Manual transmission applications.
Note:
For transmission gear ratio information
and repair information, see
230
Manual Transmission.
2/25/2009 10:12 PM
Exhaust System
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
The manual transmissions use a single
clutch disc with dual-mass flywheel.
For further information, see
210
Clutch.
Manual transmissions have a metal ID
plate mounted on the side of the
transmission. Do not rely on numbers
cast on the transmission case for
identification.
Table a. Manual transmission applications
Model
Year
Engine
Transmission
323i/Ci
325i/Ci
1999 - 2000
2000 - 2001
M52 TU
M54
Getrag S5D 250G
328i/Ci
330i/Ci
1999 - 2000
2000 - 2001
M52 TU
M54
ZF S5D 320Z
325xi330xi
2000 -2001
M54
ZF S5D 280Z
Automatic transmission
Two different automatic transmissions
are used, depending on model and
model year and/or production date. All of
the automatic transmissions are
electrohydraulically controlled with five
forward speeds. Automatic transmission
Table b.
applications are given in
Automatic transmission applications.
For automatic transmission repair
information, see
240 Automatic
Transmission.
Transmission Identification codes for
automatic transmissions are located on
metal ID tags mounted to the body of the
transmission.
Note:
323 i/Ci and 328 i/Ci models
2/25/2009 10:12 PM
Exhaust System
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
manufactured from 08/98 to 03/00 are
equipped with the A5S 360R automatic
transmission. Vehicles produced after
03/00 use the A5S 325Z transmission.
GM manufactured transmissions have
the ID tag located on the left hand side
of the transmission housing, behind the
transmission selector cable, just above
the transmission pan (arrow).
ZF manufactured transmissions have the
ID tags mounted on the left side of the
rear of the transmissions, just above the
automatic transmission pan (arrow).
Table b. Automatic transmission applications
Model
Year
Engine
Transmission
323i/Ci
328i/Ci
1999 - 2000
2000 - 2001
M52TU
GM A5S 360R
ZF A5S 325 Z
325i/Ci
330i/Ci
2000 - 2001
M54
ZF A5S 325 Z
325xi
330xi
2000 - 2001
M54
GM A5S 390R
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
Transmission lubricants
2/25/2009 10:12 PM
Clutch
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
210-1
General
This repair group covers replacement
of the clutch mechanical and hydraulic
components. Read the procedure
through before beginning a job.
Note:
See
200 Transmission–General for
transmission application information.
Special tools
The 3 Series BMW employs a
traditional style clutch layout with a self
adjusting clutch for manual
transmission cars. BMW suggests
some specific tools for fitting and
removing the self adjusting clutch
(SAC) assembly. These tools are
required for aligning and assembling
the clutch disk, as well as locking the
flywheel in place and aligning the SAC
assembly to the dual mass flywheel.
Flywheel locking tool BMW 11 2 170
Pilot bearing removal tool BMW 11 2
340
Pilot bearing installation tool BMW 11 2
350
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Clutch lining gauge BMW 21 2 080
Clutch centering mandrel BMW 21 2
142
SAC clutch lock tool BMW 21 2 150
Clutch diaphragm tensioning too BMW
21 2 160
SAC tensioning tool BMW 21 2 170
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
SAC locating ring BMW 21 2 180
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
210-2
Clutch Hydraulics
The clutch is hydraulically actuated by
the master and slave cylinders. Clutch
disc wear is automatically taken up
through the self adjusting pressure
plate springs, making periodic
adjustments unnecessary.
A soft or spongy feel to the clutch
pedal, long pedal free-play, or grinding
noises from the gears while shifting
can all indicate problems with the
clutch hydraulics. In these
circumstances it is best to start with a
clutch fluid flush, followed, if
necessary, by replacement of the
hydraulic parts.
Note:
The clutch hydraulic system shares the
fluid reservoir and fluid with the brake
hydraulic system.
Clutch hydraulic system,
bleeding and flushing
If the clutch/brake fluid is murky or
muddy, or has not been changed
within the last two years, the system
should be flushed. Flushing the old
fluid from the clutch lines is done using
a brake system pressure bleeder.
-
Raise and safely support vehicle.
-
Remove under transmission
splash guard if applicable.
-
Remove brake fluid reservoir cap.
Using a clean syringe, remove
brake fluid from reservoir. Refill
reservoir with clean DOT 4 brake
fluid.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Attach pressure brake bleeder to fluid
reservoir and pump bleeder a few times
to pressurize hydraulic fluid system.
CAUTION!
Do not exceed 2 bar (29 psi)
pressure at the fluid reservoir
when bleeding or flushing the
hydraulic system.
Brake fluid is poisonous, highly
corrosive and dangerous to the
environment. Wear safety
glasses and rubber gloves when
working with brake fluid. Do not
siphon brake fluid with your
mouth. Immediately clean away
any fluid spilled on painted
surfaces and wash with water,
as brake fluid will remove paint.
Always use new brake fluid from
a fresh, unopened container.
Brake fluid will absorb moisture
from the air. This can lead to
corrosion problems in the
hydraulic systems, and will also
lower the brake fluid's boiling
point. Dispose of brake fluid
properly.
Connect a length of hose from clutch
slave cylinder bleeder valve (arrow) to
a container.
-
Open bleeder valve and allow
brake fluid to expel until clean
fluid comes out free of air
bubbles.
-
Close bleeder valve and
disconnect pressure bleeding
equipment from fluid reservoir.
Hose on bleeder valve remains
connected.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
-
Slowly operate clutch pedal about
10 times. Fill reservoir with clean
fluid as necessary.
-
Unbolt slave cylinder from
transmission. Fit BMW special tool
21 5 030. Press slave cylinder
pushrod completely into slave
cylinder.
-
Hold slave cylinder so that bleeder
valve is at the highest point.
-
Open bleeder valve.
Once brake fluid appears with out
air bubbles, withdraw pushrod
completely.
Press slave cylinder pushrod all
the way in.
If brake fluid appears without air
bubbles close bleeder valve and
slowly release pushrod. Repeat
procedure until fluid runs out clear
and without bubbles.
-
Disconnect bleeder hose. Install
slave cylinder to transmission. Add
clean brake fluid to reservoir as
necessary. Check clutch
operation.
Tightening torque
Clutch slave
cylinder to
transmission
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Clutch master cylinder,
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
replacing
The clutch master cylinder is mounted
to the pedal assembly directly above
the clutch pedal.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Raise and safely support vehicle.
-
Remove under transmission
splash guard if applicable.
-
Remove brake fluid reservoir cap.
Using a clean syringe, remove
brake fluid from reservoir.
-
Disconnect fluid supply hose from
brake master cylinder. Place a
pan under hose to catch any
excess fluid.
-
Working in engine compartment,
disconnect fluid line fitting from
master cylinder.
Working at left rear of engine
compartment:
Peel rubber edge seal off top of
panel.
Twist plastic panel retainers
(arrows) 90° and pull out to
remove.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Disengage panel from hoses and
wiring harnesses and remove from
engine compartment.
Separate brake booster vacuum
hose at one way valve (A). Plug
hose ends.
-
Disconnect clutch pedal from
clutch master cylinder push rod by
removing securing pin.
Remove master cylinder mounting
bolts (arrows).
Remove clip (arrow) retaining hydraulic
line to master cylinder. Be prepared to
catch any excess brake fluid remaining
in hydraulic line.
Note:
Wrap clutch master cylinder with shop
rags when removing hydraulic fluid
lines from master cylinder to prevent
brake fluid spill.
-
Pull hydraulic line from master
cylinder. Remove master cylinder
with supply hose.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Fill fluid reservoir with clean fluid.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Bleed clutch hydraulics as
described earlier. Connect
negative cable to battery last.
Tightening torques
Clutch master
cylinder to pedal
cluster
Fluid line to
master cylinder or
slave cylinder
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
20 + 5 Nm
(15 + 4 ft-lb)
Clutch slave cylinder, replacing
-
Pinch off brake fluid supply hose
to clutch master cylinder using
BMW special tool 13 3 010 or
equivalent fuel line clamp tool.
-
Remove transmission splash
guard if applicable.
-
Disconnect fluid hose from slave
cylinder. Place a pan under hose
to catch any excess fluid.
Remove mounting nuts (arrows) from
slave cylinder on left side of
transmission.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Check for wear on slave cylinder.
Any other wear except on tip is
caused by misalignment of clutch
components.
Lightly coat pushrod tip with
molybdenum disulfide grease
(Molykote® Longterm 2 or
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
equivalent).
During installation be sure
pushrod tip engages recess in
clutch release lever.
Fill fluid reservoir with clean fluid.
Bleed clutch hydraulics as
described earlier.
Tightening torques
Clutch slave
cylinder to
transmission
Fluid line to slave
cylinder
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
20 + 5 Nm
(15 + 4 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
210-3
Clutch Mechanical
The transmission must be removed
from the engine to access the clutch
mechanical components. It is
recommended that the clutch disc,
pressure plate and release bearing be
replaced during a clutch overhaul. Be
sure to check the bottom of the
bellhousing for oil. If engine oil is
found, check for a faulty rear
crankshaft oil seal.
Due to the construction of the self
adjusting clutch (SAC) disc special
tools must be used when removing the
SAC style clutch. The pressure plate of
the SAC clutch uses a wedge ring
which rotates against the diaphragm
springs to accommodate for clutch disc
wear. The wedge ring adjusts by
means of spring tension, so special
tools must be used to apply and relieve
spring tension as the clutch pressure
plate is removed and installed. For
special tools needed for clutch
replacement procedures refer to the
Special tools
Table a. Clutch disc diameter
Model
Diameter
323i/Ci
325i/Ci/xi
228 mm (8.98
in.)
328i/Ci
330i/Ci/xi
240 mm (9.45
in.)
Clutch, removing
-
On all wheel drive vehicles:
Remove transfer case. See
Transfer Case.
270
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
-
Remove transmission from engine.
See
230 Manual Transmission.
-
Remove release bearing from
transmission input shaft.
Remove clutch release lever by pulling
away from spring clip in direction of
arrow.
Lock flywheel in position using BMW
special tool 11 2 170 or equivalent.
Install BMW special tool 21 2 160 or 21
2 170 with feet (arrows) clamping on to
pressure plate at openings for
self-adjusting springs. Tighten down
head nut (A) to lock feet into position.
CAUTION!
Self adjusting clutch tool feet must
engage in the openings for adjusting
springs to safely remove the SAC
pressure plate.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
-
Turn tool handle in until clutch
diaphragm spring is fully
tensioned.
-
Remove six bolts from perimeter of
pressure plate. Remove self
adjusting clutch unit and clutch
disk.
Clutch assembly and hydraulics
Clutch, inspecting
-
Inspect clutch disc for wear, cracks,
loose rivets, contamination or
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
excessive runout (warping).
Replace if necessary.
Note:
Measure the depth of clutch lining at
lining rivets. If shallowest rivet depth is
less than 1 mm (0.04 in.), replace clutch
disk.
-
Inspect flywheel for scoring, hot
spots, cracks or loose or worn guide
pins. Replace flywheel if any faults
are found.
WARNING!
If flywheel is removed from vehicle,
use new bolts during installation. The
old stretch-type bolts should not be
reused.
-
Inspect transmission pilot bearing in
end of crankshaft. The bearing
should rotate smoothly without play.
If necessary, replace as described
later.
Inspect and clean release bearing lever.
Apply a thin coat of grease to release
bearing lever lubrication points (arrows).
Also, lightly lubricate clutch disc splines
and transmission input shaft splines.
Clutch, installing new pressure
plate
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
New self adjusting clutch (SAC)
pressure plates come with a locking
plate installed that maintains spring
tension on the self adjusting springs.
This locking ring must not be removed
until the pressure plate is securely
installed on the flywheel with the clutch
disk in place.
Center clutch disk on flywheel using
BMW special tool 21 2 142, or an
equivalent clutch alignment tool.
Note:
The sides of a replacement clutch disk
are labelled engine side and
transmission side. Be sure to install
clutch disk orientated in the proper
direction.
-
Install self adjusting clutch pressure
plate onto dowel pins at flywheel.
Tighten each bolt one turn at a time
until pressure plate is fully seated,
and then torque to specification
Tightening torque
Clutch to flywheel
M8 (8.8 grade)
24 Nm (18 ft-lb)
M8 (10.9 grade)
34 Nm (25 ft-lb)
-
Using a 14 mm allen wrench,
carefully screw out locking plate in
a clockwise direction.
-
Remove BMW special tool 21 2 142
with bolt or screw enclosed with
replacement clutch disk.
Clean and inspect release bearing guide
sleeve on transmission. Install release
lever and release bearing. Bearing tabs
(A) align with contact points (B) on
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
release lever.
-
Install transmission. See
Manual Transmission.
230
Tightening torques
Transmission to engine (Torx bolts)
M8
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
M10
43 Nm (32 ft-lb)
M12
72 Nm (53 ft-lb)
Clutch, installing used pressure
plate
Note:
Before installing a used Self
Adjusting Clutch (SAC) pressure
plate, be sure to reset self adjusting
ring to the new position
Locating hooks of BMW special tool
21 2 180 must engage in openings
of SAC pressure plate
-
Place self adjusting clutch pressure
plate on clean work surface. Install
special tool 21 2 180 onto pressure
plate.
-
Squeeze handles of 21 2 180
together. Tighten down knurled
knobs of 21 2 180. SAC adjustment
ring is now in installation position.
-
Install special tool 21 2 170 over 2
12 180 on SAC pressure plate.
Screw in handle of 21 2 170 until
diaphragm spring of SAC pressure
plate is pretensioned.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Center clutch disk with BMW special tool
21 2 142. A comparable clutch alignment
tool may be used. Remove threaded
handle of clutch alignment tool
WARNING!
Be sure clutch disc is facing the
correct way. The disc should be
marked engine side or transmission
side.
-
Mount self adjusting clutch
assembly on flywheel, noting
location of alignment pins.
-
Tighten each bolt one turn at a time
until pressure plate is fully seated,
and then torque to specification.
Tightening torque
Clutch to flywheel
M8 (8.8 grade)
24 Nm (17-ft-lb)
M8 (10.9 grade)
34 Nm (25 ft-lb)
-
Unscrew handle of special tool until
load is removed from diaphragm.
Remove BMW special tool 21 2 180
from pressure plate.
-
Remove clutch alignment tool from
disk.
Clean and inspect release bearing guide
sleeve on transmission. Install release
lever and release bearing. Make sure
bearing tabs (A) align with contact points
(B) on release lever.
-
Install transmission. See
Manual Transmission.
230
Tightening torques
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Clutch
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torques
Transmission to engine (Torx bolts)
M8
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
M10
43 Nm (32 ft-lb)
M12
72 Nm (53 ft-lb)
Transmission pilot bearing,
replacing
-
Remove clutch as described earlier.
Remove transmission pilot bearing from
end of crankshaft using BMW special
tool 11 2 340 or equivalent puller.
Press new bearing into place using
BMW special tool 11 2 350 or equivalent
driver.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:15 PM
Manual Transmission
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
230-1
General
This repair group covers external
transmission service, including removal
and installation of the transmission
unit. Internal transmission repair is not
covered. Special press tools and
procedures are required to
disassemble and service the internal
geartrain.
Special tools
BMW specified tools are required for
removal and installation of the manual
transmission, as well as the removal
and installation of seals at the
transmission input, output, and
selector shafts. If these tools are
unavailable, equivalent tools may be
substituted.
Seal puller BMW 00 5 010
Engine support bracket (lower) BMW
11 8 022
Input shaft seal puller (slide hammer)
BMW 23 0 490
2/25/2009 10:16 PM
Manual Transmission
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Selector seal drift BMW 23 0 22
Output seal drift BMW 23 2 300
Manual transmissions used are based
on engine application. Consult
200
Transmission–General for transmission
application information.
Table a.
Manual transmission gear ratios lists
gear ratio specifications.
Note:
Do not rely on forged casting numbers
for transmission code identification.
Table a. Manual transmission gear ratios
Transmission
Getrag S5D 250G
ZF S5D 280Z
ZF S5D 320Z
1st
4.23
4.21
4.21
2nd
2.52
2.49
2.49
3rd
1.66
1.66
1.66
4th
1.22
1.24
1.24
5th
1.00
1.00
1.00
reverse
4.04
3.85
3.85
Gear Ratios:
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:16 PM
Manual Transmission
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
230-2
Transmission Fluid
Service
Manual transmissions installed in the 3
Series are normally filled with a
"Lifetime" manual transmission fluid
(BMW MTF LT-1) and do not require
periodic fluid changes. Transmissions
filled with MTF LT-1 lifetime oil are
identified with a yellow label near the
transmission fill plug labeled "Lifetime
Oil MTF-LT-1".
Transmission fluid level,
checking
Checking the transmission fluid level
involves simply removing the side fill
plug and inserting a finger into the hole
to check the fluid level. If the fluid level
is up to the bottom of the fill hole
(finger is wetted by transmission fluid),
the level is correct.
Transmission fluid, replacing
-
Drive vehicle for a few miles to
warm transmission.
-
Raise and safely support vehicle
to access drain plug.
CAUTION!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
Place a drain pan under transmission
and remove drain plug (A) at bottom of
transmission.
2/25/2009 10:16 PM
Manual Transmission
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Install and torque drain plug.
Remove fill plug (B) from side of
transmission.
Slowly fill transmission with fluid
until fluid overflows fill hole.
Install and torque fluid fill
plug.nothing
Fluid capacity
Getrag
transmission
ZF transmission
1.0 liter (1.1 US
qts)
1.2 liters (1.3
US qts)
Tightening torque
Transmission drain
or fill plug
50 Nm (37 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:16 PM
Manual Transmission
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
230-3
Transmission Service
Back-up light switch, replacing
Raise and safely support vehicle to
access back-up light switch. Unscrew
switch from transmission.
Note:
The back-up light switch (arrow)
on Getrag transmissions is in the
left side of the transmission.
The back-up light switch on ZF
transmission is in the right front of
the transmission.
-
Install new switch.
Tightening torque
Back-up light
switch to
transmission
-
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Check transmission fluid level
before lowering vehicle.
Selector shaft seal, replacing
(transmission installed)
-
Raise and safely support vehicle.
-
Support transmission with
transmission jack.
On rear wheel drive cars:
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Remove driveshaft. See
Driveshaft.
260
Remove transmission mount bolts
(A).
Remove transmission
crossmember bolts (B) and tilt
down rear of transmission.
On all wheel drive cars:
Remove front and rear driveshafts.
See
260 Driveshaft
Remove transfer case
crossmember bolts (arrows) and
remove transfer case. See
270
Transfer Case.
CAUTION!
Tilting the engine to lower the
transmission can lead to damage to
various components due to lack of
clearance.
Working at rear of selector shaft, pry
snap ring (A) out of groove with a small
screwdriver. Push snap ring towards
gear selector rod joint and drive out pin
(B).
Carefully pry out selector shaft oil seal
with a narrow seal remover or small
screwdriver.
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Coat new selector shaft seal with
transmission fluid. Drive new seal in
flush with housing. Use BMW special
seal installation tool 23 1 140 or
equivalent and a soft-faced (plastic)
hammer.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following;
Install driveshaft using new lock
nuts.
Check transmission oil level,
topping up as necessary.
Tightening torques
Center bearing
(driveshaft) to body
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Clamping sleeve
(driveshaft)
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Driveshaft to final drive flange
With U-joint (M10
ribbed nut)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
With U-joint (M10
compressed nut)
64 Nm (47 ft-lb)
Flex-disc to driveshaft or transmission
flange
M10 (8.8 grade)
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torques
M10 (10.9 grade)
60 Nm (44 ft-lb)
M12 (10.9 grade)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
Transmission /
transfer case
crossmember to
chassis (M8)
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Transfer case to
transmission (M10)
41 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Output shaft seal, replacing
(transmission installed)
-
Raise and safely support vehicle.
-
Support transmission with
transmission jack.
On rear wheel drive cars:
Remove driveshaft. See
Driveshaft.
260
Remove transmission mount bolts
(A).
Remove transmission
crossmember bolts (B) and tilt
down rear of transmission.
On all wheel drive cars:
Remove front and rear driveshafts.
See
260 Driveshaft
Remove transfer case
crossmember bolts (arrows) and
remove transfer case. See
270
Transfer Case.
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
CAUTION!
Tilting the engine to lower the
transmission can lead to damage to
various components due to lack of
clearance.
-
Bend back and remove
transmission output collar nut
lockplate.
Remove collar nut with 30 mm
thin-walled deep socket. Counterhold
output flange to prevent it from turning.
-
Remove output flange. If
necessary, use a puller.
Use a seal puller to remove seal from
transmission housing
Coat new seal with transmission fluid
and drive into position until it is flush
with housing. Use seal driver (BMW
special tool 23 2 300) or equivalent.
-
Reinstall output flange (and
shims, if applicable) to output
shaft.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
On Getrag S5D 250G transmissions
BMW recommends heating the output
flange to about 176F (80C) to aid in
installation. This can be done by
placing the flange in hot water.
-
Coat bearing surface of collar nut
with sealer and install nut. Tighten
collar nut in two stages. Install
new lockplate. Bend tabs into
flange grooves.
Note:
BMW recommends the use of a sealer
such as Loctite ® 242 when installing
the flange collar nut to prevent oil from
leaking past the threads.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Install driveshaft using new nuts.
See
260 Driveshaft.
Check transmission and transfer
case fluid level, if applicable,
topping up as necessary.
Tightening torque
Transmission crossmember to
chassis
M8
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Transmission output flange to output
shaft
Stage I
Stage II (after
loosening)
190 Nm (140
ft-lb)
120 Nm (89
ft-lb)
Input shaft seal, replacing
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
(transmission removed)
Replacement of the input shaft seal
requires the removal of the
transmission from the vehicle as
describedlater in this repair group.
-
Remove clutch release bearing
and release lever from inside
bellhousing.
Remove bolts (arrows) for clutch
release-bearing guide sleeve, noting
bolt lengths (Getrag transmission
shown). Remove sleeve and any
spacers (shims) under it.
-
With transmission on a
workbench, remove input shaft
seal cover from inside
bell-housing.
Locate two indents (arrows) in seal.
Thread a slide hammer seal puller at
indents, pull seal and remove seal
-
Use care not to scratch or damage
input shaft. Use a protective
sleeve or tape the shaft when
removing and installing the seal.
-
Lubricate new seal with
transmission oil and drive into
place using an appropriate drift.
-
Thoroughly clean guide sleeve
mounting bolts, sealing surfaces,
and threads in case. Apply sealer
(Loctite® 242 or equivalent) to
guide sleeve sealing surface and
bolts. Reinstall guide sleeve and
spacer(s).
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torque
Guide sleeve to transmission
M6x12 bolt
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
230-4
Transmission Removal
and Installation
Removal and installation of the
transmission is best accomplished on a
lift using a transmission jack. The
engine must be supported from above
using appropriate support equipment.
This allows the engine to pivot on its
mounts to access the upper Torx-head
bolts at the bellhousing.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and
well supported at all times. Use
a professional automotive lift or
jack stands designed for the
purpose. A floor jack is not
adequate support.
The removal of the transmission
may upset the balance of the
vehicle on a lift.
Transmission, removing and
installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Remove engine cooling intake hood
fasteners (arrows) at front of engine
compartment.
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom cover
(A) and remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove heater bulkhead cover.
Remove engine compartment side
trim panel. Turn locking knobs (A)
and slide trim panel from
mounting lip.
Remove heater bulkhead cover
mounting screws (B) and lift cover
up and out from firewall.
-
Raise and safely support vehicle.
-
Remove engine splashguard from
underside of vehicle.
Remove front suspension
reinforcement bolts (arrows). Remove
reinforcement (coupe shown) and
front axle subframe.
Note:
Tubular style front end
reinforcements are used in rear
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
wheel drive 3 Series sedans and
wagons built up to 11/00 and
coupes built up to 10/99.
Pan style front end reinforcements
are used on rear wheel drive
sedans and wagons built after
12/00, coupes built after 11/99 and
all convertibles.
All wheel drive models require no
reinforcement due to the
construction of the front subframe.
Attach BMW special tool 11 8 022 to
left and right lower control arms.
Tighten knurled screws until tool
makes contact with engine oil pan.
-
Support transmission with
transmission jack. Remove
reinforcing cross brace from below
engine/transmission.
-
Disconnect harness connector
from back-up light switch on
transmission.
-
Remove exhaust system and heat
shield. See
180 Exhaust
System
-
Remove driveshaft. See
Driveshaft.
-
On all wheel drive vehicles:
Remove transfer case. See
Transfer Case.
260
270
Disconnect shift rod from selector shaft
coupling.
-
Disconnect shift console from top
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
of transmission. See
Gearshift Linkage.
-
250
Unbolt clutch slave cylinder from
side of transmission. Do not
disconnect fluid hose. Suspend
slave cylinder from chassis using
stiff wire.
CAUTION!
Do not operate clutch pedal with
slave cylinder removed from
transmission.
-
Loosen knurled screws of BMW
special tool 11 8 022 until
transmission/engine assembly is
just above, but not in contact with
fire wall and heater connections.
CAUTION!
Tilting the engine to lower the
transmission can lead to damage to
various components due to lack of
clearance at rear of engine -Remove
brake fluid reservoir if necessary.
Remove transmission mounting
Torx-head bolts (arrows). Note length
and location of bolts.
-
Remove transmission by pulling
backward until the transmission
input shaft clears the clutch disc
splines, then pull downwards.
Lower jack and remove
transmission.
Installation is reverse of removal,
keeping in mind the following:
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
When installing a new
transmission, be sure to transfer
parts from old transmission if
applicable.
Thoroughly clean input shaft and
clutch disc splines. Lightly
lubricate transmission input shaft
before installing.
Be sure bellhousing dowels
(arrows) are correctly located.
Center rear of transmission in
driveshaft tunnel before tightening
transmission support bracket.
Always replace front end
reinforcement mounting fasteners
on vehicles equipped with the
plate style reinforcement.
Note:
Torx-head mounting bolts should
always be used with washers to prevent
difficult removal in the future.
-
Install driveshaft and preload
center bearing bracket. Use new
nuts when mounting driveshaft to
transmission/flex disc and final
260 Driveshaft.
drive. See
-
Refill transmission with
appropriate lubricant before
starting or towing the car. See
Transmission Fluid Service earlier
in this repair group.
Tightening torques
Front end reinforcement to chassis
and subframe (M10)
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Manual Transmission
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torques
(tubular style)
42 Nm (31 ft-lb)
(pan style)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
+ 90°
Rubber mount to
transmission or
bracket nut (M8)
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Slave cylinder to
transmission
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Transmission crossmember to
chassis
M8
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Transmission to engine (Torx-head)
M8
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
M10
43 Nm (32 ft-lb)
M12
72 Nm (53 ft-lb)
Transmission
drain/fill plug
50 Nm (37 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Automatic Transmission
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
240-1
General
This section covers maintenance and
replacement of the E46 automatic
transmission. Internal repairs to the
automatic transmission are not
covered. Special tools and procedures
are required to disassemble and
service internal automatic transmission
components.
Automatic transmissions are identified
by code letters found on a data plate
located on the side or rear of the
transmission case. See
200
Transmission–Generalfor application
information. For gear ratio
specifications, see
Table a.
Automatic transmission applications.
CAUTION!
ATF does not circulate unless the
engine is running. When towing an
automatic transmission vehicle, use
a flat-bed truck or raise the rear
wheels off the ground. All wheel
drive vehicles equipped with
automatic transmissions must be
towed using a flat-bed truck only.
The electronic transmission control
module (TCM) monitors transmission
operation for faults and alerts the driver
by illuminating the transmission fault
indicator on the instrument panel.
On-board diagnostic codes stored in
the TCM must be downloaded and
interpreted by trained technicians using
special BMW diagnostic equipment.
Special tools
Some special tools are required for the
removal and installation of an
automatic transmission on the E46
BMW models. While these tools are not
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Automatic Transmission
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
absolutely necessary, they are
especially helpful when dealing with
the removal and replacement of the
torque converter.
Engine support bracket BMW 00 0 200
/ 208
Oil pan support bracket BMW 11 8 022
Torque converter socket BMW 24 1 100
Spline bore alignment tool BMW 24 2
300
Torque converter clamp BMW 24 4 131
/ 135
Internal repairs to the automatic
transmission require special service
equipment and knowledge. If it is
determined that internal service is
required, consult an authorized BMW
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Automatic Transmission
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
dealer about a factory reconditioned
unit or a transmission rebuild.
323i/Ci and 328i/Ci models
manufactured from 08/98 to 03/00 are
equipped with the A5S 360R automatic
transmission. Vehicles produced after
03/00 are equipped with the A5S 325Z
transmission.
Table a. Automatic transmission applications
Model
Year
Engine
Transmission
323i/Ci
328i/Ci
1999 - 2000
2000 - 2001
M52TU
GM A5S 360R
ZF A5S 325 Z
325i/Ci
330i/Ci
2000 - 2001
M54
ZF A5S 325 Z
325xi
330xi
2000 - 2001
M54
GM A5S 390R
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:17 PM
Automatic Transmission
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
240-2
Transmission Service
The automatic transmissions installed
in the 3 Series are filled with either
Dexron III ATF, or Texaco 8072B a
special life-time oil.
CAUTION!
Mixing different types of
transmission fluids will lead to
transmission failure.
Note:
The transmission lubricant installed can
be found on a sticker on the
transmission pan. Dexron III ATF (black
sticker) reads "ATF-Oil!". Special
life-time oil (green sticker) reads
"Life-Time Oil". In addition, a sticker
may be located on the fluid sump
indicating the type of transmission
lubricant used. If in doubt, consult an
authorized BMW dealer for alternate
fluid use and current information
regarding transmission operating fluids.
Automatic transmission fluid
(ATF) level, checking
The automatic transmission is not
equipped with a dipstick. Checking the
ATF level requires measuring and
maintaining a specified ATF
temperature within a narrow range
during the checking procedure. The
checking temperature is not fully warm
or cold (the ATF pan should be
approximately warm to the touch).
-
Raise and safely support vehicle
to access ATF fill plug.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Warm up drivetrain by running
engine until ATF reaches specified
temperature. Apply brake and,
while idling engine, shift through
all gears several times. Turn
engine off.
ATF level checking
Fluid temperature
-
30° - 50°C (85° 120°F)
Connect vehicle to BMW
diagnostic scan tool DIS or MoDiC
using the Data Link Connector
(DLC) in the engine compartment,
or under driver's side of dash
(model year 2000 and later cars)
in order to read transmission
temperature.
Remove ATF fill plug (arrow). Place
transmission in neutral and restart
engine. (A5S 360R transmission
shown.)
Note:
Make sure ATF temperature is greater
then 30°C, before releasing fill plug.
-
With ATF between 30° - 50°C (85°
- 120°F), add fluid until it spills
from fill hole.
WARNING!
Hot ATF can scald. Wear eye
protection and protective clothing
and gloves during the check. If the
transmission was overfilled, hot ATF
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
will spill from the filler hole when the
fill plug is removed.
-
Reinstall fill plug using new
sealing ring.
Tightening torques
ATF drain plug to ATF sump
A5S 360R /
A5S 390R (M14)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
A5S 325Z
35 Nm (26 ft-lb)
ATF fill plug to ATF sump
A5S 360R /
A5S 390R (M14)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
A5S 325Z
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
ATF, draining and filling
The procedure given here includes
removal and installation of the ATF
fluid strainer (filter).
Remove ATF drain plug (arrow)and
drain fluid into container. (A5S 360R
transmission shown.)
WARNING!
The ATF must not be hot when
draining. Do not drain the ATF if the
engine and/or transmission is hot.
Hot ATF can scald. Wear eye
protection, protective clothing and
gloves.
-
Remove transmission pan
mounting bolts and remove pan.
-
Remove pan gasket and clean
gasket sealing surface.
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Pull ATF fluid strainer from
transmission pump housing. If strainer
sealing ring remains in pump housing
remove using a seal puller.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Always replace seal for drain plug
and all gasket(s) and O-rings.
Clean sump and sump magnet(s)
using a lint-free cloth.
Tighten transmission pan bolts in
sequential order.
Fill transmission with approved
fluid.
Check fluid level as described
Automatic transmission
under
fluid (ATF) level, checking
Note:
Use new sump bolts purchased from
BMW. Alternatively, clean old bolts and
coat with Loctite® thread locking
compound or equivalent.
Automatic transmission fluid
capacity
A5S 360R / A5S 390R
with torque
converter
9 liters (9.5 qt)
without torque
converter
4 liters (4.2 qt)
A5S 325Z (2.5 liter)
with torque
converter
8.9 liters (9.4 qt)
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Automatic transmission fluid
capacity
without torque
converter
6.2 liters (6.5 qt)
A5S 325Z (3.0 liter)
with torque
converter
8.7 liter (9.2 qt)
without torque
converter
6.1 liter (6.4 qt)
Tightening torques
ATF drain plug to ATF sump
A5S 360R /
A5S 390R (M14)
18 Nm (14 ft-lb)
A5S 325Z
35 Nm (26 ft-lb)
ATF fill plug to ATF sump
A5S 360R /
A5S 390R (M14)
18 Nm (14 ft-lb)
A5S 325Z
30 Nm (23 ft-lb)
ATF sump to transmission
A5S 360R /
A5S 390R (M14)
A5S 325Z
10 Nm (7 ft-lb)
6 Nm (4 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
240-3
Transmission Removal
and Installation
Removal and installation of the
transmission is best accomplished on a
lift using a transmission jack. Use
caution and safe workshop practices
when working beneath car and
lowering transmission.
CAUTION!
Be sure the vehicle is properly
supported. The removal of the
transmission may upset the
balance of the vehicle on a lift.
Tilting the engine to remove the
transmission can lead to
damage to various components
due to lack of clearance.
On cars with AST remove
throttle body.
Remove brake fluid reservoir if
necessary.
Torx-head bolts are used to mount the
transmission to the bellhousing. Be
sure to have appropriate tools on hand
before starting the job.
Transmission, removing and
installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Remove engine cooling intake hood
fasteners (arrows) at front of engine
compartment.
-
Remove engine driven cooling fan,
unfasten cooling fan cowl and pull
slightly upwards. See
170
Radiator and Cooling System.
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom cover
(A) and remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove heater bulkhead cover.
Remove engine compartment side
trim panel. Turn locking knobs (A)
and slide trim panel from
mounting lip.
Remove heater bulkhead cover
mounting screws (B) and lift cover
up and out from firewall.
Install engine support across engine
bay. Raise and safely support vehicle.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Make sure the car is stable and
well supported at all times. Use
a professional automotive lift or
jack stands designed for the
purpose. A floor jack is not
adequate support.
Removal of transmission will
cause engine to tip unless
engine support is used.
-
Remove engine splash guard from
underside of vehicle.
-
Remove front suspension
reinforcement at lower control
arms and front subframe.
-
Drain ATF from transmission as
described earlier.
-
Remove exhaust system and
exhaust heat shield. See
180
Exhaust System.
-
Remove driveshaft(s). See
Driveshaft.
-
On all wheel drive equipped
vehicles: Remove transfer case.
See
270 Transfer Case.
260
With selector lever in Park, disconnect
shift selector lever cable from lever and
remove cable bracket.
Hold linkage clamping bolt (A)
stationary when loosening selector
lever cable clamping nut (B).
Loosen cable clamping nut and
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
remove cable from bracket. (A5S
325Z transmission shown.)
Disconnect electrical harness
connector(s) from transmission by
turning bayonet lock ring(s) (arrows)
counterclockwise.
On A5S 325Z disconnect two
connectors on the left side of the
transmission.
On A5S 360R / A5S 390R
disconnect the harness connector
at the right rear of the
transmission.
Remove wiring harness(s) from
transmission housing.
-
Disconnect transmission cooler
line clamps from engine.
Disconnect cooler lines from
transmission.
Attach BMW special tool 11 8 022 to
lower control arms.
-
Support transmission with
transmission jack. Remove
transmission support
crossmember.
-
Lower transmission until engine
cylinder head touches firewall.
Tighten knurled screws of BMW
special tool 11 8 022 until tool
supports engine oil pan securely.
Remove access plug in cover plate on
right side of engine block and remove
torque converter bolts. Turn crankshaft
to access bolts.
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Remove bellhousing-to-engine
mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Install BMW special tools 24 4 131
and 24 4 135 to secure torque
converter in place during
transmission removal.
CAUTION!
Do not allow the torque converter to
fall off the transmission input shaft.
-
Remove transmission by pulling
back and down. Lower jack to
allow transmission to clear vehicle.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Blow out oil cooler lines with
low-pressure compressed air and
flush cooler with clean ATF twice
before reattaching lines to
transmission.
CAUTION!
Wear safety glasses when
working with compressed air.
Do not reuse ATF after flushing.
Install new sealing washers on
hollow bolts.
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Install new O-rings on
transmission cooler lines, where
applicable.
Inspect engine drive plate for
cracks or elongated holes.
Replace if necessary.
Check to be sure torque converter
is seated correctly in transmission
during final installation.
When mounting transmission to
engine, the three mounting tabs
on torque converter must be
aligned with indentations on drive
plate. Use an alignment dowel to
line up bolt holes, if necessary.
Fill transmission with clean ATF
until oil level is even with fill hole.
Then check fluid level as
described earlier.
Adjust gearshift mechanism. See
270 Transfer Case.
Note:
Torx-head mounting bolts should
always be used with washers to prevent
difficult removal in the future.
Tightening torques
ATF drain plug to ATF sump
A5S 325Z
35 Nm (26 ft-lb)
A5S 360R
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
ATF fill plug to ATF sump
A5S 325Z
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
A5S 360R
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Automatic Transmission
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torques
Front suspension
reinforcement to
chassis (M10)
42 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Torque converter to
drive plate (M10)
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Transmission
support
crossmember to
chassis
23 Nm (17 ft-lb)
Transmission to engine (Torx-head
with washer)
M8
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
M10
42 Nm (31 ft-lb)
M12
72 Nm (53 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:18 PM
Gearshift Linkage
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
250-1
General
This repair group covers transmission
gearshift and linkage service for both
manual and automatic transmission
equipped vehicles.
Special tools
BMW suggests the use of one special
tool in the removal of the gear shift
lever for manual transmission equipped
vehicles.
Pin wrench BMW 25 1 110
To gain access to the complete
gearshift mechanism it is necessary to
remove the exhaust system and the
driveshaft as described in
180
Exhaust System and
260 Driveshaft.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
250-2
Manual Transmission
Gearshift
Manual
Transmission
Gearshift Linkages
1
- Rubber boot
2
- Shift lever
bearing
3
- Shift arm
bearing
4
- Shift arm
5
- Shift lever
6
- Selector rod
7
- Spacer ring
8
- Circlip
9
- Dowel pin
10 - Lock ring
11 - Washer
12 - Gear selector
rod joint
13 - Bearing bolt
14 - Bearing bushing
Gearshift lever, removing
(manual transmission)
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Use the above illustration as a guide
when removing and installing the
linkage.
-
Remove shift knob by pulling knob
straight off the manual gearshift.
Note:
Removal of the shift knob will require
about 90 lbs. of force. Do not twist knob
or locating key can be damaged.
-
Pry up on rear of shift boot to
unclip, then remove boot from front
retainers.
-
Raise vehicle to gain access to
underside of vehicle.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove complete exhaust system.
See
180 Exhaust System.
-
Remove driveshaft(s). See
Driveshaft.
260
Support transmission with transmission
jack. Remove crossmember (arrow) from
rear of transmission.
-
Lower rear of transmission to
access gearshift linkage.
CAUTION!
Tilting the engine to lower the
transmission can lead to damage to
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
various components due to lack of
clearance.
Working above transmission, disconnect
shift rod from gearshift lever by pulling
off shift rod retaining clip in direction of
arrow (1). Disengage shift rod from
gearshift lever (2). Note washers on
either side of shift rod end.
Release gearshift lever retaining ring
from below using BMW special tool 25 1
110. Turn tool 90° ( turn)
counterclockwise.
-
Raise transmission and temporarily
install transmission crossmember.
-
Lower vehicle. Working from inside
passenger compartment, pull up on
gearshift lever to remove it together
with retaining ring and rubber
grommet.
Gearshift lever, installing
(manual transmission)
Install shift lever, aligning locking tabs
with openings in shift console (arrows).
Press down on retaining ring until it
clicks into place.
-
Install rubber grommet with arrow
pointing forward. Install shift rod
and shift boot.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Install rubber grommet correctly so that it
seals out water.
-
Connect shift rod to shift lever.
Install transmission crossmember.
Lift transmission and tighten
crossmember bolts.
Before connecting the shift rod to the
lever, be sure the gearshift lever is
facing the correct way as illustrated.
-
Install driveshaft(s) and heat shield.
See
260 Driveshaft.
-
Reinstall exhaust system. See
180 Exhaust System
-
Lower vehicle. Install shift boot
cover. Push shift knob onto lever.
Tightening torques
Rear driveshaft to final drive flange
With U-joint (M10
ribbed nut)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
With U-joint (M10
compressed nut)
64 Nm (47 ft-lb)
Flex-disc to driveshaft or transmission
flange
M10 (8.8 grade)
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
M10 (10.9 grade
60 Nm (44 ft-lb)
M12 (10.9 grade)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
Front driveshaft to
final drive flange
(with U-joint) (M10)
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
Transmission
crossmember to
body (M8)
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
250-3
Automatic Transmission
Gearshift
In E46 models, the electronic
immobilizer (EWS) prevents starter
operation unless the gear position is
Park or Neutral.
Gearshift mechanism,
adjusting (automatic
transmission)
-
Position gearshift lever in Park.
-
Raise vehicle to gain access to
shift linkage.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose.
Loosen selector clamping nut (A).
Counterhold clamping bolt when
loosening nut.
-
Push shift lever of transmission
forward toward engine (Park
position) while applying light
pressure on cable end. Tighten
cable clamping nut.
Note:
Do not overtighten the nut so that it
twists the cable .
Tightening torque
Shift cable
clamping nut
10 - 12 Nm
(7.5 - 9 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Automatic shiftlock, checking
function (automatic
transmission)
The automatic shiftlock uses an electric
solenoid to lock the selector lever in
Park or Neutral. Depressing the foot
brake with the ignition on energizes the
solenoid, allowing the lever to be
moved into a drive gear. The solenoid
is energized only when the engine
speed is below 2,500 rpm and the
vehicle speed is below 3 mph. The
solenoid is mounted in the right-hand
side of the selector lever housing.
Automatic shiftlock prevents drive gear
selection until the brake pedal is
depressed.
-
With engine running and car
stopped, place selector lever in
Park or Neutral.
-
Without depressing brake pedal,
check that selector lever is locked
in position Park or Neutral.
-
Depress brake pedal firmly.
Solenoid should be heard to
energize.
-
Check that selector lever can now
be moved out of Park or Neutral.
Note:
The next test should be performed in an
open area with the parking brake on
and with extreme caution.
-
With selector lever in Park or
Neutral and brake pedal
depressed, raise engine above
2,500 rpm. Check that selector
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
lever cannot be moved out of Park
or Neutral.
If any faults are found check the
electrical operation of the shiftlock
solenoid and check for wiring faults to
or from the transmission control
module (TCM). See
610 Electrical
Component Locations and Electrical
Wiring Diagrams.
Note:
The solenoid is controlled via the TCM,
using brake pedal position, engine
speed, and road speed as controlling
inputs.
Automatic transmission gearshift mechanism
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Gearshift Linkage
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Shift interlock, checking
function (automatic
transmission)
The shift interlock uses a cable between
the ignition switch and the shift lever to
lock the shift lever in the park position
when the key is in the off position or
removed. This feature also prevents the
key from being removed from the ignition
lock until the selector lever is in Park.
-
Shift selector lever to Park position
and turn ignition key to the off
position.
-
Remove ignition key. Check that
selector lever cannot be shifted out
of Park position.
Note:
It must only be possible to remove
ignition key with selector lever in
Park position.
Shift interlock cable must not be
kinked.
-
Turn ignition key on and depress
brake pedal. Check that selector
lever moves freely from gear to
gear.
-
With selector lever in a gear
position other than Park, attempt to
turn key to off position and remove.
Key should not go into off position.
If any faults are found check cable for
kinks and check cable attachment points
for damage or faults.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:19 PM
Driveshafts
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
260-1
General
This repair group covers the repair and
replacement of driveshafts and
driveshaft components. Drive axles are
covered in
311 Front Axle Final Drive
and
331 Rear Axle Final Drive.
Special tools
BMW suggests the use of a special
tool in the release of the clamping
sleeve which acts as a grease seal for
the splined shaft to the rear of the
driveshaft center bearing.
Clamping sleeve adjustment tool BMW
26 1 040
Front and rear driveshafts
The rear driveshaft is a two-piece unit
joined in the center by a sliding splined
coupling. This coupling compensates
for fore and aft movement of the drive
line. The driveshaft is connected to the
transmission by a rubber flex-disc and
to the rear final drive by a universal
joint. It is supported in the middle by a
center support bearing. The bearing is
mounted in rubber to isolate vibration.
All wheel drive models incorporate two
driveshafts. The rear driveshaft is a
two-piece unit with splined center
coupling much like that of a rear wheel
drive model, but it is shorter and
connects the transfer case to the rear
differential. A short, one-piece
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
driveshaft runs from the transfer case
to the front differential. The front
driveshaft bolts to the transfer case
and differential directly, using no
flexible rubber disk.
Rear wheel drive driveshaft assembly
All wheel drive
driveshaft
assemblies
1
- Front driveshaft
assembly
2
- Torx screw M10
tighten to 70 Nm (52
ft-lb)
3
- Transfer case
4
- Flex disc
5
- Bolt M12
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
tighten to 100 Nm
(74 ft-lb)
6
- Rear driveshaft
assembly
7
- Driveshaft
center bearing
mount
Troubleshooting
The source of driveline vibrations and
noise can be difficult to pinpoint. Engine,
transmission, front and rear axle, or
wheel vibrations can be transmitted
through the driveshaft to the car body.
Noises from the car may be caused by
final drive problems, or by faulty wheel
bearings, drive axles, or even worn or
improperly inflated tires.
Note:
For drive axle repair information, see
311 Front Axle Final Drive or
331
Rear Axle Final Drive.
Driveshaft noise or vibration may be
caused by worn or damaged
components. Check the universal joints
for play. With the driveshaft installed, pull
and twist the driveshaft while watching
the joint. The BMW specification for play
is very small, so almost any noticeable
play could indicate a problem.
Check the torque of the fasteners at the
flange connections. At the rear driveshaft
check the rubber of the flex-disc and
center bearing for deterioration or tearing
and check for preload at the center
bearing with a visual inspection. Check
the driveshafts for broken or missing
balance weights. The weights are welded
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
tabs on the driveshaft tubes. In addition
to inspecting for faulty driveshaft parts,
the installed angles of the driveshaft
should also be considered.
Further inspection requires removal of
the driveshafts. Check the front centering
guide on the transmission output flange
for damage or misalignment. Also check
runout at the transmission or transfer
case output flange and output shaft, and
at the final drive input flange. Check the
bolt hole bores in the flange for wear and
elongation.
Driveshaft flange runout (max.
allowable)
Transmission / transfer case output
flange
axial play
0.10 mm (0.004
in.)
radial play
0.07 mm (0.003
in.)
Final drive input
flange radial play
(measured at
driveshaft centering
lip)
0.07 mm (0.003
in.)
Spin the rear driveshaft center bearing
and check for smooth operation without
play. Check that the splines of the sliding
coupling move freely. Clean and lubricate
the splines with molybdenum disulfide
grease (Molykote® Longterm 2or
equivalent).
Check the universal joints for wear or
binding. If any joint is difficult to move or
binds, the driveshaft section should be
replaced.
Universal joint play
Maximum allowable
0.15 mm (0.006
in.)
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Table a. Driveshaft troubleshooting
lists symptoms of driveshaft problems
and their probable causes. Most of the
repair information is contained within this
repair group.
Note:
With the driveshaft installed, the actual
amount that the universal joints pivot is
limited. For the most accurate test, check
universal joints in their normal range of
movement.
If inspection reveals nothing wrong with
the driveshaft, it may need to be
rebalanced. This can be done by a
speciality driveshaft repair shop. Also,
check the alignment of the driveshaft as
described below.
Note:
Minor driveshaft vibrations can often be
corrected simply by disconnecting the
driveshaft at the final drive and
repositioning it 90, 180 or 270 in relation
to the final drive input flange.
Table a. Driveshaft troubleshooting
Symptom
Probable cause
Vibration when
Incorrect preload of
starting off (forward center bearing.
or reverse).
Center bearing
rubber deteriorated.
Corrective action
Check preload of center bearing. Readjust
preload.
Inspect center bearing and rubber. Replace if
necessary.
Flex-disc damaged
or worn.
Inspect flex-disc. Replace if necessary.
Engine or
transmission mounts
faulty.
Inspect engine and transmission mounts. Align
or replace, if necessary.
Front centering guide Check front centering guide and replace if
necessary. Check runout of driveshaft flanges.
worn, or driveshaft
mounting flanges out
of round.
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Symptom
Noise during on/off
throttle or when
engaging clutch.
Vibration at 25 to
30 mph (40 to 50
km/h).
Vibration, audible
rumble over 35
mph (60 km/h).
Probable cause
Corrective action
Universal joints worn
or seized.
Check universal joint play and movement.
Replace driveshaft if necessary.
Sliding coupling
seized.
Remove driveshaft and check movement of
sliding coupling. Clean coupling splines and
replace parts as necessary.
Driveshaft
misaligned.
Check driveshaft alignment.
Final drive
components worn or
damaged (excessive
pinion-to-ring-gear
clearance).
Remove final drive and repair.
Drive axle or CV joint
faulty.
Inspect drive axles and CV joints. Repair or
replace as necessary.
Sliding coupling
seized.
Remove driveshaft and check movement of
sliding coupling. Clean coupling splines and
replace parts as necessary.
Front centering guide Check front centering guide and replace if
worn, or driveshaft
necessary. Check runout of driveshaft mounting
mounting flanges out flanges.
of round or
damaged.
Universal joints worn
or seized.
Check universal joint play and movement.
Replace driveshaft if necessary.
Flex-disc damaged
or worn.
Inspect flex-disc. Replace if necessary.
Center bearing
rubber deteriorated.
Inspect center bearing. Replace if necessary.
Sliding coupling
seized.
Remove driveshaft and check movement of
sliding coupling. Clean coupling splines and
replace parts as necessary.
Misaligned installed
position.
Check driveshaft alignment.
Front centering guide Check front centering guide and replace if
necessary. Check runout of driveshaft mounting
worn, or driveshaft
mounting flanges out flanges.
of round or
damaged.
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Symptom
Probable cause
Corrective action
Mounting flange
bolts loose or holes
worn.
Remove driveshaft and check transmission
output flange and final drive input flange.
Replace if necessary.
Driveshaft
unbalanced.
Check driveshaft for loose or missing balance
weights. Have driveshaft rebalanced or replace if
necessary.
Universal joints worn
or seized.
Check universal joint play and movement.
Replace driveshaft if necessary.
Sliding coupling
seized.
Remove driveshaft and check movement of
sliding coupling. Clean coupling splines or
replace parts as necessary.
Incorrect preload of
center bearing.
Check preload of center bearing. Readjust if
necessary.
Center bearing
faulty.
Replace center bearing.
Final drive rubber
mount faulty.
Inspect final drive rubber mount and replace if
necessary.
Driveshaft
misaligned.
Check driveshaft alignment.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
260-2
Rear Driveshaft Service
Repair kits for the universal joints are
not available for BMW driveshafts.
Worn or damaged universal joints
usually require replacement of the
driveshaft.
1 - Hex bolt, M12
2 - Centering sleeve
3 - Flexible disk
4 - Front section of driveshaft
5 - Clamping sleeve
6 - Clamping ring
7 - Torx screw
8 - Rear section of drive shaft
9 - Center bearing
10 - Nut
11 - Center bearing support
12 - Lock ring
The driveshaft is balanced to close
tolerances. Whenever it is to be
removed or disassembled, the
mounting flanges and driveshaft
sections should be marked with paint
or a punch before proceeding with
work. This will ensure that the
driveshaft can be reassembled or
installed in exactly the original
orientation.
Rear driveshaft, aligning
The alignment of the driveshaft does
not normally need to be checked
unless the engine/transmission or the
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
final drive have been removed and
installed. If all other parts of the
driveshaft have been inspected and
found to be okay, but there is still noise
or vibration, driveshaft alignment
should be checked.
There are two important driveshaft
alignment checks. The first is to make
sure that the driveshaft runs straight
from the transmission to the final drive,
without any variation from side-to-side
caused by misalignment of the
engine/transmission in its mounts.
Make a basic check by sighting along
the driveshaft from back to front. Any
misalignment should be apparent from
the center bearing forward.
To adjust the side-to-side alignment,
loosen transmission or engine mounts
to reposition them, then retighten
mounts. The driveshaft should be
exactly centered in driveshaft tunnel.
The second important driveshaft
alignment check is more complicated. It
checks the amount the driveshaft is
angled vertically at the joints. This
angle is known as driveshaft deflection.
In general, there should be little
deflection in the driveshaft between the
engine, the center bearing, and the
final drive. Precise checks require the
use of a large protractor or some other
means of measuring the angle of the
engine and the final drive and
comparing these angles to the angle of
the driveshaft sections.
To change the deflection angle, shims
can be placed between the center
bearing and the body or between the
transmission and its rear support.
When using shims to change a
deflection angle, keep in mind that the
angle of adjacent joints will also
change. Deflection angles should be
as small as possible.
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Rear driveshaft, removing
WARNING!
Be sure the wheels are off the
ground before removing the
driveshaft. Set the parking brake
before removing the driveshaft.
Once the driveshaft has been
removed, the vehicle can roll
regardless of whether the
transmission is in gear or not.
The driveshaft is mounted to the
transmission and final drive
with self-locking nuts. These
nuts are designed to be used
only once and should be
replaced during reassembly.
-
Remove complete exhaust
180 Exhaust
system. See
System.
-
Remove exhaust heat shields.
-
Matchmark front and rear
driveshaft connections at
transmission and final drive.
Remove driveshaft mounting bolts.
Discard old nuts. Note open-end
wrench (arrow) being used to
counterhold bolt at transmission
flex-disc.
-
Support driveshaft sections from
body using stiff wire.
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Using BMW special tool 26 1 040,
loosen threaded clamping sleeve on
driveshaft a few turns.
-
Remove center support bearing
mounting bolts.
-
Remove driveshaft but do not
separate two halves. Pull down on
center of driveshaft to facilitate
removal.
Note:
If driveshaft halves were separate and
not matchmarked, see
Rear
driveshaft, installing. If a vibration
occurs, disassemble driveshaft and
rotate one section 180°.
Rear driveshaft, installing
Align driveshaft matchmarks at final
drive and then at transmission flange.
Centerlines of universal joints (arrows)
must be parallel or at 90° to each
other. Position center support bearing
and start attaching nuts. Use new
self-locking nuts.
-
Tighten flange nuts while
preventing bolts from twisting in
coupling. Tighten final drive flange
first, then tighten coupling at
transmission.
Preload center support bearing by
pushing bearing forward (arrow) 4-6
mm (0.16-0.24 in.) from center. Tighten
attaching bolts.
CAUTION!
The maximum allowable change in
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
height of the center bearing or
transmission support using shims is
3 mm (0.12 in.).
-
Tighten threaded sleeve on
driveshaft to proper torque.
-
Install heat shields.
-
Install exhaust system. See
180
Exhaust System. Connect wiring
harness to oxygen sensors.
-
Road test vehicle to check for
noise or vibration.
WARNING!
Do not reuse self-locking nuts.
These nuts are designed to be
used only once.
Avoid stressing the flex-disc
when torquing the bolts. Do this
by holding the bolts steady and
turning the nuts on the flange
side.
Tightening torques
Center bearing to
body
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Clamping sleeve
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Drive axle to differential flange
M10 Torx bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10 with locking
teeth (replace bolts) 96 Nm (71 ft-lb)
M10 with ribbed
teeth (black)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
M10 with ribbed
teeth (silver) ZNS
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torques
(replace bolts)
Flex-disc to driveshaft or transmission
flangE
M10 (8.8 grade)
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
M10 (10.9 grade)
60 Nm (44 ft-lb)
M12 (10.9 grade)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
Transmission
crossmember to
body (M8)
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Note:
Bolt grade is marked on the bolt head.
When replacing bolts, only use bolts of
the same strength and hardness as the
originals installed.
Flex-disc, replacing
The flex-disc between the front section
of the rear driveshaft and the output
flange of the transmission or transfer
case should be checked for cracks,
tears, missing pieces, or distortion.
Check for worn bolt hole bores in the
flange.
-
Remove driveshaft as described
earlier.
Note:
It is possible to only partially remove
the driveshaft, leaving it connected to
the final drive. The driveshaft can be
tilted down in the center and slid off the
transmission flange once the clamping
sleeve is loosened and the center
bearing bracket is unbolted. Suspend
the driveshaft using stiff wire in as
close to the installed position as
possible. If the driveshaft hangs
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
unsupported, the rear universal joint
may be damaged.
-
Unbolt flex-disc from driveshaft.
Note:
Removal and installation of the bolts
may be made easier by placing a large
hose clamp around the flex-disc, and
tightening the clamp slightly to
compress the coupling.
Install new flex-disc using new
self-locking nuts. Molded arrows on
coupling should face flange arms.
-
Install driveshaft as described
earlier.
Note:
Torque only the nuts while holding the
bolt heads. This will prevent damaging
or fatiguing the rubber.
Tightening torques
Center bearing to
body
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Clamping sleeve
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Drive axle to differential flange
M10 Torx bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10 with locking
teeth (replace bolts) 96 Nm (71 ft-lb)
M10 with ribbed
teeth (black)
M10 with ribbed
teeth (silver) ZNS
(replace bolts)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Flex-disc to driveshaft or transmission
flange
M10 (8.8 grade)
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Tightening torques
M10 (10.9 grade)
60 Nm (44 ft-lb)
M12 (10.9 grade)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
Transmission
crossmember to
body (M8)
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Center bearing assembly,
replacing
To replace the center bearing
assembly, the driveshaft must be
removed from the car. The center
bearing assembly consists of a grooved
ball bearing in a rubber mount. The
bearing assembly is pressed onto the
front section of the driveshaft and
secured by a circlip.
-
Remove rear driveshaft. See
Rear driveshaft, removing.
-
Match mark front and rear
driveshaft sections before
separating.
-
Loosen clamping sleeve fully and
pull driveshaft sections apart.
Remove rubber bushing, washer,
and clamping sleeve from front
section.
-
Inspect condition of rubber
bushing for splined coupling.
Replace worn or damaged parts.
Remove center bearing circlip (arrow)
and dust guard.
-
Install puller so that it pulls on
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
inner hub of bearing. Pulling on
outer ring of mount may tear
rubber, and entire bearing
assembly will need to be replaced.
-
Before installation, make sure dust
guard is on driveshaft, and then
press center mount onto
driveshaft flush with dust guard.
-
Place clamping sleeve, washer,
and rubber bushing on front
driveshaft section. Lubricate
splines with molybdenum disulfide
grease (Molykote® Longterm 2 or
equivalent) and then reassemble
driveshaft.
Note:
Do not retighten clamping sleeve until
driveshaft is installed.
-
Install driveshaft as described
earlier
-
Tighten clamping sleeve.
Tightening torque
Clamping sleeve
10 Nm (7.5 ft-lb)
Front centering guide,
replacing
The front centering guide centers the
driveshaft in relation to the
transmission or transfer case. The
guide is press-fit into a cavity in the
front of the driveshaft and slides onto
the transmission output shaft.
No specifications are given for wear of
the guide, but generally the guide
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
should fit snugly on the transmission
output shaft.
Note:
Some driveshafts have a dust cap
installed on the end of the driveshaft,
over the centering guide. The dust cap
may become bent or distorted when the
driveshaft is removed or installed.
Damage to the dust cap should not
affect the centering guide and should
not be mistaken for guide wear.
-
Remove driveshaft as described
earlier.
-
Pack cavity behind centering
guide with heavy grease until
grease is flush with bottom edge
of guide.
-
Insert 14 mm (approximately in.)
diameter mandrel or metal rod into
guide. Strike guide with hammer
to force centering guide out.
Note:
The mandrel should fit snugly in the
centering guide so that the grease
cannot escape around the sides of the
mandrel.
-
Remove old grease from
driveshaft, lubricate new centering
guide with molybdenum disulfide
grease (Molykote® Longterm 2 or
equivalent) and drive it into
driveshaft.
When installing new driveshaft
centering guide, the sealing lip of the
guide should face outward and it
should be driven into the driveshaft to
drive guide to a protrusion depth of 4.5
mm (.177 in.).
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
-
Install driveshaft as described
earlier.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:20 PM
Driveshafts
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
260-3
Front Driveshaft Service
Repair kits for the universal joints are
not available for BMW driveshafts.
Worn or damaged universal joints
usually require replacement of the
driveshaft.
Front driveshaft, removing and
installing
CAUTION!
Do not move vechicle using engine
power once front driveshaft has
been removed.
-
Raise vehicle and safely support
to access front driveshaft.
WARNING!
When raising the car using a
floor jack or a hydraulic lift,
carefully position the jack pad to
prevent damaging the car body.
A suitable liner (wood, rubber,
etc.) should be placed between
the jack and the car to prevent
body damage.
Watch the jack closely. Make
sure it stays stable and does not
shift or tilt. As the car is raised,
the car may roll slightly and the
jack may shift.
-
Remove underbody splash guard.
Remove bolts holding driveshaft to
transfer case output flange and front
differential input flange (arrows).
2/25/2009 10:21 PM
Driveshafts
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Tightening torques
Driveshaft to drive
flange (M10)
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:21 PM
Transfer Case
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
270-1
General
This repair group covers removal and
installation of the all wheel drive
transfer case. Internal transfer case
repair is not covered. Special press
tools and procedures are required to
disassemble and service the internal
geartrain.
Some procedures covered in this repair
group will require you to refer to the
following repair groups:
180 Exhaust System
260 Driveshaft
The transfer case is used in all wheel
drive models to direct power from the
transmission to both the front and rear
differentials via driveshafts. This
transfer case is unique in that it
delivers 38% of the transmission's
torque output to the front differential,
and 62% of the torque to the rear.
Unlike the transfer cases used in many
four wheel drive trucks, the transfer
case used is a single range unit,
permanently engaged to drive all four
wheels all of the time.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:21 PM
Transfer Case
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
270-2
Transfer Case
Transfer case, removing and
installing
-
Raise vehicle and safely support
to access transfer case.
WARNING!
When raising the car using a
floor jack or a hydraulic lift,
carefully position the jack pad to
prevent damaging the car body.
A suitable liner (wood, rubber,
etc.) should be placed between
the jack and the car to prevent
body damage.
Watch the jack closely. Make
sure it stays stable and does not
shift or tilt. As the car is raised,
the car may roll slightly and the
jack may shift.
-
Remove engine splash guard from
underside of vehicle.
-
Remove exhaust system. See
180 Exhaust System.
Remove exhaust system heat shields
(arrows).
-
Remove front drive shaft. See
260 Driveshaft.
-
Support transmission with
transmission jack or suitable shop
hoist.
2/25/2009 10:22 PM
Transfer Case
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
Remove transmission crossmember
(arrows).
-
Detach transfer case vent tube.
-
Keeping the driveshaft in place,
remove nuts retaining rear
driveshaft to transfer case at
flexible disc.
CAUTION!
Do not allow the driveshaft to hang
down. This may damage universal
joints at drive shaft ends.
-
Support rear driveshaft center
bearing and release mounting
nuts.
-
Lower rear driveshaft at center
bearing and remove from
transmission output flange at
flexible disk. Support from vehicle
body using stiff wire.
Remove bolts retaining transfer case to
transmission and remove transfer case.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Replace dowel pins in transfer
case mounting surface if
damaged.
Coat dowel pins with anti-seize
2/25/2009 10:22 PM
Transfer Case
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/2...
before installing.
On manual transmission cars:
Replace sealing O-ring between
transmission and transfer case.
Note:
When refilling transfer case, recheck oil
level again after driving car
approximately 200 meters (600 ft).
Tightening torques
Transmission
crossmember to
body (M8)
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Transfer case to
transmission (M10)
41 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Transfer case filler
plug (M18)
33 Nm (24 ft-lb)
Fluid capacities
Transfer case oil
change
0.16 liter (0.16
qt.)
New transfer case
fill
0.24 liter (0.25
qt.)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:22 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
300-1
General
This section covers general information
for front and rear suspension, steering
system, and the electronic braking and
stability control systems.
Front and rear syspension systems (rear wheel drive)
Front suspension
In rear wheel drive cars, the control arm
on each side connects the steering arm
(A) to mounting points on the subframe
(B) and the body frame rail (C). On all
wheel drive cars the rear mounting of the
control arm is to the subframe.
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Each front strut assembly includes a
tubular strut housing with an integrated
shock absorber and a large coil spring.
The upper strut mount includes a coil
spring seat and strut bearing. A rubber
bump stop limits suspension travel. The
steering arm clamps the lower end of the
strut assembly. The strut assembly
pivots between the upper strut mount
bearing and a ball joint on the control
arm.
The front suspension is designed with
minimum positive steering offset. This
geometry contributes to stability when
traction is unequal from side to side.
Front suspension, rear wheel drive
cars
The control arms are constructed of
forged aluminum. This design lowers the
overall weight of the car and reduces the
amount of unsprung mass. By reducing
unsprung mass, softer, more
comfortable springs can be used and
accurate handling is maintained.
The three point mounting of each
L-shaped control arm precisely controls
the front-to-rear and side-to-side position
of the strut, while the flexibility of the
joints and mounts also allows the
movement necessary for suspension
travel. The control arm mounting points
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
are designed with anti-dive geometry.
This design reduces the normal
tendency for the front of the vehicle to
dive under hard braking.
Control arm position is fixed, with no
adjustment provisions on the control
arms for altering front wheel alignment.
A stabilizer bar mounted to both strut
housings helps to reduce body roll when
cornering.
Front suspension, all wheel drive
For model year 2001, the E46 Sedan
and Sport Wagon are offered with
optional all wheel drive. The all wheel
drive models are known as 325xi or
330xi.
Note:
The internal BMW designation of these
models is E46/16.
The all wheel drive system adds approx.
100 kg (220 lbs.) to the weight of the car.
Weight distribution is largely unaffected
at 52.7% front, 47.3% rear.
The front suspension for all wheel drive
vehicles has been redesigned to provide
clearance for the front axle differential
and drive shafts. All suspension
components are constructed of steel.
The front subframe consists of two
square frame sections welded to two
tubes to form a box structure. Four bolts
(arrows) attach it to the undercarriage of
the vehicle.
The steel control arms, smaller than the
aluminum arms used on rear wheel drive
models, attach at the rear to the
subframe. The control arm inner ball
joints are bolted to the subframe. The
hydraulic engine mounts are different
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
from the rear wheel drive version and
have also been relocated to provide front
axle clearance.
The front stabilizer bar has been
increased in diameter to accommodate
the additional weight. See
Table a.
The struts are shorter than the rear
wheel drive version. Reinforcement
plates have been added between the
strut upper mounting and the strut
towers to prevent sheet metal
deformation when traveling on poor road
surfaces. The spring travel of the E46 all
wheel drive is approximately 20 mm ( 3/4
in.) less than the rear wheel drive
version. The shorter front axle spring
travel is due to the limited angle of
deflection of the front axle shafts.
Each front drive axle shaft has a
conventional constant velocity (CV) joint
at the outboard end and a triple roller
bearing CV joint at the inboard end. The
right inner joint shaft is supported by a
bearing pedestal bolted to the oil pan.
The shaft extends through the engine oil
pan into the front differential.
The front axle differential, bolted to the
left side of the engine oil pan, is driven
by a 40 mm (1.57 in.) single piece
driveshaft. Universal joints are located at
both ends of the driveshaft.
The sport suspension option is not
available for all wheel drive models.
Steering
The variable-assist power steering
system consists of an engine-driven
hydraulic pump, a rack-and-pinion type
steering gear, and connecting linkage to
the road wheels. E46 models utilize an
engine-speed dependent variable effort
steering system. At low speeds,
maximum power assist is provided to
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
ease parking and city driving. At high
speeds, assist is reduced to ensure
stability.
The steering linkage connects the
rack-and-pinion unit through tie rods to
the steering arms. The tie rod ends allow
the wheels to pivot and react to
suspension travel.
On all wheel drive models, the rack and
pinion steering is constructed with a
larger diameter piston than the rear
wheel drive version. This is necessary to
counter the additional drag of the all
wheel drive system and the wider
standard wheels and tires.
The lower steering column in all wheel
drive models connects to the steering
rack via a universal joint, whereas there
is flexible ("guibo") joint on the rear
wheel drive models. The turning radius
of the all wheel drive vehicle is 35.8 feet,
1.4 feet greater than the rear wheel drive
vehicle.
Rear suspension
The rear suspension subframe (final
drive carrier) is the main mounting point
for the differential housing and rear
suspension components. It is bolted to
the vehicle undercarriage using four
large rubber bushings (arrows).
Trailing arms locate the rear wheels and
anchor the springs, shock absorbers and
stabilizer bar. Drive axles with constantvelocity (CV) joints at both ends transfer
power from the differential to the road
wheels. The differential is mounted to
the subframe through rubber mounts
and bushings to help isolate drivetrain
noise and vibration.
In all wheel drive models, the rear
suspension and the rear differential have
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
the same layout as the rear wheel drive
version.
The rear suspension travel of the E46 all
wheel drive is approx. 17 mm (0.67 in.)
less than the rear wheel drive version.
The reason for the reduced travel in the
rear is to prevent excessive body roll as
a result of the higher body profile.
The rear stabilizer bar diameter has
been increased to accommodate the
additional vehicle weight. See
Table
a.
Table a. E46 stabilizer bars
Model
Front
diameter
Rear
diameter
Rear wheel
drive
23.0 mm
(0.906 in.)
18 mm
(0.709 in.)
All wheel
drive
23.5 mm
(0.925 in.)
20 mm
(0.787 in.)
24.0 mm
Sport
suspension (0.945 in.)
(n/a on awd)
19 mm
(0.748 in.)
Brakes
E46 cars are equipped with power disc
brakes with integral antilock brakes
(ABS). The parking brake is a dual-drum
system integrated with the rear brake
rotors.
Power assist is provided by a vacuum
booster when the engine is running. The
brake pedal pushrod is connected
directly to the master cylinder, so failure
of the vacuum booster does not normally
result in total brake failure.
Each disc brake uses a caliper with a
single hydraulic cylinder. Brake pads in
the left front and right rear contain wear
sensors. When the pads need
replacement, the sensors illuminate a
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
light on the dashboard.
Tires and wheels
Tire size is critical to the proper operation
of the anti-lock brake system and
traction control system. Several different
styles of wheels in 15, 16, and 17 inch
diameters are available from an
authorized BMW dealer.
On all wheel drive cars, standard wheel
size is 17x 7.0 to ensure there is enough
room for the front axles and brakes. Tire
size is 205/50 R17.
Tire and rim size applications are listed
in
Table b. Rim and tire sizes.
Note:
Aftermarket wheels should be selected
with care. Improperly fitted wheels can
contact and damage suspension, brake
or body components and may adversely
affect vehicle stability.
Table b. Rim and tire sizes
Model
Standard
Option
Rim size
Tire size
Rim size
Tire size
323i
15 x 6.5
195/65R 15
16 x 7
205/55R 16
323Ci
325i/Ci
328i
16 x 7
205/55R 16
17 x 8
225/45R 17
328Ci
16 x 7
205/55R 16
17 x 7.5/8.5
225/45R 17
245/45R 17
330i/Ci
17 x 7
205/50R 17
17 x 7.5/8.5
225/45R 17
245/45R 17
325xi
330xi
17 x 7
205/50R 17
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:23 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
1 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
300-2
Electronic Brake and
Stability Control
Systems
All E46 vehicles are equipped with an
Antilock Braking System (ABS). Early
production models featured ABS with
Automatic Stability Control (ABS/ASC).
Later models came equipped with ABS
and Dynamic Stability Control
(ABS/DSC). DSC builds upon the
existing ABS/ASC system to provide
electronic control of drive and braking
systems to insure vehicle stability.
This manual will refer to these systems
as ABS. ASC or DSC will be specified
when necessary. See the
accompanying illustrations for
individual system identification.
E46 Electronic braking and
stability control systems
ASC
1999 - 2000 Automatic Stability Control
Teves MK 20 ASC
1 - Brake master cylinder and fluid
reservoir, left rear of engine
compartment
2 - ASC control module and hydraulic
unit, left rear of engine
compartment under master
cylinder
3 - Rear wheel speed sensor, at each
rear wheel hub
4 - Front wheel speed sensor, at each
front steering arm
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
2 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
DSC
1999 - 2000 Dynamic Stability Control
Teves MK 20 DSC
1 - DSC control module and hydraulic
unit, right rear of engine
compartment
2 - Brake fluid reservoir, master
cylinder and DSC brake pressure
sensors, left rear of engine
compartment
3 - DSC precharge pump, left rear of
engine compartment, under brake
master cylinder
4 - Rear wheel speed sensor, at each
rear wheel hub
5 - Front wheel speed sensor, at each
front steering arm
6 - Steering angle sensor, at base of
upper steering column
7 - Lateral acceleration sensor,
behind driver’s kickpanel
8 - Rotational acceleration (yaw)
sensor, under driver’s seat,
underneath rug
2001 rear wheel drive Dynamic Stability
Control Teves MK 60 DSC
1 - Brake fluid reservoir and master
cylinder, left rear of engine
compartment
2 - DSC control module and hydraulic
unit, left rear of engine
compartment, under brake master
cylinder
3 - Rear wheel speed sensor, at each
rear wheel hub
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
3 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
4 - Front wheel speed sensor, at each
front steering arm
5 - Steering angle sensor, at base of
upper steering column
6 - Lateral acceleration sensor,
behind driver’s kickpanel
7 - Rotational acceleration (yaw)
sensor, under driver’s seat,
underneath rug
Note:
There is no precharge pump in this
system.
2001 all wheel drive Dynamic Stability
Control Bosch DSC III 5.7
1 - DSC control module, hydraulic
unit and DSC brake pressure
sensor, right rear of engine
compartment
2 - Brake fluid reservoir and master
cylinder, left rear of engine
compartment
3 - DSC precharge pump, left rear of
engine compartment, under brake
master cylinder
4 - Rear wheel speed sensor, at each
rear wheel hub
5 - Front wheel speed sensor, at each
front steering arm
6 - Steering angle sensor, at base of
upper steering column
7 - Lateral acceleration sensor and
rotational acceleration (yaw)
sensor, under driver’s seat,
underneath rug
ABS system description
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
4 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
The electronically controlled ABS
maintains vehicle stability and control
during emergency braking by
preventing wheel lock-up. ABS
provides optimum deceleration and
stability during adverse conditions. It
automatically adjusts brake system
hydraulic pressure at each wheel to
prevent wheel lock-up.
The system's main components are the
wheel speed (pulse) sensors, the
ABS/ASC or ABS/DSC control module,
and the hydraulic control unit.
The wheel speed sensors continuously
send wheel speed signals to the
control module. The control module
compares these signals to determine,
in fractions of a second, whether any of
the wheels are about to lock. If any
wheel is nearing a lock-up condition,
the module signals the hydraulic unit to
maintain or reduce pressure at the
appropriate wheel(s). Pressure is
modulated by electrically-operated
solenoid valves in the hydraulic unit.
Automatic Stability Control
(ASC)
The Automatic Stability Control (ASC)
system works in conjunction with the
Antilock Brake System (ABS) and the
engine management system to
enhance vehicle control. The main
function of the ASC system is to
maintain the rolling contact between
the tires and the road surface under all
driving conditions. This is achieved
through exact application and
management of braking and drivetrain
forces.
Note:
The traction control system referred to
as ASC (Automatic Stability Control)
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
5 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
may also be referred to as ASC+T
(Automatic Stability Control+Traction).
The ASC system improves traction by
electronically applying the rear brakes
when the rear drive wheels are
spinning at a faster rate than the front
wheels. The combined ABS/ASC
control module, operating through the
ABS hydraulic control unit, modulates
braking force at the rear wheels.
In addition, ASC will deactivate
individual fuel injectors and override
the motor driven throttle to reduce
engine torque and maintain vehicle
traction. Because the throttle is
controlled electronically the driver
cannot increase the engine power
output during ASC intervention
regardless of how far the accelerator
pedal is pushed.
The components that comprise the
ASC system also function to replace
the limited slip differential available in
previous models. Even with the ASC
system turned off, if the ASC control
module senses a difference in wheel
speed (one wheel spinning) the control
module will apply modulated braking
force to the slipping wheel until traction
is regained, but will not override fuel
injection function.
Traction control also comes into
operation during deceleration.
Decelerating on snowy or icy road
surfaces can lead to rear wheel slip. If
a rear wheel starts to drag or lock up,
the ASC system can limit the problem
by adjusting throttle, fuel injection and
ignition timing.
A switch on the center console is used
to toggle the ASC on or off.
The ASC system is designed to be
maintenance free. There are no
adjustments that can be made. Repair
and troubleshooting of the ASC system
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
6 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
requires special test equipment and
knowledge and should be performed
only by an authorized BMW dealer.
Table c. ASC indicator lamp function
lists the conditions indicated by the
ASC indicator light in the instrument
cluster.
ABS/ASC traction
control system
1
- Wheel speed
sensor
2
- Wheel speed
pulse wheel
3
- Brake disk
4
- Brake caliper
5
- ABS/ASC
hydraulic unit
6
- Brake master
cylinder
7
- Throttle valve
8
- Engine control
module
9
- Accelerator
pedal
10 - ABS/ASC
control module
Table c. ASC indicator lamp function
Indicator lamp
Condition
Action / Use
Light on
Normal ASC start-up
Automatic ASC self-test
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
7 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Indicator lamp
Condition
Action / Use
Light off
ASC monitoring mode
Automatic ASC operation
Press ASC button, light
comes on
ASC off (disabled)
Rocking the car to get out of
snow or other loose surface
Driving with snow chains
Press ASC button, light goes
out
ASC monitoring mode
Automatic ASC operation
Light flashes
ASC active mode
Normal ASC operation as it
controls wheel speed
Light stays on after start up or Defect in ASC
comes on while driving
Consult BMW dealer for
diagnosis/repair
(vehicle operation remains
normal)
Dynamic Stability Control (DSC)
Dynamic Stability Control (DSC),
standard in 2000 and later E46 models,
utilizes many principles and components
of the ASC traction control system. DSC
is active throughout the driving
experience, unlike ASC which is only
active during acceleration and braking.
DSC helps stabilize the vehicle in
cornering and avoidance maneuvers by
adjusting engine controls such as
throttle, ignition, fuel injection and the
application of brake pressure to the
wheels individually.
The DSC control module uses various
inputs to determine vehicle instability
during braking, cornering, or reduced
traction situations. Based upon these
inputs the ABS/DSC control module
sends outputs to the engine control
module and the ABS/DSC hydraulic unit
to activate torque reduction protocols
and braking intervention.
Inputs
1 - Lateral acceleration sensor
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
8 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
2 - Steering angle sensor
3 - Rotational rate (yaw) sensor
4 - Brake pressure sensor
5 - ABS wheel speed sensors
6 - Engine control module
Outputs
7 - ABS/DSC hydraulic system
8 - Ignition (spark)
9 - Fuel injection
10 - Throttle valve
The DSC system can be toggled on and
off by a switch mounted on the center
console. Turning off the DSC system
does not disable ABS or ASC functions.
Vehicle stability parameters
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
9 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
System functions
Each of the electronic braking and
stability control systems include
sub-systems which use the hydraulic
unit/control module and sensors to carry
out additional system functions. The
foundation of the stability control
systems is Antilock Braking System
(ABS) with the following basic functions:
Cornering brake control (CBC)
Electronic brake proportioning
(EBV)
The Teves MK 20 ASC system functions
as a basic ABS system, but adds
additional system functions:
Brake intervention (ADB)
Drag torque reduction (MSR)
All of the dynamic stability control
systems are based on the ABS/ASC
system, but add DSC system functions
Dynamic brake control (DBC)
Maximum brake control (MBC)
Cornering brake control (CBC)
Cornering brake control reduces brake
pressure build up on the inside rear
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
10 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
wheel brake circuit during cornering if
activation threshold values are
exceeded.
Electronic brake proportioning (EBV)
Electronic brake proportioning adjusts
braking force to the rear wheels based
upon the vehicle's loading, front to rear,
to maximize the vehicle's braking power.
Using wheel speed sensors, the control
module compares individual wheel
deceleration rates as the brakes are
applied. If the difference in wheel
speeds exceeds the programmed
threshold values, EBV is activated. EBV
activation modulates inlet valves to the
rear wheels to regulate braking force.
Brake intervention (ADB)
Brake intervention is applied to the
individual drive wheel which is losing
traction by activating the rear brake
calipers in three phases:
Pressure build
Pressure hold
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
11 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Pressure release
When intervention is necessary:
The changeover valve in the
hydraulic unit energizes and closes
inlet valves for the two front wheels
and the rear wheel with traction.
The rear brake circuit intake valve is
energized and opened to rear wheel
without traction.
Return/pressure pump is activated
and draws in brake fluid from the
master cylinder and delivers
pressurized brake fluid to wheel
without traction.
Pressure hold and pressure release
cycles are run by cycling inlet and
outlet valve to rear brake caliper
without traction.
Drive torque reduction
In low traction conditions, the ABS
control module request is sent to the
engine control module (ECM) via the
CAN-bus. The ECM accomplishes torque
reduction by implementing the following
measures:
Reducing throttle opening angle
Retarding ignition
Cutting off individual cylinder fuel
injectors
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
12 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Drag torque reduction (MSR)
During deceleration and engine braking
conditions engine drag torque can cause
the rear wheels of a vehicle to lock on
low traction surfaces, especially in high
speed, low gear driving. This can lead to
loss of traction in the rear. When drive
wheel speed is slower than front wheel
speed the ECM will suspend vehicle
coasting by increasing throttle opening
angle and engine torque.
Dynamic brake control (DBC)
The DBC function provides increased
braking pressure, up to ABS threshold,
during emergency braking situations.
The DSC control unit will implement
DBC function when brake pressure
builds rapidly with application of the
brake pedal.
DBC triggering conditions:
Brake light switch on
Brake pressure in master cylinder
above ABS threshold
Brake pressure build up speed
above threshold
Vehicle road speed above 3 mph
Pressure sensor self test completed
and sensors OK
Vehicle travelling forward
Not all wheels in ABS regulation
range
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
13 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
When DBC function is activated, braking
pressure will increase at all wheels up to
the ABS regulation point. DBC will
continue until the driver releases the
brake pedal, brake pressure drops, or
the vehicle slows to under 3 mph.
Maximum brake control (MBC)
Maximum brake control is designed to
assist in stability control by increasing
rear brake pressure when the front
wheels are under ABS regulation. MBC
intervention is triggered when the brakes
are applied too slowly to reach DBC
threshold.
MBC triggering conditions:
Both front wheels in ABS regulation
Vehicle speed above 3 mph
DBC and pressure sensor self test
completed and OK
Vehicle travelling forward
Rear wheels not under ABS
regulation
MBC will activate the return pump to
increase rear wheel pressure build up.
The function will be terminated under
the following conditions:
Front wheels drop out of ABS
regulation
Driver releases brake pedal
Brake pressure falls below
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
14 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
threshold
Vehicle road speed drops below 3
mph
Teves MK 20 ASC diagram
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
15 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Teves MK 20 DSC Diagram
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
16 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Vehicle network
The hydraulic unit/control module
communicates with some sensors and
many other control modules over the
CAN-bus. The CAN-bus is a system of
wiring that functions like a computer
network, allowing different components
to communicate over the same data line,
at the same time, by varying electronic
signals.
Component communication dialogs take
place between multiple control units and
sensors over the CAN-bus:
Engine control module (ECM)
provides current engine torque to
ABS control module.
ABS control module provides wheel
speed sensor signals (vehicle
speed) to other modules
ABS control module signals ECM to
increase/reduce torque, ECM
adjusts motor driven throttle
(MDK/EDK)
ABS control module commands
transmission control module (AGS)
to suppress shifts during ASC/DSC
regulation
DSC receives yaw, lateral
acceleration & steering angle
sensor information
ABS control module receives signal
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
17 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
from ASC/DSC switch on dash.
ABS control module signals turn
instrument cluster warning lamps
on during ASC/DSC regulation.
Hydraulic unit/control module
The hydraulic unit is mounted in
conjunction with the control module.
While the hydraulic unit and control
module function as one unit, they are
replaceable individually. All ABS/ASC or
ABS/DSC processing functions are
performed by the control module. The
control module is linked to the vehicle's
engine control module (ECM) and
transmission control module (AGS) (if
applicable) by the CAN-bus network.
Wheel speed sensors
Wheel speed sensors are a crucial
component in every ABS system. Control
modules use these sensor inputs to
determine overall vehicle speed and
individual wheel speed for both ABS
braking and stability control functions.
Three different types of wheel speed
sensor are used in the E46 electronic
braking and stability control systems:
1999 - 2000 Teves MK 20 ASC /
DSC: Inductive
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
18 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
2001 Bosch DSC III 5.7: Hall effect
2001 Teves MK 60 DSC:
Magnetoresistive
1 - Fastening element
2 - Ground contact
3 - Sensor wiring
4 - Sensor housing
5 - Metal pulse wheel
6 - Sensor element support
7 - Evaluation module
8 - Sensor element
9 - Magnet
10 - Pick-up surface
CAUTION!
The magnetoresistive and the Hall
effect sensor for the rear wheel are
physically interchangeable. However,
the electronic properties are not the
same and they must not be
interchanged.
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
19 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
DSC lateral acceleration sensor
The lateral acceleration sensor provides
the DSC control module with an input
signal based on the degree of lateral
acceleration (g forces) that the vehicle
experiences. Based on a 5 volt reference
voltage, the sensor will return an output
voltage that ranges between 0.5 and 4.5
volts to the DSC control module, with 1.8
volts as a standing voltage. This input,
along with other DSC inputs, determines
the amount of DSC regulation needed to
maintain vehicle stability.
Teves MK 60 DSC diagram
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
20 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Bosch DSC III 5.7 diagram
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
21 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
DSC rotational rate (yaw) sensor
The rotational rate sensor provides a
analog voltage signal to the DSC control
module to indicate the rotational speed
(yaw) of the vehicle on its vertical axis.
The control module supplies a 5 volt
reference voltage to the sensor. The
sensor returns a voltage between 0.25
and 4.65 volts based on the amount of
yaw. If the vehicle's yaw exceeds preset
parameters, the DSC control module will
activate a DSC regulation cycle to
increase vehicle stability while cornering.
In case of failure the sensor will send a
constant voltage to the DSC control unit.
DSC steering angle sensor
Using two potentiometers, the steering
angle sensor determines the steering
angle and the rate of steering change.
The sensor processes the two
potentiometer outputs and provides a
digital signal to the DSC control unit via
the vehicle's CAN-bus network. Sensor
recalibration is required after steering
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
22 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
angle sensor replacement or repairs to
the steering column. This recalibration is
performed using either the DIS or MoDiC
BMW scan tools.
DSC pressure sensor
The DSC pressure sensor(s) provides
the ABS/DSC control module an analog
voltage signal in proportion to brake
pressure in the master cylinder.
The DSC MK 20 and MK 60 systems use
two switches installed at the brake
master cylinder.
The Bosch DSC III 5.7 system uses one
switch installed at the DSC hydraulic
unit.
DSC precharge pump
The DSC precharge pump is used in the
Teves MK 20 DSC and Bosch DSC III 5.7
systems (1999 - 2000 DSC and 2001 all
wheel drive equipped vehicles).
The DSC precharge pump provides the
hydraulic unit with the necessary supply
of hydraulic brake fluid. When the DSC
system is activated, the precharge pump
delivers brake fluid from the reservoir to
the hydraulic unit at 10 bar (150 psi).
Switches and indicators
ASC/DSC control button
The control button is used to deactivate
the stability control functions of either
the ASC system or the DSC system.
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
23 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Brake light switch
The brake light switch input signal is
used by the control module to determine
which stability control routine is
necessary. The control module will
interrupt Automatic Stability Control
(ASC) functions if the brake pedal is
depressed during ASC operation. On
vehicles equipped with DSC, DSC
operation is not cancelled during braking
situations.
Note:
Bosch DSC III 5.7 control module
compares input from the brake light
switch with pressure sensor value. The
pressure sensor must not detect more
than 5 bar when the brake light switch is
not actuated.
Parking brake switch
The switch for the parking brake warning
lamp is used to signal the control
module if the parking brake is engaged.
This signal is used in stability control
system logic to cancel system functions.
Brake fluid level switch
The reed-type brake fluid level switch
monitors the level of brake fluid available
in the brake fluid reservoir. When an
adequate amount of fluid is present, the
switch completes a ground circuit for the
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
24 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
control module. When fluid level is too
low, the circuit is broken and the
ASC/DSC functions are turned off.
Normal braking and ABS remains
unaffected.
Warning lamps
Braking and stability control warning
lights
1 - ASC/DSC warning light. llluminates
solidly when ASC/DSC system has
been turned off, or blinks when
ASC/DSC system is activate.
2 - Brake warning light. Indicates when
the parking brake is engaged, or
when brake system hydraulic fluid
level is low.
3 - Antilock brake system (ABS)
warning light. Indicates that the
ABS system has been deactivated,
or when there is an ABS system
malfunction.
4 - Brake pad wear warning light.
Indicates worn brake pads.
WARNING!
If the brake warning lamp, ABS
warning lamp, and ASC/DSC warning
lamp are all illuminated at the same
time, there is an ABS and stability
control system failure. Do not drive
vehicle without diagnosing the
problem.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
300-3
Troubleshooting
Stable handling and ride comfort both
depend on the integrity of the
suspension and steering components.
Any symptom of instability or imprecise
road feel may be caused by worn or
damaged suspension components.
When troubleshooting suspension and
steering problems, also consider the
condition of tires, wheels and their
alignment. Tire wear and incorrect
inflation pressures can dramatically
affect handling. Subtle irregularities in
wheel alignment angles also affect
stability. Mixing different types or sizes
of tires, particularly on the same axle,
can affect alignment and may
unbalance a car's handling.
Table d. Suspension and steering
troubleshootinglists the symptoms of
common suspension and steering
problems and their probable causes,
and suggests corrective actions. Bold
type indicates the repair groups where
applicable test and repair procedures
can be found.
Table d. Suspension and steering troubleshooting
Symptom
Probable cause
Repairs
Breaking away while braking
Worn struts or shock
absorbers
Replace struts or shock
absorbers.
310,
330
Car pulls to one side,
wanders
Incorrect tire pressure
Check and correct tire
pressures.
020
Incorrect wheel alignment
Check and adjust wheel
alignment.
320
Faulty brakes (pulls only
when braking)
Check for sticking/damaged
front caliper.
340
Worn struts or shock
absorbers
Replace struts or shock
absorbers.
310,
330
Front end or rear end
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
2 of 6
Symptom
vibration or shimmy
Poor handling, poor
directional stability
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Probable cause
Repairs
Worn suspension bushings
(control arm or trailing arm)
Replace worn bushings.
310,
330
Worn front suspension ball
joints (control arm, steering
arm or steering tie-rod end)
Replace worn ball joints.
310
Unbalanced or bent
wheels/tires Loose wheel lug
bolts
Balance tires.
Check tires for uneven wear
patterns.
Check wheels for damage. .
Loose wheel lug bolts
Tighten lug bolts to proper
torque.
Rear control arm or rear
subframe bushings worn or
damaged
Replace rear suspension
bushings as necessary.
330
Rear alignment incorrect
Check and adjust wheel
alignment.
320
Poor stability, repeated
Worn struts or shock
bouncing after bumps,
absorbers
suspension bottoms out easily
Replace struts or shock
310,
330
absorbers.
Rear end hop with hard
braking
Rear trailing arm busing worn Replace trailing arm
or damaged
bushing.
330
Steering heavy, poor returnto-center
Worn upper strut mounts
Replace strut mounts.
Incorrect tire pressure
Check and correct tire
pressures.
020
steering system faulty
Check power steering fluid
level.
320
Incorrect tire pressure
Check and correct tire
pressures.
020
Steering loose, imprecise
310
Loose steering rack mounting Inspect and tighten bolts.
bolt(s)
320
Worn tie rod end(s)
Replace tie rod(s) and align
wheels.
320
Faulty front wheel bearing
Replace wheel bearing.
310
Worn or damaged steering
rack
Adjust or replace steering
rack.
320 .
Worn tires
Replace tires.
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Symptom
Probable cause
Repairs
Suspension noise, especially
over bumps (drumming,
rattling)
Worn front upper strut
mounts
Replace upper strut mounts.
310
Worn suspension bushings
(control arm or trailing arm)
Replace worn bushings.
310,
330
Worn stabilizer bar rubber
mounts
Replace stabilizer bar rubber
mounts.
310 ,
330
Loose suspension subframe
Check subframe for damage.
Tighten mounting bolts.
Tail skid when braking
Rear trailing arm front
bushing worn or damaged
Replace trailing arm
bushing.
330
Tire flat spots
Worn struts or shock
absorbers
Replace struts or shock
absorbers.
310 ,
330
Uneven ride height
Incorrect coil springs
Measure ride height.
300
Bent or damaged suspension Inspect, repair/replace as
310 ,
330
components
necessary.
Sagging coil springs
Unsteady in curves,
self-steering, poor rear end
stability
Replace springs as
310 ,
necessary.
330
Rear subframe bushings
worn or damaged
Replace rear suspension
bushings as necessary.
330
Differential bushings worn or
damaged
Replace rear suspension
bushings as necessary.
330
Rear shock absorbers worn
Replace rear shock
absorbers.
330
Wheel noise, continuous
growling, may be more
noticeable when turning
Worn wheel bearing
Replace wheel bearing.
310 ,
330
Wheel-hop on normal road
surface
Worn struts or shock
absorbers
Replace struts or shock
absorbers.
310 ,
330
ABS troubleshooting
ABS is designed to be maintenance free.
There are no adjustments that can be
made to the system. Repair and
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
troubleshooting of major ABS
components requires special test
equipment and knowledge and should
be performed by an authorized BMW
dealer.
ABS is self-tested by the control module
each time the car is started. Once the
test is complete, the ABS dashboard
warning light turns off. If the light
remains lit or comes on at any time
during driving, a system fault has
occurred and ABS is electronically
disabled. The conventional braking
system remains fully functioning.
When a system or component failure
occurs in the electronic braking and
stability control systems, either the brake
warning light, ABS warning light, or the
ASC / DSC warning light will
illuminate.Troubleshooting and
diagnosis for the electronic braking and
stability control systems must be made
using an electronic scan tool.
Brake bleeding functions, as well as
component coding and initialization must
be completed using BMW scan tools DIS
or MoDiC.
ABS system inspection
A visual inspection of the ABS system
components may help to locate system
faults. If no visual faults can be found
and the ABS light remains on, have the
system diagnosed by an authorized
BMW dealer.
Carefully inspect the entire ABS wiring
harness, particularly the pulse sensor
harnesses and connectors near each
wheel. Look for chafing or damage due
to incorrectly routed wires.
Carefully remove the wheel speed
sensors. Clean the sensor tips. Inspect
toothed wheel on wheel hub. Check for
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
missing, clogged or corroded teeth, or
other damage that could alter the
clearance between the sensor tip and
toothed wheel.
Ride height
Ride height measurement (A) at either
axle is taken from center of wheel arch to
bottom of wheel rim.
If the ride height is outside the
specification listed, new springs should
be installed. Be sure to have the old
spring code number on hand when
ordering new spring.
Table e. Front ride height
specifications (measurement A) lists
front suspension ride height
specifications,
Table f. Rear ride
height specifications (measurement A)
lists rear suspension ride height
specifications. These specifications
apply to a car in a normally loaded
position. When checking ride height or
installing suspension components that
require the car to be "normally loaded,"
load the car as follows:
Normal loaded position
Each front seat
68 Kg (150 lbs)
Rear seat (center)
68 Kg (150 lbs)
Trunk
Fuel tank
21 Kg (46 lbs)
full
Table e. Front ride height specifications (measurement A)
Wheel size
Standard
suspension
Sport
suspension
Rough road
suspension
15 inch
576 mm
(22.67 in.)
561 mm
(22.08 in.)
593 mm
(23.35 in.)
All wheel drive
suspension
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Suspension, Steering and Brakes — General
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Wheel size
Standard
suspension
Sport
suspension
Rough road
suspension
All wheel drive
suspension
16 inch
589 mm
(23.19 in.)
574 mm
(22.59 in.)
606 mm
(23.86 in.)
606 mm
(23.85 in.)
17 inch
604 mm
(23.77 in.)
589 mm
(23.19 in.)
621 mm
(24.44 in.)
621 mm
(24.44 in.)
18 inch
617 mm
(24.29 in.)
602 mm
(23.71 in.)
634 mm
(24.96 in.)
634 mm
(24.96 in.)
Maximum variation between sides: 10 mm (0.4 in)
Maximum deviation from specifications: 10 mm (0.4 in)
Table f. Rear ride height specifications (measurement A)
Wheel size
Standard
suspension
Sport
suspension
Rough road
suspension
All wheel drive
suspension
15 inch
542 mm
(21.33 in.)
526 mm
(20.70 in.)
562 mm
(22.12 in.)
16 inch
555 mm
(21.85 in.)
539 mm
(21.22 in).
575 mm
(22.64 in.)
572 mm
(22.52 in.)
17 inch
570 mm
(22.44 in.)
554 mm
(21.81 in.)
590 mm
(23.22 in).
587 mm
(23.11 in.)
18 inch
583 mm
(22.95 in.)
567 mm
(22.32 in.)
603 mm
(23.74 in.)
600 mm
(23.62 in.)
Maximum variation between sides: 10 mm (0.4 in)
Maximum deviation from specifications: 10 mm (0.4 in)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:24 PM
Front Suspension
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
310-1
General
This repair group covers the repair and
replacement of components that make
up the front suspension of E46 cars.
See
300 Suspension, Steering and
Brakes-General for a description of the
front suspension and components, as
well as specification for setting ride
height.
Special tools
Special service tools are required for
most of the work described in this
repair group. In addition to the tools
depicted in the illustrations, a variety of
press tools are necessary for control
arm bushing replacement.
Read the procedures through before
beginning any job.
Engine support bracket BMW 00 0
200/00 0 205
Bearing puller BMW 00 7 500/31 2 106
Wheel bearing installation tool BMW 31
2 110
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Upper strut nut removal socket BMW
31 2 210
Front coil spring compressor BMW 31 3
120
Ball joint puller (all wheel drive BMW
32 2 040
Ball joint puller BMW 32 3 090
Outer CV joint removal tool BMW 33 2
111/116/117
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Slide hammer with adapter BMW 33 4
201/202/203 33 2 116
Inner bearing race puller set BMW 33 4
400
Front suspension construction
Some front suspension components
are constructed of weight saving
materials. For example, the control
arms (in rear wheel drive models) are
forged aluminum. This allows for
weight reduction in the car, as well as a
lower unsprung mass for better
handling. However, the aluminum
construction prevents removal or
replacement of the pressed-in ball
joints.
WARNING!
Physical safety could be
impaired if procedures
described here are undertaken
without the proper service tools
and equipment. Be sure to have
the right tools on hand before
beginning any job.
Do not reuse self-locking nuts or
bolts. They are designed to be
used only once and may fail if
reused. Always replace
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
self-locking fasteners any time
they are loosened or removed.
Do not install bolts and nuts
coated with undercoating wax,
as the correct tightening torque
cannot be assured. Always
clean the threads with solvent
before installation, or install
new parts.
Do not attempt to weld or
straighten any suspension
components. Replace damaged
parts.
CAUTION!
Due to the aluminum
construction of the control arms,
great care must be taken when
working on and around the front
suspension:
When replacing any damaged
front end components, always
check the condition of the
control arms
Do not clean control arms with
wire brushes made of brass or
iron. Only use brushes made of
stainless steel.
Do not expose control arms to
temperatures exceeding 80°C
(176°F); sparks created by
grinding; battery acid or other
highly corrosive materials; or
steel welding splashes.
Front suspension
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
assembly (6 cylinder
models)
1
- Upper strut
mount
2
- Coil spring
3
- Strut assembly
4
- Control arm
5
- Control arm
bushing and
mount
6
- Tie rod
7
- Steering rack
8
- Front stabilizer
bar
9
- Front
suspension
subframe
10 - Steering arm
11 - Stabilizer bar
link
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
1 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
310-2
Shock Absorbers and
Springs
Note:
Setting the ride height is covered in
300 Suspension, Steering and BrakesGeneral.
The front suspension shock absorbers
in E46 cars are McPherson struts. The
strut is a major component of the
suspension and supports the spring.
Most strut assembly components are
available as replacement parts. Struts
and/or springs should always be
replaced in pairs.
Front strut, upper strut mount or spring
replacement is a two-step procedure:
Removal of strut assembly from
vehicle
Disassembly and replacement of
components on workbench
Strut assembly, removing and
installing
-
Raise car and remove front wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
Pull brake fluid hose and ABS sensor
wire harness off bracket at steering arm
pinch bolt.
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
2 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Note:
Right side shown is in illustration. Left
side bracket also holds brake pad wear
sensor wire.
-
Unbolt brake caliper assembly,
keeping brake hose connected.
Suspend brake caliper from
chassis using stiff wire. See
340 Brakes.
Remove ABS wheel speed sensor
mounting bolt (arrow). Slide sensor out
of steering arm and lay aside.
Note:
Rear wheel drive vehicle shown in
illustration.
On cars equipped with xenon
headlights: Remove headlight vertical
aim sensor link bracket mounting nuts
(arrows) from right control arm.
Loosen and remove stabilizer bar link
mounting nut (arrow) from strut.
Detach link from strut housing.
Note:
Use a thin wrench to counterhold shaft
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
3 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
of stabilizer bar link ball joint while
removing mounting nut.
Remove tie rod outer end nut. Use
BMW special tool 32 3 090 or
equivalent to press tie rod end off
steering arm.
-
Remove lower ball joint nut. Use
BMW special tool 32 3 090 or
equivalent to separate steering
arm from control arm.
Support steering arm from below.
Loosen pinch bolt (arrow) at top of
steering arm. Spread clamping collar at
slot A, if necessary, to slide steering
arm off strut assembly.
Support strut assembly from below.
Working in engine compartment at
strut tower, remove three strut
mounting nuts (A) on strut tower.
If factory alignment locating pin
(B) is missing, be sure to mark
location of strut mounting studs in
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
4 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
strut tower slots (arrows).
CAUTION!
Do not remove center strut retaining
nut.
-
Lower strut assembly from car.
When installing strut assembly into car:
Make sure locating pin (arrow) of
strut bearing is positioned
correctly in strut tower.
If factory alignment locating pin is
missing, make sure three upper
mounting studs are positioned
correctly in slotted holes
according to marks made
previously.
When installing steering arm to strut
assembly, insert positioning pin
(arrow) of strut into slot of steering arm
clamping collar. To ensure proper
alignment specifications, slide steering
arm up on strut until stop is reached.
-
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal.
Be sure to use new self-locking
nuts and bolts.
Use new steering arm mounting
bolts, or clean bolts and use
Loctite® 270 or equivalent threadlocking compound.
When attaching stabilizer link to
strut, use a thin wrench to
counterhold hold link ball joint
while tightening nut.
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
5 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torques
Brake caliper to
steering arm
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Stabilizer bar link
to strut
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Steering tie rod to
steering arm
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Steering arm to
control arm
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Steering arm pinch
bolt at strut
housing
81 Nm (60 ft-lb)
Strut assembly to
strut tower (selflocking nuts)
24 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Upper strut mount to strut tower,
self-locking M8 flanged nut:
18 mm flange
24 Nm (18 ft-lb)
21 mm flange
34 Nm (25 ft-lb)
Front spring and
upper strut mount
assembly
1
- Cap
2
- Upper strut self
locking nut M14
tighten to 64 Nm (47
ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
6 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
3
- Rivet (all wheel
drive or rough
road package
only)
4
- Strut bearing
reinforcement
(all wheel drive
or rough road
package only)
5
- Self locking
flanged nut M8
tighten to:
24 Nm (18 ft-lb) (18
mm flange)
34 Nm (25 ft-lb) (21
mm flange)
6
- Spacer plate (all
wheel drive or
rough road
package only)
7
- Upper strut
bearing
8
- Sealing ring
9
- Flat washer
10 - Upper spring
seat
11 - Upper spring
pad
12 - Rubber stop
13 - Dust seal
14 - Spring
15 - Lower spring
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
7 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
pad
16 - Strut
Strut assembly, disassembling
and assembling
Replacing the strut, upper strut mount or
spring requires that the strut assembly
first be removed from the car and
disassembled. For a guide to parts used
during component replacement, see the
accompanying diagram.
-
Remove strut assembly as
described earlier. Place in shop
vice, or support securely.
-
Using spring compressor, compress
spring until spring force on upper
mount is relieved.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to disassemble
the struts without a spring
compressor designed specifically
for this job.
Make sure the spring compressor
grabs the spring fully and
securely before compressing it.
-
Pry protective cover off top of strut
assembly. Use BMW special tool 31
2 210 or equivalent socket to
remove strut top (center) nut.
Counterhold strut shaft using 6 mm
Allen wrench.
-
Remove upper strut bearing and
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
8 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
related components.
-
Replace strut, upper strut mount or
spring, as needed.
Note:
Springs and/or struts should always be
replaced in pairs.
Be sure that replacement struts are
marked with the same code as the ones
being removed.
Note:
Aftermarket struts are not marked.
Vehicles with "rough road" package are
equipped with a spacer plate above the
upper strut mount. Make sure the strut
mount locating pin fits in the
corresponding bore of the spacer plate.
Note:
If there is no locating bore in the strut
tower for the pin in the replacement
upper strut mount to fit, drive out the pin
before installing the new mount.
Replace springs in pairs only. The part
number (A) is stamped near the large
end of the spring.
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
9 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Assembly is reverse of disassembly,
noting the following:
Line up slot in spring pad with
corresponding slot in lower spring
seat.
Use a new upper strut self locking
nut. Tighten nut fully before
releasing spring compressor.
Be sure upper spring pad is
correctly installed to upper spring
seat and spring end is correctly
seated in upper and lower spring
seats.
Release spring compressor
carefully and evenly, allowing
spring to expand slowly.
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
1 - Self locking nut M8 -tighten to: 24
Nm (18 ft-lb) (18 mm flange) 34 Nm
(25 ft-lb) (21 mm flange)
2 - Strut tower
3 - Upper strut mount
4 - Upper strut self locking nut M14
-tighten to 64 Nm (47 ft-lb)
5 - Upper strut bearing
6 - Sealing ring
7 - Rubber bump-stop
8 - Dust shield
9 - Lower spring pad
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
10 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
10 - Strut housing
11 - Locating pin
12 - Protective cap
13 - Upper spring pad
14 - Washer
15 - Upper spring seat
16 - Spring
17 - Lower spring seat
Tightening torque
Upper strut mount
to strut shaft M14
self-locking nut
64 Nm (47 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
310-3
Front End
Reinforcement
In rear wheel drive models, a front end
reinforcement is bolted to the rear of
the subframe and attached to the
frame rails.
CAUTION!
Do not drive vehicle without the front
end reinforcement in place. Damage
to the front suspension may result.
The tubular front end reinforcement is
installed with 4 bolts (A) in the
following cars:
Rear wheel drive Sedan and Sport
Wagon models manufactured until
production date 12/2000.
Coupe models manufactured until
production date 11/1999.
-
The aluminum plate type front end
reinforcement is installed in the
following cars:
All Convertible models
Coupe models manufactured from
production date 11/1999.
Rear wheel drive Sedan and Sport
Wagon models manufactured
from production date 12/2000.
CAUTION!
After 2/2001, the front reinforcement
plate was produced with larger cast
depressions to accommodate the
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
larger (66 mm) front control arm
bushings. The difference in the early
production and later plates can only
be discerned by removing the plate.
In order to safely use an early
production plate in a car with larger
bushings, insert appropriate sized
washers between frame rails and
reinforcement plate at bolts B.
-
When reinstalling front end
reinforcement:
Replace mounting bolts.
Torque bolts in 2 stages, as
shown below. Use BMW special
tool 00 9 120 or equivalent torque
angle protractor.
Tightening torque
Front end reinforcement to front
subframe or body frame rails: M10
bolt (Aor B) (always replace)
Stage 1
59 Nm (43 ft-lb)
Stage 2
torque angle 90°
+ 30°
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:25 PM
Front Suspension
1 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
310-4
Front Subframe
The front subframe provides rigid
mounting points for the engine,
suspension, and steering components.
The subframe is not normally subject
to wear and should only be replaced if
structurally damaged.
Rear wheel drive and all wheel drive
models differ significantly in the design
of the front subframe.
Removing the front subframe requires
engine lifting equipment to support the
weight of the engine from above so that
the subframe can be removed from
below.
CAUTION!
Removal or replacement of the
subframe may affect suspension and
steering geometry, including front
wheel alignment. Make appropriate
matching marks during removal and
have the front end aligned once
repairs are complete.
Front subframe, removing and
installing (rear wheel drive
models)
Using engine support equipment, raise
engine until weight of engine is
supported.
-
Raise car and remove front
wheels.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
2 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
-
Remove splash shield under
engine compartment.
-
Remove front end reinforcement.
See
Front End Reinforcement
earlier in this group.
On cars equipped with xenon
headlights: Remove front ride level
sensor mounting fastener (arrow) and
lay sensor aside.
Remove right front control arm bracket
bolts (arrows) from frame rail.
-
Repeat for left side.
Remove right inner control arm ball
joint mounting nut (arrow) at
subframe.
Drive ball joint shaft out of
subframe using soft hammer.
Push control arm aside.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
3 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Repeat for left side.
Remove steering rack mounting bolts
(arrows) at front of subframe. Suspend
rack out of the way with stiff wire.
Remove right lower engine mount
fastener (arrow).
-
Repeat on left side
Support suspension subframe from
below using appropriate jacking
equipment. Remove subframe
mounting bolts (arrows). Remove
subframe.
Note:
Right side is shown in photo. Left is
similar.
Installation is reverse of removal, noting
the following:
Make sure all bolts, bolt holes,
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
4 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
and mating surfaces are clean to
ensure proper tightening and
alignment. Use new self-locking
nuts or bolts, where applicable.
Lower engine onto engine mounts,
allowing it to settle fully before
tightening engine mount bolts.
When the job is completed, have
front end professionally aligned.
1 - Front subframe
2 - inner ball joint nut -tighten to 90
Nm (66 ft-lb)
3 - Subframe mounting bolt (See
torque table.)
4 - Control arm
Tightening torques
Control arm ball
joint to subframe
M14 self-locking
nut (always
replace)
90 Nm (66 ft-lb)
Control arm
bushing carrier to
body M10 bolt
(always replace)
59 Nm (43 ft-lb)
Front end reinforcement to front
subframe or body frame rails: M10
bolt (always replace)
Stage 1
59 Nm (43 ft-lb)
Stage 2
torque angle 90°
+ 30°
Steering rack to
subframe (M10
bolt)
42 Nm (31 ft-lb)
Subframe to body
M12-8.8 bolts
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
5 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
M12-10.9 bolts
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
M12-12.9 bolts
105 Nm (77
ft-lb)
Front subframe, removing and
installing (all wheel drive
models)
Using engine support equipment, raise
engine until weight of engine is
supported.
-
Raise car and remove front
wheels.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
-
Remove splash shield under
engine compartment.
On cars equipped with xenon
headlights: Remove front ride level
sensor mounting fastener (arrow) and
lay sensor aside.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
6 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Working at rear right corner of front
subframe, unhook heatshield from
subframe (arrow).
Remove left engine mount fastener
(arrow).
-
Repeat for right side.
-
Working at right front of subframe,
detach power steering lines.
Remove stabilizer bar anchor fasteners
(arrows) from front corners of
subframe. Suspend stabilizer bar from
chassis using stiff wire.
Working at left rear corner of subframe,
remove control arm rear bracket
mounting bolts (arrows).
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
7 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Repeat for right side.
Working at left side of subframe,
remove inner control arm ball joint
mounting bracket bolts (arrows) from
subframe. Hang control arm using stiff
wire.
WARNING!
Do not allow the control arm to hang
from the outer (steering arm) ball
joint. This can damage the ball joint.
Working underneath subframe, remove
steering rack mounting bolts (arrows).
Suspend rack with stiff wire.
Support subframe from below. Remove
subframe mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Slowly lower subframe, making
sure heat shields, wiring
harnesses and other underbody
components are clear during
removal.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
8 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Installation is reverse of removal, noting
the following:
Make sure all bolts, bolt holes,
and mating surfaces are clean to
ensure proper tightening and
alignment. Use new self-locking
nuts or bolts, where applicable.
Lower engine onto engine mounts,
making sure locating pin on left
mount (arrow) seats correctly in
slot of subframe boss.
Allowing engine to settle fully on
mounts before tightening engine
mount fasteners.
When the job is completed have
front end professionally aligned.
Tightening torques
Control arm rear
bracket to
subframe M10 bolt
(always replace)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Engine mount to
subframe M10 self
locking nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Inner ball joint to
control arm M14
self-locking nut
(always replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Inner ball joint
mount to subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Stabilizer anchor to
subframe (M8)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
9 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Steering rack to
subframe (M10
bolt)
42 Nm (31 ft-lb)
Subframe adapter
to body M10 bolt
(always replace)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Subframe front to body
M12-8.8 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
M12-10.9 bolt
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
M12-12.9 bolt
105 Nm (77
ft-lb)
Subframe rear to
adapter M12 bolt
(always replace)
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
All wheel drive front
subframe
1
- Front subframe
2
- Blind rivet nut
3
- Engine
mounting flange
4
- Steering rack
mounting flange
5
- Stabilizer bar
mounting
6
- Subframe to
body adapter
7
- Bolt M10
(always replace)
tighten to 59 Nm
(44-ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
10 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
8
- Bolt M10
(always replace)
tighten to 59 Nm (44
ft-lb)
9
- Control arm rear
bracket
10 - Bolt M12
(always replace)
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
11 - Jack point
12 - Subframe
mounting bolt
M12 (see torque
table)
13 - Control arm
inner ball joint
14 - Bolt M12
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
15 - Self locking nut
M14 (always
replace)
tighten to 80 Nm (59
ft-lb)
Control Arms
In all models each front control arm has
three attachment points:
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
11 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
A Outer ball joint attached to
steering arm
B Inner ball joint attached to front
subframe
C Bushing and bracket attached to
the frame rail (rear wheel drive
models) or front subframe (all wheel
drive models)
Note:
Rear wheel drive front control arm is
shown in the illustration.
On all models the rear bushing of the
control arm is available as a replacement
part.
On rear wheel drive models, both ball
joints are pressed into the control arm at
the factory. On all wheel drive models,
the outer (steering arm) ball joint is
pressed in. Because of the aluminum
construction of the control arm,
pressed-in ball joints are not removable.
In case of pressed-in ball joint wear or
damage, the complete control arm must
be replaced. The control arm with ball
joint(s) is available as a replacement unit
from BMW.
E46 cars have been equipped with three
different styles of control arm. Make sure
a replacement control arm is identical to
the original.
1 - Ball joint nut
2 - Front subframe
3 - Control arm
4 - Bushing
5 - Bushing bracket
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
12 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
6 - Bracket mounting bolt
7 - Inner ball joint (all wheel drive only)
8 - Ball joint mounting bolt
Control arm, removing and
installing (rear wheel drive
models)
-
Raise car and remove wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove splash shield under engine
compartment.
-
Remove front end reinforcement.
On cars equipped with xenon
headlights: Remove self levelling
headlight sensor mounting nuts
(arrows) from right control arm.
Working at steering arm, remove outer
ball joint nut (arrow). Use BMW special
tool 32 3 090 or equivalent to separate
steering arm from control arm.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
13 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove control arm inner ball joint
mounting nut (arrow) at subframe.
Drive ball joint shaft out of subframe
using soft faced hammer.
Support control arm while removing
control arm bracket bolts (arrows) from
frame rail.
-
Remove control arm.
Inspect rear bracket rubber bushing
for wear.
Check ball joints for damage,
looseness, or torn boots.
Replace control arm if ball joints are
damaged.
CAUTION!
If a control arm is deformed due
to an accident, inspect the inner
ball joint mounting bore in the
subframe for damage or
eccentricity.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
14 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
If one control arm rear rubber
bushing is damaged, bushings on
both sides must be replaced.
Note:
Control arm rear bushing replacement is
covered later in this group.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure all thread bores, bolts,
nuts and mating surfaces are clean.
Use new self-locking nuts or bolts,
where applicable.
Have vehicle alignment checked
after assembly. nothing
WARNING!
Do not reuse self-locking nuts or
bolts. They are designed to be used
only once and may fail if reused.
Tightening torques
Control arm rear
bracket to frame
rails M10 bolt
(always replace)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Front end reinforcement to front
subframe or body frame rails: M10 bolt
(always replace)
Stage 1
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Stage 2
torque angle 90°
+ 30°
Inner ball joint to
subframe M14
self-locking nut
(always replace)
90 Nm (66 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
15 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Outer ball joint to
steering arm M12
self-locking nut
(always replace)
Road wheel to hub
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Control arm, removing and
installing (all wheel drive
models)
-
Raise car and remove wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove splash shield under engine
compartment.
On cars equipped with xenon
headlights: Remove headlight vertical
aim sensor mounting nuts (arrows) from
right control arm.
Working at steering arm, remove outer
ball joint nut (arrow). Use BMW special
tool 32 3 090 or equivalent to separate
steering arm from control arm.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
16 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove inner ball joint mounting bracket
bolts (arrows) from subframe.
Support control arm. Working at rear of
subframe, remove control arm rear
bracket mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Remove control arm.
Inspect rear bracket rubber bushing
for wear.
Check ball joints for damage,
looseness, or torn boots.
Replace control arm if outer
(steering arm) ball joint is damaged.
CAUTION!
If a control arm rear rubber bushing is
damaged, both bushings must be
replaced.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
17 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Inner ball joint and control arm rear
bushing replacement is covered later in
this group.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure all thread bores, bolts,
nuts and mating surfaces are clean.
Use new self-locking nuts or bolts,
where applicable.
Have vehicle alignment checked
after assembly. nothing
WARNING!
Do not reuse self-locking nuts or
bolts. They are designed to be used
only once and may fail if reused.
Tightening torques
Control arm rear
bracket to subframe
M10 bolt (always
replace)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Inner ball joint
mount to subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Outer ball joint to
steering arm M12
self-locking nut
(always replace)
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 N
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Inner ball joint, replacing (all
wheel drive models)
-
Raise car and support safely
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
18 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove splash shield under engine
compartment.
Remove inner ball joint fasteners from
control arm and subframe.
Remove nut (A) from ball joint
shaft.
Remove bolts (B) from subframe.
Use BMW special tool 32 2 040 or
equivalent to separate ball joint from
control arm.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure thread bores, bolts, nuts
and mating surfaces are clean.
Use new self-locking nuts or bolts.
Tightening torques
Inner ball joint
mount to subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
19 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Inner ball joint to
control arm M14
self-locking nut
(always replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Control arm bushings, rear
wheel drive
CAUTION!
Never reuse a rubber bushing that
has been pulled off the control
arm. The rubber coated inner
sleeve is destroyed when it is
pulled off dry.
Check with an authorized BMW
parts dealer for the latest
information about control arm
bushing applications on E46 cars.
Control arm bushings should always be
replaced in pairs. The two bushings and
bushing carriers should have the same
markings, indicating same manufacturer.
-
To gain access to bushing, remove
control arm as described earlier.
-
Use puller to remove rear bracket
and bushing from control arm.
Inspect pin (rubber bushing) end of
control arm. Replace control arm with
end A.
Note:
Control arms with pin shape A have been
superseded by parts with pin shape B.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
20 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Inspect bushing bracket. Replace
bracket if there is a center punch mark at
boss A.
WARNING!
If a bushing bracket with the center
punch mark is reused with a new
bushing, the bushing may fall out.
Use press tools to remove old bushing
and press in new. Be sure to line up
marks on new bushing with boss on
bracket. Depending on manufacturer,
mark on bushing may consist of:
Extra buffer on inner part of
bushing (A)
Arrow on rubber webbing of
bushing (B)
Indent on outer casing of bushing
(C)
New bushing must be pressed in so that
it protrudes the correct distance from
Table a.
edges of bracket. See
Table a. Control arm bushing
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
21 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
protrusion (rear wheel drive models)
Dimension
A = Total
bushing
length
(nominal)
60 mm
bushing
66 mm
bushing
50.5 mm
(1.99 in.)
53.5 mm
(2.11 in.)
B = Bracket
width
(nominal)
34.0 mm (1.36 in.)
C = Fixed
measurement
8.5 mm
(0.33 in.)
12.0 mm
(0.47 in.)
D=
Protrusion
8.0 mm
(0.31 in)
7.5 mm
(0.29 in.)
When installing bushing on control arm:
Use soapy water on control pin and
rubber bushing to facilitate
assembly.
Make sure dimension A(distance
from inner ball joint to edge of
control arm bushing) is correct after
assembly. See
Table b.
Table b. rear wheel drive models)
Bushing diameter Bushing
or model
distance A
60 mm
289 ± 1 mm
(11.38 ± 0.04 in.)
66 mm
290.9 ± 1 mm
(11.45 ± 0.04 in.)
Be sure to reinstall bushing bracket to
frame rail correctly, with larger centering
bores facing up toward body.
Tightening torque
Control arm rear
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
22 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torque
bracket to frame rail
M10 bolt (always
replace)
Control arm bushings, all wheel
drive
CAUTION!
Never reuse a rubber bushing that
has been pulled off the control
arm. The rubber coated inner
sleeve is destroyed when it is
pulled off dry.
Check with an authorized BMW
parts dealer for the latest
information about control arm
bushing applications on E46 cars.
Control arm bushings should always be
replaced in pairs. The two bushings and
bushing carriers should have the same
markings, indicating same manufacturer.
-
To gain access to bushing, remove
control arm as described earlier.
-
Use puller to remove rear bracket
and bushing from control arm.
Use press tools to remove old bushing
and press in new.
Align bushing with bracket as
shown in accompanying illustration.
Note:
Brackets are marked L or R for left or
right.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
23 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
CAUTION!
Never reuse a rubber bushing that has
been pulled off the control arm. The
rubber coated inner sleeve is
destroyed when it is pulled off dry.
When installing bushing on control arm:
Coat control arm pin and rubber
mount with appropriate lubricant to
facilitate installation.
Make sure dimension A(distance
from first bore in control arm to
outer edge of control arm bushing)
is correct after assembly. See
Table c.
Note:
Slacken pressing tool when measuring
installation distance. Rubber bushing
must be allowed to relax for
measurement to be accurate,.
Table c. Control arm bracket
installation distance (all wheel drive
models)
Measurement A
170 ± 1 mm
(6.69 ± 0.04 in.)
Bolt bracket and control arm to front
subframe and steering arm immediately
after pressing on bushing. Be sure to
reinstall bushing bracket to subframe
correctly, with larger centering bores
facing subframe surface.
Tightening torque
Control arm rear
bracket to subframe
M10 bolt (always
replace)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
24 of 24
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
WARNING!
After installation, the car must be
left undisturbed for a minimum of
30 minutes. Leave car on the
ground but avoid major
movement.
After approx. 30 minutes, the
lubricant used to slide on the
bushing will have evaporated and
the control arm will be correctly
seated in the rubber.
Serious handling problems could
result if these instructions are not
carried out.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
310-5
Stabilizer Bar
Stabilizer bar, removing and
installing
On E46 models the stabilizer bar links
attach to the strut assemblies.
-
Raise car and support safely.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
Remove stabilizer bar connecting link
mounting nut (arrow) from stabilizer
bar on right side. Counterhold ball joint
with flat wrench. (Rear wheel drive
model shown.)
-
Repeat on left side.
Remove stabilizer bar bushing anchor
nuts (arrows) on right side.
-
Repeat on left side.
-
Remove bar.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
If necessary, loosen and remove
stabilizer bar link mounting nut (arrow)
from strut. Detach link from strut
housing.
Note:
Use a thin wrench to counterhold shaft
of stabilizer bar link ball joint while
removing mounting nut.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following
Use new self-locking nuts on
connecting links.
When attaching stabilizer link to
strut or bar, use a thin wrench to
counterhold ball joints on link
while tightening nut.
Installation of stabilizer bar is
easiest with car level (front wheels
at the same height) and as near to
normal ride height as possible.
Tightening torques
Stabilizer bar
bushing brackets
to subframe
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Stabilizer bar link
to stabilizer bar
M10 self locking
nut (always
replace)
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Stabilizer bar link
to strut M10 self
locking nut (always
replace)
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
1 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
310-6
Front Wheel Bearings
The front wheel bearings are
permanently sealed and require no
maintenance.
On rear wheel drive models, the
bearing is integral with the wheel hub
and ABS pulse wheel and pressed on
the steering arm stub axle.
1 - Steering arm and stub axle
2 - Dust guard
3 - Wheel hub, bearing and ABS
pulse wheel
4 - Stub axle collar nut -tighten to 290
Nm (214 ft-lb)
5 - Dust cap
On all wheel drive models, the front
wheel bearing is pressed into the
steering arm. The wheel hub is
pressed into the bearing and the outer
CV joint stub axle is pressed into the
hub.
The ABS front pulse wheel in all wheel
drive models is the inner (ridged) seal
of the front wheel bearing.
Special press tools are required to
replace the front wheel bearings. Read
the procedures through before
beginning the job.
Front wheel bearing, replacing
(rear wheel drive models)
-
Raise car and remove front wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
2 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
Pry off dust cap from center of wheel
hub. Bend back staked part (arrow) of
wheel hub (axle) collar nut.
-
Remount wheel and lug bolts.
-
Lower car to ground. With an
assistant applying brakes, loosen
collar nut. Do not remove
completely.
CAUTION!
The wheel hub collar nut is tightened
to a torque of 290 Nm (214 ft-lb).
Make sure the car is firmly on the
ground.
-
Raise car and remove wheel.
Remove ABS wheel speed sensor
(arrow).
-
Remove brake caliper assembly
and brake rotor as described in
340 Brakes. Leave brake hose
connected to caliper. Suspend
caliper assembly from chassis
using stiff wire.
-
Remove wheel hub collar nut.
Remove wheel hub with integral wheel
bearing from steering arm using a slide
hammer puller (BMW special tools 33 4
201, 33 4 202, 33 4 203 and 33 2 116)
or conventional puller as illustrated.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
3 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
If outermost bearing inner race
stays on steering arm stub axle,
use BMW special tool set 33 4 400
or two-jaw puller to remove race.
CAUTION!
Do not reuse a wheel bearing
assembly once it has been removed.
The removal process destroys the
bearing.
To remove innermost inner race:
Unbolt brake rotor dust shield.
Bend back wheel bearing dust
guard.
Use BMW special tools 00 7 500
and 31 2 106 to pull race off stub
axle.
-
Install splash guard and new dust
shield behind bearing. Press new
wheel hub/bearing assembly on
stub axle using BMW special tool
31 2 110 or equivalent.
CAUTION!
The BMW special tool insures that
only the inner bearing race is used to
press on the hub and bearing
assembly. The bearing is damaged if
it is not pressed on using the inner
race.
-
Install new collar nut. Do not
tighten nut to its final torque at
this time.
Install brake rotor and brake
caliper. See
340 Brakes.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
4 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Mount wheel and lug bolts. Lower
car to ground to gain leverage.
Tightening torques
Brake caliper to
steering arm
110 Nm (81 ft-lb
Brake rotor to
wheel hub
16 Nm (12 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
-
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
With an assistant applying brakes,
tighten collar nut.
Tightening torque
Collar nut to stub
axle
290 Nm (214
ft-lb)
-
Raise car and remove wheel.
-
Stake axle nut and caulk threads
of stub axle.
-
Install a new grease cap, using
Loctite® 638 sealant or equivalent.
Install wheel and lower car.
-
Install ABS pulse sensor.
Tightening torques
ABS pulse sensor
to steering arm
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Front wheel bearing, replacing
(all wheel drive models)
Removal and installation of the all
wheel drive front wheel bearing is best
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
5 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
accomplished by removing the steering
arm and wheel hub from the car and
separating the components on the
bench.
-
Raise car and remove front wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
Bend back staked part of wheel hub
(axle) collar nut (arrow).
-
Remount wheel and lug bolts.
-
Lower car to ground. With an
assistant applying brakes, loosen
collar nut. Do not remove
completely.
CAUTION!
The wheel hub collar nut is tightened
to a torque of 420 Nm (310 ft-lb).
Make sure the car is firmly on the
ground.
-
Raise car and remove front wheel.
Remove ABS wheel speed sensor
(arrow).
-
Remove brake caliper assembly
and brake rotor as described in
340 Brakes. Leave brake hose
connected to caliper. Suspend
caliper assembly from chassis
using stiff wire.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
6 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove tie rod outer end nut. Use
BMW special tool 32 3 090 or
equivalent to press tie rod end off
steering arm.
-
Detach control arm from front axle
subframe as described earlier.
-
Remove outer ball joint nut. Use
BMW special tool 32 3 090 or
equivalent to separate steering
arm and strut assembly from
control arm.
-
Attach BMW special tool 33 2 111
/116 /117, or equivalent puller, to
steering arm using five lug bolts
and press outer CV joint stub axle
inward, out of steering arm.
Support steering arm from below.
Loosen pinch bolt (arrow) at top of
steering arm. Spread clamping collar at
slot A, if necessary, to slide steering
arm off strut assembly.
-
Working at bench, clamp steering
arm in a vise.
CAUTION!
Use a vise with aluminum jaws, or
protect steering arm from damage
when clamping in vise.
Remove wheel hub with integral wheel
bearing from steering arm using a slide
hammer puller (BMW special tools 33 4
201, 33 4 202, 33 4 203 and 33 2 116).
-
If bearing inner race stays on
wheel hub, use BMW special tool
set 33 4 400 or two-jaw puller to
remove race.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
7 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove circlip (3) from steering arm.
1 - Steering arm
2 - Wheel bearing
3 - Circlip (always replace)
4 - Dust guard
5 - Wheel hub
-
Drive wheel bearing out of
steering arm using a press with
appropriate adapters.
CAUTION!
Do not reuse a wheel bearing
assembly once it has been removed.
The removal process destroys the
bearing.
-
Press in bearing using a press
with appropriate adapters.
Note:
When installing the front wheel
bearing into the steering arm, be
sure that the ridged bearing seal
(ABS impulse wheel) is facing
inboard. Start the bevelled edge of
the bearing into the bore first.
Coat bearing seat in steering arm
over 50% of its length with
Loctite® 648.
Make sure press fit surfaces are
clean and free of grease.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
8 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Replace circlip, making sure ring
is correctly seated.
-
Place dust guard over steering
arm hub.
-
Drive wheel hub into bearing
using a shop press.
CAUTION!
Press only on the inner race. The
bearing is damaged if it is not
pressed on using the inner race.
-
Installation of steering arm to car
is reverse of removal, noting the
following:
Replace control arm bracket bolts.
Torque stub axle collar nut with
vehicle on the ground. Stake nut
and caulk stub axle threads.
Have vehicle professionally
aligned.
Tightening torques
Ball joint to
steering arm
Brake caliper to
steering arm
Brake rotor to
wheel hub
Collar nut to wheel
hub
Control arm
bracket to
subframe
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
16 Nm (12 ft-lb)
420 Nm (310
ft-lb)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Suspension
9 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Steering arm pinch
bolt at strut
housing
Road wheel to hub
Tie rod to steering
arm
81 Nm (60 ft-lb)
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:26 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
311-1
General
This repair group covers the service
and replacement of components that
make up the front drive axle for
vehicles equipped with all wheel drive.
This drive system is integrated into the
front suspension of these models.
For a general description of the front
suspension and components, see
300 Suspension, Steering and BrakesGeneral.
Some procedures will require you to
also refer to the following repair
groups:
260 Driveshaft
270 Transfer Case
310 Front Suspension
340 Brakes
Procedures involving the internal
repairs of the front differential are not
included in this manual.
Special tools
BMW recommends special tools for the
removal of the drive axles as well as
the installation of the front differential
input drive flange seal. Commonly
available pullers and drifts can often be
substituted for the specified tools.
Read the procedures through before
beginning any job.
Engine support bracket BMW 00 0 200
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Transmission flange holder BMW 23 0
020
Inner CV joint puller BMW 31 1 170
Impact drift BMW 31 5 130
Outer CV joint removal tool BMW 33 2
111/116/117
System description
The front axle final drive unit is
integrated into the engine oil pan on all
wheel drive equipped models. The
front differential and the right side
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
bearing pedestal bolt to each side of a
modified oil pan. Power is transmitted
to the front differential from the transfer
case via a driveshaft, and out to front
drive hubs through two drive axles.
All wheel drive front
differential and front
subframe
1
- Front subframe
2
- Right axle
bearing pedestal
3
- Sealing O-ring
4
- Oil pan
5
- Bolt M12
(always replace)
8.8 grade tighten to
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
10.9 grade tighten
to 110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
12.9 grade tighten
to 105 Nm (77 ft-lb)
6
- Bolt M12
(always replace)
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
7
- Bolt M10
(always replace)
tighten to 59 Nm (44
ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
8
- Bolt M10
(always replace)
tighten to 59 Nm (44
ft-lb)
9
- Bolt M12
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
10 - Front control
arm with ball
joint and rear
mounting
bracket
11 - Front
differential
12 - Front
differential drain
plug
tighten to 65 Nm (48
ft-lb)
13 - Bolt M10
tighten to 45 Nm (33
ft-lb)
14 - Drive axle radial
seal
15 - Drive axle
16 - Front
differential fill
plug
tighten to 65 Nm (48
ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
1 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
311-2
Drive Axles
The front drive axles for all wheel drive
equipped models use two different
types of constant-velocity (CV) joint.
The outer CV joints are a traditional
design that allows power to be
delivered from the axle to the joint
continuously through rotation.
The inner CV joints are triple roller
bearing joints. This design minimizes
the amount of vibration and noise
transmitted back through the vehicle
drivetrain, while also allowing the axle
to move in and out to compensate for
suspension travel.
To replace a CV joint or dust boot, the
drive axle must be removed from the
car.
Drive axle, removing and
installing
Note:
If removing the drive axle for service, it
is a good idea to replace the drive axle
radial seal while the axle is removed
from the vehicle.
-
Carefully remove center cap from
wheel.
Break free staked collar nut (arrow) at
steering arm.
-
Lift vehicle and support safely.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
2 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove front wheel.
-
Remove splash shield from below
engine compartment.
-
If working on right side, remove
right side heat shield from front
axle support.
Remove ABS sensor (arrow) from
steering arm.
-
Unclip brake hose from mounting
bracket.
-
Unbolt brake caliper and suspend
from body using stiff wire.
-
On vehicles equipped with Xenon
lighting, detach headlight vertical
aim sensor from control arm.
-
Unfasten stabilizer link from
stabilizer bar.
-
Remove collar nut from drive axle
at steering arm.
-
Using BMW special tool 33 2
111/116/117, or similar tool, press
outboard end of axle out from
drive flange at steering arm.
Remove inner ball joint mounting
bracket bolts (arrows) from subframe.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
3 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Support control arm. Working at rear of
subframe, remove control arm rear
bracket mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Tilt steering arm to one side, out
of the way.
-
Using BMW special tool 31 1 170
or equivalent pry bar, pry inboard
CV joint out of front differential or
bearing pedestal.
Note:
Be prepared to catch oil drips from
differential or right side bearing
pedestal.
Installation is reverse of removal, noting
the following:
Replace drive axle radial seal
before replacing drive axle.
Before installing drive axle,
replace inboard CV joint spring
clip (arrow).
When pressing drive axle into
front axle differential or bearing
pedestal, be sure to press axle
beyond resistance of spring clip.
Spring clip must snap audibly into
place.
Replace bolts holding control arm
bushing bracket to front axle
subframe.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
4 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Be sure to restake new collar nut
at outboard end of drive axle after
tightening to correct torque
specifications. Caulk axle threads.
Top up differential fluid. See
Front differential oil, checking and
filling
Tightening torques
Brake caliper to
steering arm
Control arm
bushing bracket to
front axle subframe
(replace bolts)
Drive flange collar
nut to front hub
Inner ball joint
bracket to front
axle subframe
Road wheel to hub
Stabilizer link to
stabilizer bar
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
420 Nm (310
ft-lb)
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Drive axle radial seal, replacing
Note:
If only replacing drive axle radial seal,
the axle does not need to be completely
removed from the vehicle. Only the
inboard CV joint needs to be removed
from either the front axle differential or
the right axle bearing pedestal. The
front suspension may be partially
disassembled for radial seal
replacement.
-
Lift vehicle and support safely.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
5 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
WARNING!
Make sure car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from below
engine compartment.
Remove inner ball joint mounting
bracket bolts (arrows) from subframe.
Support control arm. Working at rear of
subframe, remove control arm rear
bracket mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Tilt steering arm to one side, out
of the way.
-
Using BMW special tool 31 1 170
or equivalent pry bar, pry inboard
CV joint out of front differential or
bearing pedestal.
Note:
Be prepared to catch oil drips from
differential or right side bearing
pedestal.
Pry radial seal out of differential
housing or bearing pedestal using a
flat screwdriver.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
6 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
1 - Right axle bearing pedestal
2 - Front differential
3 - Input shaft seal
4 - Small dustcover
5 - Large dustcover
6 - Differential plug
7 - Plug sealing ring
8 - Drive axle radial seal with lock
ring, left
9 - O-ring
10 - Engine oil pan
11 - Drive axle radial seal with lock
ring, right
Note:
Remove protective sleeve from new
drive axle radial seal before installing
seal and save for use during drive axle
installation. Drive axle radial seal is
equipped with protective covering to
prevent sealing lip from damage during
installation.
-
Using BMW special tool 31 5 130
or equivalent drift, drive radial seal
into differential housing or bearing
pedestal.
Coat sealing lip of radial seal with
transmission fluid.
Drive radial seal into differential or
bearing pedestal.
Insert protective sleeve into radial
seal.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
7 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Insert inboard end of drive axle
partially into differential housing or
bearing pedestal.
Withdraw protective sleeve from
sealing lip, cut protective sleeve
and remove sleeve.
Continue installing drive axle until
spring clip snaps audibly into
place.
Note:
Always replace spring clip on inboard
end of drive axle before reinstalling into
differential housing or bearing pedestal.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure inboard end of drive
axle audibly snaps into place.
Replace control arm bracket bolts.
Top up differential fluid. See
Front differential oil, checking and
filling
Tightening torques
Inner ball joint
bracket to front
axle subframe
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Brake caliper to
steering arm
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Control arm
bracket to front
axle subframe
(replace bolts)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
8 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Outer CV joint boot, replacing
Note:
When replacing CV boots, use
complete boot repair kits. A kit will
include a new boot, clamping bands,
special lubricant, and a new outer CV
joint axle circlip. A kit is available from
an authorized BMW dealer parts
department.
-
Remove drive axle from vehicle as
described earlier.
-
Release retaining clamps from
both ends of outer CV boot.
-
Using a hammer, pound outer CV
joint off drive axle.
-
Using a flat blade screw driver, pry
spring clip off drive axle splines.
-
Clean all old lubricant off axle
splines.
Note:
To inspect a CV joint, clean away
grease and look for galling, pitting and
other signs of wear or physical damage.
Polished surfaces or visible ball tracks
alone are not necessarily cause for
replacement. Discoloration due to
overheating indicates lack of
lubrication.
-
Place new clamping bands and
CV boot over drive axle.
-
Replace spring clip on splined
end of drive axle.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
9 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Apply Loctite® 270 or an
equivalent heavy-duty locking
compound to drive axle splines.
WARNING!
Do not let locking compound contact
balls in joint. Apply only a thin coat
to cover splines.
-
Pack outer CV joint with fresh
grease. Tap CV joint onto splined
end of drive axle until spring clip
snaps audibly into place.
CV joint lubricant capacity
Outer CV joint
-
80 gram (2.8 oz.)
Using clamp pliers, secure
retaining clamp into position
tightly sealing large end of boot
against CV joint.
Note:
Before installing each small boot clamp
be sure to "burp" boot by flexing CV
joint as far over as it will go. A small
screw-driver inserted between boot and
axle-shaft will help the process.
-
With outer CV boot full of grease,
and any air eliminated from boot,
secure small end of CV boot onto
CV joint by securing clamp with
pliers.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure inboard end of drive
axle audibly snaps into place.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
10 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Replace control arm bracket bolts.
Be sure to restake new collar nut
at outboard end of drive axle after
tightening to correct torque
specifications. Caulk axle threads.
Top up differential fluid. See
Front differential oil, checking and
filling
Tightening torques
Ball joint bracket to
front axle subframe
Brake caliper to
steering arm
Control arm
bushing bracket to
front axle subframe
Drive flange collar
nut to front hub
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
420 Nm (310
ft-lb)
Inner CV joint boot, replacing
Note:
When replacing CV joint boots, use
complete boot repair kits. A kit will
include a new boot, clamps, special
lubricant, and a new inner universal
joint circlip. A kit is available from an
authorized BMW dealer parts
department.
-
Remove drive axle from vehicle as
described earlier.
-
Release retaining clamp on both
ends of inner CV boot. Pull back
inner boot and detach inner CV
joint housing.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
11 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Remove circlip retaining triple
roller bearing to drive axle and
remove triple roller bearing.
-
Slide boot off drive axle. Separate
inner CV joint boot adapter from
boot.
-
Clean all old lubricant off axle
splines and triple roller bearing
splines.
-
Install new inner CV joint boot:
Attach boot to boot adapter.
Slide retaining clamps and boot
over drive axle.
Secure retaining clamp using
clamp pliers, tightly sealing small
end of boot against drive axle.
Install triple roller bearing with flat edge
of joint facing retaining circlip.
-
Replace inner CV joint housing
shaft circlip.
-
Pack triple roller bearing and inner
CV joint boot with fresh grease.
CV joint lubricant capacity
Inner CV joint
85 gram (3.0 oz.)
-
Insert triple roller bearing into
inner CV joint housing.
-
Secure boot connection to boot
adapter using clamp supplied with
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
12 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
boot kit.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure inboard end of drive
axle audibly snaps into place.
Replace control arm bracket bolts.
Be sure to restake new collar nut
at outboard end of drive axle after
tightening to correct torque
specifications. Caulk axle threads.
Top up differential fluid. See
Front differential oil, checking and
filling
Tightening torques
Ball joint bracket to
front axle subframe
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Brake caliper to
steering arm
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Control arm
bracket to front
axle subframe
(replace bolts)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Drive flange collar
nut to front hub
420 Nm (310
ft-lb)
Inner CV joint
assembly
1
- Spring clip
2
- Inner CV joint
housing
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
13 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
3
- Circlip
4
- Triple roller
bearing
5
- Inner CV joint
boot adapter
6
- Clamp
7
- Inner CV joint
boot
8
- Drive axle shaft
9
- Clamp
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:27 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
1 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
311-3
Front Differential
Procedures for replacement of O-ring
seal between the engine oil pan and
the front differential or right side
bearing pedestal are covered in
Front axle differential, removing and
installing and
Right axle bearing
pedestal, removing and installing.
Front differential oil, checking
and filling
Note:
BMW supplies the E46 all wheel drive
models with lifetime lubrication in the
front differential.
Front differential drain plug and fill
plug (arrows).
Note:
Use an Allen bit socket to remove drain
plug. Alternatively, cut approximately
30 mm (1.2 in) from an Allen key and
use a box end wrench on key stub.
-
Remove oil filler plug.
Note:
Differential fluid level is correct when
fluid begins to spill from fill plug.
-
Fill differential with appropriate
type and quantity of lubricant to
bottom of fill plug bore.
-
Install and tighten fill plug.
Final drive drain and fill
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
2 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Final drive drain and fill
Oil specifications
Front axle
differential oil
capacity
BMW SAF-XO
synthetic oil
0.7 liters (0.74
US qts.)
Tightening torque
Front axle
differential drain /
fill plug
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Front axle differential,
removing and installing
-
Disconnect battery negative (-)
ground at battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting battery, read
battery disconnection cautions given
at front of this manual on page viii.
-
Lift vehicle and support safely.
WARNING!
Make sure car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for purpose. A floor
jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash shield from below
engine compartment.
Support engine using appropriate
lifting device.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
3 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Release nut at top on right engine
mount (arrow).
Remove nut (arrow) at bottom on left
engine mount.
-
Raise engine approximately 10
mm (0.4 in.).
-
Remove front wheels. Unbolt
brake calipers and suspend from
body using stiff wire. See
340
Brakes.
-
Remove front driveshaft. See
260 Driveshaft.
Remove left inner ball joint mounting
bracket bolts (arrows) from subframe.
-
Repeat for right side.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
4 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Support left control arm. Working at
rear of subframe, remove control arm
rear bracket mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Repeat for right side.
Remove left tie rod outer end nut
(arrow). Use BMW special tool 32 3
090 or equivalent to press tie rod end
off steering are.
-
Repeat for right side.
Remove left ABS sensor (arrow) from
steering arm.
-
Repeat for right side.
-
Unclip brake hoses and electrical
harness wires from mounting
brackets.
-
Swing control arms and steering
arms out of the way. Using BMW
special tool 31 1 170 or equivalent
pry bar, pry inner CV joints out of
front differential and bearing
pedestal.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
5 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Note:
Be prepared to catch oil drips from
differential or right side bearing
pedestal.
Working on left side of car:
Release pinch bolt (arrow) at top
of steering arm.
Pull steering arm down from strut
assembly.
Remove steering arm, drive axle,
and control arm assembly as one
unit.
Repeat for right side.
-
Remove lower steering column.
See
320 Steering and Wheel
Alignment.
-
Remove stabilizer bar anchors
from front subframe.
Working underneath car, remove fluid
line banjo bolts (arrows) from steering
rack.
CAUTION!
Plug off power steering lines and
connections to keep out
contamination.
-
Remove front axle subframe and
steering rack from frame rails.
See
310 Front Suspension
Note:
Make sure heat shields, wiring
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
6 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
harnesses and other under body
components are clear during removal.
Detach vent tube from port (A) on front
axle differential. Remove mounting
bolts (B) and remove front axle
differential.
-
Install new sealing ring, coating
inside edge with assembly
lubricant. Push assembly ring up
to sealing ring.
Note:
Sealing and assembly rings
between oil pan and differential
must be replaced before
differential is installed.
Assembly ring prevents damage
when front axle differential is
installed.
When front axle differential is
installed on oil pan, the assembly
ring is forced over sealing ring and
remains in place.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Always replace drive axle radial
seal of differential before installing
drive axles.
Top up differential fluid. See
Front differential oil, checking and
filling
Replace sealing rings when
reinstalling banjo bolts to steering
rack.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
7 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Brake caliper to
steering arm
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Control arm
bracket to front
suspension
subframe (replace
bolts)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Engine mount to
subframe M10 self
locking nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Front axle
differential to oil
pan
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Front axle
differential fill plug
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Hydraulic hoses to power steering
pump
M14 banjo bolt
35 Nm (26 ft-lb)
M16 banjo bolt
40 Nm (30 ft-lb
Inner ball joint to
front suspension
subframe
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Stabilizer bar
bushing brackets
to subframe
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Steering arm to
lower ball joint
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Steering arm
clamping bolt at
strut housing
81 Nm (60 ft-lb)
Steering column to
steering rack
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Steering tie rod to
steering arm
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Subframe front to body
M12-8.8 bolt
77 Nm (56 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
8 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
M12-10.9 bolt
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
M12-12.9 bolt
105 Nm (77
ft-lb)
Subframe rear to
adapter M12 bolt
(always replace)
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Right axle bearing pedestal,
removing and installing
-
Lift vehicle and support safely.
WARNING!
Make sure car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for purpose. A floor
jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove right front wheel.
-
Release nut and remove tie rod
end from right steering arm
assembly.
-
Remove ABS sensor from steering
arm.
-
Unclip brake hose from mounting
bracket.
-
Unbolt brake caliper and suspend
from body using stiff wire.
Remove inner ball joint mounting
bracket bolts (arrows) from subframe.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
9 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Support control arm. Working at rear of
subframe, remove control arm rear
bracket mounting bolts (arrows).
-
Using BMW special tool 31 1 170
or equivalent pry bar, pry inner CV
joint out of bearing pedestal.
-
Release pinch bolt at top of
steering arm. Pull steering arm
down from strut assembly and
remove steering arm, drive axle,
and control arm assembly.
-
Remove grounding strap on
bearing pedestal. Remove four
bolts retaining bearing pedestal to
oil pan, and remove pedestal.
-
Install new sealing ring, coating
inside edge with assembly
lubricant. Push assembly ring up
to sealing ring.
Note:
Sealing and assembly rings
between oil pan and differential
must be replaced before
differential is installed.
Assembly ring prevents damage
when bearing pedestal is installed.
When bearing pedestal is installed
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
10 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
on oil pan, the assembly ring is
forced over sealing ring and
remains in place.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Always replace drive axle radial
seal before installing drive axle.
Top up differential fluid. See
Front differential oil, checking and
filling
Tightening torques
Bearing pedestal to
oil pan
Brake caliper to
steering arm
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
110 Nm (81
ft-lb)
Control arm
bracket to front
suspension
subframe (replace
bolts)
59 Nm (44 ft-lb)
Inner ball joint to
front suspension
subframe
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Steering arm to
lower ball joint
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Steering arm
clamping bolt at
strut housing
81 Nm (60 ft-lb)
Steering tie rod to
steering arm
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Input flange radial seal,
replacing
-
Lift vehicle and support safely.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
11 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
WARNING!
Make sure car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for purpose. A floor
jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove front driveshaft. See
260 Driveshaft
-
Pry out input flange retaining nut
lock plate.
Using a centerpunch, mark relation of
input flange retaining nut to output
shaft.
Counterhold input flange in place
using BMW special tool 23 0 020 and
remove nut.
-
Pull input flange out from
differential using a hub puller.
-
Remove input seal dust shields.
-
Using a seal puller or flat
screwdriver, pry radial seal out of
differential housing.
-
Coat sealing edges of radial seal
with transmission fluid and drive
into differential housing using
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Front Axle Final Drive
12 of 12
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
BMW special tool 31 5 130 or
equivalent drift.
-
Replace dust shields.
-
Clean input flange and install into
differential housing.
Tighten down nut until punch
marks align.
Install new input flange retaining
nut locking plate.
CAUTION!
Do not torque input flange
retaining nut beyond
matchmarks. Over-torquing can
damage differential internals.
Do not replace input flange or
input flange locking nut.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Tightening torque
Input flange collar
nut to differential
until matchmarks
align
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
320-1
General
This repair group covers steering wheel
and column removal and steering
system service, including wheel
alignment information.
Note:
Ignition lock cylinder replacement
is covered in this section.
For information on steering column
mounted switches including the
ignition switch, see
612
Switches
Special tools
Some special tools are necessary to
carry out the repairs and adjustments
required for steering service and wheel
alignment. Be sure to read the
procedures through before starting
work on the vehicle.
Inner tie rod removal tool BMW 32 2
110
Rear toe adjusting tool BMW 32 3 030
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tie rod end removal tool BMW 32 3 090
Front camber adjusting tool BMW 32 3
140
Steering system
The variable-assist power steering
system consists of an engine-driven
hydraulic pump, a rack-and-pinion
steering rack assembly with an integral
hydraulic control valve, and connecting
linkage to the road wheels.
At low speeds, maximum power assist
is provided to ease parking and city
driving. At high speeds, assist is
reduced to ensure stability. The power
steering system varies assist based on
engine speed.
Power assist is provided by a
belt-driven pump on the lower left front
of the engine, just below the alternator.
The steering rack is bolted to the front
subframe underneath the engine. The
steering wheel connects to the rack via
a telescoping column which
incorporates a rubber coupling
("guibo") to dampen vibration and
noise.
The power steering fluid is fed from the
fluid reservoir to the pump and to the
rack via rubber/metal hoses. The return
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
line from the steering rack to the
reservoir loops into the airstream in
front of the vehicle and is used as a
steering fluid cooler.
The steering rack and linkage require
no maintenance other than alignment
and periodic inspection for worn
components. The rubber rack boots
and tie-rod end boots should be
inspected periodically for tears or
damage and replaced if necessary.
WARNING!
The BMW airbag system (MRS II)
is complex. Special precautions
must be observed when
servicing the system. Serious
injury may result if system
service is attempted by persons
unfamiliar with the BMW airbag
system and its approved service
procedures. BMW specifies that
all inspection and service
should be performed by an
authorized BMW dealer.
The BMW E46 is equipped with
an airbag mounted in the
steering wheel. The airbag is an
explosive device and should be
treated with extreme caution.
Always follow the airbag
removal procedure as outlined
in
721 Airbag System (SRS).
BMW airbags are equipped with
a back-up power supply inside
the MRS II control module. A 5
second waiting period should
be observed after the battery
cable has been disconnected.
This will allow the reserve
power supply to discharge.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Do not reuse self-locking nuts.
They are designed to be used
only once and may fail if reused.
Always replace them with new
locking nuts.
Do not install bolts and nuts
coated with undercoating wax,
as correct tightening torque
cannot be assured. Always
clean the threads with solvent
before installation, or install
new parts.
Do not attempt to weld or
straighten any steering
components. Always replace
damaged parts.
Note:
The airbag system is traditionally
referred to as Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS). The BMW version of
SRS used in 1999 to 2001 E46 models
is known as the Multiple Restraint
System (MRS II).
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:28 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
320-2
Steering Wheel
Steering wheel, removing and
installing
-
Center steering wheel. Make sure
front wheels are pointed straight
ahead.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Carefully remove airbag from front
721
of steering wheel. See
Airbag System (SRS). Store
airbag unit in a safe place.
WARNING!
Improper handling of the airbag
could cause serious injury. Store the
airbag with the horn pad facing up. If
stored facing down, accidental
deployment could propel it violently
into the air, causing injury.
CAUTION!
Avoid damaging the variety of
convenience switches, such as radio
and cruise controls, installed in the
steering wheel of some models.
Remove steering wheel center bolt.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
The steering column and steering wheel
are matchmarked (arrow) at the
factory. Confirm these marks before
removing wheel from column.
-
Remove steering wheel.
-
When reinstalling steering wheel:
Align steering wheel and column
match marks.
Align steering wheel to alignment
pins located on steering column
switch block.
Install steering column center bolt.
Do not over-torque.
Tightening torque
Steering wheel to
steering shaft
-
63 Nm (46 ft-lb)
Carefully install airbag. See
Airbag System (SRS)
721
Tightening torque
Airbag to steering
wheel
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Note:
The airbag in some models is attached
to the steering wheel using spring clips
instead of mounting screws.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
320-3
Steering Column
Steering column
assembly
1
- Hex bolt (M14 x
1.5)
tighten to 63 Nm (46
ft-lb)
2
- Cable duct
3
- Steering column
adjustment lever
4
- Upper steering
column
5
- Lower steering
column with
universal joint
6
- Torx bolt (M8 x
33)
tighten to 22 Nm (16
ft-lb)
7
- Flexible joint
(guibo)
8
- Steering angle
sensor
9
- Steering angle
sensor bracket
10 - Column pivot
bushing
11 - Bolt (M8 x 36)
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
tighten to 22 Nm (16
ft-lb)
12 - Steering column
mounting
bracket
13 - Column return
spring
14 - Nut (M8)
tighten to 4.8 Nm
(3.5 ft-lb)
recheck as
necessary
Ignition lock cylinder, removing
and installing
To remove the ring antenna prior to
removing ignition lock cylinder, it is
necessary to remove the upper and
lower steering column trim. Use BMW
special tool 61 3 300 to force off the ring
antenna. Alternatively, remove the
ignition switch key cylinder first.
With ignition key in ON position (60°
from LOCKED):
Insert a thin piece of stiff wire into
opening (arrow) in lock cylinder
and pull lock cylinder out.
Detach ring antenna harness
connector.
Gently work ring antenna off key
cylinder.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Reinstallation is reverse of removal.
Lower steering column,
removing and installing
Note:
Once the lower steering column has been
removed there will be no end stop for the
steering wheel. In order to prevent
damage to contact ring in steering
column, follow procedural steps as listed.
1. Unlock steering wheel. 2. Move
steering wheel to straight ahead position.
3. Lock steering wheel and remove
ignition key.
-
Lift vehicle and support safely.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is stable and well
supported at all times. Use a
professional automotive lift or jack
stands designed for the purpose. A
floor jack is not adequate support.
-
Remove splash guard under
engine.
Remove lower steering column flexible
joint pinch bolt (arrow). Slide lower
column up and pull flexible joint off
steering rack shaft.
Note:
Do not remove alignment flange from
steering rack.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Working near firewall, remove pinch bolt
at universal joint and remove lower
steering column.
Note:
Upper steering column is keyed to lower
steering column universal joint. It can
only be installed in one position.
Installation is reverse of removal, noting
the following:
Replace flexible and universal joint
pinch bolts.
Align lower steering column to
keyed upper steering column.
Align tab (arrow) on steering rack
flange with lower steering column
flexible joint.
Tightening torque
Pinch bolts at
steering columns
joints
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Upper steering column,
removing and installing
-
Remove steering wheel as
described earlier.
Fully lower and extend (arrows)
adjustable steering column.
-
Remove retaining screw from top of
steering column upper trim cover.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Push in sides of upper trim cover
(arrows) to release from lower trim. Pull
back and up on upper trim.
Pry gently to detach flexible cover from
upper trim. Lift off trim.
Remove left footwell (pedal cluster) trim
panel.
Remove screws (A).
Remove fasteners (B).
Disconnect electrical harness connectors
at left footwell trim panel and remove
panel:
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Unplug connector at footwell interior
light (A), if equipped.
Slide lock at OBD II connector (B) in
direction of arrow.
Unplug connector at cellular phone
speaker (C) if equipped.
-
Remove lower steering column as
described earlier.
To remove steering column lower trim,
drive pins into expansion rivets (arrows)
to release. Pull down on trim.
Working at steering column:
Remove screws (arrows).
Slide switch block out from steering
column.
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors at ignition switch, wiper
switch, turn signal / high beam
switch, and steering wheel
functions / airbag connector.
Remove switch block.
Slide lower section of upper steering
column into upper section (arrow).
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove shift interlock cable (A) if
necessary.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector at EWS 3.3 ring antenna
(B).
-
Working at steering column, detach
wiring harness from cable duct.
Drill out steering column mounting shear
bolt (A), and remove mounting bolt (B).
Remove lower steering column mounting
bolts (arrows). Remove upper steering
column.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Replace shear bolt at steering
column mounting bracket. Tighten
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
until bolt head shears off.
Make sure lock of interlock cable
snaps into place.
When installing column top trim
panel, replace expansion nut for
trim retaining screw.
When installing lower trim panel,
push expansion rivet pin into rivet
until pin head is flush with rivet
head.
Tightening torques
Universal joint
pinch bolt at
steering column
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Steering column to
dashboard carrier
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
320-4
Power Steering System
The power steering fluid reservoir is
located on the lower left front of the
engine.
CAUTION!
Maintain clean conditions when
working with open power
steering fluid lines.
Plug off power steering lines
and connections to keep out
contamination.
Power steering fluid
Recommended
fluid
ATF (automatic
transmission
fluid)
Power steering
system
1
- Power steering
fluid reservoir
2
- Fluid supply
line
3
- Power steering
pump
4
- Copper sealing
ring
5
- Banjo bolt M14
tighten to 35 Nm (26
ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
6
- Banjo bolt M16
tighten to 40 Nm (30
ft-lb)
7
- Power steering
rack
8
- Pressurized
fluid line
9
- Fluid return line
10 - Fluid cooler
11 - Rack boot kit
12 - Tie rod nut
tighten to 65 Nm (48
ft-lb)
13 - Outer tie rod
end
14 - Clamp ring
15 - Outer tie rod
end lock nut
tighten to 45 Nm (33
ft-lb)
16 - Inner tie rod
tighten to 100 + 10
Nm (74 + 7 ft-lb)
Power steering system, bleeding
and filling
-
With engine off, fill power steering
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
fluid reservoir with clean fluid. Fill
level to MAX mark on dip stick.
-
Start engine. Slowly turn steering
wheel from lock to lock a minimum
of two times.
-
Turn engine off and check fluid
level, adding more if necessary.
Power steering pump, removing
and installing
-
Empty power steering fluid reservoir
using clean syringe. Do not reuse
fluid.
-
Raise front of car. Remove splash
shield from under engine.
-
Remove drive belt from power
020
steering pump. See
Maintenance.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is firmly supported
on jack stands designed for the
purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove power steering pump drive
pulley.
-
Remove fluid hoses from pump.
Plug openings in pump and hose
ends.
-
Remove brake cooling ducts on left
side.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Remove front stabilizer bar anchors
and swing stabilizer bar down out of
the way. See
310 Front
Suspension.
Remove pump mounting bolts (arrows)
and remove pump. Rear wheel drive
model shown.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure all thread bores, bolts,
nuts, fluid couplings and mating
surfaces are clean, and inside
surface of multi-ribbed-belt is free of
grease and dirt.
Use new sealing washers when
reattaching power steering pressure
lines.
Make sure hoses have adequate
clearance from chassis. Do not
over-torque banjo bolts.
Fill and bleed power steering
system as described earlier.
Tightening torques
Hydraulic hoses to power steering
pump
M14 banjo bolt
35 Nm (26 ft-lb)
M16 banjo bolt
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Power steering
pump to bracket M8
self-locking nuts
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Power steering
pump bracket to
engine block M8
self-locking nuts
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Steering rack, removing and
installing
-
Empty power steering fluid reservoir
using clean syringe. Do not reuse
fluid.
-
Raise front of car, and remove
wheels. Remove splash shield from
under engine.
Make reference measurement (A) of left
outer tie rod end to tie rod. Record
measurement.
Note:
Accurate measurement of the tie rod
end with reference to the tie rod will
help approximate correct wheel
alignment when new parts are
installed.
Note correct placement of inner
taper on locking ring
-
Repeat for right side.
Loosen left outer tie rod end lock nut
(arrow).
-
Unscrew left tie rod end from
steering rack by turning inner tie
rod shaft.
CAUTION!
Grip end of rack boot to keep it from
twisting as the tie rod shaft is
unscrewed.
-
Repeat for right tie rod.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Working underneath car, remove fluid
line banjo bolts (arrows) from steering
rack.
CAUTION!
Plug off power steering lines and
connections to keep out
contamination.
Note:
It may be necessary to remove other
components to gain access to steering
rack.
Remove lower steering column flexible
joint pinch bolt (arrow). Pull flexible joint
off steering rack shaft.
-
Move steering wheel to straight
ahead position and remove ignition
key to lock steering.
-
On all wheel drive vehicles:
Support front subframe with a shop
hoist or appropriate jack.
Detach subframe from engine and
lower approx. 20 mm ( in.). See
310 Front Suspension
Remove steering rack mounting bolts
(arrows). Remove steering rack from
subframe by pulling it forward.
Installation is reverse of removal, noting
the following:
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Make sure all thread bores, bolts,
nuts, splines and mating surfaces
are clean. Use anti-seize paste on
inner tie rod threads.
Use new self-locking nuts wherever
applicable.
Use keyed components to
reassemble steering column flexible
joint to steering rack shaft. Make
sure wheels are straight ahead.
Use new sealing rings on banjo
fittings. Do not over-torque banjo
bolts.
Use tie rod measurement previously
made (measurement A) to
temporarily set toe.
Fill and bleed power steering
system as described earlier.
Have car professionally aligned.
Tightening torques
Outer tie rod end to
steering arm
replace self-locking
nut
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Outer tie rod end
lock nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Steering column
flexible joint to
steering rack shaft
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Steering rack to subframe
M10 bolt
42 Nm (32 ft-lb)
Steering fluid lines
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
M14 banjo bolt
35 Nm (26 ft-lb)
M16 banjo bolt
40 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Outer tie rod end, replacing
-
Raise front of car. Remove road
wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is firmly supported
on jack stands designed for the
purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
Remove outer tie rod ball joint nut.
Separate outer tie rod end from steering
arm using BMW special tool 32 3 090 or
equivalent.
Make reference measurement (A) of
outer tie rod end to tie rod. Record
measurement.
Note:
Accurate measurement of the tie rod
end with reference to the tie rod will
help approximate correct wheel
alignment when new parts are
installed.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Note correct placement of inner
taper on locking ring
Loosen outer tie rod end lock nut
(arrow).
-
Unscrew tie rod end from tie rod
shaft.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Make sure all threaded parts are
clean. Use antiseize paste on inner
tie rod threads.
Use new self-locking nuts, where
applicable.
Use tie rod measurement (A) to set
toe.
Have car professionally aligned.
Tightening torques
Outer tie rod end to
steering arm
replace self locking
nut
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Outer tie rod end
lock nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Tie rod or rack boot, replacing
-
Raise front of car. Remove splash
shield from under engine.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is firmly supported
on jack stands designed for the
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove outer tie rod end
self-locking nut, and separate outer
tie rod end ball joint as described
above.
Make a reference measurement of outer
tie rod end to tie rod. Record
measurement.
Note:
Accurate measurement of the tie rod
end with reference to the tie rod will
help approximate correct wheel
alignment when new parts are
installed.
Note correct placement of inner
taper on locking ring
-
Cut rack boot band clamp and slide
bellows back. Inspect boot for any
sign of damage. Replace if
necessary.
Note:
New rack boot kit comes with new band
clamp.
Using BMW special tool 32 2 110 remove
inner tie rod shaft from steering rack.
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to steering rack
while removing tie rod, turn steering
until end of rack is as far as possible
in housing
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
When reassembling, grease tie rod taper
so that rack boot support buffer or small
end of rack boot (inset) slides on tie rod
when tie rod is tightened, preventing
rack boot from twisting.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Make sure all threaded parts are
clean. Replace self-locking nuts.
Install outer tie rod end to new tie
rod using reference measurement
(A) recorded earlier.
Have car professionally aligned.
Tightening torques
Outer tie rod end to
steering arm
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Outer tie rod end
lock nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Inner tie rod to
steering rack
100 + 10 Nm
(74 + 7 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
320-5
Wheel Alignment
Proper handling, stability, tire wear and
driving ease depend upon the correct
alignment of all four wheels. The front
axle is aligned in relation to the rear
axle, then the front wheels are aligned
in relation to one another. This is
known as a four-wheel or thrust-axis
alignment.
The BMW E46 uses a sophisticated
multi-link suspension at the front and
rear of the car. Proper alignment
requires computerized alignment
equipment.
Alignment specifications only apply
under the following conditions:
Correct wheels and tires are
installed, in good condition, and
are at the correct inflation
pressures.
All steering and suspension parts
and bushings are undamaged and
show no signs of abnormal wear.
Wheel bearings are in good
condition.
Ride height is in accordance with
specifications. See
300
Suspension, Steering and BrakesGeneral
Car is in normal loaded position.
See
Table a. Front wheel alignment
specifications for front wheel alignment
specifications,
Table b. Rear wheel
alignment specifications for rear wheel
alignment specifications.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
WARNING!
While performing alignment
procedures, make sure the car is
stable and well supported at all
times. Use a professional automotive
lift or jack stands designed for the
purpose. A floor jack is not adequate
support.
Normal loaded position
Each front seat
68 Kg (150 lb)
Rear seat (center)
68 Kg (150 lb)
Trunk
21 Kg (46 lb)
Fuel tank
full
Table a. Front wheel alignment specifications
Parameter
Standard
suspension
All wheel
drive
suspension
Toe angle (total)
Sport
suspension
Rough road
suspension
0° 14' ± 8'
Camber (difference between
left/right max. 30')
track differential angle with
20° lock on inside wheel
-20' ± 20'
-1° 34' ± 30'
20' ± 20'
-53' ± 30'
43' ± 20'
-1° 34' ± 30'
+8' ± 20'
-1° 34' ± 30'
Caster (difference between
left/right max. 30')
with 10 wheel lock
with 20 wheel lock
5° 26' ± 30'
5° 37' ± 30'
5° 27' ± 30'
5° 37' ± 30'
5° 36' ± 30'
5° 47' ± 30'
5° 17' ± 30'
5° 27' ± 30'
Front wheel displacement
0° ± 15'
Table b. Rear wheel alignment specifications
Parameter
Toe angle (total)
Standard
suspension
All wheel
drive
suspension
Sport
suspension
Rough road
suspension
0° 16' ± 6'
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
3 of 5
Parameter
Camber (difference between
left/right max. 15')
maximum allowable
deviation between sides
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Standard
suspension
-1° 30' ± 15'
All wheel
drive
suspension
-1° 15' ± 15'
Geometrical axis deviation
Sport
suspension
Rough road
suspension
-2° 04' ± 15'
-46' ± 15'
0° ± 6'
Front wheel camber
Any change to the camber will also
change the toe setting. Always adjust
camber prior to adjusting toe.
Front wheel camber adjustment can be
made by driving out factory strut
alignment pin (A) in upper strut housing.
-
Loosen upper strut mount nuts (B).
-
Use BMW special tool 32 3 140 to
adjust position of upper strut mount
studs in slotted holes (arrows).
Tightening torque
Upper strut mount
to body
24 Nm (17 ft-lb)
Front wheel toe
Front wheel toe is adjusted at tie rod
ends:
Loosen tie rod lock nut (A).
Adjust tie rod by turning inner tie
rod (B) to change length.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Note:
Steering rack can be centered by
aligning centering mark on steering
shaft with lug on steering rack.
To keep steering wheel centered,
adjust both tie rods equal amounts.
Make sure the rubber boot on the
rack moves freely on the tie rod and
does not become twisted.
Tightening torque
Tie rod lock nut
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Rear wheel camber
Rear wheel camber is adjusted at outer
end of rear lower control arm using
camber adjusting bolt.
Make sure bolt remains between
two alignment lugs (arrows) on end
of control arm.
Check toe setting as described
below.
Tightening torque
Rear lower control
arm to rear trailing
arm
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Rear wheel toe
Loosen trailing arm bracket mounting
bolts (arrows).
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Steering and Wheel Alignment
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Install BMW special tool 32 3 030
over alignment lug (A) and adjacent
bolt.
Use tool to adjust position of
bracket.
Remove tool and tighten trailing
arm bracket mounting bolts.
Tightening torque
Rear trailing arm
bracket to body
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:29 PM
Rear suspension
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
330-1
General
This repair group covers removal and
replacement of E46 rear suspension
components.
A general description of the rear
suspension, ride height specifications
and a troubleshooting guide can be
found in
300 Suspension, Steering
and Brakes-General.
Additional component replacement
information specific to all wheel drive
models can be found in the following
repair groups:
310 Front Suspension
311 Front Axle Final Drive
331 Rear Axle Final Drive
Alignment information can be found in
320 Steering and Wheel Alignment.
Special tools
Special service tools are required for
some of the work described in this
repair group. Most of these tools are
specialized presses and pullers that
might be replaced by standard pullers
of various sizes.
Read the procedures through before
beginning any job.
Bearing splitter BMW l 00 7 500
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Drive axle press BMW set 33 2
115/116/119
Flange puller BMW set 33 2 116/4
201/4 202/4 203
Inner bearing race puller BMW set 33 4
400
Wheel bearing extractor B90 (Source:
Baum Tools Unlimited)
Rear suspension description
BMW uses an independent rear
suspension consisting of an upper and
a lower control arm and a trailing arm
on each side. The weight of the car is
supported by coil springs. There is a
rear stabilizer bar attached to the upper
control arms. Gas-pressure shock
absorbers round out the rear
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
suspension.
The rear subframe (final drive carrier)
supports the rear differential and
provides mounting points for the upper
and lower control arms. The upper
control arm on each side provide the
lower spring perch for the coil spring.
The upper and lower control arm on
each side are attached to the trailing
arm. The trailing arms contain the
wheel bearings for the rear drive hubs.
The rear brake calipers are bolted to
the trailing arms.
E46 Rear suspension
1
- Shock absorber
2
- Differential
housing
3
- Rear subframe
(final drive
carrier)
4
- Upper control
arm
5
- Trailing arm
6
- Trailing arm
bracket
7
- Coil spring
8
- Lower control
arm
9
- Stabilizer bar
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
330-2
Rear Shock Absorbers
and Springs
Replace shock absorbers and springs
in pairs only.
Rear shock absorber, removing
and installing
-
Raise car and remove rear wheels.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
Support trailing arm from below using
an adjustable jackstand. Remove
shock absorber lower mounting bolt
(arrow).
CAUTION!
The shock absorber prevents the
drive axle from dropping too far.
Support the trailing arm before
removing the lower shock absorber
bolt to avoid damage to drive axle CV
joints.
On Sedan or Coupe models: Working
in trunk, pry out luggage compartment
liner retaining clips. Peel back liner to
gain access to upper shock absorber
mounting nuts (arrows).
-
On Convertible models: Open
convertible top storage
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
compartment to access upper
shock absorber mount.
-
On Sport Wagon models: Working
in cargo compartment, remove
side trim next to rear seat
backrests.
-
Support shock absorber from
below while removing upper
mounting nuts. Lower shock
absorber out of wheel housing.
Transfer shock top mounting plate,
dust cover (if applicable) and related
components to new shock absorber.
1 - Self-locking nut M10 -tighten to 14
Nm (10 ft-lb)
2 - Upper support plate
3 - Top mount
4 - Body seal
5 - Lower support plate
6 - Spacer ring
7 - Rubber bump stop
8 - Self-locking nut M8 -tighten to 24
Nm (17 ft-lb)
-
Installation on car is reverse of
removal, noting the following:
Make sure all threaded bolts, nuts
and mating surfaces are clean.
Install shock absorber into shock
tower using a new upper
mounting seal and new
self-locking nuts.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Make sure rectangular thrust
washer on lower mounting bolt is
between bolt head and shock
absorber rubber.
Tighten lower shock absorber bolt
to its final torque once car is on
ground.
Tightening torques
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm (car in
normal loaded
position)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
upper mount
14 Nm (10 ft-lb)
Shock absorber
upper mount to
body M8
self-locking nuts
28 Nm (21 ft-lb)
Coil spring, removing and
installing
-
Raise car and remove rear wheel.
Remove drive axle to final drive
mounting bolts (arrows).
Detach drive axle from final drive.
Suspend drive axle from chassis
using stiff wire.
-
Remove fuel tank protective panel.
-
Detach stabilizer bar from rear
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
subframe.
Remove rear brake line bracket
mounting bolt (arrow). Detach bracket
from trailing arm.
CAUTION!
Avoid damaging the brake hose by
stretching when the trailing arm is
lowered.
Support trailing arm from below using
an adjustable jackstand. Remove
shock absorber lower mounting bolt
(arrow).
-
Lower trailing arm slowly and
carefully until the compressed coil
spring is fully unloaded. Remove
spring.
-
If spring is to be reused:
Inspect spring for any surface
damage or corrosion.
Inspect top and bottom spring
seat rubber pads for signs of
damage.
Replace any parts showing
evidence of wear or damage.
Note:
In the "rough road package", the top
spring seat pad is 14.5 mm (0.57 in.)
thick.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
To install spring:
Coat top spring pad with
anti-friction paste (e.g., tire
mounting paste).
Slowly lift suspension back into
position, making sure coil spring is
correctly seated in upper and
lower spring seats.
When suspension has been lifted
sufficiently, reattach shock
absorber to trailing arm. Make
sure rectangular thrust washer on
lower shock absorber mounting
bolt is between bolt head and
shock absorber rubber.
Tighten lower shock absorber bolt
to its final torque once car is on
ground.
-
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal.
Tightening torques
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm (car in
normal loaded
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
position)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
1 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
330-3
Rear Suspension Arms,
Subframe and Bushings
The trailing arms, control arms and
their mounting bushings control the
position of the rear wheels. A damaged
suspension arm or worn bushings will
change the rear wheel alignment and
may adversely affect handling and
stability.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to straighten a
damaged suspension arm. Bending
or heating may weaken the original
part. If the suspension arm shows
any signs of damage or excessive
corrosion, it must be replaced.
Note:
If a rear brake line is disconnected to
remove a trailing arm, the complete
braking system must be bled as part of
the reinstallation procedure.
Rear suspension
arms, assembly
1
- Rear subframe
2
- Upper control
arm inner bolt
self-locking M12
nut
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
3
- Upper control
arm
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
2 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
4
- Upper control
arm outer bolt
self-locking M12
nut
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
5
- Trailing arm
6
- Lower control
arm eccentric
bolt eccentric
flat M12 washer
self locking M12
nut
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
7
- Trailing arm
front bolt
self-locking M12
nut
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
8
- Trailing arm
front bracket
9
- Bracket
mounting bolt
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
10 - Drive axle
11 - Lower control
arm
12 - Lower control
arm plastic
shield
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
3 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
13 - Lower control
arm inner M12
bolt lock plate
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft lb)
Trailing arm, removing and
installing
-
Raise rear end of car and remove
wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove drive axle as described in
331 Rear Axle Final Drive.
-
Right side: Detach brake pad
sensor connector at brake caliper.
-
Remove brake rotor and caliper as
described in
340 Brakes. Do not
remove brake line from caliper.
Suspend caliper from body using
stiff wire.
-
Remove parking brake cable from
brake shoe expander. See
340
Brakes.
Remove rear brake line bracket
mounting bolt (arrow). Detach bracket
from trailing arm.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
4 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
CAUTION!
Avoid damaging the brake hose by
stretching when the trailing arm is
lowered.
-
Remove fuel tank protective panel,
if equipped.
Remove ABS pulse sensor from trailing
arm.
-
Unclip pulse sensor and pad sensor
(if applicable) harnesses from
control arm and lay aside.
Support trailing arm from below using an
adjustable jackstand. Remove shock
absorber lower mounting bolt (arrow).
-
Slowly lower suspension until coil
spring can be safely removed.
Mark position (arrows) of lower control
arm eccentric mounting bolt.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
5 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Unbolt upper and lower control
arms from trailing arm. Note
direction of bolt insertion in both
arms.
To remove trailing arm:
Make reference marks to locate
trailing arm bracket to body in order
to maintain alignment
specifications.
Remove trailing arm front bracket
mounting bolts (arrows).
Working with trailing arm on
workbench, detach front bracket
from arm.
When reinstalling, preload trailing arm
front bracket bushing:
Install bolt (A) through bracket and
arm and install nut finger tight.
Using 16 mm bar stock as shown in
illustration, align base of bracket so
that it is parallel with center of
wheel bearing bore on trailing arm.
Torque bracket bolt (A).
Tightening torque
Trailing arm to front
bracket
-
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Remainder of installation is reverse
of removal, noting the following:
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
6 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Install new rear wheel bearings.
Insert control arm mounting bolts in
direction previously marked.
Always use new self-locking nuts.
Transfer brake system components
to new arm as described in
340
Brakes.
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Note:
BMW-supplied replacement trailing arms
come with control arm bushings installed.
A new wheel bearing will have to be
installed.
Tightening torques
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm (car in
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
7 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
normal loaded
position)
Trailing arm bracket
to body (M12 bolt)
Trailing arm to
upper or lower
control arm (M12
bolt)
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Upper control arm, removing
and installing
-
Remove drive axle as described in
331 Rear Axle Final Drive.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove coil spring as described
earlier.
Remove stabilizer bar link bolts (A) at
upper control arm.
Remove stabilizer bar anchor bolts
(B).
Carefully push stabilizer bar aside.
Note:
Do not twist stabilizer bar link bushing on
end of bar. See
Rear Stabilizer Bar
later in this repair group.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
8 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
If necessary, remove ride level
sensor from upper control arm.
-
Unbolt upper control arm from both
trailing arm and rear subframe.
Note direction of bolt insertion.
Note:
For clearance reasons, it may be
necessary to unbolt the differential from
the subframe and push it toward the rear
of the car in order to remove the control
arm mounting bolt from the subframe.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following;
Insert mounting bolts in direction
previously marked
Always use new self-locking nuts.
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torques
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
9 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm car in
normal loaded
position
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to rear subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to trailing arm M12
bolt
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Lower control arm, removing
and installing
-
Raise rear end of car and support it
securely on jackstands. Remove
rear wheel.
-
Support trailing arm from below
using an adjustable jackstand.
Mark position (arrows) of lower control
arm eccentric mounting bolt.
-
Remove lower control arm plastic
shield.
-
Remove both lower control arm
mounting bolts. Note direction of
bolt insertion.
Note:
For clearance reasons, it may be
necessary to unbolt the differential from
the subframe and push it toward the rear
of the car in order to remove the control
arm mounting bolt from the subframe.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
10 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Use a soft hammer to tap control
arm out of its mounting points.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Welded seam of control arm faces
upward.
To install mounting hardware at
subframe, insert lock plate into
opening in subframe from below.
Line up eccentric bolt head with
marks made previously.
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torque
Lower control arm
to rear subframe
M12 bolt
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Lower control arm
to trailing arm M12
eccentric bolt
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Rear subframe
In case of damage to the subframe, or if
a pressed-in bushing is worn, remove
subframe.
Convertible models: Remove rear
body reinforcing brace.
Remove exhaust system. See
180 Exhaust System.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
11 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Detach rear driveshaft from rear
differential. See
260 Driveshaft.
Detach rear drive axles from rear
differential. Remove rear differential.
See
331 Rear Axle Final Drive.
Detach rear control arms as
described earlier
Remove rear subframe mounting
fasteners (arrows) while supporting
subframe securely.
-
In case of damage to subframe
mounting stud threads, replace
stud.
-
In case of damage to subframe
mounting stud threads in body,
repair using Helicoil thread insert
M12 x 1.5 x 18.
Tightening torques
Differential to
subframe front bolt
(M12)
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Differential to
subframe rear bolt
(M14)
174 Nm (128
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Driveshaft to differential flange
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
12 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
M10 compression
nut
64 Nm (47 ft-lb)
M10 Torx bolt
85 Nm (63 ft-lb)
Lower control arm to
subframe (M12)
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Subframe to body
(M12)
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to subframe (M12)
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Rear subframe
assembly
1
- Rear subframe
(final drive
carrier)
2
- M12 mounting
stud
tighten to 90 Nm (66
ft-lb)
3
- Bushing
4
- Bushing
5
- M12 bolt with
washer
tighten to 110 Nm
(81 ft-lb)
6
- Rear
suspension
reinforcement
7
- M12 self-locking
collar nut
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
13 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
8
- M8 bolt
8.8 grade tighten to
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
10.9 grade tighten
to 30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
9
- M14 bolt
tighten to 174 Nm
(128 ft-lb)
10 - Bushing
11 - M14 self-locking
collar nut
12 - Bushing
13 - Stop washer
14 - M12 reduced
shaft bolt
tighten to 77 Nm (57
ft-lb)
15 - Heat shield
16 - M6 self-tapping
screw
Rear suspension bushings
When replacing any bushing in a rear
suspension component, be sure to
measure and record orientation and
protrusion of old bushing from its boss.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
14 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Support car securely before starting
work underneath rear suspension.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
Trailing arm front bushing
-
Before removing trailing arm, be
sure to mark position of trailing arm
front bracket on body to facilitate
resetting of rear toe.
Using appropriate press tools:
Press bushing out of trailing arm.
Clean all grease from eye of trailing
arm.
Draw new bushing into trailing arm:
Line up slot in bushing with mark
(A) on eye of trailing arm.
Fully pressed in, cylindrical bushing
must protrude from trailing arm eye
by measurement B = 2.5 mm (0.1
in.)
-
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torques
Trailing arm to front
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
15 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
bracket
Trailing arm
bracket to body
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper or lower control arm outer
bushing (in trailing arm)
-
Upper control arm bushing:
Remove trailing arm from car as
described earlier. Note direction of
bolt insertion.
-
Lower control arm bushing: Detach
lower control arm from trailing arm.
There is no need to remove trailing
arm.
-
Before detaching lower control arm
from trailing arm, be sure to mark
position of eccentric mounting bolt
to facilitate resetting of rear camber.
Note direction of bolt insertion.
To replace bushing:
Measure and record protrusion (A)
of old bushing from trailing arm
boss.
Press old bushing out and install
new bushing, using protrusion A as
a reference.
-
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torques
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
16 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Lower control arm
to trailing arm M12
eccentric bolt
Road wheel to hub
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm car in
normal loaded
position
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to rear subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to trailing arm M12
bolt
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Upper control arm inner bushing
-
Remove upper control arm as
described earlier.
-
Press old bushing out using
appropriate press tools.
Press new bushing starting at inner
bevelled end (arrow) of control arm
bore.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
17 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Be sure that longer collar of
bushing (A) is on same side as
bevel in control arm.
Outer bushing housing must be
flush with control arm bore when
fully pressed in.
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torque
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm (car in
normal loaded
position)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to rear subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to trailing arm M12
bolt
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
18 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Rear subframe bushing
-
Remove subframe as described
earlier.
-
In case of damage to subframe
mounting stud threads, replace
stud.
-
In case of damage to subframe
mounting stud threads in body,
repair using Helicoil thread insert
M12 x 1.5 x18.
-
Press old bushing out and install
new bushing using appropriate
press tools. Coat new bushing with
Circolight® or equivalent rubber
bonding agent.
Bushing position and orientation:
Right front bushing has elongated
hole (arrow).
Orient all bushings with triangular
arrow heads pointing front/aft on
car.
Have car professionally aligned
when job is complete.
Tightening torque
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
19 of 19
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torque
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Shock absorber to
trailing arm (car in
normal loaded
position)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
Subframe to body
(M12)
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to rear subframe
M12 bolt
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
Upper control arm
to trailing arm M12
bolt
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:30 PM
Rear suspension
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
330-4
Rear Stabilizer Bar
The rear stabilizer bar is mounted to
the rear subframe and attached via
stabilizer bar links to the rear upper
control arms.
1 - Stabilizer bar
2 - Self-locking nut M8
3 - Rubber mounting
4 - Clamping support
5 - Bolt M8
6 - Bolt M
7 - Stabilizer link support bracket
8 - Bolt M8
9 - Self-locking nut
10 - M8 Self-locking nut
11 - M8 Stabilizer link
When installing new stabilizer link:
Clean rubber seating surface at
end of stabilizer bar.
Moisten end of bar and inside
rubber mount (in link end). with
Circolight® or equivalent rubber
bonding agent.
Push bar into rubber mount and
position as shown in illustration.
Once rubber bond has set
stabilizer link can no longer be
rotated
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:31 PM
Rear suspension
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
330-5
Rear Wheel Bearings
The rear wheel bearing is a unitized
assembly and is not repairable
separately.
Special press tools, to be used with the
trailing arm attached to the car, are
required to replace a wheel bearing.
Read the procedure through before
beginning the job.
Rear wheel bearing, replacing
-
Remove drive axle as described in
331 Rear Axle Final Drive.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
-
Right side: Detach brake pad
sensor connector at brake caliper.
-
Remove brake caliper assembly
and rotor as described in
340
Brakes. Leave brake hose
connected to caliper. Suspend
caliper assembly from chassis
using stiff wire.
Remove ABS pulse sensor at trailing
arm.
2/25/2009 10:31 PM
Rear suspension
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove drive flange from bearing
assembly using impact style puller
(BMW special tools 33 2 116, 33 4
201/202/203 or equivalent).
CAUTION!
The wheel bearing is destroyed
when the drive flange is removed. Do
not attempt to reuse bearing.
Note:
Use BMW special tool set 33 4 400 or
equivalent to separate inner bearing
race from drive flange.
-
Remove bearing retaining circlip
from bearing housing in trailing
arm.
-
Using appropriate bearing
extraction tools (BMW special
tools 33 3 261/262/263 or
equivalent), pull bearing assembly
out of trailing arm bearing
housing.
-
Inspect bearing housing for any
damage or contamination.
Clean housing bore thoroughly
before installing new bearing.
2/25/2009 10:31 PM
Rear suspension
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Make sure all mating surfaces are
clean
-
Install new bearing assembly
using press tools (BMW special
tools 33 3 261/264/265 or
equivalent.
-
Install new circlip.
CAUTION!
Apply force only to outer race
when installing bearing.
Make sure that the bearing is
pressed in far enough to contact
the shoulder at the back side of
the housing and that the circlip
is fully seated in its groove.
Always use a new retaining
circlip.
-
Draw drive flange into bearing
using appropriate press tools
(BMW special tools 33 3
261/262/263 or equivalent).
CAUTION!
BMW specifies special tools to pull
the drive flange through the wheel
bearing into position. If using
alternative tools, be sure to support
the bearing inner race when
pressing or pulling the drive flange
into place.
-
Install brake caliper assembly and
rotor as described in
340
Brakes.
2/25/2009 10:31 PM
Rear suspension
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Reinstall drive axle.
Tightening torques
Brake rotor to drive
flange (M8)
16 Nm (12 ft-lb)
Brake caliper to
trailing arm (M12)
67 Nm (50 ft-lb)
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to final drive flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:31 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
331-1
General
This repair group cover removal and
repair information for the rear drive axle
shafts, CV joints and CV joint boots.
Also covered is rear differential (final
drive) removal procedures and seal
replacement information.
Internal repairs of the differential
assembly are not covered in this
manual.
Special tools
BMW recommends some special tools
for the removal of the drive axles as
well as the installation of rear
differential input and output drive
flange seals. Some common pullers
and drifts can often be substituted for
these tools.
Radial seal puller BMW 00 5 010
Flange counterhold tool BMW 23 0 020
Drive axle puller BMW 33 2 110
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Output flange seal drift BMW 33 3 400
Input flange seal drift BMW 33 3 430
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
331-2
Drive Axles
The drive axles use constant-velocity
(CV) joints on both ends. Two different
styles of CV joints have been supplied
with E46 vehicles. Refer to the
accompanying illustration:
Ball cage CV joint. Traditional
design CV joint with thick metal
housing (approx. 40 mm/1.6 in.
thick). Balls slide in non-parallel
grooves.
Slip sleeve CV joint. Thin bolt-on
flange (approx. 15 mm/0.6 in.
thick). CV joint has splined shaft
that slides into end of axle.
For replacement parts, only CV joints
boots or complete axles are offered by
BMW. To replace a CV joint boot, the
drive axle must be removed from the
car. The rear axle shafts are different in
length. The shorter of the two shafts is
located on the left side, the longer
shaft on the right.
Rear drive axle, removing and
installing
With an assistant applying brakes,
break free staked collar nut (arrow) at
center of rear wheel hub. Do not
remove completely.
Note:
The drive flange collar nut is tightened
to a torque of over 250 Nm (184 ft-lb).
Make sure the car is firmly on the
ground.
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Raise rear of car. Remove rear
wheel.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
-
Detach rear stabilizer bar anchor
bolts from rear subframe and tilt
stabilizer down.
-
Working on left axle: Detach rear
of exhaust system and tilt down.
Support rear muffler securely.
Remove drive axle to differential
mounting bolts (arrows). Detach drive
axle from drive flange. Suspend drive
axle from chassis using stiff wire.
Press drive axle from wheel bearing
housing using an appropriate puller.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Apply a light coating of oil to
contact face of collar nut and
install it loosely.
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Install road wheel and lower car to
ground.
With an assistant applying brakes,
tighten drive axle collar nut to its
final torque.
Stake and caulk collar nut.
Tightening torques
Drive axle collar nut to drive flange
M24
250 Nm (184
ft-lb)
M27
300 Nm (221
ft-lb)
Drive axle to differential flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Road wheel to hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Rear drive axle assembly
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
CV joint boots
Note:
When replacing a CV joint boot, use
a complete CV joint boot repair kit.
The kit will include a new boot,
clamping bands, special lubricant,
and a new inner CV joint circlip. The
kit is available from an authorized
BMW dealer parts department.
The outer CV joint cannot be
removed from the axle shaft. In
order to replace the outer CV boot, it
is necessary to remove the inner
joint and boot first.
If the CV joints are worn or
defective, a complete rebuilt axle
shaft is available from an authorized
BMW dealer parts department.
Working with axle shaft at bench, cut off
old boot clamps and remove boots.
Clean old grease off joints and shafts.
Use new grease from CV joint boot kit.
Ball cage CV joint boot
Lift off dust cover from inner CV joint and
remove circlip (arrow) retaining joint
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
inner hub to axle shaft.
Support inner hub at arrowswhen
pressing axle shaft out of joint.
-
Clean all old lubricant off shaft
splines and inner joint's splines.
CAUTION!
If the CV joint must be disassembled
for cleaning and inspection, be sure to
matchmark inner and outer race and
intermediate ball cage. This allows
reassembly of parts in their original
positions.
Note:
To inspect a CV joint, clean away the
grease and look for galling, pitting and
other signs of wear or physical damage.
Polished surfaces or visible ball tracks
alone are not necessarily cause for
replacement. Discoloration due to
overheating indicates lack of lubrication.
-
Apply Loctite® 270 or an equivalent
heavy-duty locking compound to
drive axle splines. Position new CV
joint on shaft so that raised or taller
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
side of hub is facing shaft.
WARNING!
Do not let the locking compound
contact the balls in the joint. Apply
only a thin coat to cover the splines.
-
While supporting axle shaft, press
inner hub of CV joint onto shaft.
Install new circlip.
Note:
Do not let the ball hub pivot more
than 20 in the outer ring of the joint.
The balls will fall out if the hub is
pivoted too far.
Before installing each small boot
clamp be sure to "burp" the boot by
flexing the CV joint as far over as it
will go. A small screwdriver inserted
between the boot and the axle shaft
will help the process.
BMW recommends Bostik®1513 or
Epple®4851 adhesive, and
Epple®39 or Curil®T sealer.
CV joint lubricant capacity
Wheel hub end
80 gram (2.8 oz.)
Differential end
85 gram (3.0 oz.)
-
Use sealing gel to seal dust cover
to CV joint prior to reinstallation.
Slip sleeve CV joint boot
-
Pull CV joint partially out of axle
shaft. Matchmark relative position of
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
joint to shaft.
CAUTION!
If the joint and shaft are not
reassembled in their original position
the assembly may be out of balance
and vibrate during operation.
When reinstalling joint, push joint into
shaft as far as it will go, then pull it out
to measurement A(16 mm / 0.6 in.).
Note:
This step insures uniform lubrication of
the CV joint.
-
Keep joint in position while
installing inner (small) boot clamp.
-
Make sure sealing lip of joint and
boot are free of grease. The boot
could otherwise slide off when boot
clamp is tightened.
Slip sleeve joint boot lengths
Inner boot
65 mm (2.6 in.)
Outer boot
55 mm (2.2 in.)
Note:
On the differential end CV joint,
position large boot clamp so that
crimp in clamp faces rivet on CV
joint flange.
Install large clamps of inner and
outer CV joints so that the crimps
are offset by 180°.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:32 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
331-3
Rear Differential
All rear differential work requires some
method of raising the car and
supporting it securely while the work is
performed. Jack stands and a floor jack
can easily be used, but use extreme
caution when working beneath the car.
See
010 General.
Note:
Removal of rear subframe (differential
carrier) is covered in
330 Rear
Suspension.
Rear differential oil, checking
and filling
Note:
BMW supplies the E46 rear differential
with lifetime lubricant.
To check rear differential oil level:
Remove oil filler plug.
Insert finger into fill hole. If finger
is wetted from oil, level is correct.
Note:
Use a 14 mm Allen socket to remove
the fill or drain plug. Alternatively, cut
approximately 30 mm (1.2 in) from an
Allen key and use a box end wrench on
the key stub.
-
If necessary, fill differential with
appropriate type and quantity of
lubricant.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
The differential fluid level is correct
when the fluid begins to spill from the
fill plug.
-
Install and tighten fill plug.
Differential oil
Differential oil capacity
Rear wheel drive
0.9 liter (0.95 US
qt.)
All wheel drive
1.0 liter (1.06 US
qt.)
Oil specification
BMW SAF-XO
synthetic oil
Tightening torques
Differential drain or
fill plug
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
Rear differential, removing and
installing
-
Raise rear end of car and support
it securely on jack stands.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
-
Remove rear drive axles.
-
If necessary, drain differential oil.
Remove rear suspension reinforcement
brace:
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove heat shield between
reinforcement brace and exhaust
pipe.
Remove bolts (A) mounting brace
to undercarriage.
Remove nuts (B) mounting brace
and front of rear subframe to
undercarriage.
Lower and remove reinforcement.
Note:
If necessary, tilt rear half of exhaust
system down. Support exhaust system
securely.
-
Detach driveshaft from differential
input shaft flange and suspend.
260 Driveshaft.
See
CAUTION!
Suspend the detached drive axle
from the car body with a stiff wire
hook to prevent damage to the outer
CV joint.
-
Remove rear stabilizer bar.
Support differential with transmission
jack. Remove rear (A) and front (B)
mounting bolts at subframe.
-
Slowly lower differential unit and
remove toward rear.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
In order to prevent excess
vibration and noise, follow
sequence for tightening
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
differential mounting bolts:
Install bolts finger tight.
Tighten front bolts (B).
Tighten rear bolt (A).
Tightening torques
Differential drain or
fill plug
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
Differential to rear subframe
Front mount (M12
bolts)
95 Nm (70 ft-lb)
Rear mount (M14
bolt)
174 Nm (128
ft-lb)
Drive axle to differential flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74
ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Driveshaft to differential flange
M10 compression
nut
64 Nm (47 ft-lb)
M10 Torx bolt
85 Nm (63 ft-lb)
Rear suspension reinforcement to
undercarriage
M12 self-locking
nut
77 Nm (57 ft-lb)
M8 bolt 8.8 grade
21 Nm (15 ft-lb)
M8 bolt 10.9 grade
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
-
Be sure to refill differential.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Differential oil
Differential oil capacity
Rear wheel drive
0.9 liter (0.95 US
qt)
All wheel drive
1.0 liter (1.06 US
qt.)
Oil specification
BMW SAF-XO
synthetic oil
Differential mounting bushings
-
If rear differential mounting
bushing are worn, damaged or oil
soaked:
Remove differential from rear
subframe.
Working at subframe, use bushing
press tools to remove old
bushings and install new ones.
Carefully note installation marks
(arrows) on new bushings.
Note:
BMW uses bushings from different
manufacturers in the course of
production. Always check with an
authorized BMW dealer for the latest
information on suspension bushings.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
331-4
Rear Differential Oil
Seals
Low oil level caused by faulty oil seals
may be the cause of noisy differential
operation. The drive flange (side) and
input shaft (front) oil seals can be
replaced while the differential is
installed.
Note:
Do not mistake leaking CV joints for
flange seal leaks. It may be helpful to
degrease the differential to pinpoint the
source of the leak prior to replacing
seals.
Output drive flange oil seal,
replacing
-
Raise car and support safely.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed
for the purpose. Place the jack
stands beneath a structural chassis
point. Do not place jack stands
under suspension parts.
-
If working on left side: Detach rear
of exhaust system and tilt down.
Support rear muffler securely.
-
Detach stabilizer bar from rear
subframe.
-
Detach drive axle from differential
as described earlier.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Suspend the detached drive axle
from the car body with a stiff wire
hook to prevent damage to the outer
CV joint.
Pry output flange from differential. For
leverage, use a wooden dowel as
shown.
Note:
Be prepared to catch dripping oil in
a pan.
Inspect flange at the point where
the oil seal rides on the shaft.
Replace the flange if there is a
groove worn in the shaft.
-
Pry old oil seal from its recess
using BMW special tool 00 5 010
or equivalent seal puller.
CAUTION!
Be careful not to mar the differential
housing when removing the seal.
-
Dip new seal in differential
lubricant and drive into place until
fully seated.
Replace locking circlip (arrow) on
output flange.
-
Install flange by pressing it in by
hand until snap ring engages. It
may be necessary to turn flange
slightly while pushing.
-
Attach drive axle and tighten bolts.
-
Top off differential with oil.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torque
Drive axle to differential flange
M10x20 mm Torx
bolt
83 Nm (61 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(black)
100 Nm (74 ft-lb)
M10x46 mm bolt
(silver) (always
replace)
80 Nm (59 ft-lb)
Input drive flange oil seal,
replacing
-
Raise car and support safely.
Remove rear suspension reinforcement
brace:
Remove heat shield between
reinforcement brace and exhaust
pipe.
Remove bolts (A) mounting brace
to undercarriage.
Remove nuts (B) mounting brace
and front of rear subframe to
undercarriage.
Lower and remove reinforcement.
Note:
If necessary, tilt rear half of exhaust
system down. Support exhaust system
securely.
-
Remove driveshaft from differential
input shaft flange. See
260
Driveshaft. Tie end of driveshaft to
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
side.
Make matching marks on differential
input shaft, collar nut and driveshaft
flange.
-
Pry lock plate from nut.
Counterhold input flange with
BMW special tool 23 0 020 or
equivalent and remove collar nut.
-
If necessary, use puller to remove
input flange.
Note:
Be prepared to catch dripping oil in a
pan.
-
Pry old oil seal from its recess
using BMW special tool 00 5 010
or equivalent seal puller.
CAUTION!
Be careful not to mar the differential
housing when removing the seal.
-
Dip new seal in differential
lubricant and drive it into position.
-
Lightly lubricate input shaft and
press input flange back on. Install
collar nut and slowly tighten until
matching marks line up.
-
Install a new lock plate and refill
differential with lubricant.
CAUTION!
If the flange collar nut is tightened
past the marks, interior components
of the differential will be damaged.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Rear Axle Final Drive
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Differential oil
Differential oil capacity
Rear wheel drive
0.9 liter (0.95 US
qt)
All wheel drive
1.0 liter (1.06 US
qt.)
Oil specification
-
BMW SAF-XO
synthetic oil
Remainder of assembly is reverse
of disassembly.
Tightening torques
Driveshaft to differential flange
M10 compression
nut
64 Nm (47 ft-lb
M10 Torx bolt
85 Nm (63 ft-lb)
Differential drain or
fill plug
70 Nm (52 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
1 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-1
General
This repair group covers brake service:
Brake pads, calipers, and disks
Master cylinder, brake booster,
and parking brake
ABS/ASC and ABS/DSC
component replacement
ABS/ASC and ABS/DSC system
descriptions are covered in
300
Suspension, Steering and BrakesGeneral.
Special tools
BMW requires the use of either the DIS
or the MoDiC diagnostic tool to safely
and completely bleed the braking and
traction control systems. Read all
procedures through before beginning a
job.
Pedal prop
Brake caliper piston tool BMW 34 1 050
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
2 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Brake pad lining gauge BMW 34 1 260
Vacuum tester BMW 34 3 100
Factory diagnostic tool DISplus or
MoDiC
E46 brake system
BMW E46 models are equipped with
vacuum power-assisted four-wheel disc
brakes with an integral Antilock Brake
System (ABS). Single-piston calipers
act on vented front and rear rotors. A
brake pad wear sensor for each axle
indicates when brake pads need
replacement. The dual drum-type
parking brake system is integrated with
the rear brake rotors.
Electronic braking and stability
control
E46 models were introduced with
Automatic Stability Control (ASC). ASC
is a computer controlled traction control
system that uses the ABS system in
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
3 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
conjunction with engine management
controls to control wheel spin and
maintain vehicle stability while braking.
Added midway through the 1999 model
year was Dynamic Stability Control
(DSC). This system uses ASC
technology, but implements wheel
speed modulation throughout all
stages of driving. DSC is able to
reduce understeer by applying differing
amounts of braking force to each
wheel, as well as overriding the engine
management system during hard
cornering.
A summary of distinguishing
characteristics of the various systems is
shown in
Table a. E46 Electronic
braking and stability control systems.
For ABS system and component
descriptions, see
300 Suspension,
Steering and Brakes-General.
WARNING!
A car with electronic stability control
is still subject to normal physical
laws. Avoid excessive speeds for the
road conditions encountered.
Table a. E46 Electronic braking and stability control systems
Year
(model)
System
(manufacturer)
Identifiers
ASC
1999 - 2000
Automatic Stability
Control
(Teves MK 20)
Control
module/hydraulic unit
under master cylinder
No precharge pump
DCS
1999 - 2000
Dynamic Stability
Control
(Teves MK 20 DSC)
Control
module/hydraulic unit
in right rear
compartment of
engine bay
Precharge pump
under master cylinder
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
4 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Year
(model)
System
(manufacturer)
Identifiers
DSC
2001
(rear wheel drive)
Dynamic Stability
Control
(Teves MK 60 DSC)
Control
module/hydraulic unit
mounted under
master cylinder.
No precharge pump
DSC
2001
(all wheel drive)
Dynamic Stability
Control
(Bosch DSC III 5.7)
Control
module/hydraulic unit
in right rear
compartment of
engine bay
Precharge pump
under master cylinder
Troubleshooting
Brake performance is mainly affected by
three things:
Level and condition of brake fluid
The system's ability to create and
maintain hydraulic pressure
Condition of friction components
Air in the brake fluid will make the brake
pedal feel spongy during braking or will
increase the brake pedal force required
to stop. Fluid contaminated by moisture
or dirt can corrode the system. Inspect
the brake fluid inside the reservoir. If it is
dirty or murky, or is more then two years
old, the fluid should be replaced.
Visually check the hydraulic system
starting at the master cylinder. To check
the function of the master cylinder hold
the brake pedal down hard with the
engine running. The pedal should feel
solid and stay solid. If the pedal slowly
falls to the floor, either the master
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
5 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
cylinder is leaking internally, or fluid is
leaking externally. Check all brake fluid
lines and couplings for leaks, kinks,
chafing and corrosion. If no leaks can be
found, the master cylinder is faulty and
should be replaced.
Check brake booster:
Remove vacuum hose (A) from
brake booster and install BMW
special tool 34 3 100 between
connection and hose on non-return
valve (B).
Start engine and check build-up of
partial vacuum. Switch engine off.
Press brake pedal to set partial
vacuum of no more than 0.8 bar
(11.6 psi). Wait for vacuum value to
stabilize.
When pedal is released, partial
vacuum should not drop by more
then 0.06 bar (0.8 psi) over 1 hour.
-
If vacuum values are not reached:
Check connections of vacuum
hoses.
Replace vacuum non-return valve
(B).
Check seal between brake booster
and master cylinder.
If values still cannot be reached,
brake booster must be replaced.
Worn or contaminated brake pads will
cause poor braking performance.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
6 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Oil-contaminated or glazed pads will
cause stopping distances to increase.
Inspect the rotors for glazing,
discoloration and scoring. Steering
wheel vibration while braking at speed is
often caused by warped rotors, but can
also be caused by worn suspension
components.
When troubleshooting, keep in mind that
tire inflation, wear and temperature can
all have an affect on braking. See
300
Suspension, Steering and BrakesGeneral for additional suspension and
brake system troubleshooting.
Table b. Brake system
troubleshooting lists symptoms of brake
problems, probable causes, and
suggested corrective actions. Unless it is
noted otherwise, relevant repairs are
described later in this repair group
WARNING!
All E46 cars require special BMW
service equipment to properly
bleed either the ABS/ASC or the
ABS/DSC system. For safety
reasons, the brake system on
these cars must not be bled
without the use of a factory
diagnostic computer.
Semi-metallic and metallic brake
friction materials in brake pads or
shoes may produce dangerous
dust.
Brake fluid is poisonous,
corrosive and dangerous to the
environment. Wear safety glasses
and rubber gloves when working
with brake fluid. Do not siphon
brake fluid with your mouth.
Immediately clean fluid spilled on
painted surfaces and wash with
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
7 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
water, as brake fluid will remove
paint.
Always use new brake fluid from
a fresh, unopened container.
Brake fluid will absorb moisture
from the air. This can lead to
corrosion problems in the braking
system, and will also lower the
brake fluid's boiling point.
Dispose of brake fluid properly.
Do not reuse self-locking nuts,
bolts or fasteners. They are
designed to be used only once
and may fail if reused. Always
replace them with new
self-locking fasteners.
Table b. Brake system troubleshooting
Symptom
Probable cause
Repairs
Brake squeal
Incorrectly installed
brake pads or
parking brake shoes,
or brake parts.
Check component installation. Check/replace
anti-rattle springs.
Brake pad carriers
dirty or corroded
Remove brake pads and clean calipers.
Brake pads
heat-glazed or
oil-soaked
Replace brake pads. Clean rotors. Replace
leaking calipers as required.
Wheel bearings worn Replace worn bearings. See
310 Front
(noise most
Suspension or
330 Rear Suspension.
pronounced when
turning)
Pedal goes to floor
when braking
Brake fluid loss due
to system leaks
Check fluid level and inspect for signs of
leakage.
Master cylinder or
electronic control
system faulty
Replace master cylinder. Diagnose electronic
control system using factory or compatible
diagnostic tool.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
8 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Symptom
Probable cause
Low pedal after
system bleeding
Master cylinder faulty Replace master cylinder.
Pedal spongy or
brakes work only
when pedal is
pumped
Air in brake fluid
Bleed system using factory or compatible
diagnostic tool
Master cylinder or
electronic control
system faulty
Replace master cylinder. Diagnose system using
factory or compatible diagnostic tool.
Excessive braking
effort
Brake pads wet
Use light pedal pressure to dry pads while
driving.
Brake pads
heat-glazed or fluidsoaked
Replace brake pads and rotors. Replace leaking
calipers.
Vacuum booster or
vacuum hose
connections to
booster faulty
Inspect vacuum lines. Test vacuum booster and
replace as required. Test vacuum non-return
valve for one-way flow.
Warped brake rotors
Resurface or replace rotors.
Brake pads worn
Replace brake pads.
Brake pads
heat-glazed or
oil-soaked
Replace brake pads. Clean rotors. Replace
leaking calipers.
Incorrect tire
pressures or worn
tires
Inspect tire condition. Check and correct tire
pressures.
Brake pads on one
side of car
heat-glazed or fluidsoaked
Replace brake pads. Clean rotors. Replace
leaking calipers. .
Brakes pulsate,
chatter or grab
Uneven braking,
car pulls to one
side, rear brakes
lock
Repairs
Caliper or brake pads Clean and recondition brakes.
binding
Brakes drag, bind
or overheat
Worn suspension
components
Inspect for worn or damaged suspension
310 Front Suspension or
components. See
330 Rear Suspension.
Brake caliper or
brake pads binding
Clean or replace caliper.
Master cylinder or
electronic control
system faulty
Replace master cylinder. Diagnose electronic
control system using factory or compatible
diagnostic tool.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
9 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:33 PM
Brakes
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-2
Bleeding brakes
Brake bleeding is usually done for one
of two reasons: Either to replace old
brake fluid as part of routine
maintenance or to expel trapped air in
the system that resulted from opening
the brake hydraulic system during
repairs.
Always use new brake fluid from an
unopened container. It is important to
bleed the entire system when any part
of the hydraulic system has been
opened. Be sure to have the special
equipment needed before beginning
the job.
WARNING!
E46 cars require special BMW
service equipment to properly bleed
either the ABS/ASC or the ABS/DSC
system. For safety reasons, the
brake system on these cars must not
be bled without the use of a factory
diagnostic computer.
When bleeding the brakes, start at the
wheel farthest from the master cylinder
and progress in the following order:
right rear brake
left rear brake
right front brake
left front brake
Pressure bleeding brakes
-
Top off brake fluid in reservoir and
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
connect BMW Diagnosis and
Information System (DIS) to 20 pin
Data Link Connector (DLC) under
hood (1999 models), or 16 pin
DLC/OBD II connector under dash
(2000- 2001 models). Call up
service function Bleeding
ABS/ASC or service function
Bleeding ABS/DSC, depending on
which system the vehicle is
equipped with.
-
Connect pressure bleeding device
to brake fluid expansion tank and
pressurize.
CAUTION!
Do not exceed a pressure of 2 bar (29
psi) when pressure bleeding the
brake system. Excessive pressure
will damage the brake fluid reservoir.
Attach bleed hose and fluid receptacle
to bleeder screw (arrow). Open
bleeder screw. Allow DIS bleeding
procedure to cycle hydraulic control
module valves with bleed screw open.
-
After bleeding procedure is
completed, slowly depress brake
pedal (12 times on ABS/ASC
vehicles, 5 times on ABS/DSC
vehicles) with bleeder screw open,
holding pedal down on the last
pump. When escaping fluid is free
of air bubbles, close bleeder
screw and release brake pedal.
CAUTION!
Bleeder hose must always remain
submersed in clean brake fluid
whenever the bleeder valve is open.
-
Refill brake fluid reservoir and
proceed to rear left wheel.
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Proceed with remaining wheels in
order as listed earlier.
Tightening torques
Bleeder screws (wrench size):
7 mm screw
11 mm screw
3.5 - 5 Nm
(2.5 - 3.7 ft-lb)
12 - 16 Nm
(9 - 12 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
1 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-3
Brake Pads, Calipers,
and Rotors
Brake pads can be replaced without
disconnecting the brake fluid hose from
the caliper or having to bleed the
brakes. The rotors can be replaced
without disassembling wheel hub and
bearing. Always machine or replace
rotors in pairs. Replace pads in sets.
Refer to the accompanying illustration
(previous page) and the detail notes
below during replacement procedures.
WARNING!
Although semi-metallic and
metallic brake friction materials
in brake pads or shoes no
longer contain asbestos, they
produce dangerous dust.
Treat all brake dust as a
hazardous material.
Do not create dust by grinding,
sanding, or cleaning brake
friction surfaces with
compressed air.
Brake pads,
calipers and rotors,
assembly
1
- Brake caliper
guide bolts
7 mm Allen head
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
2 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Torque to 30 Nm
(22 ft-lb)
2
- Brake caliper
Brake line: torque to
18 Nm (13 ft-lb)
See
Caliper
removal
3
- Brake pad wear
sensor
See
Brake pad
wear sensor
4
- Brake pad
anti-rattle clip
See
Brake pad
anti-rattle clip
5
- Brake pads
Replacement
warning at 3.0 mm
(0.11 in.)
See Brake pads
6
- Front brake
rotor retaining
screw
Torque to 16 Nm
(12 ft-lb)
7
- Front brake
rotor
Make sure contact
surfaces are clean
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
3 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
and free from
grease
See Front brake
rotor
8
- Rear brake rotor
retaining screw
Torque to 16 Nm
(12 ft-lb)
9
- Rear brake rotor
Make sure contact
surfaces are clean
and free from
grease.
Parking brake drum
dia. 160 mm (6.3
in.)
See Rear brake
rotor
For brake rotor
specifications see
Table c and
Table d
10 - Parking brake
shoes with
hardware
Min. lining thickness
1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
11 - Rear brake dust
shield
12 - Brake pad
carrier
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
4 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Make sure contact
surfaces are clean
and free from
grease
See Brake pad
carrier
13 - Brake pad
carrier retaining
bolts
Front: torque to 110
Nm (81 ft-lb)
Rear: torque to 65
Nm (48 ft-lb)
Oil bolts lightly.
Make sure contact
surfaces are clean
and free from
grease.
Caliper removal
Remove plastic caps from caliper
mounting bolts and remove caliper
mounting bolts (arrows). Remove
caliper from pad carrier.
Brake caliper hydraulic line only
needs to be removed when
replacing brake caliper with a new
unit. If removing brake caliper to
service brake pads or rotors, leave
hydraulic line connected.
If there is a ridge on rotor edge,
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
5 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
caliper piston will have to be
pressed back into caliper before
caliper can be removed.
CAUTION!
Pressing caliper piston in may cause
brake fluid reservoir to overflow. To
prevent this, use a clean syringe to
first remove some fluid from reservoir.
Open caliper bleeder screw only
when applying force to the piston.
Do not allow air to be drawn in
through bleeder screw. Catch
expelled fluid in appropriate
container.
Do not let brake caliper hang from
brake hose. Suspend it from
chassis using stiff wire.
Inspect brake caliper for signs of
leakage. Check that caliper piston
slides smoothly into caliper.
Replace caliper if any faults are
found.
Thoroughly clean all contact points
on caliper and brake pad carrier.
Clean guide bolts and make sure
they slide freely.
Do not lubricate guide bolts.
Bleed brake system if hydraulic line
to caliper has been removed or
replaced. See
Bleeding brakes.
Tightening torque
Caliper to brake
pad carrier
mounting bolts
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
6 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Brake pad wear sensor
Carefully pry pad wear sensor from
brake pad.
Insert brake pad wear sensor into
cutout in new pad where applicable.
If brake lining indicator light
illuminated prior to brake pad
replacement, replace wear sensor.
Route pad wear sensor wiring
through caliper opening and
bleeder dust cap.
Brake pad anti-rattle clip
Remove anti-rattle clip by unhooking at
top and bottom. Use screwdriver as an
aid (arrow).
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
7 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Brake pad lining thickness
To measure brake pad lining thickness:
-
Insert BMW special tool 34 1 260 at
either front right wheel or left rear
wheel
-
Move wheel until notch for brake
wear indicator can be seen through
wheel opening.
-
Insert tip of tool into notch so that
the body of tool rests on brake pad
backing plate (A), and tip touches
brake disc (B).
-
Replace pads if thickness is 3.0 mm
(0.12 in.) or less.
Brake rotor removal
Remove brake rotor mounting screw
(arrow).
Inspect rotor for cracksm signs of
overheating and scoring.
On original equipment rotors, the
minimum allowable thickness is
stamped on rotor hub. Measure
rotor braking surface with a
micrometer at eight to ten different
points and use the smallest
measurement recorded
Table c.
If rotor does not pass minimum
thickness requirements or is
damaged replace rotor.nothing
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
8 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Table c. Brake rotor reconditioning
specifications
Front
Rear
Vented rotor
wear limit
(min.
thickness)
20.4 mm
(0.80 in.)
17.4 mm
(0.68 in.)
Max.
machine
limit per
friction ring
side
0.8 mm
(0.03 in.)
0.8 mm
(0.03 in.)
WARNING!
Confirm rotor wear limit specifications
given in
Table c with specifications
stamped on rotor shell and identified
with `MIN TH"
Table d. Brake rotor sizes
Model
Front
brake
rotor
Rear brake
rotor
323 i / Ci
286 x 22
mm
(11.3 x 0.9
in.)
276 x 19
mm
(10.8 x 0.7
in.)
325 i / Ci /
xi
328 i / Ci
300 x 22
mm
(11.8 x 0.9
in.)
294 x 19
mm
(11.6 x 0.7
in.)
330 i / Ci /
xi
325 x 25
mm
(12.8 x 1.0
in.)
320 x 22
mm
(12.6 x 0.9
in.)
Brake rotors should always be
replaced in pairs.
Clean rotor with brake cleaner
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
9 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
before installing.
When installing new rear brake
rotors, the parking brake should be
adjusted. See
Parking brake.
Tightening torque
Brake rotor to hub
mounting screw
16 Nm (12 ft-lb)
Brake pad carrier removal
Remove brake pad carrier mounting
bolts (arrows) and remove pad carrier
from steering arm or trailing arm.
Tightening torques
Pad carrier to front
steering arm
110 Nm (81 ft-lb)
Pad carrier to rear
trailing arm
65 Nm (48 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-4
Master cylinder
The brake master cylinder is mounted
to the front of the vacuum booster on
the driver side bulkhead.
CAUTION!
All U.S. market E46 vehicles are
equipped with Antilock Braking
System (ABS) and either Automatic
Stability Control (ASC) or Dynamic
Stability Control (DSC). Replacing
the master cylinder requires that the
braking system be properly bled by
an authorized BMW repair facility.
This procedure is necessary for the
braking and stability controls to
function properly.
Master cylinder, removing and
installing
-
Using a clean syringe, empty
brake fluid reservoir.
WARNING!
Brake fluid is highly corrosive and
dangerous to the environment.
Dispose of it properly.
Remove interior ventilation microfilter
housing:
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Remove side trim panel from left rear of
engine compartment:
Remove rubber strip from top of
trim panel at brake booster.
Detach vacuum line (A) from
brake booster Y-connector,
unhook from trim panel and push
to side.
Unhook plastic vacuum line and
positive starter cable (B) from trim
panel and pull forward off trim
panel.
Release locking clips (C) on
edges of trim panel and remove
panel by pulling upwards.
Working at brake master cylinder:
Disconnect brake fluid level
sensor connector (A) from fluid
reservoir.
Disconnect hydraulic clutch
system supply line (B) if
applicable. Plug open brake fluid
ducts to prevent fluid leakage or
contamination.
CAUTION!
Keep clutch supply line supported
and above clutch master cylinder to
prevent any air bubbles from
reaching the clutch hydraulic
system.
If DSC precharge pump is installed
below brake master cylinder:
Release hose clamp (arrow) at
brake fluid reservoir and remove
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
precharge pump supply hose.
Plug hose and reservoir to prevent
fluid leakage or contamination.
-
Remove brake fluid reservoir.
-
Working at master cylinder:
Disconnect brake fluid lines and
electrical harness connectors from
master cylinder as needed.
On vehicles equipped with Teves
DSC: remove brake system
pressure sensors if replacing
master cylinder.
Unscrew mounting nuts and
remove master cylinder from brake
booster.
Plug open brake lines to prevent
contamination.
-
Make sure all nuts, fluid
couplings, thread bores, and
mating surfaces are clean.
-
Mount master cylinder to brake
booster using a new O-ring and
new self-locking nuts.
Tightening torque
Brake master
cylinder to brake
booster
26 Nm (19 ft-lb)
CAUTION!
Be sure to align master cylinder
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
pushrod and booster pushrod.
Use care not to over-torque
master cylinder mounting nuts.
This could damage brake
booster and prevent proper
vacuum build-up.
-
Connect brake fluid lines to
master cylinder.
Tightening torque
Brake fluid lines to
master cylinder
18 Nm (13 ft-lb)
Note:
On Teves MK 20 ASC equipped
vehicles: Be sure to leave flex in
flexible brake lines between master
cylinder and hydraulic unit.
-
Carefully reinstall fluid reservoir
using new sealing grommets.
-
Reconnect supply hose of brake
system precharge pump to brake
fluid reservoir, if applicable
-
Connect hydraulic clutch hose to
brake fluid reservoir, if applicable.
-
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal. Bleed entire
brake system as described earlier.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:34 PM
Brakes
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-5
Brake booster
The brake booster is mounted to the
bulkhead on driver's side of engine
compartment, directly behind brake
master cylinder.
A is vacuum hose from intake manifold.
B is one-way valve. Intake manifold
vacuum acts on a large diaphragm in
brake booster to reduce brake pedal
effort.
Brake booster, removing and
installing
CAUTION!
On cars with Automatic Stability
Control (ASC) or Dynamic
Stability Control (DSC), special
BMW service equipment is
required to properly bleed the
brakes. Removal of the
hydraulic unit is not
recommended unless this
equipment is available. For
safety reasons, the brake
system on cars with electronic
stability control must be bled
using the procedures described
in this repair group.
Do not mix up the fluid lines at
the hydraulic unit. Label all
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
connections before
disconnecting.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at front of this manual
on page viii.
-
Using a clean syringe, empty
brake fluid reservoir.
WARNING!
Brake fluid is highly corrosive and
dangerous to the environment.
Dispose of it properly.
-
Remove brake master cylinder as
described earlier. Make sure to
plug openings at brake fluid lines.
-
Disconnect engine vacuum hose
from brake booster.
-
Remove hydraulic unit or
precharge pump below master
cylinder as described later in this
repair group.
Working in interior, remove left footwell
(pedal cluster) trim panel.
Remove screws (A).
Remove fasteners (B).
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors at left footwell trim panel
and remove panel:
Unplug connector at footwell
interior light (A), if equipped.
Slide lock at OBD II connector (B)
in direction of arrow.
Unplug connector at speaker (C).
Remove clip (A) and slide brake
booster pushrod off brake pedal pin.
Remove brake booster mounting nuts
(B).
-
Working in engine compartment,
carefully separate brake booster
from engine compartment
bulkhead.
CAUTION!
Do not use force on booster when
separating from bulkhead. This can
damage booster and pushrod.
-
Remove booster by tilting brake
booster out in direction of engine.
Lift booster up and out from
engine compartment.
-
Installation is reverse of removal
noting the following:
Make sure all nuts, fluid
couplings, thread bores and
mating surfaces are clean.
Replace brake booster self-locking
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
mounting nuts.
Replace sealing O-ring between
master cylinder and brake
booster.
Bleed brake system as described
earlier.
CAUTION!
Do not over-torque the master
cylinder mounting bolts. This could
damage the brake booster and
prevent proper vacuum build-up.
Tightening torques
Brake master
cylinder to brake
booster
26 Nm (19 ft-lb)
Brake booster to
bulkhead
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Brake fluid line to
master cylinder or
hydraulic unit
18 Nm (13 ft-lb)
Note:
When replacing the brake booster
one-way valve or vacuum hose, install
the valve so that the molded arrow is
pointing toward the intake manifold.
Use new hose clamps.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-6
Parking brake
The parking brake is a brake drum
system integrated into the rear brake
rotors.
The parking brake can be adjusted
with the wheels installed, although the
rear wheels will have to be raised off
the ground.
Adjusting the parking brake becomes
necessary under the following
circumstances:
Replacing parking brake shoes
Replacing rear brake rotors
Excessive stroke of parking brake
handle required for actuation
(more then 10 notches)
Replacement of adjustment unit or
parking brake cables
Parking brake shoes, adjusting
Lift parking brake lever boot out of
console. While holding cables
stationary, loosen parking brake cable
nuts (A) until cables are completely
slack.
-
Raise rear of car.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is firmly supported
on jack stands designed for the
purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Do not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Remove one lug bolt from each
rear wheel. Turn road wheel until
lug bolt hole lines up with parking
brake adjuster (approximately 65°
to rear of wheel centerline).
Use flat-bladed screwdriver to turn
adjuster. On left wheel, turn adjuster in
direction 1 to expand shoes. On right
wheel, turn adjuster in direction 2 to
expand shoes.
-
Using a screwdriver, turn adjuster
to expand brake shoes until road
wheel can no longer turn, then
back adjuster off. Repeat
procedure on other rear wheel.
Parking brake adjusting (initial)
Back off adjuster
through wheel lug
bolt hole
10 notches
-
Working inside car, set parking
brake several times to seat cable.
Then pull parking brake lever up
two notches. Tighten cable
adjusting nuts until it is just
possible to turn rear wheels with
slight resistance.
-
Release lever and make sure rear
wheels turn freely.
-
Turn on ignition. Pull up parking
brake lever 1 notch and make sure
that light comes.
-
Pull parking brake lever up one
more notch and check that rear
wheels do not move and parking
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
brake warning light stays lit. If
parking brake light goes out,
contact switch must be adjusted.
-
Install parking brake lever boot.
Install road wheel lug bolts.
Tightening torque
Road wheel to
hub
100 ± 10 Nm
(74 ± 7 ft-lb)
Parking brake shoes, removing
and installing
-
Raise rear of car and remove road
wheels.
-
Without disconnecting brake fluid
hose, remove rear brake calipers
from trailing arms. Remove rear
Brake Pads,
brake rotors. See
Calipers, and Rotors.
CAUTION!
Do not let the brake caliper assembly
hang from the brake hose. Support
caliper from chassis with strong
wire.
-
Unhook upper return spring from
brake shoes. Remove shoe
retainers by pushing them in and
rotating turn. BMW special tool 34
4 000 can be used to remove
retainers, if needed.
-
Spread shoes apart and lift them
out.
-
Inspect shoe expander to make
sure it functions properly. Apply a
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
thin coat of grease to sliding parts
and pins.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Be sure to adjust parking brake
cables as described earlier.
Parking brake cable, replacing
The parking brake is actuated by two
separate Bowden cables between the
parking brake handle and the parking
brake shoe actuators at the rear brake
backing plates. Each cable can be
replaced separately.
To replace a cable it is not necessary
to remove the rear wheel or to
disassemble the brakes. However, it is
necessary to remove the complete
exhaust system and lower the exhaust
system heat shield to access the front
end of the parking brake cable
housing.
-
Working inside car, gain access to
base of parking brake handle by
removing center console storage
tray and center armrest, as
necessary.
Use BMW special tool 34 1 030 or
equivalent deep 10 mm socket to
remove parking brake cable lock nuts
(A) at base of parking brake handle.
-
Raise rear of car.
WARNING!
Make sure the car is firmly supported
on jack stands designed for the
purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point.
Do not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Remove complete exhaust system
as described in
180 Exhaust
System.
-
Remove center tunnel heat shield.
Pull parking brake cable out of body
guide tube (arrows) and detach from
routing brackets, noting correct routing
for reinstallation.
Remove one lug bolt from rear wheel.
Turn wheel until lug bolt hole is
approx. 20° below horizontal to access
end of parking brake cable.
Disconnect cable from parking brake
actuator:
Push free (parking brake handle)
end of cable into housing to create
slack inside brake drum.
Poke thin screwdriver through lug
bolt hole and pry end of parking
brake cable downward (arrow).
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Pull cable out of back of backing
plate.
-
To reinstall:
Push new cable housing into hole
in back of backing plate.
Push free (parking brake handle)
end of cable into housing until
end of cable snaps audibly into
holder inside brake drum.
Reroute new cable under car, attaching
to brackets (arrows).
-
Remainder of installation is
reverse of removal noting the
following:
Adjust parking brake as described
earlier.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
340-7
ABS Component
Replacement
CAUTION!
If the tires on the car are of
different makes, the ASC system
may over-react. Only fit tires of
the same make and tread
pattern.
In adverse conditions, such as
trying to rock the car out of deep
snow or another soft surface, or
when snow chains are fitted, it
is advisable to switch off ASC
and allow the car's driveline to
operate conventionally.
All E46 vehicles are equipped with an
Antilock Braking System (ABS). Early
production models featured ABS with
Automatic Stability Control (ABS/ASC).
Later models came equipped with ABS
and Dynamic Stability Control
(ABS/DSC). This manual will refer to
these systems as ABS. ASC or DSC
will be specified when necessary.
For ABS system and component
descriptions, see
300 Suspension,
Steering and Brakes-General.
Wheel speed sensor, replacing
CAUTION!
Magnetoresistive & Hall effect wheel
speed sensors can be interchanged
physically in the rear wheels, but
function is not similar.
-
Raise applicable end of car.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
WARNING!
Make sure the car is firmly supported
on jack stands designed for the
purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point.
Do not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
Front sensor: Unscrew mounting bolt
at steering arm (arrow).
Rear sensor: Remove sensor from its
bore (arrow) in the rear trailing arm.
Note:
ABS wheel speed sensor application
may vary depending on traction control
system installed.
Disconnect and remove impulse sensor
electrical harness (arrow) from
retaining mounts. (Left front wheel
shown).
-
During installation, apply thin coat
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
of Molykote® Longterm 2 or an
equivalent grease to impulse
sensor and housing.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Tightening torque
ABS wheel speed
sensor to steering
arm / trailing arm
8 Nm (6 ft-lb)
ABS impulse wheel
ABS impulse wheel replacement may
be needed in case of damage or
impulse teeth corrosion.
Front impulse wheel
-
Rear wheel drive models: Impulse
wheel is integral with front wheel
bearing hub.
-
All wheel drive models: Impulse
wheel is integral with inner seal of
front wheel bearing.
310 Front Suspension for front
See
wheel bearing replacement procedure.
Note:
When installing the front wheel bearing
on an all wheel drive car, be sure that
the ridged bearing seal (ABS impulse
wheel) is facing inboard.
Rear impulse wheel
-
All models: Impulse wheel is
pressed on outer CV joint, but it is
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
not replaceable separately.
See
331 Rear Axle Final Drive for CV
joint and drive axle replacement
procedures.
DSC lateral acceleration
sensor, replacing
Rear wheel drive cars: The lateral
accleration sensor is located on the left
side driver's footwell, under the panel
trim on rear wheel drive vehicles.
All wheel drive cars: The lateral
acceleration sensor is combined into
one unit with the rotational rate (yaw)
sensor. It is mounted under the driver's
seat, in front of the left seat rail. See
DSC rotational rate (yaw) sensor,
replacing.
CAUTION!
After replacing the lateral accleration
sensor, perform sensor adjustment
using either DiS or MoDiC under
menu "Service Functions".
-
Remove footwell trim on left side
A-pillar. Fold foot trim panel and
insulating mat to one side.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector. Remove mounting
screw and nut. Remove lateral
accleration sensor.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
DSC rotational rate (yaw)
sensor, replacing
Rear wheel drive cars: The DSC
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
rotational rate sensor is located on the
left side of the car, under the driver's
seat.
All wheel drive cars: The rotational rate
sensor is combined into one unit with
the lateral acceleration sensor. It is
mounted under the driver's seat, in
front of the left seat rail.
-
Remove driver's seat. See
Seats.
520
-
Remove plastic trim as necessary.
Lift carpet for driver's footwell and
fold toward center console. Move
insulation forward to gain access
to sensor.
-
Remove sensor bracket mounting
screws.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector at sensor.
-
Remove sensor to bracket
mounting screws. Lift sensor away
from bracket.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
CAUTION!
Be sure to tighten rotational rate
sensor and mounting bracket to
specified torques. The sensor is
vibration sensitive and subject to
cause DSC malfunctions if installed
improperly.
Tightening torques
Rotational rate
sensor to bracket
8 Nm (6 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Tightening torques
Sensor bracket to
body
8 Nm (6 ft-lb)
DSC steering angle sensor
Vehicles equipped with DSC have a
steering angle sensor (arrow) mounted
to the steering column right above the
pedal cluster. Replacement of this
component requires special tools to
properly align the steering column and
sensor.
After removal or replacement the
steering angle sensor requires
calibration using BMW scan tools DIS
or MoDiC. Once calibrated, the sensor
sends a confirmation ID code to the
DSC control module to indicate proper
calibration.
For steering column removal see
320 Steering and Wheel Alignment.
DSC pressure sensor
Rear wheel drive cars: Two DSC
pressure sensors are used, mounted in
the brake master cylinder.
All wheel drive cars: One DSC
pressure sensor is used, mounted on
the hydraulic unit.
Tightening torques
Pressure sensor to
hydraulic unit
19 Nm (14 ft-lb)
Pressure sensor to
master cylinder
15 + 4 Nm
(11 + 3 ft-lb)
Hydraulic unit/control module,
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
removing and installing
CAUTION!
E46 cars require special BMW
service equipment to properly bleed
the brakes. Removal of the hydraulic
unit is not recommended unless this
equipment is available. For safety
reasons, the brake system on cars
with ABS must be bled using the
procedures described in this repair
group.
Note:
Before starting this procedure,
read any fault codes from control
module memory and print out
diagnostic record.
After completing work, perform the
function test on control module
using either DIS or MoDiC.
The procedure for removing the
ABS/ASC or ABS/DSC hydraulic
unit/control module is similar for all
models. The location of the units
varies.
-
On vehicles with hydraulic unit
mounted beneath master cylinder,
remove master cylinder as
described earlier.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector at hydraulic unit/control
module.
Mark brake lines in relation to their
placement on hydraulic unit. (Teves
MK 20 ASC hydraulic unit shown.)
A - Front from master cylinder
B - Left front
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
C - Right front
D - Rear from master cylinder
E - Right rear
F - Left rear
Remove brake fluid input and
output lines.
Seal open brake fluid lines and
bores with suitable plugs to
prevent contamination.
-
Carefully remove brake lines from
any retainers or grommets that
may be in the way of hydraulic
unit/control module removal.
CAUTION!
Make sure not to bend or kink brake
lines while separating rubber
grommet from retainer.
-
Remove mounting screws of
hydraulic unit housing and remove
hydraulic unit/control module from
engine bay.
-
If necessary, separate hydraulic
unit from control module.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Check rubber mount for hydraulic
unit/control module. Replace if
damaged.
Make sure all nuts, fluid
couplings, thread bores and
mating surfaces are clean.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
Make sure brake lines are
securely seated in grommets
before installing brake lines in
hydraulic unit bores.
Bleed brakes as described earlier.
Tightening torques
Brake lines to
hydraulic unit
18 Nm (13 ft-lb)
Brake master
cylinder to brake
booster
26 Nm (19 ft-lb)
Hydraulic unit to
body
8 Nm (6 ft-lb)
Mounting bracket
to hydraulic unit
8 Nm (6 ft-lb)
DSC precharge pump,
removing and installing
CAUTION!
E46 cars require special BMW
service equipment to properly bleed
the brakes. Removal of hydraulic
components is not recommended
unless this equipment is available.
For safety reasons, the brake system
on cars with ABS must be bled using
the procedures described in this
repair group.
Note:
Before starting this procedure, read any
fault codes from control module
memory and print out the diagnostic
record.
The precharge pump is mounted below
the brake master cylinder on the left
side of the engine compartment.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
-
Using a clean syringe, empty
brake fluid reservoir.
WARNING!
Brake fluid is highly corrosive and
dangerous to the environment.
Dispose of it properly.
Remove interior ventilation microfilter
housing.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove side trim panel from left rear of
engine compartment:
Remove rubber strip (A) from top
of trim panel at brake booster.
Remove vacuum line and positive
battery cable with grommets (B)
from trim panel.
Release locking clips (C) on
edges of trim panel and remove
panel by pulling upwards.
Working at precharge pump beneath
brake master cylinder:
Remove brake fluid feed line
(arrow) from brake fluid reservoir.
Remove brake fluid intake and
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Brakes
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/3...
output lines from pump.
Remove electrical harness
connector.
Lift pump to release from lower
mounting pad.
Slide pump out of retaining ring.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Be sure to replace rubber pump
mounts if damaged or worn.
When installing vacuum hose and
battery cable at trim panel, make
sure isolating grommets are
securely seated.
Bleed brakes as described earlier.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:35 PM
Body - General
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
400-1
General
This section covers system descriptions
and general information for the repair
groups found in 4 Body and 5 Body
Equipment.
E46 Sedan
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
400-2
Body Assembly
The body styles of E46 cars covered by
this manual are the 4-door Sedan,
4-door Sport Wagon, 2-door Coupe
and 2-door Convertible. Body
dimensions vary slightly among
models. Dimensions are given in
inches.
E46 Sedan
E46 Sport Wagon
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
E46 convertible
E46 Coupe
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Body shell
The BMW 3 Series chassis is a unibody
design constructed of high strength
steel. Attaching parts, such as the front
fenders, rear quarter panels, doors,
trunk lid and hood are also constructed
of steel.
Computer aided design (CAD)
techniques have been used in refining
E46 body models to reduce vehicle
weight while retaining strength and
increasing torsional rigidity. For good
handling purposes, the more rigid the
structure the more precisely the
suspension can operate. High strength
steels now account for 50% of the body
shell weight. The body shell's resistance
to twisting forces has been almost
doubled over the previous 3 series
models. To help insure long-lasting
strength, 85% of the body (in surface
area) is made of galvanized steel. This
resists corrosion and maintains body
strength over time.
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
The E46 body shell was designed so
that the vibrations of torsional twisting
and bending are separated into discrete
components and in the inaudible range.
The current Sedan design ensures that
the body twists at 29 hertz and bends at
26 hertz.
Exterior and aerodynamics
With its traditional styling features, such
as the kidney grille, circular headlights
behind a glass cover (for reasons of
streamlining), and the "kick" in the
rearmost roof pillar (C-pillar), the E46
can be immediately recognized as a
BMW.
Wind resistance. Windows bonded flush
to the body and the guided flow of
cooling air into the engine compartment
provide a good coefficient of drag (Cd).
E46 cars have been designed for
balanced aerodynamics but not
necessarily an extremely low Cd.
A low coefficient of lift (Cl) promotes
stability at high speeds. The current
design has a front Cl of 0.08 and a
rear Cl of 0.10.
Windshield wipers are designed for
effectiveness at speeds up to and
beyond 200 kph (124 mph).
Body, window and exterior mirror
shapes have been refined for lower
wind noise and reduced soiling of
mirrors and windows. The Coupe's
side mirrors are specially shaped
and include five ribs (arrows) on
the top edge for further wind noise
reduction.
All this has resulted in a Cd of
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
approximately 0.31 for the Sedan and
0.32 for the Coupe models.
Fenders. The exterior panels are
corrosion-resistant zinc coated
(galvanized) steel. The front fenders are
bolted on. For front fender replacement
information, see
410 Fenders, Engine
Hood.
Bumpers. The front and rear bumpers
are clad in high quality deformable
plastic and provide protection with
virtually no damage to the bumper or the
vehicle at solid barrier impact speeds of
4 kph (2.5 mph). In addition to hydraulic
dampeners, which absorb the initial
impact energy, these bumpers are
backed by compressible tubes. These
deform in a controlled manner at impact
speeds greater than that for which
bumpers and hydraulic dampeners are
designed. This helps avoid expensive
damage to the body at impact speeds up
to 14 kph (9 mph).
Coupe models
The E46 Coupe is similar to the 4-door
Sedan, but has a more stretched and
sleeker appearance. Thus, with the
same wheelbase and identical length, it
looks different but still familiar.
The 2-door Coupe differs from the 4-door
(2-wheel drive) Sedan by a longer front
end, a flatter hood line with air slits, and
a roof 2.7 cm (1.1 in.) lower. Additional
differences include wider doors with
frameless windows, glass-covered
door-posts (B pillars) and a shorter and
lower trunk lid in the Coupe.
Convertible models
The E46 Convertible is an all-season
vehicle with a high level of functionality,
excellent interior comfort and acoustic
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
refinement. Interior materials and colors,
the soft top and the light-alloy wheels
have been carefully matched.
Although the automatic Convertible roof
is standard, a hard-top in body color with
heated rear window is available as an
option for the cold season.
The Convertible body structure includes
many passive safety refinements over its
fixed-top counterparts.
To achieve a more rigid underbody,
an aluminum reinforcement plate
(arrow) is bolted to the front
undercarriage and reinforcing struts
are bolted to the rear undercarriage.
Note:
The aluminum reinforcement plate is
used in all rear wheel drive E46 models
produced from December 2000.
Transverse seat support
reinforcements in the floor pan
accommodates the new
seat-integrated seat belts (SGS).
The windshield frame is reinforced
with stepped reinforcing tubes
which allow it to act as roll-over
protection.
The windshield is bonded into its
frame.
There are tubular door
reinforcements.
The rollover protection system is
tripped into position in a fraction of
second. With this feature, two bars
fully independent of each other
come up behind each rear-seat
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
backrest when the vehicle is in
danger of turning over.
A Convertible body normally flexes and
vibrates, transferring oscillations to the
passenger compartment. In the E46
Convertible, BMW utilizes a unique
battery tray in the trunk as a vibration
dampening system to counteract this
oscillation.
CAUTION!
The E46 Convertible requires a special
battery which is designed for constant
vibration.
Information for the Convertible top and
its related mechanisms can be found
541 Convertible Top .
Sport Wagon
Introduced in 2000, the E46 Sport
Wagon is identical to the E46 Sedan
from the front bumper to the B pillar
(middle door-post). From the B pillar
back the Sport Wagon features:
Remodelled rear doors
Tail gate and hinge mechanism
Rear (tail gate) window that flips up
to open, independent from the
tailgate, held open by compact
torsional coil springs
New rear bumper
Roof rails (optional equipment)
Structural, safety and comfort features in
the Sport Wagon are comparable to the
E46 Sedan and Coupe.
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Sport Wagon capacities
Cargo capacity:
Rear seat backrest
up
435 liters (15.4
cu. ft.)
Rear seat backrest
folded down
1345 liters
(47.5 cu. ft.)
Load capacity:
In cargo
compartment
On roof
540 Kg (1191 lb.)
75 Kg (165 lb.)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:37 PM
Body - General
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
400-3
Safety and Security
Features
A large number of new or improved
safety and security features are
incorporated in E46 cars.
Safety cage
The body safety cage is a continuation
of an established BMW concept for
passenger protection. Tubular impact
structures built into the body provide
protection against passenger injury
during front or rear impacts.
Door anchoring system
Each door is reinforced with a diagonal
aluminum bar with a metal hook at the
rear edge.
Upon severe side impact, the hook
locks into a recessed notch in the B or
C pillar, thus providing unitized
protection against buckling of the door.
The body side holds together as a unit,
offering significantly greater strength.
After most impacts, the door springs
back and unhooks from the notch. It
can then be opened again.
Door locks and door handles
The bow type door handles allow easy
door opening, but are secure in
accidents.
2/25/2009 10:38 PM
Body - General
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Electrical components in the locks are
fully encapsulated and cannot be
picked easily. The new door handles,
latches and lock assemblies offer
improved reliability and security against
theft.
Door position and lock condition are
detected by hall sensors.
Roof padding
In addition to the side and head
protection airbags, there is
supplementary padding at the roof
pillars and along the roof above the
doors. This is positioned to present
energy absorbing surfaces to
passengers thrown around by side
impact forces.
Seat belts
In the Sedan, Coupe and Sport Wagon
models, each front seat belt assembly
has a height-adjustable anchor at the
B pillar.
An automatic pyrotechnic (explosive
charge) tensioner tightens the front
belt at the buckle upon impact,
snugging up lap and shoulder
segments of the belt. The tensioners
are designed to automatically tension
the belts by about 2 inches (55 mm) in
the event of a collision.
A force limiter puts an upper limit on
the amount of force each belt can exert
on the passenger.
The Convertible seat belts are
integrated into the seat, but otherwise
have features similar to the other
models.
2/25/2009 10:38 PM
Body - General
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Airbags
As many as 8 airbags are installed in
E46 cars, depending on model.
The front airbags operate without
sodium azide propellant, widely
considered an irritant when an airbag is
deployed.
Starting with 2000 models, "smart"
front passenger and driver airbags
were installed. These are of the
dual-threshold, dual stage design,
including a sensor to help prevent the
unnecessary deployment of the
passenger side airbag if the seat is
unoccupied.
Depending on options chosen, one
airbag may be installed in each door of
the Sedan and Sport Wagon models,
protecting passengers against side
impacts. Coupe and Convertible
models are equipped with
door-installed airbags as well.
Head Protection System (HPS) airbags
stretch diagonally across the tops of
the front doors.
Airbag deployment automatically
triggers fuel shut-off, turns on the
hazard and interior lights, and unlocks
the doors.
WARNING!
Airbags are inflated by an
explosive device. Handled
improperly or without adequate
safeguards, airbag units can be
very dangerous. Special
precautions must be observed
prior to any work at or near any
of the airbags. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
2/25/2009 10:38 PM
Body - General
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Always disconnect the battery
and cover the negative (-)
battery terminal with an
insulator before starting
diagnostic, troubleshooting or
service work on cars fitted with
SRS, and before doing any
welding on the car.
Battery safety terminal (BST)
A pyrotechnic (explosive charge) device
automatically disconnects the battery
positive terminal during impacts or
collisions.
The seatbelt system, airbag system
and battery safety terminal are
controlled by the Multiple Restraint
System (MRS II) control module.
Security
Electronic immobilization (EWS 3.3). All
E46 vehicles incorporate an electronic
immobilization system known as EWS
3.3. This system uses a wireless
communication link between a
transponder chip in the ignition key
and the ring antenna surrounding the
ignition switch. The EWS control
module blocks the starting of the
vehicle unless the correct coded
ignition key is used.
Note:
Electronic immobilization is sometimes
referred to as the driveaway protection
2/25/2009 10:38 PM
Body - General
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
system.
Anti-theft alarm (DWA). This is a
dealer-installed option for which the
E46 vehicles are factory-wired. When
armed, the system monitors door lock
contacts and trunk and engine hood
locks and sounds a siren if it detects
tampering.
Tilt sensor. Located in the right side of
the trunk above the battery, the tilt
sensor monitors the vehicle parked
angle when DWA is armed. The siren is
activated if the vehicle angle is
changed. This helps prevent theft of
the car using a ramp truck.
Ultrasonic interior protection (UIS). An
interior ultrasonic emitter/detector is
installed in the center of the headliner
of Sedan, Coupe and Sport Wagon
models. The DWA alarm is triggered if
motion is detected inside the car.
Short distance radar (SDR) is the
interior motion detector system used in
Convertible models. The SDR emitter is
located on the driveshaft tunnel under
the center console next to the parking
brake.
For further information about anti-theft
systems, see
515 Central Locking
and Anti-theft.
Emergency location
If emergency assistance is needed, the
on-board navigation system (if
equipped) uses GPS technology to
pinpoint the location of the vehicle.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:38 PM
Body - General
1 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
400-4
Interior Features
E46 interiors have a unique character,
with a combination of sporty features
and innovative design. All body
versions were made in a wide choice of
interior and exterior colors. New colors
with matching leather or leatherette
upholstery were introduced for each
model year, including light-alloy wheels
in new designs.
Driving comfort is enhanced by power
steering, tilt steering wheel, heightadjustable front seats, and electrically
adjustable and heated rear-view
mirrors. Inside the car there are reading
lights at four seating positions.
Noise reduction
To reduce interior noise, certain body
cavities are sealed with shaped parts
installed during the manufacturing
process. The body is heated to approx
180°C (356°F) and kept at that
temperature for approx. 20 minutes,
during which interval the shaped parts
expand to fit the shapes of the cavities.
Seats
Anatomically correct seats are
constructed from polyurethane foam
containing areas or "zones" of different
firmness. They offer good lateral
support without constricting the
occupant.
Driving comfort is enhanced by power
steering, tilt steering wheel, height-
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Body - General
2 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
adjustable front seats, and electrically
adjustable and heated rear-view
mirrors. Inside the car there are reading
lights at four seating positions.
The seats have a passive internal
ventilation system: Cylindrical cavities
within the cushions and backrests
generate a pumping effect as the car's
ride motions cause occupant motion.
This helps remove moisture and feeds
fresh air into the seats.
Other features of the seating system:
The seat bases have steel springs
for added support and strength.
The seat control switches are
along the outside edge of the
seat.
Heated seats are an option in all
models.
In cars equipped with seat position
memory, three different seat
configurations can be memorized
by the seat control module(s).
Seat memory coordinates with
outside mirror memory.
In Convertible models: When a
rear passenger presses the seat
back switch forward, the comfort
entry aid system moves the seat
forward and lowers the headrest
to prevent it from contacting the
sun visor. The seat and headrest
are then returned to memorized
positions. These functions are
controlled by the seat memory
module(s).
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Body - General
3 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
For security reasons, the release
lever to fold the rear seat backrest
forward is installed in the trunk.
In Sport Wagon models: Rear seat
backs are split 60/40 with the
center arm rest on the left seat
back. The center arm rest
incorporates a non adjustable
headrest. When folded down, the
arm rest opens out with
cup-holders and a storage
compartment.
See
520 Seats for more details.
Instruments and controls
Everything in the interior passenger
compartment essential to the driver is
logically grouped and easy to reach. All
instruments and controls have been
arranged ergonomically and are fully
integrated into the overall design of the
vehicle. The following features are
optional in some models.
Tilt-telescopic steering wheel has 30
mm (1.2 in.) of vertical and longitudinal
adjustment.
Multi-function steering wheel contains
two key pads containing controls for
the sound system, telephone and
cruise control.
Padded dashboard houses the
instrument cluster and the ventilation
and heating system.
Instrument cluster uses large
easy-to-read analog instruments and is
removable as a unit without removing
the dashboard. On-board computer
and Check Control functions are
integrated into the instrument cluster
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Body - General
4 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
displays.
Service Interval Display calculates
vehicle service needs, based on
current driving patterns, and indicates
to the driver when the car requires
service.
Integrated on-board navigation system,
based on Global Positioning System
(GPS) technology, is optionally
available on E46 cars. When installed,
a multi-function monitor is included in
the center of the dash above the radio.
In addition to displaying navigation
system information, this monitor
accesses to On-Board Computer
functions, audio system controls,
mobile phone dialling and memory,
and automatic ventilation.
Park Distance Control (PDC) is an
optional system which uses ultra-sonic
sensors in the rear bumper trim to warn
the driver of approaching too close to
obstacles when parking.
Central Body Electronics (ZKE
V)
E46 cars are equipped with a
sophisticated centralized body
electric/electronics plan. Central Body
Electronics (ZKE V) is self-diagnostic
and incorporates many functions into a
single control module. The
consolidation of several systems into a
single control module minimizes power
requirements and the incorporation of
the diagnostic link results in more
efficient and accurate troubleshooting.
ZKE V directly controls the following
functions:
Windshield wiper/washer system,
with optional Rain Sensor
Interface. See
611 Wipers and
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Body - General
5 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Washers.
Central locking with power trunk
release. See
515 Central
Locking and Anti-theft.
Keyless entry (FZV)
Power window control. See
Door Windows.
512
Car/key memory
Interior lighting
Alarm system (DWA)
Electronic consumer sleep mode.
See
600 Electrical System–
General.
Other functions not directly controlled
by ZKE V but interconnected:
Rain sensor (AIC)
Sunroof operation. See
Sunroof.
Seat memory. See
540
520 Seats.
Outside rear-view mirror control
and heating
Windshield washer jet heating
ZKE V Diagnostic Trouble Codes
(DTCs) are accessible electronically
through the data-link connector (DLC).
See
610 Electrical Component
Locations.
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Body - General
6 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Note:
All 1999 models and cars
produced through June 2000 are
equipped with the DLC socket in
the rear right corner of the engine
compartment.
In cars produced after June 2000,
the DLC socket in the engine
compartment has been
discontinued. All scan tool codes
can now be accessed through the
OBD II interface socket on the
driver's side of the dashboard, left
and below the instrument cluster,
under a cover.
Heating and air conditioning
(IHKA)
The integrated heating and air
conditioning (IHKA) system uses an
extra large, infinitely variable radial
blower motor for good distribution of
air. Fresh air enters through the grille
below the engine hood and into the
passenger compartment via the
dashboard and footwell vents.
Repair information for the heating and
air conditioning system is covered in
640 Heating and Air Conditioning.
Heating and air conditioning vent diagram
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Body - General
7 of 7
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Sport Wagon interior features
Child seats. There are three child seat
hold down anchors behind the rear seat
back rest. Plastic trim covers are used to
hide the anchors.
Cargo area. There is a spring-loaded
blind and a cargo safety net installed
behind the rear seat.
Storage. There are extra storage
compartments on the left and right sides
in the rear. These house the rear window
washer fluid reservoir and sound system
components.
Power socket. A 12 volt power socket is in
the left side of the cargo area behind the
rear seat backrest.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
410-1
General
This repair group covers replacement
of the front fenders and removal and
installation of the engine hood.
Note:
The body is painted at the factory after
assembly. Realignment of body panels
may expose unpainted metal. Paint all
exposed metal once the work is
complete.
Special tools
Most body repairs can be performed
using regular automotive service tools.
Some BMW special tools are required
to set body pieces into the service
positions.
Service position hood props BMW 51 2
160
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
410-2
Front Fenders
Front fender, removing and
installing
-
Raise hood. Raise and safely
support front of vehicle.
WARNING!
When raising the car using a
floor jack or a hydraulic lift,
carefully position the jack pad to
prevent damaging the car body.
A suitable liner (wood, rubber,
etc.) should be placed between
the jack and the car to prevent
body damage.
Watch the jack closely. Make
sure it stays stable and does not
shift or tilt. As the car is raised,
the car may roll slightly and the
jack may shift.
-
Remove front wheel. Remove
inner plastic liner from wheel
housing.
-
Remove front turn signal/lens
assembly from applicable front
corner. Carefully pry out side
directional from fender and
disconnect. See
630 Lights.
-
Remove body colored trim panel
underneath headlight assembly.
Working at cowl, feed corner of side
trim panel cover out from side of
fender. Gently lift panel cover upwards
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
and remove retaining screw (arrow).
Remove lower fender attaching bolts
(arrows) at rear of wheel housing.
With door open remove upper fender to
door post attaching bolt (arrow).
Remove screw (arrow) at front of
fender.
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Remove bolts (arrows) along top edge
of fender.
-
Carefully remove fender from
body.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Before installing new fender, clean
old sealant and protective coating
from mounting surfaces.
Position new fender and loosely
install all mounting bolts. Align
fender with door pillar and inner
fender, then tighten bolts.
Repair any paint damage and
paint any exposed metal.
Reseal and apply protective
coating to mounting surfaces.
Clearance specification
Fender to front
hood or to door
4.25 ± 0.75 mm
(0.167 ± 0.03 in.)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:39 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
410-3
Engine Hood
Hood, raising to service
position
CAUTION!
Do not switch on the windshield
wipers with the engine hood
raised. As a precaution, remove
610
the wiper motor fuse. See
Electrical Component Locations.
The hood is heavy. Before
removing the hood supports, be
sure to have an assistant help
support the hood.
Open hood fully. With the help of a
partner, support hood and remove
retaining clips (arrow) on upper end of
pressurized lifting struts. Pull struts off
hood.
-
Raise hood higher and install
BMW special tool 51 2 160 in
between hood lift struts and hood
brackets to hold hood in service
position.
Hood, removing and installing
Raise hood:
Disconnect washer fluid hose (A)
from washer nozzles.
Where applicable, disconnect
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
electrical harness connector (B)
from heated nozzles.
-
Detach gas-charged hood
supports from hood.
CAUTION!
The hood is heavy. Before removing
the hood supports or hood retaining
bolts, be sure to have an assistant
help support the hood.
Loosen upper hood hinge bolts (A).
Remove ground strap (B) and remove
lower hinge bolts (C). Lift hood off
carefully.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Repair any paint damage and
paint any exposed metal.
Check hood alignment as
described next.
Note:
The hood was fitted and attached to an
unfinished body at the factory.
Unfinished surfaces exposed by this
procedure must be touched up with
paint.
Hood, aligning
When installing the hood, align the
hinges as close to the original painted
surface as possible. Movement of the
hood on its attaching hardware may
require touch-up paint.
The hood should be aligned so that
gap (arrows) to fender is as even as
possible.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Clearance specification
Hood edges to
adjoining body
panel (gap)
5.5 mm (0.216
in.)
If height adjustment at rear of hood
cannot be completed using upper
hinge, loosen lower hinge bolts
(arrows) and reposition as necessary.
Plastic coating on top of hinge stop
screw must not be damaged or
missing.
Stop disk for front of hood (arrow) is
eccentric, and is marked 0-10. Initial
setting is with the 0 setting forward, for
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
minimal clearance. Turn stop disk to
move hood front stop further out.
-
Height at front of hood is set using
spring pins and rubber stop
buffers.
Hood release cable and spring
pins, adjusting
Before adjusting hood pins, be sure
the hood is aligned evenly to fenders
and front panel.
-
Make sure bowden cable, which
connects both hood locks
together, is seated in lock guide
on both left and right locks.
Loosen hood spring pin bolts (A) and
retaining hook bolts (B) at hood on left
and right sides only enough to allow
movement.
-
Turn rubber stop buffers over
headlights inwards to provide
clearance.
-
Lower (but do not fully latch) hood
several times so pins on hood
center themselves in lower locks.
CAUTION!
Do not let hood lock with latch bolts
loose.
-
Tighten hood spring pin bolts and
latch bolts when alignment is
correct.
-
Remove one screw from each
side, clean and coat with
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Loctite®270 or equivalent, and
reinstall.
-
Unscrew rubber stop buffers
above headlight assemblies until
they support hood when closed
without movement.
-
Test hood for correct closure and
opening. If hood does not spring
open, lengthen spring pins.
To lengthen spring pin, loosen locknut
(arrow) with wrench inserted through
spring, then turn pin counterclockwise.
Hood latch
components, assembly
1
- Hood hinge
2
- Hood release
lever
3
- Torx bolt
4
- Bowden cable,
main
5
- Hex bolt
6
- Gas pressurized
strut
7
- Ball pin
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Fenders, Engine Hood
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
8
- Stop buffer
9
- Spring pin
10 - Lower hood
lock
11 - Saucer head
screw
12 - Eccentric wheel
13 - Hex nut with
plate
14 - Hood catch
15 - Bowden cable,
center
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/header.jsp
BMW > 328 > 2000 > 2.5L L6 (M52)
Welcome
[email protected]
Logout
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/main-website-loading.html?page=B...
Vehicle
Tech Info
Search
411-1
Enter Vehicle Indentification Number (VIN):
Choose vehicle:
DTC Xpress TM
Choose Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC):
General
This repair
group covers
front and
rear door
repair
information.
It includes
removal and
installation
of interior
front door
trim panels,
rear door
trim panels
of Sedans
and Sport
Wagons and
rear trim
panels of
Coupes and
Convertibles.
For
information
on the power
door
windows and
door glass
replacement,
512
see
Door
Windows.
For
information
on the power
door locking
system, see
515
Central
Locking and
Anti-theft.
Copyright © Subscription Status | FAQs | Contact Us | Help
2008. All
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
411-2
Doors
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with side-impact
airbags in the front doors. When
servicing doors on cars with front
side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-) battery
terminal. See
721 Airbag System
(SRS) for cautions and procedures
relating to the airbag system.
Front or rear door, removing
and installing
-
If working on a door with
side-impact airbag, disconnect
negative (-) battery cable.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Remove harness connector mounting
bolt (arrow) at door pillar.
Pull up on locking clip and separate
connector.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
With door fully open, remove pin bolts
(arrow) from top and bottom door
hinges.
Remove door check mounting bolt
(arrow).
-
Remove door by lifting up off
lower hinge halves.
CAUTION!
Be careful not to damage door or
other painted body surfaces. Make
sure no load is placed on wiring
harness.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Keep in mind the following:
On 4-door models, mount and
align rear doors first, followed by
the front doors.
Align door so that panel gaps are
equal on either side, as described
later. If necessary, adjust door
hinges as described later.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Adjust door striker so that trailing
edge of front door is slightly
higher (1 mm / 0.04 in.) than
leading edge of rear door. See
515 Central Locking and
Anti-theft.
Repair any paint damage and
paint any exposed metal.
CAUTION!
In 2-door models, removing and
installing the door may upset the
adjustment and alignment of the
window. Window adjustment, as
described in
512 Door Windows,
must be carried out after installation
to prevent damaging the glass.
Door adjustment
Front fender to
front door gap
approx.
4.25 mm ± 0.25
mm
(0.17 ± 0.01 in.)
Front door to rear
door gap approx.
4.5 mm ± 0.25
mm
(0.18 ± 0.01 in.)
Rear door to rear
fender approx.
4.0 mm ± 0.25
mm
(0.16 ± 0.01 in.)
Permissible
deviation from
parallel
1.0 mm (0.04
in.)
Tightening torque
Door hinge to door
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Door check, replacing
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with side-impact
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
airbags in the front doors and as an
option on 4-door models. When
servicing doors on cars with front
side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-) battery
terminal. See
721 Airbag System
(SRS) for cautions and procedures
relating to the airbag system.
-
Close door window completely.
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove interior door panel as
described later.
-
Where applicable, remove
side-impact airbag from door. See
721 Airbag System (SRS)
Remove door vapor barrier.
Remove door check mounting bolt
(arrow).
Remove rubber cover (A) and bolts (B)
from door check lockplate on door.
-
Remove door check from inside
door.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Lubricate door check before
installing.
Use new mounting bolts when
reinstalling the side-impact airbag
to the door (where applicable).
Tightening torque
Door check to
door
24 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Door hinge adjustment
If the installed door is uneven or out of
parallel, shims can be used to correct
its position. The shims are placed
behind the hinge plate and are
available in two different thicknesses
(0.5 mm and 1.0 mm).
1 - Door
2 - Protective cap
3 - Spacer plate
4 - Hex bolt
5 - Lower door hinge
6 - Hex nut with plate
7 - Door check gasket
8 - Torx bolt with washer
9 - Door check
10 - Torx bolt
11 - Upper door hinge
Front and rear doors are similar.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Tightening torques
Door hinge to door
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:40 PM
Doors
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
411-3
Door Panels
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with side-impact
airbags in the front doors and as an
option on 4-door models. When
servicing doors on cars with front
side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-) battery
terminal. See
721 Airbag System
(SRS) for cautions and procedures
relating to the airbag system.
Door trim panel, removing and
installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Gently pry off door panel trim strip.
Carefully pry out mirror adjustment
switch and disconnect harness
connector from switch.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Doors
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
-
For rear trim panel: Pry out
window switch at top of armrest.
Pry off concealing plugs (arrows) from
under armrest.
Remove door panel retaining screws
(arrows).
Unclip door panel from door perimeter
using a trim panel tool. Pull panel
retaining clips off one at a time.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Doors
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Pry off inside door release Bowden
cable at end of clip (arrow).
Pull off panel: Detach cable from
interior door release lever.
-
Disconnect radio speaker harness
connector.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Replace any damaged plastic
parts or clips.
Renew vapor barrier if it is
damaged.
Use new mounting bolts when
reinstalling side-impact airbag to
door.
When installing door panel, align
metal retainers on window sill with
openings on top of door panel.
Check door-lock mechanism and
window for ease of movement.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Doors
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Rear side trim panel, removing
and installing (Coupe model)
-
Remove rear seat cushion.
Remove rear backrest side
section. See
520 Seats.
Using a trim tool, gently pry up door
threshold trim. Starting at A-pillar,
press radius of trim downwards while
sliding trim forward off trim clips.
Remove clips from body using pliers.
Save for installation.
-
Remove trim plugs on armrest.
Remove panel mounting screws.
-
Gently pry off panel using trim
tool.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors as necessary. Remove
side panel by lifting up and toward
interior.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace any damaged plastic
parts or clips.
Rear side trim panels,
removing and installing
(Convertible model)
-
Remove rear seat cushion.
Remove rear backrest side
520 Seats.
section. See
-
Lower side windows; open
convertible roof.
-
Remove side panel insert:
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Doors
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Remove trim plugs on side panel
armrest.
Remove insert panel retaining
screws.
Gently pry side panel insert from
upper and lower side panels.
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors as necessary.
-
Remove upper side trim panel:
Remove trim retaining rivet from
upper corner at door. Pull trim cap
upwards from weather-stripping.
Unhook spring from linkage at
convertible top.
Remove retaining screws from
lower edge of upper panel.
Gently pull weather-stripping from
rear edge of upper panel as
necessary.
Pry up on upper panel and
remove.
-
Remove lower side trim panel:
Gently pry lower side trim panel
from body.
Make sure to feed lower front
corner of side trim panel out from
door threshold trim.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Doors
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Make sure to replace any broken
trim clips.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
412-1
General
This repair group covers trunk lid and
tailgate removal and installation. Also
included here are replacement
procedures for the gas-charged
support struts that hold the trunk lid or
tailgate in the open position.
Note:
The body is painted at the factory after
assembly. Realignment of body panels
may expose unpainted metal. Paint all
exposed metal once the work is
complete.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
412-2
Trunk Lid
Trunk lid, removing and
installing
Raise trunk lid.
Open tool kit and remove screws
attaching tool kit to trunk lid
(white arrows).
Unclip retaining strap at trunk lid
and remove tool kit.
Remove insulating liner expansion
rivets (black arrows), by prying
upper portion out (inset).
Remove trunk liner.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors from components and
remove wiring harness from trunk
lid.
While supporting trunk lid, loosen top
hinge screws (arrows) and remove
lower screws from left and right sides.
Note:
Before loosening hinge bolts, mark
hinge and hinge bolt locations for
reinstallation.
-
Installation is reverse of removal. If
necessary, align trunk lid to body
as described next.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Trunk lid, aligning
Raise trunk lid. Working at lower
corners of trunk lid, unscrew out rubber
buffers (arrows) on left and right sides.
Inspect pads (arrows) on each side of
latch assembly for damage or wear and
replace if necessary.
Remove protective caps at trunk lower
trim panel and loosen screws of trunk
lock until it can be moved.
Check stop screw at trunk lid hinge:
If stop screw has a round plastic
head, cut or grind off bolt head. If
head is removed, replace round
headed stop screw with flat head
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
screw and protective cap.
If stop screw has removable
protective cap (arrow) remove
protective cap from stop screw.
Adjust stop screw so that head is set to
(A) 10 mm (0.40 in.) above bore height.
To adjust trunk lid gap at rear fender:
Loosen bolts retaining trunk hinge
to trunk lid (arrows) until trunk lid
is just able to move.
If range of adjustment is
insufficient, loosen lower bolts on
trunk hinge
Once trunk lid gap is within
specification, tighten trunk hinge
to lid bolts.
Trunk lid gap specification
Trunk lid gap at
rear fender
4.25 ± 0.75 mm
(0.17 ± 0.03 in.)
CAUTION!
Before closing truck lid, be sure that
trunk lid and body are not damaged.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
To adjust trunk lid at lock:
Remove protective caps from trim
panel and loosen screws retaining
latch assembly until it can just be
moved.
Inspect pads (arrows) on each
side of latch assembly for damage
or wear and replace if necessary.
Insert key in trunk lock, and hold
key in unlock position to prevent
lock from closing. Close trunk lid
to center latch assembly.
Open trunk lid and tighten screws
retaining latch. Replace protective
caps on trim panel.
Check adjustment of trunk lid and
lock, repeat adjustment process if
necessary.
-
Screw in trunk lid detent buffers
until left and right sides of lid rest
on buffers with trunk lid closed.
CAUTION!
Top surface of trunk lid must not
protrude above top lip of fenders or
height adjustment can be distorted.
-
Gently twist detent buffer ejector
clockwise with screwdriver to
unlock buffer and release ejector.
-
To adjust stop screw at trunk lid
hinge:
Working at trunk lid hinge, set
stop screw to a height of 10 mm
(0.40 in.). Place a strip of paper on
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
top of stop screw, and gently
close trunk lid.
Adjust height of stop screw until
paper strip can be removed with
slight resistance. Once stop screw
height has been adjusted, lower
adjusted height of stop screw 2.5
mm (0.1 in.) to accommodate for
stop screw protective cap.
Fit protective cap on stop screw.
Check that trunk lid is in correct
position, adjust if necessary.
CAUTION!
Excessive force should not be
needed to close trunk lid.
Set gap measurements as listed below.
Trunk position gap adjustment
Trunk lid / trunk
panel (A)
5 ± 1.5 mm
(0.2 ± 0.06 in.)
Trunk lid / rear
fender (B)
4.25 ± 0.75 mm
(0.17 ± 0.03 in.)
Trunk lid support strut,
removing and installing
WARNING!
Make sure to support trunk lid before
removing strut.
Open trunk lid and support in open
position. Remove spring clips (arrows)
from support strut ends.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
-
Remove strut from trunk lid.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace retaining clips damaged
during removal.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
412-3
Tailgate (Sport wagon
models)
Tailgate, removing and
installing
-
Raise complete tailgate. Remove
interior trim and disconnect wiring
harnesses.
-
Disconnect left and right support
struts as detailed below.
-
While supporting tailgate, remove
hinge bolts for tailgate on left and
right sides.
CAUTION!
The tailgate is very heavy. Use
assistance to properly support both
sides prior to removal of the hinge
bolts.
-
Installation is the reverse of
removal. Follow alignment
procedures as shown below.
Tightening torques
Tailgate to tailgate
hinge (M8)
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
Tailgate, emergency release
The tailgate of the E46 Sport Wagon
has no key cylinder. An emergency
release mechanism is incorporated into
the tailgate latch. This allows
mechanical opening of the latch in
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
case of an electrical failure. The
release is located in the rear cargo
area, along the lower edge of the rear
apron behind a small access cover.
-
Working inside car, at base of
tailgate:
Remove release cover.
Push lever toward driver's side
(arrow).
Tailgate support strut,
removing and installing
Open tailgate fully. Support tailgate
and remove retaining clips (arrow) on
upper end of pressurized lifting struts.
CAUTION!
The tailgate is very heavy, and will
close without both pressurized lifting
struts installed. Properly support
tailgate prior to removal of the lifting
struts.
-
Pull struts off tailgate.
-
Remove spring retainer from lower
end of support strut and remove
strut.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace retaining clips if damaged
during removal.
Rear spoiler, removing and
installing
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Raise rear window. Remove inner trim
from glass panel by releasing clips on
trim from retainers (arrows). For clarity,
trim is removed in photo.
Note:
Use two plastic prying wedge tools to
release each pin retaining trim.
Release spoiler mounting bolts
(arrows). Disconnect wiring to brake
light and AM radio antenna and release
washer hose. Remove spoiler. (Window
shown in place).
-
Installation is the reverse of
removal. Replace any
waterproofing sheeting disturbed
during removal. Adjust spoiler as
shown later in this section.
Rear window, removing and
installing
-
Remove rear spoiler as detailed
above.
-
Working at top outside of window,
remove waterproofing sheeting
over antenna amplifier and
disconnect wiring connections.
Release tape retaining wiring
harnesses.
Release grounds (A) and rubber
grommets (B, C) at both hinges.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Support window in open position.
Working at top of tailgate, loosen
screws (arrows) on each window
hinge. Note positions of any spacers
for reinstallation.
CAUTION!
Rear window is heavy. Use a second
person to support window prior to
releasing from hinges.
-
Remove screws and lift off
window, taking care to release
wiring to rear defroster/antenna.
-
Installation is the reverse of
removal. Replace waterproofing
sheeting where disturbed. Align
window as described below.
Tightening torques
Hatchback window
to hinge (M8)
16 Nm (12 ft-lb)
Alignment of spoiler, rear
window and tailgate
Alignment procedures involve adjusting
tailgate, window, and spoiler to have
equal space between left and right
sides and to be flush with body.
Measurement locations and specific
dimensions are shown.
-
If alignment has been disturbed
during repair adjust fit of tailgate
to body. Then adjust fit of rear
window to hatch.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Clearance of the rear window is
adjusted by adding or removing
shims between hinge bracket and
rear window (maximum of three
shims).
Adjust spoiler gap to body last.
Height of spoiler is set by
alignment of the rear hatch. Gap
of spoiler to body is set by
adjusting spoiler attachment bolts.
Seam clearance specification
Rear spoiler to roof
(A)
4.25 - 5 mm
(0.167 - 0.197
in.)
Max. deviation
from parallel
0.5 mm (0.019
in.)
Lateral and vertical alignment is
adjusted using hinge bolts for window
and tailgate. Fine adjustment of the
tailgate to the body is made using
rubber stop buffers and latch
assembly.
Tailgate and rear window position
gap adjustment
Rear spoiler / side
panel (A)
3.75 ± 1.3 mm
(0.15 ± 0.05 in.)
Rear window / side
panel (B)
3.5 ± 1.4 mm
(0.14 ± 0.06 in.)
Tailgate / side
panel (C)
3.6 ± 0.75 mm
(0.14 ± 0.03 in.)
Tailgate / side
panel (height) (D)
flush to 2 mm
(0.08 in.) lower
Tailgate light /
corner light (D)
4.25 ± 0.75 mm
(0.17 ± 0.03 in.)
Tailgate / rear
bumper (E)
5 ± 1 mm
(0.2 ± 0.04 in.)
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Tailgate and rear window position
gap adjustment
Rear window /
tailgate (F)
4 ± 1 mm
(0.16 ± 0.04 in.)
Rear window /
tailgate (G)
5.4 ± 1 mm
(0.21 ± 0.04 in.)
To adjust fit of tailgate to body:
Close tailgate and open rear
window.
Tailgate hinge bolts (A, behind
trim) should be centered both
vertically and horizontally within
their adjustment range. When
centered, tighten bolts.
Loosen screws (B) on left and
right to adjust horizontal location
(gap on left and right). When gap
is correct, tighten screws.
To prevent damage or poor
operation adjustments must be
made to the rear window f the
vertical adjustment of the tailgate
is changed.
Window hinge must be parallel to
the tailgate hinge.
Stop buffers (arrows) are adjustable
and set height between tailgate and
body at sides.
To adjust buffers, remove inner
trim panel and loosen lock nut.
Initially adjust buffers to just
contact tailgate when closed, then
tighten buffers one turn. Tighten
lock nut.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Tightening torques
Lock nut for stop
buffer (M8)
15 Nm (11 ft-lb)
Loosen screws (arrows) and reposition
rear latch to further adjust gap
between tailgate and body at sides,
and to assure smooth operation.
-
To adjust striker position:
Close tailgate slowly, allowing
striker to center itself on lock.
Striker must not touch lock
housing.
Tighten striker mounting bolts,
then check tailgate to body gaps
as shown below.
Note:
Do not lubricate lock or lock striker with
grease.
Inspect plastic guides (arrows) on lock
assembly for damage or wear, and
replace if necessary. Trim panel is
removed for clarity.
The rear window lock striker height is
adjusted by loosening lock nut A, then
turning striker in or out.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Trunk Lid, Tailgate
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/4...
Retighten lock nut when window
latch operates smoothly.
To adjust rear window lock position,
initially loosen lock mounting bolts
(arrows).
Close window slowly, allowing
lock to center itself on striker.
Tighten mounting bolts, then
check rear window to body gaps
as shown above.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:41 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
510-1
General
This repair group includes repair
information for the outside rear view
mirror, front and rear bumpers, and the
easily removable exterior trim parts.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:43 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
510-2
Outside Rear View
Mirrors
Many of the mirror components are
separately available from an authorized
BMW dealer, including the glass and
outside plastic housing.
Outside mirror glass, replacing
CAUTION!
Mirror should be at or above room
temperature before removal.
Otherwise, small plastic parts or
glass may break.
-
Insert thin pry tool (wooden or
tape-wrapped screwdriver)
between bottom mirror edge and
mirror housing and carefully pry
out mirror glass from housing.
Prying mirror glass out of mirror
housing. Note screwdriver shaft
wrapped with tape.
-
Heated mirror: remove heating
element harness connectors from
back of mirror glass.
-
Install new glass into position by
pressing firmly until it snaps into
place.
Outside mirror housing,
removing and installing
-
Remove mirror glass as described
2/25/2009 10:43 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
above.
Remove housing retaining screws
(arrows) and lift off rear housing.
Tilt mirror housing forward and
compress plastic retainers (arrows)
and lift off front housing.
Note:
The front mirror housing is retained by
either three or four clips, depending on
model.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Check mirror function before
installing covering parts.
Outside mirror, removing and
installing
-
Remove front door panel trim.
411 Doors.
See
Working at door hinge, remove door
inner trim panel retaining pins
(arrows).
2/25/2009 10:43 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Gently pry off door inner trim panel
from retaining clips (arrows).
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors for window anti-trapping
protection and speaker (arrows), if
equipped.
Remove inner door panel trim. On
sedan models, trim strip extends
around window to door latch area.
Support mirror and speaker (if
equipped) and remove mounting bolts
(arrows). Lift speaker and mirror off
door and feed out cable.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
2/25/2009 10:43 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Check mirror function before
installing covering parts.
Tightening torque
Outside mirror to
door (M6)
6 Nm (4.5 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:43 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
510-3
Bumpers
Front bumper
assembly
1
- Impact absorber
2
- Spacer
3
- Cap
4
- Support bracket
5
- Bumper bracket
bolt
tighten to 41 Nm (30
ft-lb)
6
- Protective
rubber strip
7
- License plate
bracket
8
- Tow eye cover
9
- Bumper cover
10 - Carrier bumper
11 - Grill
12 - ASA bolt
tighten to 41 Nm (30
ft-lb)
13 - Mounting sleeve
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Front bumper, removing and
installing
-
Raise and properly support vehicle.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Working underneath car, remove
screws from left and right side
corner trim, then remove trim.
Remove bumper cover retaining screws
(arrows).
Remove screws (arrows) retaining
bumper bar to impact absorbers on left
and right sides.
-
Slide bumper assembly out a few
inches and disconnect the following
connections, if applicable:
Electrical harness connectors at fog
light assemblies.
Electrical harness connector at
signal horn.
Electrical harness connectors at
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
outside temperature sensor at rear
of left side of bumper and
temperature switch at rear of right
side of bumper.
-
Slide bumper straight off side
brackets.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Slide side brackets on bumper and
body carefully together.
Make sure gap between body and
bumper is set to specifications,
adjust height as necessary. See
Bumper height, adjusting.
Tightening torque
Bumper to impact
absorber (M10)
41 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Front bumper impact absorber,
replacing
The bumper mounting bracket and
impact absorber mounting hardware are
accessible with the front bumper
removed, as described above.
Front bumper impact absorber mounting
nuts (A) and drill out pop rivets (B).
Note:
Install the bumper bracket bolt with
thread locking compound such as
Loctite®270 or equivalent.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Rear bumper
assembly
1
- Cap
2
- Casket
3
- Impact absorber
4
- Carrier bumper
5
- Support bracket
6
- Bracket
7
- Protective
rubber strip
8
- Bumper cover
9
- Lower part
cover
10 - Tow eye cover
11 - ASA bolt
tighten to 41 Nm (30
ft-lb)
12 - Bumper bracket
bolt
tighten to 41 Nm (30
ft-lb)
Rear bumper, removing and
installing
-
Raise and properly support vehicle.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
Remove bumper support bolts using
special BMW tool 00 2 150.
Remove nut from bumper cover retaining
bracket at rear of left and right rear
wheel wells.
-
Remove expansion pin from lower
rear wheel well. Remove wheel well
liner from left and right sides.
Release bumper bar retaining bolt
(arrow) from impact absorber using
BMW special tool 00 2 150, or similar
Torx head socket.
CAUTION!
Protect possible contact areas to
prevent damage or scratches to
vehicle bumper and paint.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Install the bumper bracket bolt with
thread locking compound such as
Loctite®270 or equivalent.
Tightening torque
Bumper bracket to
impact absorber
(M10 bolt)
41 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Rear bumper impact absorber,
replacing
-
Remove bumper as described
above.
-
Remove luggage compartment floor
covering.
-
Remove battery and battery tray on
right side and trunk trim panel on
left side.
Remove trim caps (arrow) at rear of
frame rails.
Release nuts on inside on vehicle trunk
and remove absorber.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace body seal and protective
cap if necessary. Make sure to
check bumper height. See
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Bumper height, adjusting.
Tightening torques
Bumper bracket to
impact absorber
(M10 bolt)
41 Nm (30 ft-lb)
Impact absorber to
chassis (M8 nut)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Bumper height, adjusting
The adjustment procedure applies to
either front or rear bumpers. A 14 mm
allen socket is needed to make
adjustments.
-
Raise and properly support vehicle.
WARNING!
Make sure that the car is firmly
supported on jack stands designed for
the purpose. Place the jack stands
beneath a structural chassis point. Do
not place jack stands under
suspension parts.
-
Front bumper:
Remove bumper as described
earlier.
Remove bumper bracket bolt.
-
Rear bumper:
Remove lower bumper panel as
described in
Rear bumper,
removing and installing.
Remove bumper bracket mounting
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
bolt at impact absorber.
Using a 12-inch extension and a 14 mm
Allen socket, turn adjusting collar
clockwise or counterclockwise as needed
to change height of adjusting collar.
-
Reinstall mounting bolts and check
bumper height. Refit front bumper.
Tightening torques
Front bumper to
bumper bracket
(M8 nut)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Front bumper
bracket to impact
absorber (M10 bolt)
55 Nm (41 ft-lb)
Rear bumper
bracket to impact
absorber (M10 bolt)
42 Nm (31 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
510-4
Exterior Trim
Exterior trim is retained to the body by
plastic clips and fasteners that may be
damaged during removal. Be sure to
have necessary fasteners on hand
when reinstalling exterior trim pieces.
BMW emblem, removing and
installing
The procedure given below applies to
both front and rear emblems.
-
Wrap end of a screwdriver with
tape.
CAUTION!
Protect hood paint by covering area
around emblem with tape.
Carefully pry out emblem. Pry up
emblem carefully on either side
(arrows). Note tape on screwdriver
tips.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace plastic inserts in body if
damaged.
If emblem fits loosely, use a small
amount of body molding tape or
adhesive on rear of emblem
before installing.
Body side molding, replacing
To remove body side moldings,
carefully pry moldings straight off.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace any clips or clip covering
boots damaged during removal.
Radiator grill, removing and
installing
-
Open hood.
Gently pry out tab on left or right side
of grill trim ring (A), as well as tabs on
bottom.
-
Feed grill out through opening. Be
careful of hood lever on driver's
side grill.
-
Once grill is removed, pry
remaining tabs (B) to separate
inner grill from chrome trim ring.
-
Before installation, assemble
chrome trim ring and grill insert
securely. Replace components if
tabs or catches are broken or
missing.
To install align grill and trim ring in
appropriate location in hood. Press on
trim ring until grill snaps into place.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Exterior Trim, Bumpers
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Headlight housing trim panel,
removing and installing
-
Open hood.
-
Remove spray nozzle of vehicles
equipped with headlight cleaning
systems. See
611 Wipers and
Washers.
Unclip inner tab at radiator support.
-
Press pane downward, out of
retaining brackets. Feed out
retaining hook at fender.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
512-1
General
This repair group covers door glass,
window regulator and power window
motor repair information.
CAUTION!
All E46 models are equipped with
side-impact airbags in the front
doors. Some models are also
equipped with airbags in the rear
doors. Be sure to read the airbag
warnings and cautions in
721
Airbag System (SRS).
Electric window switch replacement is
612 Switches.
covered in
The windshield, rear window, fixed rear
door glass, and cargo compartment
glass (Sport Wagon only) are bonded
using special adhesives and tools. It is
recommended that bonded glass
replacement be done by an authorized
BMW service facility or an automotive
glass installer.
Special tools
Some window repair operations require
the use of special tools.
2-door window adjustment tool BMW
41 6 120
Window height gauge BMW 51 3 080
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Power windows
Power window features in E46 models
include:
Control of the front and rear door
window motors is carried out
directly by the General Module
(GM V).
One-touch operation in both
directions on all four windows,
where applicable.
Cable type window regulator used
for all door windows.
Anti-trap protection is provided by
the pressure sensitive finger
guard.
The window switch is pulled up to
raise the window and pushed
down to lower.
4-door models: Each rear door
has a single window switch
located in the door handle trim.
The rear window switches can be
deactivated by pressing the child
lock-out switch in the center
console.
Convenience closing/opening of
the windows from the driver's lock
cylinder or convenience opening
only from the FZV remote key.
FZV operation can be owner
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
customized with the Car Memory
function. See
515 Central
Locking and Anti-theft.
After the ignition is switched off,
electric windows can be operated
until a door is opened or until 16
minutes has elapsed.
The GM V bases window motor
end position on current draw
(load). There is a maximum
window motor run time of 8
seconds. The motor is then
switched off even if the end
position load sensor fails.
Power window electronics (GM V) Sedan and Sport Wagon
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Window switches
The push-pull type window switch
provides the GM V with a coded ground
signal. Holding a switch at the first
detent provides a single ground signal
on one wire requesting the GM V to
open the window. When released, the
ground signal is removed and the
window motor stops.
Momentarily pushing the switch to the
second detent and releasing provides an
additional ground signal on the second
wire requesting "one touch mode". The
GM V lowers the window automatically
until it reaches the end position.
The switch functions in the same
manner for window closing but the
ground signal sequence is reversed.
Note:
In Coupe models, the rear windows
switches are used for operating the
rear swing-out vent windows.
Electric window switch replacement
is covered in
612 Switches.
Rear window child lockout
switch
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
In 4-door models, the rear window child
lockout switch (arrow) is incorporated in
the driver's window switch block to the
left of the shifter. When activated, it
provides a constant ground signal to the
GM V, preventing the windows from
being operated from the rear door
switches.
The lockout switch ground signal is
overridden by the GM V if a passive
safety system (MRS) crash signal is
received.
Note:
In Convertible models the four-window
control switch is in the position occupied
by the rear window lockout switch in
4-door models.
Power window motors
The window motors are mounted on
cable regulators. The window motor
control circuit consists of two wires for
operating the motor in both directions.
The motors are activated by relays in the
GM V. The relays provide either power or
ground depending on the direction of
window travel. The GM V controls the
polarity based on a request to run the
window from a window switch or a
convenience opening/closing signal.
Convenience opening/closing
The GM V provides the convenience
open/close feature, providing control of
the power windows (and sunroof) from
outside the vehicle with the key in the
driver's door lock. The FZV (remote key)
provides the same function for window
opening only.
Anti-trap protection is active during
convenience closing from the driver's
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
door lock.
If the GM receives a request to operate
convenience closing or opening for more
than 110 seconds, the function is
deactivated and a fault code is stored.
Window anti-trap protection
In 4-door models, a rubber pressure
guard located at the top edge of each
door frame consists of two contact strips
that close when subjected to pressure.
When the contact strip closes (for
example, a hand is trapped between the
top of the window and the door frame),
an anti-trap signal is sent to the GM V.
The window immediately (within 10
milliseconds) reverses direction. This
feature does not require initialization.
The E46 pressure sensor finger guard
has a resistance of 3 K
and it is
monitored for open circuit. When
pressed, the monitored resistance
changes to < 1K . If anti-trap protection
becomes faulty the one touch window
closing will not function.
Window anti-trap protection is only active
in the one touch and convenience close
modes of operation. If the window switch
is pulled and held, anti-trap protection
will not function.
Window motor limit stop
function
If repeated window activation (up/down
cycles) exceeds one minute, the GM V
deactivates the internal relays and
disregards any further up/down
requests. The GM V provides motor
activation after a short duration but not
for the full one minute monitoring cycle.
The GM V monitors the number of times
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
a window motor is activated. It counts
each cycle and stores the number in
memory. After the stop function limit is
reached and the window motor is
deactivated, the GM V slowly reverses
the stored count of activation until the
stored number equals 0, thus allowing
the window motor to cool down.
Convertible windows
A central power window switch is located
in the Convertible console between the
left side window switches. This switch
allows all four windows to be opened
with one-touch operation and closed if
the switch is held.
The Convertible is not supplied with
window anti-trap protection. Therefore
only the driver's window allows one
touch closing.
When the convertible top is opened, the
power windows are lowered for approx.
1.5 seconds to ensure clearance for the
top. Once the top is stored in the storage
compartment, the windows will close
again if the top switch is held in the open
position.
WARNING!
Always wear hand and eye
protection when working with
broken glass.
If a window is broken, all of the
glass bits should be vacuumed
out of the door cavity. Use a blunt
screwdriver to clean out any
remaining glass pieces from the
window guide rails.
When servicing the door
windows, the harness connector
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
to the window regulator should
always be disconnected to
prevent pinching fingers in the
moving window mechanism.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:44 PM
Door Windows
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
512-2
Window Service, 4-door
Models
Sedan and Sport Wagon doors are
similar. Use the following procedures
for window service on these models.
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with
side-impact airbags in the front
doors. Some are equipped with
airbags in the rear doors as well.
When servicing the door
windows on cars with
side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-)
721 Airbag
battery cable. See
System (SRS) for cautions and
procedures relating to the airbag
system.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Window anti-trap strip, testing
-
To test function of anti-trap strip
on any window:
With key ON and window down,
pull up window switch to second
detent, thus activating one-touch
close operation.
Insert wooden block or other soft
object between glass and upper
door frame.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Window should contact block,
then immediately reverse direction
and lower by approx. 25 mm (1
in.).
Note:
Anti-trap strip is integrated into the
molding strip of the door window frame.
Front window anti-trap strip,
removing
-
Remove front door panel and
vapor barrier as described in
411 Doors.
Detach window frame molding strip
and peel toward inside of vehicle.
Separate anti-trap electrical harness
connector (arrow) at top front of door.
Note:
Wire colors for anti-trap strip are blackwhite.
If replacing molding with new one,
transfer mounting clips and foam
insulation as necessary.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
1 - Window frame molding
2 - Clip
3 - Door corner speaker cover
4 - Foam insulation
5 - Mounting clip
-
After installation, recheck anti-trap
protection.
Rear window anti-trap strip,
removing
-
Remove rear door panel and vapor
barrier as described in
411
Doors.
Detach window frame molding strip,
peeling it off fixed window partition
(arrows). Do not tear strip in area A.
-
Detach electrical harness
connector at top front of door, just
below window.
Note:
Wire colors for anti-trap strip are blackwhite.
-
After installation, recheck anti-trap
protection.
Front door window, adjusting
(4-door models)
Whenever the front window or window
regulator is removed, window
adjustment should be checked. The
glass should contact the top of the
window squarely and should seat
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
against the window seal uniformly.
Note:
If the window does not contact the
window seal uniformly, wind noise or
water infiltration may result.
-
Remove front door panel as
described in
411 Doors.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery. Then remove airbag unit
and vapor barrier from door. See
721 Airbag System (SRS).
WARNING!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Partially detach rear of vapor
barrier/sound insulation from door
and fold forward. Hold in place
using adhesive tape.
Loosen window guide rail mounting
nuts (arrows), but do not remove.
-
Reconnect battery. Open window
fully.
-
Tighten guide rail nuts.
Tightening torque
Window regulator
guide rail to door
9 Nm (80 in-lb)
Front door window, removing
and installing (4-door models)
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Remove front door panel as
described in
411 Doors.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery. Then remove airbag unit
and vapor barrier from door. See
721 Airbag System (SRS).
WARNING!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Detach window from window regulator
rails:
Reattach battery. Move window to
approx. 140 mm (5.5 in.) from
bottom.
Remove window retaining screws
(insets) at window regulator rails.
WARNING!
Once the window is positioned
correctly, disconnect harness
connector from power window motor
to prevent accidental operation of
the window.
Detach plastic window retainers from
glass:
Push expander nut (1) out of
plastic retainer.
Squeeze retainer tabs (2) and
remove from glass.
Note:
BMW recommends replacing the plastic
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
window retainers every time the glass is
removed from the door.
Turn window glass carefully inside door
cavity and lift out of door.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace plastic window retainers
once glass is inside door.
Use new mounting bolts when
reinstalling side-impact airbag to
door.
Adjust window as described
earlier.
Tightening torque
Side-impact airbag
to door
Window to
regulator guide
8.5 Nm (75
in-lb)
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Rear door window, removing
and installing (4-door models)
-
Remove rear door panel and vapor
barrier. See
411 Doors.
-
In model with rear side impact
airbag: Disconnect negative (-)
cable from battery. Then remove
airbag unit from door. See
721
Airbag System (SRS).
Detach window from window regulator
rail:
If applicable, reattach battery.
Move window to approx. 115 mm
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
(4.5 in.) from bottom.
Remove window retaining screw
(inset) at window regulator rail.
WARNING!
Once the window is positioned
correctly, disconnect harness
connector from power window motor
to prevent accidental operation of
the window.
Detach plastic window retainer from
glass:
Push expander nut (1) out of
plastic retainer.
Squeeze retainer tabs (2) and
remove from glass.
Note:
BMW recommends replacing the plastic
window retainer every time the glass is
removed from the door.
-
Pull window glass straight up to
lift out of door.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace plastic window retainer
once glass is inside door.
If applicable, use new mounting
bolts when reinstalling side-impact
airbag to door.
Rear window does not need
adjustment.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Tightening torque
Side-impact airbag
to door
Window to
regulator guide
8.5 Nm (75
in-lb)
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
1 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
512-3
Window Service, 2-door
Models
2-door models are equipped with the
"close with door shut" feature. In this
mode, the window glass moves down
slightly when the door latch is
activated, then jams up tightly against
the weather-strip when the door is fully
closed.
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with
side-impact airbags in the front
doors. When servicing the door
windows on cars with
side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-)
721 Airbag
battery cable. See
System (SRS) for cautions and
procedures relating to the airbag
system.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Front door window, adjusting
(2-door models)
The "close with door shut" feature of
2-door cars with frameless windows
makes window adjustment critical.
CAUTION!
There is risk of window glass
breakage if correct adjustment
procedures are not used. If in doubt,
this procedure should be left to a
trained BMW technician.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
2 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
The following adjustments can be
made to the window:
Longitudinal adjustment
Pretension (or window rake)
Parallelism (or window tilt)
Vertical adjustment (or retraction
depth)
Glass protrusion (when open)
Distance between side window
and door window
Emergency operation
Adjusting the "close with door shut"
feature insures low wind noise and
water leakage past windows. With the
door closed, the window must jam a
predetermined amount up into the seal.
When the door is opened, the window
must lower immediately to clear the
seal.
With door open, close window.
To simulate closed door, use
screwdriver or finger to push door
lock rotary latch in direction of
arrow.
Window must rise to its full closed
position.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
3 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Close door as far as possible without
forcing.
Coupe models: Top edge of glass
must rest on door seal (A).
Convertible models: Gap between
door and B-pillar (B) must be 25
mm (1 in.).
Note:
Window must seal with water drain at
mirror triangle in A-pillar.
-
Use door handle to open rotary
latch:
Window should lower a small
amount.
-
Close door:
Window should raise a small
amount.
-
Reopen door:
Window should lower a small
amount and clear rubber seal.
-
If window gets stuck in rubber
seal:
Lower glass.
Adjust retraction depth as
described later.
Longitudinal adjustment
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
4 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Position window approx. 155 mm (6.1
in.) above dead bottom.
Working carefully with a plastic prying
tool, detach outside trim strip from
door.
Reach through door bores (A) using
Torx driver E7 on extension with ratchet
wrench (BMW special tool 41 6 120 or
equivalent). Loosen but do not remove
longitudinal adjustment screws.
Raise glass to top. Move glass fore or
aft to attain correct adjustment.
Coupe models: When fully closed,
rear edge of window must
protrude by distance A from edge
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
5 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
of window outer sealing lip.
If necessary, replace side window
trim.
Window longitudinal adjustment
Dimension A
Door window rear
edge to side
window seal
(Coupe)
1 - 2 mm
(0.04 - 0.08 in.)
6 ± 0.75 mm
(0.24 ± 0.03 in.)
Convertible models: When all the way
up, measure door window gap to side
window trim.
Gap A is measured from edge of
door window to rear of side
window seal.
Window longitudinal adjustment
Door window rear
edge to side
window seal
(Convertible)
-
25 mm (1 in.)
Tighten longitudinal adjustment
screws.
Tightening torque
Window to guide
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Pretension
Note:
Window pretension can also be thought
of as the inward rake of the window.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
6 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Remove outer door trim strip as
described earlier.
Latch door to first catch of door lock
(A). Check that top of window rests on
rubber door seal (B).
Reach through rear bore in door with
BMW special tool 41 6 120 or
equivalent ratchet wrench.
Loosen window adjustment Torx
screw (A) 180° counterclockwise.
Turn slider adjustment nut (B)
until it is hard to move.
Continue loosening window
adjustment Torx screw and
tightening slider adjustment nut
(see previous step) until correct
window rake is reached.
Tighten window adjustment screw.
Tightening torque
Window to guide
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Vertical adjustments
Note:
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
7 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Adjusting the depth that the window
retracts into the door seal insures that
wind noise and water leakage past
window is kept to a minimum.
Parallelism. Top edge of door window
must be parallel to contour of water
drain in roof.
Note:
Window parallelism is also referred to
as window tilt.
Retraction depth. With door closed,
raise window to top.
Use BMW special tool 51 3 080 or
equivalent device to measure
depth of window in rubber seal.
Window retraction
At A-pillar or roof
line (arrows)
-
3 - 4 mm
(0.12 - 0.16 in.)
Window protrusion. When all the
way down, measure door window
glass protrusion above top edge of
door.
Window protrusion
Door window
above top of door
max. 2 mm (0.08
in.)
To adjust:
Lower door glass.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
8 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Pry out rubber plugs at base of
door.
Starting at rear of door, reach
through bore in door to turn Torx
screw (A).
Note:
Torx screw size is T20.
Repeat at front bore.
Raise window and check for
parallelism and correct depth of
retraction.
Repeat as necessary.
Reinsert rubber plugs.
Front door window, removing
and installing (2-door models)
-
Remove interior door panel. See
411 Doors.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery. Then remove airbag unit
and vapor barrier from door. See
721 Airbag System (SRS).
WARNING!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Detach door corner rubber seal
mounting clips (arrows). Remove seal
by pulling up in direction of curved
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
9 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
arrow.
Lift off window inner lip seal.
If necessary, replace any defective
retaining clip (arrow).
Position door window approximately 80
mm (3.15 in.) below roofline. If
necessary, temporarily reconnect
battery cable.
WARNING!
Once the window is lowered,
disconnect harness connector from
power window motor to prevent
accidental operation of the window.
-
Remove window mounting screws
from window regulator rails.
Note:
Window mounting screws have
left-hand thread.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
10 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Window rear mounting hardware
will stay with glass.
-
Tilt rear edge of window glass up
and out of door.
-
If glass is being replaced, transfer
window rear mounting hardware
(mounting shim, threaded sleeve
and clamping retainer) from lower
rear corner of glass to new
window.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Install window rear mounting
screw with adjusting sleeve
through guide rail and threaded
sleeve in glass.
Note:
Window mounting screws have
left-hand thread.
Use new mounting bolts when
reinstalling side-impact airbag to
door.
Adjust window as described
earlier.
Tightening torque
Side-impact airbag
to door
Window to guide
8.5 Nm (75
in-lb)
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Rear vent window or vent latch,
(Coupe models)
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
11 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Refer to accompanying illustration
when removing Coupe rear vent
window or vent latch mechanism.
1 - Vent window drive
2 - Inner cap
3 - Retainer
4 - Washer
5 - Washer
6 - Shim
7 - Glass support
When installing, make sure
U-shaped opening in glass
support points to rear of car.
To access rear vent hinges,
remove B pillar (door pillar) trim.
When reinstalling make sure
window seals completely. Note
gap clearances below.
Vent window clearances
Front trim strip to
rear edge of front
window
up to 6 mm (0.24
in.)
Rear of window to
water drain
up to 1.8 mm
(0.07 in.)
Top of window to
water drain
1 mm (0.04 in.)
Tightening torques
Vent window to
body (M6 nut)
6.2 Nm (55 in-lb)
Rear side window (Convertible
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
12 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
models)
Refer to accompanying illustration
when removing Convertible rear
window or window motor.
1 - Window motor
2 - Window regulator assembly
3 - Window glass
4 - Insert
5 - Inner seal
6 - Outer seal
CAUTION!
Convertible rear window removal,
installation and adjustment is
complex. If the final adjustment is
incorrect glass breakage may result.
This job is best left to be done by a
trained technician at a qualified
BMW repair facility.
Rear side window, adjusting
(Convertible models)
The Convertible rear side window
shares a version of "close with door
shut" feature of the front window: It
retracts slightly when the top is raised
or lowered, then rises to seal against
the folding top once the top is locked in
place.
The procedure for setting Convertible
rear side window adjustment, while
similar in principle to front window
adjustment, also depends on correct
adjustment of the folding top and of
the front window glass.
Refer to the accompanying illustration
when adjusting Convertible side
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
13 of 13
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
window.
Distance to front door window
(longitudinal adjustment) (A) must
be set by loosening Torx bolt
through bore in outer shell of car,
after removing exterior side trim
strip.
To set retraction depth
(submersion) into top rubber seal
(B), rear interior side trim panel
must be removed to access
adjustment screws.
To set window centering (C), rear
interior side trim panel must be
removed to access adjustment
screws.
To set side window depth in
relation to door window (D), rear
interior side trim panel must be
removed to access adjustment
screws.
Convertible rear side window
adjustments
A
23 - 25 mm (0.9 - 1.0 in.)
B
Window must run into
convertible top seal
when top is closed. With
top open, glass must
rest firmly against
window seal.
C
With convertible top
open, window must be
centered in channel
D
up to 1 mm (0.04 in.)
toward inside of car
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
512-4
Window Regulator
Service
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with
side-impact airbags in the front
doors. Some are equipped with
airbags in the rear doors as well.
When servicing the door
windows on cars with
side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-)
721 Airbag
battery cable. See
System (SRS) for cautions and
procedures relating to the airbag
system.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Window regulator motor
Note:
Because window operation is
electronically controlled, a window
motor does not have mechanical end
positions. For this reason it can be
removed and installed with the window
in any position and does not need
reinitialization.
To remove motor:
Remove inner door panel and
vapor barrier
Detach window motor electrical
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
harness connector (A).
Remove motor mounting bolts (B).
Twist motor slightly (arrows) to
clear window regulator mounting
tabs.
-
When reinstalling:
Make sure window has not
travelled fully downward.
Manipulate spring-loaded window
control cable (C) to engage motor
teeth to regulator gears.
Window regulators
and motors 4–door
models, assembly
1
- Front window
motor
2
- Front window
regulator
3
- Rear window
motor
4
- Rear window
regulator
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Window regulator and motor,
removing and installing (4-door
models)
Sedan and Sport Wagon doors are
similar. There are two window rails in
each front window regulator, only one in
the rear. Otherwise the front and rear
regulators are similar.
Note:
BMW recommends removing the window
regulator and motor as one unit, then
separating the two on the bench.
-
Remove door panel as described in
411 Doors.
-
Disconnect battery negative cable
and remove side impact air bag, if
applicable. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with
side-impact airbags in the front
doors. Some are equipped with
airbags in the rear doors as well.
When servicing the door windows
on cars with side-impact airbags,
always disconnect the negative (-)
battery cable. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS) for cautions and
procedures relating to the airbag
system.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Remove vapor barrier.
-
Detach window from window
regulator as described earlier. Do
not remove window from door. Push
window up and use wedge to hold
in position.
Detach window regulator from door:
Disconnect electrical harness
connector (A) to power window
motor.
Remove regulator mounting nuts
(arrows).
-
Remove window regulator through
opening in bottom of door, checking
for any wiring harnesses that might
become snagged during removal.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Be sure to route wiring harnesses to
keep them away from moving
window mechanism. Use new wire
ties as necessary.
Adjust front window as described
earlier.
Tightening torques
Window motor to
regulator
5 Nm (4 ft-lb)
Window regulator
to door
9 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Window to guide
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Door window regulator and
motor, removing and installing,
(2-door models)
-
Remove door panel as described in
411 Doors.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery. Then remove airbag unit
and vapor barrier from door. See
721 Airbag System (SRS).
-
Remove door glass as described
earlier.
-
Lower window regulator completely.
WARNING!
Once the window regulator is
positioned correctly, disconnect
harness connector from power
window motor to prevent accidental
operation of the mechanism.
Detach window regulator from door:
1 - Window motor
2 - Front window rail
3 - Window regulator mechanism
4 - Rear window rail
Disconnect electrical harness
connector to power window motor.
Remove regulator mounting nuts.
-
Remove window regulator through
opening in bottom of door, checking
for any wiring harnesses that might
become snagged during regulator
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Door Windows
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
removal.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Inspect rubber insulators. Replace if
brittle.
After inserting window regulator into
door cavity, install and tighten down
mounting nuts on rear window rail.
Install front window rail mounting
nuts but do not tighten.
Install glass. See
Front door
window, removing and installing
(2-door models)
Tighten upper nut of front rail.
Lower window glass fully.
Tighten front rail lower nuts.
Adjust window. See
Front door
window, adjusting (2-door models).
Tightening torques
Window motor to
regulator
5 Nm (4 ft-lb)
Window regulator
to door
9 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Window to guide
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:45 PM
Interior Trim
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
513-1
General
This repair group covers interior trim
removal and installation procedures.
Refer to the following repair groups for
additional information:
250 Gearshift Linkage
411 Doors (interior door
panels)
612 Switches
620 Instruments
640 Heating and Air
Conditioning (IHKA control panel)
650 Radio
721 Airbag System (SRS)
Special tools
Use plastic prying tools or wrap the
screwdriver tip with tape to avoid
marring interior trim.
Plastic prying tool BMW 00 9 321
Interior trim repairs
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Interior trim and finish panels are
clipped or screwed into place. Many of
the trim retaining clips are designed to
be used only once. When removing
trim that is held in place with clips, it is
a good idea to have spares on hand
before beginning the job.
Note:
The BMW E46 is equipped with SRS
airbags mounted in the steering wheel,
the dashboard on the passenger side,
the front doors, the A-pillars, and as an
option in rear doors on four door
models. See warnings and cautions on
721 Airbag System
below and in
(SRS).
WARNING!
Special precautions must be
observed when servicing the
BMW Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS). Serious injury
may result if system service is
attempted by persons unfamiliar
with the BMW SRS and its
approved service procedures.
BMW specifies that all
inspection and service should
be performed by an authorized
BMW dealer.
Before performing any work
involving airbags, disconnect
the negative (-) battery cable.
See
721 Airbag System (SRS).
Airbags contain a back-up
power supply within the SRS
control module. A 5 second
discharge period should be
allowed after the battery cable
has been disconnected.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
CAUTION!
When working on electrical
switches or lights, always
disconnect the negative (-) cable
from the battery and insulate the
cable end to prevent accidental
reconnection.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
To prevent marring the trim
when working on interior
components, work with plastic
prying tools or wrap the tips of
screwdrivers and pliers with
tape before prying out switches
or electrical accessories.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
513-2
Center Console
The console between the two front
seats starts behind the shifter housing.
It houses the parking brake handle,
optional telephone and oddments
storage tray. The rear portion of the
console houses the ashtray and covers
the emergency brake cable ends.
The optional front seat armrest is part
of this console.
Center console, removing and
installing
Press rolling cover of rear ashtray
down. Depress cover fully to pop
ashtray out of console. Remove
ashtray.
-
Remove retaining screws and
bracket.
-
Remove ashtray cover and
housing. Disconnect electrical
harness connector for ashtray
courtesy light.
-
Remove screws at base of ashtray
compartment in console.
Unclip trim boot for parking brake lever
and pull boot and handle forward off
brake lever.
-
Gently pry up boot or trim at
transmission selector. On
automatic transmission vehicles,
unplug connector for gear
indicator light.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Remove trim panel retaining screws
(arrows) under transmission selector
boot/trim.
Slide center console back and lift up.
Disconnect electrical harness
connector from hazard light and central
locking switch.
If applicable disconnect wiring for
factory installed cellular telephone. To
release phone connector, press catch
(A) and slide lock (B) forward.
Disconnect antenna connection.
-
On vehicles with center armrest:
Tilt armrest upright. Lift parking
brake lever upwards. Feed center
console panel out over armrest
and brake lever.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Make sure to securely fasten all
electrical harness connectors
during reassembly.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
1 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
513-3
Dashboard
The E46 dashboard assembly includes
the instrument cluster, passenger side
airbag, glove compartment, fuse and
relay panel, radio, IHKA control panel
or on-board monitor (if equipped with
GPS), front ashtray, shifter assembly,
and window control switches.
Dashboard removal is a complex
operation. Read the procedures
through before starting work.
Dashboard
assembly
1
- Dashboard
2
- Passenger knee
protector
3
- Reinforcement
4
- Damper piston
5
- Glove
compartment
6
- Glove
compartment
door
7
- Latch
8
- Right top
footwell trim
panel
9
- Storage
compartment
10 - Glove
compartment
door strap
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
2 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
11 - Glove
compartment
hinge
12 - Steering column
cover
13 - Left glove
compartment
(optional)
14 - Center knee
protector
15 - Steering column
knee protector
16 - Left footwell
(pedal cluster)
trim panel
17 - Footwell light
cover
18 - Footwell light
socket
19 - Left knee
protector
Glove compartment and right
footwell trim panel, removing
and installing
-
Open glove compartment door.
-
Snap out glove compartment light
fixture and detach electrical harness
connector.
To detach glove compartment:
Pull out retaining pin (arrow) for
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
3 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
right side strap.
Pull out pin from bottom of left side
dampening rod.
Remove glove compartment hinge
mounting bracket screws (arrows). Lift
glove compartment over mounting rod to
remove.
Remove glove compartment housing:
Remove insert mounting screws
(arrows).
If necessary, release mounting pin
(A) at right side of housing.
Pull glove compartment housing
down.
Note:
Detach glove compartment electrical
harness from guides while removing
housing.
Remove right footwell trim panel (arrow)
by pulling backward to detach from
mounting points.
Note:
Detach electrical harness connector(s)
from panel while removing.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
4 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Steering column trim, removing
and installing
-
Remove steering wheel as
described earlier.
Fully lower and extend (arrows)
adjustable steering column.
-
Remove retaining screw from top of
steering column upper trim cover.
Push in sides of upper trim cover
(arrow) to release from lower trim. Pull
back and up on upper trim.
Pry gently to detach flexible cover from
upper trim. Lift off trim.
-
Remove left footwell (pedal cluster)
trim panel. See
Steering column
trim, removing and installing.
To remove steering column lower trim,
drive pins into expansion rivets (arrows)
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
5 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
to release. Pull down on trim.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace any broken or missing
fasteners.
Left footwell (pedal cluster) trim
panel, removing and installing
-
Move steering column to maximum
extended position.
Working at trim panel, remove screws
(arrows) and expansion rivets (A).
Clips (inset) must be rotated 90° to
remove.
If equipped detach electrical
harness connectors from footwell
light and warning chime.
Release OBD II socket from panel
and pull out.
Disconnect electrical harness connectors
at left footwell trim panel and remove
panel:
Unplug connector at footwell interior
light (A), if equipped.
Slide lock at OBD II connector (B) in
direction of arrow.
Unplug connector at chime (C).
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
6 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Dashboard/shifter console
assembly, removing and
installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover terminal with
insulating material.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Using a plastic trim tool pry gently to
remove left, center and right dashboard
trim.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring interior trim, work
with a plastic prying tool.
Note:
Left side shown. Center and right
trim are similar.
To remove center trim, right trim
must be removed first.
-
Remove steering wheel. See
320
Steering and Wheel Alignment.
-
Remove left footwell trim panel as
described earlier.
-
Remove upper and lower steering
column trim. Detach steering
column stalk switch electrical
connectors and remove stalk
switch. See
612 Switches.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
7 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Remove shifter knob by pulling straight
up.
Note:
Apply approx. 90 lb. of force to pull off
knob from shift rod.
-
Lift up and remove shifter bezel by
prying gently.
-
Unclip bottom of shifter boot from
center console trim by pushing
forward. Pull boot up around shifter.
-
Remove center console as
described earlier.
-
Lift off switch carrier and detach
electrical harness connectors to
window switches.
-
Remove glove compartment as
described earlier.
To remove storage compartment below
IHKA control panel:
Open compartment door.
Push upward on tabs (arrows),
then pull out.
Remove A-pillar (windshield pillar) trim
on left and right sides by prying out
finishing strip.
CAUTION!
The Head Protection Airbag is behind
the A-pillar. Do not use sharp
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
8 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
instruments to remove trim or finisher
strip
-
Remove screws beneath finishing
strip.
Carefully pull away A-pillar trim.
-
Remove headlight switch. See
612 Switches.
-
Remove instrument cluster. See
620 Instruments.
-
Remove IHKA control panel and
module. See
640 Heating and Air
Conditioning.
-
If applicable: Reach through IHKA
control panel opening and
disconnect solar sensor harness
connector.
-
Remove radio. See
-
Remove front passenger airbag.
See
721 Airbag System (SRS).
-
Remove glove compartment as
described earlier.
650 Radio.
Remove right footwell trim panel (arrow)
by pulling backward to detach from
mounting points.
Note:
Detach electrical harness connector(s)
from panel while removing.
Remove dashboard mounting screw or
expansion rivet (arrow) in lower right
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
9 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
dashboard.
-
Similarly, remove left side
dashboard mounting screw or
expansion rivet.
Remove dashboard mounting nut
(arrow) at shifter console.
Remove mounting nuts and screw
(arrows) at dashboard face.
-
To remove dashboard:
Pull up parking brake fully.
Push seats fully back.
Lift instrument panel off carefully,
making sure all harness connectors
and wiring are disconnected.
Remove through passenger door.
-
When installing, fit dashboard
guide pin into locator slot at base of
windshield in center.
-
Install center console with
dashboard mounting nuts loose.
Align and center parts before
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Interior Trim
10 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
tightening fasteners.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:46 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
515-1
General
This section covers repair information
for door, trunk and cargo compartment
locks and central locking. Also covered
are Electronic Immobilization System
(EWS) and anti-theft alarm (DWA).
Keep in mind that E46 cars are
equipped with sophisticated and
self-diagnostic electrical systems.
When experiencing malfunctions
relating to central locking or anti-theft
systems, it is recommended that the
system be diagnosed using the BMW
service tester DIS or MoDiC or
equivalent. An advanced diagnostic
scan tool can usually pinpoint electrical
faults quickly and safely. Consult an
authorized BMW dealer.
Note:
Additional general electrical information
can be found in
610 Electrical
Component Locations and Electrical
Wiring Diagrams.
Special tools
A few special tools may be necessary
for repairs in this section.
Ring antenna removal tool BMW 61 3
300
Front door lock adjustment tool 4 mm
Allen wrench
2/25/2009 10:47 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:47 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
1 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
515-2
Central Locking
Note:
There is a door lock key cylinder on the
driver's door only
Central locking in E46 vehicles controls
the door locks, trunk or cargo
compartment lock and fuel filler flap
lock. The Central Body Electronics
(ZKE V) control module, known as the
General Module (GM V), controls
central locking.
The door lock actuators are sealed, self
contained units with no replaceable
parts. The actuators use Hall effect
sensors in place of pin contacts and
microswitches to provide door
OPEN/CLOSED status signal. Each
door lock-button only affects the
actuator it controls. There is no effect
on the central lock control of other
doors.
The automatic locking feature can
activates the door lock actuators when
a road speed signal of 2.5 MPH is
detected via the K-Bus. The factory
default coding for this feature is OFF,
but can be coded ON for individual
users with the Key Memory function.
Car Memory/Key Memory later
See
in this section.
The driver's door lock location is the
only point outside of the vehicle where
the key can mechanically control all of
the central locking system functions.
The outside locks (driver's door and
trunk) incorporate an overrunning lock
cylinder that breaks away and
freewheels if an attempt is made to
destroy either with a screwdriver or
dent puller.
The rear doors are equipped with the
child lock-out lever preventing the door
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
2 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
from being opened from the inside
regardless of lock-button position.
The General Module (GM V) and
Electronic Immobilization (EWS 3.3)
interface via the K-bus to monitor
double lock status and to initiate
double lock override. This feature
allows the doors to be opened from the
inside if a key accepted by EWS is
switched on in the ignition when the
doors are double locked.
Continuous locking/unlocking will
initiate a timed arrest of the locking
system. The GM V counts each time
the locks are actuated. After
approximately 12 cycles, the timed
arrest is active. The timed arrest is
deactivated one actuator cycle for every
8 seconds until the counter is reset to
0. The timed arrest is overridden if a
crash signal is received from the
multiple restraint system (MRS).
Central locking system
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
3 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Central locking switch
The central locking switch is housed in a
combined housing with the hazard
flasher switch. The central switch locks
all vehicle locks except for the fuel filler
flap.
The switch provides a momentary
ground input signal to the GM V. This
input single locks each door and the
trunk. The fuel filler flap remains
unlocked for refueling purposes. If a
door is manually unlocked and opened
while centrally locked, the remaining
doors stay locked. The opened door can
be re-locked when closed by manually
locking or pushing the central switch
twice. This allows the locks of the
remaining doors to be resynchronized.
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
4 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Single lock and double lock
function
Each door lock actuator incorporates two
motors:
Single lock motor controls the
mechanical lock mechanism when the
central lock switch is pressed to single
lock the vehicle. The lock mechanism is
fully locked at this point but can still be
opened from the interior by pulling the
appropriate interior door handle twice or
by pressing the central lock switch
again. When single lock function is
activated, the fuel filler flap actuator is
not locked.
Double lock motor, also known as
central arrest, is activated only when the
vehicle is locked from the outside at the
driver's door lock with a key or when the
General Module (GM V) receives a lock
request from the remote entry (FZV)
system. In this case the double lock
motor is activated simultaneously with
the single lock motor. The function of the
double lock motor is to mechanically
offset an internal rod in the lock actuator,
disabling it from unlocking the vehicle
from the interior. This prevents the doors
from being unlocked by any means
except from an unlock request at the
driver's door or via the FZV remote key.
Trunk lock
The trunk lock can be operated with the
key but does not lock or unlock the
entire vehicle. When unlocked, the trunk
can be opened by pressing the trunk
release switch pad located above the
license plate or from the remote trunk
button in the left kick panel.
The trunk can also be opened from
inside the vehicle by pressing the remote
trunk lid release button in driver's
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
5 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
footwell area. The button provides the
GM V with a ground signal when
pressed.
The vehicle must be unlocked or single
locked from the central lock switch for
the remote unlock to work. The remote
trunk release is locked out when the
trunk is locked in the valet setting or
when the GM V detects a vehicle speed
over 4 mph via the K-bus.
Pressing the trunk release button on an
FZV key also opens the trunk.
The trunk lid position (open/closed) and
trunk lock key positions are input signals
to the General Module (GM V). The trunk
lid OPEN/CLOSED signals come from
the trunk lid switch contact located in the
trunk lock motor. When closed, the trunk
contact provides a ground signal to the
GM V signifying a CLOSED trunk. This
contact also serves as the trunk light
switch when the trunk is OPEN.
The actuator motor only operates in one
direction to release the latch mechanism.
The latch mechanism can also be
manually unlocked with the key.
Located on the trunk lock are two
additional microswitches for key position
status signalling to the GM V.
Valet position switch: With the key
lock in the valet position, this switch
provides a ground signal to the GM
V. The GM V locks out the interior
trunk release button preventing the
trunk from being opened.
DWA cancel switch: When the trunk
is opened with the key, this switch
provides a ground signal to the GM
preventing the DWA alarm system
from activating, if armed.
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
6 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Remote entry (FZV)
The E46 remote (keyless) entry system
(usually called FZV) uses a tiny radio
transmitter in the vehicle key to lock and
unlock the doors and the trunk by
remote control.
1
Press once:
unlock driver's door
DWA disarmed
interior lights on
Press twice:
total unlocking
Hold
convenience opening
2
Press once:
lock
DWA armed
interior lights ON when
vehicle is locked
Press twice within 10 seconds
deactivate interior and tilt
monitoring
3
Press momentarily
trunk lid opens
Press and hold:
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
7 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
panic mode (alarm if
equipped)
There are a number of other features
incorporated in FZV:
Locking/unlocking of fuel filler lid
Selective unlocking of driver's door
(as with key in lock)
Arming/disarming of DWA alarm
system (if equipped)
Remote unlocking of the trunk only
Comfort opening of windows,
sunroof, and convertible top.
Interior lighting activation (search
mode)
Panic mode alarm activation (if
equipped)
Automatic correction for up to 1000
erroneous activation signals.
Low transmitter battery fault code
storage in the GM V
3 volt lithium battery (commercially
available CR 2016) used as power
supply for key transmitters
An EEPROM to stores key data.
Data is no longer lost when key
battery is replaced; reinitialization is
not required.
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
8 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Key incorporates an LED that
signals operator of signal
transmitting, key initialization status
and key self-test indication
Keys delivered with four different
colored labels. This is helpful to
differentiate FZV keys during
initialization, preventing possibility
of misassigning key ID which would
change coded Key Memory
functions.
Note:
A single unlock request from the
driver's door with the FZV key
unlocks the driver's door only. A
second unlock request unlocks the
remaining doors and trunk. This
feature can be modified for
individual users with the Key
Memory capabilities to activate all
lock actuators simultaneously. Car
Memory/Key Memory is covered
later in this section.
Starting with 2000 models, the
battery in the FZV ignition key is
recharged while the key is in the
ignition switch. Therefore there is no
need to replace the key battery.
The remote key receiver is part of the
antenna amplifier and is installed in the
left "C" pillar. The receiver produces a
digital signal based on the transmitter
command and sends it to the GM V for
processing. The GM V then carries out
all remote lock system, window/sunroof
convenience closing features and DWA
arming/disarming functions. The
frequency of the FZV key radio signal to
the antenna amplifier is 315 MHz. The
system is also used to convey the key
identification number being used to
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
9 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
lock/unlock the vehicle. This is a
requirement of the Key Memory feature,
covered below.
Car Memory/Key Memory
A number of features and functions can
be customized to the driver(s)
preference. The identity of the vehicle
user is provided by a signal from the
keyless entry system (FZV).
Car Memory and Key Memory are
actually two separate functions,
although they are marketed as a
combined feature.
Car Memory
The owner is provided with a list of
systems that can be customized. Prior to
vehicle delivery, the BMW scan tool DIS
or MoDiC is used to code the driver
preferences into the appropriate control
modules. Thereafter these choices
cannot be changed without recoding
with a BMW scan tool.
The functions that can be set using Car
Memory include:
Alarm system (DWA) features such
as arming/disarming with keyless
entry (FZV), activation of tilt sensor
or interior sensor
Interior light activation when central
locking is used
Convenience opening of
windows/sunroof
Interior and external lighting
preferences
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
10 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Heating/A/C preferences (IHKA)
Seat and mirror preferences
(triggered by Key Memory)
Instrument cluster display units (for
example: km vs. miles)
Key Memory
Whenever one of the FZV keys is used
to lock or unlock the car, the user is
identified by the GM V. A maximum of
four keys can be programmed with the
Key Memory feature. The use of the
personalized key then triggers Car
Memory functions such as heating/A/C
(IHKA) settings or memory seat position
adjustment.
Most programming of Key Memory
requires the use of BMW scan tools DIS
or MoDiC. However, features such as
IHKA blower speed and temperature
store automatically without the use of
scan tools.
Available Key Memory functions vary
based on vehicle equipment. The
functions that can be set include:
Automatic locking after start off
Selective locking
Heating/A/C blower speed, heated
or cooled air distribution, automatic
blower setting.
Note:
Key Memory is only activated when using
keyless entry. If the driver's door is
unlocked manually, no electronic input is
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
11 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
received at the GM V. Therefore Car
Memory/Key Memory features will not be
activated.
Remote key initialization
Initialization of FZV keys is required to
establish lock/unlock signal
synchronization with the GM V. The
initialization procedure provides the GM
V with a key identification number and a
"rolling code" for each key. If initialization
is not performed, the GM V will not
respond to the key signals.
Up to 4 remote keys can be initialized.
They must be initialized at the same
time. Key initialization is only possible
with the vehicle unlocked.
-
Close all doors and have all keys
available.
-
Using key number 1, turn the
ignition switch to KL R (accessory
position), then switch off within 5
seconds and remove the first key.
-
Within 30 seconds of turning the
ignition switch to OFF Press and
hold button #2
-
While holding button #2, press and
release ("tap") button #1 three times
within 10 seconds.
-
Release both buttons.
Note:
The Key Memory function of the GM
responds to the key identification number
of each key. If the keys are not initialized
in the same order prior to initialization,
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
12 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
the key memory functions activated by
the keys will not be assigned correctly.
Always initialize the keys in the same
order.
Convertible central locking
In Convertible models, the glove
compartment lock is integrated into
central locking functions. An additional
lock actuator is positioned above the
glove compartment lock, locking it
whenever central locking is activated.
A microswitch on the glove compartment
lock cylinder signals the GM V to lock
the trunk electrically. This is the
equivalent of valet key position. The
trunk can only be opened with either the
remote (FZV) key or the wallet key.
Also, the trunk is locked whenever the
top storage compartment is unlocked
while the top is raised or lowered. The
top storage cover motor Hall sensor
signals the GM V whenever the cover is
unlocked.
The Convertible Top Module (CVM II)
receives a signal from the GM V over the
K-bus to lock out convertible top
operation whenever the trunk is OPEN.
The FZV antenna for the Convertible is
incorporated into the rear view mirror.
Tailgate and rear window
locking
The Sport Wagon tailgate can be
opened from:
Remote key (FZV)
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
13 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Interior tailgate release button at
driver's kickpanel
Unlock microswitch above rear
license plate
Any of these input requests to the GM V
activate the tailgate latch motor. The GM
V will also switch on the interior lights
with a tailgate unlock request.
The rear window is opened with the
release switch on the rear wiper arm
cover. Pressing the switch signals the
GM V to activate the rear window release
relay.
Sport Wagon tailgate and rear window lock controls
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
14 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:53 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
1 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
515-3
Door Handles and Locks
Any time a door lock is removed and
reinstalled, be sure to check and reset:
Unlocking of rotary latch
Outside door handle overtravel
These adjustments and measurements
must be made by closing the door lock
rotary latch with a screwdriver, then
attempting to open it with the outside
door handle. Both adjustment
procedures are described below,
under
Rotary latch adjustments.
CAUTION!
Do not close the door before
resetting rotary latch adjustment.
The door may lock and be
unopenable from outside.
Rotary latch adjustments
CAUTION!
Carry out rotary latch checks and
adjustments with the door open. If
the door is closed with the incorrect
latch setting, it may not be possible
to open the door without destroying
the inner door panel.
Door lock and handle
assembly
1
- Inside door lock
release
2
- Inside door
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
2 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
release Bowden
cable
3
- Lock button and
rod
4
- 9/2000 and later
models:
Bowden cable
bracket
5
- 9/2000 and later
models: Door
handle inner
mechanism
5a - Models to
9/2000: Door
handle inner
mechanism
6
- Inner handle
mounting bolt
7
- Key cylinder
mounting bolt
(Torx)
8
- Gasket
9
- Door lock with
rotary latch
10 - Plug
11 - Bolt M6 (always
replace)
tighten to 9 Nm (80
in-lb)
12 - Gasket
13 - Outer door
handle
14 - Driver’s door:
Door lock
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
3 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
cylinder and
cover
14a - Rear or right
door: Outer
handle rear
anchor
15 - Door striker
cover
16 - Torx bolt M8
tighten to 24 Nm (18
ft-lb)
17 - Door lock striker
18 - Lock plate
Rotary latch unlocking, resetting
With door open, close rotary latch.
-
Lock car with key or lock button.
-
Unlock car.
-
Open rotary latch using outside
handle.
-
If latch unlocks, adjustment is
correct.
If latch fails to unlock:
Remove latch adjuster access hole
cover.
Use 4 mm Allen wrench to loosen
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
4 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
adjustment screw, then retighten.
Carry out check again.
Note:
The right side latch adjusting screw is
threaded left-handed.
Tightening torque
Door lock
adjustment screw
3 + 2 Nm
(27 + 18 in-lb)
Outside handle overtravel, resetting
-
With door open, close rotary latch
with a screwdriver.
-
Open rotary latch with outside door
handle.
Measure additional distance (A) handle
can travel once rotary latch releases.
If measurement A is obtained,
rotary latch adjustment is correct.
If measurement A is not obtained,
readjust rotary latch through access
hole, as described above, and
check handle overtravel again.
If measurement A is still not
obtained, replace door lock.
Outside door handle overtravel
Measurement A
min. 2 mm (0.08
in.)
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
5 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Door lock, removing and
installing
The front and rear door locks for all E46
models are similar. Early production
cars, up to 9/2000, use a lock actuator
with an external lever which couples with
the outside door handle mechanism.
Cars produced from 9/2000 use a
Bowden cable to attach the outside door
handle to the lock release mechanism.
-
Remove front door tim panel, air
bag, and vapor barrier as described
in
411 Doors and
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
Detach window from window regulator
rails:
Reattach battery. Move window to
approx. 140 mm (5.5 in.) from
bottom.
Remove window retaining screws
(insets) at window regulator rails.
WARNING!
Once the window is positioned
correctly, disconnect harness
connector from power window motor
to prevent accidental operation of the
window.
Note:
Be prepared to retrieve the captured nut
corresponding to the retaining screw on
the back side of the window rail. It may
fall to the bottom of the door.
Be sure to separate plastic lug at
base of window from rail.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
6 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Raise window to top.
CAUTION!
Guide the window up manually in
order to avoid binding.
Remove window regulator rear rail:
Remove top and bottom rail
mounting fasteners (arrows).
Slide rail down, allowing it to hang
to the side out of the way.
WARNING!
E46 cars are fitted with side-impact
airbags in the front doors. When
servicing the door locks on cars with
front side-impact airbags, always
disconnect the negative (-) battery
terminal. See
721 Airbag System
(SRS) for cautions and procedures
relating to the airbag system.
-
Driver's door: Remove door lock
cylinder as described later.
-
Models produced from 9/2000:
Carefully pry outside door handle
Bowden cable off lock assembly.
Remove lock mounting bolts (arrows)
from rear edge of door. Support lock to
prevent it from falling into bottom of
door.
-
Disconnect harness connector from
lock assembly.
-
Remove lock assembly, complete
with lock-button linkage.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
7 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Insert lock button up through inner
door plate, taking care to avoid
bending linkage.
On models produced to 9/2000: Tilt
lock assembly outward while lifting
it into position inside the door. This
is done to make sure lock lever is
inserted between outside door
handle pawl and outer door skin.
Use new door lock mounting bolts.
Use new self-locking mounting
bolts when reinstalling side-impact
airbag to door (where applicable).
Secure wire harnesses with wire
ties, as applicable.
Be sure to check unlocking of rotary
latch and outside door handle
overtravel as described above
Rotary latch adjustments.
under
Check function of window
mechanism before reinstalling vapor
barrier and inner door panel.
Tightening torques
Airbag to door
(replace screws)
8.5 Nm (75 in-lb)
Door lock to door
M6 bolt (always
replace)
9 Nm (80 in-lb)
Window guide to
door
9 Nm (80 in-lb)
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
8 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Tightening torques
Window to guide
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Driver's door lock cylinder,
removing and installing
Only the driver's door is equipped with a
lock cylinder. The procedure for
removing the door handle rear anchor on
the other three doors is similar to that for
removing the driver's door lock cylinder.
Open door and remove plastic plug
(Sedan or Sport Wagon shown in
illustration) or rubber covering (Coupe or
Convertible) at lock cylinder mounting
bolt access hole in upper rear door
edge.
Note:
On Sedan or Sport Wagon: Remove
inner plug by prying with screwdriver,
then peel off outer (oval) plastic trim.
Remove lock cylinder mounting screw
(arrow).
-
Pull out lock cylinder.
Note:
Use key in cylinder to help pull cylinder
out.
Use a small screw driver to pry cylinder
cover locking tabs (arrows). Slide cover
off cylinder gently to avoid breaking
tabs.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
9 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
On Sedan or Sport Wagon:
Replace cylinder mounting bolt
access hole trim cover if necessary.
Door handle, removing and
installing (to production date
9/2000)
-
On driver's door: Remove door lock
cylinder as described earlier.
-
Other doors: Remove door handle
rear anchor. Procedure is similar to
removing driver's door lock cylinder
described earlier.
Pull handle out as far as it will go, then
backward approx. 2 mm (0.08 in.).
-
Push handle in slightly (approx. 4
mm/0.16 in.).
-
Remove door handle from door by
angling out of door cavity.
Note:
Make sure the lock release pawl at the
rear of the handle and the mounting
guide at the front of the handle are intact.
Before reinstalling, insert screwdriver
through access hole in edge of door to
push lock release lever (arrow) outward.
-
Insert outside handle and snap
forward until a click is heard.
-
Be sure to check unlocking of rotary
latch and outside door handle
overtravel as described above
under
Rotary latch adjustments.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
10 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Door handle, removing and
installing (from production date
9/2000)
-
On driver's door: Remove door lock
cylinder as described earlier.
-
On other doors: Remove door
handle rear anchor. Procedure is
similar to removing driver's door
lock cylinder described earlier.
Pull outside door handle out and wedge
BMW special tool 00 9 322 under
handle.
-
Working in lock cylinder mounting
bolt access hole, tighten down
screw (counterclockwise direction).
Lock is now in "installation position".
Remove special tool 00 9 322.
Tightening torque
Outside handle to
lock (left-hand
thread)
-
2.0 ± 0.4 Nm
(18 ± 3.5 lb-in)
Pull outside door handle outward
and unhook from front guide.
Note:
Make sure the lock release bore at the
rear of the handle and the mounting
guide at the front of the handle are intact.
-
Before reinstalling handle, make
sure lock mechanism is in
"installation position" as described
earlier:
Distance between inner door handle
lever and outer door skin must not
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
11 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
exceed measurement A.
If measurement exceeds
specification, pull lever outward with
fingers until measurement is
correct.
Installation distance: inner door
handle lever to door
Measurement A
less than 8 mm
(0.32 in.)
Insert handle and snap into place.
Note:
Take care that the door handle base
gasket is not deformed when the handle
is installed.
-
Be sure to check unlocking of rotary
latch and outside door handle
overtravel as described above
under
Rotary latch adjustments.
Door handle inner mechanism,
removing and installing (to
production date 9/2000)
-
Remove door lock and outside door
handle as described earlier.
-
Remove front door tim panel, air
bag, and vapor barrier as described
in
411 Doors and
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
-
Remove outside handle base seals.
Loosen inner handle mounting bolt
(arrow).
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
12 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Working inside door opening, slide
inner handle toward front and
remove.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note:
Inspect mounting bolt and replace if
necessary.
Door handle inner mechanism,
removing and installing (from
production date 9/2000)
-
Remove outside door handle as
described earlier.
-
Remove outside handle base seals.
-
Remove front door tim panel, air
bag, and vapor barrier as described
411 Doors and
721 Airbag
in
System (SRS).
-
Lever out Bowden cable from door
handle with screwdriver.
-
On Sedan or Sport Wagon: Slide
Bowden cable out of guide.
Note:
Foam insulation on bowden cable must
be placed in original position during
reinstallation.
-
On Coupe or Convertible: Remove
inner door guide (plastic) to gain
access to Bowden cable.
Note:
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
13 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Take care to not damage inner door
guide during removal and installation.
-
Loosen handle mounting bolt.
-
Working inside door opening, slide
inner handle toward front and
remove.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note:
Inspect handle mounting bolt and
replace if necessary.
Bowden cable end must be correctly
fitted in lock actuator.
Door striker, replacing
-
Remove striker plastic cover.
Remove striker top mounting bolt (A).
Screw M8 stud into top bolt hole to
keep striker backing plate from
falling down into B-pillar cavity.
Remove lower bolt (B).
-
Remove and reinstall striker and
gasket while holding on to stud.
Install striker mounting bolts fingertight.
Position striker bar approx. 90° to inside
edge of door frame. Leave striker
mounting bolts finger-tight.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
14 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Set position of striker:
When closed, rear edge of front
door must be even with front edge
of rear door (Sedan or Sport
Wagon) or with rear quarter panel
(Coupe or Convertible). Maximum
deviation allowed measured at A.
When closed, shoulder of front door
must be flush to shoulder of rear
door (Sedan or Sport Wagon) or
with top of rear quarter panel
(Coupe or Convertible). No
deviation is allowed at
measurement B.
When door is closed, striker must
not contact lock housing.
With door closed, there must be no
in/out movement of door.
-
Torque striker bolts. Recheck door
alignment. Reinstall plastic cover.
Door striker position
Deviation from
parallelism of
closed door (A)
Deviation from flush
at door shoulder (B)
max. 1 mm (0.04
in.)
0
Tightening torque
Striker plate to
24 Nm (18 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
15 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Tightening torque
body pillar
Trunk locking mechanism
Trunk lock assembly
1 - Trunk release microswitch
2 - Connecting rod
3 - Lock with microswitch
4 - Torx screw M6
5 - Striker plate
6 - Trim screw
7 - Lock cover
8 - Torx bolt M6
9 - Lock cylinder gasket
10 - Self-threading screw
11 - Lock cylinder
The trunk can be unlocked by using:
Central locking button
Left door key
FZV remote entry system
Trunk lock cylinder in the trunk lid
right side taillight assembly
Trunk release in the driver's
footwell, if equipped
Microswitch in the center of the
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
16 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
license plate light strip
The trunk lock cylinder does not actuate
central locking control.
-
To remove the trunk lock
microswitch:
Remove licence plate light strip.
Separate electrical harness
connector from strip.
Separate microswitch from strip.
To access trunk lock cylinder or lock:
Raise trunk lid.
Open tool kit and remove screws
attaching tool kit to trunk lid (white
arrows). Unclip retaining strap at
trunk lid and remove tool kit.
Remove insulating liner expansion
rivets (black arrows). and remove
trunk liner. Expansion rivets are
released by pry upper portion out
(inset).
Lift off trim panel.
To remove trunk lock cylinder:
Remove right taillight socket from
trunk lid. See
630 Lights.
Remove right tail lens mounting nut
(A) and detach tail lens from trunk
lid.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
17 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Remove lock cylinder cover
mounting screws (arrows). Slide
cover to right to remove.
Note:
On Convertible models: Remove
third brake light to access trunk lock
mechanism.
Use new self-tapping screws to
reinstall trunk lock cylinder.
Pry out rear trunk edge trim caps
(arrows) to access mounting screws to
remove trunk lock striker.
When reinstalling, or to adjust trunk lid
alignment, adjust position of trunk lock
striker with mounting bolts finger tight.
Set gap measurements as listed
below.
Check trunk lid lock operation with
lid open.
Also see
412 Trunk Lid, Tailgate.
Trunk position gap adjustment
Trunk lid / trunk
panel (A)
5 ± 1.5 mm
(0.2 ± 0.06 in.)
Trunk lid / rear
fender (B)
4.25 ± 0.75 mm
(0.17 ± 0.03 in.)
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
18 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Note:
Do not lubricate lock or lock striker with
grease.
Tailgate lock, emergency
release
The Sport Wagon tailgate can be
unlocked using the central locking
switch, the left door key or the FZV
remote entry system. The tailgate can be
opened by pushing the tailgate release
button in the left front kickpanel or by
pressing the microswitch in the center of
the license plate light strip. There is no
key lock cylinder in the tailgate.
In case of electrical failure, there is an
emergency tailgate lock release. The
release is located in the rear cargo area,
along the lower edge of the rear apron
behind a small access cover. Remove
access cover and push release in
direction of arrow to open tailgate.
Tailgate and rear window
locking mechanism
Tailgate lock assembly
1 - Torx bolt M6
2 - Rear window lock
3 - Rear window lock cover
4 - Nut M6
5 - Rear window striker mounting
bracket and wiper pivot
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
19 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
6 - Rear window lock striker
7 - Tailgate lock
8 - Torx bolt M8
9 - Tailgate lock striker
10 - Lock plate
11 - Tailgate release microswitch
12 - Tailgate grip
13 - Tailgate grip gasket
14 - Tailgate
To remove tailgate lock microswitch:
Remove license plate light strip.
Separate electrical harness
connector from strip.
Separate microswitch from strip.
To remove tailgate lock:
Open tailgate and remove tailgate
rear panel trim.
Mark position of lock on rear panel.
Remove lock mounting bolts
(arrows).
Detach lock mechanism electrical
harness contractor.
Electric lock actuator and
emergency release lever can now
be separated from tailgate lock
mechanism.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
20 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
To remove tailgate lock striker:
Open tailgate and pry out lock
striker trim from bottom of tailgate.
Remove one striker mounting screw
(arrows).
Thread in M8 stud to keep striker
lock plate from falling inside door.
Remove second screw and striker.
Reinstall striker bolts finger tight.
Adjust striker position before
tightening bolts.
-
To adjust striker position:
Close tailgate slowly, allowing
striker to center itself on lock.
Striker must not touch lock housing.
Tighten striker mounting bolts, then
check tailgate to body gaps as
shown below.
Note:
Do not lubricate lock or lock striker with
grease.
To remove rear window lock striker:
Adjust striker height by loosening
lock nut A, then turning striker in or
out.
Retighten lock nut.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
21 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
To remove rear window lock:
Open tailgate. Remove tailgate trim
panel.
Detach window lock electrical
harness connector (A).
Remove lock mounting screws
(arrows).
Slide lock out from under rear
window wiper motor.
Reinstall lock mounting bolts finger
tight. Adjust lock position before
tightening bolts.
-
To adjust lock position:
Close window slowly, allowing lock
to center itself on striker.
Tighten striker mounting bolts, then
check rear window to body gaps as
shown below.
Tighten lock mounting bolts.
When reinstalling, or to adjust tailgate or
rear window alignment, adjust position of
tailgate striker or window lock with
mounting bolts finger tight.
Set gap measurements as listed
below.
Also see
412 Trunk Lid, Tailgate.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
22 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Tailgate and rear window position
gap adjustment
Rear spoiler / side
panel (A)
3.75 ± 1.3 mm
(0.15 ± 0.05 in.)
Rear window / side
panel (B)
3.5 ± 1.4 mm
(0.14 ± 0.06 in.)
Tailgate / side
panel (C)
3.6 mm ± 0.75
mm
(0.14 ± 0.03 in.)
Tailgate / side
panel (height)
flush to 2 mm
(0.08 in.) lower
Tailgate light /
corner light (D)
4.25 ± 0.75 mm
(0.17 ± 0.03 in.)
Tailgate / rear
bumper (E)
5 ± 1 mm
(0.2 ± 0.04 in.)
Rear window /
tailgate (F)
4 ± 1 mm
(0.16 ± 0.04 in.)
Rear window /
tailgate (G)
5.4 ± 1 mm
(0.21 ± 0.04 in.)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 10:59 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
515-4
Electronic
Immobilization (EWS)
E46 cars are equipped with a passive
theft-prevention system. The Electronic
Immobilization System (EWS 3.3)
makes it impossible to start the engine
using any means other than the special
keys furnished with the vehicle.
Note:
EWS is sometimes also referred to
as Driveaway Protection.
If a vehicle key is lost or stolen,
the electronic authorization for that
key can be cancelled using the
BMW scan and diagnostic tools
DIS or MoDiC.
Force applied to a key can
damage the electronic circuitry. A
damaged key will not start the
engine.
In the EWS system, the ignition key is
embedded with a computer chip and
permanently coded. The key
communicates with the vehicle using a
transponder in the key and a ring
antenna surrounding the steering lock
cylinder.
A primary code is programmed into the
key and into the vehicle itself. A
secondary code is changed every time
the vehicle is started. If the key code
and EWS control module code do not
match, the engine management control
module and the starter are disabled.
EWS ignition keys cannot be
duplicated.
The system is designed to have up to
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
ten keys. Only an authorized BMW
dealer can provide replacement keys.
Note:
It is possible to damage the
electronic circuitry in the key,
rendering it unusable. In that case,
a new key should be purchased
and initialized by an authorized
BMW dealer.
Starting with 2000 models, the
battery in the FZV ignition key is
recharged while the key is in the
ignition switch. Therefore there is
no need to replace the key battery.
EWS control module, replacing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Lower left footwell (pedal cluster) trim
panel.
Remove screws (A).
Remove fasteners (B).
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Disconnect electrical harness
connectors at left footwell trim panel
and remove panel:
Unplug connector at footwell
interior light (A), if equipped.
Slide lock at OBD II connector (B)
in direction of arrow.
Unplug connector at speaker if
equipped (C).
Remove EWS control module harness
connector (arrow).
-
Remove module mounting screws.
Remove module.
Note:
The EWS module should be identified
with EWS markings.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Ring antenna
To remove the ring antenna using
BMW special tool 61 3 300, it is
necessary to remove the upper and
lower steering column trim.
Alternatively, remove the ignition switch
key cylinder.
With ignition key in "ON" position (60°
from "LOCKED"), insert a thin piece of
stiff wire into opening (arrow) in lock
cylinder and pull lock cylinder out.
-
Detach ring antenna harness
connector.
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Gently work ring antenna off key
cylinder.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
515-5
Anti-Theft Alarm (DWA)
The DWA anti-theft system is a dealer
installed accessory option. All E46
vehicles are factory prepared to provide
the DWA function. This means that the
vehicle is prewired and the General
Module (GM V) is preprogrammed for
the system. However, once the DWA
system components are installed the
GM V must be coded, using the DIS or
MoDiC, to recognize the installed
components and carry out DWA
functions.
The GM V utilizes existing components
and/or circuits as part of the DWA
system:
Door lock hall effect sensor
contacts
Trunk lid switch contact
Trunk lock key position switch
Hood switch
DWA status (LED)
The DWA accessory kit includes the
following:
Tilt sensor in right trunk area
UIS (interior monitoring sensor) in
center of headliner
Siren in cowl area next to IHKA
housing
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Anti-theft and alarm system (DWA) (Sedan models)
DWA alarm arming/disarming
The DWA alarm is armed every time the
vehicle is locked from the outside with
the door lock cylinder or FZV key.
The LED in the rear view mirror flashes
as an acknowledgment, along with
flashing exterior lights and a momentary
chirp from the siren.
The GM V monitors all required input
signals for CLOSED status (door closed,
trunk closed, etc.) The inputs must be in
CLOSED status for a minimum of 3
seconds for the GM V to include them as
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
an activation component. If after 3
seconds any input signal not in CLOSED
status is excluded (this is acknowledged
by the DWA LED) preventing false alarm
activation.
If the DWA is armed a second time
within 10 seconds, the tilt sensor and
interior protection sensor are also
excluded as alarm activation
components. This function is useful for
preventing false alarm activation if the
vehicle is transported on a train or flat
bed truck.
While armed the trunk can be opened
without the alarm being triggered as
follows:
If opened with the trunk remote
button via the FZV, the GM V
prevents the alarm from activating.
(This feature is customizable under
the Car Memory function.)
If opened with the key at the trunk
lock cylinder, the trunk key position
switch signals the GM V and in the
same manner prevents the alarm
from activating.
In either case, when the trunk is
returned to the CLOSED position, it
will no longer activate the alarm.
Alarm operation
When the alarm is triggered, the siren
will sound for 30 seconds. At the same
time the headlight low beams and
hazard lights will flash for 5 minutes.
The GM V signals the Light Center
Switch (LSZ) via the K-bus to flash the
lights. Following an alarm trigger, the
system will reset and trigger again if
further tampering is done to the vehicle.
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Door contacts
The door lock Hall effect sensors provide
status of door OPEN/CLOSED:
When the door latch is CLOSED,
current flow through the sensor is
<5 mA.
When the door is OPEN, current
flow through the sensor is >12 mA.
With the DWA armed, the GM V will
activate the siren if it receives a door
OPEN signal.
Trunk lid switch contact
The trunk switch contact is located in the
trunk lock assembly. When closed, the
trunk contact provides a ground signal to
the GM V signifying a CLOSED trunk.
With the DWA armed, the GM V will
activate the siren if it receives a trunk
OPEN signal.
Trunk lock key position
switches
There are two switches mounted in one
block (arrow) on the trunk lock cylinder:
Valet position switch. With the key
lock in the valet position, this switch
provides a ground signal to the GM
V. The GM V locks out the interior
trunk release button preventing the
trunk from being opened.
DWA deactivation switch. When the
trunk is opened mechanically with
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
the key, this switch provides a
ground signal to the GM V
preventing the DWA from activating
if armed.
Hood contact switch
Located on the right side engine
compartment, the hood contact switch
(arrow) provides a ground signal to the
GM V signifying an open hood. The
plunger of this switch can be pulled up
past a detent causing the switch contact
to open. This feature can be used to
simulate a CLOSED hood with the hood
open when diagnosing the DWA system.
DWA LED
The DWA indicator is located in the rear
view mirror. All E46 vehicles are
equipped with the LED. It is not part of
the retailer installed accessory DWA
system.
The LED is provided with constant
battery voltage (KL 30). The GM V
provides a switched ground signal
providing the various blinking signals
used to convey DWA status to the
vehicle operator. DWA LED status is
Table a.
summarized in
Table a. DWA LED status
DWA status
DWA LED
condition
Disarmed
OFF
Armed
Continual slow
flash
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Table a. DWA LED status
DWA status
DWA LED
condition
Armed with one or
more monitored
inputs not in
CLOSED position
(trunk not closed,
etc.)
Rapid flash for 10
seconds, then
continual slow
flash
Alarm activated
Rapid flash for 5
minutes, then
continual slow
flash
Rearmed in less
than 10 seconds
ON for 1 second
Disarmed after
activated alarm
Rapid flash for 10
seconds, then
OFF
Tilt sensor
Located in the right trunk area above the
battery, the solid state tilt sensor
monitors the vehicle parked angle when
DWA is armed. The sensor requires
three signal wires to perform its function:
KL 30. Constant battery voltage
STDWA signal. Switched ground
input signal provided by the GM V
indicating DWA armed/disarmed
status. The tilt sensor is used as a
splice location for the STDWA
signal to the siren and interior
protection sensor.
NG signal. Switched ground output
signal provided to the GM V. This
signal is used for two purposes: a.
As a momentary acknowledgment
that the tilt sensor received STDWA
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
and is currently monitoring the
vehicle angle. b. If the tilt sensor
detects a change in the vehicle
angle when DWA is armed, the NG
signal is switched to inform the GM
V to activate the siren.
When the tilt sensor receives the
STDWA signal from the GM V, the angle
of the vehicle is memorized and
monitored by the solid state electronics.
Once armed, if the angle changes, the
tilt sensor provides a switched ground
signal to the GM V to activate DWA.
Interior protection (UIS)
The combined ultrasonic transmitter and
receiver in UIS monitors the vehicle
interior for motion.
The UIS is mounted in the center of the
headliner panel even with the door (B)
pillar. Due to the design of the vehicles
interior, the sensor is unidirectional and
must be installed in the proper direction
to ensure proper operation of the system
(trim cover ensures directional
installation).
Every time the DWA system is armed
(STDWA signal), the sensor adapts to
whatever objects are stationary in the
interior. The sensor emits ultrasonic
waves in a programmed timed cycle. It
receives echoes of the emitted signals.
The UIS amplifies the received sound
wave signals and compares them with
the transmitted waves. The UIS also
checks the incoming echoes for
background hiss (wind noise through a
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
partially open window) and adapts for
this.
If the echoes are consistently similar, no
movement is detected. If the echoes are
altered or inconsistent, the UIS changes
to a constant cycle and the echo is
compared again. If the inconsistency is
still present the UIS sends the activate
siren signal (INRS) to the GM V.
As with the tilt sensor, the UIS is also
switched OFF when the vehicle is locked
two times within ten seconds. This
allows the sensor to be switched OFF for
transportation purposes.
Convertible interior protection
(SDR)
In Convertible models, the interior motion
detector for the alarm system is a short
distance radar (SDR) detector located on
the center tunnel, under the center
console next to the parking brake
handle. The central position allows the
most effective monitoring of the vehicle
interior.
The SDR detector consists of two printed
circuit boards, one being the
transmitter/receiver and the other the
processing electronics. The module
housing is highly conductive material for
high frequency transmission.
The SDR sensor transmits an
electromagnetic field in a hemispherical
pattern within the vehicle interior. The
monitoring radius is preset in the
module. The receiving antenna monitors
reflected signals from the interior. The
module evaluates these signals as a
base line for vehicle security. Any
objects that come into this monitoring
radius will be detected and evaluated by
the SDR module.
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
The module operates in pulse mode.
The radar unit transmits a signal, then
pauses for the reflected signals to be
received by the module.
The detection range of the radar is
adjusted by rapid switching when the
system is armed. This allows the sensor
to adjust its range to either the
windshield with the top lowered or to the
soft top when it is raised.
The module will signal the GM V to
trigger the alarm if a new object is
detected within its sensing hemisphere.
However, false alarms may be triggered
by objects falling into the interior when
the system is armed with the top
lowered. Also, large metal objects, such
as the seat backrests, will shield the
microwave pulse and create a sensor
"shadow" effect in the interior.
As with the tilt sensor and the UIS, the
SDR sensor can be switched OFF by
activating the central locking system
twice within 10 seconds.
Alarm siren
The DWA siren is installed in the right
rear engine compartment. This location
provides a secure position with loud
acoustic output.
The siren contains electronic circuitry for
producing the warning tone when the
alarm is triggered. The siren also
contains a rechargeable battery that is
used to power the siren when the alarm
is triggered. The rechargeable battery
will allow the siren to sound if it or the
vehicle battery is disconnected. The
siren battery is recharged from the
vehicle battery when DWA is not in the
armed state.
The siren has four wires connecting it to
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
the alarm system:
KL 30 (power)
KL 31 (ground)
STDWA signal (arm/disarm signal
from GM V)
NG signal (activate siren output
signal to the GM V)
The arm/disarm output signal from the
GM V (STDWA) is provided to the tilt
sensor, UIS sensor and the siren
simultaneously. The arm/disarm signal is
a switched ground that signals the
components of DWA armed/disarmed
status.
The activate the siren, the NG signal is
high whether DWA is armed or
disarmed. If a monitored input activates
the alarm, the high signal to the siren is
switched to a 50% duty cycle at the GM
V. The control circuitry in the siren
activates the siren. If the DWA is armed
and the battery is disconnected, the
siren circuitry recognizes the normally
high NG signal as suddenly going low.
In this case the siren is also activated.
Panic mode operation
When the trunk button on an FZV key is
pressed and held, the GM V activates
the siren for the panic mode. The panic
mode is functional with either an armed
or disarmed DWA system.
Emergency disarming
Emergency disarming occurs
automatically if a key is used to turn the
ignition switch ON and EWS accepts it.
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Central Locking and Anti-Theft
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
The EWS signals the GM V to unlock the
doors and to deactivate the DWA.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:00 PM
Seats
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
520-1
General
This repair group covers removal and
installation of the front and rear seats.
Seat design and upholstery
The front seats installed in E46 cars
come in either manual or powered
versions. They offer firm support and
comfort. Their internal construction is
engineered to work together with the
vehicle suspension to absorb vibration.
The internal ventilation system of the
seats adds to the built-in comfort of
these seats.
Convertible front seats are unique to
those models in that they incorporate
the seat belts. This is called the Seat
Integrated Seatbelt (SGS) system.
Vinyl is the most common upholstery,
and leather is an available option. The
leather appears not only on the seats
but on the door panels and other areas
as well.
Front seatback nets are standard.
Seat adjustments
Regardless of level of trim, E46 seats
offer the following minimum
adjustments, with manual (photo) or
power controls (below):
Fore-aft position
Backrest angle
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Cushion height
Head restraints.
Seat memory system
In cars with seat memory, the driver's
front seat incorporates two control
modules: One in the seat adjusting
switch (arrow) and the second under
the seat cushion. The two modules
process the following:
Seat adjustments
Comfort entry aid switch (2-door
models)
Seat backrest lock microswitch
(2-door models)
Seat belt fastened
K-bus communication with the
General Module (GM V) and
instrument cluster
The driver seat module stores three
seat positions for recall. The
information is stored in non-volatile
memory, preventing loss of memory in
case of electrical power failure or
battery disconnection.
The seat adjusting switch block in the
driver's seat communicates with the
seat cushion control module over
dedicated lines. The output stages for
seat motor movement are in the seat
cushion control module. Seat positions
are recognized through the use of Hall
sensors in the motors. All components
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
of the seat memory system are
monitored for faults. Access the fault
codes using BMW scan tool DIS or
MoDiC.
In Coupe and Convertible models, the
easy entry feature facilitates access to
the rear seats. When a front backrest is
folded over, the entire seat moves
forward 90 mm (3.54 in.) to facilitate
rear entry. In models with seat memory,
the seat control module memorizes the
position of the seat and headrest when
the entry aid feature is activated. The
seat will return to its previous set
position when the entry aid button is
pressed rearward or the seat backrest
is locked.
The passenger's seat on four door
models uses a simplified control
system within the switch block and
does not include a memory module. No
on board diagnostics are incorporated
into the passenger seat on these
models.
Driver seat memory module
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Passenger seat memory module
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Rear seat configuration
Split rear folding seats are optional in
the Sedan and standard in the Sport
Wagon and Coupe. They are split 1/3
right to 2/3 left with a folding center
armrest in the left portion. The armrest,
when folded down, is equipped with a
storage compartment and cupholders.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
520-2
Front Seats
Seat removal and installation is similar
for all versions. Seat disassembly
differs in detail among the many
models of seats.
Seat repair and component
replacement is possible once the seat
has been removed from the vehicle.
Front seat, removing and
installing
WARNING!
The front seats are equipped
with pyrotechnic seat belt
tensioners. These tensioners are
powerful devices and should be
handled with extreme care.
Incorrect handling can trigger
off the tensioner and cause
injury.
BMW recommends that all repair
or replacement work on
pyrotechnic devices must be
carried out by a qualified BMW
technician.
Be sure to disconnect the
battery and wait 5 seconds
before attempting to work on
pyrotechnic devices.
Pyrotechnic devices cannot be
repaired. Always replace them.
Never treat pyrotechnic
components with cleaning
agents or grease.
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Do not expose pyrotechnic
components to temperatures
above 75°C (167°F).
Pyrotechnic components can
only be tested electrically when
installed, using BMW service
tester DIS, MoDiC or equivalent
scan tool.
Do not fire a pyrotechnic gas
generator prior to disposal. It
must be fired by a special
disposal company or shipped
back to BMW in the packaging
of the new components.
During body straightening and
welding with an electric arc
welder, always disconnect the
battery and the connection to
the pyrotechnic gas generators.
4-door models: raise seat and move to
its forward position. Working at base of
seat near doors, remove seat belt
mounting bolt (arrow).
-
Remove headrests (not
convertible).
Remove two mounting bolts (arrows)
at rear of seat rails.
-
Move seat to its rear most position,
keeping it raised.
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Remove plastic caps over front seat
mounting nuts, then remove mounting
nuts (arrows).
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Tilt seat back to access electrical
harness connectors. Slide lock to
release and disconnect. Cut or untwist
wire ties as necessary.
-
Remove seat from car. The
headrests may be removed to
provide additional clearance.
Note:
Use a blanket to protect door sill from
scuffing by seat rail during seat
removal.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Use wire ties or equivalent means
to keep seat harness wiring from
fraying.
Tightening torque
Front seat to floor
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Seat belt end to
seat
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:03 PM
Seats
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
520-3
Rear Seats
Rear seat cushion and
backrest, removing and
installing (fixed seat back
models)
-
Pull front of rear seat cushion up
to release clips. While holding
front of cushion up, pull cushion
forward to remove.
Remove rear seat backrest:
Pull top outer corners of backrest
forward (A) to detach from top
retainers.
Pull entire backrest up (B) to
detach from bottom hooks.
Slide backrest to side to clear seat
belts.
Note:
If the car is equipped with heated rear
seats, detach electrical harness
connector(s) as you remove the seat
components.
-
When reinstalling, be sure to pull
seat belts and buckles up through
appropriate slots in seat cushion.
Rear seat cushion and
backrest, removing and
installing (fold-down seat back
models)
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Seats
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Pull front of rear seat cushion up
and out of clips. While holding
front of cushion up, pull cushion
forward to remove.
-
Tilt backrests forward.
Note:
Remove rear headrests, if equipped, by
pulling straight up.
Remove backrest side section by
pulling out (A) and up (B).
-
Working between two sections of
backrest, remove backrest center
mount screws.
-
Remove outer backrest mounting
screws.
-
Raise backrests in middle slightly
and separate left and right
backrest guide. Lift backrest(s) out
through back door(s).
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
540-1
General
This repair group covers the slide-tilt
sunroof assembly.
Component locations, initialization,
sunroof panel replacement, and
sunroof height adjustment are covered.
Replacement of the cable assembly or
frame require that the headliner be
removed. Removal and repair of the
sunroof assembly and other
components inside the roof cavity is
beyond the scope of this manual.
Sunroof electronic controls,
initializing
Initialize the sunroof in the following
situations:
Malfunctions such as lack of
one-touch function, lack of comfort
opening/closing or lack of safety
(anti-trapping) features
If sunroof motor has been
removed and reinstalled
If power supply to the sunroof has
been interrupted
If repairs have been performed on
the slide/tilt mechanism
Normalization
During normalization the mechanical
end positions of the sunroof are
detected and stored by the General
Module (GM V).
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Press and hold sunroof switch in "lift"
direction.
After reaching end position, keep
switch pressed for approximately
20 seconds longer.
The sunroof motor will briefly jerk
upwards, signalling normalization
is complete.
Characteristic curve
The characteristic resistance curve of
the E46 sunroof is learned using
coding software. This resets the safety
(anti-trapping) feature. See your BMW
dealer service department.
Sunroof panel, emergency
closing
Remove access panel from below
sunroof motor by gently prying at the
rearmost edge with a plastic tool.
Disconnect the electrical connections
and lay switch panel aside.
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Insert hex key into drive in sunroof
motor, and turn hex key to manually
close sunroof.
Note:
The hex key for manually (emergency)
closing the sunroof can be found in the
tool kit located in the trunk lid (sedan,
coupe and convertible) or under the
cargo area floor panel (Sport Wagon).
Sunroof panel, adjusting
Note:
Be sure to check drains in front corners
of sunroof carrier if water is entering car
through headliner.
The sunroof is controlled by a set of
cables that move the sunroof panel
along guide rails when the motor is
operated. The sunroof can be adjusted
without removing it from the car.
The sunroof panel should be adjusted
under the following circumstances:
Sunroof misaligned with roof
Sunroof does not close squarely
Wind noise at high speeds
(sunroof closed)
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Sunroof has been removed
Whenever the top of the closed sunroof
becomes misaligned with the roof of
the car, if it does not close squarely, if
there are wind noises at speed, if there
are water leaks, or if the sunroof has
been removed.
Correct sunroof alignment:
Sunroof must be fully closed.
Gap must be even all around
edge of sunroof.
Note:
Use a credit card to measure the gap.
The card should insert through the gap
with equal resistance all around the
perimeter.
Front of sunroof must be flush to
1 mm (0.04 in.) below surface of
roof.
Rear of sunroof must be flush to 1
mm (0.04) above surface of roof.
-
To adjust sunroof height, shut
sunroof fully.
Slide sunroof liner back into roof cavity
until approx. 90 mm (3.5 in.) is
exposed.
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
The sunroof panel is retained by three
Torx screws (arrows) on each side. To
adjust sunroof height:
Loosen Torx screws until sunroof
can just be moved.
Push sunroof panel forward.
Push sunroof panel up or down
until correct height is achieved.
Tighten screws. Recheck height.
Check sunroof function.nothing
Sunroof height adjustment
specifications
Rear
flush/1 mm higher than
roof top
Front
flush/1 mm lower than roof
top
Tightening torque
Sunroof panel to
roof (Torx)
4.5 Nm (40 in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
540-2
Sunroof Components
Sunroof assembly removal and
installation involves headliner removal,
and is not covered in this manual. After
sunroof repairs be sure to follow
initialization and adjustment
procedures given earlier.
Sunroof assembly
1
- Torx bolt M5
2
- Slider
3
- Glass sunroof
panel
4
- Sunroof panel
gasket
5
- Velour ceiling
panel
6
- Synthetic strip
7
- Slider
8
- Gasket
9
- Wind deflector
10 - Deflector spring
11 - Sunroof motor
12 - Felt
13 - Frame gasket
14 - Sunroof frame
15 - Torx bolt M5
tighten to 3.5 Nm
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
(31 in-lb)
16 - Emergency
operation crank
handle
17 - Hex bolt with
washer
18 - Torx bolt M4
Sunroof panel, removing and
installing
To remove sunroof panel, open sunroof
and remove wind blocker by removing
Torx screw (arrow) on each side.
Close sunroof and slide sunroof liner
back into roof cavity until approximately
90 mm (3.5 in.) is exposed.
Remove three Torx screws (arrows) on
each side, and lift panel out.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Adjust sunroof height and gap as
described earlier.
Tightening torque
Wind blocker to
roof (Torx)
Sunroof panel to
roof (Torx)
1 Nm (9 in-lb)
4.5 Nm (40 in-lb)
Sunroof panel gasket, replacing
-
Remove sunroof panel as shown
above.
Pull old seal from panel.
Coat new seal and channel in
sunroof panel with soapy water.
Starting at back center of panel,
install new seal, taking care to not
pull seal too tightly around four
corners of panel.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Adjust sunroof height and gap as
shown earlier in this repair group.
Tightening torque
Wind blocker to
roof (Torx)
Sunroof panel to
roof (Torx)
1 Nm (9 in-lb)
4.5 Nm (40 in-lb)
Sunroof motor, replacing
Remove access panel from below
sunroof motor by gently prying at the
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Sunroof
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
rearmost edge with a plastic tool.
Remove sunroof motor mounting screws
(arrows).
-
Installation is the reverse of
removal. Perform intitialization
procedure as described earlier.
Tightening torque
Sunroof motor to
sunroof carrier
2.8 Nm (25 in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:04 PM
Convertible Top
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
541-1
General
This repair group covers the automatic
electro-hydraulic convertible top.
Information on the Rollover Protection
System is also included here.
Note:
The convertible top control module
(CVM II) is located behind the left
rear side trim panel. For the
location of other convertible top
electric components see
610
Electrical Component Locations.
The glass rear window in the
Convertible is not replaceable
separately.
Convertible top controls
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Convertible battery
BMW has designed a special battery tray
for the Convertible which serves to
dampen Convertible body flexing and
vibration.
CAUTION!
The E46 Convertible requires a special
battery which is designed for constant
vibration. A battery not designed for
this will fail much earlier.
Convertible top operation
The automatic E46 Convertible top
system completely opens and closes the
top using hydraulic cylinders and electric
motors.
The convertible top system features:
Convertible Top Module (CVM II)
with fault memory storage.
Electro-hydraulic operation
Convenience opening using FZV
(remote) key or door lock cylinder
Convenience closing using door
lock cylinder
Glass rear window
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Top monitoring during operation
using Hall sensors and angle Hall
sensors
Emergency operation
-
Manually unlock top storage cover:
Remove center arm rest.
Lift seat upholstery below ski bag.
Press button on motor assembly to
release motor from gear linkage.
Use hand crank (stored on
assembly cover) to turn linkage
assembly through access hole in
motor assembly cover.
Unlock top cover and open.
-
Switch off ignition. Hydraulic
pressure will be released in steps
after approximately 10 seconds until
all pressure is drained from
cylinders.
-
Manually raise or lower top. Use
handcrank to lock or unlock top at
windshield top frame.
Hydraulic fluid level, checking
or filling
Note:
Make sure top is lowered into storage
compartment and storage cover is
closed.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
-
Working in trunk, remove trunk trim
liner and soundproofing. If
necessary, partially remove
hydraulic unit to gain view of fill
plug and fluid reference mark
(circle). DO NOT detach hydraulic
lines.
To check:
Level must be between MAX and
MIN marks.
Reference mark is circle in
translucent reservoir.
-
To fill:
Detach hydraulic unit and pull out
without disconnecting fluid lines.
Lay unit on its side and fill through
fill plug.
Turn unit upright and recheck level.
Install new fill plug seal.
-
To drain:
Detach hydraulic unit and pull out
without disconnecting fluid lines.
Lay unit on its side and allow to
drain through fill plug.
Turn unit upright and recheck level.
Install new fill plug seal.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Convertible top fluid
Hydraulic fluid
Aral Vitamol
Tightening torques
Filler plug to
hydraulic unit
Hydraulic unit to
body
10 + 1 Nm
(89 + 9 in-lb)
10 Nm (89 in-lb)
Note:
The convertible top hydraulic fluid is
supplied in the spare parts kit. To restock
fluid, check with an authorized BMW
dealer parts department.
Convertible top switch
The convertible top switch assembly is in
the center console below the IHKA
control panel. Two push buttons, one for
each direction of travel, provide ground
input signals to the Convertible Top
Module (CVM II).
Two LEDs are positioned in the center of
the switch assembly. The top LED will
flash whenever the top is being operated
and not locked to the windshield or
stored completely in the storage
compartment. The lower LED will
illuminate if the top switch is pushed
(open top signal) and the storage
compartment floor is in the folded up
Top storage
position. See
compartment floor later in this group.
The top ceases moving once the switch
is released. The hydraulics hold the top
in position and remain under pressure
for approximately 20 minutes if the
ignition key is left in the ON position.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Convertible Top Module (CVM II)
The CVM II is installed in the left rear of
the car behind the side trim (next to the
seat). It contains the processing,
controlling and monitoring electronics for
top operation.
The CVM II communicates with the
General Module (GM V) over the K-bus
for operation of top storage cover and
windows.
The CVM II is fully self-diagnostic and is
capable of storing monitored faults.
Fault code access and diagnosis is
carried out over the K-bus with BMW
diagnostic scan tools DIS or MoDiC.
Convertible top electronic control module (CVM II)
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Fault memory storage
Convertible Top Module (CVM II) fault
memory is stored in NVRAM. Up to 16
fault codes can be stored in order of
occurrence. A distinction is made
between permanent and sporadic faults.
If a fault occurs during raising or
lowering the top, all top movement will
cease and a fault code will be stored in
memory. Then the emergency closing
procedure must be followed.
Depending on the location and type of
the fault, it may be possible to raise or
lower the top fully by pressing the switch
in the opposite direction.
If the top switch is held on more than 20
seconds after the top is completely
raised or lowered, a fault code will be
set. CVM II assumes a fault to ground in
the switch or electrical harness. The
ignition switch must then be cycled OFF
- ON to clear the fault before the top will
function again. The fault will remain in
memory until cleared with a scan tool
(DIS, MoDiC or equivalent).
All sequenced movements of the
convertible top have time-out limits
preset in CVM II. If a time-out occurs
before the end position is reached,
movement will be switched off to prevent
damage to any of the top components.
Note:
The temperature sensor in the
convertible top system signals CVM II to
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
cease operation if the hydraulic fluid
temperature exceeds 95°C (203°F).
However, any functions that have been
started will be completed before the
system is switched off. If the temperature
exceeds 105°C (221°F) the system is
immediately switched off. Close the top
using the emergency closing procedure.
Automatic operation can be resumed
when the fluid temperature drops below
95°C.
Comfort operation
Comfort closing of the top is possible by
using the key in the driver door lock
cylinder. Holding the key in the locking
position the will raise the top and close
the windows.
Comfort opening is possible from either
the driver door or remotely using the
FZV key.
Windshield frame lock
The windshield frame lock assembly
consists of the top lock motor positioned
in the center of the top frame and two
lock drive mechanisms positions on
either side of the top frame.
The lock motor and drive mechanism
unlock the top from the windshield and
raise the front of the top past the tension
point. Flexible drive shafts are used to
activate the lock assemblies and drive
the tension link rods.
Convertible top sensor operation
Three Hall sensors detect the position of
the top frame are located on the left lock
drive assembly. All three sensors receive
power and ground from CVM II.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Windshield lock sensor provides low
signal when top frame is unlocked from
windshield. LED in convertible top switch
will flash.
Tension point position sensor provides
high signal when top frame is raised
past tension point. The angle sensor
provides a linear voltage signal input to
CVM II (approx. 0.5 - 3.5 volts) as
tension bow moves from a vertical to a
horizontal position.
Main pillar Hall angle sensor is similar in
function and output to tension point
position sensor. It is mounted on left side
top linkage by left main pillar hydraulic
cylinder. The CVM uses input signal
from main pillar angle sensor for top
frame positioning.
Top storage compartment cover
Top storage compartment cover position
is detected and signalled to CVM II by a
Hall sensor on left side storage cover
hydraulic cylinder in trunk. The sensor
provides a high signal when storage
cover is fully open.
The CVM II uses this input as a
switching signal:
For activating tension bow solenoid
during top lowering
For activating main pillar solenoid
during top raising.
Top storage compartment cover
lock motor
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
The convertible top storage compartment
cover lock motor is on driveshaft tunnel
under rear seat. It consists of a motor
with Hall sensor, gear assembly and two
bowden cables connected to cover locks
on two sides of cover. The Hall sensor
detects locked/unlocked position of
cover.
During convertible top operation (raising
or lowering) CVM II signals General
Module (GM V) over K-bus to unlock
storage compartment. The lock motor
runs 180° to unlock cover latches. The
motor always turns in same direction to
lock or unlock.
Once motor has turned 180°, the Hall
sensor will signal GM V to switch off
motor. At the same time, GM V will
signal CVM II to continue top operation.
There are two storage compartment
cover lock Hall sensors, one mounted on
each storage cover latch. The switches
receive power and ground from CVM II.
Each switch input provides a high signal
when cover is unlocked and raised far
enough by cover hydraulic cylinders to
clear latches.
When cover is completely lowered by
hydraulic cylinders, the Hall sensors
send a signal to CVM II which signals
GM V to relock storage cover.
Top storage compartment floor
The trunk of the E46 Convertible offers
the variable convertible top storage
compartment floor. This feature allows
the luggage storage area to be enlarged
by approximately 40 liters (1.5 cu. ft.)
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
when soft top is raised or removed for
hard top installation.
The plastic variable compartment floor is
hinged at four point so that it can
articulate and be rotated up into top
storage space.
A lever on right side of variable floor
actuates and locks floor into position.
A dampening piston on right side
maintains position of variable floor. The
lower dampening piston hinge switches
a microswitch on right side of variable
floor when floor is in folded (raised)
position. This signal to CVM II locks out
operation of top.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
541-2
Convertible Top
Components
Mechanical top components
The metal folding frame of the top is
bolted to the sides of the car behind
the door pillars (B-pillars).
The three layer soft top consists of:
Fabric outer layer
Middle fleece liner
Inner liner
Refer to the accompanying illustration
for mechanical component locations.
Convertible top
mechanical
components
1
- Folding top
2
- Folding top
frame
3
- Base plate
4
- Windshield
frame lock
microswitch
5
- Windshield
frame lock drive
motor
6
- Windshield
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
frame cover
7
- Emergency
mechanism
cover
8
- Emergency
operation crank
9
- Tension rope
Insulation
10 - Tension bow
11 - Hall sensor
12 - Gas pressurized
spring
13 - Main pillar Hall
sensor
14 - Console
15 - Windshield
latch (left side)
Hydraulic system repairs
CAUTION!
When working on hydraulic
system, system must be at zero
pressure.
Disconnect supply and return
lines a with convertible top
stowed and in untensioned state.
Once hydraulic system has been
opened, a function test must be
carried out after work has been
completed.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Once hydraulic lines have been
disconnected from hydraulic
components, top must not be
moved. Fluid will leak from
separated coupling.
Avoid scratching hydraulic piston
rods. Even paint mist and welding
spots are harmful.
When working around hydraulic
cylinders, cover with a protective
cloth.
Working in the trunk at the convertible
top hydraulic unit, disconnect the supply
and return lines and connect them to
each other (short circuit). The system is
thus closed and the couplings are
protected against damage. The hydraulic
system cannot build up high pressure
and convertible top can be moved
manually.
Hydraulic system compontents and
electronics are shown in the
accompanying illustrations.
Terms and definitions used in diagnosing
and repairing the convertible top
hydraulic system are listed in
Table a.
Definition of hydraulic system terms.
Basic repair procedures for hydraulic
system repair are listed in
Table b.
Convertible top hydraulic system repair
procedures.
Convertible top
hydraulic components
1
- Tension bow
(rear of top)
hydraulic
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
cylinders:
Operate on top
frame linkage to
raise and lower bow
Located on two
sides of tension
bow, at sides of rear
window
Angle Hall sensor
on left tension bow
linkage detects bow
position
Hydraulic lines for
right tension bow
cylinder routed
under top fabric
along tension bow
2
- Main pillar
hydraulic
cylinders:
Actuate soft top
frame
Located on two
sides of top frame
linkage
Angle hall sensor
detects position of
main top linkage
Hydraulic lines for
right main pillar
cylinder routed
under top fabric
along tension bow
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
3
- Top storage
compartment
cover hydraulic
cylinders:
Open and close
storage
compartment cover
Located in trunk
Left cylinder
equipped with Hall
sensor to detect
fully opened
position of cover
4
- Solenoid valve
block on left
side of top
frame:
Solenoid V1
controls operation of
main pillar hydraulic
cylinder
Solenoid V2
controls tension
bow cylinders for
raising top
Solenoid V3
controls tension
bow cylinders for
lowering top
5
- Quick
disconnect in
trunk
6
- Hydraulic pump
unit:
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
In left side of trunk
behind trim
Mounted on rubber
bushings and
covered by sound
insulation
Unit consists of:
Hydraulic motor and
pump, Storage
cover solenoid
valve, Drain
solenoid valve,
Hydraulic fluid
reservoir, Hydraulic
fluid temperature
sensor
Operates at
pressures of up to
200 bar (2900
lb/in 2).
Convertible top hydraulic electronics
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Table a. Definition of hydraulic system terms
Term
Action
Notes
Hydraulic system at zero
pressure
Turn ignition to 0 position.
Wait 15 seconds.
Hydraulic system has no or
very low pressure.
Mechanical (emergency)
actuation
Open or close top by hand.
See
Closed system
All hydraulic lines connected.
Even short-circuiting of lines
is possible.
Function test
Open and close top several
times (min. 3 times).
Check hydraulic unit fluid
level and top up if necessary.
Refer to Operating
Instructions.
Short circuit
Unfasten quick release
coupling.
Connect supply and return
lines to each other.
Hydraulic system cannot
build up pressure.
Convertible top can be
moved.
Untensioned state
Emergency operation
Table b. Convertible top hydraulic system repair procedures
Operation
Mechanical (manual)
operation of top
Procedures
Ignition must be turned off
Hydraulic lines must be disconnected. (Reconnect
when finished)
After repeated actuation, system fluid is pumped into
supply tank of hydraulic unit. If hydraulic components
are replaced, there will be too much fluid in system.
Fluid level check
Stow convertible top and close storage compartment
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
Operation
Procedures
lid.
Fluid topping up or draining
Follow directions in
Hydraulic fluid level, checking or
filling, earlier in this group.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
541-3
Rollover Protection
System
Two spring-loaded rollbar cassettes are
mounted behind the rear seat. The
cassettes are bolted into the reinforced
carrier behind the seat backs. When
retracted they are covered by the rear
headrest which incorporates a flap at
the back, that will open when the
rollbars deploy.
A rollover sensor, mounted in the rear
behind the left rear seat back on the
rollbar cassette, contains the
electronics for rollover detection and
deployment final stage for triggering
the rollover bar solenoids. Two
capacitors are installed for rollbar
deployment in case of a power failure
during a crash.
The rollover sensor performs a
self-check every time the ignition is
switched on. The sensor is connected
to the diagnostic link (DLC) for
troubleshooting purposes.
If faults are detected, the warning lamp
in the instrument cluster will light up. In
case of a crash, the system will attempt
to trigger the rollover cassettes to
deploy even if a fault code is stored in
fault memory.
Note:
Diagnosis of convertible top and
Rollover Protection System are beyond
scope of this book. Your authorized
BMW dealer has proper diagnostic
equipment and tools to carry out these
tasks.
After deployment, the detent pawl in a
rollover protection cassette can be
retracted by pulling the reset lever
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Convertible Top
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/5...
forward so that rollbar can be pushed
down and locked into the solenoids.
WARNING!
Ensure that area above and adjacent
to rollover bars remains clear and
unobstructed at all times.
CAUTION!
It is not possible to close
convertible top with rollover
bars extended.
If a hardtop is mounted, be sure
to install the protective rollover
bar covers provided with
hardtop to prevent damaging
rear window in case of
deployment.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:05 PM
Electrical System - General
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
600-1
General
A brief description of the principal parts
of the electrical system is presented
here. Also covered here are basic
electrical system troubleshooting tips.
See also
Starter.
121 Battery, Alternator,
Electrical test equipment
Many electrical tests described in this
manual call for measuring voltage,
current, or resistance using a digital
multimeter. Digital meters are preferred
for precise measurements and for
electronics work because they are
generally more accurate than analog
meters. An analog meter (swingneedle) may draw enough current to
damage sensitive electronic
components.
An LED test light is a safe, inexpensive
tool that can be used to perform many
simple electrical tests that would
otherwise require a digital multimeter.
The LED indicates when voltage is
present between any two test-points in
a circuit.
The integrated safety, comfort, security
and handling systems on E46 cars are
designed with self-diagnostic
capabilities. The quickest way to
diagnose many problems is to start out
with a scan tool read out of Diagnostic
OBD
Trouble Codes (DTCs). See
On Board Diagnostics at rear of
manual.
Special Tools
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Automotive digital multimeter Fluke 87
LED tester with thin spade probes
Baum 1115 (Source: Baum Tools
Unlimited)
Scan tools BMW DIS/MoDiC
Aftermarket scan tool Baum CS2000
(Source: Baum Tools Unlimited)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
1 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
600-2
E46 Electrical System
E46 cars are electrically complex. Many
vehicle systems and subsystems are
interconnected or integrated. In
addition, the requirements of second
generation On-Board Diagnostics (OBD
II) are such that there are now many
more circuits and wires in the vehicle
than ever before. The components
must exchange large volumes of data
with one another in order to perform
their various functions.
The use of dedicated data lines for
each link in the system has reached
the limits of its capabilities. On the one
hand, wiring harnesses now must be
so complex that they become
unmanageable. In addition, the finite
number of pins on conventional
connectors becomes a limiting factor in
electronic control module development.
The solution has been found in the use
of specialized, vehicle compatible serial
bus systems. The E46 bus system is
Table a.
summarized in
Table a. E46 busses
Bus
Circuits covered
K-bus
Driver information
systems (instrument
cluster, Check Control,
on-board computer)
Central Body
Electronics (ZKE V)
General Module (GM
V)
Seat memory (SM)
Sunroof (SHD)
Rain sensor (AIC)
Telephone and sound
system
Headlight module
(LSZ)
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
2 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table a. E46 busses
Bus
Circuits covered
Coded anti-theft (EWS
III) and anti-theft (DWA)
Remote entry (FZV)
Park distance control
(PDC)
M-bus
Heating and air
conditioning (IHKA)
components
CAN-bus
Engine management
system (DME)
Transmission control
(AGS)
Antilock brakes (ABS)
Traction control (ASC)
Dynamic stability
control (DSC)
D-bus
Data link connector
(DLC)
OBD II connector
Multiple restraint
system (MRS II)
1999 E46 bus system, diagram
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
3 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Voltage and polarity
The vehicle electrical system is a 12-volt
direct current (DC) negative-ground
system. A voltage regulator controls
system voltage at approximately 12-volts.
All circuits are grounded by direct or
indirect connection to the negative (-)
terminal of the battery. A number of
ground connections throughout the car
connect the wiring harness to chassis
ground. These circuits are completed by
the battery cable or ground strap
between the body and the battery
negative (-) terminal.
Wiring, fuses and relays
Electrical components connect using
one of the following:
Heavy cables with lug-type
connectors (battery and starter)
Electrical harnesses with keyed,
push-on connectors that lock into
place
Busses with modular connectors
With the exception of the starter and the
charging system, most electrical power
is routed from the ignition switch or the
battery through the main relay panel in
back of the glove compartment or the
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
4 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
main fuse box (arrow) above the glove
compartment. Fuses are color coded to
indicate current capacities.
The relays and control modules are
mounted in various places throughout
the vehicle. See
610 Electrical
Component Locations.
Central Body Electronics (ZKE
V)
E46 vehicles are equipped with an
integrated complex of electronic modules
connected mostly via K-bus. This
system, called ZKE V, is primarily
controlled by the General Module (GM
V).
These functions are controlled directly
by the GM V:
Windshield wiper/washer system,
with optional Rain Sensor Interface.
See
611 Wipers and Washers.
Central locking, power trunk
release, keyless entry (FZV). See
515 Central Locking and Anti-theft.
Power window control. See
Door Windows.
512
Car Memory/Key Memory. See
515 Central Locking and Anti-theft.
Interior lighting. See
Switches.
612
Alarm system (DWA). See
515
Central Locking and Anti-theft.
Electronic consumer sleep mode,
described later in this section
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
5 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Other functions are not directly
controlled by the GM V but
interconnected:
Rain sensor (AIC). See
Wipers and Washers.
611
Sunroof operation (SHD). See
540 Sunroof.
Seat memory (SM) and electrical
operation. See
520 Seats.
Outside rear-view mirror control and
heating. See
510 Exterior Trim,
Bumpers.
Windshield washer jet heating. See
611 Wipers and Washers.
Redundant data storage
The following vehicle information is
stored redundantly in the instrument
cluster and the light switch module:
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
Total mileage
Service interval data
This redundancy means that the
instrument cluster or light module may
be replaced without loss of stored data.
The data between the two units is
compared each time the ignition is
switched on (KL 15 on). If the data does
not match the tamper warning dot
(arrow) in the mileage display will be
illuminated. Under certain circumstances
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
6 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
a fault code (DTC) will be set.
Resetting and resynchronizing of codes
and data requires the use of BMW scan
tools DIS or MoDiC.
Car Memory/Key Memory
A number of features and functions can
be customized to the driver(s)
preference. The identity of the vehicle
user is provided by a signal from the
keyless entry system (FZV).
Car Memory and Key Memory are
actually two separate functions,
although they are marketed as a
combined feature. See
515 Central
Locking and Anti-theft for further details.
Electrical consumer sleep mode
Central body electronics (ZKE V) is
designed to bring the vehicle electrical
consumers into "sleep mode" after 16
minutes of inactivity.
In order to test sleep mode:
Switch ignition off.
Close all doors, trunk and hood.
Lock vehicle using central locking.
Wait 16 minutes.
If one of a number of inputs into the
General Module (GM V) is activated
before the vehicle is in sleep mode, the
16 minute cycle starts again. Once the
vehicle is in sleep mode, the GM V will
"wake up" if it receives a change of
signal from one of the following sensors:
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
7 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
K-bus
Door jamb sensors
Trunk lid lock cylinder microswitch
Interior trunk lid release
push-button microswitch
Central locking button
Engine hood latch microswitch
Trunk key position switch
Interior light switch
Internal motion sensor
Tilt sensor
Driver's door lock sensors
Note:
If an interior light is accidentally left on,
the GM V will override the signal from it
after 16 minutes and implement sleep
mode.
Electrical system safety
precautions
Please read the warnings and cautions
in this section before doing any work on
your electrical system.
WARNING!
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
8 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
An airbag unit houses an
explosive powerful charge.
Making repairs without the proper
knowledge and special test
equipment may cause serious
personal injury. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
The ignition system of the car
operates at lethal voltages.
People with pacemakers or weak
hearts should not expose
themselves to the ignition system
electric currents. Extra caution
must be taken when working on
the ignition system or when
servicing the engine while it is
running or the key is on. See
120 Ignition System for
additional ignition system
warnings and cautions.
Keep hands, clothing and other
objects clear of the electric
radiator cooling fan when
working on a warm engine. The
fan may start at any time, even
when the ignition is switched off.
CAUTION!
Always turn off the engine and
disconnect the negative (-) cable
from the battery before removing
any electrical components.
Disconnecting the battery may
erase fault code(s) stored in
control module memory. Check
for fault codes using special BMW
diagnostic equipment.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
9 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Connect and disconnect ignition
system wires, multiple
connectors and ignition test
equipment leads only while the
ignition is off.
Do not disconnect the battery
with the engine running.
Do not quick-charge the battery
(for boost starting) for longer than
one minute, and do not exceed
16.5 volts at the battery with the
boosting cables attached. Wait at
least one minute before boosting
the battery a second time.
Do not use an analog meter. Use
only a digital multimeter.
Many of the solid-state modules
are static sensitive. Static
discharge will permanently
damage them. Always handle the
modules using proper static
prevention equipment and
techniques.
To avoid damaging harness
connectors or relay panel
sockets, use jumper wires with
flat-blade connectors that are the
same size as the connector or
relay terminals.
Always switch a digital
multimeter to the appropriate
function and range before making
test connections.
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
10 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Do not try to start the engine of a
car which has been heated above
176F/80C, (for example, in a paint
drying booth). Allow it to cool to
normal temperature.
Disconnect the battery before
doing any electric welding on the
car.
Do not wash the engine while it is
running, or anytime the ignition is
switched on.
Choose test equipment carefully.
Use a digital multimeter with at
least 10 megaohm input
impedance, or an LED test light.
An analog meter (swing-needle)
or a test light with a normal
incandescent bulb may draw
enough current to damage
sensitive electronic components.
An ohmmeter must not be used to
measure resistance on solid state
components such as control units
or time delay relays.
Always disconnect the battery
before making resistance (ohm)
measurements on the circuit.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:07 PM
Electrical System - General
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
600-3
Wiring Diagrams
The wiring diagrams shown in
Electrical Wiring Diagrams have been
specially designed to enable quick and
efficient diagnosis and troubleshooting
of electrical malfunctions.
Wiring codes and
abbreviations
A lot of information is included in each
wiring diagram if you know how to read
them. Wire colors in the diagrams are
abbreviated. Combined color codes
indicate a multi-colored wire. For
example the code BLU/RED indicates a
blue wire with a red stripe.
Many electrical components,
connectors, fuses, and ground
locations are identified using a unique
number. Each of these numbers
corresponds to a particular part in the
circuit commonly found in Electrical
Wiring Diagrams.
Note:
Sometimes the color of an installed
wire may be different than the one on
the wiring diagram. Don't be concerned.
Just be sure to confirm that the wire
connects to the proper terminals.
Table b. Wire color codes
German
code
English
code
Color
SW
BLK
Black
BL
BLU
Blue
BR
BRN
Brown
GN
GRN
Green
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table b. Wire color codes
German
code
English
code
Color
GR
GRY
Grey
ORG
Orange
RT
RED
Red
VI
VIO
Violet
WS
WHT
White
GE
YEL
Yellow
Most terminals are identified by
numbers on components and harness
connectors. Terminal numbers for
major electrical connections are shown
in the diagrams. Though many terminal
numbers appear only once, several
other numbers appear in numerous
places throughout the electrical system
and identify certain types of circuits.
Some common circuit numbers are
Table c.
listed below in
Table c. Terminal and circuit
numbers
Number
Circuit description
1
Low voltage switched
terminal of coil
4
High voltage center
terminal of coil
+X
Originates at ignition
switch. Supplies power
when the ignition
switch is in the PARK,
RUN, or START
position
15
Originates at ignition
switch. Supplies power
when ignition switch is
in RUN or START
position
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table c. Terminal and circuit
numbers
Number
Circuit description
30
Battery positive (+)
voltage. Supplies
power whenever
battery is connected.
(Not dependent on
ignition switch position,
unfused)
31
Ground, battery
negative (-) terminal
50
Supplies power from
battery to starter
solenoid when ignition
switch is in START
position only
+54
Originates at ignition
switch. Supplies power
when ignition switch is
in the RUN position
only
85
Ground side (-) of relay
coil
86
Power-in side (+) of
relay coil
87
Relay actuated contact
D
Alternator warning light
and field energizing
circuit
Additional abbreviations shown in the
wiring diagrams are given below.
Table d. Common E46 abbreviation
Abbreviation
Component or system
Abbreviation
Component or system
ABS
antilock brakes
KL 50
ignition switch start position
A/C
air conditioning
LDP
fuel tank leak diagnosis
pump (DME MS 42.0)
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Abbreviation
Component or system
Abbreviation
Component or system
ADB, ADB-X
automatic differential lock
LEV
low emission vehicle
AGS
adaptive transmission control LSZ
light switch module
AIC
rain sensor
MAF
mass air flow sensor
ASC
traction control
MBC
maximum braking control
AUC
automatic air recirculation
MFL
multifunction steering wheel
BST
Battery safety terminal
MRS
multiple restraint system
CAN
Controller Area Network
(BUS)
NLEV
national low emission
vehicle program
CBC
cornering brake control
NTC
negative temperature
coefficient resistor
DBC
dynamic brake control
OBC
on board computer
DK
throttle valve
OBD II
second generation on-board
diagnostics
DLC
diagnostic link connector
ORVR
on-board refueling vapor
recovery
DME
digital motor electronics
PDC
park distance control
(optional)
DMTL
diagnosis module-tank
leakage (DME MS 43.0)
PWG
pedal position sensor
DSC III
dynamic stability control
RAM
random access memory
DTC
diagnostic trouble code
RDC
tire pressure control
(optional)
DWA
anti-theft alarm system
RPS
rollover protection system
E-box
electronics box under engine RXD
hood
receive data line
ECM
engine control module
SBE
front passenger seat sensor
EGS
electronic transmission
control
SGS
seat integrated belt system
EPROM
erasable/programmable
read-only memory
SHD
sunroof module
EWS
electronic immobilizer
SII
service interval indicator
FZV
keyless entry
SM
seat memory module
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Abbreviation
Component or system
Abbreviation
Component or system
GM
general module (see ZKE)
SRS
supplemental restraint
system-airbag
HPS
head protection system
TCM
transmission control module
IHKA
automatic heating and air
conditioning system
TDC
top dead center
IHKR
manual heating and air
conditioning system
TLEV
transitional low emissions
vehicle
ITS
head protection system
TXD
transmit data line
KL 15
battery positive, ignition
switch on "run"
UIS
ultrasonic interior protection
KL 30
battery positive "hot" all the
time
ULEV
ultra low emissions vehicle
KL 31
battery/chassis ground
ZKE
central body electronics
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
600-4
Electrical
Troubleshooting
Four things are required for current to
flow in any electrical circuit: a voltage
source, wires or connections to
transport the voltage, a load or device
that uses the electricity, and a
connection to ground.
Most problems can be found using a
digital multimeter (volt/ohm/amp meter)
to check the following:
Voltage supply
Breaks in the wiring (infinite
resistance/no continuity)
A path to ground that completes
the circuit.
Electric current is logical in its flow,
always moving from the voltage source
toward ground. Electrical faults can
usually be located through a process
of elimination. When troubleshooting a
complex circuit, separate the circuit into
smaller parts. General tests outlined
below may be helpful in finding
electrical problems. The information is
most helpful when used with wiring
diagrams.
Be sure to analyze the problem. Use
wiring diagrams to determine the most
likely cause. Get an understanding of
how the circuit works by following the
circuit from ground back to the power
source.
When making test connections at
connectors and components, use care
to avoid spreading or damaging the
connectors or terminals. Some tests
may require jumper wires to bypass
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
components or connections in the
wiring harness. When connecting
jumper wires, use blade connectors at
the wire ends that match the size of the
terminal being tested. The small
internal contacts are easily spread
apart, and this can cause intermittent
or faulty connections that can lead to
more problems.
Voltage and voltage drops
Wires, connectors, and switches that
carry current are designed with very
low resistance so that current flows
with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop is caused by higher than
normal resistance in a circuit. This
additional resistance actually
decreases or stops the flow of current.
A voltage drop can be noticed by
problems ranging from dim headlights
to sluggish wipers. Some common
sources of voltage drops are corroded
or dirty switches, dirty or corroded
connections or contacts, and loose or
corroded ground wires and ground
connections.
A voltage drop test is a good test to
make if current is flowing through the
circuit, but the circuit is not operating
correctly. A voltage drop test will help
to pinpoint a corroded ground strap or
a faulty switch. Normally, there should
be less than 1 volt drop across most
wires or closed switches. A voltage
drop across a connector or short cable
should not exceed 0.5 volts.
Note:
A voltage drop test is generally
more accurate than a simple
resistance check because the
resistances involved are often too
small to measure with most
ohmmeters. For example, a
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
resistance as small as 0.02 ohms
would results in a 3 volt drop in a
typical 150 amp starter circuit.
(150 amps x 0.02 ohms =3 volts).
Keep in mind that voltage with the
key on and voltage with the engine
running are not the same. With the
ignition on and the engine off
(battery voltage), voltage should
be approximately 12.6 volts. With
the engine running (charging
voltage), voltage should be
approximately 14.0 volts. Measure
voltage at the battery with the
ignition on and then with the
engine running to get exact
measurements.
Voltage, measuring
Connect digital multimeter negative
lead to a reliable ground point on car.
Note:
The negative (-) battery terminal is
always a good ground point.
-
Connect digital multimeter positive
lead to point in circuit you wish to
measure.
If a reading is obtained, current is
flowing through circuit.
Note:
The voltage reading should not deviate
more than 1 volt from voltage at the
battery. If voltage drop is more than
this, check for a corroded connector or
loose ground wire.
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Voltage drop, testing
Voltage drop can only be checked
when there is a load on the circuit,
such as when operating the starter
motor or turning on the headlights. A
digital multimeter should be used to
ensure accurate readings.
Connect digital multimeter positive lead
to positive (+) battery terminal or a
positive power supply close to battery
source.
-
Connect digital multimeter
negative lead to other end of cable
or switch being tested.
-
With power on and circuit working,
meter shows voltage drop
(difference between two points).
This value should not exceed 1
volt.
Note:
The maximum voltage drop in an
automotive circuit, as recommended by
the Society of Automotive Engineers
(SAE), is as follows: 0 volts for small
wire connections; 0.1 Volts for high
current connections; 0.2 volts for high
current cables; and 0.3 volts for switch
or solenoid contacts. On longer wires or
cables, the drop may be slightly higher.
In any case, a voltage drop of more
than 1.0 volt usually indicates a
problem.
Continuity, checking
Continuity tests can be used to check a
circuit or switch. Because most
automotive circuits are designed to
have little or no resistance, a circuit or
part of a circuit can be easily checked
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
for faults using an ohmmeter. An open
circuit or a circuit with high resistance
will not allow current to flow. A circuit
with little or no resistance allows
current to flow easily.
When checking continuity, the ignition
should be off. On circuits that are
powered at all times, the battery should
be disconnected. Using the appropriate
wiring diagram, a circuit can be easily
tested for faulty connections, wires,
switches, relays and engine sensors by
checking for continuity.
For example, to test brake light switch
for continuity:
With brake pedal in rest position
(switch open) there is no
continuity (infinite ).
With pedal depressed (switch
closed) there is continuity (0 ).
Short circuits
Short circuits are exactly what the
name implies. The circuit takes a
shorter path than it was designed to
take. The most common short that
causes problems is a short to ground
where the insulation on a positive (+)
wire wears away and the metal wire is
exposed. When the wire rubs against a
metal part of the car or other ground
source, the circuit is shorted to ground.
If the exposed wire is live (positive
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
battery voltage), a fuse will blow and
the circuit may possibly be damaged.
Shorts to ground can be located with a
digital multimeter. Short circuits are
often difficult to locate and may vary in
nature. Short circuits can be found
using a logical approach based on
current path.
CAUTION!
On circuits protected with high
rating fuses (25 amp and
greater), wires or circuit
components may be damaged
before the fuse blows. Always
check for damage before
replacing fuses of this rating.
When replacing blown fuses,
use only fuses having the
correct rating. Always confirm
the correct fuse rating printed
on the fuse/relay panel cover.
Short circuit, testing with
ohmmeter
-
Remove blown fuse from circuit
and disconnect cables from
battery. Disconnect harness
connector from circuit load or
consumer.
Using an ohmmeter, connect one test
lead to load side of fuse terminal
(terminal leading to circuit) and the
other test lead to ground.
-
If there is continuity to ground,
there is a short to ground.
-
If there is no continuity, work from
wire harness nearest to fuse/relay
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
panel and move or wiggle wires
while observing meter. Continue to
move down harness until meter
displays a reading. This is the
location of short to ground.
-
Visually inspect wire harness at
this point for any faults. If no faults
are visible, carefully slice open
harness cover or wire insulation
for further inspection. Repair any
faults found.
Short circuit, testing with
voltmeter
-
Remove blown fuse from circuit.
Disconnect harness connector
from circuit load or consumer.
Note:
Most fuses power more than one
consumer. Be sure all consumers are
disconnected when checking for a short
circuit.
Using a digital multimeter, connect test
leads across fuse terminals. Make sure
power is present in circuit. If necessary
turn key on.
-
If voltage is present at voltmeter,
there is a short to ground.
-
If voltage is not present, work from
wire harness nearest to fuse/relay
panel and move or wiggle wires
while observing meter. Continue to
move down harness until meter
displays a reading. This is the
location of short to ground.
-
Visually inspect wire harness at
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical System - General
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
this point for any faults. If no faults
are visible, carefully slice open
harness cover or wire insulation
for further inspection. Repair any
faults found.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical Component Locations
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
610-1
General
This repair group covers fuse, relay
and control module location
information. Ground points and other
component locations are also covered,
primarily via photos or illustrations.
For additional E46 electrical system
information, see:
600 Electrical System–
General.
Electrical Wiring Diagrams
Fuses, relays and control
modules
The complex nature of E46 electrical
systems requires a very large number
of fuses and electrical components.
Locating this array of equipment is
always an important first step in any
kind of electrical diagnosis.
Investigating and correcting ground
problems often clears mysterious and
difficult to trace electrical problem. This
repair group covers the major ground
locations on the vehicle.
Keep in mind that electrical equipment
and accessories installed vary
depending on model and model year.
Always confirm that the proper
electrical component has been
identified by using the electrical wiring
diagrams at the back of this manual.
Electrical system safety
precautions
Please read the following warnings and
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical Component Locations
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
cautions before doing any work on your
electrical system.
WARNING!
The battery safety terminal,
pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners, and
airbags utilize explosive devices and
must be handled with extreme care.
Refer to the warnings and cautions
in
121 Battery, Alternator, Starter;
720 Seat Belts; and
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
Relay and fuse positions are
subject to change and may vary
from car to car. If questions
arise, an authorized BMW dealer
is the best source for the most
accurate and up-to-date
information.
A good way to verify a relay
position is to compare the
wiring colors at the relay socket
to the colors indicated on the
wiring diagrams located at the
rear of this manual.
Always switch the ignition off
and remove the negative (-)
battery cable before removing
any electrical components.
Connect and disconnect ignition
system wires, multiple
connectors, and ignition test
equipment leads only while the
ignition is switched off.
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical Component Locations
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Only use a digital multimeter for
electrical tests.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:08 PM
Electrical Component Locations
1 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
610-2
Fuse Positions
There are three locations for fuses in
E46 cars:
Main harness fuse in trunk
Fuse panel above glove
compartment
E-box in engine compartment left
side
Note:
In BMW repair information, fuses
are numbered F1 through F108.
There are two fuses with the same
designation: F5 in the main fuse
panel is rated 5A and protects the
horn circuit. F5 in the E-box fuse
carrier is rated 30A and protects
the unloader relay circuit in 1999 2000 models, and fuel injector
relay in 2001 models.
In a few cases, a fuse may have
two different amperage ratings
depending on equipment in the
vehicle. In such cases the second
rating is put in parenthesis in the
fuse rating tables.
Main harness fuse
Fig. 1 Main harness fuse in trunk:
Working ahead of battery in trunk,
remove trim liner clips.
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
2 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Peel back liner to access F108
(200 amp) fuse (arrow) in main
power distribution circuit.
Electronics box (E-box) fuse
carrier
Fig. 2 Engine electronics fuse pack in
E-box:
Working in left rear of engine
compartment, remove E-box
plastic cover.
Push on hold-down lock clip (A) to
release fuse pack carrier.
Pull up on fuse pack lock clip (B)
to release fuse pack.
To remove an individual defective fuse
inside fuse pack carrier, slide cover off
by prying gently while you use pin tool
to squeeze lock tabs. nothing
CAUTION!
Once cover is off, fuses can fall out
easily. Be sure to keep them in order
while replacing defective fuse.
Table a. E-box fuse pack
Fuse
1
Rating
30A
Protected
circuits
Not used (1999 2000 models)
DME main relay
(2001 models)
Ignition coils
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
3 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table a. E-box fuse pack
Fuse
Rating
Protected
circuits
(2001 models)
2
30A
DME control
module (ECM)
Evaporative
emissions valve
Fuel injectors
Idle speed control
valve
Resonance valve,
intake manifold
Secondary air
injection pump
Suction jet pump
valve, LDP system
Vanos solenoids
3
20A
A/C compressor
clutch relay
Camshaft position
sensors
Crankshaft
position sensor
DME main relay
Fuel pump relay
Leakage
diagnosis pump
(fuel tank)
Mass air flow
sensor
Secondary air
injection pump
relay
Thermostat
4
30A
Changeover
valve, running
losses (3/2 valve)
Oxygen sensors
5
30A
Fuel injector relay
(2001 models)
Unloader relay to
ignition coils
(1999 - 2000
models)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
4 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Main fuse panel
Fig. 3 Fuse panel above glove
compartment:
Open glove compartment door.
Working inside compartment, twist
each plastic lock tab (arrows) at
top of compartment 90°.
Pull down on fuse panel to swing
it down.
Note:
When the fuse box is up in locked
position, the plastic tabs should
point toward each other. When
unlocked, they point to the back of
the car.
A small built in flashlight (A) is in
the glove compartment next to the
fuse box.
A red plastic fuse puller (B) is in
the center of the fuse box.
The sheet of paper with the fuse
assignments, below the fuses, can
be slid out for reference.
Vertical fuses are active.
Horizontal fuses are spares.
Fuse locations in the main panel are
detailed in
Table c. 1999 fuse
positions and
Table d. 2000-2001
fuse positions.
Additional high amperage fuses are
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
5 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
found on top of the glove compartment
fuse panel beneath an access panel.
Lower glove compartment fuse panel
fully.
Slide harness connector block off
top of panel (curved arrow).
Detach access panel by
squeezing retaining clips
(arrows).
Fig. 4 High amperage fuses above
main fuse panel:
Fuses F101 through F107 are
mounted in this location.
Table b. High amperage fuse
positions
Fuse
Rating
Protected
circuits
101
50A
Engine cooling
fan (1999 - 2000
models)
102
80A
B+ terminal
DME mail relay
Engine control
module
Fuse 5 E-box fuse
pack
Transmission
control module
(TCM)
103
80A
not used
104
100A
Preheater relay
105
50A
Ignition switch
DLC
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
6 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table b. High amperage fuse
positions
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuits
106
50A
Light switching
center control
module
107
50A
Light switching
center control
module
Trailer module
108
200A
Main harness fuse
(in trunk, see
Fig. 1)
E46 main fuse panel
Table c. 1999 fuse positions
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
1
2
not used
3
4
5
5A
Horn (see also fuse 55)
6
5A
Make-up mirror light
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
7 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
7
5A
Navigation (see also fuse 41)
On-board monitor (see also fuse 41)
Radio (see also fuse 41)
Telephone (see also fuse 39)
8
not used
9
5A
Brake light
Light module (see also fuse 32)
On-board computer
Speed control
10
5A
Instrument cluster (see also fuses 34, 43)
11
5A
Airbag
Side-impact airbag
12
7.5A
Roller sun blind
13
not used
14
5A
Electronic immobilizer (EWS) (see also fuse 67)
Starter interlock
15
5A
Rain sensor
16
17
18
19
not used
20
21
22
23
24
5A
Electrochromic rear view mirror (see also fuse
67)
Parking distance control
25
5A
Heated outside mirror, passenger
Heated spray nozzles
26
5A
Garage door opener
Overheat JP
27
10A
Back-up lights
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
8 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
28
5A
Heater-A/C (see also fuses 62, 63)
Heater-A/C blower (see also fuse 37)
29
5A
Engine control (see also fuse 30)
30
7.5A
Engine control (see also fuse 29)
OBD II system
31
5A
Outside mirror
Tire pressure control (see also fuse 69)
32
5A
Light module (see also fuse 9)
33
5A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 53, 56)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 40, 53, 56, 61)
34
5A
Instrument cluster (see also fuses 10, 43)
35
not used
36
50A
Secondary air pump
37
50A
Heater-A/C blower (see also fuse 28)
38
10A (15A)
Front fog lights
39
5A
Telephone (see also fuse 7)
40
5A
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 33, 53, 56, 61)
Shift gate illumination
41
30A
Navigation (see also fuse 7)
On-board monitor (see also fuse 7)
Radio (see also fuse 7)
42
not used
43
5A
Clock
Instrument cluster (see also fuses 10, 34)
OBD II system
44
20A
Trailer module
45
not used
46
30A
Sunroof
47
15A (20A)
Cigarette lighter / power outlet
48
30A
Window, front (see also fuse 49)
49
5A
Anti-theft (see also fuse 67)
Central locking system (see also fuse 60)
Interior light (see also fuse 52)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
9 of 14
Fuse
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Rating
Protected circuit
Power window, front (see also fuse 48)
Windshield washer system (see also fuses 52,
59)
50
25A
Seat heating
51
30A
Headlight cleaning system
52
30A
Central locking system, trunk
Glove box light
Interior light (see also fuse 49)
Passenger compartment/trunk lighting
Windshield washer system (see also fuses 49,
59)
53
30A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 33, 56)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 33, 40, 56, 61)
54
15A
Fuel pump
55
15A
Horn (see also fuse 5)
56
30A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 33, 53)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 33, 40, 53, 61)
57
5A
Outside mirror
58
not used
59
30A
Windshield washer system (see also fuses 49,
52)
60
25A
Central locking (see also fuse 49)
61
30A
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 33, 40, 53, 56)
62
7.5A
A/C (see also fuses 28, 63)
63
7.5A
A/C (see also fuses 28, 62)
64
20A
Auxiliary heater (diesel)
65
30A
Driver seat adjustment
66
not used
67
5A
Anti-theft (see also fuse 49)
Electrochromic rear view mirror (see also fuse
24)
Electronic immobilizer (EWS) (see also fuse 14)
68
30A
Heated rear window
69
5A
Tire pressure control (see also fuse 31)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
10 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
70
30A
Passenger seat adjustment
71
30A
(10A Coupe)
Hinged window (Coupe)
Window, rear
Table d. 2000-2001 fuse positions
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
1
2
not used
3
4
5
5A
Horn (see also fuse 55)
6
5A
Make-up mirror light
Power top (Convertible, see also fuses 12, 35,
42, 46)
7
5A
Heated rear window (Convertible, see also fuse
68)
Navigation system (see also fuse 41)
On-board monitor (see also fuse 41)
Radio (see also fuse 41)
Telephone (see also fuse 39)
8
5A
Sequential transmission (M3, see also fuse 22)
9
5A
Brake light
Light module (see also fuse 32)
On-board computer
Speed control
10
5A
Instrument cluster (see also fuses 34, 43)
11
5A
Airbag
Side-impact airbag
12
7.5A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 33, 42, 53, 56)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 33, 40, 42, 53, 56, 61)
ABS/DSC all-wheel drive (see also fuses 33, 35,
40, 42, 53)
Manual top (Convertible, see also fuses 42, 46)
Power top (Convertible, see also fuses 6, 35, 42,
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
11 of 14
Fuse
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Rating
Protected circuit
46)
Seat heating (see also fuse 42)
Roller sun blind (see also fuse 42)
Tire pressure control (see also fuses 31, 42, 69)
13
7.5A
Roll-over protection system (Convertible)
14
5A
Electronic immobilizer (EWS) (see also fuse 67)
Starter interlock
15
5A
Rain sensor
Rear wiper (Sport Wagon, see also fuse 45)
16
17
18
not used
19
20
21
22
5A
Engine control (M3, see also fuses 29, 30)
Sequential transmission (M3, see also fuse 22)
23
5A
Heater (see also fuses 28, 62)
24
5A
Electrochromic rear view mirror (see also fuse
67)
Park distance control
25
5A
Heated outside mirror, passenger
Heated spray nozzles
26
5A
Cigarette lighter (Australia, see also fuse 47)
Garage door opener
27
10A
Engine control (see also fuses 29, 30)
Back-up light
28
5A
Air conditioner (see also fuses 62, 63)
Blower (see also fuse 50)
Heater (see also fuses 23, 62)
29
5A
Engine control (see also fuses 27, 30)
Engine control (M3, see also fuses 22, 30)
30
7.5A
Engine control (see also fuses 27, 29)
Engine control (M3, see also fuses 22, 29)
OBD II system (see also fuse 43)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
12 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
31
5A
Outside mirror (see also fuse 57)
Tire pressure control (see also fuses 12, 42, 69)
32
5A
Light module (see also fuse 9)
33
5A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 12, 42, 53, 56)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 12, 40, 42, 53, 56, 61)
ABS/DSC all-wheel drive (see also fuses 12, 35,
40, 42, 53)
34
5A
Instrument cluster (see also fuses 10, 43)
35
50A
Power top (Convertible, see also fuses 6, 12, 42,
46)
ABS/DSC all-wheel drive (see also fuses 12, 33,
40, 42, 53)
36
50A
Secondary air pump
37
50A
Engine cooling fan
38
10A
(15A)
Front foglights
39
5A
Telephone (see also fuse 7)
40
5A
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 12, 33, 42, 53, 56, 61)
ABS/DSC all-wheel drive (see also fuses 12, 33,
35, 42, 53)
Shift gate illumination
41
30A
Navigation system (see also fuse 7)
On-board monitor (see also fuse 7)
Radio (see also fuse 7)
42
30A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 12, 33, 53, 56)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 12, 33, 40, 53, 56, 61)
ABS/DSC all-wheel drive (see also fuses 12, 33,
35, 40, 53)
Manual top (Convertible, see also fuses 12, 46)
Power top (Convertible, see also fuses 6, 12, 35,
46)
Seat heating (see also fuse 12)
Roller sun blind (see also fuse 12)
Tire pressure control (see also fuses 12, 31, 69)
43
5A
Instrument cluster (see also fuses 10, 34)
OBD II system (see also fuse 30)
44
20A
Trailer module
45
20A
Rear wiper (Sport Wagon, see also fuse 15)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
13 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
46
30A
(20A convertible)
Power top (Convertible, see also fuses 6, 12, 35,
42)
Manual top (Convertible, see also fuses 12, 42)
Sunroof
47
15A
(20A)
Cigarette lighter / power outlet (Australia, see
also fuse 26)
48
30A
Power window, front (see also fuse 49)
49
5A
Anti-theft (see also fuse 67)
Central locking system (see also fuses 52, 60,
Sport Wagon, see fuse 58)
Interior light (see also fuse 52)
Windshield washer system (see also fuses 52,
59)
Window, front (see also fuse 48)
50
40A
Heater-A/C blower (see also fuse 28)
51
30A
Headlight washer system
52
30A
Central locking system (see also fuses 49, 60,
Sport Wagon see fuse 58)
Glove compartment light
Hand lamp
Interior lights (see also fuse 49)
Passenger compartment/trunk lighting
Windshield washer system (see also fuses 49,
59)
53
30A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 12, 33, 42, 56)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 12, 33, 40, 42, 56, 61)
ABS/DSC all-wheel drive (see also fuses 12, 33,
35, 40, 42)
54
15A
Fuel pump
55
15A
Horn (see also fuse 5)
56
30A
ABS/ASC (see also fuses 12, 33, 42, 53)
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 12, 33, 40, 42, 53, 61)
57
5A
Outside mirror (see also fuse 31)
58
7.5
Central locking (Sport Wagon, see also fuses
49, 52, 60)
59
30A
Windshield washer system (see also fuses 49,
52)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
14 of 14
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fuse
Rating
Protected circuit
60
25A
Central locking (see also fuses 49, 52, Sport
Wagon, see fuse 58)
61
30A
ABS/DSC (see also fuses 12, 33, 40, 42, 53, 56,
61)
62
7.5A
Heater-A/C (see also fuses 28, 63)
Heater (see also fuses 23, 28)
63
7.5A
Heater-A/C (see also fuses 28, 62)
64
not used
65
30A
66
not used
67
5A
Anti-theft (DWA) (see also fuse 49)
Electrochromic rear view mirror (see also fuse
24)
Electronic immobilizer (EWS) (see also fuse 14)
68
30A
Heated rear window (Convertible, see also fuse
7)
69
5A
Tire pressure control (see also fuses 12, 31, 42)
70
30A
Passenger seat adjustment
71
30A
(10A Coupe)
Hinged window (Coupe)
Window, rear
Driver seat adjustment
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
610-3
Ground Locations
Grounds are widely distributed
throughout the vehicle body. Several
are found under the interior carpets.
Lugs and connectors attached to
ground are susceptible to damage and
corrosion. Clean or renew them as
necessary.
Fig. 5 Left front engine compartment,
behind left headlight
1 - Ground X165
Fig. 6 Right front engine compartment,
behind right headlight
1 - Ground X166
Fig. 7 On bulkhead behind E-box
1 - Ground X6454
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 8 Under left front carpet on door
sill
1 - Ground connector X173
Fig. 9 On door sill, under driver seat
carpet
1 - Ground connector X1108
2 - Side impact airbag crash sensor
Fig. 10 Under right front carpet on door
sill
1 - Ground connector X490
Fig. 11 Behind right rear seat backrest
1 - Ground X494
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 12 Right side trunk, behind trim
1 - Ground X498
Fig. 13 Left side trunk, behind trim
1 - Ground X13016
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
1 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
610-4
Component Locations
On the following pages are photos and
illustrations showing the location of
major electrical components in E46
vehicles.
Note:
Every component is not installed in
every car.
Due to changes in production,
component locations may vary
from what is illustrated. Consult
your BMW dealer for the latest
information.
The automatic transmission range
switch is also sometimes referred
to as the gear-position switch.
The EWS 3.3 system is also
known as the driveaway protection
system or the electronic
immobilization system.
All-Season Traction (AST) is a
marketing term that refers to
ABS/ASC.
Main relay panel
-
To access main relay panel,
located under right side of
dashboard, remove glove
compartment as described in
513 Interior Trim.
Fig. 14 Behind glove compartment (no
headlight cleaning system)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
2 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
1 - A/C relay
2 - Secondary air pump relay
3 - Fuel pump relay
4 - A/C relay
5 - Foglight relay
6 - Horn relay
7 - General module (GM V)
Fig. 15 Behind glove compartment
(with headlight cleaning system)
1 - Headlight cleaning relay
2 - Secondary air pump relay
3 - A/C relay
4 - Fuel pump relay
5 - A/C relay
6 - Foglight relay
7 - Horn relay
Electronics box (E-box)
To access E-box components:
Working in left rear of engine
compartment, remove M6 Allen
head bolts (arrows).
Lift off E-box cover.
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
3 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 16 E-box
1 - Engine control module (ECM)
2 - Automatic transmission control
module (TCM)
3 - DME main relay
4 - Windshield washer double relay
5 - E-box temperature sensor
6 - B+ connector
7 - Engine electronics fuse pack
8 - 1999 - 2000 models: Unloader
relay 2001 models: fuel injector
relay
9 - Back-up light relay (automatic
transmission only)
Component location table
Table e. E46 component locations is
a cross-referenced listing of electrical
components in E46 vehicles. Where
available, photos of components in this
repair group are referred to in the
fourth column.
Note:
Every attempt has been made in
this repair manual to standardize
component names. Nevertheless,
in some cases, the same
component may appear with
different names.
No E46 vehicle is equipped with all
components illustrated. Where
necessary, year and model
applications are given in the
component location table and the
illustrations.
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
4 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table e. E46 component locations
Component
Year, model
12 volt auxiliary
power socket
Location
Refer to
see Power socket, 12-volt
3/2-way valve
1999 - 2000
Under car ahead of fuel filter, under
protective cover
A/C blower final
stage (resistor pack)
1999 - 2001
Right side of IHKA housing below
glove compartment
Fig. 40
A/C blower relay
1999 - 2001
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
A/C blower
1999 - 2001
Behind engine compartment rear
bulkhead
A/C compressor
1999 - 2001
Right front lower engine
compartment
A/C compressor
clutch relay
1999 - 2001
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
A/C control module
1999 - 2001
Center of dashboard
A/C evaporator
temperature sensor
1999 - 2001
Left side of IHKA housing below
instrument cluster
Fig. 39
A/C pressure sensor
1999 - 2001
Behind right headlight on top of
receiver/drier
Fig. 32
ABS wheel speed
sensor connector,
front (right/left)
1999 -2001
In wheel housing (right/left)
Fig. 62
ABS wheel speed
sensor connector,
rear (right/left)
1999 - 2001
Ahead of rear wheel housing
(right/left)
ABS wheel speed
sensor, front
(right/left)
1999 - 2001
In front wheel bearing
housing(right/left)
Fig. 60
ABS wheel speed
sensor, rear
(right/left)
1999 - 2001
In rear wheel bearing housing
(right/left)
Fig. 61
ABS/ASC control
module/hydraulic
unit
1999
Left rear engine compartment, below
brake master cylinder
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
5 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
ABS/ASC/DSC
warning lights
1999 - 2001
In instrument cluster
ABS/DSC charge
pressure sensor
1999 - 200
rear wheel drive
with DSC
Base of master cylinder, left side
ABS/DSC charge
pressure sensor
2001
rear wheel drive
In ABS/DSC hydraulic unit, right rear
engine compartment
ABS/DSC control
module/hydraulic
unit
1999 - 2000;
2001
all wheel drive
Right rear of engine compartment
ABS/DSC control
module/hydraulic
unit
2001
rear wheel drive
Left rear of engine compartment
ABS/DSC lateral
acceleration sensor
1999 - 2001
rear wheel drive
Behind driver kickpanel
ABS/DSC lateral
acceleration sensor
200
all wheel drive
Combined with rotational rate (yaw)
sensor under driver side carpet
ABS/DSC precharge
pump
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment, below
brake master cylinder
ABS/DSC rotational
rate (yaw) sensor
1999 - 2001
Under driver side carpet
ABS/DSC steering
angle sensor
1999 -2001
Base of upper steering column
ABS/DSC switch
1999 - 2000
At throttle housing
Accelerator pedal
sensor (PWG)
2001
Above accelerator pedal
AGS (adaptive
transmission control)
Fig. 19
Fig. 18
Fig. 35
see Automatic transmission control
module
1999 - 2001
Air flow sensor
Air quality sensor
(AUC) (for automatic
Fig. 18
see ASC/DSC switch
Accelerator pedal
sensor (PWG)
Air distribution
motors
Refer to
In IHKA housing under dashboard
(see
640 Heating and Air
Conditioning)
see Mass air flow sensor
2000 - 2001
Right side of radiator
Fig. 17,
Fig. 29
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
6 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Refer to
Airbag connector,
passenger side
1999 - 2001
Right side dashboard support
Fig. 41
Airbag connector,
steering wheel
1999 - 2001
Under steering wheel airbag
Fig. 34
Airbag control
module (MRS
module)
1999 - 2001
Under parking brake lever console,
under carpet
Fig. 9
Airbag crash sensor,
side-impact airbag
(left/right)
1999 - 2001
Front seat crossmember under
carpet (left/right)
Airbag warning light
1999 - 2001
In instrument cluster
Airbag, driver side
1999 - 2001
Steering wheel center pad
Airbag, head
protection (HPS),
electrical connector
(left/right)
1999 - 2001
At bottom of windshield pillar (A
pillar) behind dashboard (left/right)
Fig. 42
Airbag, passenger
side
1999 - 2001
Right side dashboard
Fig. 41
Airbag, side-impact
(left/right front/rear)
1999 - 2001
Inside door (left/right, front/rear)
recirculation system)
Alarm control module 1999 - 2001
(DWA)
Above main fuse box behind glove
box
Alarm indicator LED
(DWA)
1999 - 2001
Attached to rear view mirror
Alarm siren (DWA)
1999 - 2001
Right side rear of engine
compartment near wipers
Alarm siren battery
(DWA)
1999 - 2001
Inside alarm siren
All season traction
(AST)
see ABS/ASC entries
Alternator
(generator)
1999 -2001
Left front of cylinder block
Amplifier, radio
1999 - 2001
Left side trunk or cargo compartment
behind trim panel
Fig. 54,
Fig. 57
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
7 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Antenna amplifier,
diversity
Convertible
On convertible top storage cover
Antenna amplifier,
diversity
Sport Wagon
Behind left side cargo area storage
cover
Antenna amplifier,
main
Convertible
Below mast antenna in trunk
Antenna amplifier,
main
Sedan, Coupe
Behind left rear roof pillar (C-pillar)
trim panel
Antenna amplifier,
main
Sport Wagon
Below rear spoiler
Antenna diversity
switching module
Convertible
Below mast antenna in trunk
Antenna, AM
Sport Wagon
In rear spoiler
Antenna, diversity
Convertible
In convertible top storage cover
Antenna, diversity
Sport Wagon
Left rear side window
Antenna, FZV
(keyless entry)
Convertible
Interior rear view mirror
Antenna, FZV
(keyless entry)
Sedan, Coupe
Rear window, lower antenna grid
Antenna, FZV
(keyless entry)
Sport Wagon
Center rear window, combined with
FM2 antenna
Antenna, main
Convertible
Mast on left rear fender
Antenna, main (FM1
and FM2)
Sport Wagon
Rear window center and right
Antenna, telephone
Convertible
Wound around mast antenna
Antenna, telephone
Coupe, Sedan,
Sport Wagon
In roof above rear window
Anti-slip (traction)
see ABS/ASC entries
Anti-slip (traction)
control switch
see ASC/DSC switch
Anti-theft
see Alarm entries
ASC
see ABS/ASC entries
ASC+T
see ABS/ASC entries
Refer to
Fig. 57
Fig. 44
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
8 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
ASC/DSC switch
1999 - 2001
Bottom of center console, left of
shifter
AST
see ABS/ASC entries
Automatic climate
control (IHKA)
see A/C entries
Refer to
Automatic
transmission control
module (TCM)
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box
Automatic
transmission range
switch (gear
position/neutral
safety switch)
GM trans.
Left side of transmission, inside
transmission case
Automatic
transmission range
switch (gear
position/neutral
safety switch)
ZF trans.
Left side of transmission
Fig. 64
Automatic
transmission range
switch harness
connector
ZF trans.
Left side of transmission
Fig. 64
B+ jumper connector 1999 - 2001
Next to right front strut tower, right
rear engine compartment
Fig. 17,
Fig. 19
B+ supply, E-box
Left side of E-box
Fig. 16
Back-up light switch
(automatic
transmission)
see Automatic transmission range
switch
Back-up light switch
(manual
transmission)
1999 - 2000
Top left side of transmission housing
Back-up light relay
(automatic
transmission)
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment, in
E-box
Battery
1999 - 2001
Right side trunk or cargo
compartment, under tray
Battery safety
terminal (BST)
1999 - 2001
On positive battery terminal
Fig. 16
Fig. 16
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
9 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Blower
see A/C blower
Body electronics
control module
see General module (GM V)
Brake fluid level
sensor
1999 - 2001
Brake fluid pressure
sensor
Top of brake fluid reservoir, left rear
engine compartment
Refer to
Fig. 17,
Fig. 18
see ABS/DSC charge pressure
sensor
Brake light switch
1999 -2001
At pedal cluster
Brake pad sensor,
left front
1999 - 2001
Left front brake pad
Brake pad sensor,
right rear
1999 - 2001
Right rear brake pad
Brake pad wear
sensor connector,
left front
1999 - 2001
In left front wheel housing
Brake pad wear
sensor connector,
right rear
1999 - 2001
Ahead of right rear wheel housing
Camshaft actuator
(VANOS)
Fig. 37
Fig. 62
see VANOS
Camshaft position
sensor, exhaust
1999 - 2001
Right front of cylinder head
Fig. 29
Camshaft position
sensor, intake
1999 - 2001
Left front of cylinder head
Fig. 28
Carbon canister
valve
1999 - 2000
Right side of spare tire well under
floor pan
CD changer
1999 - 2001
Left side of trunk
Center brake light
Sedan, Coupe
Rear of headliner
Central locking
switch
see Hazard warning/central locking
switch
Changeover valve,
intake manifold
see Resonance valve, intake
manifold
Changeover valve,
running losses
see 3/2-way valve
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
10 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Charge pressure
sensor
see ABS/DSC charge pressure
sensor
Child protection
window control
see Window lock-out switch, rear
Chime module, park
distance control
(PDC)
1999 - 2001
In left footwell top trim
Clock
1999 - 2001
In on-board computer display of
instrument cluster
Refer to
Clutch pedal position 1999 - 2001
switch
On pedal cluster
Combination (stalk)
switch
see Turn-signal/headlight dimmer
switch (stalk switch)
see also Wiper/washer switch (stalk
switch)
Convertible top
Convertible
control module (CVM
II)
Left rear quarter panel behind trim
panel
Fig. 66
Convertible top
hydraulic motor
Convertible
In left side of trunk behind trim cover
Fig. 66
Convertible top main
pillar Hall sensor
Convertible
Behind rear seat in C pillar position
Fig. 66
Convertible top
solenoid valves
Convertible
Left and right rear main pillar, behind
quarter panel windows
Fig. 66
Convertible top
Convertible
storage compartment
floor microswitch
Right side storage compartment
hinge in trunk
Fig. 66
Convertible top
storage cover Hall
sensor
Convertible
Left rear of convertible top cover
Fig. 66
Convertible top
storage cover lock
Hall sensor
Convertible
Center of cover, between rear seat
backrests
Fig. 66
Convertible top
storage cover lock
motor Hall sensor
Convertible
Center of cover, between rear seat
backrests
Fig. 66
Convertible top
storage cover motor
Convertible
Center of cover, between rear seat
backrests
Fig. 66
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
11 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Convertible top
switch
Convertible
Bottom of center console, ahead of
shifter
Fig. 66
Convertible top
tension bow Hall
sensor
Convertible
Top rear of convertible top
Fig. 66
Convertible top visor
latch Hall sensor
Convertible
Top of windshield
Fig. 66
Coolant level sensor
1999 - 2001
At bottom of coolant expansion tank
Coolant temperature
sensor, radiator
outlet
1999 - 2001
In lower radiator hose, right front of
engine
Coolant temperature
sensor
Coolant thermostat
Refer to
Fig. 31
see Engine coolant temperature
(ECT) sensor
1999 - 2001
Cooling fan
Front of cylinder head
see Engine cooling fan entries
Crankshaft position
sensor
1999 - 2001
Left rear of engine block, under
starter motor
Fig. 22
Cruise control cut-off
switch
1999 -2001
At pedal cluster
Fig. 37
Cruise controls
(steering wheel)
1999 - 2001
Steering wheel right side keypad
Data link connector
(20-pin DLC)
1999 - 2000
Right rear engine compartment (see
also OBD II connector)
Diagnosis module
tank leakage (DMTL)
2001
see Fuel tank leakage diagnosis
pump (LDP or DMTL)
Digital motor
electronics control
module
see Engine control module (ECM)
Directional switch
(stalk switch)
see Turn signal/headlight dimmer
switch (stalk switch)
DLC
see Data link connector
see also OBD II connector
DME control module
see Engine control module (ECM)
DME main relay
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box
Fig. 17
Fig. 16
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
12 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
DMTL
2001
see Fuel tank leakage diagnosis
pump (LDP or DMTL)
Door lock
1999 - 2001
In door
Door lock Hall sensor 1999 - 2001
In door lock mechanism
Door lock
microswitch
In door lock mechanism
1999 - 2001
Drive-away
protection
see EWS
DSC
see ABS/DSC entries
DSC switch
see ASC/DSC switch
DWA
see Alarm entries
Dynamic stability
control
see ABS/DSC entries
E-box
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment, under
plastic cover
E-box cooling fan
1999 - 2001
Bottom rear of E-box
E-box temperature
sensor
1999 - 2001
Rear of E-box
ECT sensor
see Engine coolant temperature
(ECT) sensor
Electric coolant
thermostat
see Coolant thermostat
Electronic
immobilizer
see EWS entries
Electronics box
see E-box entries
Engine compartment
light switch
see Engine hood contact switch
Refer to
Fig. 16
Fig. 16
Engine control
module (ECM)
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box
Fig. 16
Engine coolant
temperature (ECT)
sensor
1999 - 2001
Under rear of intake manifold at rear
of cylinder block
Fig. 21
Engine cooling fan
(electric)
1999 - 2001
Models with automatic transmission:
In front of radiator
Fig. 17
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
13 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Refer to
Models with standard transmission:
In back of radiator
Engine cooling fan
final stage (resistor)
1999 - 2001
Engine electronics
fuse pack
In engine cooling fan housing
see Fuses, engine electronics
Engine hood contact
switch
1999 - 2001
Right rear engine compartment
Evaporative control
valve
1999 - 2001
Left front of engine mounted on
intake manifold
Evaporator
temperature sensor
Fig. 19
see A/C evaporator temperature
sensor
EWS control module
1999 - 2001
On passenger compartment
bulkhead, above pedal cluster
Fig. 38
EWS ring antenna
1999 - 2001
Around ignition switch
Fig. 36
EWS transmitter
module
1999 - 2001
In ignition key
Exhaust camshaft
position sensor
1999 - 2001
Right front of engine, top
Fig. 29
Exhaust camshaft
VANOS solenoid
1999 - 2001
Right front of engine, top
Fig. 29
Fog light relay
1999 - 2001
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
Footwell light, left
1999 - 2001
In left footwell top trim (pedal cluster
trim)
Footwell light, right
1999 - 2001
In right footwell top trim
Fresh air distribution
motor
see Air distribution motors
Fuel filler door lock
motor
1999 - 2001
In right side of trunk or cargo
compartment, behind trim
Fuel injector relay
2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box
Fuel injectors
electrical harness
1999 - 2001
Top of engine, under plastic cover
Fig. 16
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
14 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Fuel level sensor,
left
1999 - 2001
Top of fuel tank, under left rear seat
cushion
Fig. 52
Fuel level sensor,
right
1999 - 2001
Top of fuel tank, under right rear
seat cushion, combined with fuel
pump
Fig. 52
Fuel pump
1999 - 2001
Top of fuel tank, under right rear
seat cushion, combined with right
fuel level sensor
Fig. 52
Fuel pump relay
1999 - 2001
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
Fuel tank leakage
diagnosis pump
(LDP or DMTL)
1999 - 2001
Under right rear of vehicle, right side
of trunk, under protective cover
Fig. 65
Fuel tank vent valve
Refer to
see Evaporative control valve
Fuse for main
harness F108 (200
amp)
1999 - 2001
Right wheel housing in trunk
Fig. 1
Fuse panel, main
1999 - 2001
Above glove compartment
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
Fuses, additional
high amperage
1999 - 2001
Above main fuse panel
Fig. 4
Fuses, engine
electronics
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box
Fig. 2
FZV antenna
see Antenna, FZV (keyless entry)
Gas generator,
airbag
see Airbag entries
Gear position
indicator light
1999 - 2001
Under shifter bezel
Gear position/neutral
safety switch
see Automatic transmission range
switch
General module (GM 1999 - 2001
V)
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
Generator
see Alternator (generator)
Glove compartment
lock motor
Above glove compartment lock
GM V
see General module (GM V)
Fig. 47
Fig. 14
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
15 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Refer to
GPS receiver module 1999 - 2001
In trunk, mounted behind left rear
well
Ground jumper
connection
1999 - 2001
Right rear engine compartment
Fig. 19
X1108
1999 - 2001
Under driver seat carpet on door sill
Fig. 9
X13016
1999 - 2001
Left side trunk
Fig. 13,
Fig. 54
X165
1999 - 2001
Left front, engine compartment
Fig. 5
X166
1999 - 2001
Right front, engine compartment
Fig. 6
X173
1999 - 2001
Under left front carpet on door sill
Fig. 8
X217
1999 - 2001
Under right side dashboard
X218
1999 - 2001
Under right side tunnel carpet
X490
1999 - 2001
Under right front seat carpet on door
sill
Fig. 10
X494
1999 - 2001
Behind rear seat backrest
Fig. 11
X498
1999 - 2001
Right side trunk
Fig. 12,
Fig. 53
X6454
1999 - 2001
On bulkhead, left rear engine
compartment
Fig. 7
Hazard
warning/central
locking switch
1999 - 2001
On center console, behind shifter
Grounds:
Head protection
airbag (HPS)
Headlight dimmer
relay
see Airbag listings
1999 - 2001
Headlight flasher
Headlight vertical
aim actuator
(left/right) (models
with xenon
headlights)
In light control center (LSZ)
see Turn-signal/headlight dimmer
switch (stalk switch)
1999 - 2001
In headlight assembly (left/right)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
16 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Headlight vertical
aim load sensor,
front
1999 - 2001
Front subframe, right side
Headlight vertical
1999 - 2001
aim load sensor, rear
Rear subframe, right side
Headlight washer
pump
Front of washer tank, right front
engine compartment
1999 - 2001
Heater blower
Heater core
temperature sensor
Fig. 59
see A/C blower entries
1999 - 2001
Behind center console below radio
Heater recirculation
distribution motor
see Air distribution motors
Heater regulator air
distribution motor
see Air distribution motors
Heater valve
assembly
Refer to
1999 - 2001
Mounted on inner side of left strut
tower
Heating-A/C
see A/C entries
High beam switch
see Turn signal/headlight dimmer
switch (stalk switch)
Hood switch
see Engine hood security switch
Horn button
1999 - 2001
On steering wheel pad
Horn relay
1999 - 2001
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
Horn (left/right)
1999 - 2001
Next to front bumper impact
absorber (left/right)
Hot-film mass air
flow sensor
Fig. 45
Fig. 27
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
see Mass air flow sensor
Idle speed control
valve
1999 - 2001
Under intake manifold
Fig. 23
Ignition coils
1999 - 2001
Top of cylinder head, under plastic
cover
Fig. 25
Ignition relay
Ignition switch
IHKA
see Unloader relay
1999 - 2001
Right side steering column
see A/C entries
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
17 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Individual control
intake system valve
see Resonance valve, intake
manifold
Inflator assembly,
airbag
see Airbag entries
Instrument cluster
control unit
1999 - 2001
In instrument cluster
Intake air
temperature (IAT)
sensor
1999 - 2001
Center top of engine, between intake
manifold and cylinder head
Intake manifold
resonance valve
Convertible
On center tunnel below console
Interior protection
control module (UIS)
Sedan, Coupe,
Sport Wagon
In headliner
Interior temperature
intake fan
1999 - 2001
In A/C control module in center
console
Keyless entry
antenna
see Antenna, FZV (keyless entry)
Kickdown switch,
automatic
transmission
see Accelerator pedal sensor (PWG)
1999 - 2001
Under intake manifold
Lateral acceleration
sensor
see ABS/DSC lateral acceleration
sensor entries
LDP
see Fuel tank leakage diagnosis
pump (LDP or DMTL)
Leakage diagnosis
pump (LDP)
see Fuel tank leakage diagnosis
pump (LDP or DMTL)
Light control module
1999 -2001
In light switch center (LSZ)
Light switch
assembly
1999 - 2001
In light switch center (LSZ)
Light switch center
(LSZ)
1999 - 2001
In dashboard, left of steering wheel
Load-reduction relay
Fig. 25
see Resonance valve, intake
manifold
Interior protection
control module
(SDR)
Knock sensors
Refer to
Fig. 24
see Unloader relay
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
18 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Lumbar support air
compressor
1999 - 2001
Under each seat equipped with
support system
Lumbar support
control switch
1999 - 2001
Below seat base trim
Lumbar support
switch
1999 - 2001
Four-way toggle switch at base of
seat, near seat control switches
Main fuse panel
see Fuse panel, main
Main relay panel
see Relay panel, main
Main harness fuse
see Fuse for main harness F108
(200 amp)
Mass air flow sensor
1999 - 2001
Left side engine compartment
Mixing actuators
see Air distribution motors
MRS module
see Airbag control module
Multi-function clock
1999 - 2001
Multiple restraint
system (MRS)
module
Navigation computer
Refer to
Fig. 17
In dash cluster below speedometer
and tachometer
see Airbag control module
1999 - 2001
Neutral safety switch
Left side of trunk
see Automatic transmission range
switch
OBD II connector
(16-pin DLC)
1999 - 2001
In left footwell top trim, under left
side of instrument cluster (see also
Data link connector)
Oil pressure switch
1999 - 2001
Left front of engine at oil filter
housing
Fig. 26
Oil temperature
sensor
1999 - 2001
Left front of engine at oil filter
housing
Fig. 26
On-board computer
1999 - 2001
In instrument cluster
On-board monitor
1999 - 2001
In center of dashboard
Outside air
temperature sensor
1999 - 2001
Under left side of front bumper
Outside mirror
control switch
1999 - 2001
On left front door arm rest
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
19 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Oxygen sensor
connector,
post-catalyst
1999 - 2001
Top of engine, between intake
manifold and cylinder head cover
Fig. 25
Oxygen sensor
connector,
precatalyst
1999 - 2001
Top of engine, between exhaust
manifold and cylinder head cover
Fig. 25
Oxygen sensor,
post-catalyst
1999 - 2001
Bottom of exhaust manifold (access
from below)
Fig. 58
Oxygen sensor,
precatalyst
1999 - 2001
Top of exhaust manifold
Fig. 25
Park angle/tilt sensor 1999 - 2001
In right side trunk behind trim
Park distance control 1999 -2001
(PDC) module
In right side trunk above battery
Park distance control 1999 - 2001
sensors
Rear bumper trim strip
Park distance control 1999 - 2001
warning speaker
Right rear speaker, rear parcel shelf
Parking brake
warning switch
Under center console, rear of
parking brake handle
1999 -2001
Pedal position
sensor
see Accelerator pedal sensor (PWG)
Pinch protection,
window
see Window anti-trap strip
Power socket, 12-volt Sport Wagon
Cargo compartment behind left rear
seat
Power window
motors
see Window motors
Power window
switches
see Window switches
Pressure sensitive
finger guard
see Window anti-trap strip
Radiator fan
see Engine cooling fan (electric)
Radio antenna
see Antenna entries
Radio controls
(steering wheel)
1999 - 2001
Refer to
Fig. 67
Fig. 49
Fig. 57
On steering wheel left keypad
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
20 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Radio speaker: front
tweeter (left/right)
1999 - 2001
Front door window frame (left/right)
Radio/cassette/CD
player
1999 - 2001
Center of dashboard
Rain sensor
1999 - 2001
Top center of interior windshield
surface, directly ahead of rear view
mirror
Rain sensor control
module (AIC)
1999 - 2001
Attached to rain sensor at top of
windshield
Rear power window
lock-out switch
Refer to
Fig. 33
see Window lock-out switch, rear
Rear window
defogger relay
Convertible
Right rear quarter panel behind trim
panel
Rear window
defogger relay
Sedan, Coupe
Right trunk wall, behind trim liner
Rear window
defogger relay
Sport Wagon
Right rear cargo area behind trim
panel
Rear window washer
pump
Sport Wagon
Behind panel in right rear cargo area
Relay panel, main
1999 - 2001
Behind glove compartment
Resonance valve,
intake manifold
1999 - 2001
Left of intake manifold
Reversing light
switch
see Back-up light entries
Ride level sensor
see Headlight vertical aim sensor
entries
Ring antenna (EWS)
see EWS ring antenna
Rollover cassette
Convertible
Rear seat headrest
Rollover sensor
Convertible
Rear seat headrest
Rotational rate (yaw)
sensor
Fig. 53
Fig. 56
Fig. 17
see ABS/DSC rotational rate (yaw)
sensor
Seat backrest motor
1999 -2001
Bottom of seat backrest
Fig. 51
Seat control switch
module
1999 - 2001
At base of seat, on side of seat
cushion
Fig. 50
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
21 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Refer to
Seat cushion tilt
motor
1999 - 2001
Bottom of seat cushion
Fig. 50
Seat forward-back
motor
1999 -2001
Bottom of seat cushion
Fig. 50
Seat headrest motor
1999 - 2001
Top of front seat backrest
Fig. 51
Seat heater
1999 - 2001
In front seat cushion and backrest
Seat heater switch
1999 - 2001
Center console, below IHKA control
panel
Seat heater
temperature sensor
1999 - 2001
Front of front seat cushion
Seat height motor
1999 - 2001
Back of seat cushion
Seat load sensor
2000 - 2001
Under passenger seat cushion
Fig. 50
Seat memory module 1999 - 2001
(SM)
Front of seat cushion
Seat belt lock Hall
sensor
1999 - 2001
In seat belt lock
Seat belt tensioner,
pyrotechnic
(left/right)
1999 - 2001
Base of seat belt lock (left/right)
Secondary air
injection pump
1999 - 2001
Right side engine compartment,
above exhaust manifold
Fig. 17,
Fig. 30
Secondary air
injection pump relay
1999 - 2001
Main relay panel behind glove
compartment
Fig. 14,
Fig. 15
Secondary air
injection pump valve
1999 - 2001
Left front of engine
Fig. 30
Shift interlock cable
1999 - 2001
Under shifter bezel
Fig. 46
Shiftlock solenoid
1999 - 2001
Under shifter bezel
Side-impact airbag
see Airbag entries
Slip control
see ABS/ASC or ABS/DSC entries
Socket, 12 volt
see Power socket, 12-volt
Solar sensor
Sound system
amplifier
2000 - 2001
Fig. 50
Right defroster outlet at base of
windshield
see Amplifier, radio
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
22 of 40
Component
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Year, model
Location
Speed sensor
see ABS wheel speed sensor entries
Spiral spring
see Volute spring
Starter
1999 - 2001
Starter
immobilization switch
(manual
transmission)
Starter terminals 30,
50
Left rear of engine, under intake
manifold
On clutch pedal
1999 - 2001
Left rear of engine, under intake
manifold
Steering angle
sensor
see ABS/DSC steering angle sensor
Stepper motors
see Air distribution motors
Steptronic switch
Refer to
2000 - 2001
Stop light switch
Fig. 22
Under shifter bezel
see Brake light switch
Sunroof motor
1999 - 2001
In headliner
Sunroof/sunshade
switch
1999 - 2001
In center console ahead of shifter
Supplemental
restraint system
(SRS)
Fig. 43
see Airbag entries
Tailgate lock (central
locking)
Sport Wagon
In tailgate lock
Tailgate emergency
release actuator
Sport Wagon
Rear deck sill, under trim panel,
integrated with lock mechanism
Tailgate unlock
switch, exterior
Sport Wagon
Above license plate
Tailgate unlock
switch, interior
Sport Wagon
Left kick panel
Telephone connector 1999 - 2001
Under center console
Telephone antenna
see Antenna entries
Telephone controls
(steering wheel)
1999 - 2001
Steering wheel left keypad
Telephone speaker
1999 - 2001
In left footwell top trim
Fig. 48
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
23 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Telephone
transceiver
Sedan, Coupe
In trunk below parcel shelf
Thermostat,
characteristic map
cooling
Throttle housing
(MDK/EDK)
see Coolant thermostat
1999 - 2001
Under intake manifold
Throttle position
sensor
see Accelerator pedal sensor (PWG)
Tilt sensor
see Park angle/tilt sensor
Tire pressure control
system (RDC)
control unit
1999 - 2001
see EWS ring antenna
Traction control
see ABS/ASC or ABS/DSC entries
1999 - 2001
Fig. 23
Behind glove compartment
Toroidal coil
Trailer module
Refer to
Right side trunk
Transmission control
module
see Automatic transmission module
Transmission range
switch
see Automatic transmission range
switch
Transverse
acceleration sensor
see ABS/DSC lateral acceleration
sensor entries
Trunk lid microswitch Sedan, Coupe,
Convertible
In trunk lid lock
Trunk light switch
Sedan, Coupe,
Convertible
In trunk lid lock
Trunk lock (central
locking)
Sedan, Coupe,
Convertible
In trunk lid lock
Turn-signal/headlight 1999 - 2001
dimmer switch (stalk
switch)
Left side of steering column
Ultrasonic sensor
(motion detector)
(UIS)
Coupe, Sedan,
Sport Wagon
In headliner
Unloader relay
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box,
Fig. 16
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
24 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Component
Year, model
Location
Valet position switch
1999 - 2001
On trunk lock cylinder
VANOS solenoid,
exhaust side
1999 - 2001
Right front of cylinder head
Fig. 29
VANOS solenoid,
intake side
1999 - 2001
Left front of cylinder head
Fig. 17
Variable camshaft
control
Refer to
see VANOS
Volute spring
1999 - 2001
In center of steering wheel under
driver airbag
Washer fluid level
sensor
1999 - 2001
Bottom of windshield washer tank
Wheel speed sensor
see ABS wheel speed sensor entries
Window anti-trap
strip
Sedan, Sport
Wagon
Top of window frame in door
Window lock-out
switch, rear
Sedan, Sport
Wagon
Left side shifter bezel
Window motors
1999 - 2001
Inside doors
Window switches
1999 - 2001
On shifter bezel
Windshield washer
nozzle heaters
1999 - 2001
In nozzles at rear of engine hood
Windshield washer
pump
1999 - 2001
At rear of washer tank, right front
engine compartment
Windshield washer
relay
1999 - 2001
Left rear engine compartment in
E-box
Fig. 16
Wiper motor
1999 - 2001
Rear of engine compartment, behind
bulkhead
Fig. 20
Wiper/washer switch
(stalk)
1999 - 2001
Right side steering column
Yaw sensor
see ABS/DSC rotational rate (yaw)
sensor
ZKE V control
module
see General Module (GM V)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
25 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Engine compartment electrical
components
Fig. 17 Engine compartment (1999 323i)
1 - Data link connector (DLC) (1999 mid-2000 models)
2 - Hood contact switch
3 - B+ jumper connector
4 - DSC control module/hydraulic unit
5 - Secondary air pump
6 - Interior microfilter housing
7 - Resonance valve, intake manifold
(changeover valve)
8 - Mass air flow sensor
9 - Brake fluid level sensor
10 - Ground lug X6454
11 - Electronics box (E-box)
12 - Air quality sensor (AUC) (for
automatic recirculation control)
13 - Intake camshaft VANOS solenoid
14 - Engine cooling fan (electric)
Fig. 18 Left rear corner of engine
compartment (near E-box)
1 - Brake fluid level sensor
2 - DSC precharge pump (Teves DSC
MK 20/60)
3 - Brake fluid pressure sensor
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
26 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 19 Right rear corner of engine
compartment (Teves DSC MK 20/60)
1 - DSC hydraulic unit
2 - Ground jumper connection
3 - Hood contact switch
4 - B+ jumper connection
5 - DSC control module
Fig. 20 Rear of engine compartment,
behind bulkhead
1 - Wiper assembly electrical harness
connector
Fig. 21 Under rear of intake manifold
1 - Engine coolant temperature (ECT)
sensor
Fig. 22 Left rear of engine block, under
intake manifold
1 - Starter motor terminal 50
2 - Starter motor terminal 30
3 - Crankshaft position sensor
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
27 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
4 - Bore hole for crankshaft locking tool
Fig. 23 Under intake manifold
1 - Idle speed control valve
2 - Throttle housing (MDK/EDK)
Fig. 24 Under intake manifold, at
cylinder head
1 - Knock sensor cylinder 1 - 3
2 - Knock sensor harness connector
3 - Knock sensor cylinder 4 - 6
Fig. 25 Center top of engine, under
covers
1 - Intake air temperature (IAT) sensor
2 - Ignition coils
3 - Post-catalyst oxygen sensor
connectors
4 - Precatalyst oxygen sensor
connectors
5 - Precatalyst oxygen sensors
Fig. 26 Left front of engine, at oil filter
housing
1 - Oil/coolant temperature sensor
2 - Oil pressure switch
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
28 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 27 Left side of engine compartment
1 - Heater control valve
Fig. 28 Cylinder head, left front
1 - Intake camshaft position sensor
Fig. 29 Right front of engine, top
1 - Exhaust camshaft position sensor
2 - Exhaust camshaft VANOS solenoid
3 - Air quality sensor (AUC) (for
automatic recirculation control)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
29 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 30 Right front of engine
1 - Secondary air injection pump
2 - Secondary air injection pump valve
Fig. 31 Right front of engine, low
1 - Exhaust camshaft position sensor
2 - Coolant outlet temperature sensor
Fig. 32 Top of A/C receiver/drier, right
front engine compartment
1 - A/C pressure sensor
Car interior electrical
components
Fig. 33 Front door window frame
1 - Door mounted tweeter
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
30 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 34 Underneath horn pad at steering
wheel
1 - Airbag connector
Fig. 35 Left side of steering column,
below dashboard
1 - Steering angle sensor
Fig. 36 At ignition switch
1 - EWS (electronic immobilizer) ring
antenna
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
31 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 37 At pedal cluster
1 - Cruise control cut-off switch (if
equipped)
2 - Brake light switch
Fig. 38 Above pedal cluster
1 - EWS control module
Fig. 39 Left side IHKA housing, below
instrument cluster
1 - A/C evaporator temperature sensor
Fig. 40 Right side IHKA housing, below
glove compartment
1 - Blower motor resistor pack
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
32 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 41 Right side dashboard
1 - Passenger airbag
2 - Passenger airbag connector
Fig. 42 In windshield pillar (A-pillar)
1 - Head protection airbag (HPS)
electrical connector
Fig. 43 In headliner
1 - Sunroof motor
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
33 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 44 In left rear roof pillar (C pillar)
1 - Antenna amplifier
Fig. 45 Behind center console utility bin
1 - Heater core temperature sensor
Fig. 46 Under shifter bezel
1 - Shiftlock solenoid
Fig. 47 At shifter bezel
1 - Gear position indicator light
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
34 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Fig. 48 Under center console
1 - Telephone connector
Fig. 49 Under center console, rear of
parking brake handle
1 - Parking brake warning switch
Fig. 50 Driver seat (Convertible seat front
view)
1 - Seat memory module
2 - Seat control switch module
3 - Seat tilt motor
4 - Seat forward-back motor
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
35 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
5 - Seat height motor
Fig. 51 Passenger seat (Convertible seat
rear view)
1 - Headrest motor
2 - Comfort entry switch
3 - Backrest motor
Fig. 52 Below rear seat cushion, under
access covers (top of fuel tank)
1 - Right side: Electric fuel pump and
fuel level sender connector
2 - Left side: Fuel level sender
connector
Electrical components in
luggage/cargo compartment
Fig. 53 Right side trunk
1 - Rear window defogger relay
2 - F108 (200 amp fuse) in main
harness
3 - Battery safety terminal (BST)
(explosive charge)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
36 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
4 - Ground X498
Fig. 54 Left side trunk
1 - Sound system amplifier
2 - Ground X13016
Fig. 55 Trunk, below parcel shelf
1 - Telephone transceiver
Fig. 56 Right cargo area, behind trim
panel (Sport Wagon)
1 - Rear window washer pump
Fig. 57 Left cargo area (Sport Wagon)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
37 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
1 - Antenna diversity amplifier
2 - Sound system components
3 - Power socket, 12 volt
Electrical components
underneath car
Fig. 58 Underneath right side of engine,
at lower end of front exhaust pipes
1 - Post-catalyst oxygen sensors
Fig. 59 At front subframe, right side
1 - Front ride level sensor
Fig. 60 Right front steering arm (rear
wheel drive model shown)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
38 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
1 - ABS wheel speed sensor, front
Note:
Left front wheel speed sensor is similar.
Fig. 61 Right rear wheel bearing housing
(1999 rear wheel drive model shown)
ABS wheel speed sensor, rear
Note:
Left rear wheel speed sensor is similar.
Fig. 62 In left front wheel housing
1 - ABS wheel speed sensor connector
(2-pin grey)
2 - Brake pad wear sensor connector
(2-pin black)
Note:
Right rear wheel speed sensor
connector is similar.
The right front and left rear brake
pads lack the wear sensor.
Fig. 63 Rear of automatic transmission
(GM)
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
39 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
1 - Transmission control (AGS)
connector
Fig. 64 Left side of automatic
transmission (ZF)
1 - Transmission range switch/back-up
light switch harness connector
2 - Transmission range switch/back-up
light switch
3 - Transmission control (AGS) harness
connector
Fig. 65 Underneath trunk
1 - LDP/DMTL fuel tank diagnosis
pump
Convertible top electrical
components
Fig. 66 Convertible
1 - Visor latch hall sensors
2 - Solenoid valves
3 - Tension bow hall sensor
4 - Main pillar hall sensor
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Electrical Component Locations
40 of 40
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
5 - Convertible top module (CVM II)
6 - Hydraulic motor
7 - General module (GM V)
8 - Top storage cover lock motor
9 - Rear window defogger relays
10 - Storage cover lock hall sensor
11 - Roll-over cassettes and sensors
12 - Storage compartment floor
microswitch
13 - Convertible top switch
14 - Cover lock motor hall sensor
15 - Convertible top module (CVM II)
16 - Storage cover and hard top lock
hall sensor
17 - Storage cover hall sensor
Exterior electrical components
Fig. 67 Rear bumper
1 - Park distance control (PDC)
ultrasonic sensors
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:09 PM
Wipers and Washers
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
611-1
General
This repair group covers repair
information for windshield, headlight
(optional) and rear window (Sport
Wagon) wiper and washer systems.
Replacement of the wiper/washer stalk
switch assembly is covered in
612
Switches. Electrical wiring diagrams
and relays for the wiper/washer system
are covered in Electrical Wiring
Diagrams.
Special tools
Although most wiper system repairs
can be carried out with normal shop
tools, a few special tools may be
necessary as well.
Headlight washer nozzle aligning tool
BMW 00 9 100
Rear wiper drive aligning tool BMW 61
1 330
Wiper arm removal tool BMW 61 6 060
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Wiper and washer system
The wiper and washer functions in E46
vehicles are controlled by the ZKE V
general module (GM V). Driver input to
the system is via the multi-function
stalk switch to the right of the steering
column.
Operational faults in the wiper/washer
system will set Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs) which can be accessed
through BMW scan tools DIS or MoDiC.
The components of the wiper/washer
system are described below. Some
functions or components are optional,
as indicated.
Wiper/washer stalk switch. The system
has four wiper settings for the
windshield at the steering column stalk
switch.
The settings are:
A: Single wipe (hold stalk switch
down)
B: Off
C: Interval (thumb wheel on stalk
switch)
D: Slow (automatically switches to
interval when car is stopped.)
E: Fast (automatically switches to
slow speed when car is stopped.)
In "interval" setting, wiping intervals are
dependent on road speed. See
Table a. Wiper interval (seconds).
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
The windshield washer system is
activated by pulling the stalk switch
toward the driver.
In Sport Wagon models with rear
wiper/washer, pushing the stalk switch
one detent away from the driver
activates the interval rear wiper.
Pushing the stalk further forward
activates the rear window washer.
Windshield wiper double relay is in
E-box, left rear of engine compartment
(arrow) under plastic cover.
Rain sensor (optional). The infrared
rain sensor and module switch on the
windshield wipers automatically when
water drops are detected on the
windshield. The rain sensor system is
described more fully below.
Windshield/headlight washer fluid
tank is in right front of engine
compartment.
Windshield washer pump is in rear
portion of front washer tank (arrow).
Headlight washer pump (optional) is
in front portion of front washer tank.
Windshield washer nozzle jets are
located on the engine hood. With the
ignition ON, the washer jets are
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
automatically heated. The nozzle
heaters, being of the positive
temperature coefficient (PTC) design,
increase resistance as they heat up
and automatically cut back on current
consumption.
Headlight washer system (optional).
Headlight washer nozzles are on top of
the front bumper. The headlight
washer pump uses fluid from the front
washer tank. If headlights are on, they
will be cleaned every fifth time the
windshield washers are activated.
Rear window wiper assembly (Sport
Wagon) is mounted to the tailgate and
linked to the rear wiper shaft via a
mechanical coupling.
Rear washer fluid tank and pump
(Sport Wagon) is mounted in the right
cargo compartment behind trim panel.
Fill reservoir through cap in right side
rear deck pillar.
The rear window wiper/washer system
is described more fully below.
Table a. Wiper interval (seconds)
Thumb
wheel
position
Vehicle speed (mph)
<4
5 - 22
23 - 45
46 - 60
61 - 87
>87
1
26
19
17
15
15
13
2
17
12
11
10
9
7
3
10
6
6
5
4
3
4
5
3
3
2
2
2
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Windshield wiper/washer system
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Rain sensor system (optional)
The optional rain sensor system uses an
infrared sensor, located at the top of the
windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, to detect the presence of water
drops (or dirt) on the windshield. The
signal from the sensor is communicated
to the GM V, which activates the interval
wipe cycle if the wiper stalk switch
knurled knob (interval control) is in one
of the four interval settings.
The rain sensor functions by aiming a
beam of infrared light through the
windshield at a set angle. The beam is
reflected back and forth within the
windshield until it is detected by the
detector component of the rain sensor.
Rain drops (or other impurities) on the
outside of the windshield cause some of
the infrared to be dissipated outside the
windshield. As a result the detector
"sees" less infrared intensity. This is
interpreted as a need for the wiper to be
turned on.
System components:
An optical prism body attached to
the top of the windshield
Infrared emitter and detector diodes
Optics heater (to prevent
condensation from forming on
diodes and prism)
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Control module (connected to GM V
via K-bus)
The rain sensor is on-line as soon as it
receives KL R (ignition on) operating
power.
When the windshield wiper stalk
switch is placed in the intermittent
position, the GM V signals the rain
sensor control module via the K-bus
of the request for intermittent wiping
and the position of the knurled
wheel (sensitivity).
As an acknowledgment, the rain
sensor sends a command via the
K-bus to activate the wiper motor.
If more than 12 seconds pass
before the GM V receives the
acknowledgment, it concludes the
rain sensor has a defect and
operates the intermittent wipe
function as a system not equipped
with a rain sensor. The wiper
intermittent cycling is based solely
on the knurled wheel setting.
The rain sensor continuously monitors
the windshield for rain accumulation and
signals the GM V to activate the wipers
based on the knurled wheel position and
how fast rain accumulates on the
windshield.
The knurled wheel position signal (1 - 4)
via the K-bus informs the rain sensor of
the selected level of sensitivity:
Position 1 (least sensitive) delays
the wiper activation signal.
Position 4 (most sensitive) sends
the wiper activation signal to the
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
GM V sooner.
Depending on the intensity of the rain
the wipers can be operated continuously
as if set in the normal wiper stalk switch
position regardless of the knurled wheel
setting. For this reason, the vehicle
speed signal on the K-bus is not utilized
on rain sensor equipped wiper systems.
If the ignition switch is turned off with the
wiper switch in the intermittent position,
the rain sensor will only become active
after the ignition is switched back on and
one of the following occurs:
The stalk switch is moved from the
intermittent position and then back.
The knurled wheel setting is
adjusted.
The wash function is activated.
The reasoning behind this switching
strategy is to have the driver make a
conscious decision to activate the
system.
The rain sensor control module adapts
to the optics system environment as
follows:
Windshield aging: As the vehicle
ages, windshield pitting in the rain
sensor monitoring area may cause
a loss of light in the optics system.
The control module adapts for loss
of light based on the intensity of the
detected infrared light with a
cleared windshield. Therefore, rain
sensor function is not adversely
affected due to windshield aging.
Dirty windows: The rain sensor
adaptation reacts less sensitively to
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
a dirty windshield (dirt, road salt,
wax residue) after a completed wipe
cycle. A dirty windshield has a film
on it that diminishes the ability of
infrared to refract into water
droplets that are present. This
causes a delay in the rain sensor
detection capabilities which
lengthens the time intervals on an
intermittent wipe.
CAUTION!
On rain sensor equipped models,
make sure the wiper blades are in
perfect condition. Only use window
cleaner to clean the windshield.
Note:
A dirty windshield can cause the rain
sensor control module to set a fault due
to approaching limits of its adaptation
abilities.
Rain sensor system
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Rear window wiper/washer
system (Sport Wagon)
The rear wiper motor assembly in Sport
Wagon models is mounted in the tailgate
through a sound-insulating rubber
bushing.
The rear wiper/washer is controlled by
the wiper/washer steering column stalk
switch via the ZKE V system. The
functions of the system are:
Normal interval wipe
Programmed interval wipe
Continuous wipe
Washing
Normal operation is a timed interval of
approx. 7 seconds. This is triggered by
pressing the stalk switch forward to the
first detent. Full sweep and park position
of the wiper arm are recognized by two
hall sensors on the motor assembly. If
the wiper is switched OFF, the wiper arm
will return to the park position.
Programmed interval wipe:
Quickly switch rear wiper ON and
OFF.
Wait the needed interval time.
Switch rear wiper ON again.
The OFF time will be the programmed
interval, up to approx. 30 seconds.
Continuous wiping is activated any time
the rear wiper is on and the transmission
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
is in reverse. The signal is provided by
the back-up light switch via the LSZ (light
control module).
Rear window washing is activated when
the stalk switch is pushed forward past
the first detent:
Wash cycle 1. Washer pump ON for
1.5 seconds. Wiper ON 1 second
later.
Wash cycle 2. Washer pump ON for
0.5 second after 0.8 second delay.
Wiper continues.
Wash cycle 3. Washer pump ON for
0.5 second after 0.8 second delay.
Wiper ON for two wipe-dry cycles.
Note:
After washing, the rear wiper will remain
in interval (normal) wiping mode until
switched OFF.
Rear wiper/washer system
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:10 PM
Wipers and Washers
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
611-2
Wiper Blades
Wiper blade cleaning problems
Common cleaning problems with the
wipers include streaking or sheeting,
water drops after wiping, and blade
chatter.
CAUTION!
Never turn on the wiper blades while
the hood is open. Damage to the
wiper system and hood may occur.
To ensure safety during wiper
system repair procedures, remove
the windshield wiper fuse. See
610 Electrical Component Locations.
Streaking is usually caused when wiper
blades are coated with road film or car
wash wax. Clean the blades using
soapy water. If cleaning does not cure
the problem, the blades should be
replaced. BMW recommends replacing
the wiper blades twice a year, before
and after the cold season.
Water drops that remain behind after
wiping are usually caused by oil, road
film, or diesel exhaust residue on the
glass. Use an alcohol or ammonia
solution or a non-abrasive cleaner
(such as Bon-Ami®) to clean the
windshield.
Chatter may be caused by dirty or worn
blades, or by wiper arms that are out of
alignment. Clean the blades and
windshield as described above. Adjust
the wiper arm so that there is even
pressure along the blade, and so that
the blade at rest is perpendicular to the
windshield. If problems persist, the
blades and wiper arms should be
replaced.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Note:
BMW has available a special
tool/gauge (BMW special tool 00 9 210)
to align the angle of the wiper arm to
the windshield glass.
The wiper blades can be renewed in
one of two ways:
Complete blade replacement
Rubber insert replacement
Insert replacement is the most
economical method, although over time
the wiper blade itself will become worn.
One rule of thumb would be to replace
just the inserts every second time.
Wiper blades, replacing
To replace wiper blades:
Pivot wiper arm off windshield.
Position wiper blade approximately
perpendicular to wiper arm.
Remove wiper blade from wiper
arm by depressing retaining tab
(arrow) and sliding blade out of
arm.
Installation is reverse of removal.
Install wiper blade to wiper arm
until retaining tab can be heard to
click into position.
Note:
Some wiper blade versions may have
two retaining tabs.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Wiper blade inserts, replacing
To replace wiper inserts:
Remove wiper blade as described
earlier.
Unhook wiper blade insert from
wiper arm guide. If necessary,
guide slightly using needle nose
pliers.
Pull old insert from wiper arm
guides, noting installation position.
Remove metal support strips from
old insert and install into slots in
new insert, noting installation
direction of cutouts in support
strips.
Slide new insert through wiper
blade guides. Lock insert in place
at end guides.
Note:
The notched cutouts in the retaining
strips should engage the molded
notches in the inserts.
Wiper arms, removing and
installing
Note:
Wiper arm removal and installation
on the Sport Wagon rear window is
similar to the operation on the front
wiper arms.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
It may be necessary to raise the
engine hood to the service position
to access the front wiper arm
fasteners. See
410 Fenders,
Engine Hood.
CAUTION!
Make sure wipers are parked
(stalk switch in OFF position)
and the ignition is also OFF.
Use fender cover to protect
windshield.
-
With engine hood in closed
position, remove both wiper
blades.
-
Open hood. Gently pry off caps
covering wiper arm retaining nuts.
Remove each wiper arm retaining nut
(arrow). Detach arm from shaft.
Note:
Use BMW special tool 61 6 060 or
equivalent puller to remove arm.
If wiper arm sleeve (arrow) at shaft is
loose, it must be replaced.
-
Install arms and thread nuts on
loosely. Torque nuts after
installing wiper blades.
Tightening torque
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Tightening torque
Front wiper arm to
wiper shaft
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
Rear wiper arm to
wiper shaft
9.5 Nm (7 ft-lb)
-
Check to make sure blades are
positioned correctly Front wiper
arms should be installed with tips
to the right (passenger) side of the
vehicle. Measure distance of wiper
arms from lower portion of window
gasket with wiper blades installed
before tightening to correct torque.
Wiper blade park position
Front wiper blade tip distance from
windshield gasket
Right blade
24 mm (1 in.)
Left blade
44 mm (1.7 in.)
Rear wiper blade
tip distance from
rear window gasket
12 mm (1/2 in.)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
611-3
Wiper Assemblies
Windshield wiper assembly,
removing and installing
The windshield wiper assembly
(linkage and motor) is removed as a
single unit. Once the assembly is
removed, the wiper motor and other
linkage parts can be repaired or
replaced.
1 - Wiper assembly mounting nut
-tighten to 10 Nm (88 in-lb)
2 - Washer
3 - Damping ring
4 - Motor and rod assembly
5 - Rubber damper
6 - Center mounting bolt -tighten to
10 Nm (88 in-lb)
Note:
BMW does not provide the
windshield wiper motor as a
separate component.
It may be necessary to raise the
hood to the service position to
access the wiper arm fasteners.
See
410 Fenders, Engine Hood.
CAUTION!
Make sure wipers are parked
(stalk switch in OFF position)
and the ignition is also OFF.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Use fender cover to protect
windshield.
To avoid damaging the wiper
arms and pivots, do not
manually slide or force the wiper
arms across the windshield.
-
Remove wiper arms as described
earlier.
Remove housing for microfilter for
interior ventilation.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower microfilter housing.
Remove heater bulkhead cover.
Remove engine compartment side
trim panel. Turn locking knobs (A)
and slide trim panel from
mounting lip.
Remove heater bulkhead cover
mounting screws (B) and lift cover
up and out from firewall.
Detach wiper assembly inside cowl:
Remove assembly center
mounting bolt (A).
Disconnect electrical harness
connector (B).
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Remove right side wiper rod (arrow)
from transmission arm.
-
Release retaining clips and
remove windshield base trim tray.
Remove large nuts (arrow) at base of
wiper arm shafts in cowl panel.
Remove assembly.
Note:
Cover inside edges of cowl panel sheet
metal with thick tape to prevent damage
during wiper assembly removal.
Installation is reverse of removal, noting
the following:
Fit center mounting rubber
damper over pin (A) into wiper
motor mounting arm (B).
Install all fasteners finger-tight
first.
Once installed, wiper motor
should first be run to parked
position and switched off.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Next, install wiper arms but not
blades.
Close hood and fit wiper blades.
Recheck wiper blade position as
described earlier under
Wiper
arms, removing and installing.
Check all electrical harness
fittings and sealing grommets for
correct reinstallation. Replace any
wire ties cut off during removal.
Tightening torques
Center wiper
assembly mount to
cowl
10 Nm (88 in-lb)
Wiper arm to wiper
shaft
30 Nm (22 ft-lb)
Wiper shaft nut at
cowl
10 Nm (88 in-lb)
Rear window wiper motor,
removing and installing (Sport
Wagon)
-
Remove rear deck interior trim
panel.
Detach electrical harness connector(s)
and remove screws mounting motor
assembly to rear deck lid. Remove
motor assembly.
1 - Plastic trim
2 - Rear wiper pivot assembly
3 - Nut M6 -tighten to 9.5 Nm (7 ft-lb)
4 - Mechanical coupling
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
5 - Wiper motor assembly
6 - Torx bolt M6 -tighten to 9.5 Nm (7
ft-lb)
7 - Damper ring
8 - Mounting sleeve
9 - Rear wiper motor assembly
-
To install:
Remove rear window lock
assembly from rear deck.
Install wiper motor assembly and
thread mounting bolts finger tight.
Place BMW special tool 61 1 330
on rear window wiper drive and
close rear window.
With rear wiper vertical, allow rear
wiper shaft mechanical coupling to
snap into special tool bore.
Tighten down wiper motor
assembly.
Remove special tool.
Remainder of assembly is reverse
of removal.
Tightening torque
Wiper motor to
rear deck (Torx)
9.5 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Rear window wiper shaft,
removing and installing (Sport
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Wagon)
-
Remove rear wiper arm.
-
Lift rear window and remove wiper
shaft housing plastic trim covers.
-
Remove housing mounting nuts.
Remove housing.
-
Slacken rear window lift nut.
Remove wiper shaft assembly
mounting nut (arrow). Pull shaft and
bearing out of housing.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Adjust wiper arm position as
described earlier.
Tightening torques
Rear window
button to rear
window
9.5 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Wiper arm to wiper
shaft
9.5 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Wiper shaft
housing to rear
window
9.5 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
611-4
Washer Systems
The windshield washer system
includes the heated spray nozzles in
the engine hood, the washer fluid
pump, and the washer fluid reservoir in
the front passenger side of the engine
compartment.
The headlight washer system (optional)
consists of the front washer fluid tank
(shared with the windshield washer
system), a separate washer pump and
spray nozzles in the front bumper.
The rear window washer system (Sport
Wagon only) consists of a washer tank
and pump in the right side cargo
compartment behind a trim panel and a
spray nozzle at the top of the rear
window frame.
Windshield spray nozzle,
removing and installing
Working under open engine hood,
gently squeeze retaining clips (arrows)
on nozzle sides to free nozzle from
plastic intake grille.
-
Carefully disconnect hose from
nozzle. Disconnect harness
connector for nozzle heater.
Installation is reverse of removal:
Check and adjust nozzles before
driving. Use diagram.
1a - 265 mm (10.4 in)
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
1b - 445 mm (17.5 in.)
2a - 400 mm (15.7 in.)
2b - 270 mm (10.6 in.)
3a - 260 mm (10.2 in.)
3b - 550 mm (21.7 in.)
4a - 500 mm (19.6 in.)
4b - 350 mm (13.8 in.)
Note:
The windshield spray nozzles can be
aimed by using a sewing needle or a
similar diameter stiff piece of wire.
Headlight washer spray nozzle,
removing and installing
Note:
Headlight nozzles are marked L or R on
the underside. Do not mix them up.
-
Prior to removal, cover spray
nozzle with shop rag. Wash water
drains out.
-
Gently pry out spray nozzle and
pull out to stop. Tug on nozzle to
detach from washer fluid duct.
-
Transfer trim to new nozzle before
installing.
-
Snap new nozzle on fluid duct by
pushing into opening. Check to
make sure nozzle is fully snapped
into place.
Using BMW special tool 00 9 100 or
equivalent, adjust headlight washers
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
so that spray jets strike approximately
in center of each beam (arrows).
Note:
To turn on headlight washer jets, turn
on ignition, lights and windshield
washer system. To repeat spray
procedure, turn off ignition, then back
on again. Otherwise the headlight
washers are disabled for 3 minutes.
Front washer fluid reservoir
and washer fluid pumps,
replacing
-
Open hood and siphon washer
fluid from reservoir.
Detach washer fluid level sensor
harness connector (A) in front bottom
of fluid reservoir. Remove reservoir
retaining screw (arrow).
Lift reservoir. Pry gently at retaining clip
(arrow) on heat shield to disengage
from reservoir.
-
Cut off wire tie to release washer
pump harness from heat shield.
Lay heat shield aside.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
To remove windshield washer pump
(arrow) and headlight washer pump if
equipped:
Disconnect electrical connection at
pump.
Twist pump clockwise.
Pull pump out of reservoir.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Twist washer fluid level sensor
clockwise to remove from base of
reservoir.
Transfer reservoir cover and
strainer to new container.
Coat fluid pump sealing ring with
anti-friction agent.
On installation check that fluid
hoses are not kinked.
Make sure reservoir heat shield is
correctly engaged. Replace wire
tie.
Refill reservoir.
Front washer fluid level sensor,
replacing
Remove front washer fluid reservoir:
Twist washer fluid level sensor
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
(arrow) clockwise to remove from
base of reservoir.
Installation is reverse of removal.
Rear window spray nozzle,
removing and installing (Sport
Wagon)
-
Use plastic prying tool to lever
nozzle out of rubber strip at top of
rear window.
-
Push new nozzle into rubber strip.
Adjust nozzle spray pattern using
alignment specifications.
Rear window spray nozzle
alignment specifications
A
100 mm (3.9 in.)
B
320 mm (12.6 in.)
Rear window washer fluid
reservoir, replacing (Sport
Wagon)
-
Working in right rear cargo area,
remove side trim panel, then
remove sound insulation.
-
Siphon out washer fluid reservoir.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Wipers and Washers
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
To remove tank:
Detach filling and pressure hoses
(A).
Remove washer pump electrical
harness connector (B).
Loosen mounting nuts at bottom
of tank (C) slightly.
Remove top mounting nut (D) and
remove reservoir.
-
To remove fluid pump:
Detach electrical harness
connector (B).
Pry pump gently outward and up
to remove from tank.
-
When installing:
Coat pump sealing ring with
anti-friction agent.
Make sure hoses are not kinked.
Refill reservoir.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:11 PM
Switches
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
612-1
General
This section covers replacement of
electrical switches at the steering
wheel, steering column, dashboard,
pedal cluster, center console and other
locations.
See also the following sections:
119 Lubrication System for
information on testing the oil
pressure switch
250 Gearshift Linkage for
information about the gearshift
lever
515 Central Locking and
Anti-theft for information about the
electronic immobilization system
(EWS 3.3)
520 Seats for information
about power seat controls
540 Sunroof
541 Convertible Top
610 Electrical Component
Locations
630 Lights
Electrical Wiring Diagrams.
Special tools
A few special tools are necessary for
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
the repairs detailed in this section.
Plastic prying tool BMW 00 9 321
Ignition cylinder removal tool BMW 32 3
110
Ring antenna removal tool BMW 61 3
300
CAUTION!
When working on electrical
switches or lights, always
disconnect the negative (-) cable
from the battery and insulate the
cable end to prevent accidental
reconnection.
Prior to disconnecting the
battery, read the battery
disconnection cautions given at
the front of this manual on page
viii.
To prevent marring the trim
when working on interior
components, work with plastic
prying tools or wrap the tips of
screwdrivers and pliers with
tape before prying out switches
or electrical accessories.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
612-2
Steering Wheel Switches
E46 vehicles are equipped with either
the multi-function (MFL) steering wheel
or the sports steering wheel.
Incorporated into each steering wheel
are an SRS airbag, horn contacts,
selected cellular phone and radio
controls and cruise control buttons.
To replace the steering wheel switches,
remove the airbag first. See
721
Airbag System (SRS).
WARNING!
Improper handling of the airbag
could cause serious injury. Store the
airbag with the horn pad facing up. If
stored facing down, accidental
deployment could propel it violently
into the air, causing injury.
CAUTION!
Special test equipment is required to
retrieve SRS fault codes, diagnose
system faults, and reset/turn off the
SRS indicator light. The SRS
indicator light will remain on until
any problem has been corrected and
the fault memory has been cleared.
Multi-function (MFL) steering
wheel switches, accessing
Remove airbag.
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Detach electrical harness connectors
1 - Cruise control/radio/telephone
electrical harness
2 - Horn button electrical harness
3 - Airbag electrical harness
4 - Radio/telephone control switch set
5 - Airbag
6 - Cruise control switch set
-
Remove small screws on back
side of airbag pad to release left
or right switch set.
Note:
BMW does not provide the horn contact
switch as a separate part.
Sport steering wheel switches,
accessing
Remove airbag.
Note:
There is a special procedure for
detaching the airbag from the sport
steering wheel. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
Remove screws mounting switch carrier
to steering wheel.
1 - Switch carrier
2 - Steering wheel switch set
electrical harness
3 - Airbag
4 - Lower cover
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
5 - Horn button and airbag electrical
harness
-
Pull switch carrier and trim down
to detach from steering wheel.
Remove electrical harness
connector.
-
Separate bottom trim piece from
switch carrier.
Note:
BMW does not provide the horn contact
switch as a separate part.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
612-3
Steering Column
Switches
To remove any of the steering column
switches, it is necessary to first remove
the upper and lower column trim
pieces. See
513 Interior Trim.
CAUTION!
To prevent marring interior trim,
work with plastic prying tools or
wrap the tips of screwdrivers and
pliers with tape before prying out
switches or electrical accessories.
Ignition lock cylinder,
removing and installing
To remove the EWS ring antenna prior
to removing ignition lock cylinder, it is
necessary to remove the upper and
lower steering column trim. Use BMW
special tool 61 3 300 to force off the
ring antenna. Alternatively, remove the
ignition switch key cylinder first.
With ignition key in ON position (60°
from LOCKED):
Insert a thin piece of stiff wire into
opening (arrow) in lock cylinder
and pull lock cylinder out.
Detach ring antenna harness
connector.
Gently work ring antenna off key
cylinder.
Reinstallation is reverse of
removal.
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Steering column stalk switch
assembly, removing and
installing
To replace either the
directional/headlight dimmer stalk
switch or the wiper/washer stalk switch,
you must first remove the entire stalk
switch assembly from the steering
column.
CAUTION!
To prevent marring interior trim,
work with plastic prying tools or
wrap the tips of screwdrivers and
pliers with tape before prying out
switches or electrical accessories.
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover terminal with
insulating material.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove airbag unit from steering
wheel. See
721 Airbag System
(SRS). Store airbag unit in a safe
place with pad facing up.
WARNING!
Any work involving the SRS system
should only be performed by an
authorized BMW dealer. Making
repairs without the proper
knowledge and special test
equipment may cause serious
personal injury. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS)
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
With front wheels pointed straight
ahead, remove steering wheel.
See
320 Steering and Wheel
Alignment.
Note:
To help with reassembly, mark steering
wheel and spindle shaft before
disassembly.
-
Remove steering column trim.
See
513 Interior Trim.
Detach EWS ring antenna electrical
harness connector (arrow).
Detach wiper/washer switch electrical
harness connector (arrow).
Detach turn signal/headlight dimmer
switch electrical harness connector
(arrow).
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Detach airbag electrical harness
connector (arrow).
Remove stalk switch housing retaining
screws (arrows). Slide switch housing
off steering column.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Place turn signal indicator in
center position before installing.
Ensure that self cancelling cams
on turn signal switch are not
damaged during installation.
Tightening torque
Steering wheel to
steering column
spindle shaft
63 Nm (46 ft-lb)
Turn signal/headlight dimmer
switch/ wiper switch removing
and installing
-
After removing steering column
stalk switch assembly, as
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
described above, turn switch
assembly face-down on work
bench.
Squeeze locking tabs (arrows) on
sides of switch and slide switch out of
assembly holder.
-
Push in new switch until it
positively snaps into switch
housing.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:12 PM
Switches
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
612-4
Pedal Cluster Switches
To access either the brake pedal or the
clutch pedal switch, remove the left
footwell trim (above pedals). See
513 Interior Trim.
Brake light switch, replacing
Working at pedal cluster:
Detach electrical harness
connector (arrow) from brake light
switch.
Slide switch out of holder (toward
rear of car).
Note:
The brake light switch is held in place
via a serrated mounting. Remove
switch mounting from pedal cluster
bracket.
-
Push brake pedal down, install
new switch, then allow brake
pedal to spring back slowly,
automatically adjusting switch
position.
Cruise control clutch switch,
replacing
-
Working at pedal cluster:
Push clutch pedal to floor and
lock in position using a pedal stop.
Detach electrical harness
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Switches
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
connector from switch.
Squeeze together retaining clips
at front of switch. Slide switch out
of holder (toward rear of car).
-
Install new switch, then allow
clutch pedal to spring back slowly,
automatically adjusting switch
position.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Switches
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
612-5
Other Interior Switches
Many of the remaining electrical
switches are housed at the bottom
center of the dashboard, or in the
center console.
The ASC or DCS switch is ahead of the
shifter console at the bottom of the
center dashboard. When equipped,
seat heater switches are in the same
location.
The right front and right rear window
switches are ganged into one unit on
the right side of the shifter. The left
front and left rear window switches are
ganged with the child safety rear
window lockout switch (sedan and
Sport Wagon models) on the left side
of the shifter.
The central locking switch and hazard
warning switch are ganged into one
unit behind the shifter mechanism.
Replacement of the above switches is
covered below, noting when each
switch is accessible.
The left and right electric outside rear
view mirrors are controlled by one
switch on the driver door armrest.
Lower dashboard/console
switches, replacing
-
Remove shift knob by pulling knob
straight off the gearshift lever.
Note:
Removal of the shift knob will require
about 90 lbs. of force. Do not twist knob
or locating key can be damaged.
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Switches
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Pry up on rear of shift boot/bezel
to unclip, then remove boot from
front retainers.
Remove retaining screws (arrows)
under transmission selector boot/trim.
Power window switches, replacing
-
To remove left or right ganged
window switches:
Shifter bezel: Lift up by prying
gently.
Shifter boot: Unclip bottom of boot
from center console trim by
pushing forward. Pull boot up
around shifter, but do not remove.
Unclip switch retainer (A) and pull out
switches from under console trim.
Detach electrical harness
connector (B) from switches.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Switches
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
ASC/DSC/seat heater switches,
replacing
Either the ASC or DSC switch is
located in the storage
compartment/ash tray housing. Seat
heater switches are also located here,
if equipped.
This procedure can be skipped in order
to access center console switches.
Remove storage compartment below
IHKA control panel:
Open compartment door.
Push upward in center of
compartment, then pull out.
-
Remove retaining screws from
storage compartment/ash tray
housing.
-
Slide housing out and disconnect
electrical harness connectors.
Remove housing from lower
dashboard
-
With housing removed slide
switches out of housing by gently
pushing from behind.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Central locking/hazard warning
switches, replacing
Working at rear of center console,
press rolling cover of rear ashtray
down. Depress cover fully to pop
ashtray out of console. Remove
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Switches
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
ashtray.
-
Remove retaining screws and
storage tray housing. Disconnect
electrical harness connector for
storage tray courtesy light.
-
Remove screws at base of storage
tray compartment in console.
Unclip trim boot for parking brake lever
and pull boot and handle forward off
brake lever.
-
Slide center console back from
dash and lift up.
Disconnect electrical harness protector
from hazard light/central locking
switch.
-
To remove switch from console,
depress retaining tabs on each
side of switch and push switch out
through surface of console trim.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Outside mirror switch,
replacing
Carefully pry outside mirror switch from
door arm rest.
-
Disconnect harness connector
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Switches
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
from switch.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Instruments
1 of 1
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
620-1
General
This repair group covers removal and
installation of the instrument cluster.
Instrument cluster self-test procedures
are also included.
Special tools
Individual instrument cluster
components are not available. Since
instrument clusters are only available
as complete units, BMW recommends
no special tools.
Würth Stabilant® 22A Electrical contact
enhancer
Experience has found that the use of
an electrical contact enhancer will help
prevent oxidation and intermittent
circuit malfunctions at electrical
harness connectors.
CAUTION!
When servicing the instrument
cluster, always disconnect the
negative (-) cable from the battery
and insulate the cable end to prevent
accidental reconnection.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:13 PM
Instruments
1 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
620-2
Instrument Cluster
The dashboard mounted instrument
cluster is the control and information
center of the E46 cars. It is connected
to most of the systems and sensors in
the car through the use of "bus"
networks:
K-bus connects to Central Body
Electronics (ZKE V) functions,
heating/A/C (IHKA), rain sensor
system, exterior and interior lights,
Multiple Restraint System (MRS
III), and Driveway Protection (EWS
III).
CAN-bus connects to engine
management (DME), transmission
control (AGS) and traction/stability
control (ASC/DSC).
D-bus connects to 20-pin
Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC)
and/or 16-pin OBD II diagnostic
connector.
The instrument cluster stores and
communicates Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs) via the D-bus diagnostic
link.
If the vehicle is equipped with
On-Board Computer, pushing the
button at the end of the directional
stalk switch brings up on the cluster
information of interest to the driver:
Time
Outside temperature
Average fuel consumption
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
2 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Cruising range
Average vehicle speed
These functions are more fully
explained in the Owner's Manual.
The cluster also stores important
vehicle memory functions such as total
mileage and service interval data.
Instrument cluster replacement must
be followed by special procedures,
using BMW scan tools DIS or MoDiC or
equivalent, to synchronize vehicle
memory and mileage with the new
cluster unit.
Note:
Specific vehicle information is stored
redundantly in the instrument cluster
and the light control module. This
information includes: Vehicle
identification number (VIN), Total
vehicle mileage, and Service interval
data.
Instrument cluster layout
The instrument cluster uses stepper
motor driven analog gauges for display
of engine and road speed, engine
temperature, fuel level and economy.
1 - Fuel Gauge
2 - Left directional
3 - Tachometer
4 - Alternator warning light
5 - High beam warning
6 - Oil warning light
7 - Speedometer
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
3 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
8 - Right directional
9 - Temperature gauge
10 - Warning lights (Check Engine,
etc.)
11 - Left reset button
(odometer/service interval)
12 - Check Control LCD
13 - Odometer/On-Board Computer
LCD
14 - ASC/DSC warning light
15 - Fuel economy gauge
16 - Transmission range/ program LCD
(includes transmission fault
indicator)
17 - Right reset button (clock)
18 - Warning lights (brakes, etc.)
In addition, three LCD blocks display:
Check Control pictographs
Service interval and mileage
(On-Board Computer)
Automatic transmission
range/program and failure display
Warning indicators and lamps are
arranged to the right and left of the
LCD blocks. The ASC/DSC light,
charge indicator, high beam and oil
pressure lamps are located between
the speedometer and tachometer.
The instrument cluster is a sealed unit
and contains no serviceable
components.
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
4 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
E46 instrument cluster
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
5 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Instrument cluster, self-testing
In addition to the storing diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) and
communicating through the diagnostic
link, the instrument cluster is
programmed with a series of test menus
that can be accessed to check various
functions and values. The
odometer/On-Board Computer LCD
block is used to display the test menus
and results. There are a total of 21 test
menus.
Table a. Instrument cluster test
functions lists instrument cluster test
menus and submenus.
To scroll through numbered test menus:
Make sure ignition switch is OFF.
Press and hold left cluster button.
Turn ignition switch to "radio". Test
1 main menu will be displayed.
Do nothing and display will
automatically scroll through Test 1
submenus.
Tap or press instrument cluster left
button. This signals cluster to
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
6 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
display submenus or continue on to
next main test menu.
Note:
Tests 1 and 2 are always unlocked.
Tests 3 - 21 are only accessible
after unlocking the test function.
Test 19 is the unlock function for
accessing the displays.
If adjustment is necessary, enter
into Test 20 using the cluster button.
The correction factor number is
changed by using the sub-menus for
the 1s, 10s and 100s of the factor
number. The digits will automatically
scroll through 0 - 9 within each
group (1s, 10s, 100s).
Table a. Instrument cluster test functions
Menu
Submenu
Sample
output
Meaning
Test 1: Vehicle
specific data (see
Note below)
1.0
12345
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
1.1
4812
Body number
6_1.2
834762
Part number of cluster
1.3
010203
Coding/diagnosis/bus index
1.4
3499
Manufacturing date (calendar
week/year)
1.5
04_600
Hardware/software version of cluster
(hardware = 04, software = 6.00)
3_1.6
415_06
Injection status, number of
cylinders, engine factor
1.7
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
7 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Menu
Submenu
Sample
output
Meaning
Test 2: Cluster system test - activates gauge drivers, indicators and LEDs to confirm function
(see Note)
Test 3: SI data
3.0
1500
Liters
3.1
0
Periodic inspection days (not
applicable for US)
4.0
0267
26.7 liters/1000km
4.1
0073
7.3 liters/hour
Test 5: Fuel
5.0
consumed/distance
5.1
traveled
0195
9.5 liters/100 km
226
Distance left to go (226 km)
237415
Fuel level averaged
Test 4: Fuel
consumption data
(current)
Test 6: Fuel level
sensor input in
liters
6.0
Left side fuel sensor input =
23.7 liters
Right side fuel sensor input =
41.5 liters
6.1
0652
Total tank level averaged = 65.2
liters
1_6.2
0667
Indicated value and tank phase
1 = Both sensors OK
2 = One sensor faulty
3 = Implausible input
Test 7:
Temperature and
speed
7.0
032
Coolant temperature input = 32°C
7.1
245
Outside temperature input = 24.5°C
7.2
5283
Engine speed = 5,283 RPM
7.3
058
Vehicle speed = 58 km/h
XXX
HEX code, instrument cluster inputs
Test 8: Input
8.0 - 8.3
values in HEX code
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
8 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Menu
Submenu
Sample
output
Meaning
Test 9: Battery
voltage
9.0
125
12.5 volts
Test 10: Country
coding
10.0
02
US (= 02)
Test 11: Cluster
code
11.0
000003
Cluster code
13.0
"Gong"
Activate gong by pressing button
(gong response is delayed).
L-ON
Display changes from L-ON to
L-OFF every second. To unlock test
functions, press cluster button
immediately when it changes to
L-OFF. Tests are automatically
locked when exiting test functions.
Test 12: Not used
Test 13: Gong test
Test 14 Fault memory (not for diagnosis)
Tests 15 - 18: Not used
Test 19:
Lock/unlock (see
Note)
Test 20: Average
fuel consumption
correction factor
(see Note)
Test 21: Software
reset
19.0
L-OFF
20.0
XXX9
Press button when correct 1s
position is attained.
20.1
XX5X
Press button when correct 10s
position is attained.
20.2
12XX
Press button when correct 100s
position is attained.
21.0
reset
Reset software
Instrument cluster, removing
and installing
Remove instrument cluster retaining
screws (arrows).
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Instruments
9 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Place a towel over steering column.
Carefully tilt top of cluster out of dash
panel. Unlock and disconnect harness
connectors (arrows) from back of
cluster.
Note:
Steering wheel does not need to be
removed to remove instrument cluster.
If it is necessary to replace cluster,
detach trim by unlocking plastic clips
(arrows) and pushing through slots.
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Instrument cluster harness
connector locking levers must be in
up position before installing
connector.
Recode new or replacement cluster
using BMW scan tools DISplus,
MoDiC or equivalent.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
630-1
General
This repair group covers interior and
exterior lighting, including repairs to the
light switch assembly.
Special tools
Some special tools may be necessary
to install or adjust lights and light
fixtures.
Plastic trim prying tool BMW 00 9 321
Foglight/headlight adjusting tool 4
mm/6 mm Allen
Bulb applications
For convenience, the bulb applications
for E46 cars are listed in
Table a.
Table a. E46 bulb applications
Location
Type & rating
Headlights
High beam
H7 12V 55W
Low beam
(Halogen)
H7 12 V 55 W
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table a. E46 bulb applications
Location
Type & rating
Low bean (Xenon)
D2-S
Foglights
Front
HB4
Rear (Euro only)
12V 21W
Turn signal and taillight
Back-up
12V 21W
Brake
12V 21W
Brake/taillight
12V 21/4W
Licence plate
12V 5W
Side turn signal
W5W
Third brake light
LED
Turn signal (front
or rear)
12V 21W
Interior lights
Footwell
Softlite 5W
Glove compartment Softlite 5 W
Passenger
compartment, front
or rear
Softlite 5W
Reading, front or
rear
6W
Trunk or tailgate
Softlite 10W
Visor vanity
Softlite 10W
Light switch center (LSZ)
The light switch center (LSZ), mounted
in the left side of the dashboard,
consists of the following components:
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Headlight/taillight/running light
control switch
Foglight switch
Instrument dimmer control
Light control module
In addition to normal light control, the
LSZ provides the following functions:
Hot and cold monitoring of the
exterior bulbs
Emergency lighting function
Short circuit protection
Redundant storage of mileage
and service interval data
Automatic headlight adjustment
(LWR) programmed control (if
equipped)
Bulb monitoring
The light control module monitors the
following bulbs in both hot and cold
states:
High/low beams
Brake lights
Turn signal lights
Taillights
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Parking lights
Side marker lights
License plate lights
Hot and cold monitoring of light bulbs
allows the LSZ to detect defective
bulbs. Hot monitoring checks the
continuity of circuits while the lights are
switched on. Cold monitoring consists
of a brief pulse of current which is too
short for the lights to illuminate.t If the
module detects a defective bulb, a
signal is sent to the instrument cluster
and Check Control is illuminated with
the appropriate warning.
Home lighting
This convenience feature provides
lighting for the driver and passengers
to leave the vehicle and enter their
house. The feature is switched on by
activating the headlight flasher switch
after the lights and ignition are
switched OFF. The feature is switched
off after the coded time delay or by
switching the ignition ON.
Redundant data storage
The light control module serves as the
redundant storage module in parallel
with the instrument cluster. This
includes all data used for vehicle
identification, encoded on the
assembly line. In addition the total
mileage and service interval data are
also stored in the light control module.
If either the instrument cluster or light
control module has to be replaced, the
data is taken from the remaining
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
module and transferred to the
replacement unit.
Emergency (fail safe) lighting
The light control module provides
emergency lighting in the event of an
electronic module failure. Back up
hardware allows the following lighting
circuits to function:
Low beam headlights
Taillights
Brake lights
The headlights and taillights come on
as soon as the ignition is switched ON.
The brake light operates when the
brake pedal is pressed.
WARNING!
When working on electrical systems,
remove the fuse protecting the
circuit under repair. See
610
Electrical Component Locations.
CAUTION!
The headlight and foglight
assemblies use halogen bulbs.
To ensure the longevity of
halogen bulbs, the bulb glass
should not be handled. Dirt and
skin oils may cause a bulb to fail
prematurely. If necessary wipe
bulb using a clean cloth
dampened with rubbing alcohol.
Use only original equipment
replacement bulbs. Non-original
equipment bulbs may cause
false failure readings on the
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Check Control display.
To avoid marring car paint or
trim, work with plastic prying
tools or wrap the tips of tools
with tape.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
630-2
Light Switch
Light switch assembly,
removing and installing
Pry gently at left dashboard trim to
remove.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring interior trim, work
with a plastic prying tool.
Remove light switch mounting screws
(arrows).
-
Lift switch slightly and withdraw
from dashboard.
Note:
If the vehicle is equipped with a left
side glove compartment, remove
the compartment for improved
access to the back of the headlight
switch and its electrical harness.
Remove the left side footwell trim
(above the pedals) for better
access to the headlight switch
electrical harness. See
513
Interior Trim.
To release harness connector latch:
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Swing latch backward (arrow).
Pull electrical harness connector
off switch assembly.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Light control module,
separating
-
Remove light switch assembly as
described earlier.
Press in on tabs (arrows) in light
switch assembly to separate light
switch from light control module.
Gently wiggle harness connector to
remove from switch.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:14 PM
Lights
1 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
630-3
Headlights
E46 cars are equipped with Halogen
headlights as standard equipment.
Halogen bulb replacement is
performed from the back (engine) side
of the headlight assembly. The front
face of each headlight assembly is a
removable plastic cover.
Optional Xenon low-beam headlights
illuminate the road ahead and to the
sides in greater detail than
conventional headlights. Sometimes
referred to as High Intensity Discharge
(HID) lights, Xenon lights use less
energy and last longer than other
headlight bulbs.
Cars equipped with Xenon headlights
also feature automatic headlight
adjustment control (LWR) for varying
passenger and cargo loads.
Components of the headlight system
can be purchased from BMW. Use
illustrations on the following pages to
identify components.
Headlight aim, adjusting
Adjust headlight aim with correct tire
pressures, fuel tank full, and weight of
one person (approx. 75 Kg/200 lb) in
driver seat.
Use 6 mm Allen wrench, phillips head
screwdriver, or hand to adjust
headlight by turning adjusting knobs.
A is primarily for lateral
adjustment.
B is primarily for vertical
adjustment.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
2 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Note:
When adjusting headlights with
automatic adjuster system (LWR), wait
at least 30 seconds for the LWR to
cycle and adjust to its calculated
position.
Halogen headlight
assembly
1
- Mounting screw
2
- Expanding nut
3
- High beam
cover
4
- High beam bulb
5
- High beam bulb
socket
6
- Low beam bulb
socket
7
- Low beam bulb
8
- Low beam cover
9
- Headlight
housing
10 - Sealing gasket
11 - Cover
12 - Cover lock strip
Xenon headlight
asembly
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
3 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
1
- Automatic
headlight
adjustment
(LWR) stepper
motor
2
- Electrical
harness
connector
3
- Expanding nut
4
- Mounting screw
5
- Xenon bulb
control module
6
- Control module
bracket
7
- High beam
cover
8
- High beam bulb
9
- High beam bulb
socket
10 - Low beam cover
11 - Xenon bulb
ignition element
12 - Supporting ring
13 - Xenon low beam
bulb
14 - Headlight
assembly carrier
plate
15 - Headlight
housing
16 - Sealing gasket
17 - Cover
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
4 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
18 - Cover lock strip
Headlight bulb (Halogen),
replacing
Working in back of headlight assembly:
Rotate headlight bulb retaining ring
(arrows) counterclockwise.
Pull bulb socket and bulb out of
headlight assembly.
Disconnect harness connector from
socket.
Gently wiggle bulb and pull straight
out of socket.
Replace bulb by pushing firmly into
socket. Headlight bulb applications
are listed below.
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note:
To remove left side high beam bulb,
remove air filter housing cover. See
020 Maintenance.
CAUTION!
Do not touch halogen bulbs with your
bare hands. If necessary wipe bulb
using a clean cloth dampened with
rubbing alcohol.
Headlight bulb (Xenon),
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
5 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
replacing
-
Working in back of headlight
assembly:
Remove low beam (Xenon) cover.
Twist Xenon ignition element
counterclockwise and remove.
Rotate headlight bulb retaining ring
counterclockwise. Pull bulb out of
headlight assembly.
Installation is reverse of removal.
Headlight bulb applications are
listed below.
CAUTION!
Do not touch bulbs with your bare
hands. If necessary wipe bulb using a
clean cloth dampened with rubbing
alcohol.
Headlight bulb application
Low beam
(Halogen)
Low bean (Xenon)
High beam
H7 12V 55W
D2-S
H7 12V 55W
Headlight assembly, removing
and installing
CAUTION!
Following headlight assembly work,
headlight beam aim must be adjusted
using special equipment.
-
Disconnect harness connectors
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
6 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
from headlight assembly.
-
If necessary, remove headlight
washer spray nozzles. See
611
Wipers and Washers.
-
Remove front turn signal assembly
as described later in this repair
group.
Use plastic prying tool to detach and
remove trim piece below headlight
assembly.
Remove headlight mounting screws
(arrows). Lift headlight assembly
forward and out of car.
During reassembly:
Install top mounting screws hand
tight.
Pull headlight assembly toward
front of car.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
7 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Close engine hood and check to
make sure that gap between hood
and headlight assembly (A) is
correct. See specification below.
Open hood and tighten down
mounting screws.
Remainder of assembly is reverse
of removal.
Headlight to hood gap
Dimension A
-
5.0 ± 1.0 mm
(0.2 0.± 04 in.)
Adjust headlight aim as described
earlier.
Headlight lens, removing and
installing
-
If necessary, remove headlight
611
washer spray nozzles. See
Wipers and Washers.
-
Remove front turn signal assembly
as described later in this repair
group.
Use plastic prying tool to detach and
remove trim piece below headlight
assembly.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
8 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Unclip sealing gasket (arrows) and
remove.
Release clips (arrows) retaining front
lens.
Pull lens forward to remove.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Replace gasket between lens and
body of light if necessary.
Automatic headlight adjustment
(LWR)
Vehicles equipped with the optional
Xenon low-beam headlight bulbs also
feature automatic headlight adjustment
(LWR). This system automatically
adjusts the vertical positioning of the
headlights to maintain optimum
headlight beam angle for maximum
driving visibility and to prevent undue
glare for oncoming motorists. The
system compensates for vehicle load
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
9 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
angle changes.
LWR monitors vehicle load via two hall
effect sensors mounted to the front and
rear suspension members. When an
adjustment to the angle of the headlight
beams is necessary, LWR
simultaneously activates two stepper
motors (one in each headlight
assembly). The stepper motors drive a
threaded rod that moves the lower edge
of the headlight carrier plates. The
pivoting movement adjusts the vertical
position of the headlight beams.
At each axle of the vehicle, the LWR
sensor (A) is mounted to a fixed point on
the suspension subframe. A lever (B) is
connected to the moving suspension
member. The sensor output voltage
changes as the suspension moves up
and down.
All LWR diagnosis is accessed through
the light control module.
Note:
LWR is not available with standard
halogen headlights.
Headlight vertical aim
system components
1
- Bolt M5
2
- Right front ride
height sensor
mounting
bracket
3
- Self-locking nut
M6
4
- Front ride
height sensor
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
10 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
5
- Front ride
height sensor
link
6
- Self-locking nut
M8
7
- Bolt M5
8
- Right rear ride
height sensor
mounting
bracket
9
- Bolt M6
10 - Rear ride height
sensor
11 - Self-locking nut
M6
12 - Rear ride height
sensor link
13 - Extension
14 - Bracket
15 - Bolt M6
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
630-4
Front Foglights
Foglight aim, adjusting
Sedan or Sport Wagon: Use 4 mm
Allen wrench to turn plastic adjuster
(arrow) on outer edge of foglight.
Coupe or Convertible: Use adjuster
(arrow) on inside upper edge of
foglight.
2001 models:
Using plastic pry tool, pry off
foglight cover at slot (arrow).
Adjust using 6 mm Allen on
outside upper corner of foglight.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Foglight assembly, removing
and installing
Sedan or Sport Wagon:
Use plastic prying tool to lever out
foglight assembly.
Detach electrical harness
connector.
-
Coupe or Convertible:
Gently remove lower bumper trim.
Working at foglight, detach grille
and loosen mounting screws.
Remove foglight assembly with
grille attached.
Detach electrical harness
connector.
Unclip grille from foglight.
1 - Grille
2 - Foglight
3 - Adjuster
4 - Support with grommet
5 - Foglight bulb
6 - Body nut
7 - Self-tapping screw
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Installation is reverse of removal,
noting the following:
Sedan/Sport Wagon: Foglight
must be snapped firmly into
bumper retainers.
Coupe/Convertible: Keep
ventilation grommets unkinked
and firmly seated.
Adjust foglight aim as described
earlier.
Foglight bulb, replacing
-
Remove foglight assembly as
described earlier.
Twist and remove bulb from rear
of foglight assembly.
CAUTION!
Do not touch halogen bulbs with
your bare hands. If necessary wipe
bulb using a clean cloth dampened
with rubbing alcohol.
Installation is reverse of removal.
Check electrical connector for
corrosion. Spray with contact
cleaner, if necessary.
Foglight application
Front foglight bulb
HB4
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
630-5
Turn Signals, Taillights
Front turn signal assembly,
removing and installing
The procedure below also includes
turn signal bulb replacement.
With engine hood open, use a
screwdriver to press turn signal
assembly retaining clip down to
disengage from retaining tab on
headlight assembly frame.
Screwdriver must reach into fender
hole a minimum of 3 in. to reach the
retaining tab.
-
Push turn signal forward. Light
slides straight out.
-
Detach electrical harness
connector.
-
Twist and remove bulb from rear
of turn signal assembly.
CAUTION!
Do not touch bulb with your bare
hands. If necessary wipe bulb using
a clean cloth dampened with rubbing
alcohol.
Note:
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Before reinstalling, make sure rubber
seal on wrap-around trim (underneath
headlights) is firmly glued to trim.
Reglue if necessary.
Front turn signal
Turn signal bulb
12V 21W
Side turn signal assembly
The yellow marker lights on the sides
of the front fenders are turn signals.
Use plastic prying tool to gently lever
assembly out of fender.
Side turn signal
Side light bulb
12V 5W
Taillight assembly, removing
and installing
Taillight assembly
1 - Backup light bulb 12V 21W
2 - Rear foglight bulb (Euro only) 12V
21W
3 - Trunk lid/tailgate bulb carrier
4 - Trunk light bulb 12V 10W
5 - Taillight/brake light bulb 12V
21/4W
6 - Turn signal bulb 12V 21W
7 - Brake light bulb 12V 21W
8 - Corner bulb carrier
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
In E46 cars, taillight functions are split.
The corner bulb carrier on each side
contains:
Taillight bulb
Turn signal bulb
Brake light bulb
Trunk light bulb
The bulb carrier on each side of the
trunk or tailgate contains:
Back-up light
Rear foglight (European models
only)
-
To access taillight bulbs carriers,
open trunk lid or tailgate.
To access corner bulbs:
Sport Wagon: Remove cargo area
513 Interior Trim.
side trim. See
Unlatch bulb carrier retainer
(arrow), then pull carrier off
taillight assembly.
-
Detach electrical harness
connector.
-
Replace bulbs as necessary.
CAUTION!
Do not touch bulb with your bare
hands. If necessary wipe bulb using
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
a clean cloth dampened with rubbing
alcohol.
To access trunk lid taillight bulbs:
Partially remove trunk lid trim panel by
removing plastic expansion rivets
(arrows). Expansion rivets are released
by prying upper portion out (inset),
then pulling off trunk lid.
-
To access tailgate taillight bulbs:
Remove tailgate inside trim panel.
See
412 Trunk Lid, Tailgate.
Unlatch bulb carrier retainer (arrow),
then pull carrier off.
-
Detach electrical harness
connector.
-
Replace bulb(s) as necessary.
CAUTION!
Do not touch bulb with your bare
hands. If necessary wipe bulb using
a clean cloth dampened with rubbing
alcohol.
-
Installation of either bulb carrier is
reverse of removal.
Taillight applications
Backup light bulb
12V 21W
Brake light bulb
12V 21W
Brake light/taillight
bulb
12V 21/4W
Rear foglight
(European only)
12V 21W
Turn signal bulb
12 V 21W
Center brake light
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
The center brake light in all models is
an LED unit. There are no replaceable
bulbs.
Sedan or Coupe: Working from rear
seat in passenger compartment, gently
pull off trim cover over third brake light
(at top of rear glass).
Detach electrical harness
connector (A).
Remove retaining clips (B) on
either side and remove assembly.
-
Convertible: Remove inner trunk
lid trim adjacent to license plate
light assembly.
Detach electrical harness
connector
Push center brake light out.
Sport Wagon: Open rear window.
Carefully detach rear window
hinge cover.
Remove rear spoiler mounting
bolts (arrows).
Detach electrical harness
connector and rear washer hose
from spoiler.
Remove mounting screws and
remove third brake light assembly
from spoiler.
When installing, be sure electrical
harness and rear window washer
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
hose are not damaged or kinked.
Note:
Replace sealing plastic and grommets
as necessary during reassembly.
TIghtening torque
Rear spoiler to
rear glass
6 Nm (4 ft-lb)
License plate light, removing
and installing
Using a flat tipped screw driver, pry
gently on right side of license plate
light assembly (arrow). Lift off lens.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring trim, wrap the
screwdriver tip with tape.
-
Remove bulb.
Note:
Inspect bulb contact springs for damage
and corrosion. Replace socket
assembly if necessary.
License plate light application
License plate bulb
-
12V 5W
Installation is reverse of removal.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
630-6
Interior Lights
The ZKE V general module (GM V)
controls the interior lighting
automatically using input from several
monitors. The lighting can also be
manually controlled.
Each door lock actuator contains a hall
effect sensor for the purpose of
monitoring door open/closed status.
The hall effect sensor is located
directly behind the rotary latch plate
encased in the lock actuator. The
sensor is activated by the rotary latch
plate position.
Door closed: Rotary latch plate in
latched position. Current flow
through hall sensor <5 mA.
Door open: Rotary latch plate in
open position. Current flow
through hall sensor >12 mA.
A change in current flow informs the
GM V when a door is opened or closed.
The overhead front seat interior/map
light unit contains a single main interior
light. The light is controlled by the GM
V automatically or by momentarily
pressing the interior light switch
located on the light assembly. The
switch provides a momentary ground
signal that the GM V recognizes as a
request to either turn the light on (if off)
or turn the light off (if on).
If the switch is held for more than 3
seconds, the GM V interprets the
continuous ground signal as a request
to turn the interior light circuit off
(workshop mode). Workshop mode is
stored in memory: Even if the GM V is
removed from the power supply and
reconnected, the lights do not come
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
back on unless the switch is pressed
again.
There are two reading/map lights
located in the front interior light
assembly. Each is mechanically
controlled by depressing the
corresponding switch. The power
supply for the map lights is supplied by
the GM V.
There is a courtesy light in each front
footwell. These lights are only operated
when the GM V provides power to the
interior lighting circuit.
Interior lighting system
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Interior light automatic controls
The GM V provides 12 volts to the
interior lighting circuit when the status of
one of the following input signals
changes:
Door contact hall sensor active
(door open)
"Unlock" request received from
driver door key lock hall sensor
(ignition switch OFF)
"Unlock" request from FZV keyless
entry system received via K bus
(ignition switch OFF)
Vehicle exterior lights on for
minimum of 2 minutes when ignition
switch is OFF
Active crash signal from MRS II
control module
Lock button of FZV key pressed
with vehicle already locked (interior
search function)
Immediately after ignition switch is
turned to "radio" position with driver
door closed.
When vehicle is locked (single or
double) with door contacts closed.
When vehicle door contacts are
closed. Lights remain on for 20
seconds, then go to soft off.
After interior search function is
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
activated, lights automatically turn
off (soft off) after 8 seconds.
After 16 minutes with door contact
active (open door) and key off,
lights are switched off (consumer
cutoff function).
The component activation function of
DIS also has the ability to switch the
lights.
Interior light, footwell light, or
cargo compartment light (Sport
Wagon), replacing bulb
Pry interior light fixture gently to remove.
Detach electrical harness
connector.
Remove bulb and replace.
CAUTION!
When replacing bulbs, do not touch
glass of bulb with fingers. Only touch
bulb with clean cloth or bulb
packaging.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Bulb types and specifications for
various interior lamps are listed
below.
Interior light applications
Footwell light bulb
Softlite 5W
Glove compartment
light bulb
Softlite 5W
Passenger
compartment bulb,
Softlite 5W
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Lights
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Interior light applications
front or rear
Reading bulb, front
or rear
6W
Tailgate courtesy
light bulb
Softlite 10W
Visor vanity light
bulb
Softlite 10W
Trunk light bulb, replacing
The trunk lights are integrated with the
taillight assembly.
Pry trunk light cover (arrow) gently to
remove from taillight corner bulb carrier.
Remove bulb and replace.
Installation is reverse of removal.
Trunk light application
Trunk light bulb
Softlite 10W
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:15 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
1 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
640-1
General
The repair information given under this
heading applies to the heating and air
conditioning system. Many of the
procedures require that the A/C
refrigerant charge be evacuated. See
A/C system warnings and cautions
later in this repair group.
For information on the engine cooling
system, see
170 Radiator and
Cooling System.
Special tools
Some special tools are necessary for
heating and A/C repair procedures.
A variety of A/C system evacuation and
recharge equipment is available.
Follow the equipment manufacturer's
recommendations and instructions.
Plastic tool for prying off interior trim
BMW 00 9 321
IHKA control panel removal tools BMW
64 1 010
A/C line plug kit BMW 64 5 100
Note:
A/C system recharging procedures are
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
2 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
beyond the scope of this manual.
Integrated heating and cooling
system (IHKA)
The E46 integrated automatic climate
control system (IHKA) offers powerful
cooling and heating, effective
ventilation, and smooth operation in
A/C mode.
The E46 IHKA design includes the
following:
Use of R134a refrigerant only
Single heater core for temperature
regulation
Maximum heating and cooling for
defroster functions
Rear window defogger operation
integrated into the heating/cooling
system
Blower controlled through a final
stage variable resistor
Road speed dependent air
distribution and fresh air volume
Self-calibrating air distribution
stepper motors controlled via
M-bus
Fresh air microfilter system
Electronically regulated A/C
compressor
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
3 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Heater control personalization via
Car Memory/Key Memory
E46 IHKA control
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
4 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Control panel and module
Heating and air conditioning functions
are programmed via the center console
mounted control panel. The control
panel has large, easy to use soft-touch
controls, an LED display and a single
temperature setting.
1 - Manual air distribution control
buttons
2 - Interior temperature sensor
intake/outlet
3 - LCD matrix
4 - A/C control (“snowflake”)
5 - Windshield defrost control
6 - Rear window defogger control
7 - Recirculation control
8 - Blower control
9 - Temperature control
10 - Automatic air distribution
The IHKA control module, integral with
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
5 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
the front panel, includes an EEPROM
chip for storage of Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs). Inputs to the module
include:
Heater core temperature sensor
A/C evaporator temperature sensor
Other programmed functions from
Car Memory (such as rear window
defrost timing).
The module can go into "sleep mode" to
reduce power consumption when the
ignition is switched OFF but still retain
control panel settings and DTC
information. If the control module is
replaced it must be recoded using BMW
scan tools DIS or MoDiC.
Heat regulation
The E46 uses a single water valve and
heater core to provide passenger
compartment heat. The water valve is
electrically pulsed to control the flow of
coolant through the heater core.
Temperature regulation is based on the
following inputs:
Temperature control switch setting
Interior temperature sensor signal
Ambient temperature signal
Heater core temperature sensor
signal
Evaporator temperature signal
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
6 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Solar sensor input (if applicable)
A rocker switch is used to select the
desired cabin temperature, shown in the
display matrix of the control panel. The
range for temperature display is from 15°
to 32°C (60° to 90°F).
A "service station" feature is integrated
into the E46 IHKA. This prevents the
heater core from being flooded with hot
coolant when refueling the vehicle.
Blower control
The blower rocker switch on the IHKA
control panel is the master switch for the
entire system. Rocking the switch to
select slower and slower fan speeds
eventually results in the following:
Blower motor turns off.
All air distribution valves are closed.
LED and LCD displays are switched
off.
Rear window defroster is switched
off.
A/C compressor is switched off.
Even in the lowest setting, the interior
temperature sensor blower continues to
operate and the IHKA control panel
continues to signal the heater water
valve for heat.
Regulated A/C compressor
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
7 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
The operation of the A/C compressor is
modulated, eliminating noticeable on/off
cycling. In order to reduce fuel
consumption and improve vehicle
performance, the system default is with
the compressor OFF.
The A/C system uses a variable
displacement compressor. The swash
plate of the compressor is hinged so that
is can vary piston travel based on output
requirements of the system.
A/C compressor function is controlled by
the Engine Control Module (ECM) based
on inputs from the IHKA control panel.
Pressing the "snowflake" button is a
request for A/C activation. As long as the
evaporator temperature is above 2°C
(36°F), the IHKA signals the ECM to
activate the compressor.
The IHKA control module sends the
following signals to the ECM over the
K-bus and CAN-bus via the instrument
cluster:
Request for A/C activation
Load torque for switching the
compressor
Requested cooling fan speed
The IHKA determines the load torque for
compressor activation and required
engine cooling fan speed from the
pressure sensor mounted on the
receiver/dryer. The pressure sensor
provides a linear voltage input signal (0 5 volts) to the IHKA control module. The
module processes this signal and
determines the load torque of the system
(0 to 30 Nm with a variable displacement
compressor). The higher the pressure in
the system, the higher the voltage input
signal to the IHKA module. The output
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
8 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
signal to the ECM enables the ECM to
modify the idle speed, timing and fuel
injection amount based on the load that
is imposed when the compressor is
activated.
Regulated engine cooling fan
operation
The engine cooling fan (arrow) operates
at variable speeds (15 stages) based on
cooling system load. The ECM activates
the fan through a pulse modulated final
stage control. See
170 Radiator and
Cooling System for further details.
Note:
Automatic transmission models: The
engine cooling fan is located in front
of the radiator. A belt-driven fan and
fan clutch assembly is installed at
the rear of the radiator.
Standard transmission models: The
electric engine cooling fan is
installed at the rear of the radiator.
A/C system
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
9 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Maximum defrosting
Pressing the defrost button turns on
maximum defrost functions:
Fresh air distribution valves are
opened.
Recirculation valves are closed.
Windshield defrost vents are
opened.
All other air distribution vents are
closed.
Blower runs at maximum speed.
Rear window defroster is switched
on.
Note:
When windshield defrosting is turned on,
the A/C compressor does not run
automatically, although it can be turned
on manually.
Air distribution control via M-bus
Five stepper motors control fresh,
heated and air conditioned air
distribution.
1 - Face vent
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
10 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
2 - Defrost
3 - Footwell
4 - Recirculation
5 - Fresh air
Two different types of air distribution
motors are used in the system. Fast
acting motors (A) are used for the fresh
air/recirculation flaps. (Right side
shown.)
-
Slower acting motors (B) are used
for the other operations.
The center dashboard air outlet
distribution motor (arrow) allows
ventilation air temperature to be
controlled by the driver or passenger.
When fresh air is selected, the fresh air
inlet distribution flaps are positioned
according to road speed and blower
motor speed. The motors close the air
inlet flaps incrementally according to
road speed but the motion is dampened
to avoid closing and opening continually
due to slight speed changes.
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
11 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
IHKA personalization
Car Memory/Key Memory allows various
functions and features of IHKA control to
be tailored to the driver's wishes. The
functions of IHKA that can be
programmed by the driver include:
Automatic activation of recirculation
when the vehicle is started
Blower speed adjustment (8-speed
blower)
Automatic opening of ventilation
flaps with warm coolant
Automatic closing of footwell flaps
with A/C activation
Automatic closing of defroster flaps
with A/C activation
Adjustments to set temperature
Automatic activation of compressor
control when the ignition is switched
on
Auto program for blower control
when the ignition is switched on
These features are programmed using
the coding/programming function of the
DIS/MoDiC.
Note:
See
515 Central Locking and Anti-theft
for an explanation of Car Memory/Key
Memory.
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
12 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Automatic air recirculation
As of model year 2000, automatic
recirculation control is available. This
system uses an air quality sensor (AUC)
(arrow), located at the top right corner of
the radiator, to detect high levels of air
pollution and automatically switch the
IHKA to recirculation of interior air. The
recirculation button on the IHKA control
panel can be toggled to allow automatic,
manual or no recirculation.
Once recirculation is turned on, it runs
until it is turned off using the button.
Once the ignition is turned off, the
recirculation setting is saved for 15
minutes, after which the IHKA system
reverts to fresh air mode. This feature
can be over-ridden using the Car
Memory feature, so that recirculating
interior air is automatically selected on
engine start-up.
Fresh air micro filter system
A fresh air micro filter system is used in
all E46 models. The filter is housed
below the fresh air inlet at the rear of the
engine compartment. The filter can be
serviced by releasing three-quick release
screws and removing a plastic cover.
Service
The heating system is part of the engine
cooling system and is sealed. The only
required service is periodic coolant
flushing. See
170 Radiator and
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
13 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Cooling System.
Servicing the A/C system requires the
use of specialized equipment. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
Rear window defogger
The electric rear window defogger switch
is integrated in the IHKA control panel.
Pressing the rear window defogger
button activates the rear window heating
element for about 17 minutes, although
this can be changed through Car
Memory settings. Pressing the button
again activates a cycle of 40 seconds
on/80 seconds off for 5 minutes.
The defogger element in the rear glass
is integrated with the radio antenna.
The rear window defogger relay (arrow)
is located in the right side of the luggage
or cargo (Sport Wagon) compartment
behind the trim.
Convertible heated rear window
In the E46 Convertible, both the soft top
and the hard top are equipped with rear
window defogger. Power is supplied by
two relays located on the right side rear
quarter panel behind the interior trim
cover.
Rear defogger operation is controlled by
the IHKA control module.
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
14 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
On hard top:
Rear relay is energized.
Power to hard top window is
supplied through connector strip on
hard top lock.
On convertible top:
Rear relay is energized. It powers
front relay.
If convertible top control module
(CVM) signals that convertible top is
locked to windshield frame, front
relay powers rear window heater
grid.
If convertible top is lowered, a
signal from CVM to front relay
prevents heated top operation.
Front relay also signals sound
system to switch stereo sound ON
when top is up, stereo sound OFF
when top is down.
Solar sensor
The purpose of the solar sensor is to
detect and relay information about the
amount and intensity of solar heating to
the IHKA control module. The settings of
the climate control system are changed
to compensate for this additional
influence.
The solar sensor consists of a
photoresistor installed in the right
defroster outlet and a short harness.
The solar sensor receives power (5 volts)
and ground from the IHKA control
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
15 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
module. The module then calculates
voltage drop across the photoresistor
and determines the degree of solar
heating based on the change in voltage.
Voltage drop across the photoresistor
increases as solar radiation increases.
The IHKA control module processes the
photoresistor input every 10 seconds
and also checks it for plausibility based
on mapped values. Values outside the
limit indicate a malfunction and the solar
sensor signal is ignored by the module.
The IHKA module regulates interior
climate settings using the following:
Blower. The blower activation curve
is changed.
Ventilation. The opening angles of
air distribution flaps are changed.
Troubleshooting of the solar sensor is
carried out through the IHKA diagnostic
program incorporated in DIS or MoDiC.
The IHKA control module may set codes
indicating a short or an open circuit.
To access the solar sensor, remove the
trim in front of the main dashboard
panel, ahead of the dashboard vents.
Troubleshooting
Trouble with the heating and A/C system
can be broken down into one or more of
the following categories.
Mechanical problems
Control head malfunction
Blower motor malfunction
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
16 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Noisy or seized compressor
Noisy compressor clutch
Malfunctioning belt
Diagnosis of noisy engine compartment
components is covered in
100
Engine–General. A/C belt replacement is
covered in
020 Maintenance.
Cooling system problems
Coolant problems
Cooling fan problems
Cooling system pressure testing and
other diagnosis is covered in
170
Radiator and Cooling System.
Refrigerant leak
Use diagnostic equipment to pinpoint
refrigerant leaks. Replace leaky
components or seals.
Note:
Diagnosis of A/C system components is
beyond the scope of this manual. Follow
the equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Odors
MIldew in the IHKA housing and in the
evaporator fins can cause strong odors.
Working under right side of dash,
remove blower fan resistor pack (arrow)
as described later in this repair group.
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
17 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Poke a spray wand through IHKA
housing opening and spray
commercially available cleaning
agent on evaporator. Move wand
back and forth to cover evaporator
fins with liquid.
-
Allow 5 minutes for liquid to drip
through evaporator drain.
-
Start car and run heater and A/C at
maximum power for 5 minutes to
dry out evaporator.
Functional problems
IHKA self diagnostics monitors the inputs
and outputs of the system. If a fault is
detected, a Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC) is initially entered in RAM and
then in the EEPROM when the ignition is
switched off. A maximum of six DTCs
can be stored in the EEPROM when the
ignition is switched off. The E46 IHKA
module is connected to the Diagnostic
Link Connector (DLC) via the
K-bus/instrument cluster. Use DIS,
MoDiC or other suitable scan tool to
access DTCs.
When troubleshooting problems with the
E46 IHKA, it is important to note that
because the Car Memory/Key Memory
feature can change the functionality of
the system, a review of memory settings
should be performed prior to
condemning a component as faulty.
Substitute value operation
If an input potentiometer, sensor or
circuit fails or the signal from it is not
plausible, the control module ignores the
faulty signal and substitutes a
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
18 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
programmed substitute value. See
Table a.
Table a. Substitute programmed
values for IHKA component inputs
Input
Working
range
Substitute
value
Heat
exchanger
sensor
5° to
124°C
(41° to
255°F)
55°C
(131°F)
Evaporator
sensor
-10° to
30°C (14°
to 86°F)
0°C (32°F)
Interior
temperature
sensor
10° to
40°C (50°
to 104°F)
20°C (68°F)
Exterior
temperature
K-bus
0°C (32°F)
Coolant
temperature
K -bus
100°C
(212°F)
Specified
temperature
16° to
32°C (61°
to 90°F)
22°C (72°F)
Note:
The substitute value for the evaporator
temperature sensor is below the A/C
compressor cycling temperature
(2°C/34°F). If the evaporator temperature
sensor signal is not plausible, the
substitute value will switch the A/C OFF.
Table b lists resistance values and
fault limits for IHKA temperature sensors.
Table b. Temperature sensor
resistance values at 25°C (77°F)
Sensor
Resistance
Fault
limit
Heater core
9k
Temp >
± 2%
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
19 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table b. Temperature sensor
resistance values at 25°C (77°F)
Sensor
Resistance
Fault
limit
125°C
(257°F)
Evaporator
9k
Interior
10 k
± 2%
Temp >
120°C
(248°F)
± 2%
Temp ≤
-46°C
(-51°F)
Table c lists A/C evaporator
temperature-dependent resistance
values.
Table c. A/C evaporator temperature
sensor resistance values
Temperature
°C/°F
Resistance
range
k
-5/23
11.7 - 11.9
0/32
8.8 - 9.2
5/41
6.8 - 7.2
10/50
5.3 - 5.6
15/59
4.2 - 4.5
20/68
3.3 - 3.6
25/77
2.6 - 2.9
30/86
2.1 - 2.3
35/95
1.7 - 1.9
Table d lists A/C expansion valve
pressure values.
Table d. Expansion valve pressure
values
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
20 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Table d. Expansion valve pressure
values
Inlet pressure
14 bar (203 psi)
Outlet pressure
1.8 bar (26 psi)
Leak test with
detector pressure
1 - 2 bar
(14.5 - 29 psi)
A/C system warnings and
cautions
WARNING!
Always wear hand and eye
protection (gloves and goggles)
when working around the A/C
system. If refrigerant does come
in contact with your skin or eyes:
do not rub skin or eyes;
immediately flush skin or eyes
with cool water for 15 minutes;
rush to a doctor or hospital; do
not attempt to treat yourself.
Work in a well ventilated area.
Switch on exhaust/ventilation
systems when working on the
refrigerant system.
Do not expose any component of
the A/C system to high
temperatures (above 80C/176F) or
open flames. Excessive heat
causes a pressure increase which
could burst the system.
Keep refrigerant away from open
flames. Poisonous gas is
produced if it burns. Do not
smoke near refrigerant gases for
the same reason.
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
21 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
The A/C system is filled with
refrigerant gas which is under
pressure. Pressurized refrigerant
in the presence of oxygen may
form a combustible mixture.
Never introduce compressed air
into any refrigerant container (full
or empty).
Electric welding near refrigerant
hoses causes R-134a to
decompose. Discharge system
before welding.
CAUTION!
As of January 1, 1992, any person
who services a motor vehicle air
conditioner must, by law, be
properly trained and certified,
and use approved refrigerant
recycling equipment. Technicians
must complete an EPA-approved
recycling course to be certified.
It is recommended that all A/C
service be left to an authorized
BMW dealer or other qualified A/C
service facility.
State and local governments may
have additional requirements
regarding air conditioning
servicing. Always comply with
state and local laws.
Do not top off a partially charged
refrigerant system. Discharge
system, evacuate and then
recharge system.
Do not use R-12 refrigerant,
refrigerant oils or system
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
22 of 22
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
components in R-134a system.
Component damage and system
contamination results.
The mixture of refrigerant oil
(PAG oil) and refrigerant R-134a
attacks some metals and alloys
(for example, copper) and breaks
down certain hose materials. Use
only hoses and lines that are
identified with a green mark
(stripe) or the lettering "R-134a".
Immediately plug open
connections on A/C components
and lines to prevent dirt and
moisture contamination.
Do not steam clean A/C
condensers or evaporators. Use
only cold water or compressed
air.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:16 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
1 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
640-2
Vents and Ducts
The IHKA air distribution system
includes 5 air distribution motors
(stepper motors), right and left footwell
ducts, dashboard mounted defroster
vents, and three sets of face level
vents.
Removal of at least one of the stepper
motors (right footwell vent) involves
removal of the passenger side airbag in
the dashboard.
WARNING!
Airbags are inflated by an explosive
device. Handled improperly or
without adequate safeguards, the
system can be very dangerous.
Special precautions must be
observed prior to any work at or near
the airbags. See
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
CAUTION!
When working on interior trim
removal, work with plastic prying
tools or wrap the tips of screwdrivers
and pliers with tape.
Air distribution motors
The five air distribution motors are
installed under the dashboard. They
are made accessible by removing
either the glove compartment and right
footwell trim panel or the left footwell
(pedal cluster) trim panel as described
below.
Each motor can be removed after its
electrical wiring harness connector has
been removed.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
2 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Squeeze plastic clip (arrow) to
release motor.
Tilt motor out of housing.
-
During installation, be sure to
align air distribution flap and
motor drive (A).
Right side air distribution
motors, accessing
Four of the air distribution motors are
under the right side of the dashboard:
Right side fresh air/recirculation
Defroster
Ventilation flaps
Right footwell vent
-
Remove glove compartment and
right footwell trim panel for
513 Interior Trim.
access. See
CAUTION!
Disassemble interior trim carefully to
avoid damage.
-
Disconnect negative (-) battery
cable in trunk.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
3 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Right side fresh air/recirculation motor
(arrow):
For access, remove right footwell
duct as described below.
Unhook linkage, then remove
motor.
Defroster air distribution motor (arrow)
Ventilation distribution motor (arrow)
For access, remove defroster air
distribution motor.
Right footwell vent air distribution motor
(arrow):
For access, remove passenger
side airbag as described in
721
Airbag System (SRS).
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
4 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Unhook linkage, then remove
motor.
Left side air distribution motor,
accessing
The fresh air distribution motor is under
the left side of the dashboard. Remove
the left footwell (pedal cluster) trim
panel for access.
CAUTION!
Disassemble interior trim carefully to
avoid damage.
-
Move steering column to maximum
extended position.
Working at trim panel, remove
fasteners.
Note locking clips (A) which must
be rotated 90° to remove.
Remove mounting screws (B).
Unhook retaining clip from
steering column lower trim.
Detach electrical harness
connectors from footwell light and
speaker (if equipped).
Release OBD II socket from panel
and pull out.
Reach up above accelerator pedal to
gain access to fresh air distribution
motor (arrow).
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
5 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Right footwell duct, removing
and installing
-
Remove glove compartment as
described in
513 Interior Trim.
-
Remove IHKA control panel or
GPS On-Board Monitor, as
applicable (described below).
Reach through control panel opening
to detach air duct locking clip (arrow)
from heater/evaporator housing.
-
Separate bottom of air duct from
rear compartment duct.
-
Pull forward and down to remove.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Dashboard vent, removing and
installing
Pry gently at dashboard trim to remove.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring interior trim, work
with a plastic prying tool.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
6 of 6
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Remove air vent mounting screws
(arrows).
-
Lift vent slightly and withdraw from
dashboard.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note:
Removal of right or center
dashboard vent is similar.
To fully remove the center
dashboard vent, use pliers to
detach control cable housing and
remove from control lever.
Remove trim on right side prior to
removing center trim.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
640-3
Heating and A/C
Controls
The IHKA control module is integrated
with the control panel in the center
console below the radio. There is a
built-in interior temperature sensor and
fan.
Models with GPS navigation are
equipped with a center consolemounted On-Board Monitor. This
combines sound system control
functions, GPS monitoring and
heating/A/C control functions.
IHKA control panel, removing
If BMW special tools 64 1 010 are
available, slide them between IHKA
control panel front bezel and
dashboard, then pull panel out.
Otherwise, use the following
procedure.
Remove utility compartment below
IHKA control panel:
Open compartment door.
Push upward in center of
compartment to release locking
tabs (arrows).
Pull out compartment.
-
Shifter bezel: Lift up by prying
gently.
-
Shifter boot: Unclip bottom of boot
from shifter trim (window switch
carrier) by pushing forward. Pull
boot up around shifter, but do not
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
remove.
Remove screws (arrows) at rear of
shifter trim (window switch carrier). Lift
trim at back to unhook from front.
Remove screws (arrows) at front and
rear of ashtray carrier. Lift up ashtray
carrier.
-
Reach up through opening and
push IHKA control module and
panel out.
-
Detach electrical harness
connectors.
-
Disassemble panel from module
using an anti-static mat as a
working surface.
CAUTION!
Do not touch circuit boards with bare
fingers.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
On-Board Monitor, removing
-
Remove dashboard center vent as
described earlier.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Pull off menu button on face of
monitor. Reach through apertures
with screwdriver to twist catches.
This releases monitor from
console.
-
Pull out monitor and detach
electrical harness connectors in
back.
Heater core temperature
sensor, removing and installing
-
Remove IHKA control panel or
On-Board Monitor as described
earlier.
Reach through dashboard opening and
detach heater core temperature sensor
electrical harness connector (arrow).
-
Pull sensor out of IHKA housing.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Evaporator temperature sensor
To gain access to evaporator
temperature sensor (arrow):
Remove left footwell trim panel
(above pedals). See
513 Interior
Trim.
Sensor is installed in left side of
IHKA housing above coolant
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
pipes.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
640-4
Blower Components
Blower motor, removing and
installing
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower housing.
Remove heater bulkhead cover:
Remove engine compartment side
trim panel. Turn locking clips (A)
and slide trim panel up.
Remove heater bulkhead cover
mounting screws (B) and lift cover
off bulkhead.
Remove intake manifold cover:
Remove plastic trim covers
(arrows).
Remove cover hold down bolts
and lift off cover.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Working inside right side of cowl, pull
up on lever (arrow) and detach right air
intake flap from blower housing.
Pry off blower cover retaining clips (A).
Remove screw (B) and lift off outer
blower housing cover.
Remove blower cover retaining screws
(arrows). Lift off cover.
Detach electrical harness connector
(arrow).
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Pry off blower motor retaining strap.
-
Pull blower motor forward to
remove.
-
Installation is reverse of removal:
Align slot in blower motor with
mounting tab in blower motor
housing.
Blower motor resistor pack,
replacing
Note:
The blower motor resistor pack is also
referred to as the final stage unit.
-
Remove right footwell air duct as
described earlier.
Working under right side of dashboard
at side of IHKA housing, unhook
linkage, then remove air distribution
motor (arrow).
To remove blower resistor pack from
IHKA housing:
Remove mounting screws
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
(arrows).
Detach electrical harness
connector.
Press retaining clip away from
switch to release switch.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Make sure electrical harness is
routed as before.
Align guides and clips correctly.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
1 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
640-5
Heater Components
The heater valve is located in the left
side of the engine compartment,
attached to the left strut tower. The
solenoid operated valve controls
coolant flow through the heater core.
The IHKA housing, located underneath
the center of the dashboard, houses
the heater core, the A/C evaporator, the
heating and A/C blower and associated
sensors and air distribution motors.
CAUTION!
Removal of either the heater core or
the IHKA housing involves
dashboard removal. Before starting
work, disconnect the battery
negative (-) cable in the trunk. Be
sure to read the battery
disconnection cautions on page viii
and the airbag warnings in
721
Airbag System (SRS).
Heater valve, replacing
-
Drain engine coolant. See
170
Radiator and Cooling System.
WARNING!
Allow the cooling system to cool
before opening or draining the
cooling system.
Disconnect hoses (A) and electrical
harness connector (B) at heater valve
on left inner fender.
-
Carefully pull heater valve out of
rubber mounting and pull up and
out of engine compartment.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
2 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Inspect hoses and rubber mounts.
Replace as necessary.
Use new hose clamps.
Tightening torque
Coolant hose
clamp
32 - 48 mm
(2 1/4 - 4 in.)
2.5 Nm (22 in-lb)
Heater core, replacing
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower housing.
-
Remove center console and
513 Interior
dashboard. See
Trim.
-
Drain engine coolant. See
170
Radiator and Cooling System.
WARNING!
Allow the cooling system to cool
before opening or draining the
cooling system.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
3 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Working at rear engine compartment
bulkhead, loosen hose clamps
(arrows) and detach heater hoses.
-
Blow out excess coolant from
heater core using compressed air
at coolant lines.
-
Release right air duct from IHKA
housing.
Working inside passenger
compartment at IHKA housing:
Detach wiring harness (A) from
housing.
Remove heater core temperature
sensor (B) by pulling straight out.
Remove retaining clips (C) from
housing cover.
Lift off front of cover, then unhook
tabs from housing at rear.
Remove coolant pipe retaining clamps
mounting screws (arrows).
To remove heater core from IHKA
housing:
Remove coolant pipe retainers
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
4 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
(arrows) to detach pipes.
Tilt heater core to remove from
housing.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Fit lugs in back of housing cover
in heater housing slots.
Use new sealing O-rings and coat
with anti-seize agent.
Fill and bleed cooling system.
170 Radiator and Cooling
See
System.
CAUTION!
Replace coolant flange O-rings and
tighten fasteners to specified
torques.
Tightening torque
Coolant hose
clamp
32 - 48 mm
(2 1/4- 4 in.)
2.5 Nm (22 in-lb)
IHKA housing, removing and
installing
CAUTION!
Removing the IHKA housing
requires evacuating the A/C
system. DO NOT attempt this
procedure without proper tools
and training.
Any person who services a
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
5 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
motor vehicle air conditioner
must, by law, be properly
trained and certified, and use
approved refrigerant recycling
equipment. Technicians must
complete an EPA-approved
recycling course to be certified
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and
microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower housing.
Remove heater bulkhead cover:
Remove engine compartment side
trim panel. Turn locking clips (A)
and slide trim panel up.
Remove heater bulkhead cover
mounting screws (B) and lift cover
off bulkhead.
-
170
Drain engine coolant. See
Radiator and Cooling System.
WARNING!
Allow the cooling system to cool
before opening or draining the
cooling system.
Working at rear engine compartment
bulkhead, loosen hose clamps
(arrows) and detach heater hoses.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
6 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Blow out excess coolant from
heater core using compressed air
at coolant lines.
-
Following manufacturer's
instructions, connect approved
refrigerant recovery/recycling
/recharging unit to A/C system
and discharge system.
Working in right rear of engine
compartment, detach A/C lines:
Remove A/C recharging port
bracket mounting nut (A).
Remove allen bolts (B) at
bulkhead.
Using BMW special tool 64 5 102
or equivalent, detach and plug
A/C lines.
Working inside right side of cowl, pull
up on lever (arrow) and detach right air
intake flap from blower housing.
-
Working in right front of IHKA
housing, detach double pipe (A/C
line) from expansion valve.
Lay double pipe aside.
Plug up open A/C ports.
Remove IHKA housing mounting nuts
(arrows) at bulkhead.
-
Remove center console and
dashboard. See
513 Interior
Trim.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
7 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Working inside passenger
compartment below steering
column, drill out steering column
shear bolt. See
320 Steering
and Wheel Alignment.
Remove steering column
mounting bolts.
Lower column.
Under dash attachments
1 - Bulkhead
2 - Left A-pillar
3 - Head protection airbag
4 - Steering column
5 - Dashboard mounts
6 - Center tunnel
7 - Relay panel
8 - Right A-pillar
Remove dashboard reinforcement
fasteners:
Detach bulkhead brace (1).
Detach left and right A-pillar
braces (2 and 8).
Detach head protection airbag (3).
Remove center tunnel mounting
bolts (6).
-
Detach heater housing electrical
harness connectors.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
8 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Working at right side of dash:
Cut wire tie (A) at dashboard
reinforcement support for relay
panel.
Turn fuse panel lock tabs (B) 90°
and swing fuse panel down.
Detach fuse panel pivots (C) from
dashboard reinforcement.
-
Lift off dashboard reinforcement,
making sure all electrical
harnesses and hoses are free.
-
Remove IHKA housing, making
sure all electrical harnesses and
hoses are free.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note the following:
Make sure A/C condensate drain
is routed correctly.
Replace wire ties, sealing O-rings
and hose clamps.
Use new shear bolt at steering
column mounting. Tighten bolt
until head shears off.
Evacuate and recharge A/C
system using specialized
equipment.
Fill and bleed cooling system.
170 Radiator and Cooling
See
System.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
9 of 9
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Replace heater and A/C flange
O-rings and tighten fasteners to
specified torques.
Tightening torques
Coolant hose clamp
32 - 48 mm
(2 1/4 - 4 in.)
Steering column to
dashboard
reinforcement
2.5 Nm (22
in-lb)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:17 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
640-6
Air Conditioning
Components
This section covers removal and
installation of air conditioning
refrigerant components. A/C testing
and diagnosis, refrigerant discharge,
evacuation and recharge are not
covered here.
The A/C condenser, compressor,
receiver dryer, pressure sensor,
refrigerant lines and expansion valve
are either installed in the engine
compartment or accessible from the
engine compartment.
The A/C evaporator is located in the
IHKA housing. Removal of the IHKA
housing involves dashboard removal.
Before starting work, disconnect the
battery negative (-) cable in the trunk.
Be sure to read the battery
disconnection cautions on page viii and
the airbag warnings in
721 Airbag
System (SRS).
Note:
The air conditioning system is filled
with R-134a refrigerant.
A/C system
components
1
- High pressure
line
2
- Sealing O-ring
(always replace)
3
- Receiver-dryer
4
- Condenser
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
5
- Compressor
6
- Low pressure
line
7
- Access port
8
- Double pipe
9
- Expansion valve
10 - Evaporator
11 - Access port
12 - Pressure sensor
A/C compressor, replacing
-
Following manufacturer's
instructions, connect an approved
refrigerant recovery/recycling
/recharging unit to A/C system and
discharge system.
WARNING!
Do not discharge/charge the A/C
system without proper equipment and
training. Damage to the vehicle and
personal injury may result.
-
Remove splash shield from under
engine.
-
Mark A/C drive belt with direction of
rotation.
Release tension on A/C belt:
Use long-handled wrench to turn
tensioner pulley release lug (A)
clockwise (against spring tension).
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Remove drive belt.
-
Detach and set aside front washer
fluid reservoir. See
611 Wipers
and Washers.
-
Disconnect electrical harness
connector from compressor.
Remove A/C pressure hose and suction
hose flange bolts (arrows) from
compressor. Plug hoses immediately.
-
All-wheel-drive model: Unbolt and
lower front stabilizer bar. See
310 Front Suspension.
Support compressor while removing
compressor mounting bolts (arrows).
Remove compressor.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
CAUTION!
Always replace O-rings when
reconnecting refrigerant lines.
When installing a new
compressor always replace
receiver/drier unit.
Tightening torque
A/C line to A/C
compressor
20 Nm (15 ft-lb)
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Recharge system following
equipment manufacturer's
instructions. See
Table e for A/C
system fluid specifications.
Table e. A/C system fluid
specifications
Fluid
Quantity
R-134a refrigerant
740 ± 25 g
(2 lb ± 1 oz.)
Refrigerant oil
PAG oil
A/C condenser, replacing
The A/C condenser is located in front of
the radiator.
-
Following manufacturer's
instructions, connect an approved
refrigerant recovery/recycling
/recharging unit to A/C system and
discharge system.
WARNING!
Do not discharge/charge the A/C
system without proper equipment and
training. Damage to the vehicle and
personal injury may result.
Remove complete air filter housing:
Detach vacuum line at intake boot
(A).
Disconnect electrical harness
connector on mass air flow sensor
(B).
Release mass air flow sensor clips
(C).
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Remove filter housing mounting
screws (D).
Detach air duct connections (E) and
lift complete air filter housing out of
engine compartment, pulling it
forward away from mass air flow
sensor.
-
Remove intake hood, cooling fan
and shroud, and radiator, as
described in
170 Radiator and
Cooling System.
Detach A/C lines from upper right corner
of condenser. Plug lines immediately.
-
Remove fastener (expansion rivet)
from top left corner of condenser.
-
Remove Torx screw from top right
corner of condenser, just below
refrigerant line flange.
-
Lift up condenser to disengage from
plastic bracket and remove from
above.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
CAUTION!
Always replace O-rings when
reconnecting refrigerant lines.
When installing a new condenser
always replace receiver/drier unit.
-
Recharge system following
equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
A/C system fluid specifications
Fluid
Quantity
R-134a refrigerant
740 ± 25 g
(2 lb ± 1 oz.)
Refrigerant oil
PAG oil
A/C receiver/drier, replacing
The receiver/drier is mounted in the front
right corner of the engine compartment
behind and below the headlight
assembly.
-
Following manufacturer's
instructions, connect an approved
refrigerant recovery/recycling
/recharging unit to A/C system and
discharge system.
CAUTION!
The receiver/drier must be replaced
when
There is dirt in the A/C system
The compressor has seized or
has been replaced for any reason
The condenser or evaporator are
replaced for any reason
The A/C system is leaking and
there is no more refrigerant
The A/C system was open for 24
hours or more.
-
Remove right headlight assembly.
See
630 Lights.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Remove refrigerant pressure line
mounting bolts (A) from receiver/drier.
Plug lines immediately.
Disconnect high pressure switch
harness connector (B).
-
Working beneath right front of car,
remove splash shield retaining
screws. Remove splash shield.
-
Loosen receiver/drier mounting
strap bolts and slide receiver/dryer
down and out.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
CAUTION!
Always replace O-rings when
reconnecting refrigerant lines.
-
Recharge system following
equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
A/C system fluid specifications
Fluid
Quantity
R-134a refrigerant
740 ± 25 g
(2 lb ± 1 oz.)
Refrigerant oil
PAG oil
A/C expansion valve, removing
and installing
-
Following manufacturer's
instructions, connect an approved
refrigerant recovery/recycling
/recharging unit to A/C system and
discharge system.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
WARNING!
Do not discharge/charge the A/C
system without proper equipment and
training. Damage to the vehicle and
personal injury may result.
Remove housing for interior ventilation
microfilter.
Remove upper cover and microfilter.
Open wiring harness loom (A) and
remove wires.
Unfasten screws (B) and remove
lower housing.
To remove heater bulkhead cover:
Remove engine compartment side
trim panel. Turn locking clips (A)
and slide trim panel up.
Remove heater bulkhead cover
mounting screws (B) and lift cover
off bulkhead.
Working in right rear of engine
compartment, detach A/C lines:
Remove A/C recharging port
bracket mounting nut (A).
Remove allen bolts (B) at bulkhead.
Release and plug open A/C lines.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Working inside right side of cowl, pull up
on lever (arrow) and detach right air
intake flap from blower housing.
-
Working in right front of IHKA
housing, detach double pipe (A/C
line) from expansion valve.
Lay double pipe aside.
Plug up open A/C ports.
-
Remove expansion valve mounting
bolts and remove valve.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
CAUTION!
Always replace O-rings when
reconnecting refrigerant lines.
-
Recharge system following
equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
A/C system fluid specifications
Fluid
Quantity
R-134a refrigerant
740 ± 25 g
(2 lb ± 1 oz.)
Refrigerant oil
PAG oil
A/C evaporator, removing and
installing
-
Following manufacturer's
instructions, connect an approved
refrigerant recovery/recycling
/recharging unit to A/C system and
discharge system.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Drain engine coolant. See
170
Radiator and Cooling System.
-
Remove complete IHKA housing as
described earlier.
-
Remove heater core as described
earlier.
-
Working on left side of IHKA
housing:
Detach evaporator temperature
sensor electrical harness connector
and pull out sensor.
Detach wiring harness from
housing.
Detach linkage from fresh air
distribution motor.
-
Working on right side of IHKA
housing:
Unclip and remove fresh
air/recirculation motor.
Remove evaporator cover mounting
screw and remove cover.
-
Detach and remove microswitch at
side of IHKA housing.
-
Working in front of IHKA housing:
Remove blower housing mounting
screws. Lift out blower housing.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Heating and Air Conditioning
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Remove double coolant pipe.
-
Pry off evaporator housing retaining
clips and remove cover. Pull
evaporator and expansion valve out
of bottom of housing.
-
If installing new evaporator, switch
over expansion valve. Use new
sealing O-rings.
CAUTION!
Do not bend cooling fins on
evaporator. If necessary, straighten
with fin comb.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Make sure electrical harnesses are
routed as before.
Align guides and clips correctly.
Recharge system following
equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
A/C system fluid specifications
Fluid
Quantity
R-134a refrigerant
740 ± 25 g
(2 lb ± 1 oz.)
Refrigerant oil
PAG oil
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Radio
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
650-1
General
This section covers the BMW factoryinstalled sound system, including
radio, amplifier and speaker removal.
Radio antenna information is also
included.
Special tools
Use BMW special tool 00 9 321 or
equivalent plastic prying tool to pry out
plastic interior parts without damage or
marring.
Plastic prying tool BMW 00 9 321
General
A tag on the bottom of the radio
contains the serial number (A) and
model number (B).
Sound system
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Radio
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
The standard E46 radio features a
cassette player. The optional radio has
a single in-dash CD player. Both radios
are prewired for the optional CD
changer that mounts in the trunk.
Another option, the On-Board Monitor,
integrates GPS navigation with radio
and IHKA controls. Basic radio controls
are also incorporated in the steering
wheel.
Sound system components are
interconnected via K-bus. Theft
proofing of the radio by code is no
longer required as the radio will not
function without the K-bus connection
and a valid signal from the instrument
cluster.
Other features of the sound system
include:
Autostoring of stations
Speed dependent volume
Telephone muting
Diversity antenna, described later in
this group, is optional on some models
and standard on the Convertible and
Sport Wagon.
RDS
Radio Data System (RDS) is a transmit
and receive system operated in the FM
band. It is a data service offered by
radio stations in which the information
is transmitted inaudibly with the audio
programs. The name of the station is
displayed in the radio when the RDS
system is active. Program identification,
program service name and RDS quality
are also displayed.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Radio
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Troubleshooting
Although electronic radio and sound
system troubleshooting is beyond the
scope of this manual, there are number
of self-tests that are possible with the
standard BMW radio installed in E46
cars.
Radio test functions are activated by
pressing the M button within 8 seconds
of switching the radio on. Hold it
pressed in for 8 seconds to start the
tests.
The test functions include:
Radio serial number
Software version display
Speed dependent volume control
adjustment
Station signal strength, including
FM frequency set, signal strength
and quality of signal received
AM frequency set and signal
strength
The test also checks antenna
functions:
Antenna signal strength (F
number) indicates the quality of
the signal received by the
antenna. The scale ranges from 0
to 15, with the optimum value
being 15. If the value falls below
10, radio stations can not be
listened to in stereo.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:18 PM
Radio
1 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
650-2
Radio and Audio
Accessories
Radio, removing and installing
CAUTION!
Before beginning work on the
radio or sound system, verify
that the radio is an original
equipment BMW radio and that
the wiring harness has not been
modified.
Servicing of aftermarket sound
equipment should be referred to
an authorized agent of the
equipment's manufacturer.
Note:
On-Board Monitor removal is covered
640 Heating and Air Conditioning.
in
-
Prying gently, remove right
dashboard trim, then center
dashboard trim.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring interior trim, work
with a plastic prying tool.
Remove radio mounting screws
(arrows).
-
Pull radio out of instrument panel
opening. Detach electrical harness
connector and antenna lead.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
2 of 2
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Amplifier
In all models the sound system
amplifier is installed behind the trim on
the left side of the car.
-
Sedan or Coupe: To access
amplifier, carefully remove trunk
trim clips on left side and peel
back trim.
Sport Wagon: Remove left cargo
compartment trim cover. Sound system
amplifier (arrow) is behind sound
insulation.
-
Convertible:
Disconnect battery negative
terminal.
Remove lower section of rear seat
left side trim.
If necessary, remove convertible
541
top module. See
Convertible Top.
Amplifier is attached to side wall.
CD changer
The optional CD changer is located in
the left side of the trunk behind the trim
panel. An access door allows loading
of up to 6 CDs.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
1 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
650-3
Speakers
Each model in the E46 model line-up
features a slightly different speaker
setup. Speaker and other component
locations also vary depending on the
type of sound system installed. Some
of the common speaker installations
are covered in this section.
Sedan and Sport Wagon: The standard
installation is six speakers, one in each
door and two in the rear. The rear
speakers in the Sedan are in the parcel
shelf. The rear speakers in the Sport
Wagon are mounted on the left and
right wheel housings behind trim
covers.
Coupe: A tweeter and a mid-range
speaker are installed in one housing
unit in each front door panel. Another
speaker pair is in the left and right rear
side trim panels.
Convertible: The standard speaker
set-up consists of four speakers
mounted in the rear side trim panels,
two on each side. One speaker on
each side is a 130 mm wide band and
the other is a tweeter.
The Harman/Kardon system
incorporates an additional subwoofer
installed in the trunk. The amplification
for this subwoofer comes from the main
sound system amplifier.
In the Convertible, the subwoofer is
installed in the ski bag cover. It is
hinged so that it can be swung aside
when the ski bag is used. A magnet on
the subwoofer cover holds it inplace
against the rear bulkhead while the ski
bag is used. The subwoofer functions
in either position.
Also in the Convertible, the sound
system receives a signal from the rear
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
2 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
window defroster relay when the top is
lowered. This switches off the
stereophonic function.
Door mounted speaker,
removing
WARNING!
All E46 cars are equipped with front
door airbags. Rear door airbags are
optional. Before performing any work
involving airbags, disconnect the
negative (-) battery cable. See
721
Airbag System (SRS).
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove interior door panel as
described in
411 Doors.
Detach electrical harness connector (A)
and remove speaker mounting screws
(B).
-
Remove speaker.
Rear side panel speaker,
removing
-
Disconnect battery negative
terminal.
CAUTION!
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
3 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove lower section of rear seat
side trim.
-
If necessary, remove convertible
top module. See
541
Convertible Top (left side only).
-
Speaker is attached to side wall.
Rear speaker, removing and
installing
Working at rear parcel shelf, pry
speaker cover by inner edge and
remove.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring interior trim, work
with a plastic prying tool.
-
Remove mounting screws, lift up
speaker and detach electrical
harness connector.
-
When reinstalling, make sure
speaker and harness are seated
as before.
Subwoofer, removing
-
Coupe:
Working in trunk under parcel
shelf, remove subwoofer mounting
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
4 of 4
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
screws.
Unhook and pull subwoofer down.
Remove electrical harness
connector.
-
Convertible:
Working in trunk, unhook and
swing out subwoofer.
Squeeze plastic harness cover
and remove.
Detach electrical harness
connector.
Using plastic pry tool, gently pry
subwoofer at bottom left and pull
out.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
650-4
Antenna
Antenna and diversity
The antenna used for the radio,
telephone and FZV remote entry
system is integrated with the rear
window defogger in the Sedan and
Coupe models.
Convertible and Sport Wagon models
feature a diversity antenna system to
provide the strongest possible radio
station signal to the sound system.
In this system there are two (or more)
antennas. Both the main and the
auxiliary antenna(s) receive radio
signals and both signals are amplified
in separate amplifiers. The signals are
then transmitted to the diversity
switching module, which locks onto the
strongest signal and sends it to the
radio receiver.
Sport Wagon antenna system
The diversity antenna system on the
E46 Sport Wagon consists of the
following;
FM1 antenna in rear window (right
half)
FM2 antenna in rear window
(center)
FM3 antenna in left rear side
window
AM antenna in rear spoiler
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
FZV (keyless entry) antenna
combined with FM2 antenna
The FM1/FM2 antenna amplifier is
located beneath the rear spoiler. The
signal from this amplifier is transmitted
to the diversity module in the cargo
compartment behind the left trim panel.
1 - Suppression filter
2 - Antenna amplifier
3 - AM antenna
4 - Diversity module
The FM3 antenna has a separate
amplifier integrated into the diversity
module. The module will select the
clearest signal from the three antennas
and transmit that to the sound system.
The AM antenna is glued to the bottom
of the rear spoiler.
Convertible antenna system
The diversity antenna system on the
E46 Convertible consists of the
following:
Main antenna mast on left rear
fender
Auxiliary antenna in convertible
top storage cover
Main antenna amplifier, mounted
directly below the antenna mast
Auxiliary antenna amplifier,
mounted on convertible top
storage cover and powered
through antenna lead
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Diversity switching module,
mounted below antenna mast in
trunk
More information on the rear window
defogger/antenna system is in
640
Heating and Air Conditioning.
Note:
The telephone antenna is wound around
the main antenna mast.
Antenna, removing
(Convertible models)
Unscrew and remove antenna mast.
1 - Antenna mast
2 - Antenna head
3 - Antenna base
4 - Nut (M5)
5 - Antenna cable
6 - Antenna FM amplifier
7 - Antenna diversity amplifier
8 - Nut (M6)
-
Detach and remove wheel housing
trim liner in left side of trunk.
-
Through elongated hole of
antenna retaining bracket,
unscrew M5 nut.
This releases antenna head from
base.
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
Place antenna base down on
bracket.
Remove antenna head from above
fender.
-
To remove base, slide toward rear
of car, then detach cable
connections.
-
When installing, make sure the
offset of antenna head points
toward back of car.
Antenna amplifier, accessing
-
Convertible main antenna
amplifier:
Detach and remove wheel housing
trim liner in left side of trunk.
Antenna amplifier is mounted
below antenna bracket.
-
Convertible auxiliary antenna
amplifier:
Open convertible top compartment
lid.
Auxiliary amplifier is attached to
left rear corner of lid.
Sedan or Coupe antenna amplifier:
Remove left roof pillar (C-pillar)
trim panel as described in
513
Interior Trim to access amplifier.
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Radio
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/6...
-
Sedan or Coupe antenna
suppressor:
Remove right roof pillar (C-pillar)
trim panel to access suppressor.
Sport Wagon FM3 antenna/diversity
module:
Remove left cargo compartment
trim cover to gain access to
module (arrow).
-
Sport Wagon FM1/FM2 antenna
amplifier:
Remove rear spoiler. See
Trunk Lid, Tailgate.
412
Amplifier is in center of rear
window beneath spoiler.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:19 PM
Seat Belts
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
720-1
General
This section covers repairs to the seat
belts.
Multiple Restraint System (MRS II)
electronics integrate seat belt
operations and airbag deployment.
Airbag repair information is covered in
721 Airbag System (SRS).
All E46 models are equipped with
3-point shoulder belts at four seating
positions.
Sport Wagon models are
equipped with an additional
3-point shoulder belt in the center
of the rear seat.
Sedan and Coupe models are
equipped with a lap belt in the
center rear seat position.
Convertible models are equipped
with seat-integrated seat belt
system (SGS) in the front seats.
Child safety anchors
Sport Wagon models are equipped
with three child safety harness anchors
behind the rear seat in the cargo
compartment floor.
Remove plastic cover (arrow) to access
safety anchor eye.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Troubleshooting
The seat belt reel should lock when
driving quickly through curves, during
severe braking or in case of a collision.
The automatic reel does not require
any servicing and should never be
opened.
In case of an accident, follow the seat
belt troubleshooting procedures
presented in
Table a.
Troubleshooting the automatic seat
belt system.
Note:
The rear bench seat belt strap may not
retract fully due to increased friction
between strap and seat cover. A small
remaining loop in belt strap when fully
retracted is acceptable.
WARNING!
For maximum protection from
injury, seat belts should be
replaced as a set (including all
hardware), if they are subject to
occupant loading in a collision.
Seat belts should not be
modified or repaired. The seat
belt mounting points should not
be changed or modified.
Do not bleach or dye seat belt
webbing. Webbing that is
severely faded or re-dyed will
not meet the strength
requirements of a collision and
must be replaced. Clean belts
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
with a luke-warm soap solution
only.
Seat belts should be
periodically inspected for
webbing defects such as cuts or
pulled threads.
Immediately after replacing a
damaged or worn seat belt,
destroy the old belt to prevent it
from being used again.
Table a. Troubleshooting the automatic seat belt system
Problem
Probable cause
Repairs
Damage to seat belt:
Accident in which bumper
impact absorbers were
permanently deformed
Replace complete automatic
seat belt. Also check and
replace, if necessary:
Seat belt mounting on
car body
Seat belt mounting on
seat runner
Belt creased, unraveled,
pinched, cut or melted
Seat belts aged or worn
Replace complete automatic
seat belt.
Belt buckle or belt lock plastic
casing worn, damaged or
missing
Seat belt buckle is not ejected Seat belt lock mechanism
with spring pressure when red worn or damaged
button on seat belt lock is
pressed
Replace seat belt lock.
Seat belt automatic reel does
not lock when pulled out
suddenly.
Automatic reel defective
Replace reel assembly.
Seat belt automatic reel jams
when pulled out.
Automatic reel loose
Tighten reel mounting bolt.
Return spring broken inside
reel
Replace reel assembly.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Problem
Probable cause
Repairs
Seat belt does not retract
automatically. (See note.)
Automatic reel loose
Tighten reel mounting bolt.
Return spring broken inside
reel
Replace reel assembly.
Automatic belt squeaks when
belt fastened or unfastened.
Excessive friction in belt
guides
Replace reel assembly.
Automatic reel loose
Tighten reel mounting bolt.
Return spring broken inside
reel
Replace reel assembly.
Accident triggered
pyrotechnic deployment
Replace complete automatic
seat belt. Also check
retaining bracket of belt
tensioner for twist.
Front seat back requires
excessive force to lock or
unlock
Accident damage to seat via
seat belt
Replace front seat.
Seat back lock warning lamp
on when seat back is locked;
or warning lamp lights up
when seat back is shaken
Seat back lock microswitch
defective
Replace microswitch
Seat belt pyrotechnic
tensioner triggered
Convertible models only:
Microswitch electrical harness Repair electrical leads.
connectors loose or defective
Seat back lock is damaged
Contact surface of inertia reel
warped
Accident damage
Seat back warped or
deformed
Accident damage
Head restraint carrier not
parallel
Accident damage
Seat movement sticky or
sluggish at some point in its
range; unusual noises
Accident damage (side)
Front seat shows evidence of
contact with body structural
part (e.g., door)
Accident damage (side)
Front seat shows evidence of
contact with external objects
Accident damage (rollover)
If fault persists, replace front
seat.
Replace front seat.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
1 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
720-2
Front Seat Belt
Assembly
Front seat belt tensioner,
removing and installing
The front seat belt locks are equipped
with pyrotechnic (explosive charge)
automatic tensioners. These tensioners
are designed to automatically retract
and tension the seat belt by 55 mm
(approximately 2 inches) in the event of
an accident.
WARNING!
Pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners
are powerful devices and should
be handled with extreme care.
Incorrect handling can trigger
the tensioner and cause injury.
BMW recommends that all repair
or replacement work on
pyrotechnic devices must be
carried out by a qualified BMW
technician.
Be sure to disconnect the
battery and wait 5 seconds
before attempting to work on
pyrotechnic devices.
Pyrotechnic devices cannot be
repaired. Always replace them.
Never treat pyrotechnic
components with cleaning
agents or grease.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
2 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Do not expose pyrotechnic
components to temperatures
above 75°C (167°F).
Pyrotechnic components can
only be tested electrically when
installed, using BMW service
tester DIS, MoDiC or equivalent
scan tool.
Do not fire a pyrotechnic gas
generator prior to disposal. It
must be fired by a special
disposal company or shipped
back to BMW in the packaging
of the new components.
During body straightening and
welding with an electric arc
welder, always disconnect the
battery and the connection to
the pyrotechnic gas generators.
-
Detach battery negative (-) cable
in luggage compartment.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove front seat as described in
520 Seats.
Remove pyrotechnic belt tensioner:
Detach tensioner harness
connector from seat rail by cutting
wire tie (A).
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
3 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Detach harness connection (B).
Remove tensioner mounting bolt
(C).
Check tensioner mounting bracket
(arrow) for damage or bending.
Replace if necessary.
CAUTION!
A bent tensioner mounting bracket
may make it impossible to adjust
seat height.
When reinstalling:
Replace wire ties to relieve tension
on the pyrotechnic belt tensioner
harness connector.
Make sure tensioner harness
connector mounting bracket
(arrow) is installed correctly.
Tightening torques
Front seat to floor
(M10 fastener)
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Seat belt to seat
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
Tensioner
mounting bracket
to seat rail
24 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Tensioner to
mounting bracket
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
Front seat belt
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
4 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
assembly (Sedan,
Coupe, Sport Wagon)
1
- Seat belt buckle
2
- Tensioner
mounting bolt
tighten to 48 Nm (35
ft-lb)
3
- Seat belt lock
with
pyrotechnic
tensioner
4
- Seat belt stop
button
5
- Seat belt anchor
bolt
tighten to 48 Nm (35
ft-lb)
6
- Seat belt reel
assembly
6a - Seat belt anchor
end
(Sedan/Sport
Wagon models)
7
- Bolt M8
8
- B-pillar
cross-brace
9
- Plastic cap
10 - Bolt M10
tighten to 31 Nm (23
ft-lb)
11 - Spring washer
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
5 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
12 - Spacer
13 - Seat belt anchor
bar (Coupe
only)
14 - Cap
15 - Grommet
16 - Seat belt reel
mounting bolt
M10
tighten to 31 Nm (23
ft-lb)
17 - Seat belt height
adjuster
Front seat belt reel, removing
and installing (Sedan, Coupe or
Sport Wagon models)
-
Detach battery negative (-) cable in
luggage compartment.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove front seat as described in
520 Seats.
-
Coupe models: Working just inside
door sill.
Pry off plastic protective cap over
end of seat belt anchor bar.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
6 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Remove anchor bar bolt and slip off
end of seat belt from bar.
Note:
Replace anchor bar if it is bent.
Prying gently upward, remove plastic
door sill protector strip.
Sedan or Sport Wagon models: Remove
lower B-pillar (door pillar) plastic trim.
Pry gently along bottom of trim to
disengage clips from pillar.
Slide trim down and out.
-
Coupe models: Remove rear side
panel as described in
411 Doors.
Note:
Partially peel rubber door seal(s) away
from B-pillar.
Remove upper B-pillar (door pillar)
plastic trim expansion rivets (arrows).
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
7 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Pull B-pillar upper trim down to remove.
Remove automatic reel from B-pillar:
Remove upper seat belt anchor bolt
(A).
Remove cross-brace mounting bolts
(B).
Remove sound insulation at base of
B-pillar. Then remove automatic
seat belt reel mounting bolt (C).
Lift out reel.
-
If it is necessary to remove sliding
seat belt height adjuster, unscrew
mounting bolts from B-pillar.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Install automatic reel housing to
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
8 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
B-pillar by sliding tab into locating
slot.
Tightening torques
Front seat to floor
(M10 fastener)
45 Nm (33 ft-lb)
Seat belt anchor
bar to door sill
31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
Seat belt to seat
48 Nm (35 ft-lb)
Seat belt to B-pillar
sliding anchor
31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
Seat belt reel to
B-pillar bottom
31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
Sliding seat height
adjuster to B-pillar
24 Nm (18 ft-lb)
Seat-integrated seat belt system
(SGS) (Convertible models)
The front seats of E46 Convertible
models are designed with integrated
seat belts. In this way, the forces acting
on a front seat occupant during a
collision are channeled to the reinforced
floor.
All belt fastening points move with the
seat as it is adjusted. This ensures the
best possible body strapping regardless
of seat position or occupant size. With
the shorter free belt length, the occupant
is held more reliably with vehicle
deceleration.
The fixed anchor point and the seat belt
lock/tensioner are mounted on the seat
frame. The upper seat belt guide is
attached to the headrest. In this way the
belt is optimally positioned regardless of
headrest position.
The inertia reel is attached to the inside
of the seat backrest. The mechanism is
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
9 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
connected to the backrest hinge through
a lever and a cable drive (coupler
mechanism). As the angle of the
backrest is adjusted, the cable drive will
change the angle of the inertia lock. In
this way the reel is in the proper position
for locking at any seat back angle.
The seat belt lock and tensioner on the
SGS system is a pyrotechnic device
similar to that on other E46 models.
When working on SGS belts, be sure to
read the warnings and cautions in the
procedure for front seat belt tensioner
removal and installation, earlier in this
group.
Note:
SGS seat belt removal can only be
carried out with the seat out of the
car. See
520 Seats.
Once the seat has been removed,
the seat backrest must be partially
disassembled. The accompanying
illustration provides information on
SGS component locations and
fastener torques.
Seat-integrated seat
belt system (SGS)
(Convertible)
1
- Coupler
mechanism
2
- Self-tapping
screw M4.2
tighten to 2.5 Nm
(22 in-lb)
3
- Threaded pin
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
10 of 10
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
4
- Front seat
backrest
5
- Support
6
- SGS belt reel
mounting nut
M10
tighten to 39 Nm (29
ft-lb)
7
- SGS inertia reel
assembly
8
- Torx bolt M6
tighten to 4.5 Nm
(40 in-lb)
9
- Seat belt guide
cover, front
10 - Seat belt guide
cover, rear
11 - Connector
12 - Clip
13 - Seat belt button
14 - Bushing
15 - Bolt M10 (selflocking, always
replace)
tighten to 45 Nm (33
ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
1 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
720-3
Rear Seat Belt Assembly
Rear seat belts (Sedan or
Coupe models)
-
Remove rear parcel shelf to
access shoulder belt assembly
mounting bolts.
-
Remove rear seat cushion to
access rear seat belt lock
mounting bolts. See
520 Seats.
-
The accompanying illustration
provides information on rear seat
belt component locations and
fastener torques.
-
When installing seat belt lock
straps:
Install right lock strap (which is
shorter) underneath middle lock
strap.
Install left lock strap underneath
middle lap belt strap.
Metal strap ends must rest against
stop on floor underneath seat.
Rear seat belt assembly
(Sedan/Coupe)
1
- Center shoulder
belt reel
assembly (if
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
2 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
equipped)
2
- Right shoulder
belt lock
3
- Lap-belt
assembly
4
- Left shoulder
belt lock
5
- Bolt M10
tighten to 31 Nm (23
ft-lb)
6
- Left shoulder
belt reel
assembly
7
- Center shoulder
belt lock (if
equipped)
8
- Bolt M12
tighten to 31 Nm (23
ft-lb)
Rear seat belts (Sport Wagon
models)
-
Center shoulder belt:
Remove shoulder belt guide trim at
top of seat backrest. Feed belt out
through slot in trim.
Working in cargo compartment,
partially remove backrest cover to
access shoulder belt reel.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
3 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Remove shoulder belt reel
mounting bolt inside backrest.
Note:
Remove bowden cable from backrest
brackets and unhook from backrest
release latch. Center seat belt reel can
be then be removed.
-
Outboard shoulder belt:
Remove roof-pillar (C-pillar) trim.
Remove center shoulder belt.
-
Lift up rear seat cushion(s) to
access rear seat belt lock mounting
bolt(s).
The accompanying illustration provides
information on rear seat belt component
locations and fastener torques.
1 - Bolt M10 -tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
2 - Right shoulder belt reel assembly.
3 - Center belt lock
4 - Right belt lock
5 - Left belt lock
6 - Center shoulder belt reel assembly
7 - Left shoulder belt reel assembly
8 - Bolt M12 -tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
-
When installing seat belt lock
straps:
Install right belt lock strap (which is
shorter) underneath center belt lock
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
4 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
strap.
Install left belt lock strap
underneath center lap belt strap.
Metal strap ends must rest against
stop on floor underneath seat.
Rear seat belts (Convertible
models)
-
Access shoulder belt or seat belt
lock mounting bolts:
Remove center armrest.
Push shoulder belts toward sides
and feed out of top guides.
Lift seat cushion up and forward to
remove.
Remove lower backrest securing
screws located below backrest. Lift
backrest straight up and unhook
from tabs in back.
Remove rear head restraints by
pulling straight up.
Remove cover of rollover protection
bars for right and left side.
Open convertible top compartment
cover.
-
Shoulder belt reels are bolted to
convertible top storage
compartment.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Seat Belts
5 of 5
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
The accompanying illustration provides
information on rear seat belt component
locations and fastener torques.
1 - Bolt M10 -tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
2 - Left shoulder belt reel assembly.
3 - Seat belt stop button
4 - Left belt lock
5 - Bolt M12 -tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:20 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
721-1
General
This repair group covers airbag
components. Airbag system repair and
fault diagnosis is not covered here.
Diagnostics, component testing, and
airbag system repair should be carried
out by trained BMW service
technicians.
Note:
Airbags are also known as the
Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS). In the E46 cars the
occupant safety system is called
the Multiple Restraint System
(MRS).
Special test equipment is required
to retrieve airbag fault codes,
diagnose system faults, and
reset/turn off the airbag indicator
light. The indicator light will remain
on until any problem has been
corrected and the fault memory
has been cleared.
Individual airbag system components
can only be tested electronically when
installed in the car. BMW service
testers DIS or MoDiC or equivalent
must be used for diagnostic work.
Special tools
Most airbag system repairs can be
performed with normal shop tools. Use
BMW special tool 00 9 321 or
equivalent plastic prying tool to pry out
plastic interior parts without damage or
marring.
Plastic prying tool BMW 00 9 321
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Airbag system
The E46 airbag system consists of the
following:
Driver airbag in the center of the
steering wheel hub
Passenger airbag in the right side
of the dashboard
Front side-impact airbags, one in
each front door
Head Protection System (HPS)
airbags, one in each front roof
pillar (A-pillar)
As an option, some cars may be
equipped with:
Rear side-impact airbags, one in
each rear door (4-door Sedan or
Sport Wagon).
The airbags and seat belts are
integrated into the Multiple Restraint
System (MRS). The MRS control
module is located on the center tunnel,
underneath the rug below the parking
brake handle.
E46 Airbags
1
- Driver air bag
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
2
- Passenger
airbag
3
- Head Protection
System (HPS)
airbag
4
- Front door
side-impact
airbag
5
- Rear door
side-impact
airbag (optional)
2-stage airbag
Beginning in the 2000 model year
(9/1999 production) the front airbags
were changed to a 2-stage style airbag.
This ensures that the force of airbag
inflation is not greater than necessary to
provide protection. The airbags are
designed to provide "soft" deployment if
the acceleration sensor detects a
low-speed impact, with a "hard"
deployment only in higher speed
impacts.
Head protection airbags (HPS)
This protective system covers a large
area between the front roof pillar
(A-pillar) and the rear section of the roof.
A hollow flexible tube about 5 feet long
and 1.5 inches in diameter is anchored
inside the A-pillar and front roof rail and
concealed by interior trim.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Upon severe side impact, a gas
generator unit fills the Head Protection
System (HPS) tube with inert gas. The
expanding tube pops out of the trim to
form a straight tube 5.1 inches in
diameter and stretched in a straight line
from the lower windshield pillar to above
the rear door. The inflated tube is
located to prevent the front occupant's
head from contacting the A-pillar, the
B-pillar, or side window. The tube's
sloping position allows protection for
both short and tall people. The inflated
tube is stiff enough to retain much of its
effectiveness even if the window is
broken. The HPS tube remains inflated
for approximately 7 to 8 seconds to
extend protection time in case the
vehicle encounters additional side
impacts during the crash.
Rear side-impact airbags
Similar to the standard-equipment front
side-impact airbags, the rear airbags are
built into the doors of sedan models.
These were offered as a special order
option on certain models only. They can
be deactivated to protect infants or small
children riding in the rear seat. Activation
and deactivation can be performed by
using either DIS or MoDiC BMW scan
tools.
MRS deployment logic
Main sensing and triggering functions for
the front-impact airbags and seat belt
tensioners are combined into a single
MRS control module located above the
center tunnel, under the rug, beneath
the parking brake handle.
Side-impact and head protection airbags
are controlled by separate sensors, one
for each side of the vehicle.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
MRS deployment logic provides two
thresholds for the activation of the safety
system, depending upon the severity of
impact and whether or not occupants
have fastened their seat belts:
Belts fastened, low impact speed:
Lower deployment threshold. Only
seat belt pyrotechnic tensioners are
deployed.
Belts fastened, high impact speed:
Higher deployment threshold.
Tensioners and front-impact airbags
are deployed.
Belts not fastened, low or high
impact speed: Airbags are
deployed.
Passenger seat not occupied:
Neither belt tensioner nor airbag is
deployed on that side.
MRS
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Airbag indicator light
The MRS control module detects and
stores system status.
The airbag indicator light in the
instrument cluster displays the status of
the airbag system when the ignition key
is in "accessory" or ON positions.
System normal: Indicator light
comes on briefly, then goes out.
System malfunction: Indicator light
fails to come on.
System malfunction: Indicator light
comes on briefly, goes out and
lights up again.
The airbag indicator light also comes on if
the seat belt pyrotechnic tensioners have
been triggered.
Warnings
When servicing airbag equipped cars, the
following precautions must be observed
to prevent personal injury.
WARNING!
If the airbag indicator light is on,
there is a risk that the airbags will
not be triggered in case of an
accident. Be sure to have the
system inspected and repaired
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
immediately.
Airbag(s) are inflated by an
explosive device. Handled
improperly or without adequate
safeguards, the system can be
very dangerous. Special
precautions must be observed
prior to any work at or near the
airbags.
The airbag is a vehicle safety
system. Serious injury may result
if system service is attempted by
persons unfamiliar with the BMW
MRS II and its approved service
procedures. BMW advises that all
inspection and service be
performed by an authorized BMW
dealer.
Always disconnect the battery and
cover the negative (-) battery
terminal with an insulator before
starting diagnostic,
troubleshooting or service work
not associated with the airbags,
and before doing any welding on
the car.
After disconnecting the battery,
wait 5 seconds before beginning
work on airbag components.
If an airbag has been activated
due to an accident, BMW specifies
that airbag components be
replaced. For more information on
post-collision airbag service, see
an authorized BMW dealer.
Do not fire an airbag unit prior to
disposal. It must be fired by a
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
special disposal company or
shipped back to BMW in the
packaging of the new
components.
When removing a fired airbag unit,
avoid contact with the skin; wear
gloves. In case of skin contact,
wash with water.
Do not allow airbag system
components to come in contact
with cleaning solutions or grease.
Never subject airbag components
to temperatures above 167F (75C).
When reconnecting the battery, no
person should be inside the
vehicle.
Always place an airbag unit that
has been removed from its
packaging with the padded side
facing upward. Do not leave an
airbag unit unattended.
If the airbag unit or airbag control
module has been dropped from a
height of meter (1 ft.) or more, the
airbag unit should not be
installed.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
1 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
721-2
Airbag Electronics
Airbag harnesses and
connectors
If airbag connection harnesses show
visible signs of wear or damage, they
must be replaced or repaired.
-
To repair airbag harness:
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover negative
terminal with insulating material.
Disconnect harness connector at
airbag module or on intermediate
plug.
Cut through one cable, then the
other, and repair.
CAUTION!
Do not under any circumstances
cut through both wires of an
airbag harness at the same time.
Perform only one repair on an
airbag harness wire. If more
than one spot is damaged,
replace the entire section of
harness.
MRS control module, replacing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover negative
terminal with insulating material.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
2 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove center utility tray between
front seats. See
513 Interior
Trim.
Cut open carpet on top of center tunnel
to access MRS II module.
-
Remove module mounting nuts
and lift up control module. Detach
electrical harness connector.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Be sure that MRS module ground
cable is attached to the module
mounting stud.
Side-impact crash sensor,
removing and installing
-
Make sure ignition key is OFF.
-
Remove front seat. See
Seats.
520
Remove plastic door sill trim by lifting
to release clips at one end, then sliding
off. Fold up carpet towards rear seat
floor. If necessary, remove floor level
heater duct.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
3 of 3
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Remove electrical harness connector
from crash sensor (A). Remove sensor
retaining screws (B) and remove
sensor. Note direction of sensor arrow
before removing.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Note:
Arrow on sensor must point to door sill.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
1 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
721-3
Airbags
Driver airbag, removing and
installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover negative
terminal with insulating material.
WARNING!
After disconnecting the battery, wait
5 seconds before beginning work on
airbag components.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Multifunction (MFL) steering wheel:
Working behind steering wheel,
completely loosen Torx screws
(T30) while holding airbag in
place.
Support airbag unit to prevent it
from falling out.
Carefully lift airbag unit off steering
wheel and disconnect harness
connector (arrow) from rear of airbag
unit.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
2 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Sport steering wheel:
Insert screwdriver through
opening in rear of steering wheel
and push against spring tension
to release airbag unit lock.
Repeat procedure on other side of
steering wheel.
Lift off airbag unit and detach
electrical harness connectors.
WARNING!
Store the removed airbag unit
with the horn pad facing up. If
stored facing down, accidental
deployment could propel it
violently into the air, causing
injury.
Once an airbag is removed, the
car must not be driven.
Do not connect the battery with
the airbag disconnected. A fault
code will be stored, setting off
the airbag indicator light.
Special tools are needed to reset
the fault memory.
Once the airbag unit is installed
and all other service procedures
have been completed, start the
engine and check that the
airbag indicator light goes out. If
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
3 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
the indicator light stays on, the
airbag system will not function
as designed. Have the system
diagnosed and repaired by an
authorized BMW dealer.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
MFL steering wheel: Torque
airbag using specification listed
below.
Sport steering wheel: Press airbag
unit mounting pins into spring
locks in steering wheel until they
snap in firmly.
CAUTION!
Do not pinch airbag harness in
center of steering wheel when
installing airbag.
Tightening torque
Airbag to steering
wheel (MFL)
8 Nm (71 in-lb)
Passenger airbag, removing
and installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover negative
terminal with insulating material.
WARNING!
After disconnecting the battery, wait
5 seconds before beginning work on
airbag components.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
4 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Pry gently at right dashboard trim to
remove.
CAUTION!
To avoid marring interior trim, work
with a plastic prying tool.
-
Remove right dashboard fresh air
outlet mounting screws and pull
outlet out of dash.
Lift cover from top of passenger side
airbag on dashboard.
Remove cover strap retaining bolts
(arrows) to detach cover
completely from dashboard.
CAUTION!
The plastic retainer at the right end
of the cover may snap during
removal. Be sure to have extra
retainers on hand for reassembly
Remove airbag mounting bolts
(arrows).
-
Lift airbag and disconnect
electrical harness connector.
Remove airbag.
WARNING!
Store the removed airbag unit with
the soft pad facing up. If stored
facing down, accidental deployment
could propel it violently into the air,
causing injury.
Early E46 cars (through production
date 9/1999) were equipped with a
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
5 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
single stage airbag, identified by
having only one wire loom in the
harness connector. Later production
two stage airbags are supplied by two
wire looms in the connector plug. The
two kinds of airbags are NOT
interchangeable.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Make sure wiring harness is not
pinched when installing airbag
unit in dashboard.
Tightening torques
Airbag cover strap
to dashboard (M6)
9 Nm (7 ft-lb)
Passenger air bag
to dashboard (M8)
22 Nm (16 ft-lb)
Door mounted side-impact
airbag, removing and installing
-
Disconnect negative (-) cable from
battery and cover negative
terminal with insulating material.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
-
Remove inside door panel as
described in
411 Doors.
Front door airbag:
Remove airbag mounting bolts
(arrows).
Turn over airbag unit and cut off
electrical harness wire tie.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
6 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Detach harness connector.
CAUTION!
When removing and installing the
airbag unit, pay attention to the
routing of the electrical harness to
avoid kinks or breaks in the wire.
-
Rear door airbag:
Detach electrical harness
connector.
Remove mounting bolts and
remove airbag from door.
-
Installation is reverse of removal.
Route electrical harnesses as they
were before.
Use new wire ties as necessary.
Use new self-locking mounting
bolts.
Tightening torque
Side-impact airbag
to door
8.5 Nm (75
in-lb)
Head protection airbag (HPS)
components
Replacement of a head protection
airbag (HPS) is an extensive operation.
Replacement includes removal of the
following components:
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
7 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
Complete dashboard
Complete headliner
Windshield pillar (A-pillar) trim
Door pillar (B-pillar) trim
-
Before starting work on the HPS
airbag, disconnect negative (-)
cable from battery and cover
negative terminal with insulating
material.
CAUTION!
Prior to disconnecting the battery,
read the battery disconnection
cautions given at the front of this
manual on page viii.
Tightening torque
HPS airbag to body
11 Nm (8 ft-lb)
HPS airbag
mounting bracket to
A or B-pillar
2.5 Nm (22
in-lb)
HPS gas generator
to dashboard
reinforcement M6
self-tapping screw
4 Nm (35 in-lb)
Head protection airbag
(HPS)
1
- B-pillar
deflection plate
2
- Head protection
airbag
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
Airbag System (SRS)
8 of 8
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/7...
3
- Cable holder
4
- Gas generator
5
- Self-tapping
screw M6
tighten to 4 Nm (35
in-lb)
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:21 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
1 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
OBD-2
On-Board Diagnostics
(OBD II)
OBD II is an acronym for On-Board
Diagnostics II, the second generation of
on-board self-diagnostic equipment
requirements. These standards were
originally mandated for California
vehicles. Since 1996 they have been
applied to all passenger vehicles sold
in the United States.
On-board diagnostic capabilities are
incorporated into the hardware and
software of the engine control module
(ECM) to monitor virtually every
component that can affect vehicle
emissions. OBD II works to ensure that
the vehicles remain as clean as
possible over their entire life.
Each emission-influencing component
is checked by a diagnostic routine to
verify that it is functioning properly. If a
problem or malfunction is detected, the
OBD II system illuminates a warning
light on the instrument panel to alert
the driver. This malfunction indicator
light (MIL) will display the phrase
"Check Engine" or "Service Engine
Soon."
The OBD II system also stores
important information about the
detected malfunction so that a repair
technician can accurately find and fix
the problem.
Note:
Specialized OBD II scan tool
equipment is needed to access the
fault memory and OBD II data.
The OBD II fault memory
(including the MIL) can only be
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
2 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
reset using the special scan tool.
Removing the connector from the
ECM or disconnecting the battery
will not erase the fault memory.
The extra hardware needed to operate
the OBD II system consists mainly of
the following:
Additional oxygen sensors
downstream of the catalytic
converters
Fuel tank pressure sensor and
device to pressurize fuel storage
system
Several engine and performance
monitoring devices
Standardized 16-pin OBD II
connector under the dash
Upgraded components for the
federally required 100,000 mile or
10 year reliability mandate
Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL)
The OBD II system is designed to
illuminate the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) when emission levels
exceed 1.5 times the Federal
standards.
Note:
On model year 1999 and 2000 cars, the
MIL is labeled Check Engine. On model
year 2001 cars, the MIL is labeled
Service Engine Soon.
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
3 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
The MIL will come on under the
following conditions.
An engine management system
fault is detected for two
consecutive OBD II drive cycles.
A catalyst damaging fault.
A component malfunction (such
as catalyst deterioration) causes
emissions to exceed 1.5 times
OBD II standards.
Manufacturer-defined
specifications are exceeded.
An implausible input signal is
generated.
Misfire faults occur.
A leak is detected in evaporative
system.
The oxygen sensors observe no
purge flow from purge
valve/evaporative system.
The engine control module (ECM)
fails to enter closed-loop operation
within specified time.
The engine control module (ECM)
or automatic transmission control
module (TCM) enters "limp home"
operation mode.
Key is in "ignition on" position
before cranking (bulb check
function).
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
4 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
Additional information, MIL:
A fault code is stored within the
ECM upon the first occurrence of
a fault in the system being
checked.
Two complete consecutive drive
cycles with the fault present
illuminate the MIL. The exception
to the two-fault requirement is a
catalyst damaging fault, which will
turn the light on immediately.
If the second drive cycle was not
complete and the specific function
was not checked as shown in the
example, the ECM counts the third
drive cycle as the next consecutive
drive cycle. The MIL is illuminated
if the function is checked and the
fault is still present.
Once the MIL is illuminated it will
remain illuminated unless the
specific function has been
checked without fault through
three complete consecutive drive
cycles.
The fault code will be cleared from
memory automatically if the
specific function is checked
through 40 consecutive drive
cycles without the fault being
detected.
Note:
In order to automatically clear a catalyst
damaging fault from memory, the
condition under which the fault occurred
must be evaluated for 80 consecutive
drive cycles without the fault
reoccurring.
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
5 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
With the use of a universal or 'generic'
scan tool connected to the DLC
(Diagnostic Link Connector), diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) can be obtained,
along with the conditions associated
with the illumination of the engine
service light. Using a more advanced or
BMW-dedicated scan tool, additional
'proprietary' information is normally
available.
Scan tool and scan tool display
Owing to the advanced nature of OBD
II adaptive strategies, all diagnostics
need to start with a scan tool. The
aftermarket scan tools can be
connected to either the 16-pin OBD II
Data Link Connector (DLC) or the BMW
20-pin DLC in the engine compartment.
Data from the OBD II DLC may be
limited, depending on scan tool and
vehicle.
OBD II standards mandate that the
16-pin DLC must be located within
three (3) feet of the driver and must not
require any tools to be exposed. The
communication protocol used by BMW
is ISO 9141.
Starting with June 2000 production, the
20-pin BMW diagnostic port (Data Link
Connector or DLC) which was
previously located in the engine
compartment has been deleted. All
diagnostic, coding and programming
functions are incorporated into the
OBD II diagnostic port, located under
left side of dashboard.
Note:
On cars built up 06-2000: when
accessing emissions related DTCs
through the 16-pin OBD II DLC, the
BMW 20-pin DLC cap must be
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
6 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
installed.
Professional diagnostic scan tools
available at the time of this
printing include the BMW factory
tools (DISplus and MoDiC) and a
small number of aftermarket
BMW-specific tools. The CS2000
from Baum Tools Unlimited, the
Retriever from Assenmacher
Specialty Tools, and the MT2500
from Snap-On Tools are examples
of quality OBD scan tools.
In addition to the professional line
of scan tools, inexpensive
`generic' OBD II scan tool software
programs and handheld units are
readily available. These tools do
have limited capabilities, but they
are nonetheless powerful
diagnostic tools. These tools read
live data streams and freeze frame
data as well as a host of other
valuable diagnostic data.
For the do-it-yourself owner,
simple aftermarket DTC readers
are also available. These
inexpensive BMW-only tools are
capable of checking for DTCs as
well as turning off the illuminated
MIL and resetting the service
indicator lights.
Diagnostic monitors
A diagnostic monitor is an operating
strategy that runs internal tests and
checks a specific system, component
or function. This is similar to computer
self tests.
Completion of a drive cycle ensures
that all monitors have completed their
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
7 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
required tests. The ECM must
recognize the loss or impairment of the
signal or component and determine if a
signal or sensor is faulty based on 3
conditions:
Signal or component shorted to
ground
Signal or component shorted to
B+
Signal or component missing
(open circuit)
The OBD II system must monitor all
emission control systems that are
on-board. Not all vehicles have a full
complement of emission control
systems. For example, a vehicle may
not be equipped with secondary air
injection, so naturally no secondary air
readiness/function code would be
present.
OBD lI requires monitoring of the
following:
Oxygen sensor monitoring
Catalyst monitoring
Misfire monitoring
Evaporative system monitoring
Secondary air monitoring
Fuel system monitoring
Monitoring these emissions related
functions is done using DME input
sensors and output accouters based
on preprogrammed data sets. If the
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
8 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
ECM cannot determine the
environment or engine operating
conditions due to missing or faulty
signals it will set a fault code and,
depending on conditions, illuminate the
MIL.
Oxygen sensor monitoring: When drive
conditions allow, response rate and
switching time of each oxygen sensor
is monitored. In addition, the heater
function is also monitored. The OBD II
"diagnostic executive" knows the
difference between upstream and
downstream oxygen sensors and reads
each one individually.
All oxygen sensors are monitored
separately. In order for the oxygen
sensor to be effectively monitored, the
system must be in closed loop
operation.
Catalyst monitoring: This strategy
monitors the two heated oxygen
sensors per bank of cylinders. It
compares the oxygen content going
into the catalytic converter to the
oxygen leaving the converter.
The diagnostic executive knows that
most of the oxygen should be used up
during the oxidation phase and if it
sees higher than programmed values,
a fault will be set and the MIL will
illuminate.
Misfire detection: This strategy
monitors crankshaft speed fluctuations
and determines if a misfire occurs by
variations in speed between each
crankshaft sensor trigger point. This
strategy is so finely tuned that it can
even determine the severity of the
misfire.
The diagnostic executive must
determine if misfire is occurring, as well
as other pertinent misfire information.
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
9 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
Specific cylinder(s)
Severity of the misfire event
Emissions relevant or catalyst
damaging
Misfire detection is an on-going
monitoring process that is only
disabled under certain limited
conditions.
Secondary air injection monitoring:
Secondary air injection is used to
reduce HC and CO emissions during
engine warm up. Immediately following
a cold engine start (-10 to 40�C),
fresh air/oxygen is pumped directly into
the exhaust manifold. By injecting
oxygen into the exhaust manifold,
catalyst warm-up time is reduced.
System components:
Electric air injection motor/pump
Electric motor/pump relay
Non-return valve
Vacuum/vent valve
Stainless steel air injection pipes
Vacuum reservoir
The secondary air system is monitored
via the use of the pre-catalyst oxygen
sensors. Once the air pump is active
and air is injected into the system, the
signal at the oxygen sensor will reflect
a lean condition. If the oxygen sensor
signal does not change, a fault will be
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
10 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
set and identify the faulty bank(s). If
after completing the next cold start a
fault is again present, the MIL will be
illuminated.
Fuel system monitoring: This monitors
receives high priority. It looks at the
fuel delivery needed (long/short term
fuel trim) for proper engine operation
based on programmed data. If too
much or not enough fuel is delivered
over a predetermined time, a DTC is
set and the MIL is turned on.
Note:
Fuel trim refers to adjustments to base
fuel schedule. Long-term fuel trim
refers to gradual adjustments to the fuel
calibration adjustment as compared to
short term fuel trim. Long term fuel trim
adjustments compensate for gradual
changes that occur over time.
Fuel system monitoring monitors the
calculated injection time (ti) in relation
to engine speed, load, and the
pre-catalytic converter oxygen
sensor(s) signals as a result of residual
oxygen in the exhaust stream.
The diagnostic executive uses the
precatalyst oxygen sensor signal as a
correction factor for adjusting and
optimizing the mixture pilot control
under all engine operating conditions.
Evaporative system monitoring: This
monitor checks the sealed integrity of
the fuel storage system and related
fuel lines.
This monitor has the ability to detect
very small leaks anywhere in the
system. A pressure test is be
performed on the EVAP system on a
continuous basis as the drive cycle
allows.
On MS 42.0 cars, a leak detection
pump (LDP) is used to pressurize and
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
11 of 11
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
check system integrity. On MS 43.0
cars, a more sophisticated DMTL
(Diagnostic Module - Leak Detection)
pump is used.
Drive cycle
The OBD II drive cycle is an important
concept in understanding OBD II
requirements. The purpose of the drive
cycle is to run all of the emissionrelated on-board diagnostics over on a
broad range of driving conditions.
The drive cycle is considered
completed when all of the diagnostic
monitors have run their tests without
interruption. For a drive cycle to be
initiated, the vehicle must be started
cold and brought up to 160�F and at
least 40�F above its original starting
temperature.
Once the drive cycle is completed, the
system status or
inspection/maintenance (I/M) readiness
codes are set to "Yes."
System status codes will be set to "No"
in the following cases:
The battery or ECM is
disconnected.
The ECM's DTCs have been
erased after completion of repairs
and a drive cycle has not be
completed.
A scan tool can be used to determine if
on-board diagnosis is complete as well
as the status of the I/M codes. All
required tests must be completed
before the I/M readiness codes will be
set to "Yes".
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
Readiness codes
2/25/2009 11:22 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
1 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
OBD-3
BMW Fault Codes
(DTCs)
Below is a comprehensive listing of
BMW DTCs and the corresponding
SAE P-codes.
Table a. Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
1
Ignition coil cyl.2
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
2
Ignition coil cyl.4
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
3
Ignition coil cyl.6
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
5
P0202
Injector circuit cyl.
2
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
6
P0201
Injector circuit cyl.
1
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
2 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
8
P0101
Mass air flow
circuit range/perf.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
10
Engine coolant
temp. circuit
range/perf.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits within specific engine
operations.
11
Coolant temp.
coolant outlet
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits within specific engine
operations.
14
P0111
Intake air temp.
Input analog
range/performance (0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits within specific engine
operations.
18
P1397
Exhaust cam
position sensor
malfunction
Input analog
phase shift (0-5V)
Internal check of phase shift
from camshaft sensor should change during every
crankshaft revolution.Phase
shift occurs due to 2:1
relationship between
camshafts.
19
P1529
VANOS solenoid
activation, exhaust
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
21
P1525
VANOS solenoid
activation, intake
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
22
P0203
Injector circuit cyl.
3
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
3 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
23
P0206
Injector circuit cyl.
6
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
24
P0204
Injector circuit cyl.
4
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
25
P0135
Oxygen sensor
heater pre-cat
(Bank1)
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
27
P1550
Idle control valve
closing coil
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
29
Ignition coil cyl.1
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
30
Ignition coil cyl.3
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
31
Ignition coil cyl.5
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
DME initiates secondary
ignition for each cylinder then
looks for feedback through
shunt resistor in harness to
determine if ignition actually
occurred.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
4 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
33
P0205
Injector circuit cyl.
5
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
35
P1453
Secondary air
injection pump
Output digital
on/off (active low)
TDME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
36
MS 43
Main relay
malfunction
Input analog
(0-12V)
Signal range check between
DME ignition analog input
and main relay power circuit
analog input.
38
MS 43
Clutch switch
faulty
Input digital
(0-12V)
Plausibility check of clutch
switch and DME internal
values such as load and
engine speed.
39
Brake light switch,
and brake light
plausibility test
Input digital
(0-12V)
When brake light switch is
active, brake light test switch
must be also active. If not,
fault is stored.
40
Brake light switch,
pedal sensor
plausibility test
Input digital /
analog (0-12V /
0-5V)
If pedal sensor is showing
angle greater than "limp
home angle" and additionally
brake light switch is active,
fault is stored.
42
Multi functional
steering wheel,
redundant code
Input binary
stream (0-12V)
Every signal from cruise
control switch is transferred
redundantly. A fault is set
whenever two redundant
information paths are showing
a different status.
43
Multi functional
steering wheel,
control switch
Input binary
stream (0-12V)
When status from cruise
control showing
set/accelerate and
deceleration are same time,
fault is set.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
5 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
45
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
Multi functional
steering wheel,
toggle-bit
Input binary
stream (0-12V)
Every 0.5 sec. a message that
includes a toggle bit (toggles
between 0->1 and 1->0) is
transmitted. Change bit is
monitored to indicate proper
function.
47
MS 43
Torque monitoring
level 1
DME internal
values logical
48
MS 43
Internal control
module
DME HW test
memory
ECU internal test
DME HW test
P1145
MS 42
Running losses
valve (3/2), final
stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
MS 43
ECU internal test
DME HW test
MS 43
ECU internal test
DME HW test
49
50
51
52
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Rear exhaust valve Output digital
flap
steady (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
53
P1509
Idle control valve
opening coil
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
55
P0155
Oxygen sensor
heater pre-cat
(Bank 2)
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Ignition feedback,
interruption at
Input analog (32V)
Check for correct signal
voltage. If voltage is 32V
56
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
6 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
shunt resistor
Explanation
(limitation voltage) then
secondary ignition voltage is
detected and shunt resistor
may be faulty.
57
P0325
Knock sensor 1
circuit, (Bank 1)
circuit continuity
Input analog
amplitude
(13-19kHz)
Plausibility check between
knock sensor amplitude
during knocking with internal
knock detection mapped DME
values.
59
P0330
Knock sensor 2
circuit, (Bank 2)
circuit continuity
Input analog
amplitude
(13-19kHz)
Plausibility check between
knock sensor amplitude
during knocking with internal
knock detection mapped DME
values.
61
P0141
Oxygen sensor
heater post-cat
(Bank 2)
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
62
P0412
Secondary air
injection system
switching valve
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
65
P0340
Intake cam position Input analog
sensor,
phase shift 0-5V
malfunction
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
68
Output digital
EVAP system,
purge control valve pulse width (active
circuit
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
69
Relay fuel pump
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
Output digital
on/off (active low)
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
7 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
transistor and component
exists.
74
AC compressor
relay
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
79
P0161
Oxygen sensor
heater post-cat
(Bank 1)
83
P0335
Crankshaft position Input digital
sensor,
(0-12V)
malfunction
Checks for correct signal
pattern and correct number of
expected flywheel teeth.
100
P0601
Internal control
module, memory
check sum or
communication
DME internal
values logical
Internal hardware test of
RAM, ROM, and Flash Prom.
103
P1519
VANOS faulty
reference value
intake
DME internal
values logical
Maximum VANOS adjustment
angle, checked at every
engine start must be within a
specified limit.
104
P1520
VANOS faulty
reference value
exhaust
DME internal
values logical
Maximum VANOS adjustment
angle, checked at every
engine start must be within a
specified limit.
105
P1522
VANOS stuck
(Bank 1) intake
DME internal
values
Monitoring of a desired
VANOS adjustment within a
predefined diagnostic time
limit.
106
P1523
VANOS stuck
(Bank 2) exhaust
DME internal
values
Monitoring of a desired
VANOS adjustment within a
predefined diagnostic time
limit.
109
P1580
Motor throttle valve Output digital
pulse width
pulse width not
(0-12V)
plausible
Throttle position control
algorithm checks for problems
with mechanical coupling
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
8 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
spring within motor throttle
body.
110
P1542
Pedal sensor
potentiometer 1
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
111
P1542
Pedal Sensor
Potentiometer 2
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
112
P0120
MS 42
Motor throttle valve Input analog
potentiometer 1
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
MS 43
Throttle position
sensor 1
Input analog
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
113
P0120
Motor throttle valve Input analog
potentiometer 2
(0-5V)
Failed signal range check
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
114
P1580
MS 42
Motor throttle valve DME internal test
final stage
Final stage inside DME
(special H-bridge), will set
internal flag whenever a short
to ground, a short to battery
voltage or a disconnection
occurs.
MS 43
A second pedal
sensor range
check failure is
determined
DME internal
values logical
If pedal sensor malfunction is
determined, followed by a
second malfunction, a signal
is sent.
P1623
MS 42
Output voltage 5V
for potentiometer
operation 1
DME internal (5V)
Check for proper 5 volts
supply to potentiometers is
possible within a predefined
voltage limit.
MS 43
Range check for
throttle position
adaptation
Input analog
(0-5V)
Range check for closed
position of throttle sensors.
P1623
Output voltage for
potentiometer
operation 2
DME internal (5V)
Check for proper 5 volts
supply to potentiometers is
possible within a predefined
voltage limit.
115
116
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
9 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
117
P1542
Pedal sensor
potentiometer
plausibility
Input analog
(0-5V)
If there is a difference greater
than specified between two
redundant signals from
potentiometer, fault will be
set.
118
P0120
MS 42
Motor throttle
feedback
potentiometer
plausibility
Input analog
(0-5V)
If there is a difference greater
than specified between two
redundant signals from
potentiometer, fault will be
set.
MS 43
Throttle position
sensor 1;
plausibility check
sensor 1 to mass
air flow meter
DME internal
values
Signal range is checked
against predetermined
diagnostic limits. Rationality
check with mass air flow
meter.
P1580
MS 42
MDK, throttle
mechanical
sticking
DME internal test
Throttle doesn't reach desired
opening angle within a
specified time.
MS 43
Throttle position
sensor 2;
plausibility check
sensor 1 to mass
air flow meter
DME internal
values
Signal range is checked
against predetermined
diagnostic limits. Rationality
check with mass air flow
meter.
P1542
MS 42
Pedal sensor/
DME internal
motor throttle valve values logical
potentiometer not
motor
plausible
Signal from motor throttle
valve potentiometer must be
equal signal from pedal
sensor potentiometer plus
any adaptive values.
MS 43
Plausibility check
between brake
switch and pedal
sensor
Input digital /
analog
Plausibility check between
constant pedal value and
brake switch. First pedal
value must be constant and
for next step brake switch
must be active.
122
P1101
Oil temp. sensor
malfunction
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits and calculated
temperature.
123
P1622
Electric thermostat
control, final stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
119
120
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
10 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
124
P1593
DISA, range/perf.
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
Coolant fan, final
stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
P1470
MS 42
LDP-magnetic
valve
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
MS 43
DMTL valve
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
127
Fuel pump
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
128
EWS signal not
present or faulty
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
During time out check no
signal was present within
specific time or faulty
information from serial
interface (parity, overrun,
etc.).
130
CAN time out
(ASC1)
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
125
126
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
11 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
131
CAN time out (instr Input binary
2)
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
132
CAN time out (instr Input binary
3)
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
133
CAN time out
(ASC3)
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS not received within
expected time.
135
MS 43
Limp home
position adaptation
necessary
DME internal
values logical
Limp home position must be
in specified range. If range is
exceeded, a fault is set.
136
MS 43
Motor throttle valve DME internal
open / closing test values logical
failed
From limp home mode
position, throttle valve will be
open, afterwards it must fall
back into limp home position.
If fall back position is not in
specified range, fault is set.
140
P1475
LDP reed-switch
not closed
Input digital on/off
(0-12V)
With shut off valve open and
no pressure on system, reed
contact should be closed,
showing a "high signal". If not
the case in beginning of every
diagnostics check, a signal is
sent.
140
MS 43
DMTL pump final
stage
Output digital
on/off (active low)
DME final stage will set flag
whenever a short to ground, a
short to battery voltage or a
disconnection between output
transistor and component
exists.
141
P1477
EVAP: reed switch
not closed, doesn't
open or doesn't
close
Input digital on/off
(0-12V)
Within predetermined time
LDP reed switch signal must
change from high to low or
from low to high or LDP reed
switch is "low" for longer than
predetermined time.
142
P1477
EVAP: reed switch
not closed, doesn't
open or doesn't
close
Input digital on/off
(0-12V)
Within predetermined time
LDP reed switch signal must
change from high to low or
from low to high or LDP reed
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
12 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
switch is "low" for longer than
predetermined time.
142
MS 43
DMTL module fault DME internal
values logical
143
P1476
EVAP: clamped
tube check
146
MS 43
DME internal input
Range check
voltage supply
analog
pedal sensor 2 and
throttle position
sensors
Supply voltage for sensors
must be within a specified
range.
147
MS 43
Range check
DME internal input
voltage supply
analog
pedal sensor 2 and
throttle position
sensors
Supply voltage for sensors
must be within a specified
range.
149
P1140
Motor throttle
feedback
potentiometer and
air mass sensor
signal not
plausible
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal from motor throttle
valve potentiometer must be
suitable to signal from air
mass sensor. A fault is set if
difference exceeds specified
limit.
150
P0130
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
short to battery
volt.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal has to be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or a fault will set.
151
P0130
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
short to ground
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
152
P0130
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
Input digital
frequency (0-12V)
Frequency of LDP pumps
reed switch is lower then
predetermined limit. Volume
of leak is determined to be too
small (i.e. pinched or
restricted hose)
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
13 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
on input line.
153
P0150
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 2),
short to battery
volt.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
154
P0150
Oxygen
sensorpre-cat
(Bank 2), short to
ground
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
155
P0150
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 2),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
on input line.
156
P0136
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 1),
short to battery
volt.
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
157
P0136
Oxygen sensor
Input analog
Post Cat. (Bank 1), (0-5V)
short to ground
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
159
P0156
Input analog
Oxygen sensor
Post Cat. (Bank 2), (0-5V)
short to battery
volt.
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
160
P0156
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 2),
short to ground
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical shorts exist on input
line. Voltage signal must be
within a predetermined range
(0.1V -1V) or fault will set.
Input analog
(0-5V)
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
14 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
160
MS 43
Throttle valve
position controller
DME internal
values logical
161
MS 43
Throttle valve
position controller
DME internal
values logical
162
MS 43
Throttle valve
position controller
DME internal
values logical
168
MS 43
Throttle valve
position, throttle
sticking
DME internal test
calculated
MDK final stage
shut off
DME internal test
This fault indicates problem
on pedal sensor, throttle
potentiometer or throttle. A
separately stored fault code
indicates problem.
169
Explanation
171
P0601
System has been
shut down due to
safety controller
DME internal test
Safety controller has shut
down motor throttle valve
function due to not plausible
MDK input values.
172
P1542
Pedal sensor
potentiometer
short between two
potentiometer
paths
DME internal
check
5 volts for potentiometers are
switched on within a specific
time pattern.
173
P0120
Motor throttle valve Rationality check
potentiometer
contact short
Motor throttle valve
potentiometer
174
P0120
Motor throttle valve Input analog
potentiometer
(0-5V)
adaptation of idle
end position
Signal for idle position must
be within a specified range. If
range is exceeded, fault is
set.
Pedal sensor
potentiometer 1
adaptation of the
idle end position
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal for idle position must
be within a specified range. If
range is exceeded, fault is
set.
Pedal sensor
potentiometer 2
adaptation of the
idle end position
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal for idle position must
be within a specified range. If
range is exceeded, fault is
set.
175
176
P1542
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
15 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
188
P1132
Oxygen sensor
heater, pre-cat
(Bank 1),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
189
P1133
Oxygen sensor
heater, pre-cat
(Bank 2),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
190
P1186
Oxygen sensorheater, post-cat
(Bank 1),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
191
P1187
Oxygen sensor
heater, post-cat
(Bank 2),
insufficient
Output digital
pulse width (active
low)
DME internally calculated
heater power is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits.
197
MS 43
Signal range check DME internal
analog input
202
P0170
Fuel trim (Bank 1),
O2 control limit
DME internal
values logical
Controller for lambda is too
long beyond a min. or a max.
203
P0173
Fuel Trim (Bank 2), DME internal
O2 control limit
values logical
Controller for lambda is too
long beyond a min. or a max.
204
P0505
Idle control
system, idle speed
not plausible
DME internal
values logical
Functional check between
actual engine speed (RPM)
and predetermined RPM
exceeds maximum deviation
of +200/-100 RPM.
208
EWS, engine
speed check not
ok
DME internal test
Engine speed signal is
transferred by EWS to DME.
Fault is set if transferred
signal is not reflecting engine
speed due to input problem in
EWS.
209
EWS, content of
message
Input binary
stream bit data
(0-12V)
Content of binary message
received from EWS invalid.
210
Ignition feedback,
faulty (>2
cylinders)
Input analog
timing (100 mV)
Check for correct signal
timing after each ignition has
been initiated by feedback
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
16 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
signal. If more than two
ignition signals are not
recognized than there might
be a problem in feedback line.
211
P1510
Idle control valve
stuck
DME internal
values logical
Functional check against a
calculated value by
monitoring flow though air
mass meter to determine if
idle valve is mechanically
stuck open. Tested during
closed throttle.
214
P0500
Vehicle speed
sensor
Input digital
frequency (0-12V)
Signal range is checked
against predefined diagnostic
limits. No vehicle speed is
observed after specific time
when compared to engine
speed and load equivalent to
moving vehicle.
215
P0136
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 1),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
on input line.
216
P0136
Oxygen sensor
post-cat (Bank 2),
disconnection
Input analog
(0-5V)
Oxygen sensor signal range
is checked to determine if
electrical disconnection exist
on input line.
217
P0505
CAN time out
(EGS1)
Input digital binary
information(0-12V)
CAN message between
DME/EGS was not received
within expected time.
CAN-chip, bus off
Input digital binary Hardware test determines if
information (0-12V) CAN bus is off line. Data
transmission is disturbed.
219
220
P1184
Input analog (high
Oxygen sensor
is lean) (0-5V)
post-cat (Bank 1)
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor stays in rich or
lean state. If it remains there
too long in either, fault will
set.
221
P1185
Input analog (high
Oxygen sensor
is lean) (0-5V)
post-cat (Bank 2)
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor stays in rich or
lean state. If it remains there
too long in either fault will set.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
17 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
222
P0125
Insufficient coolant
temp. to permit
closed loop
operation
Input analog
(0-5V)
Comparison of actual coolant
temperature against
calculated DME value which
varies with load signal.
223
P1180
Oxygen sensor
Input analog (high
post-cat (Bank 1),
is lean) (0-5V)
switching time slow
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If too long, fault will
set.
224
P1181
Oxygen sensor
Input analog (high
post-cat (Bank 2),
is lean) (0-5V)
switching time slow
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If too long, fault will
set.
225
P1192
Post-cat sensor
(Bank 1); trim
control
Input analog
(0-5V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with post
catalyst sensor bank 1.
226
P0193
Post-cat sensor
(Bank 2); trim
control
Input analog
(0-5V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with post
catalyst sensor bank 2.
227
P0188
Fuel trim (Bank 1),
O2 control
adaptation limit
DME internal
values logical
Range control of adaptation
values.
228
P0189
Fuel trim (Bank 2),
O2 control
adaptation limit
DME internal
values logical
Range control of adaptation
values.
229
P0133
Oxygen sensor
Input analog (high
pre-cat (Bank 1,
is lean) (0-5V)
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If too long, fault will
set.
230
P0153
Input analog (high
Oxygen sensor
is lean) (0-5V)
pre-cat (Bank 2),
slow response time
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor stays in its rich
or lean state. If it remains
there too long in either fault
will set.
231
P1178
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 1),
switch time too
slow
Input analog (high
is lean) (0-5V)
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If it takes too long to
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
18 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
switch fault will set.
232
P0179
Oxygen sensor
pre-cat (Bank 2),
switch time too
slow
Input analog (high
is lean) (0-5V)
Checks amount of time
oxygen sensor takes to switch
from rich to lean and vice
versa. If it takes too long to
switch fault will set.
233
P0420
Catalyst efficiency
(Bank 1), below
threshold
Input analog
(0-5V)
Compares value of pre-cat
oxygen sensor to value of
post-cat oxygen sensor to
measure oxygen storage
capability / efficiency of
catalytic converter. Post-cat
oxygen sensor must be
relatively lean.
234
P0430
Catalyst efficiency
(Bank 2), below
threshold
Input analog
(0-5V)
Compares value of pre-cat
oxygen sensor to value of
post-cat oxygen sensor to
measure oxygen storage
capability / efficiency of
catalytic converter. Post-cat
oxygen sensor must be
relatively lean.
235
P1190
Pre-cat sensor
(Bank 1):trim
control
Input analog (high
is rich) (0-1V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with
pre-cat sensor bank 1
236
P1191
Pre-cat sensor
(Bank 2):trim
control
Input analog (high
is rich) (0-1V)
Rationality check for O2
control adaptation with
pre-cat sensor bank 2
238
P0301
Cyl. 1 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 1 is longer, fault
will set.
239
P0302
Cyl. 2 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
19 of 20
BMW
code
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
for cylinder 2 is longer, fault
will set.
240
P0303
Cyl. 3 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 3 is longer, fault
will set.
241
P0304
Cyl. 4 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 4 is longer, fault
will set.
242
P0305
Cyl. 5 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 5 is longer, fault
will set.
243
P0306
Cyl. 6 misfire
detected
DME internal
values logical
Crankshaft
speed/acceleration is
monitored by crank sensor.
Time for each cylinder
combustion is compared
against avg. of others. If time
for cylinder 6 is longer, fault
will set.
Segment timing
faulty, flywheel
adaptation
Input analog
(0-5V)
Flywheel segments are
monitored during deceleration
to establish baseline for
misfire calculation. If
segments are too long/short
(bad flywheel) and exceed
limit, fault will be set.
244
2/25/2009 11:23 PM
On-Board Diagnostics
20 of 20
http://ebahn.bentleypublishers.com/BMW/3/E46/Repair%20Manuals/8...
BMW
code
P-code
Fault type and
function
Signal type and
range
Explanation
245
P1423
Secondary air
injection (Bank 1),
flow too low
Input analog
(0-5V)
Checks to see if oxygen
sensor reacts to increase in
unmetered airflow generated
by secondary air pump
operation. Oxygen sensor
must sense lean condition or
fault will set.
246
P1421
Secondary air
injection (Bank 2),
flow too low
Input analog
(0-5V)
Checks to see if oxygen
sensor reacts to increase in
unmetered airflow generated
by secondary air pump
operation. Oxygen sensor
must sense lean condition or
fault will set.
247
P1432
Secondary air
valve stuck open
Input analog
(0-5V)
Checks to see if oxygen
sensor reacts to increase in
unmetered airflow generated
by secondary air pump
operation. Oxygen sensor
must sense lean condition or
fault will set.
248
P1184
Post-cat sensor;
signal after decel
phase not
plausible; (Bank 1)
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal is checked for a lean
signal in decel and a
transition between lean to rich
after decel
249
P1185
Post-cat sensor;
signal after decel
phase not
plausible; (Bank 2)
Input analog
(0-5V)
Signal is checked for a lean
signal in decel and a
transition between lean to rich
after decel
250
P0440
Functional check
purge valve
Input analog
(0-5V)
This functional check looks
for reaction of oxygen sensor
signal during canister
purging. Oxygen sensor, air
flow meter and RPM values
must react to purging of
canister.
Copyright © 2006 Robert Bentley, Inc. All rights reserved.
2/25/2009 11:23 PM